Table of Contents

As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on September 7, 2010

Registration No. 333-165200

 

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

AMENDMENT NO. 6

to

FORM S-1

REGISTRATION STATEMENT

UNDER

THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933

Tower Automotive, LLC

to be converted as described herein to a corporation named

TOWER INTERNATIONAL, INC.

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

 

Delaware   3714   20-8879584

(State or other jurisdiction of

incorporation or organization)

 

(Primary Standard Industrial

Classification Code number)

 

(I.R.S. Employer

Identification Number)

17672 Laurel Park Drive North, Suite 400E

Livonia, Michigan 48152

(248) 675-6000

(Address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of registrant’s principal executive offices)

James Gouin

Chief Financial Officer

17672 Laurel Park Drive North, Suite 400E

Livonia, Michigan 48152

(248) 675-6000

(Name, address, including zip code and telephone number, including area code, of agent for service)

Please address a copy of all communications to:

 

Peter H. Ehrenberg, Esq.

Michael J. Reinhardt, Esq.

Lowenstein Sandler PC

1251 Avenue of the Americas

New York, New York 10020

(212) 262-6700

  

Joseph A. Hall, Esq.

Davis Polk & Wardwell LLP

450 Lexington Avenue

New York, New York 10017

(212) 450-4000

Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public: As soon as practicable after this Registration Statement becomes effective.

If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of 1933, check the following box.   ¨

If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, please check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.   ¨

If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.   ¨

If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.   ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

 

Large accelerated filer   ¨   Accelerated filer   ¨   Non-accelerated filer   x   Smaller reporting company   ¨
   

(Do not check if a smaller

reporting company)

 

The Registrant hereby amends this Registration Statement on such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the Registrant shall file a further amendment which specifically states that this Registration Statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933 or until the Registration Statement shall become effective on such date as the Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.

 

 

 


Table of Contents

The information in this prospectus is not complete and may be changed. We may not sell these securities until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities and it is not soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted.

 

Subject to Completion

Preliminary Prospectus dated September 7, 2010

 

PROSPECTUS

            Shares

LOGO

Tower International, Inc.

Common Stock

 

 

This is Tower International, Inc.’s initial public offering. We are selling              shares of our common stock.

We expect the public offering price to be between $             and $             per share. Currently, no public market exists for the shares. Our shares have been approved for listing on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “TOWR.”

Investing in our common stock involves risks that are described under “ Risk Factors ” beginning on page 18 of this prospectus.

 

 

 

     Per Share    Total

Public offering price

   $                 $             

Underwriting discount

   $                 $             

Proceeds, before expenses, to us

   $                 $             

The underwriters may also purchase up to an additional              shares from us, at the public offering price, less the underwriting discount, within 30 days from the date of this prospectus to cover over-allotments, if any.

Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any state securities commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or determined if this prospectus is truthful or complete. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

The underwriters expect to deliver the shares against payment in New York, New York on or about                 , 2010.

 

Goldman, Sachs & Co.   Citi   J.P. Morgan
Wells Fargo Securities    Baird    Lazard Capital Markets

The date of this prospectus is                     , 2010.


Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

     Page

Prospectus Summary

   1

Risk Factors

   18

Special Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements

   41

Use of Proceeds

   42

Dividend Policy

   43

Capitalization

   44

Dilution

   47

Selected Historical Consolidated Financial Data

   49

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

   52

Business

   90

Management

   108

Compensation Discussion and Analysis

   114

Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions

   136

Principal Stockholders

   139

Description of Certain Indebtedness

   141

Description of Capital Stock

   147

Shares Eligible for Future Sale

   151

Material United States Federal Income and Estate Tax Considerations for Non-U.S. Holders

   153

Underwriting

   156

Conflicts of Interest

   161

Legal Matters

   161

Experts

   161

Where You Can Find More Information

   162

Index to Financial Statements

   F-1

We have not authorized anyone to provide any information other than that contained in this prospectus or in any free writing prospectus prepared by or on behalf of us. We take no responsibility for, and can provide no assurance as to the reliability of, any other information that others may give you. We are offering to sell, and seeking offers to buy, our common stock only in jurisdictions where offers and sales are permitted. The information contained in this prospectus is accurate only as of the date of this prospectus, regardless of the time of delivery of this prospectus or of any sale of our common stock.

Through and including                     , 2010 (the 25th day after the date of this prospectus), all dealers effecting transactions in these securities, whether or not participating in this offering, may be required to deliver a prospectus. This is in addition to a dealer’s obligation to deliver a prospectus when acting as an underwriter and with respect to an unsold allotment or subscription.

MARKET AND INDUSTRY DATA

Market and industry data used throughout this prospectus, including information relating to our relative position in the vehicle structural component and assemblies industry, is based on the good faith estimates of management, which in turn are based upon management’s review of internal surveys, independent industry surveys and publications and other publicly available information, including reports and information prepared by CSM Worldwide ® , a global forecasting service for automotive production. The reports prepared by CSM Worldwide ® are subscription-based. All references in this prospectus to historical industry production volumes, projections, estimates or other data attributable to CSM Worldwide ® are based on data available from the CSM Worldwide ® July 2010 forecast.

 

i


Table of Contents

TRADEMARKS AND TRADE NAMES

We own or have rights to trademarks or trade names that we use in conjunction with the operation of our business. In addition, our name, logo and website name and address are our service marks or trademarks. Each trademark, trade name or service mark by any other company appearing in this prospectus belongs to its holder. Our principal trademark or trade name that we use is Tower Automotive ® .

CORPORATE CONVERSION

Immediately prior to the consummation of this offering, we will convert from a Delaware limited liability company to a Delaware corporation and will change our name from Tower Automotive, LLC to Tower International, Inc. We refer to this transaction as the Corporate Conversion. See “Business—Our History and Corporate Structure—Our Corporate Conversion.”

 

ii


Table of Contents

PROSPECTUS SUMMARY

The following summary is qualified in its entirety by, and should be read together with, the more detailed information and financial statements and related notes thereto appearing elsewhere in this prospectus. You should read the entire prospectus carefully, particularly the “Risk Factors” beginning on page 18 and our consolidated financial statements and the related notes thereto. In this prospectus, unless otherwise indicated or the context otherwise requires, references to (1) the terms “we,” “us,” “our,” the “Company,” “Tower” and “Tower Automotive” refer to Tower International, Inc. and its subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, (2) the term “CCM” refers only to Cerberus Capital Management, L.P. and (3) the term “Cerberus” refers to CCM and funds and accounts affiliated with CCM. The terms “Adjusted EBITDA” and “Adjusted EBITDA margin” are defined in footnotes 10 and 11 in “—Summary Consolidated Financial Data,” and the terms “Predecessor” and “Successor” are defined in “—Summary Consolidated Financial Data.”

Our Company

We are a leading integrated global manufacturer of engineered structural metal components and assemblies primarily serving automotive original equipment manufacturers, or OEMs. We offer our automotive customers a broad product portfolio, supplying body-structure stampings, frame and other chassis structures, as well as complex welded assemblies, for small and large cars, crossovers, pickups and SUVs. We have also recently entered the utility-scale solar energy market with an agreement to supply large stamped mirror-facet panels and welded support structures. We refer to such agreement as our solar agreement.

 

Product Offerings

LOGO

Our products are manufactured at 31 production facilities strategically located near our customers in North America, South America, Europe and Asia. We support our manufacturing operations through nine engineering and sales locations throughout the world. We are a disciplined, process-driven company with an experienced management team that has a history of implementing sustainable operational improvements. From January 1, 2008 through December 31, 2009, we achieved $195 million in manufacturing and purchasing cost reductions.

 

 

1


Table of Contents

We achieved these cost reductions in large part through successful implementation of Lean Six Sigma principles and rigorous application of global best practices. These cost reductions helped us achieve a 6% gross profit margin in 2009 during an historically challenging environment in the automotive industry. For the year ended December 31, 2009, we generated revenues of $1.6 billion and a net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC of $(67.9) million. In addition, we had Adjusted EBITDA of $125 million and an Adjusted EBITDA margin of 7.6% for the year ended December 31, 2009. For the six months ended June 30, 2010, we generated revenues of $980.8 million and a net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC of $(2.6) million. In addition, we had Adjusted EBITDA of $102.4 million and an Adjusted EBITDA margin of 10.4% for the six months ended June 30, 2010.

We believe that our product capabilities, our geographic, customer and product diversification and the cost reductions that we achieved in 2008 and 2009 position us to benefit from a recovery in global automotive industry production. We also intend to leverage our program management and engineering expertise to pursue growth opportunities outside of our existing automotive markets, as demonstrated by our solar agreement.

Our Industry

CSM Worldwide ® projects significant growth in the global automotive market, with production expected to increase from 57 million units in 2009 to 83 million units by 2013.

CSM Worldwide ® Global Light Vehicle Production Forecast (millions of units)

LOGO

We believe OEMs produce a majority of their structural metal components and assemblies internally. While OEM policies differ and may be especially impacted by their own capacity utilization, the capital expenditures associated with internal production can be substantial. We believe that longer term, OEMs may outsource a greater proportion of their stamping requirements because of this capital and fixed-cost intensity and we may benefit from this shift in our customer preferences. In addition, we believe OEMs will increasingly favor global vehicle platforms supported by larger, more capable and financially strong suppliers. Given our global manufacturing footprint, competitive cost structure and integrated design, engineering and program management capabilities, we are well-positioned to take advantage of these potential opportunities.

 

 

2


Table of Contents

Our Competitive Strengths

Geographic Diversification

We are well-diversified geographically, which positions us to participate in growth opportunities as they occur over time around the world and mitigates the impact of regional production fluctuations on our business. These potential opportunities range from near-term cyclical volume recovery in North America and Europe to continued growth in emerging markets such as Brazil and China. Proximity to end customers is especially important in our business because size and weight make our products difficult and expensive to transport. Our geographic mix of 2009 revenues is shown below:

Geographic Mix (% of 2009 Revenues)

LOGO

Customer Diversification

We have a well-diversified customer mix. In 2009, no single customer accounted for more than 17% of our revenues, and ten different OEMs individually accounted for 5% or more of our revenues. European OEMs were our biggest customer group in 2009, followed by Asian OEMs, with Detroit 3 OEMs representing the smallest group, at 18% of 2009 revenues. Ford accounted for approximately 70% of our 2009 Detroit 3 revenues. With this customer diversification, we believe we are well-positioned to participate in the anticipated automotive recovery, while also mitigating our exposure to any individual customer. The term “Detroit 3” refers collectively to Ford, General Motors and Chrysler and the term “European OEMs” includes Volvo and Opel.

Customer Mix (% of 2009 Revenues)

 

LOGO

 

 

3


Table of Contents

Platform Diversification

Our products are offered on a diverse mix of vehicle platforms, reflecting the balanced portfolio approach of our business model and the breadth of our product capabilities. We believe that our platform diversification provides us an opportunity to participate in an industry recovery without being overly exposed to a single vehicle model. We supply products to approximately 160 vehicle models globally. Our 10 largest vehicle models represented approximately 36% of our 2009 revenues.

Vehicle Segment Mix (% of 2009 Revenues)

LOGO

See “Business—Our Competitive Strengths—Platform Diversification” for definitions of the terms “small cars,” “large cars” and “North American framed vehicles.”

Competitive Cost Structure

Based on the cost improvement actions we have taken, the results we have achieved and our experience in the automotive industry, we believe we have a competitive cost structure. During the Predecessor’s restructuring, while operating under bankruptcy protection, it achieved significant savings. For example, in North America the Predecessor reduced its manufacturing footprint from 23 to 12 plants, a 48% reduction. In addition, our average North American labor rate for hourly production workers, including wages and fringe benefits, was reduced by approximately 15%, to what we believe is a competitive level for our sector, and we froze our pension plan. We also capped our post-retirement healthcare liability to an amount which, at December 31, 2009, was $1.7 million. Following the acquisition of the Predecessor’s assets, we moved aggressively to improve productivity and manufacturing throughput to world-class standards to further improve our cost structure. We launched eight operating efficiency initiatives through 2009, we launched two additional operating efficiency initiatives in 2010 and we intend to implement other efficiency programs in the future to assist us in driving costs out of our manufacturing and procurement processes.

 

 

4


Table of Contents

Efficiency Initiatives

LOGO

See “Business—Manufacturing and Operations” for a detailed explanation of this chart.

We measure our operating efficiencies in manufacturing and purchasing cost reductions as a percentage of our material and manufacturing costs. As a result of our process-driven initiatives, we significantly increased that annual percentage improvement from approximately 2% in 2006 to approximately 6% in 2009 resulting in $195 million in manufacturing and purchasing cost savings from January 1, 2008 through December 31, 2009. Our focus in 2010 and beyond is to retain the benefit of these achieved cost savings as anticipated volume recovery occurs.

Operating Efficiencies vs. Prior Year

(Manufacturing and Purchasing Cost Reductions as % of Manufacturing and Material Costs)

LOGO

 

 

5


Table of Contents

Good Quality

Through rigorous standardization of global best practices and major process improvements such as Lean Six Sigma, we have improved our quality results, with customer-reported defects per million parts, or PPM, down to 29 in 2009.

Customer-Reported PPM

LOGO

Experienced Management Team

Our senior management team has substantial industry and related operational and financial experience. In addition, the eight executives comprising our executive leadership team have been in place as a cohesive group essentially since we acquired the Predecessor’s assets in 2007. Mark Malcolm, our Chief Executive Officer since August 2007, worked for 28 years in a broad variety of roles with Ford Motor Company. Mr. Malcolm then became a senior operational adviser for Cerberus, where he led a year-long due diligence effort prior to the acquisition of the Predecessor’s assets, assessing strengths and weaknesses and developing the business plan that we have executed since the acquisition. Our Chief Operating Officer, Michael Rajkovic, worked for Ford and Visteon prior to assuming officer positions at Goodyear and U.S. Can Corporation. Jim Gouin, our Chief Financial Officer, worked for 28 years at Ford, including as Vice President, Finance and Global Corporate Controller.

 

 

6


Table of Contents

Our Strategy

Our strategy is to strengthen our leadership position as a supplier to the global automotive industry and to expand opportunistically into non-automotive markets. We believe that our core strengths described above position us to continue to provide a high-quality, low-cost value proposition to our customers, enabling profitable growth. Specific strategic objectives include:

Revenue Growth

Our strategy for revenue growth has three main pillars: organic automotive growth, expansion into solar and other non-automotive markets, and opportunistic acquisitions and joint ventures.

Organic Automotive Growth:     Although for planning purposes we have been and remain cautious about the pace of automotive industry recovery in 2010, we believe that vehicle growth will be above-average over the next three to five years. Having significantly improved our cost structure over the last three years, we believe that we are poised to benefit from an anticipated cyclical recovery in the European and North American markets and to grow in developing markets like Brazil and China. In terms of organic automotive growth, our planning assumption is that our growth will roughly track the growth in annual vehicle production. We will also strive to increase our share of business, principally through contract wins for new models developed by our existing customers and by expanding our customer base, while maintaining good geographic, customer and platform diversification.

Expansion into Solar and Other Non-Automotive Markets:     We intend to leverage our integrated engineering, manufacturing and program-management expertise to pursue growth opportunities in non-automotive markets. The solar industry shows promise for us, as many applications require highly engineered large stampings and complex welded structural assemblies that must be produced in high volume at repeatable tight tolerances, similar to our product requirements in the automotive industry. To date, we have won a solar agreement initially entered into in August 2009. The amount of revenues that we may generate from this agreement will depend in part upon the extent of the financing our customer is able to raise for its solar projects. Efforts by our customer to obtain such financing may be subject to substantial delays and may ultimately be unsuccessful. We cannot be sure when production will commence or when revenues will be generated from these projects until our customer secures appropriate financing. While we plan to invest approximately $30 to $35 million (net of government and other incentives) to support this agreement, we cannot yet predict the extent to which such spending will be made in 2010 or in subsequent periods. Our capital expenditures for these projects would include investing in a new facility in the southwest United States that could provide a base for additional expansion. We believe the solar industry in the United States and globally has the potential to grow at an average rate substantially greater than the trend rate for the automotive industry. Beyond solar, we believe there may be similar opportunities in the future to apply and extend our core skills in other industries, such as defense, wind or appliances.

Opportunistic Acquisitions and Joint Ventures:     We intend to analyze and pursue acquisition opportunities where we believe we can add value and realize synergies by improving operating results through application of our processes, as demonstrated in our own business. We anticipate that the automotive structural metal components and assemblies sector will experience increased consolidation and believe that we are well-positioned to participate successfully in that evolution. We also intend to seek suitable partners to set up additional joint ventures in developing automotive markets, such as China, which we believe have above-average secular growth prospects. While we regularly participate in discussions with potential acquisition targets and joint venture partners, there are presently no specific agreements that have reached the stage where execution has become probable.

Continuous Process-Driven Operating Improvements

Our business philosophy and approach is grounded in the fundamental importance of building capabilities through ongoing process awareness and improvements. That focus and mindset applies to daily plant and cash reports, to detailed monthly business reviews, to our adoption and implementation of Lean Six Sigma principles, to our global inventory reduction process, to our internal controls, to our employee engagement process that measures the involvement of our employees and to many other critical governance and business processes

 

 

7


Table of Contents

employed and under development in our company. Near-term results must be delivered, but we strive to do so in a way that is repeatable and sustainable, strengthening our longer-term competitiveness to the ultimate benefit of our customers, employees, suppliers and stockholders.

Intense Focus on Cash Flow

We have a common focus and an alignment of incentives throughout our company on the importance of operating cash flow. For example, we track cash on a daily basis and our global bonus program is tied largely to cash flow metrics. This common focus and aligned incentive with respect to cash flow among all our employees helps us in seeking to create value for our stockholders. For example, inventories were reduced from 23 average days on hand in December 2007 to approximately 13 average days on hand in December 2009.

Maintain a Sound Balance Sheet

We consider it critical to maintain a sound balance sheet in the cyclical automotive industry. That mindset and approach helped us weather the severe 2009 downturn without violating our loan covenants, and we intend to maintain this approach going forward. We anticipate reducing our leverage by applying a portion of the net proceeds from this offering to repay indebtedness.

Recent Developments

On August 24, 2010, our wholly owned subsidiaries Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc., which we refer to in this prospectus as the “Issuers,” consummated the sale of $430 million aggregate principal amount of their 10.625% Senior Secured Notes due 2017, resulting in estimated net proceeds to the Issuers of $409.4 million, after deducting original issue discount, discounts to the initial purchasers and estimated fees and expenses. We refer to such notes in this prospectus as the “notes.” The notes are jointly and severally and unconditionally guaranteed by Tower Automotive, LLC (which upon consummation of the Corporate Conversion will become Tower International, Inc.) on a senior unsecured basis, and by Tower Automotive, LLC’s existing domestic subsidiaries (other than TA Holdings Finance, Inc.) that are guarantors of our revolving credit facility and our synthetic letter of credit facility on a senior secured basis. See “Description of Certain Indebtedness — 10.625% Senior Secured Notes due 2017.” We used the net proceeds from the offering of the notes, as well as $5.9 million of our cash, to retire our first lien term loan, other than the synthetic letter of credit facility associated with that loan.

Ownership

Prior to this offering, we will become a Delaware corporation and all of our outstanding capital stock will be owned by Tower International Holdings, LLC, a newly formed entity controlled by Cerberus. We sometimes refer to Tower International Holdings, LLC in this prospectus as our controlling stockholder.

In connection with the closing of this offering, we will issue restricted stock units, or RSUs, to our executive officers and certain board members under one of our benefit plans. We will also grant stock options to our executive officers, board members and other employees, each with an exercise price equal to the price to the public of our common stock offered in this offering. Immediately after this offering, Tower International Holdings, LLC will control approximately     % (approximately     % if the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares is exercised in full) of our common stock. Such percentages are based on shares of common stock outstanding and do not take into account common stock underlying such RSUs and stock options. Such RSUs will have nine month and eighteen month vesting periods and such stock options will vest ratably on March 1, 2012, March 1, 2013 and March 1, 2014.

Corporate Information

Our principal executive offices are located at 17672 Laurel Park Drive North, Suite 400E, Livonia, Michigan 48152, and our telephone number is (248) 675-6000. For information regarding our corporate history, see “Business—Our History and Corporate Structure.” Our website address is www.towerautomotive.com. The information contained on our website or that can be accessed through our website is not part of this prospectus, and investors should not rely on any such information in deciding whether to purchase our common stock.

 

 

8


Table of Contents

THE OFFERING

 

Common stock we are offering.

             shares (or              shares if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares in full).

 

Common stock to be outstanding after this offering

             shares (or              shares if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares in full).

 

Use of proceeds

The net proceeds to us from this offering will be approximately $              after deducting the underwriting discount and estimated expenses of this offering and assuming we sell the shares for $              per share, representing the midpoint of the range on the cover page of this prospectus. We intend to use the net proceeds of this offering to retire indebtedness and for working capital and general corporate purposes. See “Use of Proceeds.”

 

Dividend policy

We do not intend to pay dividends on our common stock in the foreseeable future. See “Dividend Policy.”

 

Risk factors

See “Risk Factors” and other information included in this prospectus for a discussion of factors you should carefully consider before deciding to invest in our common stock.

 

Proposed ticker symbol

“TOWR”

 

Conflicts of interest

More than 5% of the net proceeds of the offering is expected to be used to repay borrowings we have received from both JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., an affiliate of J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., an affiliate of Wells Fargo Securities, LLC. Because J.P. Morgan Securities LLC and Wells Fargo Securities, LLC are participating underwriters in this offering, a “conflict of interest” is deemed to exist under the applicable provisions of Rule 2720 of the Conduct Rules of the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc., or FINRA. Accordingly, this offering will be made in compliance with the applicable provisions of Rule 2720 of the Conduct Rules. Rule 2720 currently requires that a “qualified independent underwriter,” as defined by the FINRA rules, participate in the preparation of the registration statement and the prospectus and exercise the usual standards of due diligence in respect thereto. Goldman, Sachs & Co. is serving in that capacity. For more information, see “Conflicts of Interest.”

The number of shares of common stock outstanding after the offering is based on              shares of common stock issuable pursuant to our Corporate Conversion and excludes              shares reserved for issuance under RSUs which we expect to grant to our executive officers and certain board members pursuant to one of our benefit plans in connection with the consummation of this offering, which RSUs will be subject to vesting requirements. See “Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—Long Term Incentive Compensation Awards.” The number of shares of common stock

 

 

9


Table of Contents

outstanding after the offering also excludes stock options covering a total of              shares of our common stock which we expect to grant to our executive officers, board members and other employees in connection with the consummation of this offering, which stock options will be subject to vesting requirements. See “Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—2010 Equity Incentive Plan.”

Unless otherwise indicated, all information contained in this prospectus assumes that the underwriters do not exercise their option to purchase up to              additional shares of our common stock and assumes that our Corporate Conversion has been consummated.

For more detailed information regarding our common stock, see “Description of Capital Stock.”

 

 

10


Table of Contents

SUMMARY CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

The following tables set forth (i) summary consolidated financial data of Tower Automotive, LLC, for periods after July 31, 2007, the date on which we acquired substantially all of the assets and assumed certain specific liabilities of Tower Automotive, Inc. and its United States subsidiaries in connection with the bankruptcy proceedings of Tower Automotive, Inc. and such subsidiaries and acquired the capital stock of substantially all of the foreign subsidiaries of Tower Automotive, Inc. and (ii) summary consolidated financial data of Tower Automotive, Inc. for periods on or before July 31, 2007. With respect to our financial data and throughout this prospectus, we refer to Tower Automotive, Inc. through July 31, 2007 as the Predecessor and we refer to Tower Automotive, LLC after July 31, 2007 as the Successor. The summary consolidated financial data for the periods ended December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007 and July 31, 2007 have been derived from our audited consolidated financial statements and related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. The summary consolidated financial data as of June 30, 2010 and for the six month periods ended June 30, 2010 and 2009 have been derived from our unaudited consolidated financial statements and related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. In the opinion of our management, such unaudited financial statements have been prepared on the same basis as the audited financial statements and reflect all adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring adjustments, necessary for a fair presentation of our results of operations and financial position for such periods.

Prior to the consummation of this offering, we will convert from a Delaware limited liability company to a Delaware corporation and will change our name from Tower Automotive, LLC to Tower International, Inc. We refer to this transaction as the Corporate Conversion. See “Business—Our History and Corporate Structure—Our Corporate Conversion.”

The summary consolidated financial data as of any date and for any period are not necessarily indicative of the results that may be achieved as of any future date or for any future period. As a result of the implementation of applicable accounting pronouncements relating to our acquisition of the Predecessor’s consolidated assets, the financial statements and financial data presented in this prospectus for dates and for periods ending on or before July 31, 2007 are not comparable with the financial statements and financial data presented in this prospectus for periods after July 31, 2007.

The following tables also set forth certain summary consolidated unaudited adjusted balance sheet data as of June 30, 2010, giving effect to the items described in footnote 7 to the tables. In addition, the following tables present certain summary unaudited pro forma and adjusted pro forma summary of operations data for the year ended December 31, 2009 and the six months ended June 30, 2010, giving effect to the items described in footnotes 4 and 5 to the tables. The summary consolidated unaudited adjusted balance sheet data and summary unaudited pro forma and adjusted pro forma summary of operations data are presented for informational purposes only and do not purport to represent what our financial condition or results of operations actually would have been had the referenced events occurred on the dates indicated or to project our financial condition or results of operations as of any future date or for any future period.

You should read the following summary financial data in conjunction with “Use of Proceeds,” “Selected Historical Consolidated Financial Data,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and our consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 

 

11


Table of Contents

Summary Consolidated Financial Data

 

    Successor     Predecessor(1)  
  Six Months
Ended June 30,
    Year Ended
December 31,
    Five Months
Ended
December  31,
2007
    Seven Months
Ended
July  31,
2007
 
  2010     2009     2009     2008      
                (in millions)  

Statement of Operations Data:

           

Revenues

  $ 980.8      $ 697.9      $ 1,634.4      $ 2,171.7      $ 1,086.1      $ 1,455.5   

Cost of sales

    872.0       
681.9
  
    1,536.8        1,991.3        970.5        1,325.9   

Gross profit

    108.8        16.0        97.6        180.4        115.6        129.6   

Gross profit margin

    11.1     2.3     6.0     8.3     10.6     8.9

Selling, general and administrative expenses(2)

  $ 65.0      $ 53.3      $ 118.3      $ 138.6      $ 57.0      $ 77.2   

Operating income/(loss)

    37.6        (37.5     (36.9     34.0        55.5        30.0   

Operating income/(loss) margin

    3.8     (5.4 )%      (2.3 )%      1.6     5.1     2.1

Interest expense, net.

  $ 27.3      $ 27.2      $ 56.9      $ 60.2      $ 34.0      $ 65.5   

Net income/(loss) attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC

    (2.6     (39.0     (67.9     (52.3     15.2        (106.0 )(3) 
    Six Months Ended
June 30, 2010
  Year Ended
December 31, 2009
           
    Actual   As Adjusted   Actual   As Adjusted            

Basic and diluted pro forma loss per share

      (4)       (5)       (4)       (5)      
    Successor     Predecessor  
  Six Months
Ended June 30,
    Year Ended
December 31,
    Five Months
Ended
December 31,

2007
    Seven Months
Ended
July 31,
2007
 
  2010     2009     2009     2008      
              (in millions)  

Cash Flow Data:

           

Net cash provided by (used in)

           

Operating activities

    $27.1        $(16.6   $ 48.9      $ 200.6      $ 118.2      $ 18.3   

Investing activities

    (56.8 )(6)      (45.6     (86.0     (126.8     (676.3     (53.4

Financing activities

    36.3        68.3        50.8        (32.3     651.4        53.0   
    As of June 30, 2010                
    Actual     As Adjusted
for the
Notes
Offering
  As Further
Adjusted
for this
Offering
               
    (in millions)                    

Balance Sheet Data(7):

             

Cash and cash equivalents

  $    149.6      $    143.7          

Total assets

    1,300.7        1,297.1          

Total debt(8)

    654.1        641.3          

Redeemable preferred units(9)

    179.5        —            

Total members’/stockholders’ equity (deficit)

    (156.3     42.7          
    Successor     Predecessor  
  Six Months
Ended June 30,
    Year Ended
December 31,
    Five Months
Ended
December  31,
2007
    Seven Months
Ended
July 31,
2007
 
  2010     2009     2009     2008      
                (dollars in millions)  

Other Financial Data:

           

Adjusted EBITDA(10)

    $102.4        $41.0      $ 125.0      $ 212.9      $ 123.6      $ 144.6   

Adjusted EBITDA margin(11)

    10.4     5.9     7.6     9.8     11.4     9.9

Capital expenditures(12)

  $ 33.2      $ 26.9      $ 78.9      $ 129.1 (13)    $ 39.4      $ 38.5   
    As of June 30, 2010                
    Actual   As Adjusted
for the
Notes
Offering
  As Further
Adjusted

for this
Offering
               
    (in millions)                    

Net debt(14)

  $504.5   $497.6          

 

 

12


Table of Contents

 

(1) For information regarding our acquisition of the Predecessor’s business in 2007, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Bases of Presentation—2007 Acquisition.”
(2) In connection with the closing of the notes offering, we paid a total of $5.5 million of compensation to our executive officers pursuant to a special incentive program. We have also committed to pay an additional $1.2 million under that program to certain executive officers upon the earlier of the consummation of this offering or August 24, 2011. See “Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Components of Compensation—Special Incentive Compensation.” This latter cash benefit will vest fully upon consummation of the closing of this offering. The payments of such $1.2 million vest immediately upon the closing of this offering because at such time there will be no further conditions to payment of that compensation. The full amount of the compensation paid pursuant to the special incentive program will be charged as a compensation expense against earnings in the year or years in which such compensation is paid.

In connection with the consummation of this offering, we expect to grant              RSUs covering an aggregate of              shares of our common stock to our executive officers and certain board members under our 2010 long-term incentive compensation program. See “Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—Long Term Incentive Compensation Awards.” The grant date value of the RSUs, less an estimated forfeiture amount, will be charged as a compensation expense against earnings over the vesting period of the RSUs, commencing in 2010.

In connection with the consummation of this offering, we expect to grant stock options covering an aggregate of              shares of our common stock to our executive officers, board members and other employees, each with an exercise price equal to the price to the public of our common stock sold in this offering. See “Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—2010 Equity Incentive Plan.” The grant date value of the stock options, less an estimated forfeiture amount, will be charged as a compensation expense against earnings over the vesting period of the stock options, commencing in 2010.

Upon consummation of this offering, we may establish a potential bonus pool under our Value Creation Plan for the benefit of approximately 70 employees, none of whom are executive officers. See “Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Compensation for Employees Who Are Not Named Executive Officers or Directors—Value Creation Plan.” The Value Creation Plan provides that actual payments of bonus amounts will not occur earlier than the date on which Tower International Holdings, LLC sells shares of our common stock with aggregate proceeds equal to the sum of (a) $180.9 million plus a ten percent return on such amount accruing from July 31, 2010 and (b) $25 million plus a ten percent return on such amount accruing from August 24, 2010. The aggregate bonus pool will represent a specified percentage, ranging from 3.75% to 4.2%, of the “net value gained” by affiliates of CCM in respect of their equity investment in Tower International Holdings, LLC. The “net value gained” is a formula amount designed to reflect the net unrealized profit in connection with this offering by affiliates of CCM in respect of their investment in such entity. Any compensation paid pursuant to the Value Creation Plan will be charged as a compensation expense against earnings over a period ending on the estimated date of payment of such compensation.

Upon consummation of the notes offering, we established a bonus pool of up to $7.5 million under our Supplemental Value Creation Program, also for the benefit of approximately 70 employees, none of whom are executive officers. This program provides that actual payments of such bonus amounts will be subject to nine and eighteen month vesting requirements. See “Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Compensation for Employees Who Are Not Named Executive Officers or Directors— Supplemental Value Creation Program.” Any compensation paid pursuant to the Supplemental Value Creation Program will be charged as a compensation expense against earnings over the applicable vesting periods.

 

 

13


Table of Contents

Set forth below is a summary of the amounts of the bonus and equity-based awards described above. The RSUs and stock options are described in terms of the number of shares of common stock underlying such RSUs and stock options.

 

($ in millions)

   Special
Incentive
Compensation  ($)
   RSUs (#)    Stock
Options
(#)
   Value
Creation
Plan ($)
    Supplemental
Value
Creation
Program ($)
 

Executive officers

   $ 6.7            —          —     

Directors

     —              —          —     

Other employees

     —      —         $        $ 7.5   
                                 

Total

   $ 6.7          $    (a)(b)    $ 7.5 (a) 
                                 

 

  (a) The amount to be charged against earnings will be subject to reduction based on an estimated forfeiture amount for the awards.
  (b) The dollar amount for the Value Creation Plan is based on the following assumptions: (i) the price to the public in this offering equals the mid-point of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, (ii) the value of the shares of our common stock issued to Tower International Holdings, LLC upon consummation of the Corporate Conversion is at least $             and (iii) this offering is consummated during September 2010.

 

(3) Represents amounts attributable to the Predecessor.
(4) Pro forma loss per share gives effect to the Corporate Conversion as if it had occurred on the first day of the periods presented. It has been calculated by dividing the net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC by             , constituting the number of shares of common stock to be issued pursuant to the Corporate Conversion.
(5) Adjusted pro forma loss per share also adjusts pro forma loss per share to give effect to (i) the notes offering as if it occurred on the first day of the periods presented and the concurrent retirement of our first lien term loan and (ii) the assumed repayment of $             million on our revolving credit facility with a portion of the net proceeds from this offering. For purposes of this calculation, during the periods presented we have added to interest expense the difference between the interest payable on the notes and the interest paid on our first lien term loan after giving effect to hedging arrangements applicable to the first lien term loan and we have reduced interest expense by the interest paid on the portion of our revolving credit facility which we expect to repay with a portion of the net proceeds of this offering, net of applicable taxes. We have then divided the adjusted net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC by             , constituting the sum of (i) the number of shares of common stock to be issued pursuant to the Corporate Conversion and (ii) the number of shares to be sold in this offering to cover repayment of $             million of our revolving credit facility at an assumed initial public offering price of $             per share, representing the midpoint of the range on the cover page of this prospectus, after deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and the estimated offering expenses payable by us.
(6) During the first quarter of 2010, we acquired a manufacturing facility in Artern, Germany which represents $16.7 million of the cash utilized for investing activities.
(7) As adjusted balance sheet data gives effect to the notes offering, pursuant to which we received gross proceeds of $417.2 million (representing $430 million aggregate principal amount less $12.8 million of original issue discount) and used those proceeds together with the cancellation transaction described below and $5.9 million of our cash to retire our first lien term loan (other than the synthetic letter of credit facility associated with that loan) and to pay related fees and expenses. In connection with consummation of the notes offering, Cerberus caused one of its affiliates to cancel $25 million aggregate principal amount of our first lien term loan in exchange for equity in Tower Automotive, LLC. All references in this prospectus to use of proceeds from the notes offering and the retirement of our first lien term loan give effect to such cancellation transaction.

 

 

14


Table of Contents
     As adjusted balance sheet data also gives effect to the conversion of our redeemable preferred units into capital units, as described in footnote 9 below.

 

     As further adjusted balance sheet data also gives effect to the Corporate Conversion, the sale of              shares of common stock by us in this offering at an assumed initial public offering price of $             per share (representing the mid point of the range on the cover page of this prospectus) and the application of the net proceeds of this offering as described under “Use of Proceeds”, assuming that $             of the net proceeds are used to repay indebtedness on our revolving credit facility and the balance is added to working capital.
(8) Consists of short-term and long-term debt, current portion of long-term debt and capital lease obligations.
(9) Represents preferred equity interests in Tower Automotive, LLC. See Note 18 to our consolidated financial statements as of June 30, 2010 and for the six month periods ended June 30, 2010 and 2009. On August 12, 2010, the preferred units, common units and management incentive plan units of Tower Automotive, LLC, which constituted all of the equity interests in Tower Automotive, LLC, were converted into capital units of Tower Automotive, LLC.
(10) Adjusted EBITDA is included in this prospectus, and in Note 16 to our consolidated financial statements, because it is one of the principal factors upon which our management assesses operating performance. Our Chief Executive Officer measures the operating performance of our segments on the basis of Adjusted EBITDA. In addition to adjusting net income/(loss) to exclude interest expense, income taxes, depreciation and amortization, Adjusted EBITDA also adjusts net income/(loss) by excluding items or expenses as set forth below. Adjusted EBITDA is not a measure of operating performance defined in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, or GAAP. However, our management believes that Adjusted EBITDA is useful to investors in evaluating our performance because it is a commonly used financial metric for measuring and comparing the operating performance of companies in our industry. We believe that the disclosure of Adjusted EBITDA offers an additional financial metric that, when coupled with our GAAP results and the reconciliation to our GAAP results presented below, provides a more complete understanding of our results of operations and the factors and trends affecting our business.
     Adjusted EBITDA should not be considered as an alternative to net income/(loss) as an indicator of our operating performance, as an alternative to net cash provided by operating activities as a measure of liquidity, or as an alternative to any other measure prescribed by GAAP. The primary limitations associated with the use of Adjusted EBITDA as compared to GAAP results are (i) other companies in our industry may define EBITDA differently than we define Adjusted EBITDA and, as a result, our references to Adjusted EBITDA may not be comparable to similarly titled measures used by other companies in our industry and (ii) it excludes financial information that some may consider important in evaluating our operating performance. We compensate for these limitations by providing the following disclosure of the differences between Adjusted EBITDA and GAAP results, including providing a reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to GAAP results, to enable investors to perform their own analysis of our operating results.

 

 

15


Table of Contents

Adjusted EBITDA is calculated as follows:

 

     Successor     Predecessor  
   Six Months Ended
June 30
    Year Ended
December 31
    Five Months
Ended
December  31,
2007
    Seven Months
Ended
July 31,
2007
 
       2010             2009         2009     2008      
    

(in millions)

 

Net income / (loss) attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC

   $ (2.6   $ (39.0   $ (67.9   $ (52.3   $ 15.2      $ (106.0
                                                

Adjustments:

            

Depreciation and amortization

     58.7        79.4      $ 147.7      $ 170.3      $ 61.3      $ 90.5   

Interest expense, net

     27.3        27.2        56.9        60.2        34.0        65.5   

Restructuring(a)

     4.7        (1.1     13.4        4.8        1.8        22.4   

Provision / (benefit) for income taxes

     8.4        2.8        (1.1     19.5        10.4        15.0   

Chapter 11 and related reorganization items(b)

     —          —          —          —          —          62.2   

Other (income) / loss, net(c)

     —          (32.4     (33.7     —          —          —     

Non-controlling interest, net of tax(d)

     4.5        3.9        8.9        6.6        3.0        5.4   

Equity in joint ventures(e)

     —          —          —          —          (7.1     (12.4

Receivable factoring charges(f)

     0.2        0.2        0.8        0.7        1.6        1.7   

Compensation expense related to the special incentive program(g)

     0.5        —          —          —          —          —     

Other adjustments(h)

     0.7        —          —          3.1        3.4        0.3   
                                                

Total adjustments

   $ 105.0      $ 80.0      $ 192.9      $ 265.2      $ 108.4      $ 250.6   
                                                

Adjusted EBITDA

   $ 102.4      $ 41.0      $ 125.0      $ 212.9      $ 123.6      $ 144.6   
                                                

 

  (a) Represents costs associated with facilities closures or permanent layoffs, including (i) closure and other exit costs and (ii) termination and severance payments.
  (b) Primarily represents professional fees and other costs associated with the Predecessor’s bankruptcy proceedings.
  (c) Represents gains associated with a reduction in our synthetic letter of credit facility and then a repurchase and retirement of a portion of our first lien term loan.
  (d) Represents the net income attributable to non-controlling partners in entities that we consolidate in our financial results, given the controlling nature of our interests in these entities.
  (e) Represents our portion of the net income of our non-controlled joint venture with Metalsa S.A. de C.V., or Metalsa, which we sold in December 2007.
  (f) Represents the discounts taken by our customers when making payments on our accounts receivable before the normal payment terms would require payment. We have excluded these amounts from Adjusted EBITDA because they represent a form of finance charge and finance charges have otherwise been excluded in calculating Adjusted EBITDA.
  (g) In connection with the closing of the notes offering, we paid a total of $5.5 million to our executive officers pursuant to a special incentive program. Upon the earlier to occur of consummation of this offering or August 24, 2011, we are committed to pay an additional $1.2 million to certain executive officers pursuant to this program.
  (h) Other adjustments consist of one-time costs associated with discontinued operations for the period ended July 31, 2007; one-time costs associated with the acquisition of the assets of the Predecessor for the period ended December 31, 2007; one-time costs associated with due diligence on a potential acquisition for the period ended December 31, 2008; and one-time costs related to the acquisition of a facility in Artern, Germany for the period ended June 30, 2010.

 

 

16


Table of Contents
(11) Represents Adjusted EBITDA divided by revenues. We believe that Adjusted EBITDA margin is useful to investors in evaluating our performance because Adjusted EBITDA is a commonly used financial metric for measuring and comparing the operating performance of companies in our industry. In addition, we use Adjusted EBITDA margin because we believe it is helpful to us and to investors when comparing our performance over various reporting periods on a consistent basis, as Adjusted EBITDA excludes items that we do not believe reflect our core operating performance.
(12) Capital expenditures do not equal cash disbursed for purchases of property, plant, and equipment as presented in our consolidated statement of cash flows, and as shown in Note 16 to our consolidated financial statements, include amounts paid and accrued during the periods presented.
(13) Includes $30.6 million of lease buyout payments that we paid in 2008 to terminate certain equipment leases in Europe and North America. Our Adjusted EBITDA improved by approximately $14.6 million per year as a result of these lease termination payments.
(14) Represents total debt less cash and cash equivalents. We regard net debt as a useful measure of our outstanding debt obligations. Our use of the term “net debt” should not be understood to mean that we will use any cash on hand to repay debt. Net debt, adjusted in the manner set forth in Note 7, is calculated as follows:

 

    June 30, 2010
    Actual     As Adjusted
for the Notes
Offering
    As Further
Adjusted for
this Offering
    (in millions)      

Total debt

  $ 654.1      $ 641.3 (a)   

Cash and cash equivalents

    (149.6     (143.7  
                   

Net debt

  $ 504.5      $ 497.6     
                   

 

  (a) As adjusted and as further adjusted total debt is presented net of $12.8 million of original issue discount in respect of the notes.

 

 

17


Table of Contents

RISK FACTORS

An investment in our common stock is subject to a number of risks. You should carefully consider the risks described below together with all the other information contained in this prospectus before deciding whether to purchase our common stock. If any of the following risks occurs, our business, financial condition, prospects and results of operations could be harmed. In such an event, the trading price of our common stock could decline and you may lose part or all of your investment.

Risk Factors Relating to Our Industry and Our Business

The recent deterioration in the global economy, the global credit markets and the financial services industry has severely and negatively affected demand for automobiles and automobile parts and our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

Demand for and pricing of our products are subject to economic conditions and other factors present in the various domestic and international markets where our products are sold. The level of demand for our products depends primarily upon the level of consumer demand for new vehicles that are manufactured with our products. The level of new vehicle purchases is cyclical, affected by such factors as general economic conditions, interest rates, consumer confidence, consumer preferences, patterns of consumer spending, fuel costs and the automobile replacement cycle.

The global economic crisis that has existed for at least the last two years and continues to exist has resulted in delayed and reduced purchases of durable consumer goods, such as automobiles. As a result, our OEM customers have significantly reduced their production. According to CSM Worldwide ® , vehicle production during 2009 decreased by 32% and 43% in North America and by 20% and 25% in Europe, as compared to 2008 and 2007, respectively. This was the principal reason our revenues declined by $537 million, or 25%, from 2008 to 2009. These unprecedented conditions have had a severe and negative impact on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

In addition, there has recently been significant economic instability in several countries in the European Union where we conduct business. Such instability could adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

Further deterioration in the United States and world economies could exacerbate the difficulties experienced by our customers and suppliers in obtaining financing, which, in turn, could materially and adversely impact our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

Lending institutions have suffered and may continue to suffer losses due to their lending and other financial relationships, especially because of the general weakening of the global economy and the increased financial instability of many borrowers. Longer-term disruptions in the credit markets could further adversely affect our customers by making it increasingly difficult for them to obtain financing for their businesses and for their customers to obtain financing for automobile purchases. Our OEM customers typically require significant financing for their respective businesses. In addition, our OEM customers typically have related finance companies that provide financing to their dealers and customers. These finance companies have historically been active participants in the securitization markets, which have experienced severe disruptions during the global economic crisis. Our suppliers, as well as the other suppliers to our customers, may face similar difficulties in obtaining financing for their businesses. If capital is not available to our customers and suppliers, or if its cost is prohibitively high, their businesses would be negatively impacted, which could result in their restructuring or even reorganization/liquidation under applicable bankruptcy laws. Any such negative impact, in turn, could materially and negatively affect our company either through the loss of revenues to any of our customers so affected, or due to our inability to meet our commitments without excess expense resulting from disruptions in supply caused by the suppliers so affected.

A number of automobile manufacturers are, and over the last several years have been, facing severe financial difficulties. Many automobile manufacturers have undertaken significant restructuring actions in an effort to improve profitability and remain solvent. Weaknesses in the capital markets combined with a slowdown

 

18


Table of Contents

in global automotive demand have increased the pressure on our customers and their cash reserves. Automobile manufacturers are burdened with substantial structural and embedded costs, such as facility overhead, pension expenses and healthcare costs, that have caused some manufacturers, including GM and Chrysler, to seek government financing and, ultimately, file for bankruptcy protection. Due to the declining economic situation, the United States government granted General Motors and Chrysler government loans to assist them in obtaining the necessary capital to continue to operate. In spite of the government programs, Chrysler filed for bankruptcy on April 30, 2009 and GM filed for bankruptcy on June 1, 2009. Chrysler and GM emerged from bankruptcy on June 10, 2009 and July 10, 2009, respectively. Other automakers are likewise experiencing difficulties from a weakened economy, tightening credit and reduced demand for their products. For example, certain automakers have sought and been granted government assistance in countries such as Germany, Sweden, Brazil, France, Britain, Portugal, Spain, and Canada in an attempt to sustain viability. We may be adversely affected by either a bankruptcy filing or merger or sale of an OEM. We cannot assure you that governmental responses to these disruptions will restore consumer confidence or improve the liquidity of the financial markets.

Given the significant decline in global automotive demand, many automotive suppliers have experienced a significant drop in their cash flow, which has caused certain of such companies to breach some of their debt covenants. Due to the tight credit market, there can be no assurance that these companies will be able to amend their debt covenants on commercially reasonable terms. This, in turn, may cause significant supply issues that could materially and adversely affect us.

Financial difficulties experienced by any major customer could have a material adverse impact on us if such customer were unable to pay for the products we provide or we experienced a loss of, or material reduction in, business from such customer. As a result of such difficulties, we could experience lost revenues, significant write-offs of accounts receivable, significant impairment charges or additional restructurings beyond the steps we have taken to date.

The automobile industry is highly cyclical and cyclical downturns in our domestic or international business segments negatively impact our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

The volume of automotive production in North America, Europe and the rest of the world has fluctuated, sometimes significantly from year-to-year, and such fluctuations give rise to fluctuations in demand for our products. Because we have significant fixed production costs, relatively modest declines in our customers’ production levels can have a significant adverse impact on our results of operations. Our results of operations have been negatively impacted over the last several years in part due to declines in North American production levels from prior periods. According to CSM Worldwide ® , vehicle production during 2009 decreased by 32% and 43% in North America and by 20% and 25% in Europe as compared to 2008 and 2007, respectively.

The highly cyclical nature of the automotive industry presents a risk that is outside our control and that cannot be accurately predicted. For example, many believe that the current global economic crisis will continue throughout 2010 and we cannot assure you that we will be able to maintain or improve our results of operations in a stagnant or diminishing economic environment. Moreover, a number of factors that we cannot predict can and have impacted cyclicality in the past. Further decreases in demand for automobiles generally, or in the demand for our products in particular, could materially and adversely impact our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

Product recalls by OEMs could negatively impact their production levels and therefore have a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

There have recently been significant product recalls by some of the world’s largest automobile manufacturers. Toyota, for example, has engaged in a recall of some of its most popular models. Recalls may result in decreased production levels due to (i) an OEM focusing its efforts on addressing the problems underlying the recall, as opposed to generating new sales volume, and (ii) consumers’ electing not to purchase

 

19


Table of Contents

automobiles manufactured by the OEM initiating the recall, or by OEMs in general, while such recalls persist. Any reductions in OEM production volumes, especially those OEMs that are our existing customers, could have a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

Product liability claims could cause us to incur losses and damage our reputation.

Many of our products are critical to the structural integrity of a vehicle. As such, we face an inherent business risk of exposure to product liability claims in the event of the failure of our products to perform to specifications, or if our products are alleged to result in property damage, bodily injury or death. In addition, if any of our products are, or are alleged to be, defective, we may be required to participate in a recall involving those products. We are generally required under our customer contracts to indemnify our customers for product liability claims in respect of our products. In addition, we do not have insurance covering product recalls. Accordingly, we may be materially and adversely impacted by product liability claims.

The decreasing number of automotive parts customers could make it more difficult for us to compete favorably.

Our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows could be materially and adversely affected because the OEM customer base is consolidating. As a result, we are competing for business from fewer customers. Due to the cost focus of these major customers, we have been, and expect to continue to be, requested to reduce prices as part of our initial business quotations and over the life of contracts we have been awarded. We cannot be certain that we will be able to generate cost savings and operational improvements in the future that are sufficient to offset price reductions requested by customers and to make us profitable and position us to win additional business.

The decreasing number of automotive parts suppliers could make it more difficult for us to compete favorably.

Consolidation and bankruptcies among automotive parts suppliers are resulting in fewer and larger competitors who benefit from purchasing and distribution economies of scale. If we cannot compete favorably in the future with these larger suppliers, our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows could be adversely affected due to a reduction of, or inability to increase, revenues.

We may have difficulty competing favorably in the highly competitive automotive parts industry.

The automotive parts industry is highly competitive. Although the overall number of competitors has decreased due to ongoing industry consolidation, we face significant competition within each of our major product areas, including from new competitors entering the markets that we serve, and from OEMs seeking to integrate vertically. The principal competitive factors include price, quality, global presence, service, product performance, design and engineering capabilities, new product innovation and timely delivery. We cannot assure you that we will be able to continue to compete favorably in these competitive markets or that increased competition will not have a material adverse effect on our business by reducing our ability to increase or maintain sales and profit margins. A number of our major OEM customers manufacture products which compete with our products. Our OEM customers tend to outsource less when they have idle capacity.

We principally compete for new business at the beginning of the development of new models and upon the redesign of existing models by major OEM customers. New model development generally begins three-to-five years prior to the marketing of such models to the public. Redesign of existing models begins during the life cycle of a platform, usually at least two-to-three years before the end of the platform’s life cycle. The failure to obtain new business on new models or to retain or increase business on redesigned existing models, could adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations, and cash flows. In addition, as a result of the relatively long lead times required for many of our structural components, it may be difficult in the short term for us to obtain new revenues to replace any unexpected decline in the sale of existing products.

 

20


Table of Contents

The inability for us, our customers and/or our suppliers to obtain and maintain sufficient debt financing, including working capital lines, and credit insurance may adversely affect our, our customers’ and our suppliers’ liquidity and financial condition.

Our working capital requirements can vary significantly, depending in part on the level, variability and timing of our customers’ worldwide vehicle production and the payment terms with our customers and suppliers. Our liquidity could also be adversely impacted if our suppliers were to suspend normal trade credit terms and require payment in advance or payment on delivery. If our available cash flows from operations are not sufficient to fund our ongoing cash needs, we would be required to look to our cash balances and availability for borrowings under our credit facilities to satisfy those needs, as well as potential sources of additional capital, which may not be available on satisfactory terms and in adequate amounts, if at all.

Capital markets conditions have made it difficult for companies, including ours, to raise and maintain the liquidity necessary to operate. While we believe that we have sufficient liquidity to operate, there can be no assurance that we, our customers and our suppliers will continue to have such ability. This may increase the risk that we cannot produce our products or will have to pay higher prices for our inputs. These higher prices may not be recovered in our selling prices.

Our suppliers often seek to obtain credit insurance based on the strength of the financial condition of our subsidiary with the payment obligation, which may be less robust than our consolidated financial condition. If we were to experience liquidity issues, our suppliers may not be able to obtain credit insurance and in turn would likely not be able to offer us payment terms that we have historically received. Our failure to receive such terms from our suppliers could have a material adverse effect on our liquidity.

We may incur material costs related to product warranties and other legal proceedings, which could have a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

If our warranty expense estimates differ materially from our actual claims, or if we are unable to estimate future warranty expense for new products, our business and financial results could be harmed. Currently, we have limited exposure to warranty claims with our present products and historically we have incurred limited expense in relation to warranty claims; however, as we transition to new products in the future, including within our solar business, we may incur substantial warranty expense related to these products.

From time to time, we are involved in legal proceedings, claims or investigations that are incidental to the conduct of our business. Some of these proceedings allege damages against us relating to environmental liabilities, personal injury claims, taxes, employment matters or commercial or contractual disputes.

We cannot assure you that the costs, charges and liabilities associated with these matters will not be material, or that those costs, charges and liabilities will not exceed any amounts reserved for them in our consolidated financial statements. In future periods, we could be subject to cash costs or non-cash charges to earnings if any of these matters is resolved unfavorably to us.

We are dependent on large customers for current and future revenues. The loss of any of these customers or the loss of market share by these customers could have a material adverse impact on us.

We depend on major vehicle manufacturers for our revenues. For example, during 2009, Volkswagen, Fiat and Ford accounted for 17%, 13% and 13% of our revenues, respectively. The loss of all or a substantial portion of our sales to any of our large-volume customers could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows by reducing cash flows and by limiting our ability to spread our fixed costs over a larger revenue base. We may make fewer sales to these customers for a variety of reasons, including, but not limited to:

 

   

loss of awarded business;

 

   

reduced or delayed customer requirements;

 

21


Table of Contents
   

OEMs’ insourcing business they have traditionally outsourced to us;

 

   

strikes or other work stoppages affecting production by our customers; or

 

   

reduced demand for our customers’ products.

See “—Further deterioration in the United States and world economies could exacerbate the difficulties experienced by our customers and suppliers in obtaining financing, which, in turn, could materially and adversely impact our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.”

In addition, Ford has sold Volvo Car Corporation to Geely, a privately-owned Chinese OEM. The change in ownership may adversely impact our ability to win new business from Volvo. We cannot predict how Volvo will be operated in the future.

The loss of key customer platforms could materially and adversely affect our business.

Our typical sales contract with a customer provides for supplying that customer’s requirements for a particular platform, rather than manufacturing a specific quantity of components. Our revenues contracts generally run for the life of the platform, usually three to ten years, and do not require the purchase by our customers of any minimum number of components. The loss or significant reduction in demand for vehicles for which we produce components could have a material adverse effect on our existing and future revenues and net income. The loss of one or more significant platforms, or a significant decrease in purchases from us in respect of such platforms, could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

We may be unable to realize revenues represented by our awarded business, which could materially and adversely impact our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

The realization of future revenues from awarded business is inherently subject to a number of important risks and uncertainties, including the number of vehicles that our customers will actually produce, the timing of that production and the mix of options that our customers may choose. Prior to 2008, substantially all of our North American customers had slowed or maintained at relatively flat levels new vehicle production for several years. During 2009, new vehicle production decreased dramatically as a result of the global economic crisis. In addition, we have agreed with our customers, that during the course of our awarded business, and as sales volume increases, we will lower the per unit cost of our products, and such savings will, in part, be passed on to our customers. Accordingly, we cannot assure you that we will realize any or all of the future revenues represented by our awarded business. Any failure to realize these revenues could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

In addition to not having a commitment from our customers regarding the minimum number of products they must purchase from us if we obtain awarded business, typically the terms and conditions of the agreements with our customers provide that they have the contractual right to unilaterally terminate our contracts with them with no notice or limited notice. If such contracts are terminated by our customers, our ability to obtain compensation from our customers for such termination is generally limited to the direct out-of-pocket costs that we incurred for raw materials and work-in-progress and in certain instances undepreciated capital expenditures.

We base a substantial part of our planning on the anticipated lifetime revenues of particular products. We calculate the lifetime revenues of a product by multiplying our expected price for a product by forecasted production volume during the length of time we expect the related vehicle to be in production. We use a third-party forecasting service, CSM Worldwide ® , to provide long-term forecasts which allows us to determine how long a vehicle is expected to be in production. Lifetime revenues associated with a particular platform are not guaranteed and are not equivalent to backlog. If we over-estimate the production units or if a customer reduces

 

22


Table of Contents

its level of anticipated purchases of a particular platform as a result of reduced demand, our actual revenues for that platform may be substantially less than the lifetime revenues we had anticipated for that platform. See “—Our ability to recognize revenues from our agreement with Stirling Energy Systems, or SES, is subject to several risks, any one of which could materially and adversely impact our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.”

Typically, it takes two to five years from the time a manufacturer awards a program until the program is launched and production begins. In many cases, we must commit substantial resources in preparation for production under awarded customer business well in advance of the customer’s production start date. Although we have been successful in recovering these costs under appropriate circumstances in the past, we cannot assure you that our results of operations will not be materially adversely impacted in the future if we are unable to recover these types of pre-production costs related to our customers’ cancellation of awarded business.

Shifts in demand away from light trucks and sport utility vehicles could materially and adversely impact our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

In our North American operations, we are heavily dependent on SUVs and pickup trucks, which accounted for approximately 61% of North American revenues in 2009. As fuel prices increased significantly during the first half of 2008, consumers began to shift their purchases from these types of vehicles to cross-over utility vehicles, or CUVs, and passenger cars. CUVs are vehicles built on car platforms but that have many features similar to a traditional SUV. While gas prices have moderated, there has not been a substantial shift back to SUVs and pickup trucks. These trends could adversely affect our North American operations as the product life cycles are long and it will take time to diversify the North American portfolio.

Our joint venture partners may have interests that are not consistent with those of the joint venture, thereby resulting in our joint venture failing to achieve the results we desire.

We have two joint ventures in China. In both instances, our joint venture partner is also affiliated with the largest customer of the joint venture. As such, these partners may negotiate on behalf of customers of the joint venture for sales terms that are not in the best interest of the joint venture. More specifically, when acting on behalf of a customer, our joint venture partners effectively receive 100% of the benefits of revenues terms, but when acting as a joint venture partner we must share with them any benefits received by the joint venture. This may create a misalignment of incentives between us and our joint venture partners that could have a material adverse impact on our business.

Our ability to recognize revenues from our agreement with Stirling Energy Systems, or SES, is subject to several risks, any one of which could materially and adversely impact our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

There are several risks directly associated with our solar agreement with SES. SES must secure significant financing in order to be in a position to purchase the products we have agreed to manufacture. There can be no assurances when or if financing will be made available to SES. In order for us to produce large stamped mirror-facet panels and welded support structures for SES, we must equip a facility for production that we are leasing in Arizona. We may not be able to recover the costs we incur in establishing this facility if the contractual arrangement with SES is not a long-term success.

Our anticipated revenue from our solar agreement is based on a number of assumptions and subject to significant uncertainties and contingencies, including non-binding and uncertain volume estimates and pricing targets. The amount of revenues that we may generate will depend in part upon the extent of the financing SES is able to raise for its solar projects. The term of the agreement is five years, except that it will automatically extend if necessary to assure that a specified production volume threshold has been met. There is no guarantee that the

 

23


Table of Contents

SES agreement will produce the expected revenues. SES is not required to purchase a minimum number of mirror-facet components and welded support structures from us. The revenues that we obtain from our solar agreement are entirely dependent on the sales that SES achieves for its products. Additionally, SES has the right to terminate the agreement with us if, among other reasons, the products we sell to SES are persistently and verifiably uncompetitive with the products sold by another company at similar volumes and with similar capital investment requirements. Under no circumstances should the existence of our solar agreement be regarded as a representation or prediction that we will achieve or are likely to achieve any particular results. Additionally, we do not have prior experience manufacturing components for the solar industry and therefore cannot assure you that we will be able to produce solar components in mass volume or that our margins associated with solar revenues will be comparable to our margins in our automotive business.

We have agreed to provide a three-year warranty on the products that we sell to SES. We will warrant to SES that, among other things, our products are free from defects, conform to specifications and have been manufactured in compliance with all applicable laws. Should the products we sell to SES be found to be defective or otherwise violate our warranties to SES, we could face significant expenses to comply with our SES warranty obligations.

The termination of, or damage to, one or more of our relationships with key third-party suppliers could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

We obtain raw materials and components, including some of our steel, from third-party suppliers. Any delay in receiving supplies could impair our ability to deliver products to our customers and, accordingly, could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows. Some of our suppliers are the sole source for a particular supply item. Loss of or damage to our relationships with these suppliers could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

Various factors could result in the termination of our relationship with any supplier or the inability of suppliers to continue to meet our requirements on favorable terms. For example, the volatility in the financial markets and uncertainty in the automotive sector could result in exposure related to the financial viability of certain of our key third-party suppliers. Severe financial difficulties at any of our major suppliers could have a material adverse effect on us if we were unable to obtain, on a timely basis, on similar economic terms, the quantity and quality of components and raw materials we require to produce our products. In response to financial pressures, suppliers may also exit certain business lines, or change the terms on which they are willing to provide raw material and components to us.

Disruptions in the automotive supply chain could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

The automotive supply chain has been faced with severe cash flow problems as a result of the significantly lower production of vehicles, increases in certain raw material, commodity and energy costs and restricted access to additional liquidity. Several automotive suppliers have filed for bankruptcy protection or ceased operations. Severe financial difficulties, including bankruptcy, of any automotive supplier could have a significant disruptive effect on the entire automotive industry, leading to, among other things, supply chain disruptions and labor unrest. For example, if a parts supplier were to cease operations, it could force the automotive manufacturers to whom the supplier provides parts to shut down their operations. This, in turn, could force other suppliers, including us, to shut down production at plants that are producing products for these automotive manufacturers.

The volatility of steel prices may adversely affect our results of operations.

We utilize steel and various purchased steel products in virtually all of our products. We refer to the “net steel impact” as the combination of the change in steel prices that are reflected in customer pricing, the change in the cost to procure steel from the mills, and the change in our recovery of scrap steel, which we refer to as offal.

 

24


Table of Contents

While we strive to achieve a neutral net steel impact over time, we are not always successful in achieving that goal. Changes in steel prices may affect our liquidity because of the time difference between our payment for our steel and our collection of cash from our customers. We tend to pay for replacement materials, which are more expensive when steel prices are rising, over a much shorter period. As a result, rising steel prices may cause us to draw greater than anticipated amounts from our credit lines to cover the cash flow cycle from our steel purchases to cash collection for related accounts receivable. This cash requirement for working capital is higher in periods when we are increasing our inventory quantities.

A by-product of our production process is the generation of offal. We typically sell offal in secondary markets, which are similar to the steel markets. We generally share our recoveries from sales of offal with our customers either through scrap sharing agreements, in cases where we are on resale programs, or in the product pricing that is negotiated regarding increases and decreases in the steel price in cases where we purchase steel directly from the mills. In either situation, we may be impacted by the fluctuation in scrap steel prices, either positive or negative, in relation to our various customer agreements. Since scrap steel prices generally increase and decrease as steel prices increase and decrease, our sale of offal may mitigate the severity of steel price increases and limit the benefits we achieve through steel price declines. Any dislocation in offal and steel prices could negatively affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

The seasonality we experience in our business may negatively impact our quarterly results of operations, cash flows and liquidity.

Our business is seasonal. Our customers in Europe typically shut down vehicle production during portions of July or August and during one week in our fourth quarter. Our North American customers typically shut down vehicle production for approximately two weeks during July and for one week during December. Such seasonality may adversely affect our results of operations, cash flows and liquidity during the third and fourth quarters of our fiscal year.

We have significant operating lease obligations and our failure to meet those obligations could adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

We lease many of our manufacturing facilities and certain capital equipment. Our lease expense under these operating leases was $24.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2009 and $10.9 million for the six months ended June 30, 2010. A failure to pay our lease obligations would constitute a default allowing the applicable landlord or lessor to pursue remedies available to it under our leases and applicable law, which could include taking possession of property that we utilize in our business and, in the case of facilities leases, evicting us. In addition, we are party to two master leases with entities affiliated with a single commercial real estate company that cover a number of our leased properties. These master leases require us to continue to perform under the leases with respect to certain properties that we are no longer using. Such obligations negatively impact our results of operations.

We may incur material costs related to plant closings, which could have a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

If we must close additional manufacturing locations because of loss of business or consolidation of manufacturing facilities, the employee severance, asset retirement and other costs, including reimbursement costs relating to public subsidies, to close these facilities may be significant. In certain locations that are subject to leases, we may continue to incur material costs consistent with the initial lease terms. Due to the current state of the global economy, there is no assurance that additional plants will not have to be closed. We continually attempt to align production capacity with demand, which may result in additional closures. Historically, we have incurred significant costs related to the closure of our facilities and can provide no assurance that such costs will not be material in the future.

Our ability to operate effectively could be impaired if we are unable to recruit and retain key personnel.

Our success depends, in part, on the efforts of our executive officers and other key senior managers and employees. Our senior management team has reoriented our business towards anticipated future demand and

 

25


Table of Contents

potential alternative markets and has implemented significant productivity initiatives. The loss of members of our senior management team could jeopardize our ability to execute these business strategies and could adversely impact our efforts to improve our cost competitiveness. In addition, our future success will depend on, among other factors, our ability to continue to attract and retain qualified personnel. For example, we will also need to attract engineers with experience in non-automotive areas in order to continue our efforts in the solar industry and explore opportunities in other non-automotive industries. The loss of the services of our executive officers, senior managers or other key employees, or the failure to attract or retain qualified employees, could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

The hourly workforce in the automotive industry is highly unionized and our business could be adversely affected by labor disruptions.

As of December 31, 2009, we had approximately 7,400 employees, of whom approximately 5,000 were covered under collective bargaining agreements. If major work disruptions involving our employees were to occur, our business could be adversely affected by a variety of factors, including a loss of revenues, increased costs and reduced profitability. We cannot assure you that we will not experience a material labor disruption at one or more of our facilities in the future in the course of renegotiation of our labor arrangements or otherwise. In addition, substantially all of the hourly employees of North American vehicle manufacturers and many of their suppliers are represented by the United Automobile, Aerospace and Agricultural Implement Workers of America under collective bargaining agreements. Vehicle manufacturers and suppliers and their employees in other countries are also subject to labor agreements. A work stoppage or strike at our production facilities, at those of a significant customer, or at a significant supplier of ours, such as the 2008 strike at American Axle that resulted in 30 General Motors facilities in North America being idled for several months, could have a material adverse impact on us by disrupting demand for our products or our ability to manufacture our products. Also, we cannot assure you that the labor rate following a renegotiation of any of our current collective bargaining agreements will be beneficial to us.

We sponsor a defined benefit pension plan that is underfunded and will require substantial cash payments. Additionally, if the performance of the assets in our pension plan does not meet our expectations, or if other actuarial assumptions are modified, our required contributions may be higher than we expect.

We sponsor a defined benefit pension plan that is underfunded. Although the Predecessor ceased benefit accruals under the plan, we anticipate that the plan may require substantial cash payments in order to meet our funding obligations. These cash contributions may be significant in future periods and could adversely impact our cash flow.

Additionally, our earnings may be positively or negatively impacted by the amount of income or expense recorded for our pension plan. GAAP requires that income or expense for pension plans be calculated at the annual measurement date using actuarial assumptions and calculations. These calculations reflect certain assumptions, the most significant of which relate to the capital markets, interest rates and other economic conditions. Changes in key economic indicators can change these assumptions. These assumptions, along with the actual value of assets at the measurement date, will impact the calculation of pension expense for the year. Although GAAP expense and pension contributions are not directly related, the key economic indicators that affect GAAP expense also affect the amount of cash that we would contribute to our pension plan. As a result of current economic instability, the investment portfolio of the pension plan has experienced volatility and a decline in fair value. Because the values of these pension plan assets have fluctuated and will fluctuate in response to changing market conditions, the amount of gains or losses that will be recognized in subsequent periods, the impact on the funded status of the pension plan and the future minimum required contributions, if any, could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows, but such impact cannot be determined at this time.

 

26


Table of Contents

We are subject to environmental requirements and risks as a result of which we may incur significant costs, liabilities and obligations.

We are subject to a variety of environmental and pollution control laws, regulations and permits that govern, among other things, soil, surface water and groundwater contamination; the generation, storage, handling, use, disposal and transportation of hazardous materials; the emission and discharge of materials, including greenhouse gases, or GHGs, into the environment; and health and safety. If we fail to comply with these laws, regulations or permits, we could be fined or otherwise sanctioned by regulators or become subject to litigation. Environmental and pollution control laws, regulations and permits, and the enforcement thereof, change frequently, have tended to become more stringent over time and may necessitate substantial capital expenditures or operating costs.

Under certain environmental requirements, we could be responsible for costs relating to any contamination at our or a predecessor entity’s current or former owned or operated properties or third-party waste-disposal sites, even if we were not at fault. Soil and groundwater contamination is being addressed at certain of these locations. In addition to potentially significant investigation and cleanup costs, contamination can give rise to third-party claims for fines or penalties, natural resource damages, personal injury or property damage.

We cannot assure you that our costs, liabilities and obligations relating to environmental matters will not have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

We may incur material costs related to the return or retirement of leased and owned assets, which could have a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

Facility leases generally require that the premises be returned to the owner or lessor in the original condition. Asset leases also may require the disassembly and removal of heavy equipment at the termination of the lease. Costs are incurred in connection with the removal of equipment and general cleanup resulting from past operations and/or equipment removal. In addition, environmental assessments, notifications to regulatory authorities and cancellation of permits may be required. Finally, costs associated with the removal and/or mitigation of asbestos-containing materials also may be incurred in connection with lease terminations, improvements to facilities or otherwise. We have established reserves for these asset retirement obligations based, in part, on past experiences at other facilities that we have operated. Although we believe our estimates of costs associated with asset retirement obligations are reasonable, future experience may require us to revise these estimates. We could be subject to material cash or non-cash charges to earnings if we are required to incur material additional costs based on our ongoing analyses of the asset retirement obligations at our properties.

We are subject to risks related to our international operations.

Our international operations include manufacturing facilities in China, South Korea, Brazil and Europe, and we sell our products in each of these areas. For the year ended December 31, 2009, approximately 71% of our revenues were derived from operations outside the United States. International operations are subject to various risks that could have a material adverse effect on those operations and our business as a whole, including:

 

   

exposure to local economic conditions;

 

   

exposure to local political conditions, including the risk of seizure of assets by a foreign government;

 

   

exposure to local social unrest, including any resultant acts of war, terrorism or similar events;

 

   

exposure to local public health issues and the resultant impact on economic and political conditions;

 

   

foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations;

 

   

hyperinflation in certain foreign countries;

 

   

the risk of government-sponsored competition;

 

27


Table of Contents
   

controls on the repatriation of cash, including the imposition or increase of withholding and other taxes on remittances and other payments by foreign subsidiaries; and

 

   

export and import restrictions.

Foreign exchange rate fluctuations could cause a decline in our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

As a result of our international operations, we are subject to risk because we generate a significant portion of our revenues and incur a significant portion of our expenses in currencies other than the U.S. dollar. To the extent that we have significantly more costs than revenues generated in a foreign currency, we are subject to risk if the foreign currency in which our costs are paid appreciates against the currency in which we generate revenues because the appreciation effectively increases our cost in that country. The financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of some of our operating entities are reported in foreign currencies and then translated into U.S. dollars at the applicable foreign exchange rate for inclusion in our consolidated financial statements. As a result, appreciation of the U.S. dollar against these foreign currencies generally will have a negative impact on our reported sales and profits while depreciation of the U.S. dollar against these foreign currencies will generally have a positive effect on reported revenues and profits. A significant amount of our revenues are denominated in Euros. Economic instability in the European Union and the related decline in the value of the Euro could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

To the extent we are unable to match revenues received in foreign currencies with costs paid in the same currency, foreign exchange rate fluctuations in that currency could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

We may use a combination of natural hedging techniques and financial derivatives to protect against certain foreign currency exchange rate risks. Such hedging activities may be ineffective or may not offset more than a portion of the adverse financial impact resulting from foreign currency variations. Gains or losses associated with hedging activities also may negatively impact operating results.

We will have increased exposure to depreciation in the Euro due to the exchange of U.S. dollar for Euro denominated debt as a result of our retirement of our outstanding first lien term loan and the issuance of the notes in August 2010. We intend to evaluate our hedging activities in light of such exposure, but there is no guarantee we will be able to effectively mitigate such risk.

Entering new markets, such as our entry into solar power, poses new competitive threats and commercial risks.

As we seek to expand into markets beyond vehicle structural components and assemblies, we expect to diversify our product revenues by leveraging our development, engineering and manufacturing capabilities in order to source necessary parts and components for other industries. Such diversification requires investments and resources that may not be available as needed. While we have signed a contract with a customer in the solar energy industry, we cannot guarantee that we will win additional solar energy or other contracts in new markets. Furthermore, even if we sign contracts in new markets, we cannot guarantee that we will be successful in leveraging our capabilities into these new markets and thus in meeting the needs of these new customers and competing favorably in these new markets. If these customers experience reduced demand for their products or financial difficulties, our future prospects will be negatively affected as well.

Any acquisitions we make could disrupt our business and materially harm our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

We may, from time to time, consider acquisitions of complementary companies, products or technologies. Acquisitions involve numerous risks, including difficulties in the assimilation of the acquired businesses, the diversion of our management’s attention from other business concerns, the assumption of unknown liabilities,

 

28


Table of Contents

undisclosed risks impacting the target and potential adverse effects on existing business relationships with current customers and suppliers. In addition, any acquisitions could involve the incurrence of substantial additional indebtedness or dilution to our stockholders. We cannot assure you that we will be able to successfully integrate any acquisitions that we undertake or that such acquisitions will perform as planned or prove to be beneficial to our operations and cash flow. Any such failure could seriously harm our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

Our historical financial information is not comparable to our current financial condition, results of operations and cash flows because of our use of purchase accounting in connection with the purchase of assets from the bankruptcy estate of the Predecessor (which resulted in a new valuation for our assets and liabilities to their fair values).

It may be difficult for you to compare both our historical and future results to our results for the period before August 1, 2007. The acquisition of our assets from the Predecessor was accounted for utilizing purchase accounting, which resulted in a new valuation for our assets and liabilities to their fair values. This new basis of accounting began on August 1, 2007. In addition, we expect future acquisitions, if any, will also be accounted for using purchase accounting and, therefore, similar limitations regarding comparability of historical and subsequent results could arise.

The mix of profits and losses in various jurisdictions may have an impact on our overall tax rate, which in turn, may adversely affect our profitability.

Our overall effective tax rate is equal to our total tax expense as a percentage of our total operating profit or loss before tax. However, tax expenses and benefits are determined separately for each of our taxpaying entities or groups of entities that is consolidated for tax purposes in each jurisdiction. Losses in such jurisdictions may provide no current financial statement tax benefit. As a result, changes in the mix of projected profits and losses between jurisdictions, among other factors, could have a significant impact on our overall effective tax rate.

Negative or unexpected results from tax audits could adversely affect us.

We are currently subject to tax audits by governmental authorities in the United States and numerous non-United States jurisdictions. Because the results of tax audits are inherently uncertain, negative or unexpected results from one or more such tax audits could adversely affect us.

Proposed future United States federal income tax legislation could adversely impact our effective tax rate.

In May 2009, President Obama’s administration announced proposed future tax legislation that would if enacted into law substantially modify the rules governing the United States taxation of owners of certain non-United States subsidiaries. In February 2010, President Obama’s administration delivered a proposed budget reflecting similar proposed future tax legislation. These potential changes include, but are not limited to: limitations on the deferral of United States taxation of foreign earnings; limitations on the ability to claim and utilize foreign tax credits; and deferral of various tax deductions until non-United States earnings are repatriated to the United States. Each of these proposals would be effective for taxable years beginning after December 31, 2010. Many details of the proposals remain unknown, although if any of these proposals are enacted into law they could adversely impact our effective tax rate.

The value of our deferred tax assets could become impaired, which could materially and adversely affect our operating results.

As of December 31, 2009, we had approximately $5.6 million in net deferred income tax assets. These deferred tax assets include net operating loss carryforwards that can be used to offset taxable income in future periods and reduce income taxes payable in those future periods. We periodically determine the probability of the

 

29


Table of Contents

realization of deferred tax assets, using significant judgments and estimates with respect to, among other things, historical operating results, expectations of future earnings and tax planning strategies. If we determine in the future that there is not sufficient positive evidence to support the valuation of these assets, due to the factors described above or other factors, we may be required to further adjust the valuation allowance to reduce our deferred tax assets. Such a reduction could result in material non-cash expenses in the period in which the valuation allowance is adjusted and could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations.

Our ability to utilize our net operating loss carryforwards may be limited and delayed. As of December 31, 2009, we had U.S. net operating loss carryforwards of approximately $148.5 million. Certain provisions of the United States tax code could limit our annual utilization of the net operating loss carryforwards. There can be no assurance that we will be able to utilize all of our net operating loss carryforwards and any subsequent net operating loss carryforwards in the future.

In addition, adverse changes in the underlying profitability and financial outlook of our operations in several foreign jurisdictions could lead to changes in our valuation allowances against deferred tax assets and other tax accruals that could adversely affect our financial results.

Further, subsequent to consummation of this offering, we may have an “ownership change” for purposes of Section 382 of the Internal Revenue Code if, under certain circumstances, our existing stockholders were to sell within a specified period a sufficient amount of our common stock that they then possess to cause an ownership change. If we do experience an ownership change, we may be further limited, pursuant to Section 382 of the Internal Revenue Code, in using our then-current net operating losses to offset taxable income for taxable periods (or portions thereof) beginning after such ownership change. Consequently, in the future we may be required to pay increased cash income taxes because of the Section 382 limitations on our ability to use our net operating loss carryforwards. Increased cash taxes would reduce our after-tax cash flow.

We have a material amount of goodwill, which, if it becomes impaired, would result in a reduction in our net income and stockholders’ equity.

Goodwill represents the amount by which the cost of an acquisition accounted for using the purchase method exceeds the fair value of the net assets acquired. GAAP requires that goodwill be periodically evaluated for impairment based on the fair value of the reporting unit. A significant percentage of our total assets represent goodwill primarily associated with the purchase of our assets from the Predecessor in 2007. Declines in our profitability or the value of comparable companies may impact the fair value of our reporting units, which could result in a write-down of goodwill and a reduction in net income.

As of June 30, 2010, we had approximately $60.7 million of goodwill on our consolidated balance sheet that could be subject to impairment. In addition, if we acquire new businesses in the future, we may recognize additional goodwill, which could be significant. We could also be required to recognize additional impairments in the future and such an impairment charge could have a material adverse effect on our financial position and results of operations in the period of recognition.

We may face risks relating to climate change that could have an adverse impact on our business.

GHG emissions have increasingly become the subject of substantial international, national, regional, state and local attention. GHG emission regulations have been promulgated in certain of the jurisdictions in which we operate, and additional GHG requirements are in various stages of development. For example, the United States Congress is considering legislation that would establish a nationwide limit on GHGs. In addition, the United States Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) has finalized regulations that will affect GHG emissions from mobile and stationary sources pursuant to the federal Clean Air Act. When effective, such measures could require us to modify existing or obtain new permits, implement additional pollution control technology, curtail operations or increase our operating costs. In addition, our OEM customers may seek price reductions from us to

 

30


Table of Contents

account for their increased costs resulting from GHG regulations. Further, growing pressure to reduce GHG emissions from mobile sources could reduce automobile sales, thereby reducing demand for our products and ultimately our revenues. Thus, any additional regulation of GHG emissions, including through a cap-and-trade system, technology mandate, emissions tax, reporting requirement or other program, could adversely affect our business, results of operations, financial condition, reputation, product demand and liquidity.

Risk Factors Relating to Our Indebtedness

We have a substantial amount of indebtedness, which could have a material adverse effect on our financial health and our ability to fund our operations, to obtain financing in the future and to react to changes in our business, and which could adversely affect the price of our common stock.

We have substantial indebtedness for borrowed money. As of June 30, 2010, on a pro forma basis after giving effect to the notes offering and the application of the net proceeds from the notes offering as well as the use of $5.9 million of our cash to retire our first lien term loan (other than the synthetic letter of credit facility portion thereof), we would have had indebtedness for borrowed money (including capital leases) of $641.3 million in the aggregate (net of $12.8 million original issue discount in respect of the issuance of the notes) with interest rates ranging from 2.18% to 14.57%.

Our significant amount of debt could limit our ability to satisfy our obligations, limit our ability to operate our businesses and impair our competitive position. For example, it could:

 

   

adversely affect our stock price;

 

   

make it more difficult for us to satisfy our obligations under our financing documents;

 

   

increase our vulnerability to adverse economic and general industry conditions, including interest rate fluctuations, because a portion of our borrowings are, and will continue to be, at variable rates of interest;

 

   

require us to dedicate a substantial portion of our cash flow from operations to payments on our debt, which would reduce the availability of our cash flow from operations to fund working capital, capital expenditures or other general corporate purposes;

 

   

limit our flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in our business and industry;

 

   

place us at a disadvantage compared to competitors that may have proportionately less debt;

 

   

limit our ability to obtain additional debt or equity financing due to applicable financial and restrictive covenants in our debt agreements; and

 

   

increase our cost of borrowing.

We may not be able to refinance any of our debt or we may not be able to refinance our debt on commercially reasonable terms.

As of June 30, 2010, on a pro forma basis after giving effect to the notes offering and the application of the net proceeds from the notes offering as well as the use of $5.9 million of our cash to retire our first lien term loan (other than the synthetic letter of credit facility portion thereof), $109.9 million of our indebtedness (including capital leases) had a maturity of one year or less. We cannot assure you that we will be able to refinance, extend the maturity or otherwise amend the terms of our existing indebtedness, or whether any refinancing, extension or amendment will be on commercially reasonable terms. The indebtedness issued in any refinancing of our existing indebtedness could have a significantly higher rate of interest and greater costs than our existing indebtedness. There can be no assurance that the financial terms or covenants of any new credit facility and/or other indebtedness issued to refinance our existing indebtedness will be the same or as favorable as those under our existing indebtedness.

 

31


Table of Contents

Our ability to complete a refinancing of our existing indebtedness prior to their respective maturities is subject to a number of conditions beyond our control. For example, if a disruption in the financial markets were to occur at the time that we intended to refinance this indebtedness, we might be restricted in our ability to access the financial markets. If we were unable to make payments or refinance our debt or obtain new financing under these circumstances, we would have to consider other options, such as:

 

   

sales of assets;

 

   

sales of equity; or

 

   

negotiations with lenders and their respective agents to restructure the applicable debt.

Our debt instruments may restrict, or market or business conditions may limit, our ability to employ some of our options.

In addition, under our credit agreements, a change in control may lead the lenders to exercise remedies such as acceleration of the loan, termination of their obligations to fund additional advances and collection against the collateral securing such loan and in the case of the notes, a change in control may lead to one or more noteholders exercising their change of control put right.

Despite our current indebtedness levels, we may still be able to incur substantially more debt. This could exacerbate the risks associated with our substantial leverage.

Although we expect to use a portion of the net proceeds from this offering to retire existing indebtedness, we may incur additional indebtedness in the future or refinance existing debt prior to the respective maturities of such debt. After giving pro forma effect to the notes offering and the application of the net proceeds from the notes offering as well as the use of $5.9 million of our cash to retire our first lien term loan, as of June 30, 2010 (other than the synthetic letter of credit facility portion thereof), we would have had $56.8 million of availability for additional borrowings of senior secured indebtedness under our revolving credit facility and would have been able to cause the issuance of $4.4 million of additional letters of credit under our synthetic letter of credit facility. We could also incur indebtedness under other existing as well as additional financing arrangements. If new debt or other liabilities are added to our current debt levels, the related risks that we now face could intensify.

We may be unable to generate sufficient cash to service all of our indebtedness and may be forced to take other actions to satisfy our obligations under such indebtedness, which may not be successful.

Our ability to make scheduled payments on or to refinance our debt obligations, certain of which have short term maturities, depends on our financial condition and operating performance, which is subject to prevailing economic and competitive conditions and to financial, business and other factors beyond our control. We cannot assure you that we will maintain a level of cash flows from operating activities sufficient to permit us to pay or refinance our indebtedness, including the notes and our revolving credit facility.

If we are unable to service our debt or pay our other obligations, we will be forced to take actions such as revising or delaying our strategic plans, reducing or delaying capital expenditures, selling assets, restructuring or refinancing such debt, or seeking additional equity capital. We may be unable to effect any of these remedies on satisfactory terms, or at all. Our revolving credit facility, our synthetic letter of credit facility and the indenture governing the notes restrict our ability to dispose of assets and use the proceeds from such disposition. We may not be able to consummate those dispositions or to use those proceeds to meet any debt service obligations then due. For more information, see “Description of Certain Indebtedness.”

If we cannot make scheduled payments on our debt, we will be in default and, as a result:

 

   

the indenture trustee or the noteholders who collectively hold at least 25% in principal amount of the outstanding notes could declare all outstanding principal and interest to be due and payable;

 

32


Table of Contents
   

the lenders under our revolving credit facility, our synthetic letter of credit facility and the agreements governing certain of our other indebtedness could terminate their commitments to lend to us and to issue letters of credit, and such lenders could foreclose against the assets securing our borrowings; and

 

   

we could be forced into bankruptcy or liquidation.

Certain of our debt is owned by Cerberus, which controls our controlling stockholder, and in certain instances such as in the event of a default under the financing documents governing such debt, the interests of Cerberus in its capacity as a lender may be adverse to the interests of our stockholders.

As of August 26, 2010, Cerberus, which controls our controlling stockholder, owned all $27.5 million of the commitments under our synthetic letter of credit facility. Cerberus may have interests as a lender which differ from the interests of our stockholders. In the event that Cerberus seeks to exercise certain rights that it has pursuant to the financing documents governing our indebtedness, such actions could be adverse to the interests of our stockholders. In addition, Cerberus and our controlling stockholder may have an incentive to cause us to refinance such debt, even if the terms available in the market are not as attractive as the terms contained in our existing indebtedness.

Our debt instruments restrict our current and future operations.

The financing documents governing our indebtedness impose significant operating and financial restrictions on us. These restrictions limit our ability and the ability of our subsidiaries to, among other things:

 

   

incur or guarantee additional debt, incur liens, or issue certain equity;

 

   

declare or make distributions to our stockholders, repurchase equity or prepay certain debt;

 

   

make loans and certain investments;

 

   

make certain acquisitions of equity or assets;

 

   

enter into certain transactions with affiliates;

 

   

enter into mergers, acquisitions and other business combinations;

 

   

consolidate, transfer, sell or otherwise dispose of certain assets;

 

   

use the proceeds from sales of assets and stock;

 

   

enter into sale and leaseback transactions;

 

   

enter into restrictive agreements;

 

   

make capital expenditures;

 

   

change our fiscal year;

 

   

amend or modify organizational documents; and

 

   

engage in businesses other than the businesses we currently conduct.

In addition to the restrictions and covenants listed above, certain of our financing documents require us, under certain circumstances, to comply with specified financial maintenance covenants. Any of these restrictions or covenants could limit our ability to plan for or react to market conditions or meet certain capital needs and could otherwise restrict our corporate activities.

Any one or more of the risks mentioned herein, as well as events not yet contemplated, could result in our failing to meet such covenants and restrictions. Our ability to comply with these covenants and restrictions may be affected by events beyond our control, and an adverse development affecting our business could require us to

 

33


Table of Contents

seek waivers or amendments of such covenants or restrictions or alternative or additional sources of financing. We cannot assure you that these waivers, amendments or alternative or additional financings could be obtained, or if obtained, would be on terms acceptable to us.

A breach of any of the covenants or restrictions contained in any of our existing or future financing agreements, including our inability to comply with the financial maintenance covenants in such financing documents, could result in an event of default under those financing documents. Any such event of default could permit the agent or lenders under our financing documents, if such documents so provide, to discontinue lending, to accelerate the related debt as well as any other debt to which a cross acceleration or cross default provision applies, and to declare all borrowings outstanding under our financing arrangements to be immediately due and payable and institute enforcement proceedings against those assets that secure the extensions of credit under our outstanding indebtedness. In addition, the agent or lenders could terminate any commitments they had made to supply us with further funds. If the agent or lenders require immediate repayments, we may not be able to repay them in full. This could adversely affect our financial results, liquidity and cash flow and our ability to service our indebtedness and could lead to our bankruptcy.

Substantially all of our subsidiaries’ assets are pledged as collateral under secured financing arrangements.

As of June 30, 2010, on a pro forma basis after giving effect to the notes offering and the application of the net proceeds therefrom as well as the use of $5.9 million of our cash to retire our first lien term loan (other than the synthetic letter of credit facility portion thereof), there was $600.5 million (net of $12.8 million original issue discount in respect of the issuance of the notes) of secured indebtedness outstanding under our financing arrangements. Substantially all of our subsidiaries’ assets are pledged as collateral for these borrowings. As of June 30, 2010, on a pro forma basis after giving effect to the notes offering and the application of the net proceeds therefrom as well as the use of $5.9 million of our cash to retire our first lien term loan (other than the synthetic letter of credit facility portion thereof), our secured financing arrangements permitted additional borrowings of up to a maximum of $65.4 million and an additional $4.4 million of available letters of credit to be issued under our synthetic letter of credit facility. Most of our domestic subsidiaries are either primary obligors or guarantors under a secured financing arrangement. Substantially all of our domestic subsidiaries’ assets are pledged as collateral for these guarantees. If we are unable to repay all secured borrowings when due, whether at maturity or if declared due and payable following a default, the agent or the lenders, as applicable, would have the right to proceed against the collateral pledged to secure the indebtedness and may sell the assets pledged as collateral in order to repay those borrowings, which could have a material adverse effect on our businesses, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

We operate as a holding company and depend on our subsidiaries for cash to satisfy the obligations of the holding company.

Tower International, Inc. is a holding company. Our subsidiaries conduct all of our operations and own substantially all of our assets. Our cash flow and our ability to meet our obligations depends on the cash flow of our subsidiaries. In addition, the payment of funds in the form of dividends, intercompany payments, tax sharing payments and other forms are in certain instances subject to restrictions under the terms of our subsidiaries’ financing arrangements.

Our variable rate indebtedness exposes us to interest rate risk, which could cause our debt costs to increase significantly.

A significant portion of our borrowings are at variable rates of interest and expose us to interest rate risks. As of June 30, 2010, on a pro forma basis after giving effect to the notes offering and the application of the net proceeds therefrom to retire our first lien term loan (other than the synthetic letter of credit facility portion thereof), approximately 26% of our total debt would have been at variable interest rates. Based on amounts outstanding of our variable rate debt as of June 30, 2010, on a pro forma basis after giving effect to the notes offering and the application of the net proceeds therefrom to retire our first lien term loan (other than the synthetic letter of credit facility portion thereof), a 1% increase in the per annum interest rate for our variable rate debt would increase our

 

34


Table of Contents

interest expense by approximately $1.7 million annually. An increase in borrowings under our revolving credit facility or any similar replacement facilities which provide for variable interest rates would increase our exposure to increases in market interest rates.

Our ability to borrow under our revolving credit facility is subject to an annual appraisal of certain of our assets. Such appraisal could result in the reduction of available borrowings under this facility, thereby negatively impacting our liquidity.

The borrowings available under our revolving credit facility are subject to the calculation of a borrowing base, which is based upon the value of certain of our assets, including accounts receivable, inventory and property, plant and equipment, which we refer to as PP&E. The administrative agent for this facility causes a third party to perform an appraisal of the assets included in the calculation of the borrowing base either on an annual basis or, if our availability under the facility is less than $30,000,000 during any twelve month period, as frequently as on a semi-annual basis. In addition, if certain material defaults under the facility have occurred and are continuing, the administrative agent has the right to perform any such appraisal as often as it deems necessary in its sole discretion. During 2008 and 2009, the appraised value of our PP&E was less than the value of such assets used in the calculation of the borrowing base at the time of the previous appraisal, thereby reducing available borrowings under our revolving credit facility. If any such appraisal results in a significant reduction of the borrowing base, a portion of the outstanding indebtedness under the facility could become immediately due and payable.

Risk Factors Relating to Our Common Stock and This Offering

The price of our common stock may be volatile.

The price at which our common stock will trade after this offering may be volatile due to a number of factors, including:

 

   

actual or anticipated fluctuations in our financial condition or annual or quarterly results of operations;

 

   

changes in investors’ and financial analysts’ perception of the business risks and conditions of our business;

 

   

changes in, or our failure to meet, earning estimates and other performance expectations of investors or financial analysts;

 

   

unfavorable commentary or downgrades of our stock by equity research analysts;

 

   

our success or failure in implementing our growth plans;

 

   

changes in the market valuations of companies viewed as similar to us;

 

   

changes or proposed changes in governmental regulations affecting our business;

 

   

changes in key personnel;

 

   

depth of the trading market in our common stock;

 

   

failure of securities analysts to cover our common stock after this offering;

 

   

termination of the lock-up agreement or other restrictions on the ability of our existing stockholders to sell shares after this offering;

 

   

future sales of our common stock;

 

   

the granting or exercise of employee stock options or other equity awards;

 

   

increased competition;

 

   

realization of any of the risks described elsewhere under “Risk Factors”; and

 

   

general market and economic conditions.

 

35


Table of Contents

In addition, equity markets have experienced significant price and volume fluctuations that have affected the market prices for the securities of newly public companies for a number of reasons, including reasons that may be unrelated to our business or operating performance. These broad market fluctuations may result in a material decline in the market price of our common stock and you may not be able to sell your shares at prices you deem acceptable. In the past, following periods of volatility in the equity markets, securities class action lawsuits have been instituted against public companies. Such litigation, if instituted against us, could result in substantial cost and the diversion of management attention.

The shares you purchase in this offering will experience immediate and substantial dilution.

The initial public offering price of our common stock will be substantially higher than the net tangible book value per share of our outstanding common stock. Assuming an initial public offering price of $            per share, representing the midpoint of the range on the cover page of this prospectus, purchasers of our common stock will effectively incur dilution of $            per share in the net tangible book value of their purchased shares. Conversely, the shares of our common stock owned by existing stockholders will receive a material increase in net tangible book value per share. You may experience additional dilution if we issue common stock in the future. As a result of this dilution, you may receive significantly less than the full purchase price you paid for the shares in the event of liquidation.

Upon consummating this offering, Tower International, Inc. will be a “controlled company” within the meaning of the New York Stock Exchange corporate governance standards and, as a result, will qualify for, and intends to rely on, exemptions from certain corporate governance requirements. You will not have the same protections afforded to stockholders of companies that are subject to these requirements.

Upon completion of this offering, Cerberus, through our controlling stockholder, will continue to control a majority of our outstanding common stock. As a result, we will be a “controlled company” within the meaning of the New York Stock Exchange corporate governance standards. Under these standards, a company of which more than 50% of the voting power is held by an individual, group or another company is a “controlled company” and may elect not to comply with certain corporate governance requirements, including:

 

   

the requirement that a majority of the board of directors consist of independent directors;

 

   

the requirement that we have a nominating/corporate governance committee that is composed entirely of independent directors with a written charter addressing the committee’s purpose and responsibilities;

 

   

the requirement that we have a compensation committee that is composed entirely of independent directors with a written charter addressing the committee’s purpose and responsibilities; and

 

   

the requirement for an annual performance evaluation of the nominating/corporate governance and compensation committees.

Following this offering, we intend to utilize these exemptions. As a result, we may not have a majority of independent directors and our nominating and corporate governance and compensation committees will not consist entirely of independent directors. Accordingly, you will not have the same protections afforded to stockholders of companies that are subject to all of the corporate governance requirements. As of August 26, 2010, Cerberus also owned 100 percent of our synthetic letter of credit facility.

The interests of our controlling stockholder in its capacity as a stockholder may be adverse to the interests of our other stockholders.

After this offering, our controlling stockholder will continue to be able to control the election of our directors, determine our corporate and management policies and determine, without the consent of our other stockholders, the outcome of any corporate transaction or other matter submitted to our stockholders for approval, including potential mergers or acquisitions, asset sales and other significant corporate transactions. Our controlling stockholder will also have sufficient voting power to amend our organizational documents.

 

36


Table of Contents

We cannot assure you that the interests of our controlling stockholder will coincide with the interests of other holders of our common stock. Additionally, Cerberus, which controls our controlling stockholder, is in the business of making investments in companies and may, from time to time, acquire and hold interests in businesses that compete directly or indirectly with us. Our certificate of incorporation provides that neither Cerberus or its affiliates, nor members of our board of directors who are not our employees (including any directors who also serve as officers) or their affiliates, have any duty to refrain from engaging, directly or indirectly, in the same or similar business activities or lines of business in which we operate. Cerberus and our controlling stockholder may also pursue, for their own accounts, acquisition opportunities that may be complementary to our business, and, as a result, those acquisition opportunities may not be available to us. So long as our controlling stockholder continues to own a significant amount of our common stock, it will continue to be able to strongly influence or effectively control our decisions, including director and officer appointments, potential mergers or acquisitions, asset sales and other significant corporate transactions. These potential conflicts of interest could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects if attractive corporate opportunities are directed by Cerberus, its affiliates or our directors to themselves or their other affiliates instead of to us.

For a description of Cerberus’ interest as a lender to our company, see “— Certain of our debt is owned by Cerberus, which controls our controlling stockholder, and in certain instances such as in the event of a default under the financing documents governing such debt, the interests of Cerberus in its capacity as a lender may be adverse to the interests of our stockholders.”

Shares eligible for future sale may cause the market price of our common stock to decline, even if our business is doing well.

Sales of substantial amounts of our common stock in the public market after this offering, or the perception that these sales may occur, could adversely affect the price of our common stock and could impair our ability to raise capital through the sale of additional equity securities. Upon completion of this offering, our certificate of incorporation will authorize us to issue 350,000,000 shares of common stock and we will have             shares of common stock outstanding. Of these outstanding shares, the              shares of common stock sold in this offering will be freely tradable, without restriction, in the public market unless purchased by our affiliates. The remaining              shares of common stock will be “restricted securities,” as that term is defined in Rule 144 under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), which will be freely tradable subject to applicable holding period, volume and other limitations under Rule 144 or Rule 701 of the Securities Act.

Upon completion of this offering, the restricted securities will be subject to a lock-up agreement with the underwriters, restricting the sale of such shares for 180 days after the date of this offering. This lock-up agreement is subject to a number of exceptions, however, and holders may be released from these agreements without prior notice at the discretion of each of the representatives of the underwriters. Moreover, after expiration of the lock-up our controlling stockholder, as the holder of an aggregate of              shares of our common stock, will have rights, subject to some conditions, to require us to file registration statements covering its shares or to include its shares in registration statements that we may file for ourselves or other stockholders. Once we register these shares, they can be freely sold in the public market upon issuance.

A trading market may not develop for our common stock, and you may not be able to sell your stock.

There is no established trading market for our common stock, and the market for our common stock may be highly volatile or may decline regardless of our operating performance. You may not be able to sell your shares at or above the initial public offering price.

Prior to this offering, you could not buy or sell our equity publicly. Our common stock has been approved for listing on the New York Stock Exchange. However, an active public market for our common stock may not develop or be sustained after this offering. If a market does not develop or is not sustained, it may be difficult for you to sell your shares of common stock at a price that is attractive to you, or at all.

 

37


Table of Contents

The initial public offering price will be determined through negotiation between us and representatives of the underwriters, and may not be indicative of the market price for our common stock after this offering.

Reports published by securities or industry analysts, including projections in those reports that exceed our actual results, could adversely affect our common stock price and trading volume.

We currently expect that securities research analysts, including those affiliated with our underwriters, will establish and publish their own periodic projections for our business. These projections may vary widely from one another and may not accurately predict the results we actually achieve. Our stock price may decline if our actual results do not match securities research analysts’ projections. Similarly, if one or more of the analysts who writes reports on us downgrades our stock or publishes inaccurate or unfavorable research about our business, our stock price could decline. If one or more of these analysts ceases coverage of our company or fails to publish reports on us regularly, our stock price or trading volume could decline. While we expect securities research analyst coverage, if no securities or industry analysts commence coverage of our company, the trading price for our stock and the trading volume could be adversely affected.

We have never operated as a public company and the obligations incident to being a public company will require additional expenditures of both time and resources.

Although the Predecessor was a public company, we have never operated as a public company, and we expect that the obligations of being a public company, including substantial public reporting, auditing and investor relations obligations, will require significant additional expenditures, place additional demands on our management and require the hiring of additional personnel. These obligations will increase our operating expenses and could divert our management’s attention from our operations. The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and the SEC rules and regulations implementing that Act, as well as various New York Stock Exchange rules, will require us to implement additional corporate governance practices and may require further changes. These rules and regulations will increase our legal and financial compliance costs, and make some activities more difficult, time-consuming and/or costly. We also expect these rules and regulations to make it more difficult and more expensive for us to obtain director and officer liability insurance. We may be required to accept reduced coverage or incur substantially higher costs to obtain coverage. These rules and regulations could also make it more difficult for us to attract and retain qualified independent members of our board of directors and qualified members of our management team.

If we are unable to favorably assess the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting, or if our independent registered public accounting firm is not able to provide an unqualified attestation report on the effectiveness of our internal controls over financial reporting, our stock price could be materially adversely affected.

We will be required to certify to and report on, and our independent registered public accounting firm may be required to attest to, the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting on an annual basis, beginning with the second Annual Report on Form 10-K that we file with the SEC after completion of this offering. Following this offering, we expect to devote considerable resources, including management’s time and other internal resources, to a continuing effort to comply with regulatory requirements relating to internal controls, as we were not subject to the requirements of Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 while we were a private company. If we cannot favorably assess the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting, or if we require an attestation report from our independent registered public accounting firm and that firm is unable to provide an unqualified attestation report on the effectiveness of our internal controls over financial reporting, investor confidence and, in turn, our stock price could be materially adversely affected.

 

38


Table of Contents

We will have broad discretion over the use of the proceeds to us from this offering, and we may not use these funds in a manner of which you would approve or which would enhance the market price of our common stock.

We will have broad discretion to use the net proceeds from this offering, and you will be relying on the judgment of our board of directors and management regarding the use of these proceeds. Although we expect to use a portion of the net proceeds from this offering to retire existing indebtedness, we have not allocated the balance of these net proceeds for specific purposes and cannot assure you that we will use these funds in a manner of which you would approve.

Provisions in our charter documents, certain agreements governing our indebtedness and under Delaware law could make an acquisition of us more difficult and may prevent attempts by our stockholders to replace or remove our current management, even if beneficial to our stockholders.

Provisions in our certificate of incorporation and our bylaws that are effective upon the closing of this offering may discourage, delay or prevent a merger, acquisition or other change in control of our company that stockholders may consider favorable, including transactions in which you might otherwise receive a premium for your shares. These provisions could also limit the price that investors might be willing to pay in the future for shares of our common stock, thereby depressing the market price of our common stock. In addition, these provisions may frustrate or prevent any attempts by our stockholders to replace or remove our current management by making it more difficult for stockholders to replace members of our board of directors. Among others, these provisions:

 

   

establish a staggered board of directors such that not all members of the board are elected at one time;

 

   

on or after such date that our controlling stockholder, its affiliates, or any person who is an express assignee or designee of our controlling stockholder’s rights under our certificate of incorporation and such assignee’s or designee’s affiliates, ceases to beneficially own (as defined in Rule 13d-3 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934), in the aggregate, at least 50% of the outstanding shares of our common stock, which we refer to as the 50% Trigger Date, allow the authorized number of our directors to be changed only by resolution of our board of directors (and prior to such date, only by stockholders having the right to vote at least fifty percent in voting power of our outstanding voting stock, voting together as a single class, which holders, prior to such date, may also fill vacancies and newly created directorships resulting from any increases in authorized directors);

 

   

on or after the 50% Trigger Date, limit the manner in which stockholders can remove directors from our board (and prior to such date, stockholders having the right to vote at least fifty percent in voting power of our outstanding voting stock, voting together as a single class, may remove a director with or without cause);

 

   

on or after such date that our controlling stockholder, its affiliates, or any person who is an express assignee or designee of our controlling stockholder’s rights under our certificate of incorporation and such assignee’s or designee’s affiliates, ceases to beneficially own (as defined in Rule 13d-3 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934), in the aggregate, at least 33-1/3% of the outstanding shares of our common stock, which we refer to as the 33-1/3% Trigger Date, prohibit stockholders from proposing business to be conducted at special meetings of stockholders:

 

   

establish advance notice requirements for nominations by stockholders of directors to our board of directors;

 

   

on or after the 33-1/3% Trigger Date, require that stockholder actions must be effected at a duly called stockholder meeting and prohibit actions by our stockholders by written consent;

 

   

on or after the 33-1/3% Trigger Date, limit who may call stockholder meetings to the chairman of our board of directors or our board of directors pursuant to a resolution approved by a majority of the

 

39


Table of Contents
 

whole board (prior to that time, special meetings of stockholders may be called by the chairman of our board of directors, by our board of directors pursuant to a resolution approved by a majority of the whole board or by any of our controlling stockholder, its affiliates, or any express assignee or designee of our controlling stockholder under our certificate of incorporation, and such assignee’s or designee’s affiliates or any director employed by any of them);

 

   

require any stockholder, or group of stockholders acting in concert, who seeks to transact business at a meeting or nominate directors for election to submit a list of derivative and other interests in our company’s securities, including any short interests and synthetic equity interests held by such proposing stockholder;

 

   

require any stockholder, or group of stockholders acting in concert, who seeks to nominate directors for election to submit a description of all material relationships and related party transactions between such stockholders or group of stockholders, and their respective affiliates and associates, with the proposed nominee(s) and their respective affiliates or associates;

 

   

establish that our bylaws may be amended or repealed by a majority vote of our board of directors or, on or after the 50% Trigger Date, by stockholders having the right to vote at least two-thirds in voting power of our outstanding voting stock, voting together as a single class (and prior to such date, by stockholders having the right to vote at least 50% in voting power of our outstanding shares of voting stock, voting together as a single class);

 

   

limit our ability to engage in business combinations with certain interested stockholders; and

 

   

authorize our board of directors to cause the issuance of preferred stock without stockholder approval, which could work to dilute the stock ownership of a potential hostile acquirer, effectively preventing acquisitions that have not been approved by our board of directors.

Our certificate of incorporation authorizes the board of directors to issue up to 50,000,000 shares of preferred stock. The preferred stock may be issued in one or more series, the terms of which may be fixed by resolution of our board of directors without further action by the stockholders. These terms may include voting rights, preferences as to dividends and liquidation, conversion rights, redemption rights, and sinking fund provisions. The issuance of preferred stock could diminish the rights of holders of our common stock, and therefore could reduce the value of our common stock. In addition, specific rights granted to holders of preferred stock could be used to restrict our ability to merge with, or sell assets to, a third party. The ability of our board of directors to issue preferred stock could delay, discourage, prevent or make it more difficult or costly to acquire or effect a change in control, thereby preserving the current stockholders’ control.

We have no present intention to pay dividends and, even if we change that policy, we may be restricted from paying dividends on our common stock.

We do not intend to pay dividends for the foreseeable future. If we change that policy and commence paying dividends, we will not be obligated to continue those dividends and our stockholders will not be guaranteed, or have contractual or other rights, to receive dividends. If we commence paying dividends in the future, our board of directors may decide, in its discretion, at any time, to decrease the amount of dividends, otherwise modify or repeal the dividend policy or discontinue entirely the payment of dividends.

Our ability to pay dividends will be restricted by certain of the agreements governing our indebtedness, and may be restricted by agreements governing any of our future indebtedness. Furthermore, we are permitted under the terms of certain of the agreements governing our indebtedness to incur additional indebtedness (under certain circumstances) which in turn may severely restrict or prohibit the payment of dividends.

Under the DGCL, our board of directors may not authorize the payment of a dividend unless it is either paid out of our surplus, as calculated in accordance with the DGCL, or if we do not have a surplus, it is paid out of our net profits for the fiscal year in which the dividend is declared and/or the preceding fiscal year.

 

40


Table of Contents

SPECIAL NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This prospectus contains statements which constitute forward-looking statements, including statements relating to trends in the operations and financial results and the business and the products of our company as well as other statements including words such as “anticipate,” “believe,” “plan,” “estimate,” “expect,” “intend” and other similar expressions. Forward-looking statements are made based upon management’s current expectations and beliefs concerning future developments and their potential effects on us. Such forward-looking statements are not guarantees of future performance. The following important factors, and those important factors described elsewhere in this prospectus, including the matters set forth under the section entitled “Risk Factors,” could affect (and in some cases have affected) our actual results and could cause such results to differ materially from estimates or expectations reflected in such forward-looking statements:

 

  Ÿ  

OEM automobile production volumes;

 

  Ÿ  

the financial condition of the OEMs;

 

  Ÿ  

our ability to make scheduled payments of principal or interest on our indebtedness;

 

  Ÿ  

our ability to refinance our indebtedness;

 

  Ÿ  

our ability to generate non-automotive revenues, including revenues from our solar agreement with SES;

 

  Ÿ  

our ability to comply with the covenants and restrictions contained in the instruments governing our indebtedness;

 

  Ÿ  

our customers’ ability to obtain equity and debt financing for their respective businesses;

 

  Ÿ  

our dependence on our largest customers;

 

  Ÿ  

significant recalls experienced by OEMs;

 

  Ÿ  

pricing pressure from our customers;

 

  Ÿ  

strengthening of the U.S. dollar and other foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations impacting our results;

 

  Ÿ  

work stoppages or other labor issues at our facilities or at the facilities of our customers or suppliers;

 

  Ÿ  

risks associated with non-U.S. operations, including foreign exchange risks and economic instability in some regions, including Europe;

 

  Ÿ  

costs or liabilities relating to environmental and safety regulations, including those relating to GHG emissions;

 

  Ÿ  

any increase in the expense and funding requirements of our pension and other postretirement benefits; and

 

  Ÿ  

the possibility that our controlling stockholder’s interests will conflict with our other stockholders’ interests.

This prospectus also contains estimates and other statistical data made by independent parties and by us relating to market size and growth and other data about our industry. This data involves a number of assumptions and limitations, and you are cautioned not to give undue weight to such estimates. Projections, assumptions and estimates of our future performance and the future performance of the industries in which we operate are necessarily subject to a high degree of uncertainty and risk.

Any forward-looking statement speaks only as of the date on which it is made, and we undertake no obligation to update any forward-looking statement to reflect events or circumstances after the date on which the statement is made or to reflect the occurrence of unanticipated events. Except as required by law, we undertake no obligation to publicly revise our forward-looking statements to reflect events or circumstances that arise after the date of this prospectus.

 

41


Table of Contents

USE OF PROCEEDS

We estimate that the net proceeds from the shares offered by us will be approximately $             million, after deducting the underwriting discount and estimated expenses of this offering and assuming we sell the shares for $             per share, representing the midpoint of the range on the cover page of this prospectus.

A $1.00 increase or decrease in the assumed initial public offering price of $             per share would increase or decrease the net proceeds to us from this offering by approximately $             million, assuming the number of shares offered by us, as listed on the cover page of this prospectus, remains the same.

We intend to use $             million of the net proceeds from this offering to reduce the outstanding balance on our revolving credit facility and the balance of such net proceeds for working capital and other general corporate purposes. The amount outstanding under our revolving credit facility varies frequently and at the closing of this offering may be less than or greater than the balance reflected in this prospectus as outstanding at June 30, 2010. Net proceeds dedicated to working capital may ultimately be used to further reduce our indebtedness, including indebtedness outstanding under our revolving credit facility, our foreign subsidiary indebtedness, the notes and our capital leases.

At June 30, 2010, the weighted average interest rate in effect on our revolving credit facility was 3.1%. Such indebtedness matures on July 31, 2012.

Contemporaneous with the closing of this offering, we will pay a total of $1.2 million to certain executive officers pursuant to a special incentive program. In addition, we expect to grant RSUs to our executive officers and certain directors and grant stock options to our executive officers, directors and other employees and we may establish a bonus pool for certain employees who are not executive officers pursuant to our Value Creation Plan. Such RSUs and stock options are subject to vesting requirements. See footnote 2 in “Prospectus Summary—Summary Consolidated Financial Data.”

 

42


Table of Contents

DIVIDEND POLICY

We do not expect to pay any cash dividends for the foreseeable future.

We are not required to pay dividends, and our stockholders will not have contractual or other rights to receive dividends. The declaration and payment of any dividends will be at the sole discretion of our board of directors and will depend upon, among other things, our earnings, financial condition, capital requirements, level of indebtedness, contractual restrictions with respect to the payment of dividends, and other considerations that our board of directors deems relevant. If we commence paying dividends at any time, our board of directors may decide, in its discretion, at any time thereafter, to decrease the amount or dividends, otherwise modify or repeal the dividend policy or discontinue entirely the payment of dividends.

The agreements governing our indebtedness contain, and agreements governing any of our future indebtedness may contain, various covenants that limit our ability to pay dividends. We are also a holding company that does not conduct any business operations of our own. As a result, we are dependent upon cash dividends and distributions and other transfers from our subsidiaries to make dividend payments on our common stock. In addition, our subsidiaries are permitted to pay dividends to us subject to general restrictions imposed on dividend payments under the jurisdiction of incorporation or organization of each subsidiary. See “Risk Factors—Risk Factors Relating to Our Common Stock and This Offering—We have no present intention to pay dividends and, even if we change that policy, we may be restricted from paying dividends on our common stock.”

The ability of our board of directors to declare a dividend is also subject to limits imposed by Delaware corporate law. Under Delaware law, our board of directors and the boards of directors of our corporate subsidiaries incorporated in Delaware, may declare dividends only to the extent of “surplus,” which is defined as total assets at fair market value minus total liabilities, minus statutory capital, or if there is no surplus, out of net profits for the fiscal year in which the dividend is declared and/or the preceding fiscal year.

 

43


Table of Contents

CAPITALIZATION

The following table sets forth our cash and cash equivalents and our capitalization on a consolidated basis as of June 30, 2010:

 

   

on an actual basis;

 

   

on an adjusted basis, giving effect to the notes offering, in connection with which:

 

   

we received gross proceeds of $417.2 million (representing $430 million aggregate principal amount less $12.8 million of original issue discount);

 

   

Cerberus caused one of its affiliates to forgive $25 million aggregate principal amount of our first lien term loan in exchange for an equity interest in Tower Automotive, LLC;

 

   

we used the gross proceeds from the notes offering, together with $5.9 million of our cash, to retire the balance of our first lien term loan (other than our synthetic letter of credit facility) and to pay related fees and expenses; and

 

   

all of the equity interests in Tower Automotive, LLC, including the preferred units, were converted into capital units of Tower Automotive, LLC; and

 

   

on an as further adjusted basis, also giving effect to:

 

   

the Corporate Conversion;

 

   

the sale by us of              shares of common stock in this offering at an assumed initial public offering price of $             per share, representing the midpoint of the range on the cover page of this prospectus, and the receipt of the net proceeds thereof, after deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and the estimated offering expenses payable by us;

 

   

the assumed use of $             of the net proceeds from this offering to repay outstanding indebtedness under our revolving credit facility; and

 

   

the assumed addition to our working capital of the balance of the net proceeds from this offering.

 

44


Table of Contents

The as adjusted and as further adjusted information below is illustrative only and our capitalization following the closing of this offering will be adjusted based on the actual initial public offering price and other terms of this offering determined at pricing. This table should be read in conjunction with “Use of Proceeds,” “Selected Historical Consolidated Financial Data,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and our consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 

     Actual     As
Adjusted
for the
Notes
Offering
    As Further
Adjusted
for this
Offering(1)
     (in millions)

Cash and cash equivalents(2)

   $ 149.6      $ 143.7      $             
                      

Total debt (including current portion):

      

Asset based revolving credit facility(3)

   $ 53.5      $ 53.5      $             

First lien term loan:

      

U.S. dollar denominated tranche

     203.3        —       

Euro denominated tranche(4)

     226.7        —       

Notes

     —          417.2 (5)   

Other foreign subsidiary indebtedness(6)

     152.1        152.1     

Capital leases

     18.5        18.5     
                      

Total debt, including current portion(7)

   $ 654.1      $ 641.3      $             
                      

Mezzanine equity: Redeemable preferred units(8)

   $ 179.5      $ —        $  

Stockholders’ equity (deficit):

      

Limited liability company interests, no par or stated value

     12.9        217.4 (9)   

Preferred stock, $0.01 par value, 50,000,000 shares authorized, no shares issued and outstanding, actual, as adjusted, and as further adjusted

     —          —       

Common stock, $0.01 par value, 350,000,000 shares authorized; no shares issued and outstanding, actual and as adjusted; and              shares issued and outstanding, as further adjusted

     —          —       

Additional paid-in capital

     —          —       

Retained earnings (deficit)

     (156.2     (161.7  

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

     (57.4     (57.4  
                      

Total equity before noncontrolling interest (deficit)

   $ (200.7   $ (1.7   $             
                      

Noncontrolling interests in subsidiaries

     44.4        44.4     
                      

Total members/stockholders’ equity (deficit)

   $ (156.3   $ 42.7      $  
                      

Total capitalization (including current portion of long-term debt)

   $ 677.3      $ 684.0      $  
                      

 

(1) A $1.00 increase or decrease in the assumed initial public offering price of $             per share, representing the midpoint of the range on the cover page of this prospectus, would result in an approximately $             million increase or decrease in each of the as further adjusted additional paid-in capital, as further adjusted total stockholders’ equity (deficit) and as further adjusted total capitalization, assuming that the number of shares offered by us, as set forth on the cover page of this prospectus (assuming that the Corporate Conversion had taken place and excluding shares reserved for issuance under RSUs issuable pursuant to one of our benefit plans in connection with the consummation of this offering), remains the same and after deducting the commissions and discounts and estimated offering expenses payable by us. An increase or decrease of 1.0 million shares in the number of shares offered by us would result in an approximately $             million increase or decrease in each of the as further adjusted additional paid-in capital, as further adjusted total stockholders’ equity (deficit) and as further adjusted total capitalization, assuming the assumed initial public offering price of $             per share, representing the midpoint of the range on the cover page of this prospectus, remains the same and after deducting the commissions and discounts and estimated offering expenses payable by us.

 

45


Table of Contents
(2) Net proceeds from the notes offering are expected to be $409.4 million, after all expenses are determined. As adjusted cash and cash equivalents gives effect to the use of $5.9 million of our cash to fund the balance of the cash needed to retire our first lien term loan (other than the synthetic letter of credit facility portion thereof) and to repay all fees and expenses related to the notes offering.
(3) Consists of a $150 million senior secured asset based revolving credit facility. As of June 30, 2010, there was a $110.3 million borrowing base under this revolving credit facility, and $53.5 million of borrowings and no letters of credit were outstanding under this facility.
(4) At June 30, 2010, the Euro denominated tranche was €185.3 million and was translated into US dollars at a foreign currency exchange rate of $1.2229 per Euro.
(5) Gives effect to the issuance of $430 million aggregate principal amount of notes (net of $12.8 million of original issue discount).
(6) Consists primarily of borrowings in South Korea and Brazil and receivable factoring in Italy.
(7) For further information regarding our long-term debt, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Debt,” “Description of Certain Indebtedness” and note 8 to our consolidated financial statements.
(8) Represents preferred equity interests in Tower Automotive, LLC. See Note 18 to our consolidated financial statements as of June 30, 2010 and for the six month periods ended June 30, 2010 and 2009. On August 12, 2010, all of the equity interests in Tower Automotive, LLC, including the preferred units, were converted into capital units of Tower Automotive, LLC.
(9) Gives effect to (i) the conversion of preferred units, common units and management incentive plan units of Tower Automotive, LLC into capital units of Tower Automotive, LLC and (ii) the cancellation by Cerberus of $25 million aggregate principal amount of our first lien term loan in connection with the consummation of the notes offering and the issuance of equity in Tower Automotive, LLC in exchange therefor.

The table that we have presented above assumes that              shares of common stock are issued pursuant to the Corporate Conversion and excludes (i)              shares reserved for issuance under RSUs which we expect to grant to our executive officers and certain board members pursuant to one of our benefit plans in connection with the consummation of this offering and (ii)              shares issuable upon the exercise of stock options which we expect to grant in connection with the consummation of this offering to our executive officers, board members and other employees. See “Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—Long Term Incentive Compensation Awards” and “Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—2010 Equity Incentive Plan.” For additional information regarding such RSUs and stock options, as well as information regarding bonus pools for employees who are not executive officers, see footnote 2 in “Prospectus Summary—Summary Consolidated Financial Data.”

The table above reflects the use of $             million of net proceeds from this offering to reduce the amount outstanding under our revolving credit facility. The amount outstanding under our revolving credit facility varies frequently and at the closing of this offering may be less than or greater than the balance reflected in this prospectus as outstanding as of June 30, 2010. Amounts reflected in the table above as being added to cash and cash equivalents may ultimately be used to further reduce our indebtedness, including indebtedness outstanding under our revolving credit facility, our foreign subsidiary indebtedness, the notes and our capital leases.

 

46


Table of Contents

DILUTION

Purchasers of the common stock in this offering will suffer an immediate dilution in net tangible book value per share. Dilution is the amount by which the price paid by the purchasers of common stock in this offering will exceed the pro forma net tangible book value per share of common stock immediately after this offering. Our net tangible book value (deficit) of our common stock at June 30, 2010 was $(229.2) million or $             per share of common stock after giving effect to the Corporate Conversion as if it had occurred on June 30, 2010. Net tangible book value per share represents our tangible assets less total liabilities, divided by the number of shares of common stock outstanding as of June 30, 2010. After giving effect to the consummation of the Corporate Conversion and this offering, assuming an initial public offering price of $             per share, representing the midpoint of the range on the cover page of this prospectus, and the application of the net proceeds therefrom, our pro forma net tangible book value as of June 30, 2010 would have been $             million or $             per share of common stock. This represents an immediate increase in pro forma net tangible book value to existing stockholders of $             per share of common stock and an immediate dilution to new investors of $             per share of common stock.

The following table illustrates this per share dilution:

 

Assumed initial public offering price per share

   $             

Net tangible book value per share as of June 30, 2010

  

Increase in pro forma net tangible book value per share resulting from the Corporate Conversion and this offering

  

Pro forma net tangible book value per share after this offering

  

Pro forma dilution per share to new investors

   $  
      

A $1.00 increase or decrease in the assumed initial public offering price of $             per share, representing the midpoint of the range on the cover page of this prospectus, would increase or decrease our net tangible book value by $             million, the net tangible book value per share of common stock after this offering by $             per share of common stock, and the dilution per share of common stock to new investors by $             per share of common stock, assuming the number of shares offered by us, as set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, remains the same and after deducting the commissions and discounts and estimated offering expenses payable by us.

If the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares from us in full, the following will occur:

 

   

the pro forma percentage of shares of our common stock held by existing stockholders will decrease to approximately     % of the total number of pro forma shares of our common stock outstanding after this offering; and

 

   

the pro forma number of shares of our common stock held by new public investors will increase to             , or approximately    % of the total pro forma number of shares of our common stock outstanding after this offering.

 

47


Table of Contents

The following table summarizes, as of June 30, 2010, the number of shares purchased or to be purchased from us, the total consideration paid or to be paid to us, and the average price per share paid or to be paid to us by existing stockholders and new investors purchasing shares of our common stock in this offering, assuming an initial public offering price of $             per share, representing the midpoint of the range on the cover page of this prospectus, before deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us. As the table below shows, new investors purchasing shares of our common stock in this offering will pay an average price per share substantially higher than our existing stockholders paid.

 

     Units /Shares Purchased     Total Consideration      
     Number    Percent     Amount    Percent     Average Price
Per Share
     (in millions)

Existing Stockholders

        $                   $             

New Investors

             $             
                          

Total

      100.0   $                 100.0  
                          

The number of shares of common stock outstanding as of June 30, 2010 is based on giving effect to              shares of common stock issuable pursuant to our Corporate Conversion and excludes shares reserved for issuance under RSUs which we expect to grant certain executive officers and directors pursuant to one of our benefit plans in connection with the consummation of this offering.

If the RSUs which we expect to grant upon consummation of this offering had vested as of June 30, 2010, our pro forma net tangible book value as of June 30, 2010 would have been approximately $             per share, and the pro forma net tangible book value after giving effect to this offering would have been $             per share, representing dilution in our pro forma net tangible book value per share to new investors of $            . For purposes of this paragraph, we have assumed that              RSUs will be issued upon consummation of this offering. See “Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards— Long Term Incentive Compensation Awards.”

 

48


Table of Contents

SELECTED HISTORICAL CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

The following table sets forth our selected historical consolidated financial data as of the dates and for the periods indicated. The selected consolidated balance sheet data of the Successor as of December 31, 2009 and 2008, the selected consolidated statement of operations data and the selected consolidated statement of cash flows data of the Successor for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008 and for the five months ended December 31, 2007 and the selected consolidated statement of operations data and the selected consolidated statement of cash flows data of the Predecessor for the seven months ended July 31, 2007 have been derived from our audited consolidated financial statements and related notes that we have included elsewhere in this prospectus. The selected consolidated balance sheet data of the Successor as of December 31, 2007 and of the Predecessor as of December 31, 2006 and 2005 and the selected consolidated statement of operations and the statement of cash flows data of the Predecessor for the years ended December 31, 2006 and 2005 have been derived from audited consolidated financial statements, which are not presented in this prospectus. The selected consolidated balance sheet data, the selected consolidated statement of operations data and the selected consolidated statement of cash flows data as of June 30, 2010 and for the six month periods ended June 30, 2010 and 2009 have been derived from our unaudited consolidated financial statements and related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. In the opinion of our management, such unaudited financial statements have been prepared on the same basis as the audited financial statements and reflect all adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring adjustments, necessary for a fair presentation of our results of operations and financial position for such periods.

The selected historical consolidated financial data as of any date and for any period are not necessarily indicative of the results that may be achieved as of any future date or for any future period. As a result of the implementation of applicable accounting pronouncements relating to our acquisition of the Predecessor’s assets, the financial statements and financial data presented in this prospectus for dates and for periods ending on or before July 31, 2007 are not comparable with the financial statements and financial data for periods after July 31, 2007.

The following table also presents certain selected unaudited pro forma and adjusted pro forma summary of operations data for the year ended December 31, 2009 and the six months ended June 30, 2010, giving effect to the items described in footnotes 2 and 3 to the table. The selected unaudited pro forma and adjusted pro forma summary of operations data is presented for informational purposes only and does not purport to represent what our results of operations would have been had the referenced events occurred on the dates indicated or to project our results of operations for any future period.

 

49


Table of Contents

You should read the following selected historical consolidated financial data in conjunction with the more detailed information contained in “Capitalization,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and our consolidated financial statements and the related notes that we have presented elsewhere in this prospectus.

 

    Successor     Predecessor  
    Six  Months
Ended
June 30,
    Year Ended
December 31,
    Five Months
Ended

December 31,
2007
    Seven  Months
Ended

July 31,
2007
    Year Ended
December 31,
 
  2010     2009     2009     2008         2006     2005  
   

(in millions except unit/share and per unit/share data)

 

Statement of Operations Data:

               

Revenues

  $ 980.8      $ 697.9      $ 1,634.4      $ 2,171.7      $ 1,086.1      $ 1,455.5      $ 2,539.4      $ 2,932.2   

Cost of sales

    872.0        681.9        1,536.8        1,991.3        970.5        1,325.9        2,389.2        2,752.1   

Gross profit

    108.8        16.0        97.6        180.4        115.6        129.6        150.2        180.1   

Gross profit margin

    11.1     2.3     6.0     8.3     10.6     8.9     5.9     6.1

Selling, general and administrative expenses(1)

  $ 65.0      $ 53.3      $ 118.3      $ 138.6      $ 57.0      $ 77.2      $ 131.5      $ 149.7   

Amortization expense

    1.5        1.3        2.8        3.0        1.2        —          —          —     

Restructuring and related asset impairment charges, net

    4.7        (1.1     13.4        4.8        1.8        22.4        70.5        116.4   

Operating income/(loss)

    37.6        (37.5     (36.9     34.0        55.5        30.0        (51.1     (78.3

Operating income/(loss) margin

    3.8     (5.4 )%      (2.3 )%      1.6     5.1     2.1     (2.0 )%      (2.7 )% 

Interest expense, net.

  $ 27.3      $ 27.2      $ 56.9      $ 60.2      $ 34.0      $ 65.5      $ 95.3      $ 101.8   

Chapter 11 and related reorganization items

    —          —          —          —          —          62.2        66.2        167.4   

Income/(loss) from continuing operations

    1.9        (35.0     (59.0     (45.7     18.2        (100.3     (199.4     (346.9

Cumulative effect of accounting change

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          (7.8

Net income/(loss)

    1.9        (35.0     (59.0     (45.7     18.2        (100.6     (195.4     (368.4

Net income attributable to the non-controlling interests

    4.5        3.9        8.9        6.6        3.0        5.4        6.7        5.0   

Net income/(loss) attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC

    (2.6     (39.0     (67.9     (52.3     15.2        (106.0     (202.1     (373.4

Preferred unit dividends

    8.6        7.9        16.1        14.9        8.8        —          —          —     

Income/(loss) available to common unitholders/stockholders

    (11.2     (46.9     (84.0     (67.3     6.4        (106.0     (202.1     (373.4

Basic and diluted income/(loss) per unit/share:

               

Income/(loss) from continuing operations

    (1,320     (5,516     (9,885     (7,917     748        (1.79     (3.51     (6.00

Income/(loss) from discontinued operations

    —          —          —          —          —          (0.01     0.07        (0.23

Cumulative effect of accounting change

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          (0.14

Income/(loss) per unit/share

    (1,320     (5,516     (9,885     (7,917     748        (1.80     (3.44     (6.37

Weighted average basic and diluted units/shares outstanding (in thousands)

    8.5        8.5        8.5        8.5        8.5        58,807        58,659        58,645   

Cash dividends declared per unit

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

 

     Six Months Ended
June 30, 2010
   Year Ended
December 31,  2009
     Actual   As Adjusted    Actual    As Adjusted
                    
Basic and diluted pro forma loss per
share
       (2)       (3)        (2)   

    (3)

 

    Successor   Predecessor  
    June  30,
2010
    December 31,   December 31,  
      2009     2008     2007   2006     2005  
   

(in millions)

 

Balance Sheet Data:

           

Cash and cash equivalents

  $ 149.6      $ 149.8      $ 126.8      $ 96.8   $ 64.3      $ 65.8   

Total assets

    1,300.7        1,334.4        1,269.8        1,582.9     2,107.0        2,291.2   

Total debt(4)

    654.1        669.5        628.1        691.7     1,681.0        1,625.9   

Redeemable preferred units(5)

    179.5        170.9        155.2        145.9     —          —     

Total members’/stockholders’ equity (deficit)

    (156.3     (147.2     (88.5     32.6     (662.7     (487.6

 

50


Table of Contents

 

(1) In connection with the closing of the notes offering, we paid a total of $5.5 million of compensation to our executive officers pursuant to a special incentive program. We have also committed to pay an additional $1.2 million under that program to certain executive officers upon the earlier of the consummation of this offering or August 24, 2011. See “Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Components of Compensation—Special Incentive Compensation.” This latter cash benefit will vest fully upon consummation of the closing of this offering. The payments of such $1.2 million vest immediately upon the closing of this offering because at such time there will be no further conditions to payment of that compensation. The full amount of the compensation paid pursuant to the special incentive program will be charged as a compensation expense against earnings in the year or years in which such compensation is paid.
(2) Pro forma loss per share gives effect to the Corporate Conversion as if it had occurred on the first day of the periods presented. It has been calculated by dividing the net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC by             , constituting the number of shares of common stock to be issued pursuant to the Corporate Conversion.
(3) Adjusted pro forma loss per share also adjusts pro forma loss per share to give effect to (i) the notes offering as if it had occurred on the first day of the periods presented and the concurrent retirement of our first lien term loan (other than the synthetic letter of credit facility portion thereof) and (ii) the assumed repayment of $             million on our revolving credit facility with a portion of the net proceeds from this offering. For purposes of this calculation, during the periods presented we have added to interest expense the difference between the interest payable on the notes and the interest paid on our first lien term loan after giving effect to hedging arrangements applicable to the first lien term loan and we have reduced interest expense by the interest paid on the portion of our revolving credit facility which we expect to repay with a portion of the net proceeds of this offering, net of applicable taxes. We have then divided the adjusted net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC by             , constituting the sum of (i) the number of shares of common stock to be issued pursuant to the Corporate Conversion and (ii) the number of shares to be sold in this offering to cover repayment of $             million of our revolving credit facility at an assumed initial public offering price of $             per share, representing the midpoint of the range on the cover page of this prospectus, after deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and the estimated offering expenses payable by us.
(4) Consists of short-term and long-term debt, current portion of long-term debt and capital lease obligations.
(5) Represents preferred equity interests in Tower Automotive, LLC. See Note 18 to our consolidated financial statements as of June 30, 2010 and for the six month periods ended June 30, 2010 and 2009. On August 12, 2010, the preferred units, common units and management incentive plan units of Tower Automotive, LLC, which constituted all of the equity interests in Tower Automotive, LLC, were converted into capital units of Tower Automotive, LLC.

 

51


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

You should read the following discussion of our financial condition and results of operations together with the “Selected Historical Consolidated Financial Data” and the historical consolidated financial statements and related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. This discussion contains forward-looking statements and involves numerous risks and uncertainties, including, but not limited to, those described under “Risk Factors,” where we have described the material risks applicable to us. Actual results may differ materially from those contained in any forward-looking statements. Certain monetary amounts, percentages and other figures included in this prospectus have been subject to rounding adjustments. Accordingly, figures shown as totals in certain tables may not be the arithmetic aggregation of the figures that precede them, and figures expressed as percentages in the text may not total 100% or, as applicable, when aggregated may not be the arithmetic aggregation of the percentages that precede them.

Overview of the Business

We are a leading integrated global manufacturer of engineered structural metal components and assemblies primarily serving automotive OEMs. We offer our automotive customers a broad product portfolio, supplying body-structure stampings, frame and other chassis structures, as well as complex welded assemblies, for small and large cars, crossovers, pickups and SUVs. We have also recently entered the utility-scale solar energy market with an agreement to supply large stamped mirror-facet panels and welded support structures.

Our products are manufactured at 31 production facilities strategically located near our customers in North America, South America, Europe and Asia. We support our manufacturing operations through nine engineering and sales locations throughout the world. Our products are offered on a diverse mix of vehicle platforms, reflecting the balanced portfolio approach of our business model and the breadth of our product capabilities. We supply products to approximately 160 vehicle models globally. Our 10 largest vehicle models represented approximately 36% of our 2009 revenues.

We are a disciplined, process-driven company with an experienced management team which has a history of implementing sustainable operational improvements. From January 1, 2008 through December 31, 2009, we achieved $195 million in manufacturing and purchasing cost reductions. We achieved these cost reductions in large part through successful implementation of Lean Six Sigma principles and rigorous application of global best practices. These cost reductions helped us achieve a 6% gross profit margin and a 7.6% Adjusted EBITDA margin in 2009 during an historically challenging environment in the automotive industry.

We believe that our product capabilities, our geographic, customer and product diversification and the cost reductions that we achieved in 2008 and 2009 position us to benefit from a recovery in global automotive industry production. We intend to leverage our program management and engineering experience to pursue growth opportunities outside our existing automotive markets, as demonstrated by our solar agreement. The solar industry shows promise for us, as many applications require highly engineered large stampings and complex welded structural assemblies that must be produced in high volume at repeatable tight tolerances similar to our product requirements in the automotive industry. Pursuant to our solar agreement, we are to supply large stamped mirror-facet panels and welded support structures to SES. The amount of revenues that we may generate from this agreement will depend in part upon the extent of the financing SES is able to raise for its solar projects. We cannot be sure when production will commence or when revenues will be generated from these projects until SES secures appropriate financing. See “Risk Factors—Our ability to recognize revenues from our agreement with Stirling Energy Systems, or SES, is subject to several risks, any one of which could materially and adversely impact our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.”

While we plan to invest approximately $30 to $35 million (net of government and other incentives) to support this agreement, we cannot yet predict the extent to which such spending will be made in 2010 or in subsequent periods. Our capital expenditures for these projects would include investing in a new facility in the southwest United States that could provide a base for additional expansion.

 

52


Table of Contents

We believe the solar industry in the United States and globally has the potential to grow at an average rate substantially greater than the longer term trend rate for the automotive industry. Beyond solar, we believe there may be similar opportunities in the future to apply and extend our core skills in other industries, such as defense, wind or appliances.

Factors Affecting Our Industry

Our business and our revenues are primarily driven by the strength of the global automotive industry, which tends to be cyclical and highly correlated to general global macroeconomic conditions. The strength of the automotive market dictates the volume of purchases of our products by our OEM customers to ultimately satisfy consumer demand. We manufacture products pursuant to written agreements with each of our OEM customers. However, those agreements do not dictate the volume requirements of our customers; instead, OEMs monitor their inventory and the inventory levels of their dealers and adjust the volume of their purchases from us based on consumer demand for their products.

During the latter half of 2008 and throughout 2009, the automotive industry experienced an unprecedented downturn, led by the recession in the United States and followed by declines in many major markets around the world. The economic crisis in general, and the decline in consumer spending and the financial market turmoil in particular, had a severe and detrimental impact upon the global automotive market. In response to both the lack of strong consumer demand and the tightening of access to financial markets, OEMs reduced production volumes throughout the automotive industry, significantly impacting the revenues of both OEMs and their suppliers.

As measured by CSM Worldwide ® , global industry production of cars and light trucks peaked at 69 million in 2007 and declined to 57 million in 2009. This decline was more pronounced in the more mature markets: North American and European production levels declined from 37 million vehicles in 2007 to 25 million vehicles in 2009. In response to the unprecedented economic crisis, certain governments, including the United States, enacted tax incentives and took other affirmative steps to spur consumer purchases of automobiles in 2009. These steps may have limited the adverse effects of the global economic crisis on the automotive industry and may help to position the industry for recovery. Over the long term, CSM Worldwide ® projects production will reach 83 million vehicles by 2013, reflecting a recovery in both the North American and European markets as well as continued growth in emerging markets such as China and Brazil. We believe that we are well positioned to benefit from this long-term trend, but we are not insulated from short-term fluctuations in the global automotive industry.

Factors Affecting Our Revenues

While overall production volumes are largely driven by economic factors outside of our direct control, we believe that the following elements of our business also impact our revenues:

 

   

Diversification of our customer base.     Our revenues are impacted by the popularity of the OEMs for which we supply structural metal components and their respective market shares. By diversifying our customer base, we limit the risks associated with a downturn in any one OEM’s product portfolio. For example, we have reduced our exposure to Ford, General Motors and Chrysler—the “Detroit 3”—from 66% of our Predecessor’s revenues in 2002 to 18% of our revenues in 2009, and have focused our efforts mainly on automotive manufacturers with a global presence.

 

   

Diversification of our vehicle mix.     Similar to shifts in popularity of OEMs, shifts in consumer preferences directly influence the types and quantities of vehicles that OEMs manufacture, which in turn directly influences the structural components that we produce. By diversifying the vehicle types that we supply components for, we limit the risks associated with a downturn in any one of our vehicle segments. In 2009, our revenue mix was: 49%—small cars; 21%—large cars, including multi-purpose vehicles; 18%—North American framed vehicles; and 12%—other—light trucks. See “Business—Our Competitive Strengths—Platform Diversification” for definitions of the terms “small cars”, “large cars” and “North American framed vehicles.”

 

53


Table of Contents
   

Diversification of our product offerings.     Our OEM customers rely upon us to efficiently produce structural metal components for the platforms that they design and to respond quickly to platform and vehicle enhancements that they develop. OEMs value the extent to which we are able to integrate multiple stampings and assemblies into offerings, thereby reducing the extent to which they must devote their focus and capital to integrating components they purchase from their suppliers.

 

   

Geographic diversification.     Given the high costs and difficulties associated with transporting large structural metal components that we manufacture, it is critical that our facilities are in close proximity to our customers. We believe that countries such as Brazil and China, as well as other regions including Eastern Europe, will experience significant growth in vehicle demand and associated production volumes during the next five years as projected by CSM Worldwide ® . We currently have 6 manufacturing facilities in Poland, Slovakia, Brazil and China and a technical center in India. As such, our geographic footprint is positioned to benefit as these markets expand and ultimately influence our revenue growth.

 

   

Opportunities to pursue non-automotive revenues.     Our ability to produce large engineered structural components and assemblies is not confined to automotive markets. We have entered into an agreement to manufacture large stamped mirror-facet panels and welded support structures for SES. We cannot be sure when production will commence or when revenues will be generated from this agreement until our customer secures appropriate financing. In addition to our solar agreement, we intend to consider and pursue other applications of our core competencies to develop other sources of non-automotive revenues.

 

   

Life cycle of our agreements.     Our agreements with OEMs typically follow one of two patterns. Agreements for new models of vehicles normally cover the lifetime of the platform, often with periods of two to five years before these models are marketed to the public. Agreements covering design improvements to existing automobiles have shorter expected life cycles, typically with shorter pre-production and development periods. Typically, once a supplier has been designated to supply components for a new platform, an OEM will continue to purchase those parts from the designated manufacturer for the life of the program. For any given agreement, our revenues depend in part upon the life cycle status of the applicable product platform. Overall, our revenues are enhanced to the extent that the products we are assembling and producing are in the peak production periods of their life cycles.

 

   

Product pricing.     Generally, our customers negotiate annual price reductions with us during the term of their contracts. When negotiated price reductions are expected to be retroactive, we accrue for such amounts as a reduction of revenues as products are shipped. The extent of our price reductions negatively impacts our revenues. In unusual circumstances, we have been able to negotiate year-over-year price increases as well.

 

   

Steel pricing .    We require significant quantities of steel in the manufacture of our products. Although changing steel prices affect our results, we seek to be neutral with respect to steel pricing over time, with the intention of neither making nor losing money as steel prices fluctuate. The pricing of our products includes a component for steel which increases as steel prices increase and decreases as steel prices decrease. For our North American customers and several of our other customers, we purchase steel through our customers’ resale programs, where our customers actually negotiate the cost of steel for us. In other cases, we procure steel directly from the mills, negotiating our own price and seeking to pass through steel price increases and decreases to our customers.

 

   

Seasonality .    Our business is seasonal. Our customers in Europe typically shut down vehicle production during portions of July or August and during one week in our fourth quarter. Our North American customers typically shut down vehicle production for approximately two weeks during July and for one week during December. Our results of operations, cash flows and liquidity in our third and fourth quarters may be impacted by these seasonal practices.

 

   

Foreign exchange.     Our foreign exchange transaction risk is generally limited, primarily because we purchase and produce products in the same country where we sell to our final customer. However, the translation of foreign currencies back to the U.S. dollar may have a significant impact on our revenues

 

54


Table of Contents
 

and financial results. Foreign exchange has an unfavorable impact on revenues when the U.S. dollar is relatively strong as compared with foreign currencies and a favorable impact on revenues when the U.S. dollar is relatively weak as compared with foreign currencies. The functional currency of our foreign operations is the local currency. Assets and liabilities of our foreign operations are translated into U.S. dollars using the applicable period-end rates of exchange. Results of operations are translated at applicable average rates prevailing throughout the period. Translation gains or losses are reported as a separate component of accumulated other comprehensive income in our consolidated statements of stockholders’ equity (deficit). Gains and losses resulting from foreign currency transactions, the amounts of which were not material in any of the periods presented in this prospectus, are included in net income (loss).

Factors Affecting Our Expenses

Our expenses are principally driven by the following factors:

 

   

Cost of steel .    We utilize steel and various purchased steel products in virtually all of our products. We refer to the “net steel impact” as the combination of the change in steel prices that are reflected in the price of our products, the change in the cost to procure steel from the mill, and the change in our recovery of scrap steel, which we refer to as offal. Our strategy is to be economically indifferent to steel pricing by having these factors offset each other. While we strive to achieve a neutral net steel impact, we are not always successful in achieving that goal, in large part due to timing. Depending upon when a steel price change occurs, that change may have a disproportionate effect, within any particular fiscal period, on our product pricing, our steel costs and the results of our sales of scrap steel. Imbalances in any one particular fiscal period may be reversed in a subsequent fiscal period, although we can not assure you if or when these reversals will occur.

 

   

Purchase of steel.     As noted above, we purchase a portion of our steel from our customers through our customers’ resale programs and a portion of our steel directly from the mills. Whether our customer negotiates the cost of steel for us in a customer resale program or we negotiate the cost of steel with the mills, the price we pay is charged directly to our cost of sales, just as the component of product pricing relating to steel is included within our revenues.

 

   

Sale of scrap steel.     We typically sell offal in secondary markets which are influenced by similar market forces. We generally share our recoveries from sales of offal with our customers either through scrap sharing agreements, in cases where we are on resale programs, or in the product pricing that is negotiated regarding increases and decreases in the steel price in cases where we purchase steel directly from the mills. In either situation, we may be impacted by the fluctuation in scrap steel prices, either positive or negative, in relation to our various customer agreements. Since scrap steel prices generally increase and decrease as steel prices increase and decrease, our sale of offal may mitigate the severity of steel price increases and limit the benefits we achieve through steel price declines. Recoveries related to sales of offal reduce cost of sales.

 

   

Other manufacturing expenses .    Our cost of sales includes raw material costs, labor expenses and other expenses that we incur to operate our plants. In addition to steel, our cost of sales is directly impacted by:

 

   

the number of employees engaged in manufacturing and the wages and benefits that we pay to those employees;

 

   

depreciation;

 

   

energy expenses;

 

   

the costs we incur to purchase raw materials other than steel;

 

   

non-production materials;

 

55


Table of Contents
   

shipping and handling expenses; and

 

   

lease expenses associated with our production facilities.

 

   

Selling, general and administrative expenses.     Our selling, general and administrative, or SG&A, expenses include costs associated with our sales efforts; engineering; centralized finance, human resources, purchasing, and information technology services; and other administrative functions. For information regarding charges against earnings that we will recognize in connection with certain compensation programs, see footnote 2 in “Prospectus Summary—Summary Consolidated Financial Data.”

 

   

Amortization expense.     Our amortization expense consists of the charges we incur to amortize certain intangible assets. The intangible assets relate to key customer relationships in Europe and Brazil and land rights in China. Our intangible assets are amortized over their estimated useful lives as determined when the intangible asset is initially recorded. See note 4 to our consolidated financial statements.

 

   

Restructuring and related asset impairment charges.     Our restructuring expenses are incurred when we establish reserves for particular restructuring actions and when we incur costs that are expensed as incurred related to particular restructuring actions. We have implemented several restructuring plans in recent years in order to realign our manufacturing capacity to meet global automotive production demands and to improve the utilization of our facilities.

 

   

Interest expense.     Our interest expense relates to costs associated with our debt instruments and reflects both the amount of our indebtedness and the rates we are required to pay. Our primary debt instruments consist of our notes and our asset-based revolving credit facility. We also have debt at our foreign subsidiaries, consisting of borrowings in South Korea and Brazil and a factoring facility in Italy. Our interest expense is also affected by the amortization of our debt issuance costs.

 

   

Provision for income taxes .    We make estimates of the amounts to recognize for income taxes in each tax jurisdiction in which we operate. In addition, provisions are established for withholding taxes related to the transfer of cash between jurisdictions and for uncertain tax positions taken. As a result of Cerberus’ cancellation of $25 million aggregate principal amount of our first lien term loan in connection with the notes offering, we may experience cancellation of indebtedness income of up to $25 million. At December 31, 2009, we had approximately $148.5 million in net operating losses which we may use to offset any income tax payable as a result of any such cancellation of indebtedness income.

 

   

Efficiencies .    Our ability to control our costs is directly linked to our ability to offset price reductions and other cost increases with reductions in operating costs through the implementation of various manufacturing, purchasing, administrative and other efficiencies. We seek to drive costs out of our operations through several ongoing initiatives, including the following:

 

   

Manufacturing efficiencies .    We have achieved cost savings in our core manufacturing operations through several ongoing initiatives, including:

 

   

Implementation of Lean Six Sigma principles.     Lean and Six Sigma are industry-recognized methodologies which our management utilizes to reduce waste, improve quality and improve our ability to respond to customer demand rates by focusing on reductions in manufacturing lead times.

 

   

Labor best practices standardization.     We studied how other companies utilize their production related labor. As a result of that study, we developed benchmark labor standards for our production processes. We then applied those standards and processes consistently across our manufacturing facilities.

 

   

Real-time production reporting and throughput analysis.     Many of our manufacturing facilities are equipped with production count systems that interface directly with our general ledger system. These reports enable us to reduce the costs we incur to manufacture our products. Real-time production reporting allows us to:

 

   

perform bottleneck management analysis, which allows us to analyze production bottlenecks and improve efficiency and cycle times;

 

56


Table of Contents
  Ÿ  

complete shift-to-shift assessments, which help us to reduce the number of employees needed to meet production during any given shift; and

 

  Ÿ  

perform press changeover time analysis, which helps us to reduce the time in which equipment is not in production.

 

   

Purchasing efficiencies.     We actively negotiate with our supply base to achieve year-over-year price reductions in the components and supplies that we purchase.

 

   

SG&A reductions.     We have reduced the amount of our SG&A expense necessary to operate our business. We have centralized and continue to centralize several administrative functions which we previously performed on a decentralized basis, including purchasing, customer quoting and product costing, product engineering and accounting. In addition, we have instituted policies and procedures on discretionary spending to reduce our costs.

Adjusted EBITDA

We use the term Adjusted EBITDA throughout this prospectus. We define Adjusted EBITDA as net income/(loss) before interest, taxes, depreciation, amortization, restructuring items and other adjustments described in the reconciliations provided in this prospectus. Adjusted EBITDA is not a measure of performance defined in accordance with GAAP. We use Adjusted EBITDA as a supplement to our GAAP results in evaluating our business.

Adjusted EBITDA is included in this prospectus because it is one of the principal factors upon which our management assesses performance. Our Chief Executive Officer measures the performance of our segments on the basis of Adjusted EBITDA. As an analytical tool, Adjusted EBITDA assists us in comparing our performance over various reporting periods on a consistent basis because it excludes items that we do not believe reflect our core operating performance.

We believe that Adjusted EBITDA is useful to investors in evaluating our performance because EBITDA is a commonly used financial metric for measuring and comparing the operating performance of companies in our industry. We believe that the disclosure of Adjusted EBITDA offers an additional financial metric that, when coupled with the GAAP results and the reconciliation to GAAP results, provides a more complete understanding of our results of operations and the factors and trends affecting our business.

Adjusted EBITDA should not be considered as an alternative to net income/(loss) as an indicator of our performance, as an alternative to net cash provided by operating activities as a measure of liquidity, or as an alternative to any other measure prescribed by GAAP. There are limitations to using non-GAAP measures such as Adjusted EBITDA. Although we believe that Adjusted EBITDA may make an evaluation of our operating performance more consistent because it removes items that do not reflect our core operations, (i) other companies in our industry may define Adjusted EBITDA differently than we do and, as a result, it may not be comparable to similarly titled measures used by other companies in our industry; and (ii) Adjusted EBITDA excludes certain financial information that some may consider important in evaluating our performance.

We compensate for these limitations by providing disclosure of the differences between Adjusted EBITDA and GAAP results, including providing a reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to GAAP results, to enable investors to perform their own analysis of our operating results. For a reconciliation of consolidated Adjusted EBITDA to its most directly comparable GAAP measure, net income (loss), see footnote 10 in “Prospectus Summary—Summary Consolidated Financial Data.”

Because of these limitations, Adjusted EBITDA should not be considered as a measure of the income generated by our business or discretionary cash available to us to invest in the growth of our business. Our management compensates for these limitations by analyzing both our GAAP results and Adjusted EBITDA. See our consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 

57


Table of Contents

Bases of Presentation

2007 Acquisition

On July 31, 2007, we acquired substantially all of the assets, including the name, of Tower Automotive, Inc. and 25 of its United States subsidiaries in exchange for a purchase price of $779.3 million, which amount is net of cash acquired of $82.1 million and includes direct acquisition costs of $27 million. We also acquired the stock of substantially all of the sellers’ foreign affiliates. In addition to the purchase price that we paid for these assets, we assumed foreign debt and debt-like instruments of $235.7 million, resulting in aggregate consideration of approximately $1 billion.

Previously, in February 2005, Tower Automotive, Inc. and its United States subsidiaries, which we refer to collectively as the debtors, filed a voluntary petition for relief under the United States bankruptcy laws. From February 2005 until our acquisition on July 31, 2007, the debtors operated their business in the normal course as debtors-in-possession. The assets of the debtors that we did not acquire were transferred into a liquidation trust. Pursuant to the plan of reorganization confirmed by the United States Bankruptcy Court, the only liabilities of the United States debtors that we assumed were certain current liabilities and pension and other post-retirement benefit obligations. Concurrent with the closing of the 2007 acquisition, the debtors ceased all operations.

The acquisition was accounted for as a purchase in accordance with FASB ASC No. 805. As a result, we allocated the purchase price to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the date of acquisition, based on their estimated fair values as of the closing date, in accordance with FASB ASC No. 805. The excess of the cost of the acquisition over the net amounts assigned to the fair value of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed was recorded as goodwill. As a result of the application of FASB ASC No. 805, the financial statements and financial data presented in this prospectus for dates and for periods ending on or before July 31, 2007 are not comparable with the financial statements and financial data presented in this prospectus for periods after July 31, 2007. We refer to our acquisition of the assets of the debtors and the acquisition of substantially all of the stock of the debtors’ foreign affiliates as the 2007 acquisition.

The accounting pronouncements applicable to the Predecessor while it was undergoing reorganization do not change the application of GAAP in the preparation of the Predecessor’s financial statements. However, those pronouncements do require that the financial statements, for periods including and subsequent to the filing of the bankruptcy petition, distinguish transactions and events that are directly associated with the reorganization from the ongoing operations of the Predecessor.

The debtors incurred certain professional and other expenses directly associated with their bankruptcy proceedings. In addition, the debtors made certain provisions to adjust the carrying value of certain pre-petition liabilities to reflect the debtors’ estimate of allowed claims. We have classified these costs and expenses as Chapter 11 and related reorganization items in our consolidated statements of operations for the seven months ended July 31, 2007.

2010 Corporate Conversion

We have been organized as a limited liability company since the 2007 acquisition. Prior to the consummation of this offering, (i) all of our existing equity owners will transfer their equity interests in Tower Automotive, LLC to a newly created limited liability company, Tower International Holdings, LLC, (ii) Tower Automotive, LLC will convert into a Delaware corporation, which will be named Tower International, Inc., and (iii) all of the equity interests in Tower Automotive, LLC will be converted into common stock of Tower International, Inc. Thus, immediately prior to the consummation of this offering, all of our outstanding common stock will be owned by Tower International Holdings, LLC. We refer to this transaction as the Corporate Conversion.

Our Segments

Our management reviews our operating results and makes decisions based upon two reportable segments: the Americas and International, each of which has its own president and leadership team. For accounting

 

58


Table of Contents

purposes, we have identified four operating segments, which we have aggregated into two reportable segments. See Note 16 to our consolidated financial statements. Through June 30, 2010, our businesses have had similar economic characteristics, including the nature of our products, our production processes and our customers.

Results of Operations—Six Months Ended June 30, 2010 Compared with the Six Months Ended June 30, 2009

Automobile production volumes increased during the six months ended June 30, 2010 in all major markets compared to the six months ended June 30, 2009. The following table presents production volumes in specified regions according to CSM Worldwide ® for the six months ended June 30, 2010 compared to the six months ended June 30, 2009 (in millions of units produced):

 

     Europe     Korea     China     North America     Brazil  

Six Months Ended June 30, 2010

   9.5      2.1      7.0      6.0      1.5   

Six Months Ended June 30, 2009

   7.7      1.5      4.8      3.5      1.4   
                              

Increase/(decrease)

   1.8      0.6      2.2      2.5      0.1   
                              

Percentage change

   24   38   48   72   13 %

According to CSM Worldwide ® , vehicle production for the full year of 2010 is expected to increase over 2009, but not to the same extent as the increase for the first six months of 2010 over the first six months of 2009. According to CSM Worldwide ® , full year vehicle production is expected to increase by 36% in North America and 8% in Europe during 2010 as compared to 2009.

The following table presents selected financial information for the six months ended June 30, 2010 and 2009 (in millions):

     International    Americas     Consolidated  
     Six Months Ended
June 30,
   Six Months Ended
June 30,
    Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
     2010    2009    2010    2009     2010     2009  

Revenues

   $ 558.6    $ 438.2    $ 422.2    $ 259.7      $ 980.8      $ 697.9   

Cost of sales

     489.2      397.8      382.8      284.1        872.0        681.9   
                                             

Gross profit

     69.4      40.4      39.4      (24.4     108.8        16.0   

Selling, general and administrative

               

expenses

     30.5      28.0      34.5      25.3        65.0        53.3   

Amortization

     1.1      1.0      0.4      0.3        1.5        1.3   

Restructuring

     2.9      2.0      1.8      (3.1     4.7        (1.1
                                             

Operating income/(loss)

   $ 34.9    $ 9.4    $ 2.7    $ (46.9     37.6        (37.5
                                 

Interest expense, net

                27.3        27.2   

Other (income)/loss, net

                —          (32.4

Provision/(benefit) for income taxes

                8.4        2.8   

Noncontrolling interest, net of tax

                4.5        3.9   
                           

Net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC

              $ (2.6   $ (39.0
                           

Comparison of Periods—GAAP Analysis of Consolidated Results

Revenues

Total revenues increased during the six months ended June 30, 2010 by $282.9 million or 41% from the six months ended June 30, 2009, reflecting primarily higher volume in both our Americas segment ($155.4 million) and our International segment ($151 million). Revenues were also positively impacted by the strengthening of

 

59


Table of Contents

foreign currencies against the U.S. dollar , both in our Americas segment, primarily the Brazilian Real ($16.2 million), and in our International segment, primarily the Korean Won ($13.8 million), offset partially by the strengthening of the U.S. dollar against the Euro in our International segment ($10 million). Revenues were negatively impacted by unfavorable pricing and economics ($ 41.7 million), primarily related to lower steel recoveries and prices.

Gross Profit

When we analyze our total gross profit, we separately categorize external factors—volume, product mix and foreign exchange—and all other factors which impact gross profit, which we refer to as “other factors”. When we refer to “mix,” we are referring to the relative composition of revenues and profitability of the products we sell in any given period. When we refer to “pricing and economics”, we are referring to (i) the impact of adjustments in the pricing of particular products, which we refer to as product pricing; (ii) the impact of steel price changes, taking into account the component of our product pricing attributable to steel, the cost of steel included in our cost of sales and the amounts recovered on the sale of offal, which in total we refer to as the net steel impact; and (iii) the impact of inflation and changes in operating costs such as labor, utilities and fuel, which we refer to as economics.

Total gross profit increased by $92.8 million or 580% from the six months ended June 30, 2009 to the six months ended June 30, 2010, and our gross profit margin increased from 2.3% during the 2009 period to 11.1% in the 2010 period, as partially explained by higher volume ($72.8 million), favorable product mix ($4.3 million), and favorable foreign exchange ($0.9 million). All other factors were net favorable by $14.7 million. Cost of sales was reduced by manufacturing, purchasing and other efficiencies ($24.5 million) and savings from restructuring actions undertaken in 2008 and 2009 ($3.1 million). Total gross profit was also positively impacted by a reduction in the depreciation included in cost of sales from $76.4 million during the six months ended June 30, 2009 to $55.1 million during the six months ended June 30, 2010. The reduction reflected primarily a portion of our fixed assets becoming fully depreciated in July 2009 as a result of having been assigned estimated lives of two years at the time of our acquisition in 2007 and accelerated depreciation in 2009 related to certain restructuring actions taken in the Americas segment. These factors more than offset unfavorable pricing and economics ($20.8 million), the non-recurrence of customer cost recoveries ($9.5 million), and higher launch costs ($4.1 million).

Selling, General and Administrative Expenses (“SG&A”)

Total SG&A increased $11.7 million or 22% from the six months ended June 30, 2009, reflecting higher bonus and salary costs and increased personnel costs, primarily for engineers ($8.1 million), the strengthening of foreign currencies against the U.S. dollar , primarily the Korean Won and Brazilian Real ($2.1 million), and acquisition costs related to the acquisition of a manufacturing plant in Artern, Germany during the first quarter of 2010 ($0.7 million). In addition, SG&A for the six months ended June 30, 2010 includes a charge for compensation costs related to the Special Incentive Program ($0.5 million) described under “Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Components of Compensation—Special Incentive Compensation.”

Amortization Expense

Total amortization expense increased $0.2 million from the six months ended June 30, 2009 reflecting primarily the amortization of an intangible asset recorded in Artern at the end of the first quarter of 2010 and the strengthening of foreign currencies against the U.S. dollar. Our amortization expense consists of the charges we incur to amortize certain intangible assets.

Restructuring Expense

Total restructuring expense increased $5.8 million from the six months ended June 30, 2009 related primarily to an impairment charge taken on our press shop in Bergisch Gladbach, Germany as we put it up for sale and the non-recurrence of restructuring income which offset the charges incurred during 2009 in our Americas segment.

 

60


Table of Contents

Interest Expense, net 

Interest expense, net, remained consistent between the six month periods as borrowings were similar in both of the periods. An increase in borrowings in Europe, South Korea, and Brazil were offset by a decrease in borrowings in North America.

Provision/(Benefit) for Income Taxes

Income tax expense increased $5.6 million from the six months ended June 30, 2009. The change in income tax expense varies each period depending on the level and mix of income and losses generated in the various jurisdictions. Our income tax expense is disproportionately higher than our statutory rate primarily due to valuation allowances recorded against tax benefits on losses incurred in certain countries, including the U.S. The increased operating income in the Americas segment (primarily in the U.S.) is offset by net operating losses that are subject to valuation allowances which, when reduced, do not benefit the current tax provision. We have recorded the valuation allowances due to the uncertainty of the future realization of the tax benefits associated with the losses.

Noncontrolling Interest, Net of Tax

The adjustment to our earnings required to give effect to the elimination of noncontrolling interests increased by $0.6 million from the six months ended June 30, 2009 reflecting increased earnings in our Chinese joint ventures.

Comparison of Periods—Non-GAAP Analysis of Adjusted EBITDA

A reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC for the six month periods presented is set forth below (in millions):

 

     International     Americas     Consolidated  
     Six Months
Ended June 30,
    Six Months
Ended June 30,
    Six Months
Ended June 30,
 
     2010     2009     2010     2009     2010     2009  

Adjusted EBITDA

   $ 65.5      $ 46.0      $ 36.9      $ (5.0   $ 102.4      $ 41.0   

Intercompany charges

     3.5        3.2        (3.5     (3.2     —          —     

Restructuring

     (2.9     (2.0     (1.8     3.1        (4.7     1.1   

Depreciation and amortization

     (30.4     (37.6     (28.3     (41.8     (58.7     (79.4

Receivable factoring charges and other

     (0.1     (0.2     (0.1     —          (0.2     (0.2

Acquisition costs

     (0.7     —          —          —          (0.7     —     

Compensation pursuant to the special incentive program

     —          —          (0.5     —          (0.5     —     
                                                

Operating income

   $ 34.9      $ 9.4      $ 2.7      $ (46.9     37.6        (37.5
                                    

Interest expense, net

             (27.3     (27.2

Other Income

             —          32.4   

(Provision)/benefit for income taxes

             (8.4     (2.8

Noncontrolling interest, net of tax

             (4.5     (3.9
                        

Net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC

           $ (2.6   $ (39.0
                        

See footnote 10 in “Prospectus Summary”—Summary Consolidated Financial Data.”

 

61


Table of Contents

The following table presents revenues (a GAAP measure) and Adjusted EBITDA (a non-GAAP measure) for the six months ended June 30, 2010 and 2009 (in millions) as well as an explanation of variances:

 

    International     Americas     Consolidated  
    Revenues     Adjusted
EBITDA(a)
    Revenues     Adjusted
EBITDA(a)
    Revenues     Adjusted
EBITDA(a)
 

Six Months Ended June 30, 2010 results

  $ 558.6      $ 65.5      $ 422.2      $ 36.9      $ 980.8      $ 102.4   

Six Months Ended June 30, 2009 results

    438.2        46.0        259.7        (5.0     697.9        41.0   
                                               

Variance

  $ 120.4      $ 19.5      $ 162.5      $ 41.9      $ 282.9      $ 61.4   
                                               

Variance attributable to:

           

Volume and mix

  $ 151.0      $ 30.7      $ 155.4      $ 46.4      $ 306.4      $ 77.1   

Foreign exchange

    3.8        (1.7     16.2        0.5        20.0        (1.2

Pricing and economics

    (35.0     (18.1     (6.7     (10.7     (41.7     (28.8

Manufacturing and purchasing efficiencies

    —         11.4        —         18.9        —         30.3   

Selling, general and administrative expenses and other items(b)

    0.6        (2.8     (2.4     (13.2     (1.8     (16.0
                                               

Total

  $ 120.4      $ 19.5      $ 162.5      $ 41.9      $ 282.9      $ 61.4   
                                               

 

(a) We have presented a reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC above.
(b) When we refer to “selling, general and administrative expenses and other items”, the “other items” refer to (i) savings which we generate after implementing restructuring actions, (ii) the costs associated with launching new products, (iii) one-time items and (iv) other efficiencies.

Adjusted EBITDA

When we analyze Adjusted EBITDA, we separately categorize external factors—volume, product mix and foreign exchange—and all other factors which impact Adjusted EBITDA, which we refer to as “other factors.”

Total Company: Total Adjusted EBITDA improved by $61.4 million or 150% from the six months ended June 30, 2009, as explained by higher volume ($72.8 million) and favorable product mix ($4.3 million) offset partially by unfavorable foreign exchange ($1.2 million). All other factors were net unfavorable by $14.5 million; manufacturing and purchasing efficiencies ($30.3 million) were more than offset by unfavorable pricing and economics ($28.8 million) and unfavorable SG&A expenses and other items ($16 million).

International Segment: In our International segment, Adjusted EBITDA improved by $19.5 million or 42% from the six months ended June 30, 2009, reflecting higher volumes ($34.5 million) offset partially by unfavorable product mix ($3.8 million) and unfavorable foreign exchange ($1.7 million). All other factors were net unfavorable by $9.5 million. Unfavorable pricing and economics ($18.1 million), principally product pricing and labor costs, were offset partially by manufacturing and purchasing efficiencies ($11.4 million). In addition, SG&A and other items contributed unfavorably during the six months ended June 30, 2010 ($2.8 million), resulting from the non-recurrence of customer cost recoveries ($2.7 million) and higher launch costs ($1.6 million), offset partially by savings from restructuring actions undertaken in 2008 and 2009 ($1.4 million).

Americas Segment: In our Americas segment, Adjusted EBITDA improved by $41.9 million from the six months ended June 30, 2009, reflecting primarily higher volumes ($38.3 million) and favorable product mix ($8.1 million). Foreign exchange had a negligible impact. All other factors were net unfavorable by $5 million. Unfavorable pricing and economics ($10.7 million), principally product pricing and labor costs including higher bonus and salary costs, and higher SG&A expenses and other items ($13.2 million) were offset partially by manufacturing and purchasing efficiencies ($18.9 million). The adverse impact from SG&A spending and other items resulted from the non-recurrence of customer cost recoveries ($6.8 million), higher launch costs ($2.5 million) and increased personnel costs, primarily for engineers ($2.5 million), offset partially by savings from restructuring actions undertaken in 2008 and 2009 ($1.7 million).

 

62


Table of Contents

Results of Operations—Year Ended December 31, 2009 Compared with the Year Ended December 31, 2008

Due to the downturn in the global economy, automobile production volumes decreased significantly during 2009 in all major markets except China and Brazil. The following table presents production volumes in specified regions according to CSM Worldwide ® for 2009 compared to 2008 (in millions of units produced).

 

     Europe     Korea     China     North America     Brazil  

2009 production

   16.3      3.4      11.1      8.6      2.9   

2008 production

   20.5      3.7      7.3      12.6      2.9   
                              

Increase/(decrease)

   (4.2   (0.3   3.8      (4.0   0.0   
                              

Percentage change

   (20 )%    (8 )%    52   (32 )%    2

The following table presents selected financial information for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008 (in millions). In the discussion that follows, all references to “2009” are to the year ended December 31, 2009 and all references to “2008” are to the year ended December 31, 2008.

 

     International    Americas     Consolidated  
     2009    2008    2009     2008     2009     2008  

Revenues

   $ 990.5    $ 1,251.4    $ 643.9      $ 920.3      $ 1,634.4      $ 2,171.7   

Cost of sales

     889.9      1,104.5      646.9        886.8        1,536.8        1,991.3   
                                              

Gross profit

     100.6      146.9      (3.0     33.5        97.6        180.4   

Selling, general and administrative expenses

     57.7      63.3      60.6        75.3        118.3        138.6   

Amortization

     2.0      2.2      0.8        0.8        2.8        3.0   

Restructuring

     12.6      1.4      0.8        3.4        13.4        4.8   
                                              

Operating income/(loss)

   $ 28.3    $ 80.0    $ (65.2   $ (46.0     (36.9     34.0   
                                  

Interest expense, net

               56.9        60.2   

Other (income)/loss, net

               (33.7     —     

Provision/(benefit) for income taxes

               (1.1     19.5   

Noncontrolling interest, net of tax

               8.9        6.6   
                          

Net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC

             $ (67.9   $ (52.3
                          

Comparison of Periods—GAAP Analysis of Consolidated Results

Revenues

Total revenues declined in 2009 by $537.3 million or 25% from 2008, reflecting primarily lower volume in both our Americas segment ($262 million) and our International segment ($167.1 million) and the effect of the strengthened U.S. dollar against foreign currencies in our International segment, primarily the Euro and Korean Won ($96.6 million), and against foreign currencies in our Americas segment, primarily the Brazilian Real ($19.8 million).

Gross Profit

Total gross profit declined in 2009 by $82.8 million or 46% from 2008 and gross profit margin decreased from 8.3% in 2008 to 6% in 2009, as explained by lower volume ($103.2 million), unfavorable product mix ($43.8 million), and unfavorable foreign exchange primarily in the International segment ($17.3 million, excluding the impact on depreciation). All other factors were net favorable by $81.5 million—cost of sales was reduced primarily by manufacturing, purchasing and other efficiencies ($90 million) that more than offset unfavorable pricing and economics ($35.5 million). The unfavorable pricing and economics was attributable principally to product pricing and net steel impact ($46.7 million), offset partially by reductions in our workers’

 

63


Table of Contents

compensation and healthcare costs ($11.2 million) associated with reductions in our workforce and improvements in our plant safety record in the Americas segment. Gross profit was positively impacted by the achievement of savings in 2009 from restructuring actions undertaken in 2008 and 2009 ($10.2 million) and was negatively impacted by a one-time provision associated with a value-added tax audit in Brazil ($4.7 million).

Total gross profit was also positively impacted by a reduction in the depreciation included in cost of goods sold from $164.1 million in 2008 to $141.1 million in 2009. The reduction reflected primarily a portion of our fixed assets becoming fully depreciated in July 2009 as a result of having been assigned estimated lives of two years at the time of our acquisition in 2007, as well as the strengthening of the U.S. dollar against foreign currencies, primarily in the International segment, offset partially by accelerated depreciation in 2009 related to certain restructuring actions taken in the Americas segment.

Selling, General and Administrative Expenses

Total SG&A decreased $20.3 million or 15% from 2008, reflecting a reduction in personnel and related expenses associated with the decline in production and a reduction in other spending undertaken to control costs ($17.1 million) primarily in the Americas segment and the strengthening of the U.S. dollar against foreign currencies resulting in less SG&A costs ($4.8 million, excluding the impact of depreciation) primarily in the International segment.

Amortization Expense

Total amortization expense decreased by $0.2 million due to the strengthening of the U.S. dollar against foreign currencies.

Restructuring Expense

Total restructuring increased by $8.6 million or 179% from 2008 due to higher restructuring charges incurred in 2009, related primarily to the closure of our press shop in Bergisch Gladbach, Germany.

Interest Expense, net

Interest expense, net, decreased in 2009 by $3.3 million or 5.5% as compared to 2008, related primarily to declining debt balances in the Americas segment due to a debt repurchase in the second quarter and declining rates on the portion of our first lien term loan not covered by an interest rate swap.

Other Income

During 2009, we amended certain terms of our revolving credit facility, first lien term loan agreement and synthetic letter of credit facility. As part of the amendments, we reduced our $200 million revolving credit facility to $150 million, reduced our synthetic letter of credit facility from $60 million to $27.5 million and repurchased $32.9 million of the U.S. tranche of our first lien term loan. In connection with these transactions, we recognized gains of $33.7 million which we recognized as other income.

Provision (Benefit) for Income Taxes

Income tax expense declined $20.6 million or 106% in 2009 from 2008 reflecting primarily the substantial decrease in overall income, a tax benefit from gain recognition in other comprehensive income and a shift in the mix of income among jurisdictions.

Noncontrolling Interest, Net of Tax

The adjustment to our earnings required to give effect to the elimination of minority interests increased by $2.3 million in 2009 from 2008 reflecting increased earnings in our Chinese joint ventures.

 

64


Table of Contents

Comparison of Periods—Non-GAAP Analysis of Adjusted EBITDA

A reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC for the periods presented is set forth below (in millions):

 

     International     Americas     Consolidated  
     2009     2008     2009     2008     2009     2008  

Adjusted EBITDA

   $ 108.7      $ 163.9      $ 16.3      $ 49.0      $ 125.0      $ 212.9   

Intercompany charges

     8.0        3.0        (8.0     (3.0     —          —     

Restructuring

     (12.6     (1.4     (0.8     (3.4     (13.4     (4.8

Depreciation and amortization

     (75.1     (82.4     (72.6     (87.9     (147.7     (170.3

Receivable factoring charges

     (0.7     —          (0.1     (0.7     (0.8     (0.7

Other adjustments

     —          (3.1     —          —          —          (3.1
                                                

Operating income/(loss)

   $ 28.3      $ 80.0      $ (65.2   $ (46.0     (36.9     34.0   
                                    

Interest expense, net

             (56.9     (60.2

Other income

             33.7        —     

(Provision)/benefit for income taxes

             1.1        (19.5

Noncontrolling interest, net of tax

             (8.9     (6.6
                        

Net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC

           $ (67.9   $ (52.3
                        

See footnote 10 in “Prospectus Summary—Summary Consolidated Financial Data.”

The following table presents revenues (a GAAP measure) and Adjusted EBITDA (a non-GAAP measure) for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008 (in millions) as well as an explanation of variances:

 

     International     Americas     Consolidated  
     Revenues     Adjusted
EBITDA(a)
    Revenues     Adjusted
EBITDA(a)
    Revenues     Adjusted
EBITDA(a)
 

2009 results

   $ 990.5      $ 108.7      $ 643.9      $ 16.3      $ 1,634.4      $ 125.0   

2008 results

     1,251.4        163.9        920.3        49.0        2,171.7        212.9   
                                                

Variance

   $ (260.9   $ (55.2   $ (276.4   $ (32.7   $ (537.3   $ (87.9
                                                

Variance attributable to:

            

Volume and mix

   $ (167.1   $ (60.4   $ (262.0   $ (86.6   $ (429.1   $ (147.0

Foreign exchange

     (96.6     (12.3     (19.8     (0.2     (116.4     (12.5

Pricing and economics

     3.3        (23.8     4.3        (10.6     7.6        (34.4

Manufacturing and purchasing efficiencies

     —          39.7        —          48.6        —          88.3   

Selling, general and administrative expenses and other items

     (0.5     1.6        1.1        16.1        0.6        17.7   
                                                

Total

   $ (260.9   $ (55.2   $ (276.4   $ (32.7   $ (537.3   $ (87.9
                                                

 

(a) We have presented a reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC above.

Adjusted EBITDA

Total Company: Total Adjusted EBITDA declined in 2009 by $87.9 million or 41% from 2008, as explained by lower volume ($103.2 million), unfavorable product mix ($43.8 million) and unfavorable foreign exchange ($12.5 million). All other factors were net favorable by $71.6 million; manufacturing and purchasing efficiencies ($88.3 million) and a decrease in SG&A and other items ($17.7 million) more than offset unfavorable pricing and economics ($34.4 million).

 

65


Table of Contents

The favorable impact of manufacturing and purchasing efficiencies more than offset general cost increases. We were able to achieve this gain in 2009 because of the continued implementation of our competitive cost structure initiatives. Our focus in 2010 and beyond is to retain the benefit of these achieved cost savings as anticipated volume recovery occurs. Our objective is to continue to achieve operating efficiencies large enough to at least offset general cost increases.

International Segment: In our International segment, Adjusted EBITDA declined by $55.2 million or 34% from 2008, reflecting lower volumes ($37.4 million), unfavorable product mix ($23 million) and unfavorable foreign exchange ($12.3 million). All other factors were net favorable by $17.5 million; unfavorable pricing and economics ($23.8 million), principally product pricing and labor costs, were more than offset by operational efficiencies ($39.7 million). In addition, SG&A and other items contributed favorably in 2009, primarily because restructuring savings were achieved in 2009 from restructuring actions undertaken in 2008 and 2009 ($5.2 million), offset partially by higher launch costs in Europe.

Americas Segment: In our Americas segment, Adjusted EBITDA declined by $32.7 million or 67% from 2008, reflecting primarily lower volumes ($65.8 million) and unfavorable product mix ($20.8 million). Foreign exchange had a negligible impact. All other factors were net favorable by $54.1 million, due principally to operational efficiencies ($48.6 million) and reduced SG&A expenses and other items ($16.1 million). The positive impact from SG&A spending and other items resulted from a reduction in personnel and related expenses and a reduction in other spending undertaken to control costs ($17.1 million) and savings from restructuring actions undertaken in 2008 and 2009 ($5 million). These other factors were offset partially by unfavorable pricing and economics ($10.6 million) and a one-time provision associated with a value added tax audit in Brazil ($4.7 million). The unfavorable pricing and economics reflects principally unfavorable product pricing and net steel impact ($21.8 million), offset partially by reductions in our workers’ compensation and healthcare costs ($11.2 million) associated with reductions in our workforce and improvements in our plant safety record. Our net steel impact was adversely impacted by lower offal recoveries in 2009.

Results of Operations—Year Ended December 31, 2008 Compared with the Year Ended December 31, 2007

As a result of our acquiring our business from the debtors on July 31, 2007, our financial results for 2007 have been separately presented in our consolidated financial statements for the Predecessor for the period January 1, 2007 through July 31, 2007 and for the Successor for the period August 1, 2007 through December 31, 2007. We have presented below two separate analyses, one comparing our results for the five month periods ended December 31, 2008 and 2007 and one comparing our results for the seven month periods ended July 31, 2008 and 2007.

Five Months Ended December 31, 2008 Compared to the Five Months Ended December 31, 2007

Automotive production volumes decreased significantly during the last five months of 2008 in all major markets due to the downturn in the global economy. The following table presents production volumes in specified regions according to CSM Worldwide ® for the five months ended December 31, 2008 compared to the five months ended December 31, 2007 (in millions of units produced):

 

     Europe     Korea     China     North
America
    Brazil  

Five months ended December 31, 2008

   6.9      1.5      2.8      4.8      1.1   

Five months ended December 31, 2007

   8.7      1.7      3.0      6.3      1.2   
                              

Increase / (decrease)

   (1.8   (0.2   (0.2   (1.5   (0.1
                              

Percentage change

   (21 )%    (14 )%    (8 )%    (23 )%    (10 )% 

 

66


Table of Contents

The following table presents selected financial information for the five months ended December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2007 (in millions):

 

     International    Americas     Consolidated  
     Five Months
Ended

December 31,
   Five Months
Ended

December 31,
    Five Months
Ended
December 31,
 
     2008    2007    2008     2007     2008     2007  

Revenues

   $ 433.1    $ 577.1    $ 281.8      $ 509.0      $ 714.9      $ 1,086.1   

Cost of sales

     381.5      506.7      286.0        463.8        667.5        970.5   
                                              

Gross profit

     51.6      70.4      (4.2     45.2        47.4        115.6   

Selling, general and administrative expenses

     33.7      27.2      20.5        29.8        54.2        57.0   

Amortization

     0.8      0.9      0.3        0.4        1.1        1.3   

Restructuring

     1.3      2.4      7.2        (0.6     8.5        1.8   
                                              

Operating income/(loss)

   $ 15.8    $ 39.9    $ (32.2   $ 15.6        (16.4     55.5   
                                  

Interest expense, net

  

    24.0        34.0   

Provision for income taxes

  

    6.7        10.4   

Equity in joint venture

  

    —          (7.1

Noncontrolling interest, net of tax

  

    2.5        3.0   
                          

Net income/(loss) attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC

  

  $ (49.6   $ 15.2   
                          

Comparison of Periods—GAAP Analysis of Consolidated Results

Revenues

Total revenues declined during the five months ended December 31, 2008 by $371.2 million or 34% from the five months ended December 31, 2007, reflecting primarily lower volume in both our Americas segment ($236.4 million) and our International segment ($118 million) and the effect of the strengthening of the U.S. dollar against foreign currencies in our International segment, primarily the Euro and Korean Won ($38.6 million), and against foreign currencies in our Americas segment, primarily the Brazilian Real ($3.9 million), offset partially by favorable pricing and economics ($24 million), primarily related to higher steel prices that were passed on to our customers.

Gross Profit

Total gross profit declined during the five months ended December 31, 2008 by $68.2 million or 59% from the five months ended December 31, 2007 and gross profit margin decreased from 10.6% for the five months ended December 31, 2007 to 6.6% for the five months ended December 31, 2008, reflecting primarily lower volume ($85.6 million), unfavorable product mix ($11.2 million) and unfavorable foreign exchange ($5.4 million, excluding the impact on depreciation). All other factors were net favorable by $34 million—cost of sales was reduced primarily by manufacturing, purchasing and other efficiencies ($59.6 million) and the favorable impact of the buyout of an operating lease ($8 million) in 2008 in our International segment, offset partially by unfavorable pricing and economics ($34.7 million). In addition, a one-time inventory charge was recorded in 2007 in our Americas segment ($4.2 million).

Total gross profit was also adversely impacted by an increase in the depreciation included in cost of goods sold from $59.8 million during the five months ended December 31, 2007 compared to $61.8 million during the five months ended December 31, 2008. The increase reflected primarily the buyout of an operating lease in 2008 in our International segment as mentioned above.

Selling, General and Administrative Expenses

Total SG&A decreased $2.8 million or 5% from the five months ended December 31, 2007, reflecting primarily a reduction in spending undertaken to control costs.

 

67


Table of Contents

Restructuring Expense

Total restructuring increased $6.7 million from the five months ended December 31, 2007 to the five months ended December 31, 2008 due to the closure of our Traverse City facility in our Americas segment in September 2008.

Interest Expense, net

Interest expense, net, decreased during the five months ended December 31, 2008 by $10 million or 29% as compared to the five months ended December 31, 2007. Interest expense decreased primarily due to the repayment of our second lien term loan prior to the five months ended December 31, 2008.

Provision for Income Taxes

Provision for income taxes decreased $3.7 million or 36% during the five months ended December 31, 2008 from the five months ended December 31, 2007, reflecting primarily the decrease in pre-tax income and the mix of income in various foreign jurisdictions.

Equity in Earnings of Joint Ventures, Net of Tax

Equity in earnings of joint ventures decreased by $7.1 million during the five months ended December 31, 2008 from the five months ended December 31, 2007 due to our selling our 40% joint venture interest in Metalsa in December 2007.

Noncontrolling Interest, Net of Tax

The adjustment to our earnings required to give effect to the elimination of minority interests decreased by $0.5 million during the five months ended December 31, 2008 from the five months ended December 31, 2007, reflecting lower earnings at our Chinese joint ventures.

Comparison of Periods—Non-GAAP Analysis of Adjusted EBITDA

A reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to net income/(loss) attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC for the periods presented is set forth below (in millions):

 

     International     Americas     Consolidated  
     Five Months
Ended
December 31,
    Five Months
Ended
December 31,
    Five Months
Ended
December 31,
 
     2008     2007     2008     2007     2008     2007  

Adjusted EBITDA

   $ 56.8      $ 67.2      $ (0.3   $ 56.4      $ 56.5      $ 123.6   

Intercompany Charges

     (7.6     1.1        7.6        (1.1     —          —     

Restructuring

     (1.3     (2.4     (7.2     0.6        (8.5     (1.8

Depreciation & Amortization

     (32.0     (26.7     (32.3     (34.6     (64.3     (61.3

Receivable factoring charges

     —          —          —          (1.6     —          (1.6

Other adjustments

     (0.1     0.7        —          (4.1     (0.1     (3.4
                                                

Operating income (loss)

   $ 15.8      $ 39.9      $ (32.2   $ 15.6        (16.4     55.5   
                                    

Interest expense, net

  

    (24.0     (34.0

Provision for income taxes

  

    (6.7     (10.4

Equity in joint venture

  

    —          7.1   

Noncontrolling interest, net of tax

  

    (2.5     (3.0
                        

Net income/(loss) attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC

  

  $ (49.6   $ 15.2   
                        

See footnote 10 in “Prospectus Summary—Summary Consolidated Financial Data.”

 

68


Table of Contents

The following table presents revenues (a GAAP measure) and Adjusted EBITDA (a non-GAAP measure) for the five months ended December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2007 (in millions) as well as an explanation of variances:

 

     International     Americas     Consolidated  
     Revenues     Adjusted
EBITDA(a)
    Revenues     Adjusted
EBITDA(a)
    Revenues     Adjusted
EBITDA(a)
 

Five months ended December 31, 2008 results

   $ 433.1      $ 56.8      $ 281.8      $ (0.3   $ 714.9      $ 56.5   

Five months ended December 31, 2007 results

     577.1        67.2        509.0        56.4        1,086.1        123.6   
                                                

Variance

   $ (144.0   $ (10.4   $ (227.2   $ (56.7   $ (371.2   $ (67.1
                                                

Variance attributable to :

            

Volume and mix

   $ (118.0   $ (28.3   $ (236.4   $ (68.5   $ (354.4   $ (96.8

Foreign exchange

     (38.6     (3.7     (3.9     0.3        (42.5     (3.4

Pricing and economics.

     13.2        (7.2     10.8        (27.5     24.0        (34.7

Manufacturing and purchasing efficiencies

     —          21.8        —          40.4        —          62.2   

Selling, general and administrative expenses and other items

     (0.6     7.0        2.3        (1.4     1.7        5.6   
                                                

Total

   $ (144.0   $ (10.4   $ (227.2   $ (56.7   $ (371.2   $ (67.1
                                                

 

(a) We have presented a reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to net income/(loss) attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC above.

Adjusted EBITDA

Total Company: Total Adjusted EBITDA declined during the five months ended December 31, 2008 by $67.1 million or 54% from the five months ended December 31, 2007, reflecting primarily lower volume ($85.6 million), unfavorable product mix ($11.2 million) and unfavorable foreign exchange ($3.4 million). All other factors were net favorable by $33.1 million, reflecting favorable efficiencies ($62.2 million) and SG&A expenses and other items ($5.6 million), offset partially by pricing and economics ($34.7 million).

International Segment: In our International segment, Adjusted EBITDA declined during the five months ended December 31, 2008 by $10.4 million or 16% as compared to the five months ended December 31, 2007, reflecting primarily unfavorable volume ($26.2 million), unfavorable foreign exchange ($3.7 million) and unfavorable product mix ($2.1 million). All other factors were net favorable by $21.6 million, reflecting favorable efficiencies ($21.8 million) and the favorable impact of the buyout of an operating lease ($8 million) in 2008, offset partially by pricing and economics ($7.2 million).

Americas Segment: In our Americas segment, Adjusted EBITDA declined during the five months ended December 31, 2008 by $56.7 million or 101% as compared to the five months ended December 31, 2007, reflecting primarily lower volume ($59.4 million) and unfavorable product mix ($9.1 million). Foreign exchange had a negligible impact. All other factors were net favorable by $11.5 million, reflecting primarily favorable efficiencies ($40.4 million), offset partially by pricing and economics ($27.5 million).

 

69


Table of Contents

Seven Months Ended July 31, 2008 Compared to the Seven Months Ended July 31, 2007

Industry production volumes increased during the first seven months of 2008 in all major markets except North America and Korea. The following table presents production volumes in specified regions according to CSM Worldwide ® for the seven months ended July 31, 2008 compared to the seven months ended July 31, 2007 (in millions of units produced):

 

     Europe     Korea     China     North
America
    Brazil  

Seven months ended July 31, 2008

   13.6      2.3      4.6      7.8      1.8   

Seven months ended July 31, 2007

   13.0      2.3      3.9      8.8      1.5   
                              

Increase / (decrease)

   0.6      —        0.7      (1.0   0.3   
                              

Percentage change

   4   (1 )%    16   (11 )%    23

The following table presents selected financial information for the seven months ended July 31, 2008 and 2007 (in millions):

 

     International    Americas     Consolidated  
     Seven Months
Ended

July 31,
   Seven Months
Ended

July 31,
    Seven Months
Ended
July 31,
 
     2008    2007    2008     2007     2008     2007  

Revenues

   $ 818.1    $ 772.1    $ 638.7      $ 683.4      $ 1,456.8      $ 1,455.5   

Cost of sales

     722.8      687.1      601.0        638.8        1,323.8        1,325.9   
                                              

Gross profit

     95.3      85.0      37.7        44.6        133.0        129.6   

Selling, general and administrative expenses

     29.6      35.1      54.8        42.1        84.4        77.2   

Amortization

     1.4      —        0.5        —          1.9        —     

Restructuring

     0.1      0.9      (3.8     21.5        (3.7     22.4   
                                              

Operating income/(loss)

   $ 64.2    $ 49.0    $ (13.8   $ (19.0     50.4        30.0   
                                  

Interest expense, net

  

    36.2        65.5   

Chapter 11 and related reorganization items

  

    —          62.2   

Provision for income taxes

  

    12.8        15.0   

Equity in joint venture

  

    —          (12.4

Noncontrolling interest, net of tax

  

    4.1        5.4   

Loss from discontinued operations

  

    —          0.3   
                          

Net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC

  

  $ (2.7   $ (106.0
                          

Comparison of Periods—GAAP Analysis of Consolidated Results

Revenues

Total revenues increased during the seven months ended July 31, 2008 by $1.3 million as compared to the seven months ended July 31, 2007, despite lower volume in both our Americas segment ($75.8 million) and our International segment ($20.9 million), due principally to the effect of the weakening of the U.S. dollar against foreign currencies in our International segment, primarily the Euro and Korean Won ($75.7 million), and against foreign currencies in our Americas segment, primarily the Brazilian Real ($22.7 million).

Gross Profit

Total gross profit increased during the seven months ended July 31, 2008 by $3.4 million or 3% as compared to the seven months ended July 31, 2007 and gross profit margin increased from 8.9% in 2007 to 9.1% in 2008, despite lower volume ($21.6 million) and unfavorable product mix ($6.1 million), due in part to favorable foreign exchange ($17 million, excluding the impact on depreciation). All other factors were net

 

70


Table of Contents

favorable by $14.1 million—cost of sales was reduced primarily by manufacturing, purchasing and other efficiencies ($47.4 million) that were offset partially by unfavorable pricing and economics ($22.2 million), principally product pricing and labor costs. Gross profit was positively impacted by restructuring savings that were achieved during the seven months ended July 31, 2008 from restructuring actions in 2007 ($4.8 million).

Total gross profit was also adversely impacted by an increase in the depreciation included in cost of goods sold from $86.9 million during the seven months ended July 31, 2007 compared to $102.3 million during the seven months ended July 31, 2008. The increase reflected primarily the revaluation of the depreciable base as a result of the 2007 acquisition.

Selling, General and Administrative Expenses

Total SG&A increased $7.2 million or 9% from the seven months ended July 31, 2007, reflecting primarily an increase in personnel costs and other spending ($5.1 million) and the strengthening of foreign currencies against the U.S. dollar ($4.7 million excluding the impact of depreciation).

Amortization Expense

Total amortization expense increased by $1.9 million due to the establishment of certain intangible assets related to customer relationships.

Restructuring Expense

Total restructuring decreased $26.1 million or 117% from the seven months ended July 31, 2007 due to the closure of our Upper Sandusky, Kendallville, Granite City and Milan facilities in our Americas segment during 2007 as we attempted to better align our capacity with demand. During the seven months ended July 31, 2008, we had restructuring income resulting from the cancellation of an old customer program relating to our closed facility in Milwaukee, Wisconsin.

Interest Expense, net

Interest expense, net, decreased during the seven months ended July 31, 2008 by $29.3 million or 45% as compared to the seven months ended July 31, 2007. Interest expense decreased primarily due to a revised capital structure that was implemented on the acquisition date.

Chapter 11 and Related Reorganization Items

We were acquired by Cerberus; therefore, we did not incur any Chapter 11 or related reorganization charges during the seven months ended July 31, 2008.

Provision for Income Taxes

Provision for income taxes decreased $2.2 million or 15% during the seven months ended July 31, 2008 as compared to the seven months ended July 31, 2007, primarily reflecting the mix of income in the various foreign taxing jurisdictions.

Equity in Earnings of Joint Ventures, Net of Tax

Equity in earnings of joint ventures decreased by $12.4 million during the seven months ended July 31, 2008 as compared to the seven months ended July 31, 2007 due to our selling a 40% joint venture interest in Metalsa in December 2007.

 

71


Table of Contents

Noncontrolling Interest, Net of Tax

The adjustment to our earnings required to give effect to the elimination of minority interests decreased by $1.3 million or 24% during the seven months ended July 31, 2008 from the seven months ended July 31, 2007 due to lower earnings at our China joint ventures.

Comparison of Periods—Non-GAAP Analysis of Adjusted EBITDA

A reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC for the periods presented is set forth below (in millions):

 

     International     Americas     Consolidated  
     Seven Months
Ended
    Seven Months
Ended
    Seven Months
Ended
 
     2008     2007     2008     2007     2008     2007  
     Successor     Predecessor     Successor     Predecessor     Successor     Predecessor  

Adjusted EBITDA

   $ 107.1      $ 86.0      $ 49.3      $ 58.6      $ 156.4      $ 144.6   

Intercompany Charges

     10.6        2.8        (10.6     (2.8     —          —     

Restructuring

     (0.1     (0.9     3.8        (21.5     3.7        (22.4

Depreciation & Amortization

     (50.4     (38.9     (55.6     (51.6     (106.0     (90.5

Receivable factoring charges

     —          —          (0.7     (1.7     (0.7     (1.7

Other adjustments

     (3.0     —          —          —          (3.0     —     
                                                

Operating income (loss)

   $ 64.2      $ 49.0      $ (13.8   $ (19.0     50.4        30.0   
                                    

Interest expense, net

  

    (36.2     (65.5

Chapter 11 and related reorganization items

  

    —          (62.2

Provision for income taxes

  

    (12.8     (15.0

Equity in joint venture

  

    —          12.4   

Noncontrolling interest, net of tax

  

    (4.1     (5.4

Loss from discontinued operations

  

    —          (0.3
                        

Net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC

  

  $ (2.7   $ (106.0
                        

See footnote 10 in “Prospectus Summary—Summary Consolidated Financial Data.”

 

72


Table of Contents

The following table presents revenues (a GAAP measure) and Adjusted EBITDA (a non-GAAP measure) for the seven months ended July 31, 2008 and July 31, 2007 (in millions) as well as an explanation of variances:

 

     International     Americas     Consolidated  
     Revenues     Adjusted
EBITDA(a)
    Revenues     Adjusted
EBITDA(a)
    Revenues     Adjusted
EBITDA(a)
 

Seven months ended July 31, 2008 results

   $ 818.1      $ 107.1      $ 638.7      $ 49.3      $ 1,456.8      $ 156.4   

Seven months ended July 31, 2007 results

     772.1        86.0        683.4        58.6        1,455.5        144.6   
                                                

Variance

   $ 46.0      $ 21.1      $ (44.7   $ (9.3   $ 1.3      $ 11.8   
                                                

Variance attributable to:

            

Volume and mix

   $ (20.9   $ 2.6      $ (75.8   $ (30.3   $ (96.7   $ (27.7

Foreign exchange

     75.7        11.3        22.7        1.0        98.4        12.3   

Pricing and economics

     (4.6     (12.7     4.0        (9.5     (0.6     (22.2

Manufacturing and purchasing efficiencies

     —          20.5        —          23.9        —          44.4   

Selling, general and administrative expenses and other items

     (4.2     (0.6     4.4        5.6        0.2        5.0   
                                                

Total

   $ 46.0      $ 21.1      $ (44.7   $ (9.3   $ 1.3      $ 11.8   
                                                

 

(b) We have presented a reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC above.

Adjusted EBITDA

Total Company: Total Adjusted EBITDA increased during the seven months ended July 31, 2008 by $11.8 million or 8% as compared to the seven months ended July 31, 2007, despite lower volumes ($21.6 million) and unfavorable product mix ($6.1 million), due in part to favorable foreign exchange ($12.3 million). All other factors were net favorable by $27.2 million, reflecting favorable efficiencies ($44.4 million) and favorable SG&A expenses and other items ($5 million), offset partially by unfavorable pricing and economics ($22.2 million), principally product pricing and labor costs. The reduction in SG&A expenses and other items reflected primarily restructuring savings achieved during the seven months ended July 31, 2008 from restructuring actions in 2007 ($4.8 million).

International Segment: In our International segment, Adjusted EBITDA increased during the seven months ended July 31, 2008 by $21.1 million or 25% as compared to the seven months ended July 31, 2007, reflecting favorable product mix ($3.9 million) and favorable exchange ($11.3 million), offset partially by lower volume in Asia ($1.3 million). All other factors were net favorable by $7.2 million, reflecting primarily favorable efficiencies ($20.5 million), offset partially by unfavorable pricing and economics ($12.7 million).

Americas Segment: In our Americas segment, Adjusted EBITDA declined during the seven months ended July 31, 2008 by $9.3 million or 16% as compared to the seven months ended July 31, 2007, reflecting primarily lower volume ($20.3 million) and unfavorable mix ($10.0 million). Foreign exchange had a negligible impact. All other factors were net favorable by $20 million, reflecting favorable efficiencies ($23.9 million) and reduced SG&A expenses and other items ($5.6 million), offset partially by unfavorable pricing and economics ($9.5 million). We reduced SG&A expenses and other items primarily as a result of restructuring savings that were achieved during the seven months ended July 31, 2008 from restructuring actions in 2007 ($4.8 million).

 

73


Table of Contents

Restructuring

The following table sets forth our net restructuring expense by type for the periods presented (in millions):

 

     Successor     Predecessor  
       Six months
Ended 

June 30,
    Year Ended
December 31,
    Five months
Ended
December 31,
    Seven months
Ended

July 31,
 
     2010    2009     2009     2008     2007     2007  

Employee termination costs

   $ 0.2    $ 2.6      $ 12.0      $ 9.8      $ 3.5      $ 6.9   

Other exit costs

     1.8      3.2        6.5        4.1        5.1        1.8   

Asset impairment costs

     2.7      —          1.8        —          —          21.6   

Restructuring income

     —        (6.9     (6.9     (9.1     (6.8     (7.9
                                               
   $ 4.7    $ (1.1   $ 13.4      $ 4.8      $ 1.8      $ 22.4   
                                               

We restructure our global operations in an effort to align our capacity with demand and to reduce our costs. Restructuring costs include employee termination benefits and other incremental costs resulting from restructuring activities. These incremental costs principally include equipment and personnel relocation costs. Restructuring costs are recognized in our consolidated financial statements in accordance with FASB ASC No. 420, “Exit or Disposal Obligations,” and appear in our statement of operations under a line item entitled “restructuring and asset impairment charges, net.” We believe the restructuring actions discussed below will help our efficiency and results of operations on a going forward basis.

In September 2008, we announced the closure of our Traverse City, Michigan facility (the facility has ceased production, although some operations remain). Charges of $4 million and $4.5 million were recognized during the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively. The charges incurred during 2009 were comprised of $100,000 of severance costs, $1.8 million for an additional impairment charge on the Traverse City facility and $2.1 million of other exit costs. The charges incurred during 2008 were comprised of $4.4 million of severance costs and $100,000 of other exit costs.

In July 2009, we announced that we had ceased production at our press shop in Bergisch Gladbach, Germany. This closure impacted 57 employees. Total estimated costs of the closure of this facility are $10.2 million, which is comprised of $9.1 million of employee costs and $1.1 million of other exit costs. We recorded the entire charge of $10.2 million in 2009 relating to the closure of the Bergisch press shop. We expect to incur cash outlays of $7.7 million during 2010 related to this action. In connection with our prior restructuring actions and current activities other than our Bergisch press shop and Traverse City closure, we recorded restructuring charges of approximately $6.1 million during 2009.

In March 2010, we recorded an impairment charge of $2.7 million on our Bergisch Gladbach, Germany facility which was closed in 2009. This charge was recorded to align the book value to fair value as the facility has been classified as held for sale. The additional charges incurred in 2010, 2009, and 2008 related to other severance costs and ongoing maintenance of facilities closed as a result of prior actions. We expect to continue to incur additional restructuring expense in 2010 primarily related to previously announced restructuring actions. We do not anticipate that any additional expense will be significant with respect to previously announced actions.

We had no restructuring income during the six months ended June 30, 2010 and we had restructuring income of $6.9 million, $9.1 million, and $6.8 million, respectively, during the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008 and the five months ended December 31, 2007. Our Predecessor had restructuring income of $7.9 million during the seven months ended July 31, 2007. The restructuring income was related to the cancellation of an old customer program relating to our closed facility in Milwaukee, Wisconsin. This income was recorded in the Americas segment. As of June 30, 2009, all recoveries had been received.

 

74


Table of Contents

Quarterly Results

The following table sets forth certain summary unaudited financial information (dollars in millions, except per unit amounts) regarding our consolidated results of operations, including a reconciliation of net income/(loss) to Adjusted EBITDA, for each of the past ten quarters.

 

     Year Ended December 31, 2008  
     Quarter
Ended
March 31
    Quarter
Ended
June 30
    Quarter
Ended
Sept. 30
    Quarter
Ended

Dec. 31
 

Revenues

   $ 621.9      $ 667.6      $ 500.8      $ 381.4   

Cost of sales

     571.8        586.8        475.7        357.0   

Gross profit

     50.1        80.8        25.1        24.4   

Gross profit margin

     8.1     12.1     5.0     6.4

Selling, general and administrative expenses

   $ 35.1      $ 37.1      $ 35.1      $ 31.3   

Operating income/(loss)

     15.3        45.1        (9.9     (16.5 )(a) 

Operating income/(loss) margin

     2.5     6.8     (2.0 )%      (4.3 )% 

Interest expense, net

   $ 16.2      $ 14.8      $ 14.7      $ 14.5   

Provision for income taxes

     3.2        8.2        2.1        6.0   

Net income/(loss) attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC

     (5.6     20.1        (28.4     (38.4 )(a) 

Basic and diluted income/(loss) per unit attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC

     (1,086     1,930 (b)      (3,783     (4,978

Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Information:

        

Net income/(loss) attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC

   $ (5.6   $ 20.1      $ (28.4   $ (38.4 )(a) 

Noncontrolling interest, net of tax.

     1.5        2.0        1.8        1.3   

Provision for income taxes

     3.2        8.2        2.1        6.0   

Interest expense, net

     16.2        14.8        14.7        14.5   

Receivable factoring charges

     0.3        0.4        —          —     

Depreciation and amortization

     42.4        43.9        46.6        37.4   

Restructuring

     (1.1     (2.2     (0.9     9.0   

Other adjustments

     3.1        —          —          —     
                                

Adjusted EBITDA(c)

   $ 60.0      $ 87.2      $ 35.9      $ 29.8   
                                

Adjusted EBITDA margin(c)

     9.6     13.1     7.2     7.8

 

(a) During the fourth quarter, we announced the closure of our manufacturing facility in Traverse City, Michigan, which resulted in charges of $4.5 million.
(b) There was not a dilutive impact based on the use of the treasury method.
(c) “Adjusted EBITDA” and “Adjusted EBITDA Margin” are described in footnotes 10 and 11, respectively, in “Prospectus Summary—Summary Consolidated Financial Data.”

 

75


Table of Contents
    Year Ended December 31, 2009     Year Ending
December 31, 2010
 
    Quarter
Ended
March 31
    Quarter
Ended
June 30
    Quarter
Ended
Sept. 30
    Quarter
Ended

Dec. 31
    Quarter
Ended
March 31
    Quarter
Ended

June 30
 

Revenues

  $ 320.0      $ 377.8      $ 435.6      $ 501.0      $ 479.1      $ 501.7   

Cost of sales

    322.8        359.1        395.6        459.3        425.9        446.1   

Gross profit

    (2.8     18.7        40.0        41.7        53.2        55.6   

Gross profit margin

    (0.9 )%      4.9     9.2     8.3     11.1     11.1

Selling, general and administrative expenses

  $ 26.3      $ 27.0      $ 30.1      $ 34.9      $ 33.0      $ 32.0   

Operating income/(loss)

    (29.7     (7.8     7.2        (6.6 )(a)      15.4        22.2   

Operating income/(loss) margin

    (9.3 )%      (2.1 )%      1.7     (1.3 )%      3.2     4.4

Interest expense, net

  $ 13.5      $ 13.7      $ 13.3      $ 16.4      $ 13.6      $ 13.7   

Provision/(benefit) for income taxes.

    (1.5     4.3        2.5        (6.4     4.1        4.3   

Net income/(loss) attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC

    (43.0     4.0 (b)      (9.9     (19.0 )(a)      (4.5     1.9   

Basic and diluted income/(loss) per unit attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC

    (5,521     5 (c)      (1,646     (2,647     (1,030     290   

Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Information:

           

Net income/(loss) attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC

  $ (43.0   $ 4.0      $ (9.9   $ (19.0   $ (4.5   $ 1.9   

Noncontrolling interest, net of tax.

    1.3        2.6        2.5        2.5        2.2        2.3   

Provision/(benefit) for income taxes

    (1.5     4.3        2.5        (6.4     4.1        4.3   

Other (income)/loss, net

    —          (32.5 )(b)      (1.2     —          —          —     

Interest expense, net

    13.5        13.7        13.3        16.4        13.6        13.7   

Receivable factoring charges

    —          0.2        0.2        0.4        —          0.2   

Depreciation and amortization

    40.1        39.4        36.4        31.8        30.3        28.4   

Restructuring

    —          (1.1     2.1        12.4 (a)      4.1        0.6   

Other adjustments(d)

    —          —          —          —          0.7        —     

Compensation expense related to initial public offering

    —          —          —          —          0.2        0.3   
                                               

Adjusted EBITDA(e)

  $ 10.4      $ 30.6      $ 45.9 (f)    $ 38.1 (g)    $ 50.7      $ 51.7   
                                               

Adjusted EBITDA margin(e)

    3.3     8.1     10.5     7.6     10.6     10.3

 

(a) During the fourth quarter of 2009, we closed our press shop in Bergisch Gladbach, Germany, which resulted in charges of $10.2 million.
(b) During the second quarter of 2009, we recorded a one-time gain of $32.5 million related to the repurchase of a portion of our first lien term loan. See note 8 to our consolidated financial statements.
(c) There was not a dilutive impact based on the use of the treasury method.
(d) Represents one-time costs related to the acquisition of a facility in Artern, Germany.
(e) “Adjusted EBITDA” and “Adjusted EBITDA Margin” are described in footnotes 10 and 11, respectively, in “Prospectus Summary—Summary Consolidated Financial Data.”
(f) During the third quarter of 2009, Adjusted EBITDA was positively impacted by one-time adjustments of $3 million related to our workers’ compensation accrual and $3.1 million related to recoveries of expenditures for customer-funded tooling we use in our manufacturing operations.
(g) During the fourth quarter of 2009, Adjusted EBITDA was adversely impacted by a one-time $4.2 million provision associated with a VAT audit in Brazil. In addition, we recorded an incremental bonus accrual of $3.3 million. See “Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Components of Compensation—2009 Tower Bonus Plan.”

Liquidity and Capital Resources

General

We generally expect to fund expenditures for operations, administrative expenses, capital expenditures and debt service obligations with internally generated funds from operations, and satisfy working capital needs from time-to-time with borrowings under our revolving credit facility or use of cash on hand. We believe that we will be able to meet our debt service obligations and fund our short-term and long-term operating requirements for at least the next twelve months with cash flow from operations and borrowings under our revolving credit facility, although no assurance can be given in this regard.

 

76


Table of Contents

Cash Flows and Working Capital

The following table shows the components of our cash flows for the periods presented:

 

     Successor     Predecessor  
     Six Months
Ended June 30,
    Year Ended
December 31,
    Five Months
Ended
December 31,
2007
    Seven Months
Ended
July 31, 2007
 
   2010     2009     2009     2008      
                             (millions)        

Net cash provided by (used in):

            

Operating activities

   $ 27.1      $ (16.6   $ 48.9      $ 200.6      $ 118.2      $ 18.3   

Investing activities

     (56.8     (45.6     (86.0     (126.8     (676.3     (53.4

Financing activities

     36.3        68.3        50.8        (32.3     651.4        53.0   

Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities

During the six months ended June 30, 2010, we generated $27.1 million of cash flow from operations compared with cash utilized of $16.6 million during the six months ended June 30, 2009. The primary reason for this increase resulted from higher volumes during the first half of 2010 which increased our revenues and profitability. During the six months ended June 30, 2010, we utilized $31.7 million of cash through working capital items, reflecting primarily seasonal working capital. In addition, our working capital increased by $4.9 million due to higher customer funded tooling during the first six months of 2010. During the six months ended June 30, 2009, we utilized $28.6 million of cash through working capital items, reflecting primarily the downturn in the global economy which caused revenues and profitability to decline significantly.

During 2009, we generated $48.9 million of cash flow from operations compared with $200.6 million in 2008. The primary reason for this reduction resulted from lower volumes related to the global economic downturn that substantially reduced our revenues and profitability. Although our operating cash flows were substantially decreased, we were nevertheless able to generate $9 million of cash from working capital items, reflecting our efforts to reduce the amount of working capital needed in our business. During 2008, we were able to generate a $87.3 million benefit from working capital items, reflecting primarily our efforts to match the payment terms on which we paid our suppliers with the payment terms on which our customers paid us. This reversed a trend that the Predecessor experienced during its bankruptcy proceedings, when suppliers were demanding shorter payment terms.

Net Cash Used in Investing Activities

Net cash utilized in investing activities was $56.8 million during the six months ended June 30, 2010 compared to net cash utilized of $45.6 million during the six months ended June 30, 2009. The $11.2 million increase in cash used reflects our acquisition of a manufacturing plant in Artern, Germany, offset partially by a decline in capital expenditures primarily related to the timing of program launches.

Net cash utilized in investing activities was $86 million during 2009 compared to net cash utilized of $126.8 million during 2008. The $40.8 million decrease in cash used in investing activities for 2009 reflects our using $30.6 million of cash in 2008 to buy-out equipment leases, which resulted in operating improvements. In addition, we used cash to pay the consideration in connection with the 2007 acquisition.

Net Cash Provided by Financing Activities

Net cash provided by financing activities was $36.3 million during the six months ended June 30, 2010 compared to $68.3 million during the six months ended June 30, 2009. The $32 million change was attributable primarily to lower financing actions needed due to the increased generation of cash from operations in 2010.

 

77


Table of Contents

Net cash provided by financing activities was $50.8 million during 2009 compared to net cash utilized of $32.3 million during 2008. The $83.1 million change was attributable primarily to increased borrowings in 2009 to offset some of the negative cash impact resulting from the significant downturn in the global economy. In contrast, during 2008 we used $27.9 million to repay in full our second lien term loan.

Working Capital

We manage our working capital by monitoring key metrics principally associated with inventory, accounts receivable and accounts payable. We have implemented various inventory control processes which have allowed us to reduce our inventory days on hand. As a result, our inventory levels decreased from $110.5 million at December 31, 2007 to $76.2 million at December 31, 2008 and to $62.6 million at December 31, 2009. Although our inventory levels increased to $69 million at June 30, 2010, that increase reflects the substantial increase in volume during the six months ended June 30, 2010. We have continued our efforts to match the terms on which we pay our suppliers with the payment terms we receive from our customers in an effort to remain cash flow neutral with respect to our trade payables and receivables.

On June 30, 2010, December 31, 2009 and December 31, 2008, we had working capital balances of $36.1 million, negative ($29.8) million and negative ($22) million, respectively. We negotiate our payment terms to our vendors to either match or exceed the payment terms that we receive from our customers on our accounts receivable and our pre-paid tooling. In addition, we actively manage our inventory balances to minimize the inventory on hand which is facilitated by our customers’ just-in-time manufacturing process. We also have a substantial portion of our foreign subsidiary debt subject to annual renewal. Historically, we have been successful in renewing this debt as it becomes due. During the second quarter of 2010, we were successful in renewing $20.4 million of our foreign subsidiary debt, changing the terms from annual renewal to an extended term, which increased working capital. As of June 30, 2010, we had available liquidity of $215 million, which we believe is adequate to fund our working capital requirements for at least the next 12 months.

Despite the significant decline in our revenues during 2009, our accounts receivable balance increased from $175.3 million as of December 31, 2008 to $290.1 million as of December 31, 2009. The increase in our accounts receivable balance reflects increased revenues during the last quarter of 2009 as compared with the last quarter of 2008. Our revenues for the fourth quarter of 2009 were $501 million, which represented an increase of $119.6 million over our revenues during the fourth quarter of 2008. Almost all of this increase occurred during the last two months of the quarter. Our November and December 2009 revenues were $327 million as compared with $239.1 million during November and December 2008. Our accounts receivable balance at June 30, 2010 was $310.3 million, reflecting our increased revenues during the six months ended June 30, 2010.

Sources and Uses of Liquidity

Our available liquidity at June 30, 2010 was $215 million, and consisted of $149.6 million of cash on hand and unutilized borrowing availability of $56.8 million and $8.6 million, respectively, under our U.S. and foreign credit facilities. As of December 31, 2009 and 2008, we had available liquidity in the amount of $238.1 million and $236 million, respectively.

During 2009, despite the tightening of credit in our industry, we were able to increase borrowings in certain of our foreign jurisdictions, including additional borrowings in Korea, new borrowings in Brazil and increasing certain account receivable factoring lines in Europe. All of these actions helped to offset the declining cash flow from operating activities arising from the significant downturn in our revenues.

As of June 30, 2010, we had current maturities of long term debt of $111.5 million, of which $66.7 million related to debt in South Korea, $27.4 million related to receivable factoring in Europe, and $13 million related to debt in Brazil. The majority of our South Korean debt and all of our Brazilian debt is subject to annual renewal. Historically, we have been successful in renewing this debt on an annual basis, but we cannot assure you that this debt will continue to be renewed or, if renewed, that this debt will continue to be renewed under the same terms. The receivable factoring in Europe consists of uncommitted, demand facilities which are subject to termination at

 

78


Table of Contents

the discretion of the banks, although we have not experienced any terminations by the banks at any time since the 2007 acquisition. We believe that we will be able to continue to renew the majority of our South Korean and Brazilian debt and to continue the receivable factoring in Europe.

During the first quarter of 2010, we renewed $13.5 million of maturing secured indebtedness in South Korea for an additional year. There were no material changes to the terms of the loans except the average annual interest rate reduced from 7.1% to 6.3%. In Brazil, two local banks provided us with a combined $8 million (R$14.5 million) of new one-year term loans that refinanced previous principal payments made on our existing term loan portfolio. The terms of the new loans are substantially the same as the other portfolio loans except for a reduction in interest rates from the portfolio average of 13.8% to 13.2% for the new loans.

During the second quarter of 2010, we renewed $20.4 million of maturing secured bonds in South Korea for an additional two years. We also renewed three additional facilities with aggregate indebtedness of $7.8 million for an additional year. There were no material changes to the terms of the loans except for the extension of the maturities. In addition, we obtained a new $4.1 million unsecured bond from the South Korean Government. The bond has a three year maturity with an interest rate of 8.32%. In Brazil, one of the local banks provided us with a new $3 million (R$5.3 million) one-year term loan. The terms of the new loan are substantially the same as the other portfolio loans.

Debt

As of June 30, 2010, we had outstanding indebtedness, excluding capital leases, of approximately $635.6 million, which consisted of the following:

 

   

$53.5 million of indebtedness outstanding under our asset-based lending revolving credit facility;

 

   

$203.3 million of indebtedness outstanding on the United States portion of our first lien term loan;

 

   

€185.3 (or $226.7 million) of indebtedness outstanding on the European portion of our first lien term loan; and

 

   

$152.1 million of other foreign subsidiary indebtedness.

Our asset-based revolving credit facility, which we refer to as our ABL revolver, provides for a revolving credit facility in the aggregate amount of $150 million, subject to a borrowing base limitation. Our ABL revolver provides for the issuance of letters of credit in an aggregate amount not to exceed $75 million, provided that the total amount of credit (inclusive of revolving loans and letters of credit) extended under our ABL revolver is subject to an overall cap, on any date, equal to the lesser of $150 million or the amount of the borrowing base on such date. The borrowing base is based upon the value of certain of our assets, including certain of our accounts receivable, inventory and PP&E, and thus changes from time to time depending on the volume of the assets included within the borrowing base. The administrative agent for this facility causes to be performed an appraisal of the assets included in the calculation of the borrowing base either on an annual basis or, if our availability under the facility is less than $30 million during any twelve month period, as frequently as on a semi-annual basis. In addition, if certain material defaults under the facility have occurred and are continuing, the administrative agent has the right to perform any such appraisal as often as it deems necessary in its sole discretion. Our administrative agent may make adjustments to our borrowing base pursuant to these appraisals. These adjustments may negatively impact our ability to obtain revolving loans or support our letters of credit needs under our ABL revolver. Based on our asset mix at June 30, 2010, we were entitled to borrow $110.3 million under our revolver at June 30, 2010. On that date, we had outstanding $53.5 million of borrowings under the revolver and no letters of credit outstanding. Thus, we could have borrowed an additional $56.8 million under the revolver as of June 30, 2010, calculated (in millions) as follows:

 

Revolver borrowing base

   $ 110.3

Borrowings on revolver

     53.5

Letters of credit outstanding on revolver

     —  
      

Availability

   $ 56.8
      

 

79


Table of Contents

Our ABL revolver bears interest at a base rate plus a margin or at LIBOR plus a margin. The applicable margin is determined by reference to the average availability under the ABL revolver over the preceding three months. The applicable margins as of June 30, 2010 were 0.75% and 1.75% for base rate and LIBOR based borrowings, respectively. As of June 30, 2010, there was $56.8 million of borrowing availability under the ABL revolver. Borrowings outstanding under our ABL revolver may vary significantly from time to time depending on our cash needs at any given time. Our ABL revolver expires in July 2012.

Our first lien term loan was borrowed in two tranches, a $250 million U.S. dollar denominated tranche and a €190.8 million Euro denominated tranche ($260 million at the time of the initial borrowing). Our first lien term loan carried an initial rate of interest equal to 4.00% per annum plus the applicable U.S. dollar LIBOR or EURIBOR rate. Subsequently, the applicable margin has increased to 4.25% per annum. As of June 30, 2010, the interest rates in effect were 4.79% per annum and 4.84% per annum on the U.S. dollar and Euro tranches, respectively. The effective rates on the U.S. dollar and Euro tranches increase to 8.85% and 6.96%, respectively, when taking into account the impact of interest rate swaps. Our first lien term loan, scheduled to mature in July 2013, was repaid on August 24, 2010, funded principally by our offering of $430 million aggregate principal amount of the notes. Under our first lien term loan agreement, we also have a $27.5 million synthetic letter of credit facility, of which $23.1 million was outstanding at June 30, 2010. The synthetic letter of credit facility remains outstanding notwithstanding the retirement of the first lien term loan.

Our other foreign subsidiary indebtedness consists primarily of borrowings in South Korea and Brazil and factoring in Italy. Factoring involves the sale of our receivables at a discount, which discount is included in interest expense. A majority of the South Korean debt and all of the Brazilian debt is subject to annual renewal. The factoring in Italy consists of uncommitted demand facilities which are subject to termination at the discretion of the applicable banks. Interest on the South Korean borrowings ranges from 4.23% to 9.96% per annum. Interest on the Brazilian debt ranges from 12.68% to 14.57% per annum.

Our ABL revolver contains a financial maintenance covenant ratio, which we refer to as the fixed charge coverage ratio. Compliance with the fixed charge coverage ratio is determined by comparing consolidated lender-adjusted EBITDA to consolidated fixed charges, each as defined in the credit agreement governing our ABL revolver. If we have less than ten percent of the total commitment available (provided that such number cannot be less than $10 million or greater than $20 million) under our ABL revolver for more than five consecutive days, we are required to maintain a fixed charge coverage ratio of not less than 1.00 to 1.00 on a rolling four quarter basis. We were not required to maintain a minimum fixed charge coverage ratio under our ABL revolver during 2009. If we are required at any time to maintain the fixed charge coverage ratio, such requirement will end after we have more than ten percent of the total commitment available (provided that such number cannot be less than $10 million or greater than $20 million) for twenty consecutive days.

Our first lien term loan agreement, which continues to apply to us with respect to our synthetic letter of credit facility, contains a leverage covenant ratio, which we refer to as the first priority leverage ratio. Compliance with this ratio is determined by comparing our first priority debt to consolidated lender-adjusted EBITDA, each as defined in the credit agreement governing our first lien term loan. We are required to maintain a first priority leverage ratio of not greater than 4.25 to 1.00 on a rolling four quarter basis. In addition, our first lien term loan contains a financial maintenance covenant ratio referred to as the interest coverage ratio, which is determined by comparing consolidated lender-Adjusted EBITDA (calculated in accordance with the first lien term loan agreement) to consolidated interest expense, excluding amounts not paid or payable in cash, each as defined in the credit agreement governing our first lien term loan. We are required to maintain an interest coverage ratio of not less than 2.00 to 1.00 on a rolling four quarter basis. As of June 30, 2010, we were in compliance with the required leverage ratio and interest coverage ratio covenants. Our financial condition and liquidity would be adversely impacted by the violation of any of our covenants.

On August 24, 2010, the Issuers consummated the sale of $430 million aggregate principal amount of the 10.625% Senior Secured Notes due 2017. The indenture governing the notes contains a provision that gives each

 

80


Table of Contents

holder of notes the right, upon a change of control, to require the Issuers to purchase all or any part of such holder’s notes at a purchase price in cash equal to 101% of the principal amount thereof plus accrued and unpaid interest. The Issuers may also redeem some or all of the notes on the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in the indenture.

The indenture governing the notes contains customary covenants applicable to our subsidiaries and places some restrictions on Tower Automotive, LLC which will become restrictions on Tower International, Inc. upon consummation of the Corporate Conversion. The indenture governing the notes contains certain restrictions on, among other things, our subsidiaries’ ability to: incur debt; incur liens; declare or make distributions to us or our equity holders; repay debt; enter into mergers, acquisitions and other business combinations; engage in asset and equity sales; enter into sale and lease-back transactions; enter into restrictive agreements; and enter into transactions with affiliates. The indenture governing the notes includes customary events of default, including, but not limited to, in respect of payment defaults; breaches of covenants; bankruptcy; material judgments; failure to have perfected liens on substantially all or all the collateral securing the notes; and cross-acceleration to material indebtedness.

For further information regarding our credit facilities, see “Description of Certain Indebtedness.”

Capital and Operating Leases

We maintain capital leases mainly for a manufacturing facility and certain manufacturing equipment. We have several operating leases, including leases for office and manufacturing facilities and certain equipment, with lease terms expiring between the years 2011 and 2021. As of December 31, 2009, our total future operating lease payments amounted to $125.6 million and the present value of minimum lease payments under our capital leases amounted to $17.4 million. During the first quarter of 2010, we added $9.6 million of capital lease obligations in connection with our acquisition of a manufacturing plant in Artern, Germany, of which we are committed to making lease payments of approximately $5.9 million during 2010. As of December 31, 2009, we were committed to making lease payments of not less than $23.4 million on our operating leases and not less than $3 million on our capital leases during 2010.

Capital Expenditures

In general, we are awarded new automotive business two to five years prior to the launch of a particular program. During the pre-launch period, we typically invest significant resources in the form of capital expenditures for the purchase and installation of the machinery and equipment necessary to manufacture the related products. Capital expenditures for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008 were $78.9 million and $129.1 million, respectively. During the year ended December 31, 2008, we spent $30.6 million to buy-out certain equipment leases. Our Adjusted EBITDA improved by approximately $14.6 million per year as a result of these lease termination payments. Our capital spending for 2010 will include $75 to $80 million for our automotive business. While we plan to invest approximately $30 to $35 million (net of government and other incentives) to support our solar agreement, we cannot yet predict the extent to which such spending will be made in 2010 or in subsequent periods. Our capital expenditures for this project would include investing in a new facility in the southwest United States that could provide a base for additional expansion.

Off-Balance Sheet Obligations

Our only off-balance sheet obligations consist of our obligations under our synthetic letter of credit facility that is part of our first lien term loan facility. As of June 30, 2010, letters of credit outstanding were $23.1 million under our $27.5 million synthetic letter of credit facility.

Our synthetic letter of credit facility was fully cash collateralized by third parties for purposes of replacing or backstopping letters of credit outstanding. The cash collateral was deposited by the third parties in a trust account, and we have no right, title or interest in the trust account. Applicable fees are 4.5% of the aggregate letters of credit outstanding for commissions and fronting fees and a deposit fee of 0.15% based on the amount of the cash collateral deposit.

 

81


Table of Contents

Contractual Obligations and Commercial Commitments

Our contractual obligations and commercial commitments as of December 31, 2009 are summarized below (in millions):

 

     Payments Due by Period

Contractual Obligations

   Total    Less
than 1
year
   1-3
years
   4-5
years
   After 5
years

Long-term debt (including current portion):

              

Asset based revolving credit facility

   $ 24.5    $ —      $ 24.5    $ —      $ —  

First lien term borrowings:

              

U.S. dollar denominated tranche

     204.3      2.1      4.2      198.0      —  

Euro denominated tranche

     266.7      2.7      5.4      258.6      —  

Other foreign subsidiary indebtedness

     156.4      134.7      21.7      —        —  

Cash interest payments

     145.5      43.9      80.8      20.8      —  

Pension contributions(a)

     111.2      9.7      40.0      37.5      24.0

VEBA payments(b)

     1.8      1.2      0.6      —        —  

Expected tax payments(c)

     10.7      2.8      3.2      4.1      0.6

Capital and tooling purchase obligations(d)

     92.8      92.8      —        —        —  

Capital lease obligations

     22.3      2.9      4.4      3.4      11.6

Operating leases

     125.6      23.4      30.3      21.4      50.5
                                  

Total contractual obligations at December 31, 2009

   $ 1,161.8    $ 316.2    $ 215.1    $ 543.8    $ 86.7
                                  

 

(a) Represents expected future contributions required to achieve an actuarially determined completely funded status for our pension plan.
(b) Represents obligations assumed pursuant to the 2007 acquisition to make contributions to a Voluntary Employee Benefit Association, or VEBA, trust to administer medical insurance benefits.
(c) Represents payments expected to be made to various governmental agencies relating to certain tax positions taken by our company pursuant to FASB ASC 450 “ Accounting for Uncertain Tax Positions .”
(d) Represents obligations under executory purchase orders related to capital and tooling expenditures.

Our purchase orders for inventory are based on demand and do not require us to purchase minimum quantities.

Quantitative and Qualitative Analysis of Market Risk

Market risk is the potential loss arising from adverse changes in market rates and prices. We are exposed to market risk in the normal course of our business operations due to our purchases of steel, our sales of scrap steel, our ongoing investing and financing activities and our exposure to foreign currency exchange rates. We have established policies and procedures to govern our management of market risks.

Commodity Pricing Risk

Steel is the primary raw material that we use. We purchase a portion of our steel from certain of our customers through various OEM resale programs. The purchases through customer resale programs have buffered the impact of price swings associated with the procurement of steel. The remainder of our steel purchasing requirements are met through contracts with steel mills. At times, we may be unable to either avoid increases in steel prices or pass through any price increases to our customers. We refer to the “net steel impact” as the combination of the change in steel prices that are reflected in product pricing, the change in the cost to procure steel from the mill, and the change in our recovery of scrap steel, which we refer to as offal. Our strategy is to be economically indifferent to steel pricing by having these factors offset each other. While we strive to achieve a neutral net steel impact, we are not always successful in achieving that goal, in large part due to timing differences. Depending upon when a steel price change or offal price change occurs, that change may have a

 

82


Table of Contents

disproportionate effect, within any particular fiscal period, on our product pricing, our steel costs and the results of our sales of scrap steel. Net imbalances in any one particular fiscal period may be reversed in a subsequent fiscal period, although we can not assure you that, or when, these reversals will occur.

Interest Rate Risk

At June 30, 2010, we had total debt of $654.1 million, consisting of fixed rate debt of $362.4 million (55%) and floating rate debt of $291.7 million (45%). We were required by our credit agreements to enter into two interest rate swap agreements during the third quarter of 2007 with notional principal amounts of $182.5 million and €100 million. These derivative agreements, which expired in August 2010, effectively fixed interest rates at 5.06% and 4.62%, respectively, on a portion of our floating rate debt. Assuming no changes in the monthly average variable-rate debt levels of $288.5 million and $290.1 million for the six months ended June 30, 2010 and 2009, respectively, and giving effect to such interest rate swap agreements, we estimate that a hypothetical change of 100 basis points in the LIBOR and alternate base rate interest rates would have impacted interest expense for each of the six months ended June 30, 2010 and 2009 by $1.4 million and $1.5 million, respectively. A 100 basis point increase in interest rates would not materially impact the fair value of our fixed rate debt. At June 30, 2010, on a pro forma basis after giving effect to the notes offering and the application of the net proceeds therefrom, we would have had total debt of $641.3 million (net of $12.8 million original issue discount), consisting of fixed rate debt of $474.7 million (74%) and floating rate debt of $166.6 million (26%). On a pro forma basis after giving effect to the notes offering and the application of the net proceeds therefrom and assuming no changes in the monthly average variable-rate debt levels of $155 million and $125.4 million for the six months ended June 30, 2010 and 2009, respectively, we estimate that a hypothetical change of 100 basis points in the LIBOR and alternate base rate interest rates would have impacted interest expense for each of the six months ended June 30, 2010 and 2009 by $0.8 million and $0.6 million, respectively.

Foreign Exchange Risk

A significant portion of our revenues is derived from manufacturing operations in Europe, Asia and South America. The results of operations and financial condition of our non-United States businesses are principally measured in their respective local currency and translated into U.S. dollars. The effects on us of foreign currency fluctuations in Europe, Asia and South America are mitigated by the fact that expenses are generally incurred in the same currency in which revenues are generated, since we strive to manufacture our products in close proximity to our customers. Nevertheless, the reported income of our foreign subsidiaries will be higher or lower depending on a weakening or strengthening of the U.S. dollar against the respective foreign currencies.

Assets located in our foreign facilities are translated into U.S. dollars at foreign currency exchange rates in effect as of the end of each reporting period. The effect of such translations is reflected as a separate component of consolidated stockholders’ equity (deficit). As a result, our consolidated stockholders’ equity/(deficit) will fluctuate depending upon the weakening or strengthening of the U.S. dollar against the respective foreign currencies.

Our strategy for managing currency risk relies primarily upon conducting business in a foreign country in that country’s currency. We may, from time to time, also participate in hedging programs intended to reduce our exposure to currency fluctuations. We believe that the effect of a 100 basis point movement in foreign currency rates against the U.S. dollar would not have materially affected our consolidated financial condition, results of operations or cash flows for the years ended December 31, 2008 and 2009 or for the six months ended June 30, 2010 and 2009.

We will have increased exposure to depreciation in the Euro due to the exchange of U.S. dollar for Euro denominated debt as a result of our retirement of our outstanding first lien term loan and our offering of senior secured notes in August 2010. We intend to evaluate our hedging activities in light of such exposure, but there is no guarantee we will be able to effectively mitigate such risk.

 

83


Table of Contents

Inflation

Despite recent declines, we have experienced a continued rise in inflationary pressures impacting certain commodities, such as petroleum-based products, resins, yarns, ferrous metals, base metals and certain chemicals. Additionally, because we purchase various types of equipment, raw materials and component parts from our suppliers, we may be adversely affected by their inability to adequately mitigate inflationary, industry, or economic pressures. These pressures have proven to be insurmountable to some of our suppliers and we have seen the number of bankruptcies and insolvencies in our industry increase. The overall condition of our supply base may possibly lead to delivery delays, production issues or delivery of non-conforming products by our suppliers in the future. As such, we continue to monitor our vendor base for the best sources of supply and work with those vendors and customers to attempt to mitigate the impact of the pressures mentioned above.

Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates

Our discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations is based upon our consolidated financial statements which have been prepared in accordance with GAAP. The preparation of these consolidated financial statements requires us to make estimates and judgments that affect amounts reported in those statements. We have made our best estimates of certain amounts contained in our consolidated financial statements. We base our estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that we believe are reasonable under the circumstances, the results of which form the basis for making judgments about the carrying value of assets and liabilities. However, application of our accounting policies involves the exercise of judgment and use of assumptions as to future uncertainties and, as a result, actual results could differ materially from these estimates. Management believes that the estimates, assumptions, and judgments involved in the accounting policies described below have the most significant impact on our consolidated financial statements.

Use of Estimates

In order for us to prepare our consolidated financial statements in conformity with GAAP, we are required to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities as of the date of the consolidated financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Generally, matters subject to estimation and judgment include amounts related to accounts receivable realization, inventory obsolescence, unsettled pricing discussions with customers and suppliers, fair value measurements, pension and other postretirement benefit plan assumptions, restructuring reserves, self-insurance accruals, asset valuation reserves and accruals related to environmental remediation costs, asset retirement obligations and income taxes. Actual results may be materially different than the estimates that we record in the consolidated financial statements.

Revenue Recognition

We recognize revenue once the criteria in FASB ASC 605, Revenue Recognition , have been met. These criteria are that persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists, delivery has occurred or services have been rendered, our price to the buyer is fixed or determinable, and collectability is reasonably assured.

We recognize revenue as our products are shipped to our customers, at which time title and risk of loss passes to the customer. We participate in certain customers’ steel resale programs. Under these programs, we purchase steel directly from a customer’s designated steel supplier for use in manufacturing products for that customer. We take delivery and title to such steel and we bear the risk of loss and obsolescence. We invoice our customers based upon annually negotiated selling prices, which inherently includes a component for steel under these resale programs. For sales for which we participate in a customer’s steel resale program, revenue is recognized on the entire amount of the sales, including the component for purchases under that customer’s steel resale program.

We are generally asked to provide annual price reductions by our customers. When negotiations are underway and negotiated prices are expected to be retroactive, we accrue for such amounts as a reduction of

 

84


Table of Contents

revenue as products are shipped. We record adjustments to those accruals in the period in which the pricing is finalized with the customer or if it becomes probable and estimable that pricing negotiated with customers will vary from previous assumptions.

We enter into agreements to produce products for our customers at the beginning of a given vehicle program life. Once we enter into these agreements, fulfillment of the customers’ purchasing requirements is our obligation for the entire production period of the vehicle programs, which range from three to ten years, and generally we have no provisions to terminate these contracts. Additionally, we monitor the aging of uncollected billings and adjust the accounts receivable allowance on a quarterly basis as necessary, based on our evaluation of the probability of collection. The adjustments we have made due to the write-off of uncollectible amounts have been negligible.

Restructuring Reserves

We have recognized accruals in relation to restructuring reserves, which require the use of estimates and judgment regarding risk, loss exposure and ultimate liability. Reserves for restructuring activities are estimated primarily for activities associated with the discontinuation and consolidation of certain operations of our company. Changes to these assumptions and estimates could materially affect the recorded liabilities and related loss.

Reserves for Workers’ Compensation Liability

We provide for estimated medical and indemnity compensation costs related to workers’ compensation liabilities when it becomes probable that a liability has been incurred and reasonable estimates of such costs are available. Estimates for accruals for workers’ compensation liability matters are based on historical patterns of the number of occurrences, costs incurred and a range of potential outcomes. We also utilize the assistance of independent advisors to assist in analyzing the adequacy of these reserves.

Allowance for Doubtful Accounts

We maintain an allowance for doubtful accounts for estimated losses resulting from the inability of our trade customers to make required payments. We provide an allowance for specific customer accounts where collection is doubtful and also provide an allowance for customer deductions based on historical collection and write-off experience. Additional allowances would be required if the financial condition of our customers deteriorated. Bad debt expense is not material for any periods presented.

Fair Value Measurements

We adopted FASB ASC No. 820, Fair Value Measurements , on January 1, 2008 for current assets and liabilities and on January 1, 2009 for non-current assets and liabilities. FASB ASC No. 820 (i) creates a single definition of fair value, (ii) establishes a framework for measuring fair value and (iii) expands disclosure requirements about items measured at fair value. FASB ASC No. 820 applies both to items recognized and reported at fair value in the financial statements and items disclosed at fair value in the notes to the financial statements. FASB ASC No. 820 does not change existing accounting rules governing what can or what must be recognized and reported at fair value in the financial statements, or disclosed at fair value in the notes to the financial statements. Additionally, FASB ASC No. 820 does not eliminate practicability exceptions that exist in accounting pronouncements amended by FASB ASC No. 820 when measuring fair value. As a result, we will not be required to recognize any new assets or liabilities at fair value.

Prior to the adoption of FASB ASC No. 820, certain measurements of fair value were based on the price that would be paid to acquire an asset, or received to assume a liability (an entry price). FASB ASC No. 820 clarifies the definition of fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset, or paid to transfer a liability, in an

 

85


Table of Contents

orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date (that is, an exit price). The exit price is based on the amount that the holder of the asset or liability would receive or need to pay in an actual transaction, or in a hypothetical transaction if an actual transaction does not exist, at the measurement date. In some circumstances, the entry and exit price may be the same; however, they are conceptually different.

Fair value is generally determined based on quoted market prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities. If quoted market prices are not available, we use valuation techniques that place greater reliance on observable inputs and less reliance on unobservable inputs. In measuring fair value, we may make adjustments for risks and uncertainties, if a market participant would include such an adjustment in its pricing.

FASB ASC No. 820 establishes a fair value hierarchy that distinguishes between assumptions based on market data, referred to as observable inputs, and our assumptions, referred to as unobservable inputs. Determining where an asset or liability falls within that hierarchy depends on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement as a whole. An adjustment to the pricing method used within either level 1 or level 2 inputs could generate a fair value measurement that effectively falls in a lower level in the hierarchy. The hierarchy consists of three broad levels as follows:

 

  Level 1: Quoted market prices in active markets for identical assets and liabilities;

 

  Level 2: Inputs other than level 1 inputs that are either directly or indirectly observable; and

 

  Level 3: Unobservable inputs developed using our estimates and assumptions, which reflect those that market participants would use.

 

   

Fair value measurements at December 31, 2009 using:

   

Quoted prices in active
markets for identical
assets

  Significant other
observable inputs
  Significant unobservable
inputs
   
   

Level 1

  Level 2   Level 3   Total

Liabilities:

       

Interest rate swap

 

Not applicable

  $10.6 million   Not applicable   $10.6 million

Total long-term debt

 

Not applicable

  Not applicable   $651.9 million   $651.9 million

As shown above, we value our interest rate swap using significant other observable inputs. The fair value is determined using third-party valuation models. The third party valuation models use quoted interest rate curves to calculate the forward value and then discount the forward values to the present period. We value our long-term debt using significant unobservable inputs. The fair value was determined based on estimated fair value of comparable instruments.

The determination of where an asset or liability falls in the hierarchy requires significant judgment. We evaluate our hierarchy disclosures each quarter based on various factors, and it is possible that an asset or liability may be classified differently from quarter to quarter. However, we expect that changes in classifications between different levels will be rare.

Most derivative contracts are not listed on an exchange and require the use of valuation models. Consistent with FASB ASC No. 820, we attempt to maximize the use of observable market inputs in our models. When observable inputs are not available, we default to unobservable inputs.

Goodwill

Goodwill represents the excess of the cost of an acquisition over the fair value of net assets acquired. Goodwill is not amortized but is tested for impairment on at least an annual basis. In accordance with FASB ASC No. 350, Intangibles—Goodwill and Other , goodwill is reviewed for impairment utilizing a two-step process.

 

86


Table of Contents

The first step of the impairment test requires the identification of the reporting units, and comparison of the fair value of each of these reporting units to the respective carrying value. We define our reporting units as Europe, Asia, North America, and South America. The recoverability of goodwill is evaluated at the following reporting units for which goodwill exists: Europe and South America. These reporting units exist at a lower level than our reportable segments. If the carrying value is less than the fair value, no impairment exists and the second step is not performed. In the second step, the impairment is computed by comparing the implied fair value of reporting unit goodwill with the carrying amount of that goodwill. FASB ASC No. 350 requires goodwill to be tested for impairment annually at the same time every year, and when an event occurs or circumstances change such that it is reasonably possible that impairment may exist. The annual impairment test is performed at year end.

We utilize an income approach to estimate the fair value of each of our reporting units. The income approach is based on projected debt free cash flow which is discounted to the present value using discount factors that consider the timing and risk of cash flows. We believe that this approach is appropriate because it provides a fair value estimate based upon the reporting units’ expected long-term operating cash flow performance. This approach also mitigates the impact of cyclical trends that occur in the industry. Fair value is estimated using recent automotive industry and specific platform production volume projections, which are based on internally-developed forecasts, as well as commercial, wage and benefit, inflation and discount rate assumptions. Other significant assumptions include terminal value growth rates, terminal value margin rates, future capital expenditures, known restructuring actions, and changes in future working capital requirements. While there are inherent uncertainties related to the assumptions used and to management’s application of these assumptions to this analysis, we believe that the income approach provides a reasonable estimate of the fair value of our reporting units. However, our assumptions and estimates may differ significantly from actual results. We also use a second approach, which is the market multiple approach, to test the reasonableness of the income approach.

Our 2009 and 2008 annual goodwill impairment analysis, completed as of each year end, indicated that the carrying value of the Europe and South America reporting units was less than the respective fair values; thus, no impairment existed at either date. The fair value of each reporting unit was substantially in excess of the carrying value.

Income Taxes

We account for income taxes under the asset and liability method, which requires the recognition of deferred tax assets and liabilities for the expected future tax consequences of events that have been included in the financial statements. Under this method, deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined based on the differences between the financial statements and tax basis of assets and liabilities using enacted tax rates in effect for the year in which the differences are expected to reverse. We record net deferred tax assets to the extent we believe that these assets will more likely than not be realized. In making such determination, we consider all available positive and negative evidence, including future reversals of existing taxable temporary differences, projected future taxable income, tax planning strategies and recent financial operations. Valuation allowances have been recorded where it has been determined that it is more likely than not that we will not be able to realize the net deferred tax assets. Due to the significant judgment involved in determining whether deferred tax assets will be realized, the ultimate resolution of these items may be materially different from the previously estimated outcome.

Pursuant to ASC 740, we have allocated a tax benefit of $4.9 million to continuing operations due to the gain in other comprehensive income offsetting a portion of the losses from continuing operations. There is a corresponding tax provision of $4.9 million charged to other comprehensive income.

Reserves for taxes are established for taxes that may become payable in future years as a result of audits by tax authorities. These tax reserves are reviewed as circumstances warrant and adjusted as events occur that affect our potential liability for additional taxes, such as conclusion of tax audits, identification of new issues, changes in federal or state laws or interpretations of the law.

 

87


Table of Contents

Impairment and Depreciation of Long-Lived Assets

Our long-lived assets are reviewed for impairment whenever adverse events or changes in circumstances indicate a possible impairment. An impairment loss is recognized when the carrying value of a long-lived asset exceeds its fair value based upon undiscounted future cash flows generated by the asset. Significant judgments and estimates used by management when evaluating long-lived assets for impairment cover, among other things, the following:

 

   

program product volumes and remaining production life for parts produced on the assets being reviewed;

 

   

product pricing over the remaining life of the parts, including an estimate of future customer price reductions which may be negotiated;

 

   

product cost information, including an assessment of the success of our cost reduction activities; and

 

   

assessments of future alternative applications of specific long-lived assets based on awarded programs.

In addition, we follow our established accounting policy for estimating useful lives of long-lived assets. This policy is based upon significant judgments and estimates as well as historical experience. Actual future experience with those assets may indicate different useful lives resulting in a significant impact on depreciation expense.

Pension and Other Postretirement Benefits

The determination of the obligation and expense for pension and other postretirement benefits is dependent on the selection of certain assumptions used by actuaries in calculating such amounts. Those assumptions are described in note 11 to the 2009 consolidated financial statements and include, among others, the discount rate, expected long-term rate of return on plan assets and expected increases in compensation and healthcare costs. In accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, actual results that differ from these assumptions are accumulated and amortized over future periods and, therefore, generally affect the recognized expense and recorded obligation in such future periods. While we believe that our current assumptions are appropriate based on available information, significant differences in actual experience or significant changes in assumptions may materially affect the pension and other postretirement obligations and the future expense.

Pension and other postretirement costs are calculated based on a number of actuarial assumptions, most notably the discount rates used in the calculation of our pension benefit obligations for the years ended December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively, of 5.75%, 6.25% and 6.25% and the discount rates used in the calculation of our postretirement benefit obligations of 6.25%, as of each of our December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007 measurement dates, respectively. The discount rates that we use are developed based on a yield curve analysis from a third party, which calculates the yield to maturity that mirrors the timing and amounts of future benefits.

The expected rate of return on pension plan assets under FASB ASC No. 715, Compensation—Retirement Benefits , of 7.25% as of December 31, 2009 and 2008, represents our expected long-term rate of return on plan assets. The rate of return assumptions selected by us reflect our estimate of the average rate of earnings expected on the funds invested or to be invested in order to provide for future participant benefits to be paid out over time. As part of this estimate, we review the existing allocation of invested assets against expectations about future performance of similar asset allocations. Future expectations were obtained from readily available public sources. Expected future returns were adjusted for expectations regarding future investment and other expenses.

 

88


Table of Contents

Based on our assumptions as of December 31, 2009 (the measurement date), a change in the discount rate or the expected rate of long term return on plan assets assumptions, holding all other assumptions constant, would have the following effect on our pension costs and obligations on an annual basis:

 

     Impact on Net
Periodic Benefit Cost
 
     Increase     Decrease  

.25% change in discount rate

   $ (1,517   $ (1,401

.25% change in expected long-term rate of return

     (367,701     367,702   
     Impact on Obligation  
     Increase     Decrease  

.25% change in discount rate

   $ (5,634,318   $ 5,878,870   

FASB ASC No. 715 and the policies we have used, most notably the use of a calculated value of plan assets for pensions as described above, generally reduce the volatility of pension expense that would otherwise result from changes in the value of the pension plan assets and pension liability discount rates. Our pension benefits relate to our plan in the United States.

Our 2010 pension expense is estimated to be approximately $4.4 million. We expect to contribute approximately $9.7 million to our pension plans in 2010.

As of July 31, 2007, future benefit payments on our other postretirement benefit plans were capped at specified amounts to be paid through 2011. See note 11 to the 2009 consolidated financial statements.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

For information regarding recent accounting pronouncements, see note 2 to our consolidated financial statements.

 

89


Table of Contents

BUSINESS

Our Company

We are a leading integrated global manufacturer of engineered structural metal components and assemblies primarily serving automotive OEMs. We offer our automotive customers a broad product portfolio, supplying body-structure stampings, frame and other chassis structures, as well as complex welded assemblies, for small and large cars, crossovers, pickups and SUVs. We have also recently entered the utility-scale solar energy market with our solar agreement to supply large stamped mirror-facet panels and welded support structures.

Our products are manufactured at 31 production facilities strategically located near our customers in North America, South America, Europe and Asia. We support our manufacturing operations through nine engineering and sales locations throughout the world. We are a disciplined, process-driven company with an experienced management team that has a history of implementing sustainable operational improvements. From January 1, 2008 through December 31, 2009, we achieved $195 million in manufacturing and purchasing cost reductions. We achieved these cost reductions in large part through successful implementation of Lean Six Sigma principles and rigorous application of global best practices. These cost reductions helped us achieve a 6% gross profit margin in 2009 during an historically challenging environment in the automotive industry. For the year ended December 31, 2009, we generated revenues of $1.6 billion and a net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC of $(67.9) million. In addition, we had Adjusted EBITDA of $125 million and an Adjusted EBITDA margin of 7.6% for the year ended December 31, 2009. For the six months ended June 30, 2010, we generated revenues of $980.8 million and a net loss attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC of $(2.6) million. In addition, we had Adjusted EBITDA of $102.4 million and an Adjusted EBITDA margin of 10.4% for the six months ended June 30, 2010.

We believe that our product capabilities, our geographic, customer and product diversification, and the cost reductions that we achieved in 2008 and 2009 position us to benefit from a recovery in global automotive industry production. We also intend to leverage our program management and engineering expertise to pursue growth opportunities outside of our existing automotive markets, as demonstrated by our solar agreement.

Our Industry

CSM Worldwide ® projects significant growth in the global automotive market, with production expected to increase from 57 million units in 2009 to 83 million units by 2013.

CSM Worldwide ® Global Light Vehicle Production Forecast (millions of units)

LOGO

 

90


Table of Contents

We believe OEMs produce a majority of their structural metal components and assemblies internally. While OEM policies differ and may be especially impacted by their own capacity utilization, the capital expenditures associated with internal production can be substantial. We believe that longer term, OEMs may outsource a greater proportion of their stamping requirements because of this capital and fixed-cost intensity and we may benefit from this shift in our customer preferences. In addition, we believe OEMs will increasingly favor global vehicle platforms supported by larger, more capable and financially strong suppliers. Given our global manufacturing footprint, cost structure and integrated design, engineering and program management capabilities, we are well-positioned to take advantage of these potential opportunities.

Our Competitive Strengths

Geographic Diversification

We are well-diversified geographically, which positions us to participate in growth opportunities as they occur over time around the world and mitigates the impact of regional production fluctuations on our business. These potential opportunities range from near-term cyclical volume recovery in North America and Europe to continued growth in emerging markets such as Brazil and China. Proximity to end customers is especially important in our business because size and weight make our products difficult and expensive to transport. Our geographic mix of revenues for 2009, 2008 and 2007 is shown below:

Geographic Mix (% of Revenues)

 

     Year Ended December 31,  

Region

   2009     2008     2007  

Europe

   40   41   37

North America

   29   32   41

South America

   10   10   6

Korea

   12   12   12

China

   9   5   4
                  

Total

   100   100   100
                  

 

91


Table of Contents

Customer Diversification

We have a well-diversified customer mix. In 2009, no single customer accounted for more than 17% of our revenues, and ten different OEMs individually accounted for 5% or more of our revenues. European OEMs, including Volvo and Opel, were our biggest customer group in 2009, followed by Asian OEMs, with Detroit 3 OEMs representing the smallest group, at 18% of 2009 revenues. Ford accounted for approximately 70% of our 2009 Detroit 3 revenues. With this customer diversification, we believe we are well-positioned to participate in the anticipated automotive recovery, while also mitigating our exposure to any individual customer. The below charts summarize our customer mix as a percent of revenues in 2009, 2008 and 2007.

Customer Mix (% of Revenues)

 

     Year Ended December 31,  

Customer

   2009     2008     2007  

VW

   17   14   11

Fiat

   13   11   9

Ford

   13   14   17

Volvo

   10   10   9

Hyundai / Kia

   10   11   12

Nissan

   6   6   9

Daimler

   5   7   6

Chrysler

   5   7   8

Toyota

   5   6   6

BMW

   5   4   4

Chery

   3   1   1

Honda

   2   3   2

Other

   6   6   6
                  

Total

   100   100   100
                  

Customer Mix by Region (% of Revenues)

 

     Year Ended December 31,  

OEM

   2009     2008     2007  

European OEMs

   54   51   43

Asian OEMs

   28   28   31

Detroit 3 OEMs

   18   21   26
                  

Total

   100   100   100
                  

Platform Diversification

Our products are offered on a diverse mix of vehicle platforms, reflecting the balanced portfolio approach of our business model and the breadth of our product capabilities. We believe that our platform diversification provides us an opportunity to participate in an industry recovery without being overly exposed to a single vehicle model. We supply products to approximately 160 vehicle models globally. Our 10 largest vehicle models represented approximately 36% of our 2009 revenues.

 

92


Table of Contents

Vehicle Platform Mix (% of Revenues)

 

     Year Ended December 31,  

Vehicle Platform

   2009     2008     2007  

Small Cars

   49   43   36

Large Cars

   21   22   24

North American Framed Vehicles

   18   16   27

Other—Light Trucks

   12   19   13
                  

Total

   100   100   100
                  

The term “small cars” refers to passenger cars that are classified by CSM Worldwide ® in the smallest three of CSM’s four categories of passenger cars, the term “large cars” refers to the largest category of passenger cars, multi-purpose vehicles and cross-over vehicles that are based on a unibody structure and the term “North American framed vehicles” refers to vehicles that are built on a full-frame structure, such as pick-up trucks and most sports utility vehicles.

Competitive Cost Structure

Based on the cost improvement actions we have taken, the results we have achieved and our experience in the automotive industry, we believe we have a competitive cost structure. During the Predecessor’s restructuring, while operating under bankruptcy protection, we achieved significant restructuring savings. For example, in North America the Predecessor reduced its manufacturing footprint from 23 to 12 plants, a 48% reduction. In addition, our average North American labor rate for hourly production workers, including wages and fringe benefits, was reduced by approximately 15%, to what we believe is a competitive level for our sector and froze our pension plan. We also capped our post-retirement healthcare liability to an amount which, at December 31, 2009, was $1.7 million. Following the acquisition of the Predecessor’s assets, we shifted aggressively to improve productivity and manufacturing throughput to world-class standards to further improve our cost structure. We launched eight operating efficiency initiatives through 2009, we launched two additional operating efficiency initiatives in 2010 and we intend to implement other efficiency programs in the future to assist us in driving costs out of our manufacturing and procurement processes.

LOGO

 

93


Table of Contents

See “Manufacturing and Operations” below for a detailed explanation of this chart.

We measure our operating efficiencies in manufacturing and purchasing cost reductions as a percentage of our material and manufacturing costs. As a result of our process-driven initiatives, we significantly increased that annual percentage from approximately 2% in 2006 to approximately 6% in 2009 resulting in $195 million in manufacturing and purchasing cost savings from January 1, 2008 through December 31, 2009. Our focus in 2010 and beyond is to retain the benefit of these achieved cost savings as anticipated volume recovery occurs.

Operating Efficiencies vs. Prior Year

(Manufacturing and Purchasing Cost Reductions as % of Manufacturing and Material Costs)

LOGO

Good Quality

Through rigorous standardization of global best practices and major process improvements such as Lean Six Sigma, we have improved our quality results, with customer-reported defects per million parts, or PPM, down to 29 in 2009.

Customer-Reported PPM

 

 

LOGO

 

94


Table of Contents

Experienced Management Team

Our senior management team has substantial industry and related operational and financial experience. In addition, the eight executives comprising our executive leadership team have been in place as a cohesive group essentially since we acquired the Predecessor’s assets in 2007. Mark Malcolm, our Chief Executive Officer since August 2007, worked for 28 years in a broad variety of roles with Ford Motor Company. Mr. Malcolm then became a senior operational adviser for Cerberus, where he led a year-long due diligence effort prior to the acquisition of the Predecessor’s assets, assessing strengths and weaknesses and developing the business plan that we have executed since the acquisition. Our Chief Operating Officer, Michael Rajkovic, worked for Ford and Visteon prior to assuming officer positions at Goodyear and U.S. Can Corporation. Jim Gouin, our Chief Financial Officer, worked for 28 years at Ford, including as Vice President, Finance and Global Corporate Controller. To maintain the quality of our management team, we engage in a comprehensive talent review and succession planning process annually.

Our Strategy

Our strategy is to strengthen our leadership position as a supplier to the global automotive industry and to expand opportunistically into non-automotive markets. We believe that our core strengths described above position us to continue to provide a high-quality, low-cost value proposition to our customers, enabling profitable growth. Specific strategic objectives include:

Revenue Growth

Our strategy for revenue growth has three main pillars: organic automotive growth, expansion into solar and other non-automotive markets, and opportunistic acquisitions and joint ventures.

Organic Automotive Growth :    Although for planning purposes we have been and remain cautious about the pace of automotive industry recovery in 2010, we believe that vehicle growth will be above-average over the next three-to-five years. Having significantly improved our cost structure over the last three years, we believe that we are poised to benefit from an anticipated cyclical recovery in the European and North American markets and to grow in developing markets like Brazil and China. In terms of organic automotive growth, our planning assumption is that our growth will roughly track the growth in annual vehicle production. We will also strive to increase our share of business principally through contract wins for new models developed by our existing customers and by expanding our customer base, while maintaining good geographic, customer and platform diversification.

Expansion into Solar and Other Non-Automotive Markets :    We intend to leverage our integrated engineering, manufacturing and program-management expertise to pursue growth opportunities in non-automotive markets. The solar industry shows promise for us, as many applications require highly engineered large stampings and complex welded structural assemblies that must be produced in high volume at repeatable tight tolerances, similar to our product requirements in the automotive industry. To date, we have won a solar agreement entered into in August 2009. The amount of revenues that we may generate from this agreement will depend in part upon the extent of the financing our customer is able to raise for its solar projects. Efforts by our customer to obtain such financing may be subject to substantial delays and may ultimately be unsuccessful. We cannot be sure when production will commence or when revenues will be generated from these projects until our customer secures appropriate financing. While we plan to invest approximately $30 to $35 million (net of government and other incentives) to support this agreement, we cannot yet predict the extent to which such spending will be made in 2010 or in subsequent periods. Our capital expenditures for these projects would include investing in a new facility in the southwest United States that could provide a base for additional expansion. We believe the solar industry in the United States and globally has the potential to grow at an average rate substantially greater than the trend rate for the automotive industry. Beyond solar, we believe there may be similar opportunities in the future to apply and extend our core skills in other industries, such as defense, wind or appliances.

Opportunistic Acquisitions and Joint Ventures :    We intend to analyze and pursue acquisition opportunities where we believe we can add value and realize synergies by improving operating results through application of

 

95


Table of Contents

our processes, as demonstrated in our own business. We anticipate that the automotive structural metals and assemblies sector will experience increased consolidation and believe that we are well-positioned to participate successfully in that evolution. We also intend to seek suitable partners to set up additional joint ventures in developing automotive markets such as China, which we believe have above-average secular growth prospects. While we regularly participate in discussions with potential acquisition targets and joint venture partners, there are presently no specific agreements that have reached the stage where execution has become probable.

Continuous Process-Driven Operating Improvements

Our business philosophy and approach is grounded in the fundamental importance of building capabilities through ongoing process awareness and improvements. That focus and mindset applies to daily plant and cash reports, to detailed monthly business reviews, to our adoption and implementation of Lean Six Sigma principles, to our global inventory reduction process, to our internal controls, to our employee engagement process that measures the involvement of our employees, and to many other critical governance and business processes employed and under development in our company. Near-term results must be delivered, but we strive to do so in a way that is repeatable and sustainable, strengthening our longer-term competitiveness to the ultimate benefit of our customers, employees, suppliers and stockholders.

Intense Focus on Cash Flow

We have a common focus and an alignment of incentives throughout our company on the importance of operating cash flow. For example, we track cash on a daily basis and our global bonus program is tied largely to cash flow metrics. This common focus and aligned incentive with respect to cash flow among all our employees helps us in seeking to create value for our stockholders. For example, inventories were reduced from 23 average days on hand in December 2007 to approximately 13 average days on hand in December 2009.

Maintain a Sound Balance Sheet

We consider it critical to maintain a sound balance sheet in the cyclical automotive industry. That mindset and approach helped us weather the severe 2009 downturn without violating our loan covenants, and we intend to maintain this approach going forward. We anticipate reducing our leverage by applying a portion of the net proceeds from this offering to repay indebtedness.

Our History and Corporate Structure

Our Corporate History

Tower Automotive, Inc., our predecessor, was formed in 1993 to acquire R. J. Tower Corporation. On February 2, 2005, Tower Automotive, Inc. along with 25 of its United States subsidiaries each filed a voluntary petition for relief under Chapter 11 of the Bankruptcy Code in the United States Bankruptcy Court, Southern District of New York. On July 11, 2007, the Bankruptcy Court confirmed the Chapter 11 Reorganization Plan of the debtors and approved the sale of substantially all of the debtors’ assets to Tower Automotive, LLC. The plan became effective on July 31, 2007, and in connection therewith, the debtors completed the sale of substantially all of their assets to Tower Automotive, LLC. As part of the sale, Tower Automotive, LLC also acquired the capital stock of substantially all of the foreign subsidiaries of Tower Automotive, Inc.

Our Corporate Conversion

Prior to the consummation of this offering, (i) all of our equity owners will transfer their equity interests in Tower Automotive, LLC to a newly created limited liability company, Tower International Holdings, LLC, (ii) Tower Automotive, LLC will convert into a Delaware corporation, which will be named Tower International, Inc., and (iii) all of the equity interests in Tower Automotive, LLC will be converted into common stock of Tower International, Inc. Thus, immediately prior to the consummation of this offering, all of our outstanding common stock will be owned by Tower International Holdings, LLC.

 

96


Table of Contents

Our Products

We produce a broad range of structural components and assemblies, many of which are critical to the structural integrity of a vehicle. We have also recently entered the utility-scale solar energy market with our solar agreement to supply large stamped mirror-facet panels and welded support structures.

 

Product Offerings
LOGO

Body structures and assemblies

Body structures and assemblies form the basic upper body structure of the vehicle and include structural metal components such as body pillars, roof rails and side sills. This category also includes Class A surfaces and assemblies. Class A surfaces are the “exterior skin” of the vehicle—body sides, hoods, doors, fenders and pickup truck boxes. These components form the appearance of the vehicle, calling for flawless surface finishes.

Complex body-in-white assemblies

Complex body-in-white assemblies are comprised of multiple components and sub-assemblies welded to form major portions of the vehicle’s body structure. We refer to body-in-whites as the manufacturing stage in which the vehicle body sheet metal has been assembled or designed but before the components and trim have been added. Examples of complex assemblies include front and rear floor pan assemblies and door/pillar assemblies.

Chassis, lower vehicle structures and suspension components

Lower vehicle frames and structures include chassis structures that make up the “skeleton” of a vehicle and which are critical to overall performance, particularly in the areas of noise, vibration and harshness, handling and crash management. These products include pickup truck and SUV full frames, automotive engine and rear suspension cradles, floor pan components, and cross members that form the basic lower body structure of the vehicle. These heavy gauge metal stampings carry the load of the vehicle, provide crash integrity, and are critical to the strength and safety of vehicles. We manufacture a wide variety of stamped, formed and welded suspension components including control arms, suspension links, track bars, spring and shock towers, shackles, twist axles, radius arms, stabilizer bars, trailing axles and brackets for OEMs worldwide.

 

97


Table of Contents

Other—Automotive

We also manufacture a variety of other automotive products, including heat shields and other precision stampings, for our OEM customers.

Other—Non-Automotive

We have a five-year solar agreement to supply large stamped mirror-facet panels and welded support structures to SES. The amount of revenues that we may generate from this agreement will depend in part upon the extent of the financing SES is able to raise for its solar projects. We cannot be sure when production will commence or when revenues will be generated from these projects until SES secures appropriate financing. In addition, SES is not required to purchase a minimum number of mirror-facet panels and welded support structures from us. For a description of risks associated with the achievement of those lifetime revenues see “Risk Factors—Our ability to recognize revenue from our agreement with Stirling Energy Systems, or SES, is subject to several risks, any one of which could materially and adversely impact our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows”.

Product Mix

We have a well-diversified product group mix. Our product group mix of revenues for 2009, 2008 and 2007 is shown below:

Product Group Mix (% of Revenues)

 

     Year Ended December 31,  

Product Group

   2009     2008     2007  

Body structures and assemblies

   56   58   60

Chassis, lower vehicle structures and suspension components

   25   23   26

Complex body-in-white assemblies

   17   17   13

Other

   2   2   1
                  

Total

   100   100   100
                  

 

98


Table of Contents

Overview of Major Vehicle Models

The following table presents an overview of the major vehicle models for which we supply products:

 

OEM

  

Models

  

Product Type

Europe      
Volvo    S40 / V50 / C30    Complex Assembly
VW    Cayenne / Touareg / Q7    Body Structures
   Octavia    Body Structures
   Caddy Van    Body Structures
BMW    1 / 3 Series    Body Structures
Daimler    Sprinter / Crafter    Body Structures & Complex Assembly
Fiat    Bravo    Body Structures
   Ducato    Body Structures
   MiTo    Body Structures
   Punto    Body Structures
North America   
Ford    Econoline   

Frame Assembly

   Expedition / Navigator    Body Structures
   F-Series    Body Structures
   Focus    Body Structures
   Taurus / Sable    Complex Assembly
   Ranger   

Frame Assembly

Chrysler    Dakota   

Frame Assembly

   Grand Caravan / Town & Country    Body Structures
   Wrangler   

Frame Assembly

Nissan    Frontier / Xterra / Pathfinder    Body Structures & Frame Assembly
   Titan / Armada / Qx56   

Frame Assembly

Toyota    Camry    Body Structures
Asia      
Hyundai    Bongo Truck    Body Structures & Frame Assembly
   Carens    Body Structures
   Carnival   

Frame Assembly

   Forte    Body Structures
   Mohave   

Frame Assembly

   Sorento    Body Structures & Frame Assembly
   Sportage    Body Structures
VW—FAW    Bora / Golf A4    Chassis
   Jetta    Chassis
Chery    A3    Chassis
   M11    Chassis
SAIC    Rover 550    Chassis
South America   
VW    Gol    Body Structures
   Fox    Body Structures
Fiat    Palio / Doblo    Body Structures
   Punto    Body Structures
Honda    Civic    Body Structures
   Fit    Body Structures

 

99


Table of Contents

Manufacturing and Operations

We focus on achieving superior product quality at the lowest operating costs possible and concentrate on improving our manufacturing processes to drive out inefficiencies. We seek to continually improve our processes in efforts to improve our cost competitiveness and to achieve higher quality. We continue to adapt our capacity to customer demand, both by expanding capabilities in growth areas and by reallocating capacity away from demand segments in decline.

We are committed to implementing Lean Six Sigma principles throughout our manufacturing processes. We utilize Lean Six Sigma principles to increase the efficiency of our operations and to reduce operating costs, thereby improving our cost competitiveness. We have accomplished efficiency improvements while at the same time improving our quality performance, with customer-reported defects per million parts reduced to 29 in 2009 from 43 and 74 in 2008 and 2007, respectively.

Our manufacturing operations consist primarily of stamping and welding operations, system and modular assembly operations, coating, and other ancillary operations. Stamping involves passing metal through dies in a stamping press to form the metal into three-dimensional parts. We produce stamped parts using precision single-stage, progressive and transfer presses, ranging in size from 150 to 4,500 tons, which perform multiple functions to convert raw material into finished products. We invest in our press technology to increase flexibility, improve safety and minimize die changeover time.

We feed stampings into assembly operations that produce complex assemblies through the combination of multiple parts that are welded or fastened together. Our assembly operations are performed on either dedicated, high-volume welding/fastening machines or on flexible cell-oriented robotic lines. The assembly machines attach additional parts, fixtures or stampings to the original metal stampings. In addition to standard production capabilities, our assembly machines also are able to perform various statistical control functions and identify improper welds and attachments. From time to time we work with manufacturers of fixed/robotic welding systems to develop faster, more flexible machinery.

Our products use various grades and thicknesses of steel and aluminum, including high–strength, hot- and cold-rolled, galvanized, organically coated, stainless, and aluminized steel. See “Supply Base—Manufactured Components and Raw Materials” below.

 

100


Table of Contents

We have launched a series of process improvements since the 2007 acquisition of the Predecessor’s assets, as reflected below. We expect to continue to benefit in the future from these and other process improvements.

 

Year
Launched

  

Process Improvement

  

Description

2007    Labor best practices standardization—hourly production labor    Adjusted hourly production labor levels to standard best practice.
2007    Lean Six Sigma    Lean Six Sigma is a data driven approach to process improvement, combining two discrete methodologies. Lean principles focus on increasing the throughput of specific manufacturing processes and Six Sigma principles focus on reducing variability in the production process.
2008    Global inventory reduction process    Systematic material order-to-delivery process designed to improve inventory efficiency by aligning inventory levels with customer demand.
2008    Real time production reporting and throughput analysis    Software was embedded in manufacturing equipment to enable production issues to be identified within real time and not at the end of a shift or work day.
2009    Capex standards (run-rate, re-use and components) and pre-production process (3P)    Upfront process and procedures that seek to provide optimal utilization of equipment investment, manpower and space requirements.
2009    Hit-to-hit standards and improvement process    Structured process seeking to reduce press changeover time and maximize utilization of production time.
2009    Cost of product quality process    Process methodology aimed at improving internal quality while reducing costs (e.g., parts re-worked and re-scrapped).
2009    Labor best practices standardization—salary    Adjusted salary personnel staffing to standard best practice levels.
2010    Materials engineering/reduction process    Procedural process seeking to drive material cost improvement through key initiatives within our company and with our customers and suppliers.
2010    Shop floor competencies    Training of shop floor personnel by providing the tools, skills and understanding needed to operate a Lean environment.

Supply Base—Manufactured Components and Raw Materials

We purchase various manufactured components and raw materials for use in our manufacturing processes. All of these components and raw materials are available from numerous sources. We employ just-in-time manufacturing and sourcing systems enabling us to meet customer requirements for faster deliveries while minimizing our need to carry significant inventory levels. The primary raw material used to produce the majority of our products is steel. We purchase hot- and cold-rolled, galvanized, organically coated, stainless and aluminized steel from a variety of suppliers. We purchase a portion of our steel from certain of our customers

 

101


Table of Contents

through various OEM resale programs. The purchases through customer resale programs have buffered the impact of price swings associated with the procurement of steel. The remainder of our steel purchasing requirements are met through contracts with steel producers and market purchases. In addition, we produce small- and medium-sized stampings, fasteners, tubing, and rubber products.

Although we have not, in recent years, experienced any significant shortages of manufactured components or raw materials, and we normally do not carry inventories of these items in excess of those reasonably required to meet our goal of just-in-time production and transportation schedule, the possibility of shortages exist, especially in light of the current weakened state of the supply base. We strive to achieve a neutral net steel impact over time.

Facilities

We are headquartered in Livonia, Michigan in a 76,300 square foot facility that we lease. This facility is utilized for management offices as well as certain customer service, engineering, human resources, information technology, finance and treasury functions. We believe that this facility is suitable for the activities conducted there.

Our manufacturing is conducted in 31 manufacturing facilities strategically located throughout North and South America, Europe and Asia. Our manufacturing facilities are supported by nine engineering and sales locations throughout the world.

 

102


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth selected information regarding each of our facilities.

 

Facility

   Country    Description of Use    Square
Feet
    Ownership
Americas Locations           

Aruja

   Brazil    Manufacturing / Office /
Technical Center
   217,900      Owned

Betim

   Brazil    Manufacturing    120,600      Owned

Auburn, Indiana

   United States    Manufacturing    162,800      Leased

Bardstown, Kentucky

   United States    Manufacturing    601,700      Owned /
Leased(1)

Bellevue, Ohio (2 locations)

   United States    Manufacturing    363,700      Owned

Bluffton, Ohio

   United States    Manufacturing    196,175      Leased

Chicago, Illinois

   United States    Manufacturing    423,700      Leased

Clinton Township, Michigan

   United States    Manufacturing    385,300      Leased

Elkton, Michigan

   United States    Manufacturing    1,100,000      Owned

Grand Rapids, Michigan

   United States    Office    5,900      Leased

Granite City, Illinois

   United States    Manufacturing    465,000 (2)    Leased

Goodyear, Arizona(3)

   United States    Manufacturing    458,800      Leased

Kendallville, Indiana

   United States    Manufacturing    142,400 (2)    Leased

Livonia, Michigan

   United States    Corporate Office /
Technical Center
   76,300      Leased

Madison, Mississippi

   United States    Manufacturing    270,500      Leased

Meridian, Mississippi

   United States    Manufacturing    412,000      Leased

Milan, Tennessee

   United States    Manufacturing    531,400 (2)    Leased

Plymouth, Michigan

   United States    Manufacturing    285,100      Leased

Smyrna, Tennessee

   United States    Manufacturing    271,000      Leased

Traverse City, Michigan

   United States    Manufacturing    220,600 (4)    Owned

Upper Sandusky, Ohio

   United States    Manufacturing    80,000 (2)    Leased
International Locations           

Gent

   Belgium    Manufacturing    346,700      Leased

Artern

   Germany    Manufacturing    164,600      Owned

Bergisch-Gladbach

   Germany    Corporate Office /
Technical Center
   99,400 (5)    Owned

Zwickau

   Germany    Manufacturing    499,000      Owned /
Leased(6)

Duisburg

   Germany    Manufacturing    110,000      (7)

Buchholz

   Germany    Manufacturing    79,900      Owned

Kaarst

   Germany    Purchasing Office    3,300      Leased

Caserta

   Italy    Manufacturing    262,500      Owned

Turin

   Italy    Manufacturing / Office /
Technical Center
   180,300      Owned

Melfi

   Italy    Manufacturing    73,600      Owned

Opole

   Poland    Manufacturing    146,000      (6)

Malacky

   Slovakia    Manufacturing    539,400      Owned

WuHu

   China    Manufacturing / Office /
Technical Center
   308,500      (8)

Changchun

   China    Manufacturing / Office /
Technical Center
   249,100      (9)

Hyderabad

   India    Engineering / Design /
Technical Center
   8,700      Leased

Yokohama

   Japan    Sales / Engineering /
Technical Center
   2,500      Leased

Kwangju Metropolitan City, Pyeongdong

   Korea    Manufacturing    237,000      Owned

 

103


Table of Contents

Facility

   Country    Description of Use    Square
Feet
   Ownership

Hwaseong-si, Gyeonggi-do

   Korea    Manufacturing    221,900    Owned

Shiheung-si, Gyeonggi-do

   Korea    Manufacturing    183,000    Owned

Ansan-si, Gyeonggi-do

   Korea    Manufacturing    60,700    Owned

Yeongcheon-si

   Korea    Manufacturing    49,400    Owned

Ulsan Metropolitan City

   Korea    Manufacturing    53,900    Owned

Gunpo-si, Gyeonggi-do

   Korea    Office / Technical Center    28,800    Owned

 

(1) Facility consists of three buildings—two buildings are leased and one building is owned.
(2) Facility is closed, but we remain subject to obligations under the operating lease.
(3) Manufacturing has not yet commenced at this facility.
(4) Facility has ceased production, although some operations remain.
(5) The manufacturing facility has been closed, but the technical center and corporate office remain open.
(6) Facility consists of two buildings—one building is leased and one building is owned.
(7) We own a building right to this facility which is leased by one of our subsidiaries to another of our subsidiaries.
(8) Facility is utilized by our joint venture. The building is owned by the joint venture.
(9) Facility is utilized by our joint venture. The building is owned by the joint venture.

Sales, Marketing and Distribution

Our sales and marketing efforts are designed to create awareness of our engineering, program management, manufacturing and assembly expertise, and to translate our leadership position into contract wins. We have developed a sales team that consists of an integrated group of professionals, including skilled engineers and program managers, which we believe provides the appropriate mix of operational and technical expertise needed to interface successfully with OEMs. We sell directly to OEMs through our sales and engineering teams at our technical and customer service centers strategically located around the world. Bidding on automotive OEM platforms typically encompasses many months of engineering and business development activity. We integrate our sales force directly into our operating team and task our sales employees and work closely, customers throughout the process of development and manufacturing a product. Our proximity to our customer base enable us to enjoy close relationships with our customers and position us well to seek future business awards.

Customers

We have developed long-standing business relationships with our customers around the world. We work together with our customers in various stages of production, including development, component sourcing, quality assurance, manufacturing and delivery. With a diverse mix of products and facilities in major markets worldwide, we believe we are well-positioned to meet customer needs. We believe we have a strong, established reputation with customers for providing high-quality products at competitive prices, as well as for timely delivery and customer service. Given that the automotive OEM business involves long-term production contracts awarded on a platform-by-platform basis, one of our business strategies is to leverage our strong customer relationships to obtain new platform awards.

Customer Support

We have nine engineering and sales locations throughout the world, including a 24-hour engineering support center in India. We believe that we provide effective customer solutions, products and service to our customers throughout the world. Our customer service group is organized into customer-dedicated teams within regions to provide more focused service to our clients.

Competition

We principally compete for new business both at the beginning of the development of new models and upon the redesign of existing models. New-model development generally begins two to five years before the marketing of such models to the public. Once a supplier has been designated to supply parts for a new program, an OEM usually will continue to purchase those parts from the designated producer for the life of the program, although

 

104


Table of Contents

not necessarily for a redesign. OEMs typically rigorously evaluate us and other suppliers based on many criteria such as quality, price/cost competitiveness, system and product performance, reliability and timeliness of delivery, new product and technology development capability, excellence and flexibility in operations, degree of global and local presence, effectiveness of customer service and overall management capability.

We believe that we compete effectively with other leading suppliers in our market. The strength and breadth of our program management and engineering capabilities, as well as our geographic, customer and platform diversification, provide the necessary scale to attempt to optimize our cost structure. We follow manufacturing practices designed to improve efficiency and quality, including, but not limited to, manpower standardization and global inventory reduction initiatives, all of which enable us to manage inventory so that we can deliver quality components and systems to our customers in the quantities and at the times ordered. Our resulting quality and delivery performance, as measured by our customers, is designed to meet or exceed their expectations.

Our major competitors include: Magna International, Inc. (Cosma division), Gestamp Automocion, Martinrea International, Gruppo Magnetto, Benteler Automotive, Thyssen Krupp (stamping group), Sungwoo and MS Auto Tech. We compete with other competitors with respect to certain of our products and in particular geographic markets. The number of our competitors has decreased in recent years and we believe will continue to decline due to supplier consolidation and the current economic downturn. OEMs have been, and we expect will continue to be, increasingly focused on the financial strength and viability of their supply base. We believe that such scrutiny of suppliers will result in additional contraction in the supply base and may force combinations of some suppliers.

In addition, a number of our major OEM customers manufacture products which compete with our products. Our OEM customers tend to outsource less when they have idle capacity. Although these OEM customers have indicated that they will continue to rely on outside suppliers, they could elect to increase the extent to which they manufacture products to meet their own requirements or to compete with us.

Joint Ventures

Joint ventures represent an important strategic part of our business. We have used our joint ventures to enter into new geographic markets, such as China, to gain new customers and/or strengthen our position with existing customers, and to develop new technologies.

When we enter new geographic markets where we have not previously established substantial local experience and infrastructure, teaming with a local partner can reduce capital investment by leveraging pre-existing infrastructure. In addition, local partners in these markets can provide knowledge and insight into local customs and practices and access to local suppliers of raw materials and components. All of these advantages can reduce the risk, and thereby enhance the prospects for the success, of an entry into a new geographic market.

Joint ventures can also be an effective means to acquire new customers and strengthen relationships with existing customers. Through joint venture arrangements, partners can access technology that they would otherwise be required to develop independently, thereby reducing the time and cost of development. Moreover, they can provide the opportunity to create synergies and applications of the technology that would not otherwise be possible.

We currently have two joint ventures in China: Tower Automotive (WuHu) Company Ltd., which we refer to as WuHu, and Changchun Tower Golden Ring Automotive Products Co., Ltd., which we refer to as TGR.

Our WuHu joint venture consists of an 80% equity interest in WuHu, a joint venture limited liability company located in WuHu City, Anhui Province, China. This joint venture primarily serves to supply Chery with front and rear lower vehicle structure modules and their respective replacement platforms.

 

105


Table of Contents

Our TGR joint venture consists of a 60% equity interest in TGR, a joint venture limited liability company located in the City of Changchun, Jilin Province, China. Our TGR joint venture primarily supplies FAW-VW Automotive Company Limited with structure based components, including sub-frames, cross members with motor carriers, rear axles, frame front-ends, and control arms and the structural components for other vehicles.

Employees

As of December 31, 2009, we had approximately 7,400 employees worldwide, of whom approximately 5,000 were covered under collective bargaining agreements.

We are not aware of any work stoppages since the inception of the Predecessor in 1993. A strike or slow-down by one of our unions could have a material adverse effect on our business. We believe that our relations with our employees are satisfactory.

Intellectual Property

By the nature of our business, the loss of any single intellectual property right owned by us or licensed to us is not likely to cause a material disruption in the manufacturing, marketing and distribution of our products.

Our customers typically own the tooling we use in the manufacture of their vehicles.

Legal Proceedings

We are from time to time involved in legal proceedings, claims or investigations that are incidental to the conduct of our business. We vigorously defend ourselves against these claims. In future periods, we could be subjected to cash costs or non-cash charges to earnings if any of these matters is resolved on unfavorable terms. However, although the ultimate outcome of any legal matter cannot be predicted with certainty, based on current information, including our assessment of the merits of the particular claims, we do not expect that our pending legal proceedings or claims will have a material adverse impact on our future consolidated financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.

Environmental Matters

We are subject to various domestic and foreign federal, state and local laws and regulations governing the protection of the environment and health and safety, including those regulating soil, surface water and groundwater contamination; the generation, storage, handling, use, disposal and transportation of hazardous materials; the emission and discharge of materials, including GHGs, into the environment; and the health and safety of our employees. We are also required to obtain environmental permits from governmental authorities for certain operations. We have taken steps to comply with these numerous and sometimes complex laws, regulations and permits. We have also achieved ISO-14001 registration for substantially all of our facilities. While compliance with environmental requirements has not had a material impact on our capital expenditures, earnings or competitive position, we have made and will continue to make capital and other expenditures pursuant to such requirements and, if we violate or fail to comply with these requirements, could be subject to fines, penalties or litigation.

Environmental laws, regulations and permits, and the enforcement thereof, change frequently and have tended to become more stringent over time. In particular, more rigorous GHG emission requirements are in various stages of development. For example, the United States Congress is considering legislation that would establish a nationwide limit on GHGs, and the EPA has finalized regulations that will affect GHG emissions from mobile and stationary sources pursuant to the federal Clean Air Act. Any regulation of GHG emissions, including through a cap-and-trade system, technology mandate, emissions tax, reporting requirement or other program, could subject us to significant costs, including those relating to emission credits, pollution control

 

106


Table of Contents

equipment, monitoring and reporting, as well as increased energy and raw material prices. In addition, our OEM customers may seek price reductions from us to account for their increased costs resulting from GHG regulations. Further, growing pressure to reduce GHG emissions from mobile sources could reduce automobile sales, thereby reducing demand for our products and ultimately our revenues. Although there is still significant uncertainty surrounding the scope, timing and effect of future GHG regulation, any such regulation could have a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition, results of operations, reputation, product demand and liquidity.

We also could be responsible for costs relating to any contamination at our or a predecessor entity’s current or former owned or operated properties or third party waste disposal sites, even if we were not at fault. Some of these locations have been impacted by environmental releases, and soil or groundwater contamination is being addressed at certain of these sites. In addition to potentially significant investigation and remediation costs, contamination can give rise to third party claims for fines or penalties, natural resource damages, personal injury or property damage. Our costs and liabilities associated with environmental contamination could be substantial and may be material to our business, financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.

Segment Overview

See note 16 to our consolidated financial statements for information on our segments.

International Operations

We have significant manufacturing operations outside the United States, and in 2009, approximately 71% of our revenues originated outside the United States. For information regarding potential risks associated with our international operations, see “Risk Factors—We are subject to risks related to our international operations.” See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and note 16 to our consolidated financial statements for further information regarding our international operations.

 

107


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT

The following table sets forth information regarding the members of our board and our executive officers. Immediately after this offering, our board of directors will be divided into three classes with staggered three-year terms.

 

Name

   Age   

Position

Mark Malcolm

   56   

President, Chief Executive Officer and Board Member

James Gouin

   50   

Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

Michael Rajkovic

   49   

Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer

William Pumphrey

   50   

President, Americas

Gyula Meleghy

   55   

President, International Operations

William Cook

   59   

Senior Vice President, Global Human Resources

Jeffrey L. Kersten

   42   

Senior Vice President and Corporate Controller

Paul Radkoski

   50   

Senior Vice President, Global Purchasing

Nicholas Chabraja

   67   

Chairman of the Board

Dennis Donovan

   61   

Board Member

Frank English, Jr.

   64   

Board Member

Chan Galbato

   47   

Board Member

Allan Gilmour

   76   

Board Member

Dev Kapadia

   38   

Board Member

Larry Schwentor

   56   

Board Member

Rande Somma

   58   

Board Member

None of our officers or board members has any family relationship with any other board member or officer. “Family relationship” for this purpose means any relationship by blood, marriage or adoption, not more remote than first cousin.

The business experience during at least the past five years of each of the directors and officers listed above is as follows:

Mark Malcolm has been a board member and our President and Chief Executive Officer since August 1, 2007. Prior to assuming that role, Mr. Malcolm served as a senior member of CCM’s operations team from January 2006 to July 2007 and played a leading role on behalf of CCM in the 2007 acquisition of Tower Automotive. Before joining CCM, Mr. Malcolm spent 28 years at Ford Motor Company in a variety of senior financial positions, including Executive Vice President and Controller of Ford Motor Credit from 2004 to 2005, Director of Finance and Strategy for Global Purchasing from 2002 to 2004 and Director of Worldwide Accounting from 2000 to 2002.

James Gouin has served as our Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer since November 1, 2007. Prior to joining us, Mr. Gouin served in 2007 as a senior managing director of the corporate financial practice of FTI Consulting, Inc., a business advisory firm. Prior to joining FTI, Mr. Gouin spent 28 years at Ford Motor Company in a variety of senior positions, including as the Vice President, Finance and Global Corporate Controller from 2003 to 2006 and as the Vice President of Finance, Strategy and Business Development of Ford Motor Company’s International Operations from 2006 to 2007.

Michael Rajkovic has been our Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer since August 1, 2007. Prior to assuming that role, Mr. Rajkovic served as a senior member of CCM’s operations team from August 2006 to August 2007 and assisted Mr. Malcolm in various aspects of the 2007 acquisition of Tower Automotive. Before joining CCM, Mr. Rajkovic was Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of United States Can Corporation, a global packaging company, from May 2005 to March 2006. Prior to his service with U.S. Can

 

108


Table of Contents

Corporation, Mr. Rajkovic served as Vice President of Finance, North America and as Chairman of the Canadian subsidiary of The Goodyear Tire and Rubber Company, an automotive products manufacturer, from August 2003 to May 2005. Prior to that period, Mr. Rajkovic held a variety of manufacturing and finance positions within Visteon Corporation, a manufacturer of climate, interior, electronic and lighting products for automobiles, from January 2000 to August 2003, during which period Visteon was owned by Ford Motor Company.

William Pumphrey joined the Predecessor in January 2005 and served as President, North American Operations for the Predecessor until our 2007 acquisition. He continued in that role with us until April 2008, when he became President, Americas, a position which he continues to hold and which covers both North and South America. Prior to joining the Predecessor, Mr. Pumphrey was employed by Lear Corporation, a manufacturer of automotive seating systems, electrical distribution systems and electronics products, from 1999 to 2004. While employed by Lear Corporation, Mr. Pumphrey at different times was responsible for that company’s Asia Pacific division, European Ford division, Daimler-Chrysler division and electrical and electronics division. From 1991 to 1999, Mr. Pumphrey held various positions in business development, product development and program management for United Technologies Automotive Inc., a manufacturer of components and systems for automotive manufacturers that was acquired by Lear Corporation in 1999.

Gyula Meleghy has been our President, International Operations since November 5, 2007. From July 2006 until November 2007, Dr. Meleghy held the position of President, Asia for the Predecessor and then for us, with oversight responsibility for all of our business in Asia. Prior to that period, Dr. Meleghy served as President, Europe and South America for the Predecessor from August 2004 to July 2006. Prior to occupying that position, Dr. Meleghy served in various positions within the Predecessor’s European operations from 2000 to August 2004. Before joining the Predecessor, Dr. Meleghy was the President of the Dr. Meleghy Group, a family-owned automotive supplier that was acquired by the Predecessor in 2000.

William Cook has been our Senior Vice President, Global Human Resources since September 2007. From 2001 to 2007 he held senior human resource leadership positions at The Goodyear Tire & Rubber Company in Akron, Ohio, including four years as Vice President of Human Resources for Goodyear North American Tire. During a fifteen year career at United Technologies Corporation Mr. Cook held key leadership positions, including four years as head of human resources for Carrier Corporation Residential and Light Commercial Systems, a supplier of heating and air conditioning equipment, and eight years as head of human resources for Otis Elevator Asia-Pacific, a supplier of elevators and escalators.

Jeffrey L. Kersten has been our Senior Vice President and Corporate Controller since February 1, 2007. He transitioned to that position from the position of Senior Vice President, Restructuring, which he held since October 2006 with the Predecessor. From 2004 to 2006, Mr. Kersten was the Predecessor’s Senior Vice President, Strategy and Business Development. Mr. Kersten joined the Predecessor in 1997, holding financial positions within the Predecessor’s Grand Rapids, Michigan offices until 2001, when he relocated to France and became the Predecessor’s European Regional Finance Leader. Mr. Kersten began his career in 1990 with the accounting firm of Arthur Andersen, where he remained until 1997, specializing in mergers and acquisitions.

Paul Radkoski has served as the Predecessor’s and our Senior Vice President, Global Purchasing, since March 2006. Prior to joining the Predecessor, Mr. Radkoski held various positions within Visteon Corporation, an automotive supplier, from 2000 until 2006, including the position of Vice President, North America Purchasing and Supplier Management from 2005 to 2006. Earlier in his career, Mr. Radkoski held various purchasing, manufacturing and logistics positions with Lear Corporation from 1997 to 2000 and automobile manufacturers BMW (from 1993 to 1997) and Honda of North America (from 1986 to 1993).

Nicholas D. Chabraja became a board member and Chairman of our board on August 24, 2010. Mr. Chabraja has been a member of the board of directors of General Dynamics, a defense industry contractor, since 1994. Mr. Chabraja was Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of General Dynamics from 1997 to 2009. He served General Dynamics as non-executive chairman from 2009 to May 2010. Previously, Mr. Chabraja had been vice chairman of General Dynamics. He joined General Dynamics in 1993 as senior vice president and

 

109


Table of Contents

general counsel. From 1994 to 1996, Mr. Chabraja was an executive vice president of General Dynamics, with the company’s strategic planning, finance, legal and investor relations functions reporting to him. Prior to joining General Dynamics, Mr. Chabraja was a senior partner in the Chicago law firm of Jenner & Block. Mr. Chabraja has served as a director of Northern Trust Corporation since 2007. He previously served as a director of Ceridian Corporation from 2001 to 2007 (and as a director of Ceridian Corporation’s predecessor from 1998-2001).

Dennis Donovan became a member of our board on August 24, 2010. Since 2009, Mr. Donovan has been a Senior Advisor of Cerberus Operations and Advisory Company, LLC, or COAC, an affiliate of CCM. From 2008 to 2009, Mr. Donovan was a senior executive and director of COAC. Mr. Donovan joined COAC in 2007 as Chief Human Resource Officer. Mr. Donovan previously served as Executive Vice President, Human Resources at The Home Depot, a home improvement retailer, from 2001 to 2007. Mr. Donovan has been a Managing Director and a member of the compensation committee of the Traxis Group, B.V., a bus manufacturer and an affiliate of CCM, since 2008. He has served as an advisor to our board and compensation committee since 2009 and to the boards of directors and compensation committees of GMI Holding Corporation, a fabric supplier, since 2008 and Freedom Group, Inc., a manufacturer of sporting goods products and an affiliate of CCM, since 2009.

Frank E. English, Jr. became a member of our board on August 24, 2010. Mr. English has served as a Senior Advisor at Morgan Stanley & Co. since his retirement from that global financial services firm in 2009. From 1976 to 2009, Mr. English served in various senior roles at Morgan Stanley & Co., most recently as Managing Director and Vice Chairman of Investment Banking from 2002 to 2009. Prior to that, Mr. English held positions in research, investment banking, capital markets and fixed income at Morgan Stanley & Co. Mr. English spent a considerable part of his career at Morgan Stanley & Co. analyzing and advising companies in the automotive industry. Since 2009, Mr. English has been a director of Arthur J. Gallagher & Co.

Chan Galbato became a member of our board on August 24, 2010. Since 2009, Mr. Galbato has been a Senior Operating Executive of Cerberus Operations and Advisory Company, LLC, an affiliate of CCM. From 2007 to 2009, Mr. Galbato owned and managed CWG Hillside Investments LLC, a consulting business providing operational and strategic turnaround expertise to chief executive officers of portfolio-based companies. From 2005 to 2007, Mr. Galbato was President and CEO of the Controls division of Invensys plc, a global technology company. Prior to his position with Invensys, he served as President of Services of The Home Depot (2003 to 2005); President and Chief Executive Officer of Armstrong Floor Products (2001 to 2003); Chief Executive Officer of Choice Parts (2000 to 2001); and Chief Executive Officer of Coregis Insurance Company, a GE Capital company (1998 to 2000). Prior to that, Mr. Galbato held various leadership positions within General Electric’s technology and industrial businesses. Since 2006, Mr. Galbato has served as a director of Brady Corporation. Since August 25, 2010, Mr. Galbato has been the chairman of the board of directors of New Page Corporation and New Page Holding Corporation.

Allan D. Gilmour became a member of our board on August 24, 2010. On August 30, 2010, Mr. Gilmour was named interim president of Wayne State University. Mr. Gilmour served as Vice Chairman of the board of directors of Ford Motor Company from 2002 to 2005, a position that he previously held from 1992 until his initial retirement in 1995. Mr. Gilmour began his career with Ford Motor Company in 1960. While at Ford, Mr. Gilmour served in a variety of roles, including: President of Ford Automotive Group; Executive Vice President, International Automotive Operations; Vice President, External and Personnel Affairs; Vice President and Controller; Chief Financial Officer; and President of Ford Motor Credit Company. Since 1995, Mr. Gilmour has served on the board of directors of DTE Energy Company, and since 2006, he has served on the board of directors of Universal Technical Institute, Inc. From 1990 to 2007, Mr. Gilmour served on the board of directors of Whirlpool Corporation.

Dev Kapadia has been a board member since August 1, 2007. Mr. Kapadia has been a Managing Director of CCM since 2003. From 1996 to 2003, Mr. Kapadia served in various capacities with The Carlyle Group, a global private investment firm, and Carlyle Management Group, an affiliate of The Carlyle Group dedicated to turnaround and special situation investments. Prior to joining Carlyle in 1996, Mr. Kapadia was a financial analyst with Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette, an investment banking firm. Mr. Kapadia serves on the boards of directors of various privately held companies.

 

110


Table of Contents

Larry Schwentor has been a board member since August 1, 2007. Mr. Schwentor has held executive and managing board positions with Peguform GmbH, or Peguform, since February 2005. Peguform manufactures interior and exterior plastic parts for the automotive industry and was a CCM portfolio company. From April 2003 to February 2005, he was an Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Key Safety Systems, Inc., a manufacturer of automotive safety restraints. Prior to assuming responsibilities at Key Safety Systems, Mr. Schwentor served as the Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Key Plastics, Inc., from September 1999 through April 2003. Key Plastics is a manufacturer of plastic components and functional assemblies for manufacturers of light vehicles and their suppliers. Both Key Safety Systems and Key Plastics were portfolio companies of Carlyle Management Group. Prior to joining Key Plastics, Mr. Schwentor was the Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of CMI International, Inc., a producer of highly engineered, cast and machined engine and structural components and assemblies for automobiles and trucks. Mr. Schwentor was employed by CMI International from May 1986 to February 1999. Mr. Schwentor was employed by the Certified Public Accounting firm of Moore, Smith and Dale from September 1976 through May 1986. During his tenure with that firm, he held various positions on the audit and management advisory services side of the firm and was responsible for auditing both public and private manufacturing companies.

Rande Somma has been a board member since August 1, 2007. Mr. Somma has been President of his consulting company, Rande Somma and Associates LLC, since May 2004. Prior to establishing that business, he was the President of Automotive Operations - Worldwide, at Johnson Controls, Inc. from 2002-2003 and was President of Automotive Operations - North America at Johnson Controls from 2000-2002. From 1988 to 2000, Mr. Somma held several different managerial positions in the Automotive Systems Group at Johnson Controls. Johnson Controls is a Tier 1 supplier of automotive systems and facility management and control products. In the automotive market, it is a major supplier of integrated seating and interior systems and batteries. Prior to joining Johnson Controls, Mr. Somma served in a variety of purchasing, manufacturing and sales positions within the automotive division of Rockwell International. Since 2005, Mr. Somma has been a member of the board of directors of Gentex Corporation, a supplier to the global automotive industry. Additionally, Mr. Somma is currently the Chairman of the Executive Board of the NewNorth Center for Design in Business, a nonprofit learning center for the delivery of intellectual and experiential training programs focused on the development and application of design centric innovation.

Mr. Kapadia was selected to be a board member based on his experience as a board member of, and senior executive with private equity firms that invest in, other manufacturing companies. Similarly, we selected Messrs. Schwentor and Somma to be board members based on their experiences as senior executives of various manufacturing companies. We selected Mr. English to be a board member because we believe his background in investment banking and capital markets will be valuable in helping us manage financing and liquidity issues. We selected Mr. Gilmour to be a board member based on his experience in finance and strategic issues involving the automotive industry. We selected Messrs. Donovan and Galbato to be board members based on their operational experience with large companies. We selected Mr. Chabraja to be a board member based on his executive level experience at General Dynamics.

Each of Messrs. Pumphrey and Kersten and Dr. Meleghy were officers of our Predecessor, when it filed for bankruptcy protection in 2005. Mr. Radkoski joined the Predecessor after it filed for bankruptcy protection. Mr. Schwentor was hired in late 1999 to assist Key Plastics through a bankruptcy process that ran from March 2000 through its conclusion in April 2001 with its sale. Mr. Schwentor remained with the successor company after its emergence from bankruptcy. Mr. Galbato was President and CEO of Armstrong World Industries, Inc. (2001-2003) after it filed for bankruptcy protection.

Board Composition

Our board currently has nine members, comprised of one executive officer (Mr. Malcolm), one officer of CCM (Mr. Kapadia), two other individuals who are affiliated with CCM (Messrs. Donovan and Galbato), two current or former consultants selected by us after consideration of their knowledge of manufacturing companies (Messrs. Schwentor and Somma) and three individuals who are unaffiliated with CCM and who our board has determined are independent (Messrs. Chabraja, English and Gilmour).

 

111


Table of Contents

In accordance with our certificate of incorporation, immediately following this offering our board of directors will be divided into the following three classes with staggered three-year terms:

 

   

Class I, whose initial term will expire at the annual meeting of stockholders to be held in 2011;

 

   

Class II, whose initial term will expire at the annual meeting of stockholders to be held in 2012; and

 

   

Class III, whose initial term will expire at the annual meeting of stockholders to be held in 2013.

The Class I directors will be Messrs. Donovan, Gilmour and Somma, the Class II directors will be Messrs. English, Galbato and Schwentor, and the Class III directors will be Messrs. Chabraja, Kapadia and Malcolm.

At each annual meeting of stockholders, the successors to directors whose terms then expire will be elected to serve from the time of election and qualification until the third annual meeting following election. Any additional directorships resulting from an increase in the number of directors will be distributed among the three classes so that, as nearly as possible, each class will consist of one-third of the directors. The division of our board of directors into three classes with staggered three-year terms may delay or prevent a change of our management or a change in control.

Board Committees

Upon completion of this offering, Cerberus will continue to control a majority of our outstanding common stock. As a result, we will be a “controlled company” within the meaning of the New York Stock Exchange corporate governance standards. Under the New York Stock Exchange rules, a company of which more than 50% of the voting power is held by an individual, group or another company is a “controlled company” and may elect not to comply with certain New York Stock Exchange corporate governance requirements, including:

 

   

the requirement that a majority of our board of directors consist of independent directors;

 

   

the requirement that we have a nominating/corporate governance committee that is composed entirely of independent directors with a written charter addressing the committee’s purposes and responsibilities;

 

   

the requirement that we have a compensation committee that is composed entirely of independent directors with a written charter addressing the committee’s purposes and responsibilities; and

 

   

the requirement for an annual performance evaluation of the nominating/corporate governance and compensation committees.

Following this offering, we intend to utilize these exemptions. As a result, we will not have a majority of independent directors and we will not have a compensation committee or nominating and corporate governance committee consisting entirely of independent directors. Accordingly, you will not have the same protections afforded to stockholders of companies that are subject to all of the New York Stock Exchange corporate governance requirements.

Audit Committee.     Upon consummation of this offering, the audit committee of our board of directors will consist of Messrs. English, Gilmour and Schwentor, and Mr. Gilmour will serve as the chairman of this committee. The audit committee assists the board in its oversight responsibilities relating to the integrity of our financial statements, the qualifications, independence, compensation and performance of our independent auditors, our systems of internal accounting and financial controls, the performance of our internal audit function, the compliance of our company with legal and regulatory requirements and compliance with our company’s Code of Business Conduct and Ethics. Upon the consummation of this offering, we will have two independent directors serving on our audit committee. We intend to have a completely independent audit committee within one year of this offering. Our board of directors will determine which member of our audit committee qualifies as an “audit committee financial expert” under SEC rules and regulations.

 

112


Table of Contents

Compensation Committee.     Upon consummation of this offering, the compensation committee of our board of directors will consist of Messrs. Chabraja, Donovan and Kapadia, and Mr. Kapadia will serve as the chairman of this committee. The primary purpose of the compensation committee of the board is to (i) facilitate our board’s discharge of its responsibilities relating to the evaluation and compensation of our executives, (ii) oversee the administration of our compensation plans, (iii) review and determine board member compensation and (iv) prepare any report on executive compensation required by the rules and regulations of the SEC and the listing standards of the New York Stock Exchange.

Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee .    Upon the consummation of this offering, the nominating and corporate governance committee of our board of directors will consist of Messrs. Chabraja, Kapadia and Galbato, and Mr. Chabraja will serve as the chairman of this committee. The purpose of our nominating and corporate governance committee is to (i) review the qualification of, and recommend to our board, proposed nominees for election to our board, consistent with criteria approved by our board, (ii) select, or recommend that our board select, the director nominees for the next annual meeting of stockholders, (iii) develop, evaluate and recommend to our board corporate governance practices applicable to our company and (iv) lead our board in its annual review of the board and management.

Prior to the consummation of this offering, our board of directors will adopt written charters under which the audit committee, compensation committee and nominating and corporate governance committee will operate. A copy of these charters, which will satisfy the applicable standards of the SEC and the New York Stock Exchange, will be available on our website at www.towerautomotive.com.

Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation

None of our executive officers serves as a member of the compensation committee or board of directors of any other entity that has an executive officer serving as a member of our board or compensation committee.

Code of Business Conduct and Ethics

We have adopted a code of business conduct and ethics that applies to all of our employees, officers and board members, including those officers responsible for financial reporting. The code of business conduct and ethics will be available on our website at www.towerautomotive.com . We expect that any amendments to the code, or any waivers of its requirements, will be disclosed on our website.

 

113


Table of Contents

COMPENSATION DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS

Introduction

The following discusses the compensation of the Named Executive Officers for the year ended December 31, 2009. As used herein, the term “Named Executive Officers” refers to:

 

   

Mark Malcolm, our President and Chief Executive Officer;

 

   

James Gouin, our Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer;

 

   

Michael Rajkovic, our Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer;

 

   

William Pumphrey, our President, Americas; and

 

   

Gyula Meleghy, our President, International Operations.

Compensation Program Objectives and Philosophy

The primary objectives of our compensation programs are to (i) attract, motivate and retain the best executive officers with the skills necessary to successfully manage our business, and (ii) align the interests of our executive officers with stockholders by rewarding them for strong company performance. In support of these objectives, we:

 

   

seek to provide a total compensation package that is competitive with other companies in our industry and other companies of a similar size and complexity;

 

   

evaluate and reward executive officers based on dynamic factors such as adopting and overseeing the implementation of processes designed to drive sustainable productivity and profitable growth; and

 

   

provide a meaningful portion of the total compensation package in the form of awards tied to the operating performance of our company. Our key performance measures are tied to Adjusted EBITDA and cash flow, each as described below.

Compensation-Setting Process

The Compensation Committee of our board has responsibility for oversight and review of our total compensation strategy, including the design and monitoring of certain executive benefit plans such as our annual cash bonus plan, which we sometimes refer to as the Tower Bonus Plan. In addition, the Compensation Committee determines the compensation of our Chief Executive Officer and reviews and approves the compensation of all officers, including each of our Named Executive Officers. In setting and reviewing compensation for our Named Executive Officers, the Compensation Committee evaluates the compensation components that it believes support our company’s objectives and philosophy.

The Compensation Committee reviews the appropriateness and effectiveness of our compensation programs. The Compensation Committee approves target award opportunities and performance criteria to be utilized in our annual cash bonus plan. In addition, the Compensation Committee is responsible for determining equity-based awards and establishing and then monitoring long-term incentive plans.

The Compensation Committee considers competitive market practices with respect to the compensation of our Named Executive Officers. The Compensation Committee also considers, in its discretion, compensation levels for our Named Executive Officers as compared to those of executives holding similar positions at other domestic and international manufacturing companies that the Committee views as comparable in terms of size and complexity of business, with additional consideration given to individual credentials. For 2008 and 2009, the Compensation Committee did not engage in formal benchmarking.

 

114


Table of Contents

In 2010, the Compensation Committee engaged an independent consultant, Hewitt Associates LLC, to provide it with advice and comparative analyses of various elements of executive compensation, including annual salary, annual variable bonus, total targeted annual cash compensation and long-term incentives.

As described elsewhere in this prospectus, upon completion of this offering, we will be a “controlled company” within the meaning of the New York Stock Exchange corporate governance standards, and therefore will not be required to have a Compensation Committee that is composed entirely of independent directors.

Role of Executive Officers in Executive Compensation

The Compensation Committee determines the total compensation for our Chief Executive Officer. Our Chief Executive Officer plays no role in determining his own compensation.

The Compensation Committee also determines the total compensation of our other Named Executive Officers acting with advice from our Chief Executive Officer. Although the Compensation Committee utilizes and considers comments, advice and recommendations of our Chief Executive Officer, the final decision with respect to compensation levels and components of the other Named Executive Officers remains with the Compensation Committee.

Components of Compensation

Our compensation programs consist of several components, although particular individuals may not be eligible for each component. The guiding principles of our compensation programs remain consistent throughout the various components. In each instance, we seek to incentivize and retain our employees by providing competitive compensation while at the same time aligning the interests of our Named Executive Officers with those of our stockholders. The principal components of our compensation programs for the Named Executive Officers are: annual base salary; annual cash bonus incentive compensation; long term incentive compensation plans and programs; equity incentive awards; retirement benefits; severance benefits; perquisites; and employment agreements, which contain termination benefits. The Compensation Committee considers such applicable components as part of an entire compensation package for our Named Executive Officers and does not ascribe weightings to any particular component.

Annual Base Salary

We use base salary to attract and retain highly qualified executive officers. When establishing base salaries for the Named Executive Officers, the Compensation Committee and the Chief Executive Officer (other than for himself) consider a number of factors, including the seniority, skills and experience of the individual, the individual’s prior salary, the functional role of the position, and the level of the Named Executive Officer’s responsibilities. The leading factors in determining increases in base salary include the performance, experience and skills of the individuals, and the employment market for senior executives with similar levels of experience and skills.

During 2009, in light of the economic environment in the automobile industry, Mr. Malcolm proposed to us, and we accepted, a reduction in his base salary by 20% and the other Named Executive Officers proposed to us, and we accepted, reductions in their base salaries by 10%. Such reductions became effective February 1, 2009. Mr. Malcolm and the other Named Executive Officers took such paycuts to illustrate their willingness to place our company’s interests ahead of their personal interests during a challenging year. Commencing January 1, 2010, the base salaries for each of our Named Executive Officers were restored to the levels that existed immediately prior to these reductions.

Annual Cash Bonus Incentive Compensation

We believe that annual cash incentive awards motivate our Named Executive Officers and reward them for annual business results that help create value for our stockholders. Each year, the Compensation Committee

 

115


Table of Contents

establishes an annual Tower Bonus Plan for the Named Executive Officers based on financial targets determined by the Compensation Committee. Other employees participate in our Tower Bonus Plan as well.

2009 Tower Bonus Plan

In April 2009, the Compensation Committee approved the Tower Bonus Plan for 2009, which we refer to as the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan. Despite the deterioration in the automotive market and in general economic conditions anticipated for 2009, the Compensation Committee determined that the annual cash bonus incentive compensation program would serve to maintain common focus and to motivate our employees to perform well during what we expected would be a difficult year.

Each Named Executive Officer was assigned a target bonus, expressed as a percentage of such participant’s base salary, without giving effect to the voluntary reductions in base salaries that occurred in 2009. Mr. Malcolm’s effective target bonus was 110.4% of his annual base salary. Mr. Malcolm’s employment agreement was amended to increase his target bonus from 100% to 125% for the last five months of the year to further motivate him to drive annual performance. Messrs. Gouin and Rajkovic had target bonuses, pursuant to their employment agreements, of 100% of their respective annual base salaries. Each of Mr. Pumphrey and Dr. Meleghy had target bonuses of 75% of their respective annual base salaries. Dr. Meleghy’s employment agreement provides for a 75% target. Mr. Pumphrey does not have an employment agreement, and although his offer letter provided him with an annual target bonus of 60% of base salary, the Compensation Committee decided to provide for a 75% target bonus in order to further motivate and incentivize Mr. Pumphrey and to equate his target bonus with Dr. Meleghy’s target bonus.

The Compensation Committee establishes the level of company performance necessary for the Named Executive Officers to earn bonus payments under the Tower Bonus Plan. For 2009, the Compensation Committee designated “Adjusted EBITDA Improvement” and “Cash Flow” as the two financial performance measures for purposes of the plan.

Adjusted EBITDA Improvement was defined as the amount by which Adjusted EBITDA in 2009 exceeded Adjusted EBITDA in 2008, excluding the impact of volume, mix and foreign exchange on Adjusted EBITDA. We determined the impact of volume, mix and foreign exchange on Adjusted EBITDA pursuant to policies that we utilize to manage our business and measure our performance throughout the year. The Compensation Committee excluded the impact of volume, mix and foreign exchange in light of the economic environment for OEMs and their suppliers during 2009. More specifically, the Committee sought to reward management based on our company successfully implementing operational efficiencies to more than offset cost increases.

The following table provides a calculation of Adjusted EBITDA Improvement for the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan:

 

     Adjusted
EBITDA
 

2009 Adjusted EBITDA

   $ 125.0   

2008 Adjusted EBITDA

     212.9   
        

Variance

   $ (87.9
        

Impact on 2009 Adjusted EBITDA of:

  

Volume and mix

   $ 147.0   

Foreign exchange

     12.5   
        

Total

   $ 159.5   
        

2009 Adjusted EBITDA Improvement

   $ 71.6   
        

 

116


Table of Contents

For purposes of the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan, the term “Cash Flow” is defined as the amount of the reduction or increase in our net debt, excluding the effect of foreign exchange and debt repurchases, if any. Net debt is defined as total debt less cash and cash equivalents. The Compensation Committee designated Cash Flow as a performance measure in order to focus our management on maximizing liquidity during a difficult economic environment where the credit markets were in distress.

The Compensation Committee retained discretion to adjust the calculation of Adjusted EBITDA Improvement and Cash Flow to account for unanticipated events. For the Named Executive Officers, the Compensation Committee weighted Adjusted EBITDA Improvement performance and Cash Flow performance, each 50%, in order to calculate bonuses under the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan.

The Compensation Committee also established a minimum threshold of performance necessary in order to earn any payouts under the Tower Bonus Plan. We had to (i) achieve Cash Flow of no less than negative $65 million and (ii) be in compliance with all covenants relating to our ABL facility and first lien term loan during 2009. The Compensation Committee and the board believed that the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan must emphasize the importance of achieving a minimum Cash Flow threshold during an economic crisis before the payment of any bonuses.

The 2009 Tower Bonus Plan established threshold amounts that must be satisfied for a payment to be made in respect of each performance measure and a target amount necessary for there to be a payout of 100 percent of an assigned bonus target percentage amount. Such thresholds and 100 percent payout targets, as well as other mid-range performance levels and payout percentages, are set forth in the table below.

 

                    Cash Flow (50%)                            

                         (in millions)                            

 

Adjusted EBITDA

Improvement (50%)

(in millions)

Achievement

 

Payout (%)

 

Achievement

 

Payout (%)

$(65)

      0%   $66.0          0%

$(50)

    15%   $81.0   18.75%

$(35)

    30%   $96.0        45%

$(15)

    70%   $116.0        85%

$0

  100%   $123.5       100%

The Compensation Committee selected Cash Flow of negative $65 million as a threshold because such amount was consistent with our business plan and selected zero dollars of Cash Flow for a 100 percent payout because operating in a cash flow neutral position would have been a significant accomplishment in light of the difficult economic environment.

The Compensation Committee selected Adjusted EBITDA Improvement of $66 million as a threshold because such amount was consistent with the Adjusted EBITDA Improvement that would be achieved if we were to only implement cost savings measures that had already been identified at the time we adopted the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan. The Compensation Committee selected Adjusted EBITDA Improvement of $123.5 million for a 100% payout recognizing that attaining that level of performance would require identifying additional significant cost savings and would be extremely difficult in the distressed economic environment of 2009, even after taking into account the plan feature that excluded the impact of volume, mix and foreign exchange in analyzing Adjusted EBITDA improvement. The Compensation Committee concluded that if such level of performance were achieved in that environment, it should be amply rewarded because it would reflect identification and implementation of additional meaningful cost savings programs.

Payouts under the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan were based on the amount by which each performance threshold was exceeded, subject to adjustment by the Compensation Committee for extraordinary events. More specifically, the payout percentage described below increased for each dollar that Cash Flow was above negative $65 million and for each dollar that Adjusted EBITDA Improvement was above $66 million. To motivate our executive officers to exceed established goals, there were no maximums or caps on payments.

 

117


Table of Contents

Payouts for results between the threshold and target levels, and above target levels, were calculated as follows. For Cash Flow,

 

   

for each $5 million of increase above negative $65 million and up to negative $35 million, the payout percentage increased by 5%;

 

   

for each $5 million increase above negative $35 million and up to $0, the payout percentage increased by 10%; and

 

   

for each $5 million of increase above $0, the payout percentage increased by 20%.

For Adjusted EBITDA Improvement,

 

   

for each $10 million of improvement above $66 million and up to $86 million, the payout percentage increased by 12.5%; and

 

   

for each $10 million of improvement above $86 million, the payout percentage increased by 20%.

The Cash Flow and Adjusted EBITDA Improvement payout percentages set forth in the above table were adjusted ratably between bands of payout percentages.

For 2009, we met the thresholds necessary to pay bonuses under the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan. We achieved compliance with the minimum requirements for a bonus payout, in that (i) Cash Flow was greater than negative $65 million, and (ii) we were in compliance with all covenants relating to our ABL facility and first lien term loan during 2009.

Our calculated Cash Flow and Adjusted EBITDA Improvement under the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan were negative $32 million and positive $71.6 million, respectively, after the bonus payment adjustment described below. Such amounts correlated to a payout percentage of 18% for Cash Flow and a payout percentage of 3.5% for Adjusted EBITDA Improvement, or an overall bonus payment amount equal to 21.5% of target bonus amounts for the Named Executive Officers. Typically, our Compensation Committee correlates a 100% bonus payout with achievement of our business plan goals for the year. For 2009, our business plan established an Adjusted EBITDA target of $125 million, significantly less than the $212.9 million of Adjusted EBITDA achieved during 2008. When the Compensation Committee established the performance standards in the first quarter of 2009, the conditions in the automotive market were so precarious that the Compensation Committee opted for use of an Adjusted EBITDA Improvement measure rather than an Adjusted EBITDA measure. In the view of the Compensation Committee, the steps taken by management during 2009 to conserve cash, improve efficiencies and reduce costs, as well as the voluntary reductions in salary agreed to by management, were instrumental in enabling our company to achieve the Adjusted EBITDA target of $125 million for 2009. In evaluating performance, the Compensation Committee also took into account management’s willingness to make cash flow judgments independent of the impact under the bonus plan, management’s efforts to maintain liquidity during a challenging year and management’s control of our net debt position. As a result, the Compensation Committee exercised its discretion to increase the overall payment amount from 21.5% to 62.6% of target bonus amounts for the Named Executive Officers, which resulted in an additional aggregate bonus payment to all plan participants of $3.3 million.

We calculated our 2009 annual cash incentive award for Mr. Malcolm as follows: the payout percentage of 62.6% multiplied by (ii) Mr. Malcolm’s individual bonus target percentage of base salary (110.4%)  multiplied by (iii) Mr. Malcolm’s base salary of $800,000, resulting in a $552,718 overall bonus award. We calculated the 2009 annual cash bonus awards for the other Named Executive Officers in the same manner.

2010 Tower Bonus Plan

On February 13, 2010, the Compensation Committee approved the 2010 Tower Bonus Plan. The 2010 plan is structured similarly to the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan. The Compensation Committee established the level of performance necessary for the Named Executive Officers to earn their targeted payouts and assigned each Named

 

118


Table of Contents

Executive Officer a target percentage of base salary. For 2010, the Compensation Committee designated “Ongoing Margin Improvement” (which is the same as Adjusted EBITDA Improvement used in the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan), Adjusted EBITDA and Cash Flow as the three financial measures used to determine payouts. Ongoing Margin Improvement performance will account for 40% of the total award, Adjusted EBITDA performance will account for 30% of the total award and Cash Flow performance will account for 30% of the total award. The Compensation Committee added Adjusted EBITDA as a performance measure as it is consistent with how management evaluates the business and would have been a performance measure under the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan if not for the distressed economic environment at the time that the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan was adopted.

The Compensation Committee also established a minimum threshold of performance necessary in order to earn any payouts under the 2010 Tower Bonus Plan. That minimum threshold involves achieving a level of Adjusted EBITDA that is greater than 2009 Adjusted EBITDA and maintaining compliance with all covenants relating to our bank debt during 2010. There is no maximum payout under the plan. As was the case with the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan, the 2010 Tower Bonus Plan was designed in this manner to motivate the Named Executive Officers and other employees to meet and exceed established performance levels. The performance thresholds necessary for the Named Executive Officers to earn their targeted payouts have been established by the Compensation Committee at levels intended to be challenging, but attainable.

Equity-Based Incentive Awards

We believe providing our Named Executive Officers with equity interests in our company motivates them to make decisions that will build the long-term value of our company and aligns their interests with those of our stockholders. However, no form of equity was awarded to our Named Executive Officers in 2009.

Management Incentive Plan

Tower Automotive Management, LLC, an affiliate of our company, consummated the sale of units of non-voting membership interests in itself, which we refer to as the Management MIP Units, to eight of our executive officers, including each of the Named Executive Officers, and to certain of our board members and consultants. Tower Automotive Management, LLC made such sales pursuant to the Tower Automotive Management, LLC management incentive plan. In this prospectus, we refer to Tower Automotive Management, LLC as Tower Management, LLC, and we refer to the Tower Automotive Management, LLC management incentive plan as the MIP.

Tower Management, LLC, in turn, purchased an equal number of equity interests in our company, which we refer to as the MIP Units. Tower Management, LLC has no assets other than the MIP Units. Accordingly, the Management MIP Units held by our Named Executive Officers and certain of our board members and consultants represent indirect ownership interests in the MIP Units.

The MIP is designed to align the interests of Management MIP Unit holders with those of our stockholders by providing such holders with an indirect ownership interest in us.

We awarded a cash bonus payment to each Named Executive Officer in an amount equal to the purchase price for the Management MIP Units ($500 per unit) together with a “gross-up” payment intended to compensate each Named Executive Officer for the estimated income taxes such person would incur as a result of receiving the bonus payment. Executives, including the Named Executive Officers, purchased an aggregate of 925 Management MIP Units for an aggregate purchase price of $462,500. In connection with the related purchases, we awarded bonuses to our executives in an aggregate amount of $462,500 and aggregate gross-up payments that totaled $267,072. Mr. Malcolm purchased 300 Management MIP Units; Messrs. Gouin and Pumphrey and Dr. Meleghy each purchased 100 Management MIP Units; and Mr. Rajkovic purchased 175 Management MIP Units.

 

119


Table of Contents

The Management MIP Units, when purchased, were subject to time-vesting and performance-vesting requirements. In 2010, the Compensation Committee removed the performance-vesting requirements for our executives in exchange for application of the time-vesting requirement to 100% of the awarded Management MIP Units. In making a recommendation to our board in support of the elimination of the performance-based vesting metric, the Compensation Committee determined that changing the original performance-based vesting event targets to time-vesting events would foster the retention of key executives. The Compensation Committee did not believe it was necessary to reset the performance-based vesting event in order to achieve these goals. For each of Messrs. Malcolm, Rajkovic and Pumphrey and Dr. Meleghy, 25% of the participant’s time-based Management MIP Units vested on August 1, 2008, and the remaining time-based Management MIP Units are scheduled to vest in equal amounts on the successive three anniversaries of the first vesting date. For Mr. Gouin, 25% of his Management MIP Units vested on November 19, 2008, and his remaining time-based Management MIP Units are scheduled to vest in equal amounts on the successive three anniversaries of his first vesting date. In connection with the elimination of the performance vesting requirements that were applicable to a portion of the Management MIP Units, each participant became vested in the number of his performance-based Management MIP Units that would have been vested as of such date had they originally been subject to the same vesting requirements as the time-based Management MIP Units. The remainder of each of such performance-based Management MIP Units will vest in accordance with the same schedule as their time-based Management MIP Units. Management MIP Units also fully vest if a “Liquidation Event” (as defined in the MIP) occurs while a holder is employed by us. This offering will not constitute a liquidation event under the MIP. A “Liquidation Event” under the MIP occurs if we sell all or substantially all of our assets, if we consummate a merger, acquisition or sale in which our stockholders receive consideration for at least 50% of their equity interests, if we liquidate or dissolve or if Tower International Holdings, LLC undergoes a reorganization or similar transaction that its board of managers declares to be a Liquidation Event.

After giving effect to our Corporate Conversion, the Management MIP Units will represent indirect equity interests in Tower International Holdings, LLC, and will remain outstanding following consummation of this offering. Tower International Holdings, LLC will have the same capital structure as we had prior to the consummation of the Corporate Conversion. As described in footnote 9 to the tables set forth in “Prospectus Summary—“Summary Consolidated Financial Data”, on August 12, 2010, the preferred units, common units and MIP Units of Tower Automotive, LLC were converted into capital units of Tower Automotive, LLC. Such conversions did not impact the outstanding Management MIP Units described herein.

Holders of Management MIP Units will not be entitled to any distributions from Tower International Holdings, LLC until Cerberus receives distributions from Tower International Holdings, LLC of $205.9 million plus a ten percent return on unpaid distributions, such return running from July 31, 2010 with respect to $180.9 million of such gross amount and from August 24, 2010 with respect to the balance. A total of 8,500 capital units of Tower Automotive, LLC are owned by Cerberus and a total of 1,500 capital units of Tower Automotive, LLC are owned by Tower Management, LLC. See “—Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year-End” below for additional information regarding the Management MIP Units.

No MIP Units or Management MIP Units were issued or sold in 2009 and we do not expect to issue or sell any additional MIP Units or Management MIP Units.

2010 Equity Incentive Plan

Our board has adopted a new equity incentive plan—which we refer to as our 2010 Equity Incentive Plan—pursuant to which a total of              shares of our common stock are authorized for issuance in the form of stock options, restricted stock awards and other equity-based awards. See “— Long Term Incentive Compensation Awards” below.

In addition to the RSU’s described below under “—Long-Term Incentive Compensation Awards”, we intend to grant stock options covering              shares of our common stock to our executive officers, board

 

120


Table of Contents

members and other employees. These options will have an exercise price equal to the price paid by the public in this offering. We expect that these options will vest ratably on March 1, 2012, March 1, 2013 and March 1, 2014. Such stock options will also vest in full upon the occurrence of a change in control of our company as defined in our 2010 Equity Incentive Plan. With respect to these stock options, we expect that stock options covering the following number of shares of our common stock will be granted to the following persons: Mr. Malcolm,              shares; Mr. Gouin,              shares; Mr. Rajkovic,              shares; Mr. Pumphrey,              shares; Dr. Meleghy,              shares; all other executive officers as a group,              shares; all other employees as a group,              shares; Mr. Chabraja,             shares; Mr. Donovan,              shares; Mr. English,              shares; Mr. Galbato,              shares; Mr. Gilmour,              shares; and Mr. Kapadia,              shares.

Long Term Incentive Compensation Awards

We entered into long-term compensation agreements with senior executives, including all of our Named Executive Officers and certain directors, as a means of recognizing their performance since August 1, 2007. We refer to these agreements collectively as our 2010 Long-Term Incentive Program. The Compensation Committee believes that this program will serve as a retention and motivation tool.

In connection with the consummation of this offering, we intend to grant RSUs covering the following number of shares of our common stock to the Named Executive Officers, as well as to other executive officers and to board members Larry Schwentor and Rande Somma. All such RSUs will be granted under our 2010 Equity Incentive Plan.

 

   

for our Named Executive Officers: Mr. Malcolm,              RSUs; Mr. Gouin,              RSUs; Mr. Rajkovic,              RSUs; Mr. Pumphrey,              RSUs; and Dr. Meleghy,              RSUs;

 

   

for other executive officers as a group:              RSUs; and

 

   

for two of our non-employee directors (each of whom is also a consultant to our company): Mr. Schwentor,              RSUs; and Mr Somma,              RSUs.

Provided that we close this offering during 2010, such RSUs will vest according to the following schedule:

 

   

fifty percent of the RSUs will vest nine months after consummation of this offering, which date we refer to as the First Vesting Date; and

 

   

the balance of the RSUs will vest eighteen months after the consummation of this offering, which date we refer to as the Second Vesting Date.

Such RSUs will vest on the vesting date described above if the executive is employed by us on such vesting date. Such RSUs will also vest in full upon the occurrence of a change in control of our company, as defined in our 2010 Equity Incentive Plan.

Such RSUs shall also vest for an executive in the event that we or one of our applicable affiliates terminate the executive’s employment for any reason other than for “cause”, as defined in the plan, or the executive’s employment terminates due to death or disability. In the case of such a non-cause termination,

 

   

that occurs prior to the First Vesting Date, 50% of the RSUs will vest on the earlier to occur of (i) the First Vesting Date and (ii) December 31 of the calendar year during which such non-cause termination occurs; and

 

   

that occurs after the First Vesting Date but before the Second Vesting Date, 100% of the RSUs will vest on the earlier to occur of (i) the Second Vesting Date and (ii) December 31 of the calendar year during which such non-cause termination occurs.

The Compensation Committee believes that the above vesting dates are appropriate in light of the performance of our executives in guiding our company in a difficult economic environment.

 

121


Table of Contents

Special Incentive Compensation

In February 2010, our Compensation Committee approved the creation of a special incentive program, which we refer to as the Special Incentive Program. The Special Incentive Program provides for an aggregate bonus pool of $5.5 million. The Special Incentive Program was designed to recognize the performance of the Named Executive Officers and certain other senior executives in our achieving certain events, including the retirement of our first lien term loan.

Our board has determined that the closing of the notes offering and the consequent repayment of the outstanding first lien term loan (excluding the related synthetic letter of credit facility) triggered the payment of awards under the Special Incentive Program. Accordingly, in connection with that offering, Messrs. Malcolm, Gouin, Rajkovic and Pumphrey and Dr. Meleghy received cash bonuses under the Special Incentive Program in the amounts of $1,750,000, $1,000,000, $1,350,000, $400,000 and $400,000, respectively. Our board also amended the Special Incentive Program to provide for the payment of $1.2 million to certain executive officers upon the earlier to occur of the consummation of this offering or August 24, 2011; Mr. Pumphrey and Dr. Meleghy will each receive $345,000 of such amount.

Defined Contribution Plan Retirement Benefits

We maintain a 401(k) Plan, a qualified defined contribution plan, and the Named Executive Officers resident in the United States are eligible to participate in this plan. We match 100% of the first 1% of each participant’s compensation that is contributed to the plan and 50% of the next 5% of such participant’s compensation that is contributed to the plan.

Employment Agreements and Severance Benefits

We have entered into employment agreements with each of the Named Executive Officers, other than William Pumphrey, whose employment terms are set forth in an offer letter. The employment agreements provide for the payment of severance benefits to the Named Executive Officers under specified circumstances. In entering into these agreements, we considered the benefit of receiving confidentiality, non-competition, non-solicitation and non-disparagement protections. The amount and type of benefits under the employment agreements are described below under “—Potential Payments Upon Termination—Severance—Employment Agreements.”

Perquisites and Other Benefits

Messrs. Malcolm, Gouin, Rajkovic and Pumphrey and Dr. Meleghy receive non-accountable cash perquisites in annual gross amounts of $25,000, $25,000, $25,000, $35,000 and $10,800, respectively. We consider such amounts to be market competitive and part of the compensation package we believe is necessary to attract key talent. There are no restrictions on how each Named Executive Officer may use such cash perquisites.

The Named Executive Officers participate in our other benefit plans on the same terms as other employees. These plans include medical and dental insurance and life insurance.

Stock Ownership Guidelines

There are currently no equity ownership requirements or guidelines that any of our Named Executive Officers or other employees must meet or maintain.

Policy Regarding Restatements

We do not currently have a formal policy requiring a fixed course of action with respect to compensation adjustments following a restatement of financial results. If we were to consider a restatement of our financial statements, our board or the Compensation Committee would evaluate whether future compensation adjustments were appropriate based upon the facts and circumstances surrounding the restatement.

 

122


Table of Contents

Internal Revenue Code Section 162(m)

Section 162(m) of the Internal Revenue Code generally disallows a tax deduction for compensation in excess of $1 million per year paid by a publicly held corporation to its chief executive officer, chief financial officer and to each of its three other most highly compensated executive officers, unless the compensation qualifies as “performance-based” or is otherwise exempt from Section 162(m). Under a transition rule, for a limited period of time after a company becomes publicly held, the deduction limits do not apply to any compensation paid pursuant to a compensation plan or agreement that existed during the period in which the corporation was not publicly held. The Compensation Committee will consider the potential impact of Section 162(m) on compensation decisions, and intends to maintain flexibility to approve compensation for an executive officer that does not meet the deductibility requirements of Section 162(m) in order to provide competitive compensation packages.

Compensation Tables

The following table summarizes the compensation paid by us to the Named Executive Officers for services rendered during the fiscal years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008.

2009 Summary Compensation Table

 

Name and Principal Position

   Year    Salary     Bonus     Non-Equity
Incentive Plan
Compensation(1)
   All Other
Compensation
    Total

Mark Malcolm

   2009    $ 653,333 (2)      —        $ 552,718    $ 26,260 (3)    $ 1,232,312

President and Chief Executive Officer

   2008    $ 800,000      $ 247,117 (4)    $ 999,200    $ 26,470 (3)    $ 2,072,787
              

James Gouin

   2009    $ 408,750 (5)      —        $ 281,565    $ 26,199 (3)    $ 716,514

Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

   2008    $ 450,000      $ 82,372 (4)    $ 562,050    $ 26,200 (3)    $ 1,120,622

Michael Rajkovic

   2009    $ 499,584 (5)      —        $ 344,135    $ 26,260 (3)    $ 869,979

Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer

   2008    $ 550,000      $ 144,152 (4)    $ 686,950    $ 26,403 (3)    $ 1,407,504

William Pumphrey

   2009    $ 408,750 (5)      —        $ 211,174    $ 73,184 (6)    $ 693,108

President, Americas

   2008    $ 450,000      $ 82,372 (4)    $ 421,538    $ 36,537 (7)    $ 990,447

Gyula Meleghy

   2009    $ 418,560 (5)      —        $ 216,242    $ 319,967 (9)    $ 954,769

President, International Operations(8)

   2008    $ 460,800      $ 107,944 (10)    $ 431,654    $ 578,187 (11)    $ 1,578,585

 

(1) Amounts earned pursuant to the Tower Bonus Plan.
(2) For 2009, reflects a 20% voluntary reduction in annual base salary from February through December 2009.
(3) Represents a non-accountable cash perquisite of $25,000 and the cost of certain insurance premiums.
(4) Represents bonus paid to the executive in connection with his purchase of Management MIP Units.
(5) For 2009, reflects a 10% voluntary reduction in annual base salary from February through December 2009.
(6) Amount includes $35,000 as a perquisite allowance to be used for a vehicle lease, financial and tax planning, and club dues; also includes a $36,986 guaranteed payment pursuant to the terms of Mr. Pumphrey’s offer letter and $1,198 for the cost of certain insurance premiums.
(7) Represents $35,000 as a perquisite allowance to be used for a vehicle lease, financial and tax planning, and club dues and $1,537 for the cost of certain insurance premiums.

 

123


Table of Contents
(8) Amounts for Dr. Meleghy were converted from Euros to U.S. dollars using the exchange rate effective December 31, 2009 of €1.00 to $1.44 and from Yen to U.S. dollars using the exchange rate effective December 31, 2009 of ¥92.43 to $1.00.
(9) Amount includes $19,039 representing the cost of a company vehicle, $14,674 in cell phone costs, $10,800 as a perquisite allowance and $15,846 in company-paid insurance payments. Also, includes allowances pursuant to Dr. Meleghy’s expatriate assignment which includes $48,600 as a goods and services allowance, $9,806 as a car and driver allowance, $77,825 as a housing allowance, $3,253 as a utilities allowance, $6,395 as a home leave allowance, $1,921 as a furniture allowance, $1,812 as a club membership allowance, and $109,996 in tax gross-ups.
(10) Includes $50,704 paid to Dr. Meleghy in connection with his purchase of Management MIP Units and $57,240 representing a retention bonus.
(11) Amount includes $21,600 as a perquisite allowance and $15,515 in company-paid insurance premiums. Also, includes allowances pursuant to Dr. Meleghy’s expatriate assignment, which includes $97,200 as a goods and services allowance, $19,612 as a car and driver allowance, $168,776 as a housing allowance, $5,831 as a utilities allowance, $16,903 as a home leave allowance, $14,033 as a furniture allowance, $3,953 as a club membership allowance, $23,450 as an education allowance and $191,313 in tax gross-ups.

Grants of Plan-Based Awards

The following sets forth certain information with respect to grants of plan-based awards for the year ended December 31, 2009 made to our Named Executive Officers.

2009 Grants of Plan-Based Awards

 

Name

   Estimated Future Payouts  Under
Non-Equity Incentive Plan Awards(1)
   Threshold
($)(2)
   Target
($)(3)
   Maximum
($)(4)

Mark Malcolm

   —      $ 883,360    —  

James Gouin

   —      $ 450,000    —  

Michael Rajkovic

   —      $ 550,000    —  

William Pumphrey

   —      $ 337,500    —  

Gyula Meleghy

   —      $ 337,500    —  

 

(1) Dollar amounts represent the potential award opportunities at the threshold, target and maximum levels under the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan. No other awards were made under the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan to the Named Executive Officers during 2009. Amounts actually earned are reflected in the Summary Compensation Table.
(2) Participants under the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan are entitled to a payout so long as the minimum criteria for payments under the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan are satisfied. The minimum criteria under the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan required that we remain in compliance with all debt covenants during 2009 relating to our ABL facility and first lien term loan and that we achieve Cash Flow of at least negative $65 million and Adjusted EBITDA Improvement of at least positive $66 million. The chart above reflects that if those criteria were met but not exceeded, no payouts would have been made.
(3) Represents the amounts that would have been paid if we remained in compliance with all debt covenants during 2009 relating to our ABL facility and first lien term loan and achieved break-even Cash Flow and Adjusted EBITDA Improvement of $123.5 million.
(4) There is no maximum amount of cash bonus awards under the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan.

 

124


Table of Contents

Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year-End Table

The following 2009 Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year-End table summarizes our Named Executive Officers’ outstanding equity awards under all plans at December 31, 2009.

2009 Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year-End

 

Name

   Unit Awards
   Number of
Management MIP
Units That Have
Not Vested (#)
   Market Value of
Management MIP Units
That Have

Not Vested ($)(1)

Mark Malcolm

   237.5   

James Gouin

   75   

Michael Rajkovic

   131   

William Pumphrey

   80   

Gyula Meleghy

   80   

 

(1) There was no established market value for the Management MIP Units at December 31, 2009 and we do not expect that there will be an established market value for the Management MIP Units when this offering is completed. If (i) a liquidation event had occurred on December 31, 2009 under the MIP, (ii) the Corporate Conversion had occurred on or before that date and (iii) the Management MIP Units had a market value that is equal to the valuation of such units determined by Tower Automotive, LLC as of February 19, 2010 pursuant to FASB ASC 718 “Stock-based Compensation”, which we refer to as the Implied MIP Unit Value, each of Mr. Malcolm’s, Mr. Gouin’s, Mr. Rajkovic’s and Mr. Pumphrey’s and Dr. Meleghy’s unvested Management MIP Units would have had values of $0.

Units Vested Table

The table below shows the Management MIP Units held by the Named Executive Officers that vested in 2009 as well as the total number of vested Management MIP Units held by the Named Executive Officers.

 

Name

   Unit Awards    Total Vested
Management
MIP
Units(2)
   Number of
Management
MIP Units
Acquired on
Vesting in
2009
   Value
Realized on
Vesting in

2009(1)
  

Mark Malcolm

   31.25       62.5

James Gouin

   12.5       25

Michael Rajkovic

   22       44

William Pumphrey

   10       20

Gyula Meleghy

   10       20

 

(1) If at December 31, 2009, each Management MIP Unit had a value equal to the Implied MIP Unit Value, the value realized on vesting in 2009 for Messrs. Malcolm, Gouin, Rajkovic, Pumphrey and Meleghy would have each been $0.
(2) Represents all vested Management MIP Units held by the Named Executive Officer as of December 31, 2009.

Potential Payments Upon Termination

Severance—Employment Agreements

We have employment agreements with each of Messrs. Malcolm (dated August 1, 2007, as amended), Gouin (dated November 1, 2007, as amended) and Rajkovic (dated August 16, 2007, as amended) and

 

125


Table of Contents

Dr. Meleghy (dated February 15, 2000). Each of the employment agreements was approved and authorized by the Compensation Committee or our board (other than Dr. Meleghy’s agreement, which was assumed by the Predecessor). Our employment agreements with Messrs. Malcolm, Gouin and Rajkovic have been extended such that their terms will continue until July 31, 2012, October 31, 2012 and August 15, 2012, respectively, with each agreement being extendable for successive one-year periods or, if the executive agrees, two-year periods. The current term of Dr. Meleghy’s employment agreement expires on December 31, 2011. Dr. Meleghy’s employment agreement is automatically renewable for periods of 12 months on each January 1 unless either he or we provide the other with notice of non-renewal at least six months before the term would renew. Mr. Pumphrey does not have an employment agreement specifying a term of employment, but he does have an offer letter that sets forth certain terms and conditions of his employment.

Each agreement provides for a minimum annual base salary ($800,000 for Mr. Malcolm, $450,000 for Mr. Gouin, $550,000 for Mr. Rajkovic, and €300,000 for Dr. Meleghy; and effective August 1, 2010, we increased Mr. Malcolm’s base salary to $840,000, Mr. Gouin’s base salary to $472,500, Mr. Rajkovic’s base salary to $577,500 and Dr. Meleghy’s base salary to €336,000), and the agreements for Messrs. Malcolm, Rajkovic and Gouin provide that the executive’s base salary may be increased from time to time at our discretion. Mr. Pumphrey’s offer letter provides for an annual base salary of $450,000 and effective August 1, 2010, we increased Mr. Pumphrey’s base salary to $472,500. Each of the agreements and Mr. Pumphrey’s offer letter also provide for eligibility for annual incentive compensation at the target level of 130% of base salary for Mr. Malcolm, 105% of base salary for Messrs. Gouin and Rajkovic and 80% of base salary for Dr. Meleghy. Mr. Pumphrey’s offer letter provides for a target annual incentive of 60% of his base salary, which amount we subsequently increased to 80%.

If Messrs. Malcolm’s, Gouin’s or Rajkovic’s employment is terminated by us for “cause”, or in the case of Messrs. Malcolm and Gouin by the executive without “good reason,” as these terms are defined in their respective employment agreements, the executive will be entitled to receive the following benefits, which we refer to as the accrued benefits:

 

   

the amount of any base salary earned and due but not paid through the date of termination;

 

   

the amount of any annual bonus relating to the calendar year prior to the year of termination that was earned on the applicable bonus approval date but unpaid; and

 

   

any reimbursable expenses that have not been reimbursed.

If Mr. Malcolm’s, Mr. Gouin’s or Mr. Rajkovic’s employment is terminated due to his death or disability, if we terminate any such executive’s employment without “cause,” if he terminates his employment for “good reason” (other than in the case of Mr. Rajkovic) or if his employment agreement terminates because we do not elect to extend the term of the agreement, he will receive the following benefits:

 

   

the accrued benefits;

 

   

an aggregate amount equal to (i) in the case of Mr. Malcolm, two times his annualized base salary in effect as of the effective date of termination payable in 12 equal monthly installments, and (ii) in the case of Messrs. Gouin and Rajkovic, one times his annualized base salary in effect as of the effective date of termination payable in 12 equal monthly installments;

 

   

a pro-rated portion (based on the number of days in the calendar year up to and including the date of termination) of the annual bonus relating to the calendar year of termination based on the actual awards for the plan year of termination (or a reasonable good faith determination of the expected amount of the actual awards if the actual awards are not determinable by March 15 of the calendar year following the calendar year of termination); and

 

   

COBRA premiums will be waived to the extent the cost of coverage exceeds the cost we charge for active employees for similar coverage, until the first to occur of (i) the first twelve months of COBRA coverage or (ii) the date the executive is covered under another group health plan.

If Mr. Pumphrey’s or Dr. Meleghy’s employment is terminated involuntarily and without cause, the executive will be entitled to receive, pursuant to our executive severance policy, the following benefits:

 

   

the accrued benefits;

 

126


Table of Contents
   

an amount up to one times his annualized base salary as of the effective date of termination;

 

   

a pro-rated portion (based on the number of days in the calendar year up to and including the date of termination) of the annual bonus relating to the calendar year of termination based on the actual bonus amounts paid to other similarly situated executive officers for the plan year of termination; and

 

   

COBRA premiums will be waived to the extent the cost of coverage exceeds the cost we charge for active employees for similar coverage, until the first to occur of (i) the first twelve months of COBRA coverage or (ii) the date the executive is covered under another group health plan.

Dr. Meleghy may be entitled to additional benefits under German law.

The following tables set forth the benefits potentially payable to each Named Executive Officer in the event of a termination of such person’s employment, assuming that such events occurred as of the date of the consummation of this offering:

 

Mark Malcolm

   Severance
Amounts(1)
    Benefits
Continuation
    Vested
    RSUs    
    Total

Termination by us for any reason (other than by us for cause) or because we do not extend the term of Mr. Malcolm’s employment agreement

   $ 1,680,000 (2)    (3)    $                  (4)    $                 

Termination by Mr. Malcolm for good reason

   $ 1,680,000 (2)    (3)      —        $ 1,680,000

Termination by us for cause

     —                —          —  

Termination by Mr. Malcolm without good reason

     —                —          —  

 

(1) In the event of any termination either by us or by the executive, the executive is entitled to the accrued benefits as described under “Severance—Employment Agreements”. In the event that this offering is consummated and thereafter Mr. Malcolm’s employment is terminated by us other than for cause or by Mr. Malcolm for good reason, the vesting of Mr. Malcolm’s RSUs will accelerate.
(2) Aggregate amount represents two times Mr. Malcolm’s annualized rate of base salary as of the effective date of termination in accordance with the terms of his employment agreement. Aggregate amount does not include a pro-rated portion of the 2010 annual bonus Mr. Malcolm would be entitled to receive in the event of such a termination during 2010, as more fully described above.
(3) Pursuant to Mr. Malcolm’s employment agreement, COBRA premiums will be waived to the extent the cost exceeds the cost we charge for active employees for similar coverage for 12 months. Mr. Malcolm has waived health coverage.
(4) Represents the value of RSUs that accelerate upon termination, based on the number of RSUs expected to be granted multiplied by the price to the public in this offering. See “—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—Long Term Incentive Compensation Awards”. Assumes such RSUs were issued immediately prior to consummation of the offering and the price to the public equals the mid-point of the range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus.

 

James Gouin

   Severance
Amounts(1)
    Benefits
Continuation
    Vested
    RSUs    
    Total

Termination by us for any reason (other than by us for cause) or because we do not extend the term of Mr. Gouin’s employment agreement

   $ 472,500 (2)    $ 10,705 (3)    $                  (4)    $                 

Termination by Mr. Gouin for good reason

   $ 472,500 (2)    $ 10,705 (3)      —        $ 483,205

Termination by us for cause

     —          —          —          —  

Termination by Mr. Gouin without good reason

     —          —          —          —  

 

(1) In the event of termination either by us or by the executive, the executive is entitled to the accrued benefits as described under “Severance—Employment Agreements”. In the event that this offering is consummated and thereafter Mr. Gouin’s employment is terminated by us other than for cause or by Mr. Gouin for good reason, the vesting of Mr. Gouin’s RSUs will accelerate.
(2) Aggregate amount represents one times Mr. Gouin’s annualized rate of base salary as of the effective date of termination in accordance with the terms of his employment agreement. Aggregate amount does not include a pro-rated portion of the 2010 annual bonus Mr. Gouin would be entitled to receive in the event of such a termination during 2010, as more fully described above.
(3) Pursuant to Mr. Gouin’s employment agreement, COBRA premiums will be waived to the extent the cost exceeds the cost we charge for active employees for similar coverage for 12 months.

 

127


Table of Contents
(4) Represents the value of RSUs that accelerate upon termination, based on the number of RSUs expected to be granted multiplied by the price to the public in this offering. See “—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—Long Term Incentive Compensation Awards”. Assumes such RSUs were issued immediately prior to consummation of the offering and the price to the public equals the mid-point of the range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus.

 

Michael Rajkovic

   Severance
Amounts(1)
    Benefits
Continuation
    Vested
    RSUs    
    Total

Termination by us for any reason (other than by us for cause) or because we do not extend the term of Mr. Rajkovic’s employment agreement

   $ 575,000 (2)    $ 10,751 (3)    $                  (4)    $                 

Termination by us for cause or resignation by
Mr. Rajkovic

     —          —          —          —  

 

(1) In the event of termination either by us or by the executive, the executive is entitled to the accrued benefits as described under “Severance—Employment Agreements”. In the event that this offering is consummated and thereafter Mr. Rajkovic’s employment is terminated by us other than for cause or by Mr. Rajkovic for good reason, the vesting of Mr. Rajkovic’s RSUs will accelerate.
(2) Aggregate amount represents one times Mr. Rajkovic’s annualized rate of base salary as of the effective date of termination in accordance with the terms of his employment agreement. Aggregate amount does not include a pro-rated portion of the 2010 annual bonus Mr. Rajkovic would be entitled to receive in the event of such a termination during 2010, as more fully described above.
(3) Pursuant to Mr. Rajkovic’s employment agreement, COBRA premiums will be waived to the extent the cost exceeds the cost we charge for active employees for similar coverage for 12 months.
(4) Represents the value of RSUs that accelerate upon termination, based on the number of RSUs expected to be granted multiplied by the price to the public in this offering. See “—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—Long Term Incentive Compensation Awards”. Assumes such RSUs were issued immediately prior to consummation of the offering and the price to the public equals the mid-point of the range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus.

 

William Pumphrey

  Severance
Amounts
    Benefits
Continuation
    Vested
RSUs
    Total

Termination by us for any reason (other than by us for cause)

  $ 472,500 (1)    $ 10,749 (2)    $                  (3)    $                 

Termination by us for cause or by Mr. Pumphrey

    —          —          —          —  

 

(1) Aggregate amount represents one times Mr. Pumphrey’s annualized rate of base salary as of the effective date of termination in accordance with the terms of our executive severance policy. Aggregate amount does not include a pro-rated portion of the 2010 annual bonus Mr. Pumphrey would be entitled to receive in the event of such a termination during 2010, as more fully described above. In the event this offering is consummated and thereafter Mr. Pumphrey’s employment is terminated by us other than for cause or by Mr. Pumphrey for good reason, the vesting of Mr. Pumphrey’s RSUs will accelerate.
(2) Pursuant to the terms of our executive severance policy, COBRA premiums will be waived to the extent the cost exceeds the cost we charge for active employees for similar coverage for 12 months.
(3) Represents the value of RSUs that accelerate upon termination, based on the number of RSUs expected to be granted multiplied by the price to the public in this offering. See “—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—Long Term Incentive Compensation Awards”. Assumes such RSUs were issued immediately prior to consummation of the offering and the price to the public equals the mid-point of the range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus.

 

Dr. Meleghy

  Severance
Amounts
    Benefits
Continuation
  Vested
    RSUs    
    Total

Termination by us for any reason (other than by us for cause)

  $ 483,840 (1)    —     $                  (2)    $                 

Termination by us for cause or by Dr. Meleghy

    —        —       —          —  10.5

 

(1) Aggregate amount equal to one times Dr. Meleghy’s annualized rate of base salary as of the effective date of termination in accordance with the terms of our executive severance policy. The executive’s annual base salary is €336,000. The amount shown in the table represents the executive’s base salary converted from Euros to U.S. dollars using the foreign exchange rate effective on December 31, 2009 of €1.00 = $1.44. Aggregate amount does not include a pro-rated portion of the 2010 annual bonus Dr. Meleghy would be entitled to receive in the event of such a termination during 2010, as more fully described above. In the event this offering is consummated and thereafter Dr. Meleghy’s employment is terminated by us other than for cause or by Dr. Meleghy for good reason, the vesting of Dr. Meleghy’s RSUs will accelerate.

 

128


Table of Contents
(2) Represents the value of RSUs that accelerate upon termination, based on the number of RSUs expected to be granted multiplied by the price to the public in this offering. See “—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—Long Term Incentive Compensation Awards”. Assumes such RSUs were issued immediately prior to consummation of the offering and the price to the public equals the mid-point of the range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus.

Stock Incentive Plan

The following is a summary of the material terms of our 2010 Equity Incentive Plan. This description is not complete. For more information, we refer you to the full text of the Equity Incentive Plan, which we filed as an exhibit to the registration statement of which this prospectus forms a part.

The purposes of the Equity Incentive Plan are (i) to attract and retain highly competent employees, board members, consultants and other advisors to serve our company and its affiliates; (ii) to provide additional incentives to such persons by aligning their interests with those of our shareholders; and (iii) to promote the success and business of our company.

The Equity Incentive Plan authorizes the grant of the following types of awards: nonqualified stock options, or NSOs, incentive stock options, or ISOs, stock appreciation rights, or SARs, restricted stock, restricted stock units, or RSUs, performance shares, performance units, other cash-based awards and other stock-based awards. Awards may be granted to employees, officers, non-employee board members, consultants and other service providers of our company and its affiliates. However, ISOs may be granted only to employees.

We have authorized a total of              shares of common stock for issuance pursuant to all awards granted under the Equity Incentive Plan. The number of shares issued or reserved pursuant to the Equity Incentive Plan (or pursuant to outstanding awards) is subject to adjustment as a result of mergers, consolidations, reorganizations, stock splits, stock dividends and other changes in our common stock. Shares subject to awards that have been terminated, expired unexercised, forfeited or settled in cash do not count as shares issued under the Equity Incentive Plan. No person may receive awards of stock options or SARs during any calendar year for more than              shares of our common stock.

As contemplated by our 2010 Long-Term Incentive Program, upon consummation of this offering, we expect to grant RSUs to each of Messrs. Malcolm, Gouin, Rajkovic and Pumphrey and Dr. Meleghy under the Equity Incentive Plan. Such RSUs are subject to time-based vesting. See “—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—Long Term Incentive Compensation Awards.” We also expect to grant stock options to our executive officers, certain directors and other employees, each with an exercise price equal to the price to the public of our common stock sold in this offering. Such stock options will be subject to time-based vesting. See “Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—2010 Equity Incentive Plan.”

Administration.     The Equity Incentive Plan will be administered by the Compensation Committee. The Compensation Committee will have the discretion to determine the individuals to whom awards may be granted under the Equity Incentive Plan, the number of shares of our common stock subject to each award, the type of award, the manner in which such awards will vest and the other conditions applicable to awards. The Compensation Committee will be authorized to interpret the Equity Incentive Plan, to establish, amend and rescind any rules and regulations relating to the Equity Incentive Plan and to make any other determinations that it deems necessary or desirable for the administration of the Equity Incentive Plan. All decisions, determinations and interpretations by the Compensation Committee, and any rules and regulations under the Equity Incentive Plan and the terms and conditions of or operation of any award, are final and binding on all participants.

Stock Options.     The Compensation Committee will determine the exercise price and other terms for each option and whether the options will be NSOs or ISOs. The exercise price per share of each option will not be less than 100% of the fair market value of our common stock on the date of grant, which, unless otherwise determined by the Committee, will be deemed to be the New York Stock Exchange closing price of a share of our common stock on the last trading day before the date of grant. Options granted at the time of this offering will have an exercise price per share equal to the price to the public of the common stock sold in this offering. ISOs may be granted only to employees and are subject to certain other restrictions. To the extent an option

 

129


Table of Contents

intended to be an ISO does not qualify as an ISO, it will be treated as a nonqualified option. A participant may exercise an option by written notice and payment of the exercise price in shares, cash or a combination of shares and cash, as determined by the Compensation Committee, including an irrevocable commitment by a broker to pay over the net proceeds from a sale of the shares issuable under an option, the delivery of previously owned shares and/or withholding of shares deliverable upon exercise. The maximum term of any option granted under the Equity Incentive Plan is ten years from the date of grant. The Compensation Committee may, in its discretion, permit a holder of an NSO to exercise the option before it has otherwise become exercisable, in which case the shares of our common stock issued to the recipient will continue to be subject to the vesting requirements that applied to the NSO before exercise.

Stock Appreciation Rights.     The Compensation Committee may grant SARs independent of or in connection with an option. The Compensation Committee will determine the other terms applicable to SARs. The exercise price per share of each SAR will not be less than 100% of the fair market value of our common stock on the date of grant, which, unless otherwise determined by the Committee, will be deemed to be the New York Stock Exchange closing price of a share of our common stock on the last trading day before the date of grant. The maximum term of any SAR granted under the Equity Incentive Plan will be ten years from the date of grant. Generally, each SAR will entitle a participant upon exercise to an amount equal to:

 

   

the excess of the fair market value on the exercise date of one share of our common stock over the exercise price, multiplied by

 

   

the number of shares of common stock covered by the SAR.

Payment may be made in shares of our common stock, in cash, or partly in common stock and partly in cash, all as determined by the Compensation Committee.

Restricted Stock and Restricted Stock Units.     The Compensation Committee will have the authority to award restricted common stock and/or RSUs under the Equity Incentive Plan. Restricted stock awards consist of shares of stock that are transferred to a participant subject to restrictions that may result in forfeiture if specified conditions are not satisfied. RSUs confer the right to receive shares of our common stock, cash, or a combination of shares and cash, at a future date upon or following the attainment of certain conditions specified by the Compensation Committee. The Compensation Committee will determine the restrictions and conditions applicable to each award of restricted stock or RSUs, which may include performance-based conditions. Although we do not expect to declare any dividends in the foreseeable future, dividends with respect to restricted stock may be paid to the holder of the shares as and when dividends are paid to shareholders or at the time that the restricted stock vests, as determined by the Compensation Committee. Unless the Compensation Committee determines otherwise, holders of restricted stock will have the right to vote the shares. The Equity Incentive Plan authorizes us to withhold from participants shares of common stock having a fair market value equal to our withholding obligation with respect to restricted stock and/or RSUs.

Performance Shares and Performance Units.     The Compensation Committee may award performance shares and/or performance units under the Equity Incentive Plan. Performance shares and performance units are awards, denominated in shares of our common stock, cash or a combination thereof, which are earned during a specified performance period subject to the attainment of performance criteria, as established by the Compensation Committee. The Compensation Committee will determine the restrictions and conditions applicable to each award of performance shares and performance units.

Other Stock-Based and Cash-Based Awards.     The Compensation Committee may award other types of equity-based or cash-based awards under the Equity Incentive Plan, including the grant or offer for sale of shares of our common stock that do not have vesting requirements and the right to receive one or more cash payments subject to satisfaction of such conditions as the Compensation Committee may impose.

 

130


Table of Contents

Performance Criteria.     Vesting of awards granted under the Equity Incentive Plan may be subject to the satisfaction of one or more performance goals established by the Compensation Committee. The performance goals may vary from participant to participant, group to group, and period to period. Performance goals may be weighted for different factors and measures. The Compensation Committee will certify the degree of attainment of performance goals after the end of each year.

Transferability.     Unless otherwise determined by the Compensation Committee, awards granted under the Equity Incentive Plan will not be transferable other than by will or by the laws of descent and distribution.

Change in Control.     The Compensation Committee may, at the time of the grant of an award provide for the effect of a change in control (as defined in the Equity Incentive Plan) on any award, including (i) accelerating or extending the time periods for exercising, vesting in, or realizing gain from any award, (ii) eliminating or modifying the performance or other conditions of an award, or (iii) providing for the cash settlement of an award for an equivalent cash value, as determined by the Compensation Committee. The Compensation Committee may, in its discretion and without the need for the consent of any recipient of an award, also take one or more of the following actions contingent upon the occurrence of a change in control: (a) cause any or all outstanding options and SARs to become immediately exercisable, in whole or in part; (b) cause any other awards to become non-forfeitable, in whole or in part; (c) cancel any option or SAR in exchange for a substitute option; (d) cancel any award of restricted stock, RSUs, performance shares or performance units in exchange for a similar award of the capital stock of any successor corporation; (e) redeem any restricted stock, RSU, performance share or performance unit for cash and/or other substitute consideration with a value equal to the fair market value of an unrestricted share of our common stock on the date of the change in control; (f) cancel any option or SAR in exchange for cash and/or other substitute consideration based on the value of our common stock on the date of the change in control , and cancel any option or SAR without any payment if its exercise price exceeds the value of our common stock on the date of the change in control; or (g) make such other modifications, adjustments or amendments to outstanding awards as the Compensation Committee deems necessary or appropriate. The grant agreements for the RSUs and stock options that we intend to grant at the time of this offering provide for accelerated vesting upon a change in control. The Compensation Committee currently anticipates that grants of stock options, RSUs, restricted stock and other equity-based awards in the future will contain similar accelerated vesting provisions.

Effectiveness of the Equity Incentive Plan; Amendment and Termination.     The Equity Incentive Plan will become effective upon the closing of this offering. The Equity Incentive Plan will remain available for the grant of awards until the tenth anniversary of the effective date. The board may amend, alter or discontinue the Equity Incentive Plan in any respect at any time, but no amendment may materially and adversely affect the rights of a participant under any awards previously granted, without his or her consent, except that stockholder approval will be needed for any amendment that would increase the maximum number of shares available for awards, reduce the exercise price of outstanding options or SARs, change the class of eligible participants, or if otherwise required by applicable law or stock market requirements.

Compensation of Board Members

The following table sets forth a summary of our non-employee board members’ compensation for fiscal 2009. Mark Malcolm, our President and Chief Executive Officer, also serves on our board. Mr. Malcolm, however, does not receive any compensation for his board service beyond the compensation he receives as an executive officer of our company. Dev Kapadia, a member of our board and an employee of CCM, did not receive any compensation from us for serving on the board in 2009, but will receive compensation as a board member commencing upon completion of this offering. Seth Gardner, a former member of our board and former employee of CCM, similarly did not receive any compensation from us.

 

131


Table of Contents

Director Compensation

 

Name

   Fees Earned
or Paid in
Cash
    Non-Equity
Incentive Plan
Compensation
    All Other
Compensation
   Total

Daniel Ajamian(1)

   $ 612,500 (2)    $ 469,275 (3)    —      $ 1,081,775

Seth Gardner(4)

     —          —        —        —  

Dev Kapadia

     —          —        —        —  

Larry Schwentor

   $ 363,333 (5)    $ 250,280 (6)    —      $ 613,613

Rande Somma

   $ 272,500 (5)    $ 140,783 (7)    —      $ 413,283

 

(1) Mr. Ajamian ceased serving on our board in February 2010.
(2) Reflects a 20% voluntary reduction in fees from February through December 2009.
(3) Represents amounts earned by Anthem Management Group, LLC pursuant to the Service Agreement, dated as of August 1, 2007, by and among Tower Automotive, LLC, Daniel Ajamian and Anthem Management Group, LLC, as amended. Mr. Ajamian is the sole member of Anthem Management Group, LLC.
(4) Mr. Gardner ceased serving on our board in November 2009.
(5) Reflects a 10% voluntary reduction in fees from February through December 2009.
(6) Represents amounts earned by MGT4VALUE LLC pursuant to the Service Agreement, dated as of August 1, 2007, between Tower Automotive, LLC, Larry Schwentor and MGT4VALUE LLC, as amended. Mr. Schwentor is the sole member of MGT4VALUE LLC.
(7) Represents amounts earned by Rande Somma & Associates LLC pursuant to the Service Agreement, dated as of December 1, 2007, between Tower Automotive LLC, Rande Somma and Rande Somma & Associates LLC, as amended. Mr. Somma is the sole member of Rande Somma & Associates LLC.

Service Agreements with Certain Current and Former Directors

We have entered into service agreements with each of Rande Somma and his affiliate (dated December 1, 2007, as amended), Larry Schwentor and his affiliate (dated August 1, 2007, as amended) and Daniel Ajamian and his affiliate (dated August 1, 2007, as amended). Each of the service agreements was approved and authorized by our board. Mr. Somma’s service agreement continues until December 1, 2010. Mr. Ajamian’s services agreement terminated in February 2010 and Mr. Schwentor’s service agreement terminated on August 1, 2010.

Each of the service agreements provides or provided for a minimum base consulting fee ($300,000 for Mr. Somma; $400,000 for Mr. Schwentor; and $750,000 for Mr. Ajamian), which may be increased if the base salary of our chief executive officer is increased during the term of the service agreement. Each of the service agreements also provides or provided for eligibility for annual incentive compensation at target levels of $225,000 for Mr. Somma, $400,000 for Mr. Schwentor and $750,000 for Mr. Ajamian, and for reimbursement of certain tax, legal and other expenses incurred by the consultant under the service agreement.

If Mr. Somma’s services agreement is terminated by us for “cause,” as that term is defined in his agreement, or is voluntarily terminated by him, Mr. Somma will be entitled to receive the following benefits, which we refer to as the accrued consultant benefits:

 

   

the amount of the base consulting fee earned and due but not paid through the date of termination;

 

   

the amount of any annual bonus relating to the calendar year prior to the year of termination that was earned on the applicable bonus approval date but unpaid; and

 

   

any reimbursable expenses that have not been reimbursed.

If Mr. Somma’s services agreement is terminated because of his death or because he becomes “disabled,” as that term is defined in his agreement, Mr. Somma will be entitled to receive the following benefits:

 

   

the accrued consultant benefits;

 

132


Table of Contents
   

in the event of termination following Mr. Somma’s disability (but not in the event of termination because of his death), the consulting fee for the period beginning on the date of such termination and ending on the date which is three months after the date of such termination; and

 

   

a pro rata portion (based on the number of days elapsed during the calendar year in which such termination occurs) of the annual bonus for the calendar year in which the termination occurs.

If Mr. Somma’s services agreement is terminated by us without “cause,” as that term is defined in his consulting agreement, or if the consulting period terminates upon expiration of its term (as was the case with Mr. Schwentor), Mr. Somma will be entitled to receive the following benefits:

 

   

the accrued consultant benefits;

 

   

a pro rata portion (based on the number of days elapsed during the calendar year in which such termination occurs) of the annual bonus for the calendar year in which the termination occurs; and

 

   

if terminated by us without cause prior to the expiration of its term, the consulting fee for the remainder of the then existing term of the consulting agreement.

In connection with the termination of Mr. Ajamian’s services agreement, we paid Mr. Ajamian a pro-rated portion of his 2010 bonus in the amount of $117,123 and consulting fees of $62,500 per month through July 2010.

Equity Compensation of Board Members

The following table shows the aggregate number of unvested Management MIP Units held on December 31, 2009 by each person who was a non-employee board member at that time (including any Management MIP Units which are held by an entity controlled by such board member). See “—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—Management Incentive Plan.”

 

Name

   Unvested
Management MIP
Units

at  Fiscal Year-End

Dev Kapadia

   —  

Daniel Ajamian

   150

Larry Schwentor

   75

Rande Somma

   25

Mr. Somma through his affiliate consummated the purchase of 50 Management MIP Units, Mr. Schwentor through his affiliate consummated the purchase of 150 Management MIP Units and Mr. Ajamian through his affiliate consummated the purchase of 300 Management MIP Units, all on substantially the same terms as the purchases made by the Named Executive Officers, except that none of the board members received bonus payments or related gross-up payments in connection with these purchases. Each paid a purchase price of $500 per Management MIP Unit. See “—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—Management Incentive Plan” for a discussion of Management MIP Units held by Mr. Malcolm.

The Management MIP Units, when purchased, were subject to time-vesting and performance-vesting requirements. Under their respective purchase agreements, each of Messrs. Somma, Schwentor and Ajamian were required to provide services to us or one of our affiliates on the applicable time-based vesting date in order for time-vesting time to occur. For Mr. Somma, 50% of his time-based Management MIP Units vested on November 30, 2008, and his remaining time-based Management MIP Units vested on November 30, 2009. For each of Messrs. Schwentor and Ajamian, 50% of his time-based Management MIP Units vested on July 31, 2008, and his remaining time-based Management MIP Units vested on July 31, 2009.

In 2010, the Compensation Committee removed the performance-vesting requirements for Messrs. Schwentor and Somma. Such former performance-based vesting units held by each of Mr. Schwentor and Mr. Somma now vest in two tranches: 50% percent vest on January 1, 2011 and 50% percent vest on January 1, 2012.

 

133


Table of Contents

Other Compensation of Board members

Upon consummation of this offering and as contemplated by the 2010 Long-Term Incentive Program, we expect to grant to Mr. Schwentor and Mr. Somma RSUs under our 2010 Equity Incentive Program. See “—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—Long Term Incentive Compensation Awards.” The 150 MIP Management Units held by Mr. Ajamian which are subject to performance-vesting requirements will be forfeited if the aggregate market price of the common stock that Cerberus would receive if our controlling stockholder was liquidated immediately after this offering does not exceed an agreed upon amount or if this offering is not consummated on or before December 1, 2010. If such units are forfeited, Tower Management LLC will be obligated to pay Mr. Ajamian a total of $75,000 for such units, representing his cost. If the target amount is met and this offering is consummated on or before December 1, 2010, Mr. Ajamian’s performance-vesting units will be vested.

Board Member Fees

Our board has approved a revised compensation program pursuant to which we will provide the following compensation to board members who are neither employed by us or parties (either individually or through entities controlled by them) to consulting agreements with us:

 

   

annual retainer of $150,000, or $300,000 in the case of the chairman of the Board;

 

   

additional annual compensation of $10,000 to the chairman of our Audit Committee; and

 

   

additional annual compensation of $5,000 to the chairman of our other standing Board committees.

The Board has the discretion to convert up to one half of the annual retainer into equity interests of our company.

We reimburse each non-employee member of our board for out-of-pocket expenses incurred in connection with attending our board and committee meetings. Board members do not participate in a nonqualified deferred compensation plan and we do not pay any life insurance policies for the board members.

Limitation of Liability and Indemnification of Officers and Directors

Under our bylaws, which will be adopted immediately following the occurrence of the Corporate Conversion, we are obligated to indemnify our directors and officers to the fullest extent permitted by law. We are also expressly required to advance certain expenses to our directors and officers. We believe that these indemnification provisions are useful to attract and retain qualified directors and executive officers.

The General Corporate Law of the State of Delaware, or DGCL, permits a corporation to limit or eliminate a director’s personal liability to the corporation or the holders of its capital stock for breach of duty. Our certificate of incorporation, which will be filed immediately upon the occurrence of the Corporate Conversion, includes a provision that eliminates the personal liability of directors for monetary damages for breach of fiduciary duty as a director to the fullest extent permitted by Delaware law. This limitation is generally unavailable for acts or omissions by a director which (i) were in bad faith, (ii) were the result of active and deliberate dishonesty and were material to the cause of action so adjudicated or (iii) involved a financial profit or other advantage to which such director was not legally entitled. The DGCL also prohibits limitations on director liability for acts or omissions which resulted in a violation of a statute prohibiting certain dividend declarations, certain payments to stockholders after dissolution and particular types of loans.

Any amendment to or repeal of these provisions will not (i) in the case of the indemnification provisions, adversely affect any right or protection conferred on any person existing at the time the events giving rise to the protection have occurred and (ii) in the case of the limitation on liability provisions, apply to or have any effect on liability of a director with respect to any acts or omission of such director occurring prior to such amendment or repeal. If Delaware law is amended to provide for further limitations on the personal liability of directors of corporations, then the personal liability of our directors will be further limited to the fullest extent then permitted.

 

134


Table of Contents

Compensation for Employees Who Are Not Named Executive Officers or Directors

2009 Tower Bonus Plan

Certain employees who are not Named Executive Officers also participated in the 2009 Tower Bonus Plan. In general, such employees participated in the plan on the same terms as generally applicable to the Named Executive Offers. However, with respect to certain of those participants, 30% of bonus payouts were based on company-wide Adjusted EBITDA Improvement performance, 20% of bonus payouts were based on regional Adjusted EBITDA Improvement performance (based on our performance in the participant’s region), 30% of bonus payouts were based on company-wide Cash Flow performance, and 20% of bonus payouts were based on regional Cash Flow performance (based on our performance in the participant’s region). The applicable regions for the regional Adjusted EBITDA Improvement and Cash Flow targets were North America, Europe, South America, Korea and China.

Value Creation Plan

Tower Management, LLC, after approval by the Compensation Committee, adopted a value creation plan, which we refer to as the Value Creation Plan, effective as of January 1, 2008. Effective February 19, 2010, Tower Management, LLC assigned the Value Creation Plan to us and we amended and restated the plan. Approximately seventy employees are eligible to participate in the Value Creation Plan, but none of the Named Executive Officers or other officers are participants.

Upon consummation of this offering, we may establish a potential bonus pool under our Value Creation Plan. The Value Creation Plan provides that actual payments of bonus amounts will not occur earlier than the date on which Tower International Holdings, LLC sells shares of our common stock with aggregate proceeds equal to the sum of (a) $180.9 million plus a ten percent return on such amount accruing from July 31, 2010 and (b) $25 million plus a ten percent return on such amount accruing from August 24, 2010. The aggregate bonus pool will represent a specified percentage, ranging from 3.75% to 4.2%, of the “net value gained” by affiliates of CCM in respect of their equity investment in Tower International Holdings, LLC. The “net value gained” is a formula amount designed to reflect the net unrealized profit in connection with this offering by affiliates of CCM in respect of their investment in such entity. Any compensation paid pursuant to the Value Creation Plan will be charged as a compensation expense against earnings over a period ending on the estimated date of payment of such compensation.

To be eligible for a bonus under the Value Creation Plan, a participant must generally remain in our employment through the date of payment.

Supplemental Value Creation Program

Effective February 19, 2010, our Compensation Committee approved the creation of a cash bonus program, which we refer to as the Supplemental Value Creation Program. Approximately seventy employees are eligible to participate in the Supplemental Value Creation Program, but none of the Named Executive Officers or other officers are participants.

As a result of the consummation of the notes offering, we established a potential bonus pool of up to $7.5 million for purposes of the Supplemental Value Creation Program. Awards made under the program are to be paid according to the following schedule:

 

   

fifty percent (50%) of the award shall be paid on May 24, 2011; and

 

   

fifty percent (50%) of the award shall be paid on February 24, 2012.

To be eligible for a bonus under the Supplemental Value Creation Program, a participant must generally remain in our employment through the date of payment.

 

135


Table of Contents

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED PERSON TRANSACTIONS

As of August 26, 2010, Cerberus, which controls our controlling stockholder, owned all of our $27.5 million synthetic letter of credit facility, which is part of the first lien term loan. An aggregate of $27.5 million may be drawn down on letters of credit under our synthetic letter of credit facility.

On August 24, 2010, upon consummation of the notes offering, we repaid in full the outstanding indebtedness under our first lien term loan (exclusive of the synthetic letter of credit facility portion thereof), of which Cerberus received $371.9 as a participant in such first lien term loan. Cerberus acquired its interests in our first lien term loan and synthetic letter of credit facility in market transactions with other lenders.

The maximum amount of indebtedness that was owed by us at any time during the year ended December 31, 2009 on our first lien term loan was $502.8 million. This facility requires principal payments of 1%, paid quarterly at the end of January, April, July and October of each year. This facility matures on July 31, 2013. In the event that the lenders seek to exercise certain rights that they may have pursuant to the finance documents governing such indebtedness, such actions could be adverse to the interests of our stockholders. Upon consummation of the notes offering, we repaid all indebtedness outstanding under our first lien term loan, other than the synthetic letter of credit facility portion thereof. In connection with the consummation of the notes offering, Cerberus caused one of its affiliates to cancel $25 million aggregate principal amount of the first lien term loan and in exchange therefore an affiliate of Cerberus received an equity interest in our company. For additional information regarding our indebtedness, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Debt” and note 8 to our consolidated financial statements.

As described in footnote 9 to the tables set forth in “Prospectus Summary—Summary Consolidated Financial Data”, on August 12, 2010, the preferred units, common units and MIP Units of Tower Automotive, LLC were converted into capital units of Tower Automotive, LLC.

Cerberus does not charge us a quarterly or annual management or sponsor fee. Except as described below, we have not paid any fees to Cerberus in connection with consulting services provided by Cerberus. We reimbursed Cerberus Operations and Advisory Company, LLC, or COAC, an affiliate of CCM, less than $0.1 million during the first six months of 2010, less than $0.1 million during 2009, $0.8 million during 2008 and $0.3 million during 2007 for consulting services. We also paid $1.1 million to Cerberus for reimbursement of its acquisition related costs during 2007. If we request COAC to provide consulting services in the future, we would expect to reimburse COAC for the salaries and benefits of the individuals providing such services on behalf of COAC.

On August 3, 2007, an affiliate of Cerberus acquired 80% of the Chrysler division from DaimlerChrysler Corporation. We sell certain products from our North American operations to Chrysler. Sales of these products amounted to $144.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2008 and $81.1 million for the period from August 1, 2007 to December 31, 2007. Our accounts receivable with Chrysler at December 31, 2008 and 2007, were $6.5 million and $4.9 million, respectively. On April 30, 2009, Chrysler filed for bankruptcy. Our sales to Chrysler during the four months ended April 30, 2009 were $17.7 million.

We made pension payments of approximately $0.3 million in 2009, 2008, and 2007 and $0.1 million during the six months ended June 30, 2010 to the mother of Gyula Meleghy, our President, International Operations, as required pursuant to the terms of the acquisition by the Predecessor of Dr. Meleghy & Co. GmbH on January 1, 2000.

For information regarding payments we have made under service agreements with entities controlled by our board members, see “Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Director Compensation—Service Agreements with Certain Current and Former Directors.”

 

136


Table of Contents

Registration Rights Agreement

Registration Rights

In connection with this offering, we will enter into a registration rights agreement with our controlling stockholder.

Demand Rights

Under the registration rights agreement, our controlling stockholder holds registration rights that allow it at any time after six months following the consummation of this offering (but not within 180 days after the consummation of any other public offering) to request that we register for resale under the Securities Act all or any portion of the shares of our common stock that our controlling stockholder owns. Our controlling stockholder is entitled to an unlimited number of such demand registrations. We are also not required to effect any demand registration within 30 days prior to the filing of, or during the 180 days following the effectiveness of, a registration statement for which Tower International Holdings, LLC holds “piggyback” registration rights (as described below) and are given the opportunity to sell shares pursuant to such registration statement. We may refuse a request for demand registration if, in our reasonable judgment, it is not feasible for us to proceed with the registration because of the existence of any acquisition, disposition or other material transaction or financing activity involving us, or because of the unavailability of audited financial statements or our possession of material information that it would not be in our best interests to disclose in a registration statement, provided that such refusal only results in one 90 day delay to the registration and only occurs one time in any twelve-month period.

Piggyback Rights

Our controlling stockholder also holds “piggyback” registration rights exerciseable at any time commencing six months following this offering that allow it to include the shares of our stock that it owns in any public offering of equity securities initiated by us (other than those public offerings pursuant to registration statements on forms that do not permit registration for resale by them). These “piggyback” registration rights are subject to proportional cutbacks based on the manner of such offering and the identity of the party initiating such offering.

Indemnification; Expenses

We have agreed to indemnify our controlling stockholder against any losses or damages resulting from any untrue statement or omission of material fact in any registration statement or prospectus pursuant to which it sells our shares, unless such liability arose from our controlling stockholder’s misstatement or omission, and our controlling stockholder has agreed to indemnify us against all losses caused by its misstatements or omissions in those documents. We will pay all expenses incidental to our performance under the registration rights agreement, and our controlling stockholder will pay its respective portion of all underwriting discounts, commissions and transfer taxes relating to the sale of its shares under the registration rights agreement.

Voting Agreement

We expect to grant RSUs to our executive officers upon consummation of this offering. Each recipient of such RSUs will be required to enter into a voting agreement with our controlling stockholder whereby such persons agree to vote such shares as directed by our controlling stockholder. Cerberus controls our controlling stockholder.

Related Person Transaction Policy

Our board of directors recognizes that related person transactions, as defined in our related person transaction policy, present a risk of actual or perceived conflicts of interest that could damage the reputation and public trust of our company. It is our policy that all related party transactions shall be subject to approval or ratification in accordance with our related person transaction policy.

 

137


Table of Contents

The audit committee will review this policy annually and will recommend amendments, if any, to the board for its consideration. In addition, the board has determined that the audit committee of our board shall consider, approve or ratify each related person transaction. The audit committee will, in determining whether to approve or ratify a related person transaction, take into account, among other factors it deems appropriate: (i) the benefits to our company; (ii) the impact on a director’s independence in the event the related person is a director, an immediate family member of a director or an entity in which a director is a partner, stockholder or executive officer; (iii) the availability of other sources for comparable products or services; (iv) the terms of the proposed related person transaction; (v) whether the transaction is on terms no less favorable than terms generally available to an unaffiliated third party; and (vi) the extent of the related person’s interest in the transaction. No member of the audit committee will participate in any review, consideration or approval of any related person transaction with respect to which such member or any of his or her immediate family members is the related person.

 

138


Table of Contents

PRINCIPAL STOCKHOLDERS

The following table sets forth certain information as of August 26, 2010, with respect to the beneficial ownership of our common stock, after giving effect to the Corporate Conversion and this offering, by:

 

   

each of our Named Executive Officers;

 

   

each of our directors;

 

   

all of our directors and executive officers as a group; and

 

   

each person or group of affiliated persons who is known by us to beneficially own more than 5% of our common stock.

The amounts and percentages of common stock beneficially owned are reported on the basis of regulations of the SEC governing the determination of beneficial ownership of securities. Under the SEC’s rules, a person is deemed to be a beneficial owner of a security if that person has or shares voting power, which includes the power to vote or to direct the voting of such security, or investment power, which includes the power to dispose of or to direct the disposition of such security. Unless otherwise indicated below, each beneficial owner named in the table below has sole voting and sole investment power with respect to all shares beneficially owned, subject to community property laws where applicable. The information set forth in the following table excludes any shares of our common stock purchased in this offering by the respective beneficial owner and assumes that our Corporate Conversion has taken place.

The number of shares of common stock outstanding used in calculating the percentage for each listed person or entity excludes shares reserved for issuance under RSUs issuable pursuant to one of our benefit plans in connection with the consummation of this offering, based on the assumed mid-point of the range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus.

Unless otherwise indicated, the address of each beneficial owner is c/o Tower International, Inc., 17672 Laurel Park Drive North, Suite 400E, Livonia, MI 48152.

 

     Shares Beneficially
Owned Prior to This
Offering
   Shares
Beneficially
Owned After
Offering

Name of Beneficial Owner

   Number    Percent    Number    Percent

Named Executive Officers and Directors:

           

Mark Malcolm(1)

           

James Gouin(2)

           

Michael Rajkovic(3)

           

William Pumphrey(4)

           

Gyula Meleghy(5)

           

Nicholas Chabraja(6)

           

Dennis Donovan(6)

           

Frank English, Jr.(6)

           

Chan Galbato(6)

           

Allan Gilmour(6)

           

Dev Kapadia(6)

           

Larry Schwentor(7)

           

Rande Somma(8)

           

Executive officers and directors as a group (16 persons)(9)

           

5% Stockholders

           

Stephen Feinberg(10)

           
                   

Total

           
                   

 

139


Table of Contents

 

  * Less than 1%.
(1) Excludes              shares of common stock underlying RSUs which we expect to grant in connection with the consummation of this offering and              shares of common stock underlying stock options which we expect to grant in connection with the consummation of this offering. Excludes 300 Management MIP Units held by Mr. Malcolm.
(2) Excludes              shares of common stock underlying RSUs which we expect to grant in connection with the consummation of this offering and              shares of common stock underlying stock options which we expect to grant in connection with the consummation of this offering. Excludes the 100 Management MIP Units held by Mr. Gouin.
(3) Excludes              shares of common stock underlying RSUs which we expect to grant in connection with the consummation of this offering and              shares of common stock underlying stock options which we expect to grant in connection with the consummation of this offering. Excludes the 175 Management MIP Units held by Mr. Rajkovic.
(4) Excludes              shares of common stock underlying RSUs which we expect to grant in connection with the consummation of this offering and              shares of common stock underlying stock options which we expect to grant in connection with consummation of this offering. Excludes the 100 Management MIP Units held by Mr. Pumphrey.
(5) Excludes              shares of common stock underlying RSUs which we expect to grant in connection with the consummation of this offering and              shares of common stock underlying stock options which we expect to grant in connection with the consummation of this offering. Excludes the 100 Management MIP Units held by Dr. Meleghy.
(6) Excludes the following number of shares of common stock underlying stock options which we expect to grant in connection with the consummation of this offering: for Mr. Chabraja,              shares; for Mr. Donovan,              shares; for Mr. English,              shares; for Mr. Galbato,              shares; for Mr. Gilmour,              shares; and for Mr. Kapadia,              shares.
(7) Excludes              shares of common stock underlying RSUs which we expect to grant in connection with the consummation of this offering and              shares of common stock underlying stock options which we expect to grant in connection with consummation of this offering. Excludes the 150 Management MIP Units held by Mr. Schwentor.
(8) Excludes              shares of common stock underlying RSUs which we expect to grant in connection with the consummation of this offering and              shares of common stock underlying stock options which we expect to grant in connection with the consummation of this offering. Excludes the 50 Management MIP Units held by Mr. Somma.
(9) Excludes              shares of common stock underlying RSUs which we expect to grant in connection with the consummation of this offering and              shares of common stock underlying stock options which we expect to grant in connection with the consummation of this offering. Excludes 975 Management MIP Units held by the executive officers and directors.
(10) Tower International Holdings, LLC will acquire 10,000 capital units of Tower Automotive, LLC, which, in the aggregate, will be converted into              shares of our common stock pursuant to the Corporate Conversion. Pursuant to the limited liability company agreement of Tower International Holdings, LLC, the manager of Tower International Holdings, LLC exercises sole voting and dispositive authority over all of the securities owned by Tower International Holdings, LLC. The manager of Tower International Holdings, LLC is CCM. Stephen Feinberg is the sole shareholder of Craig Court, Inc., the managing member of Craig Court GP, LLC, which is the general partner of CCM. As a result of the foregoing, Mr. Feinberg, through one or more intermediate entities, possesses the sole power to vote and the sole power to direct the disposition of all shares of the Company’s common stock held by Tower International Holdings, LLC. The address for Stephen Feinberg is c/o Cerberus Capital Management, L.P., 299 Park Avenue, New York, NY 10171.

For additional information regarding the RSUs to be issued in connection with the consummation of this offering, see “Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—Long Term Incentive Compensation Awards.”

 

140


Table of Contents

DESCRIPTION OF CERTAIN INDEBTEDNESS

The following is a summary of the material provisions of the instruments evidencing our material indebtedness. This summary is not a complete description of all of the terms of the agreements governing our material indebtedness. Copies of the material agreements governing our material indebtedness have been filed as exhibits to our registration statement filed in connection with this offering.

On July 31, 2007, certain of our subsidiaries entered into credit agreements to finance the acquisition of substantially all of the assets and the assumption of certain liabilities of the Predecessor, Tower Automotive, Inc. The credit agreements provided for a revolving credit facility in the aggregate amount of $200 million, which has subsequently been reduced to $150 million, a first lien term loan, which was divided into two tranches of $250 million and $260 million (or €190.8 million) and which (exclusive of our synthetic letter of credit facility) was paid in full with the proceeds of the notes offering and $5.9 million of our cash, a second lien term loan of $115 million (which has been repaid) and a synthetic letter of credit facility of $60 million (which has been reduced to $27.5 million). The revolving credit facility also provides for the issuance of letters of credit in an aggregate amount not to exceed $75 million.

The proceeds of the credit agreements were used, in part, to pay the purchase price of the acquisition, for related fees and expenses and for general corporate purposes.

Two of our subsidiaries, one domestic and one European, are borrowers under the credit agreements. The US borrower under the credit agreements is Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and the European borrower under the credit agreements is Tower Automotive Holdings Europe, B.V. The US borrower is a named borrower under each of the credit agreements, whereas the European borrower is a named borrower under all credit facilities except for the revolving credit facility.

Revolving Credit Facility

Expiration Date

The expiration date for the revolving credit facility is July 31, 2012.

Interest and Borrowings

Advances under the revolving credit facility bear interest at a base rate plus a margin or LIBOR plus a margin. The applicable margins are determined by the average availability under the revolving credit facility over the preceding three months. The applicable margins as of June 30, 2010 were 0.75% per annum and 1.75% per annum for base rate and LIBOR based borrowings, respectively. As of June 30, 2010 there was a $110.3 million borrowing base under the revolving credit facility and $53.5 million of borrowings and no letters of credit were outstanding under that facility.

Security and Guarantees

The revolving credit facility is secured by (1) a first-priority lien on all accounts receivable, inventory, cash, investments, property, plant and equipment of the US borrower and the guarantors, (2) a second-priority pledge of 65% of any voting and 100% of any non-voting equity interests held in any foreign subsidiary by the US borrower and the guarantors, and (3) a second-priority lien on all other tangible and intangible assets of the US borrower and the guarantors.

The revolving credit facility is guaranteed by us, certain intermediate holding companies and by several of our direct and indirect domestic subsidiaries.

Covenants

The revolving credit facility agreement contains customary covenants applicable to several of our subsidiaries and us. The revolving credit facility agreement contains certain financial covenants, as well as

 

141


Table of Contents

restrictions on, among other things, our ability to: incur debt; incur liens; declare or make distributions to our equity holders; make loans and investments; repay debt; enter into mergers, acquisitions and other business combinations; engage in asset sales; amend or modify our governing documents; enter into sale and lease-back transactions; make capital expenditures; enter into certain hedging arrangements; change our fiscal year; enter into restrictive agreements; and enter into transactions with affiliates.

Our ABL revolver contains a financial maintenance covenant ratio, which we refer to as the fixed charge coverage ratio. Compliance with the fixed charge coverage ratio is determined by comparing consolidated lender-adjusted EBITDA to consolidated fixed charges, each as defined in the credit agreement governing our ABL revolver. If less than ten percent of the total commitment is available (provided that such number cannot be less than $10 million or greater than $20 million) under our ABL revolver for more than five consecutive days, we are required to maintain a fixed charge coverage ratio of not less than 1.00 to 1.00 on a rolling four quarter basis. We were not required to maintain a minimum fixed charge coverage ratio under our ABL revolver during 2009. If we are required at any time to maintain the fixed charge coverage ratio, such requirement will end after more than ten percent of the total commitment is available (provided that such number cannot be less than $10 million or greater than $20 million) for twenty consecutive days. Our financial condition and liquidity would be adversely impacted by the violation of these covenants.

Events of Default

The revolving credit facility agreement includes customary events of default, including, but not limited to, payment defaults; material misrepresentations; breaches of covenants; bankruptcy; change of control; material judgments; certain Employee Retirement Income Act of 1974, as amended (or ERISA) related breaches and cross-defaults to material indebtedness.

10.625% Senior Secured Notes due 2017

Principal, Interest Payments and Change of Control

On August 24, 2010, Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc., which we refer to in this prospectus as the Issuers, consummated the sale of $430 million aggregate principal amount of their 10.625% Senior Secured Notes due 2017. The Issuers are obligated to pay interest on the notes on each March 1 and September 1, commencing on March 1, 2011. The notes will mature on September 1, 2017. The indenture governing the notes contains a provision that gives each holder of notes the right, upon a change of control, to require the Issuers to purchase all or any part of such holder’s notes at a purchase price in cash equal to 101% of the principal amount thereof plus accrued and unpaid interest.

Optional Redemption

At any time prior to September 1, 2014, the Issuers may redeem some or all of the notes at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the notes to be redeemed, plus a “make-whole” premium and accrued and unpaid interest. Additionally, prior to September 1, 2014, during any 12-month period, the Issuers may redeem up to 10% of the principal amount of the notes at a redemption price equal to 105% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest. The Issuers may redeem some or all of the notes at any time on or after September 1, 2014 at certain prices described in the indenture governing the notes plus accrued and unpaid interest. In addition, prior to September 1, 2013, the Issuers may redeem up to 35% of the original principal amount of the notes from the proceeds of certain equity offerings at a price of 110.625% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest.

Guarantees and Security

The notes are jointly and severally and unconditionally guaranteed by Tower Automotive, LLC (which upon consummation of the Corporate Conversion will become Tower International, Inc.) on a senior unsecured basis,

 

142


Table of Contents

and by Tower Automotive, LLC’s existing domestic subsidiaries (other than TA Holdings Finance, Inc.) that are guarantors of our revolving credit facility and our synthetic letter of credit facility on a senior secured basis. We refer to such domestic subsidiaries as the “Subsidiary Guarantors.”

The notes and the subsidiary guarantees are secured by the same collateral as, and on a pari passu basis with, the Issuers’ and the Subsidiary Guarantors’ obligations under our synthetic letter of credit facility.

The notes are senior secured obligations of the Issuers, rank equally in right of payment to any existing and future senior indebtedness of the Issuers and are effectively junior in priority to the extent of the collateral securing the Issuers’ and the Subsidiary Guarantors’ obligations under our revolving credit facility.

Covenants

The indenture governing the notes contains customary covenants applicable to our subsidiaries and places some restrictions on us. The indenture governing the notes contains certain restrictions on, among other things, our subsidiaries’ ability to:

 

   

incur debt;

 

   

incur liens;

 

   

declare or make distributions to us or our equity holders;

 

   

repay debt;

 

   

enter into mergers, acquisitions and other business combinations;

 

   

engage in asset and equity sales;

 

   

enter into sale and lease-back transactions;

 

   

enter into restrictive agreements; and

 

   

enter into transactions with affiliates.

Events of Default

The indenture governing the notes includes customary events of default, including but not limited to, in respect of payment defaults; breaches of covenants; bankruptcy; material judgments; failure to have perfected liens on substantially all or all the collateral securing the notes; and cross-acceleration to material indebtedness.

First Lien Term Loan and Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility

The first lien term loan was borrowed in two tranches, with $250 million advanced to the US borrower and the Euro currency equivalent of $260 million (or €190.8 million) advanced to the European borrower. The first lien term loan requires principal payments of 1%, paid quarterly at the end of each January, April, July and October. As of June 30, 2010, Cerberus owned approximately 90% of the first lien term loan. The first lien term loan matures on July 31, 2013. The first lien term loan (exclusive of the synthetic letter of credit facility portion thereof) was repaid in full in connection with the consummation of the notes offering.

The synthetic letter of credit facility, which is part of the first lien term loan credit agreement, is fully cash collateralized by the deposit lenders for purposes of replacing or backstopping letters of credit. The cash collateral was deposited by the deposit lenders in a restricted deposit account, and neither we nor any of our subsidiaries has any right, title or interest in such cash collateral. On April 8, 2009, the synthetic letter of credit facility was reduced from $60 million to $30 million. On September 30, 2009, the synthetic letter of credit facility was further reduced by $2.5 million from $30 million to $27.5 million. As of June 30, 2010, the outstanding letters of credit under the synthetic letter of credit facility were $23.1 million. Applicable fees were

 

143


Table of Contents

initially 4.25% of the aggregate letters of credit outstanding for commissions and fronting fees and a deposit fee of 0.15% based on the amount of the cash collateral deposit. Effective as of December 26, 2007, upon amendment of the first lien term loan credit agreement, the applicable letter of credit commissions, outstanding letter of credit fees, and fronting fees increased by 25 basis points to 4.65%. As of August 26, 2010, Cerberus owned 100% of the synthetic letter of credit facility.

Security and Guarantees

The synthetic letter of credit facility is secured by (1) a first-priority lien on 65% of any voting and 100% of any non-voting equity interests held in any foreign subsidiary by the US borrower and the guarantors, (2) a second-priority lien on all accounts receivable, inventory, cash, investments, property, plant and equipment of the US borrower and the guarantors, and (3) a first-priority lien on all other tangible and intangible assets of the US borrower and the guarantors.

The synthetic letter of credit facility is guaranteed by us, by certain intermediate holding companies and by several of our direct and indirect domestic subsidiaries.

Covenants

The first lien term loan credit agreement contains customary covenants applicable to our subsidiaries and us. The first lien term loan credit agreement contains certain financial covenants, as well as restrictions on, among other things, us and our subsidiaries ability to: incur debt; incur liens; declare or make distributions to our equity holders; make loans and investments; repay debt; enter into mergers, acquisitions and other business combinations; engage in asset sales; amend or modify our governing documents; enter into sale and lease-back transactions; enter into restrictive agreements; make capital expenditures; enter into certain hedging arrangements; change our fiscal year, and enter into transactions with affiliates.

Our first lien term loan contains a leverage covenant ratio, which we refer to as the first priority leverage ratio. Compliance with this ratio is determined by comparing our first priority debt to consolidated lender-adjusted EBITDA, each as defined in the credit agreement governing our first lien term loan. We are required to maintain a first priority leverage ratio of not greater than 4.25 to 1.00 on a rolling four quarter basis. In addition, our first lien term loan contains a financial maintenance covenant ratio referred to as the interest coverage ratio, which is determined by comparing consolidated lender-adjusted EBITDA to consolidated interest expense, excluding amounts not paid or payable in cash, each as defined in the credit agreement governing our first lien term loan. We are required to maintain an interest coverage ratio of not less than 2.00 to 1.00 on a rolling four quarter basis. As of June 30, 2010, we were in compliance with the required leverage ratio and interest coverage ratio covenants. Our financial condition and liquidity would be adversely impacted by the violation of any of these covenants.

Events of Default

The first lien term loan credit agreement includes customary events of default, including but not limited to, payment defaults; material misrepresentations; breaches of covenants; bankruptcy; change of control; material judgments; certain ERISA related breaches and cross-defaults to material indebtedness.

As of June 30, 2010, we believe that we are in full compliance with the financial, reporting and other covenants that govern our credit agreements.

As of June 30, 2010, the weighted average interest rate of our credit facilities (first lien term loan and revolving credit facility) was 4.57% per annum, or 7.26% when taking into account the impact of interest rate swaps, as discussed below. On a pro forma basis to give effect to the notes offering and the application of the net proceeds therefrom, the weighted average interest rate of our revolving credit facility and the notes as of June 30, 2010 would have been 9.73%.

 

144


Table of Contents

Interest Rate Swaps

We were required by the credit agreements to enter into two derivative interest rate swap agreements during the third quarter of 2007 with notional principal amounts of $182.5 million and €100 million. These derivative agreements effectively fixed interest rates at 5.06% per annum and 4.62% per annum, respectively, on a portion of floating debt. The swaps limit the changes in cash flows which result from changes in interest rates. The swaps expired in August 2010. Periodic measurement of hedge effectiveness is performed quarterly. Any changes in the effective portion of these derivatives are recorded as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), a component of stockholders’ equity, while any ineffective portion will be recorded in earnings and reflected in the consolidated statement of income as part of interest expense. As of June 30, 2010, no ineffective portion exists and the fair values of these derivatives are recorded as a liability of $3.4 million within accrued liabilities on our consolidated balance sheet. The fair value of our interest rate swaps was determined based on third-party valuation models.

Generally, borrowings of foreign subsidiaries are made under credit agreements with commercial lenders and are used to fund working capital and other operating requirements.

South Korea

Our South Korean subsidiary had borrowings in South Korea of $111.7 million as of June 30, 2010, consisting of secured indebtedness of $39.7 million, secured bonds of $31.2 million, unsecured indebtedness of $20.4 million, and unsecured corporate bonds of $20.4 million issued in connection with a government sponsored collateralized bond program, with interest rates ranging from 4.23% per annum to 9.96% per annum. The majority of these borrowings are subject to annual renewal. Substantially all of the assets of our South Korean subsidiary serve as collateral for the secured bonds and the other secured indebtedness. The discussion in the next four paragraphs describes certain calendar year 2009 and 2010 activity with respect to our South Korean subsidiary’s borrowings in South Korea.

During the second quarter of 2009, our South Korean subsidiary issued $12.9 million (KRW 15 billion) of unsecured corporate bonds through participation in the South Korean government’s Collateralized Bond Obligation program, and secured bonds of $5.6 million (KRW 6.5 billion) underwritten by a local bank, and obtained a loan of $0.9 million (KRW 1 billion) leaving $1.7 million (KRW 2 billion) undrawn and available. These new debts have maturities of between one and three years, with an average maturity of 2.3 years. In addition, another local bank extended by one year the maturity of $21.4 million (KRW 25 billion) of secured bonds and a $2.6 million (KRW 3 billion) term loan. Substantially all of the terms remained the same, except for the interest rates, which decreased by an average of 2.61% from 8.75% to 6.14%.

During the third quarter of 2009, our South Korean subsidiary obtained new term loan financing from a local bank in South Korea of $4.3 million (KRW 5 billion). This subsidiary used $2.1 million (KRW 2.4 billion) of the proceeds to repay a portion of an existing, higher interest rate term loan at another local bank, leaving $2.2 million (KRW 2.6 billion) undrawn and available against this financing. The subsidiary did not incur prepayment penalty. The remainder of the proceeds are to be used to support increased inter-company sales from our South Korean tool shop to overseas affiliates. This new debt is unsecured and has a one year maturity.

During the first quarter of 2010, we renewed $13.5 million of maturing secured indebtedness for an additional year. There were no material changes to the terms of the loans except the average annual interest rate was reduced from 7.1% to 6.3%.

During the second quarter of 2010, we renewed $20.4 million of maturing secured bonds for an additional two years. We also renewed three additional facilities aggregating $7.8 million for an additional year. There were no material changes to the terms of the loans except for the extension of the maturities. In addition, we obtained a new $4.1 million unsecured bond from the South Korean Government. The bond has a three year maturity with an interest rate of 8.32%.

 

145


Table of Contents

Brazil

As of June 30, 2010, the Company had borrowings in Brazil of $13 million (R$ 23.4 million) which have interest rates ranging from 12.7% to 14.6% with maturity dates ranging from July 2010 to May 2011. This credit is provided through bilateral agreements with three local banks. Periodic interest and principal payments are required. All loans have a duration of one year or less and are secured by certain fixed and current assets.

Italy

During the second quarter of 2009, local banks in Italy increased the receivable factoring facilities available to one of our Italian subsidiaries by $21 million (€14.7 million). As of June 30, 2010, the receivable factoring facilities available to our subsidiary are $37 million (€27.4 million), of which $6.1 million (€5 million) was undrawn at June 30, 2010. These are uncommitted, demand facilities which are subject to termination at the discretion of the banks. Any factoring under these facilities is with recourse, and is secured by the accounts receivable factored. As of June 30, 2010, the liability is recorded on our consolidated balance sheet in current maturities of long-term debt.

Capital Leases

We have capital lease obligations of $18.5 million and $17.6 million as of June 30, 2010 and December 31, 2009, respectively.

 

146


Table of Contents

DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK

The following description of our capital stock and provisions of our certificate of incorporation and bylaws are summaries. You should refer to the certificate of incorporation and the bylaws that will be in effect upon completion of this offering, copies of which have been filed with the SEC as exhibits to our registration statement, of which this prospectus forms a part. The description of our common stock reflects the Corporate Conversion which will occur prior to the closing of this offering.

Upon the closing of this offering, our authorized capital stock will consist of 350,000,000 shares of common stock, par value $0.01 per share, and 50,000,000 shares of preferred stock, par value $0.01 per share. Immediately prior to the offering, after giving effect to the Corporate Conversion, we will have              issued and outstanding shares of common stock and will not have any issued and outstanding preferred stock.

Common Stock

Upon the closing of the Corporate Conversion and this offering, there will be              shares of common stock outstanding (assuming no exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares). All shares of our common stock that will be issued pursuant to the Corporate Conversion, as well all shares of our common stock that will be issued on completion of this offering, will be fully paid and nonassessable.

Subject to preferences that may be applicable to any then outstanding series of preferred stock, the holders of common stock are entitled to receive ratably any dividends that may be declared from time to time by the board of directors. In the event of our liquidation, dissolution or winding-up, the holders of common stock are entitled to share ratably in all assets remaining after payment of liabilities, subject to prior distribution rights of preferred stock, if any, then outstanding. Our common stock has no preemptive or conversion rights or other subscription rights. There are no redemption or sinking fund provisions applicable to our common stock.

The holders of our common stock are entitled to one vote per share and do not have cumulative voting rights. As a result, stockholders owning or controlling more than 50% of the total votes cast for election of directors can elect all the directors in that slate for the year.

Preferred Stock

Our board of directors has the authority, by adopting resolutions, to issue up to 50,000,000 shares of preferred stock in one or more series, with the designations and preferences for each series set forth in the adopting resolutions. Our certificate of incorporation authorizes our board of directors to determine, among other things, the rights, preferences and limitations pertaining to each series of preferred stock. Our board of directors could authorize the issuance of preferred stock with terms and conditions that could discourage a takeover or other transaction that some holders of our common stock might believe to be in their best interests or in which holders of common stock might receive a premium for their shares over and above the market price.

Limitations on Directors’ Liability

Under our bylaws, which will be adopted immediately following the occurrence of the Corporate Conversion, we are obligated to indemnify our directors and officers to the fullest extent permitted by law. We are also expressly required to advance certain expenses to our directors and officers. We believe that these indemnification provisions are useful to attract and retain qualified directors and executive officers.

The DGCL permits a corporation to limit or eliminate a director’s personal liability to the corporation or the holders of its capital stock for breach of duty. Our certificate of incorporation, which will be filed immediately upon the occurrence of the Corporate Conversion, includes a provision that eliminates the personal liability of

 

147


Table of Contents

directors for monetary damages for breach of fiduciary duty as a director to the fullest extent permitted by Delaware law. This limitation is generally unavailable for acts or omissions by a director which (i) were in bad faith, (ii) were the result of active and deliberate dishonesty and were material to the cause of action so adjudicated or (iii) involved a financial profit or other advantage to which such director was not legally entitled. The DGCL also prohibits limitations on director liability for acts or omissions which resulted in a violation of a statute prohibiting certain dividend declarations, certain payments to stockholders after dissolution and particular types of loans. The effect of these provisions is to eliminate our rights and the rights of our stockholders (through stockholders’ derivative suits on behalf of our company) to recover monetary damages against a director for breach of fiduciary duty as a director (including breaches resulting from grossly negligent behavior), except in the situations described above. These provisions will not limit the liability of directors under the federal securities laws of the United States.

Transfer Agent and Registrar

The Transfer Agent and Registrar for our common stock is American Stock Transfer & Trust Company, LLC.

Anti-Takeover Effects of Delaware Law and our Corporate Charter Documents

Our Board

Our board of directors will be divided into three classes with staggered three-year terms. At each annual meeting of stockholders, the successors to directors whose terms then expire will be elected to serve from the time of election and qualification until the third annual meeting following election.

Our certificate of incorporation and our bylaws allow for not less than 3 and not more than 15 directors. The exact number of directors will be fixed from time to time by our board of directors, which number shall be subject to increase or decrease by holders of more than fifty percent of our outstanding common stock until such time that our controlling stockholder and its affiliates, or any person who is an express assignee or designee of our controlling stockholder of its rights under our certificate of incorporation and such assignee’s or designee’s affiliates, ceases to beneficially own (as defined in Rule 13d-3 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934), in the aggregate, at least 50% of the outstanding shares of our common stock (which we refer to as the 50% Trigger Date). In addition, our certificate of incorporation provides that on or after the 50% Trigger Date, directors may be removed only for cause and only by the affirmative vote of stockholders having the right to vote at least two-thirds in voting power of our outstanding voting stock, voting together as a single class, unless such removal for cause is recommended by our board of directors, in which case such removal for cause will require the affirmative vote of stockholders having the right to vote at least a majority in voting power of our outstanding voting stock, voting together as a single class. Prior to the 50% Trigger Date, a director may be removed with or without cause by stockholders having the right to vote at least fifty percent in voting power of our outstanding voting stock, voting together as a single class. Under our bylaws, on or after the 50% Trigger Date, any vacancy on our board of directors, including a vacancy resulting from an enlargement of our board of directors, may be filled by vote of a majority of our directors then in office (prior to that date, any vacancy on the board of directors may be filled by stockholders having the right to vote at least 50% in voting power of our outstanding voting stock, voting together as a single class). Furthermore, our certificate of incorporation and bylaws provide that on or after the 50% Trigger Date, the authorized number of directors determined by our board may be changed only by resolution of our board of directors. The classification of our board of directors and the limitations on the ability of our stockholders to remove directors, change the authorized number of directors and fill vacancies could make it more difficult for a third party to acquire, or discourage a third party from seeking to acquire, control of our company.

Stockholder Action; Special Meeting of Stockholders; Advance Notice Requirements for Stockholder Proposals and Director Nominations

Our certificate of incorporation provides that prior to such date that our controlling stockholder and its affiliates, or any person who is an express assignee or designee of our controlling stockholder of its rights under

 

148


Table of Contents

our certificate of incorporation and such assignee’s or designee’s affiliates, cease to beneficially own (as defined in Rule 13d-3 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934), in the aggregate, at least 33-  1 / 3 % of the outstanding shares of our common stock, which we refer to as the 33-  1 / 3 % Trigger Date, nominations of directors and stockholders’ proposals by our controlling stockholder shall not be subject to the advance notice provisions described below. Our bylaws provide that for all other stockholders, any action required or permitted to be taken by our stockholders at an annual meeting or special meeting of stockholders may only be taken if it is properly brought before such meeting, and if the acting stockholders have fulfilled certain informational requirements, including apprising us of their derivative holdings in the company, and, in the case of director nominations, whether the nominating stockholder has engaged in any related party transactions with the nominee. Our bylaws also provide that after the 33-  1 / 3 % Trigger Date, stockholders may not propose business to be brought before a special meeting of stockholders. Our certificate of incorporation provides that, on or after the 33-  1 / 3 % Trigger Date, action may not be taken by written action in lieu of a meeting (prior to that time action may be taken by written consent).

Our certificate of incorporation and our bylaws also provide that, on or after the 33-  1 / 3 % Trigger Date special meetings of the stockholders can only be called by the chairman of our board of directors, or by our board of directors pursuant to a resolution approved by a majority of the whole board (prior to that time, special meetings of stockholders may be called by the chairman of our board of directors, by our board of directors pursuant to a resolution approved by a majority of the whole board or by any of our controlling stockholder, its affiliates, or any express assignee or designee of our controlling stockholder under our certificate of incorporation, and such assignee’s or designee’s affiliates or any director employed by any of them).

These provisions could have the effect of delaying until the next stockholder meeting stockholder actions that are favored by the holders of a majority of our outstanding voting securities.

Voting

The DGCL provides generally that the affirmative vote of a majority of the shares entitled to vote on any matter is required to amend a corporation’s certificate of incorporation or bylaws, unless a corporation’s certificate of incorporation or bylaws, as the case may be, requires a greater percentage. Our bylaws may be amended or repealed by a majority vote of our board of directors or, prior to the 50% Trigger Date, by stockholders having the right to vote at least 50% in voting power of our outstanding voting stock, voting together as a single class, and from and after the 50% Trigger Date, by stockholders having the right to vote at least two-thirds in voting power of all outstanding voting stock, voting together as a single class. Our certificate of incorporation may be amended with the affirmative vote of stockholders having the right to vote a majority in voting power of our outstanding voting stock, voting together as a single class, except that from and after the 50% Trigger Date, the affirmative vote of stockholders having the right to vote at least two-thirds in voting power of our outstanding voting stock, voting together as a single class, is required to amend the provisions of our certificate of incorporation relating to our board of directors, stockholder action and business combinations.

Business Combinations

We have opted out of Section 203 of the DGCL; however, our certificate of incorporation contains provisions providing that on or after the 50% Trigger Date, stockholders having the right to vote at least two-thirds in voting power of the outstanding voting stock, voting together as a single class, or a majority of our disinterested directors, is required to approve a Business Combination (as defined in the certificate of incorporation, which limits such term to business combinations with entities controlled by persons or entities (other than Cerberus and its affiliates) that beneficially own more than 20% of our outstanding voting stock) without the fulfillment of several pre-conditions, including; certain minimum requirements with respect to the consideration paid in such Business Combination, the form of consideration, the payment of dividends and minimum dividend payments, as well as prohibitions on interested stockholder transactions and procedural requirements related to the delivery of proxy or information statements to be mailed to stockholders in connection with a proposed Business Combination. Under certain circumstances, this provision will make it more

 

149


Table of Contents

difficult for a person who would be an “interested stockholder” to effect various business combinations with our company. This provision may encourage companies interested in acquiring our company to negotiate in advance with our board of directors because the stockholder approval requirement would be avoided if a majority of disinterested directors then serving on our board of directors approves the business combination. These provisions also may have the effect of preventing changes in our board of directors and may make it more difficult to accomplish transactions which stockholders may otherwise deem to be in their best interests.

“Blank Check” Preferred Stock

We will be authorized to issue, without any further vote or action by the stockholders, up to 50,000,000 shares of preferred stock in one or more classes or series and, with respect to each such class or series, to fix the number of shares constituting the class or series and the designation of the class or series, the voting powers, if any, of the shares of the class or series, and the preferences and relative, participating, optional and other special rights, if any, and any qualifications, limitations or restrictions, of the shares of such class or series.

Corporate Opportunity

Our certificate of incorporation provides that we renounce any interest or expectancy in, or in being offered an opportunity to participate in, any business opportunity which may be a corporate opportunity for Cerberus or the members of our board of directors who are not our employees (including any directors who also serve as officers). We do not renounce our interest in any corporate opportunity offered to any such director or officer if such opportunity is expressly offered to such person solely in his or her capacity as our director or officer.

Credit Facility

Under our credit agreements, a change of control may lead the lenders to exercise remedies, such as acceleration of the loan, termination of their obligations to fund additional advances and collection against the collateral securing such loan.

Registration Rights

Upon the closing of this offering, our controlling stockholder, which will be the indirect holder of              shares of our common stock, will have the right to require us to register its shares under the Securities Act under specified circumstances.

Demand and Form S-3 Registration Rights

Beginning six months after the closing of this offering, our controlling stockholder, subject to specified limitations, may require that we register all or part of its shares of our common stock for sale under the Securities Act on an unlimited number of occasions. In addition, our controlling stockholder may from time to time make demand for registrations on Form S-3, a short form registration statement, when we are eligible to use that form.

Piggyback Registration Rights

If we register any of our common stock, either for our own account or for the account of other securityholders, our controlling stockholder is entitled to notice of the registration and to include its shares of common stock in the registration.

Limitations and Expenses

Other than in a demand registration, with specified exceptions, our controlling stockholder’s right to include shares in a registration is subject to the right of the underwriters to limit the number of shares included in the offering. All fees, costs and expenses of any demand registrations, piggyback registrations and any registrations on Form S-3 will be paid by us, and all selling expenses, including underwriting discounts and commissions, will be paid by the holders of the securities being registered.

For additional information, see “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions—Registration Rights Agreement.”

 

150


Table of Contents

SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE

Prior to this offering, there has been no market for our common stock, and a liquid trading market for our common stock may not develop or be sustained after this offering. Future sales of substantial amounts of our common stock, including shares underlying RSUs or in the public market after this offering, or the anticipation of those sales, could adversely affect the price of our common stock from time to time and could impair our ability to raise capital through sales of our equity securities.

Excluding shares of common stock issuable upon vesting of RSUs or exercise of stock options, upon the completion of this offering, we will have outstanding              shares of common stock, after giving effect to the issuance of              shares of common stock in this offering. In addition to the shares of common stock outstanding,             shares have been reserved for issuance upon vesting of RSUs that we expect to grant pursuant to our 2010 Equity Incentive Plan and that are subject to vesting schedules that extend for a period of eighteen months after this offering. See “Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—Long Term Incentive Compensation Awards.” In addition to these RSUs, we intend to grant stock options covering              shares of our common stock to our executive officers, certain directors and employees in connection with the consummation of this offering. See “Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Components of Compensation—Equity-Based Incentive Awards—2010 Equity Incentive Plan.” Such RSUs and stock option are subject to vesting requirements.

Of the shares to be outstanding after the completion of this offering, the            shares sold in this offering will be freely tradable without restriction under the Securities Act unless purchased by our “affiliates,” as that term is defined in Rule 144 under the Securities Act. All of the remaining             shares of common stock are held by “affiliates” and therefore are “restricted securities” under Rule 144 or are otherwise “restricted securities” under Rule 144. After the 180-day lock-up period, these restricted securities may be sold in the public market only if registered or if they qualify for an exemption from registration, such as under Rule 144 or Rule 701 under the Securities Act. All of these restricted securities and all other shares of common stock other than those sold in this offering will be subject to the 180-day lock-up period described below.

Rule 144

In general, a person who has beneficially owned restricted shares of our common stock for at least six months would be entitled to sell such securities, provided that (i) such person is not deemed to have been one of our affiliates at the time of, or at any time during the 90 days preceding, a sale and (ii) we are subject to the Exchange Act periodic reporting requirements for at least 90 days before the sale. Persons who have beneficially owned restricted shares of our common stock for at least six months but who are our affiliates at the time of, or any time during the 90 days preceding, a sale, would be subject to additional restrictions, by which such person would be entitled to sell within any three month period only a number of securities that does not exceed the greater of either of the following:

 

   

1% of the number of shares of our common stock then outstanding, which will equal approximately              shares immediately after this offering, assuming no exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares, based on the number of shares issuable pursuant to our Corporate Conversion; or

 

   

the average weekly trading volume of our common stock on the New York Stock Exchange during the four calendar weeks preceding the filing of a notice on Form 144 with respect to the sale;

provided, in each case, that we are subject to the Exchange Act periodic reporting requirements for at least 90 days before the sale. Such sales both by affiliates and by non-affiliates must also comply with the manner of sale, current public information and notice provisions of Rule 144 to the extent applicable.

 

151


Table of Contents

Lock-Up Agreements

We, our officers and directors, our controlling stockholder and Cerberus have agreed with the underwriters, subject to certain exceptions, not to sell, dispose of or hedge any shares of our common stock or equity or profits interests of Tower International Holdings, LLC or any securities convertible into or exchangeable for our common stock or equity or profits interests of Tower International Holdings, LLC during the period ending 180 days after the date of this prospectus, except with the prior written consent of each of the representatives of the underwriters. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if (i) during the last 17 days of the 180-day restricted period, we issue an earnings release or material news or a material event relating to our company occurs; or (ii) prior to the expiration of the 180-day restricted period, we announce that we will release earnings results during the 16-day period beginning on the last day of the 180-day restricted period, the restrictions described above shall continue to apply until the expiration of the 18-day period beginning on the issuance of the earnings release or the occurrence of the material news or material event. See “Underwriting.”

Rule 701

Rule 701, as currently in effect, permits resales of shares in reliance upon Rule 144 but without compliance with certain restrictions, including the holding period requirement, of Rule 144. Any of our employees, officers, directors or consultants who purchased shares under a written compensatory plan or contract may be entitled to rely on the resale provisions of Rule 701. Rule 701 permits affiliates to sell their Rule 701 shares under Rule 144 without complying with the holding period requirements of Rule 144. Rule 701 further provides that non-affiliates may sell their shares in reliance on Rule 144 without having to comply with the holding period, public information, volume limitation or notice provisions of Rule 144. All holders of Rule 701 shares are required to wait until 90 days after the date of this prospectus before selling their shares.

Registration Rights

Upon the closing of this offering, our controlling stockholder, as the holder of an aggregate of            shares of our common stock will have the right to require us to register these shares under the Securities Act under specified circumstances. After registration pursuant to these rights, these shares will become freely tradable without restriction under the Securities Act. Please see “Description of Capital Stock—Registration Rights” for additional information regarding these registration rights.

 

152


Table of Contents

MATERIAL UNITED STATES FEDERAL INCOME AND ESTATE TAX CONSIDERATIONS

FOR NON-U.S. HOLDERS

The following is a general discussion of certain United States federal income and estate tax consequences of the ownership and disposition of our common stock by a non-U.S. holder that purchases shares pursuant to this offering. As used in this discussion, the term non-U.S. holder means a beneficial owner of our common stock that, for U.S. federal income tax purposes, is an individual, corporation, estate or trust other than:

 

   

an individual who is a citizen or resident of the United States;

 

   

a corporation (including any entity treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes) created or organized in or under the laws of the United States, any State thereof or the District of Columbia;

 

   

an estate whose income is includible in gross income for U.S. federal income tax purposes regardless of its source; or

 

   

a trust (1) if a U.S. court is able to exercise primary supervision over the administration of the trust and one or more U.S. persons have authority to control all substantial decisions of the trust, or (2) that has a valid election in effect under applicable Treasury regulations to be treated as a U.S. person.

If any entity taxed as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes holds common stock, the tax treatment of a partner will generally depend upon the status of the partner and the activities of the partnership. A partnership and a partner of a partnership holding our common stock are urged to consult their own tax advisor.

This discussion does not consider:

 

   

federal gift tax consequences, U.S. state or local or non-U.S. tax consequences (and holders should also note that the rules for determining whether an individual is a non-resident alien for income tax purposes may differ from those applicable for estate tax purposes);

 

   

specific facts and circumstances that may be relevant to a particular non-U.S. holder’s tax position, including, if the non-U.S. holder is a partnership or trust, that the U.S. tax consequences of holding and disposing of our common stock may be affected by certain determinations made at the partner or beneficiary level;

 

   

the tax consequences for the stockholders or beneficiaries of a non-U.S. holder;

 

   

special tax rules that may apply to particular non-U.S. holders, such as financial institutions, insurance companies, tax-exempt organizations, hybrid entities, broker-dealers, traders in securities, U.S. expatriates and former long-term permanent residents of the United States, an integral part or controlled entity of a foreign sovereign, regulated investment companies, “controlled foreign corporations,” “passive foreign investment companies,” corporations that accumulate earnings to avoid U.S. federal income tax, tax-qualified retirement plans, holders subject to the alternative minimum tax, persons who own more than 5% of our common stock and persons who hold or receive our common stock pursuant to the exercise of any employee stock option or otherwise as compensation; or

 

   

special tax rules that may apply to a non-U.S. holder that holds our common stock as part of a straddle, hedge, conversion transaction, synthetic security or other integrated investment.

The following discussion is based on provisions of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”), applicable U.S. Treasury regulations and administrative and judicial interpretations, all as in effect on the date of this prospectus, and all of which are subject to change, retroactively or prospectively. We have not requested, and do not intend to request, a ruling from the U.S. Internal Revenue Service (the “IRS”) with respect to any of the U.S. federal income or estate tax consequences described below, and as a result there can be no

 

153


Table of Contents

assurance that the IRS will agree with the conclusions we have reached and describe herein. The following summary assumes that a non-U.S. holder holds our common stock as a “capital asset” within the meaning of section 1221 of the Code (generally, property held for investment). Each non-U.S. holder should consult a tax advisor regarding the U.S. federal, state, local and non-U.S. income and other tax consequences of acquiring, holding and disposing of shares of our common stock.

Distributions and Dividends

Generally, distributions paid to a non-U.S. holder with respect to our common stock will constitute dividends for U.S. federal income tax purposes to the extent paid from our current or accumulated earnings and profits, as determined under U.S. federal income tax principles. If a distribution exceeds our current and accumulated earnings and profits, the excess will be treated as a tax-free return of the non-U.S. holder’s investment, up to such holder’s tax basis in the common stock. Any remaining excess will be treated as capital gain, subject to the tax treatment described below in “Gain on Disposition of Common Stock.”

In the event that we pay dividends on our common stock, we will have to withhold a U.S. federal withholding tax at a rate of 30%, or a lower rate under an applicable income tax treaty, from the gross amount of dividends paid to a non-U.S. holder.

Dividends that are effectively connected with a non-U.S. holder’s conduct of a trade or business in the United States and, if an income tax treaty applies, attributable to a permanent establishment in the United States (“ECI”), are taxed on a net income basis at the regular graduated rates and in the manner applicable to U.S. persons. In that case, we will not have to withhold U.S. federal withholding tax if the non-U.S. holder complies with applicable certification and disclosure requirements. In addition, in the case of a holder that is a foreign corporation and has ECI, a branch profits tax may be imposed at a 30% rate, or a lower rate under an applicable income tax treaty, on such holder’s dividend equivalent amount.

In order to claim the benefit of an income tax treaty or claim exemption from withholding because the income is effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business in the United States, the non-U.S. holder must provide a properly executed Form W-8BEN, for treaty benefits, or W-8ECI, for effectively connected income, prior to the payment of dividends. These forms must be periodically updated. Non-U.S. holders should consult their tax advisors regarding their entitlement to benefits under a relevant income tax treaty and their ability to claim exemption from withholding because the income is effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business in the United States, and related certification requirements.

A non-U.S. holder that is eligible for a reduced rate of U.S. federal withholding tax under an income tax treaty may obtain a refund or credit of any excess amounts withheld by filing an appropriate claim for a refund with the IRS in a timely manner.

Gain on Disposition of Common Stock

A non-U.S. holder generally will not be taxed on gain recognized on a disposition of our common stock unless:

 

   

the gain is effectively connected with a non-U.S. holder’s conduct of a trade or business in the United States and, if an income tax treaty applies, is attributable to a permanent establishment maintained by the non-U.S. holder in the United States; in this case, the gain will be taxed on a net income basis at the regular graduated rates and in the manner applicable to U.S. persons, unless an applicable treaty provides otherwise, and, if the non-U.S. holder is a foreign corporation, the branch profits tax described above may also apply;

 

   

the non-U.S. holder is an individual who is present in the United States for 183 days or more in the taxable year of the disposition and meets other requirements; in this case, the non-U.S. holder will be subject to a 30% tax on the gain derived from the disposition; or

 

154


Table of Contents
   

we are or have been a United States real property holding corporation, or “USRPHC,” for U.S. federal income tax purposes at any time during the shorter of the five-year period ending on the date of disposition or the period that the non-U.S. holder held our common stock. We believe that we are not currently, and we do not anticipate becoming in the future, a USRPHC.

Federal Estate Tax

Common stock owned or treated as owned by an individual who is a non-U.S. holder (as specifically defined for estate tax purposes) at the time of death, will be included in the individual’s gross estate for U.S. federal estate tax purposes, and therefore may be subject to U.S. federal estate tax, unless an applicable estate tax or other treaty provides otherwise.

Information Reporting and Backup Withholding

We must report annually to the IRS and to each non-U.S. holder the amount of dividends paid to that holder and the tax withheld from those dividends. These reporting requirements apply regardless of whether withholding was reduced or eliminated by an applicable income tax treaty. Copies of the information returns reporting those dividends and withholding may also be made available to the tax authorities in the country in which the non-U.S. holder is a resident under the provisions of an applicable income tax treaty or agreement.

Under some circumstances, U.S. Treasury regulations require additional information reporting and backup withholding (currently at a rate of 28%) on some payments on our common stock. The gross amount of dividends paid to a non-U.S. holder that fails to certify its non-U.S. holder status in accordance with applicable U.S. Treasury regulations generally will be reduced by backup withholding at the applicable rate.

The payment of the proceeds of the disposition of our common stock by a non-U.S. holder to or through the U.S. office of any broker generally will be reported to the IRS and reduced by backup withholding unless the non-U.S. holder either certifies its status as a non-U.S. holder under penalties of perjury or otherwise establishes an exemption. The payment of the proceeds of the disposition of our common stock by a non-U.S. holder to or through a non-U.S. office of a non-U.S. broker generally will not be reduced by backup withholding or reported to the IRS unless the non-U.S. broker has certain enumerated connections with the United States. In general, the payment of proceeds from the disposition of our common stock by or through a non-U.S. office of a broker that is a U.S. person or that has certain enumerated connections with the United States will be reported to the IRS and may, in limited circumstances, be reduced by backup withholding, unless the broker receives a statement from the non-U.S. holder, signed under penalty of perjury, certifying its non-U.S. status or the broker has documentary evidence in its files that the holder is a non-U.S. holder.

Non-U.S. holders should consult their own tax advisors regarding the application of the information reporting and backup withholding rules to them.

Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Any amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules from a payment to a non-U.S. holder will be refunded, or credited against the holder’s U.S. federal income tax liability, if any, provided that the required information or appropriate claim for refund is furnished to the IRS in a timely manner.

New Reporting Requirements

Recently enacted legislation generally imposes a withholding tax of 30% on payments to certain foreign entities, after December 31, 2012, including dividends and on the gross proceeds of dispositions of U.S. common stock, unless various U.S. information reporting and due diligence requirements that are different from, and in addition to, the certification requirements described above have been satisfied. Non-U.S. holders should consult their tax advisers regarding the possible implications of this legislation on their investment in our common stock.

 

155


Table of Contents

UNDERWRITING

Goldman, Sachs & Co., Citigroup Global Markets Inc. and J.P. Morgan Securities LLC are acting as joint book-running managers of the offering and as representatives of the underwriters named below. Subject to the terms and conditions stated in the underwriting agreement dated the date of this prospectus, each underwriter named below has severally agreed to purchase, and we have agreed to sell to that underwriter, the number of shares set forth opposite the underwriter’s name.

 

Underwriter

   Number of
Shares

Goldman, Sachs & Co.

  

Citigroup Global Markets Inc.

  

J.P. Morgan Securities LLC

  

Wells Fargo Securities, LLC

  

Robert W. Baird & Co. Incorporated

  

Lazard Capital Markets LLC

  
    

Total

  
    

The underwriting agreement provides that the obligations of the underwriters to purchase the shares included in this offering are subject to approval of legal matters by counsel and to other conditions. The underwriters are obligated to purchase all the shares (other than those covered by the option to purchase additional shares described below) if they purchase any of the shares.

Shares sold by the underwriters to the public will initially be offered at the initial public offering price set forth on the cover page of this prospectus. Any shares sold by the underwriters to securities dealers may be sold at a discount from the initial public offering price not to exceed $             per share. If all the shares are not sold at the initial offering price, the underwriters may change the offering price and the other selling terms. The underwriters do not expect sales to discretionary accounts to exceed five percent of the total number of shares offered. The offering of the shares by the underwriters is subject to receipt and acceptance and subject to the underwriters’ right to reject any order in whole or in part.

If the underwriters sell more shares than the total number set forth in the table above, we have granted to the underwriters an option, exercisable for 30 days from the date of this prospectus, to purchase up to              additional shares at the public offering price less the underwriting discount. To the extent the option is exercised, each underwriter must purchase a number of additional shares approximately proportionate to that underwriter’s initial purchase commitment. Any shares issued or sold under the option will be issued and sold on the same terms and conditions as the other shares that are the subject of this offering.

We, our officers and directors, our controlling stockholder and Cerberus have agreed that, for a period of 180 days from the date of this prospectus, we and they will not without the prior written consent of each of the representatives, dispose of or hedge any shares of our common stock or equity or profits interests in Tower International Holdings, LLC or any securities convertible into or exchangeable for our common stock or such equity or profits interests. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if (i) during the last 17 days of the 180-day restricted period, we issue an earnings release or announce material news or a material event; or (ii) prior to the expiration of the 180-day restricted period, we announce that we will release earnings results during the 16-day period beginning on the last day of the 180-day restricted period, the restrictions described above shall continue to apply until the expiration of the 18-day period beginning on the issuance of the earnings release or the announcement of the material news or material event.

At our request, the underwriters have reserved up to 5% of the shares for sale at the initial public offering price to persons who are directors, officers or other employees, or who are otherwise associated with us, through a directed share program. The number of shares available for sale to the general public will be reduced by the number of directed shares purchased by participants in the program. Except for our officers and directors at the

 

156


Table of Contents

time of consummation of the offering who have entered into lock-up agreements as contemplated in the immediately preceding paragraph, each person buying shares through the directed share program has agreed that, for a period of 180 days from the date of this prospectus, he or she will not, without the prior written consent of each of the representatives, dispose of or hedge any shares of our common stock or equity or profits interests of Tower International Holdings, LLC or any securities convertible into or exchangeable for our common stock or equity or profits interests of Tower International Holdings, LLC. For certain officers and directors purchasing shares through the directed share program, the lock-up agreements contemplated in the immediately preceding paragraph shall govern with respect to their purchases. Any directed shares not purchased will be offered by the underwriters to the general public on the same basis as all other shares offered. We have agreed to indemnify the underwriters against certain liabilities and expenses, including liabilities under the Securities Act, in connection with the sales of the directed shares.

Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for our shares. Consequently, the initial public offering price for the shares was determined by negotiations between us and the representatives. Among the factors considered in determining the initial public offering price were our results of operations, our current financial condition, our future prospects, our markets, the economic conditions in and future prospects for the industry in which we compete, our management, and currently prevailing general conditions in the equity securities markets, including current market valuations of publicly traded companies considered comparable to our company. We cannot assure you, however, that the price at which the shares will sell in the public market after this offering will not be lower than the initial public offering price or that an active trading market in our shares will develop and continue after this offering.

Our shares have been approved for listing on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “TOWR.”

The following table shows the underwriting discounts and commissions that we are to pay to the underwriters in connection with this offering. These amounts are shown assuming both no exercise and full exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares.

 

     No
Exercise
   Full
Exercise

Per share

   $                 $             

Total

   $                 $             

We estimate that the total expenses of this offering will be $            . We are reimbursing the underwriters for the cost of qualifying the offering under Rule 5110 of the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority.

In connection with the offering, the underwriters may purchase and sell shares in the open market. Purchases and sales in the open market may include short sales, purchases to cover short positions, which may include purchases pursuant to the option to purchase additional shares, and stabilizing purchases.

 

   

Short sales involve secondary market sales by the underwriters of a greater number of shares than they are required to purchase in the offering.

 

   

“Covered” short sales are sales of shares in an amount up to the number of shares represented by the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares.

 

   

“Naked” short sales are sales of shares in an amount in excess of the number of shares represented by the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares.

 

   

Covering transactions involve purchases of shares either pursuant to the option to purchase additional shares or in the open market after the distribution has been completed in order to cover short positions.

 

   

To close a naked short position, the underwriters must purchase shares in the open market after the distribution has been completed. A naked short position is more likely to be created if the underwriters are concerned that there may be downward pressure on the price of the shares in the open market after pricing that could adversely affect investors who purchase in the offering.

 

157


Table of Contents
   

To close a covered short position, the underwriters must purchase shares in the open market after the distribution has been completed or must exercise the option to purchase additional shares. In determining the source of shares to close the covered short position, the underwriters will consider, among other things, the price of shares available for purchase in the open market as compared to the price at which they may purchase shares through the option to purchase additional shares.

 

   

Stabilizing transactions involve bids to purchase shares so long as the stabilizing bids do not exceed a specified maximum.

Purchases to cover short positions and stabilizing purchases, as well as other purchases by the underwriters for their own accounts, may have the effect of preventing or retarding a decline in the market price of the shares. They may also cause the price of the shares to be higher than the price that would otherwise exist in the open market in the absence of these transactions. The underwriters may conduct these transactions on the New York Stock Exchange, in the over-the-counter market or otherwise. If the underwriters commence any of these transactions, they may discontinue them at any time.

The underwriters and their respective affiliates are full-service financial institutions engaged in various activities, which may include securities trading, commercial and investment banking, financial advisory, investment management, principal investment, hedging, financing and brokerage activities. Certain of the underwriters and their respective affiliates have, from time to time, performed, and may in the future perform, various financial advisory and investment banking services for us, for which they received or will receive customary fees and reimbursement of expenses. In addition, J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, or its affiliate, is a lender under our first lien term loan facility, which is 90% owned by Cerberus, and J.P. Morgan Securities LLC and Wells Fargo Securities, LLC, or their affiliates, are lenders under our asset-based revolving credit facility.

In the ordinary course of their various business activities, the underwriters and their respective affiliates may make or hold a broad array of instruments and actively trade debt and equity securities (or related derivative securities) and financial instruments (including bank loans) for their own account and for the accounts of their customers and may at any time hold long and short positions in such securities and instruments. Such investment and securities activities may involve our securities and instruments.

We have agreed to indemnify the underwriters against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act, or to contribute to payments the underwriters may be required to make because of any of those liabilities.

Lazard Frères & Co. LLC referred this transaction to Lazard Capital Markets LLC and will receive a referral fee from Lazard Capital Markets LLC in connection therewith.

Notice to Prospective Investors in the European Economic Area

In relation to each member state of the European Economic Area that has implemented the Prospectus Directive (each, a “Relevant Member State”), an offer to the public of any shares described in this prospectus may not be made in that Relevant Member State, except that the shares may be offered to the public in that Relevant Implementation State, if and to the extent they have been implemented in that Relevant Member State:

 

   

to any legal entity that is authorized or regulated to operate in the financial markets or, if not so authorized or regulated, whose corporate purpose is solely to invest in securities;

 

   

to any legal entity that has two or more of (1) an average of at least 250 employees during the last financial year; (2) a total balance sheet of more than €43,000,000 and (3) an annual net turnover of more than €50,000,000, as shown in its last annual or consolidated accounts;

 

   

to fewer than 100 natural or legal persons in the Relevant Member State (other than qualified investors as defined below) subject to obtaining the prior consent of the underwriters for any such offer; or

 

   

in any other circumstances that do not require the publication of a prospectus pursuant to Article 3 of the Prospectus Directive,

 

158


Table of Contents

provided that no such offer of the shares shall result in a requirement for the publication by the Company or the underwriters of a prospectus pursuant to Article 3 of the Prospectus Directive.

Each purchaser of shares described in this prospectus located within a relevant member state will be deemed to have represented, acknowledged and agreed that it is a “qualified investor” within the meaning of Article 2(1)(e) of the Prospectus Directive.

For purposes of this provision, the expression an “offer to the public” in relation to any shares in any Relevant Member State means the communication in any form and by any means of sufficient information on the terms of the offer and the shares to be offered so as to enable an investor to decide to purchase or subscribe for the shares, as the expression may be varied in that member state by any measure implementing the Prospectus Directive in that member state, and the expression “Prospectus Directive” means Directive 2003/71/EC and includes any relevant implementing measure in each Relevant Member State.

The sellers of the shares have not authorized and do not authorize the making of any offer of shares through any financial intermediary on their behalf, other than offers made by the underwriters with a view to the final placement of the shares as contemplated in this prospectus. Accordingly, no purchaser of the shares, other than the underwriters, is authorized to make any further offer of the shares on behalf of the sellers or the underwriters.

Notice to Prospective Investors in the United Kingdom

This prospectus is only being distributed to, and is only directed at, persons who are outside the United Kingdom or who are qualified investors within the meaning of Article 2(1)(e) of the Prospectus Directive that are also (i) investment professionals falling within Article 19(5) of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (Financial Promotion) Order 2005 (the “Order”) or (ii) high net worth entities, and other persons to whom it may lawfully be communicated, falling within Article 49(2)(a) to (d) of the Order (each such person being referred to as a “relevant person”). This prospectus and its contents are confidential and should not be distributed, published or reproduced (in whole or in part) or disclosed by recipients to any other persons in the United Kingdom. Any person in the United Kingdom that is not a relevant person should not act or rely on this document or any of its contents.

Notice to Prospective Investors in France

Neither this prospectus nor any other offering material relating to the shares described in this prospectus has been submitted to the clearance procedures of the Autorité des Marchés Financiers or of the competent authority of another member state of the European Economic Area and notified to the Autorité des Marchés Financiers. The shares have not been offered or sold and will not be offered or sold, directly or indirectly, to the public in France. Neither this prospectus nor any other offering material relating to the shares has been or will be:

 

   

released, issued, distributed or caused to be released, issued or distributed to the public in France; or

 

   

used in connection with any offer for subscription or sale of the shares to the public in France.

Such offers, sales and distributions will be made in France only:

 

   

to qualified investors ( investisseurs qualifiés ) and/or to a restricted circle of investors ( cercle restreint d’investisseurs ), in each case investing for their own account, all as defined in, and in accordance with articles L.411-2, D.411-1, D.411-2, D.734-1, D.744-1, D.754-1 and D.764-1 of the French Code monétaire et financier ;

 

   

to investment services providers authorized to engage in portfolio management on behalf of third parties; or

 

   

in a transaction that, in accordance with article L.411-2- I-1°-or-2°-or 3° of the French Code monétaire et financier and article 211-2 of the General Regulations ( Règlement Général ) of the Autorité des Marchés Financiers , does not constitute a public offer ( offre au public ).

 

159


Table of Contents

Pursuant to Article 211-3 of the General Regulations ( Règlement Général ) of the Autorité des Marchés Financiers, the shares may be resold directly or indirectly, only in compliance with articles L.411-1, L.411-2, L.412-1 and L.621-8 through L.621-8-3 of the French Code monétaire et financier .

Notice to Prospective Investors in Hong Kong

The contents of this prospectus have not been reviewed by any regulatory authority in Hong Kong. You are advised to exercise caution in relation to the offer. If you are in any doubt about any of the contents of this document, you should obtain independent professional advice. The shares may not be offered or sold in Hong Kong by means of any document other than (i) in circumstances which do not constitute an offer to the public within the meaning of the Companies Ordinance (Cap. 32, Laws of Hong Kong), or (ii) to “professional investors” within the meaning of the Securities and Futures Ordinance (Cap. 571, Laws of Hong Kong) and any rules made thereunder, or (iii) in other circumstances which do not result in the document being a “prospectus” within the meaning of the Companies Ordinance (Cap. 32, Laws of Hong Kong) and no advertisement, invitation or document relating to the shares may be issued or may be in the possession of any person for the purpose of issue (in each case whether in Hong Kong or elsewhere), which is directed at, or the contents of which are likely to be accessed or read by, the public in Hong Kong (except if permitted to do so under the laws of Hong Kong) other than with respect to shares which are or are intended to be disposed of only to persons outside Hong Kong or only to “professional investors” within the meaning of the Securities and Futures Ordinance (Cap. 571, Laws of Hong Kong) and any rules made thereunder.

Notice to Prospective Investors in Japan

The shares offered in this prospectus have not been and will not be registered under the Financial Instruments and Exchange Law of Japan. The shares have not been offered or sold and will not be offered or sold, directly or indirectly, in Japan or to or for the account of any resident of Japan (which term as used herein means any person resident in Japan, including any corporation or other entity organized under the laws of Japan), except (i) pursuant to an exemption from the registration requirements of the Financial Instruments and Exchange Law and (ii) in compliance with any other applicable requirements of Japanese law.

Notice to Prospective Investors in Singapore

This prospectus has not been registered as a prospectus with the Monetary Authority of Singapore. Accordingly, this prospectus and any other document or material in connection with the offer or sale, or invitation for subscription or purchase, of the shares may not be circulated or distributed, nor may the shares be offered or sold, or be made the subject of an invitation for subscription or purchase, whether directly or indirectly, to persons in Singapore other than (i) to an institutional investor (as defined under Section 4A(1)(c) of the Securities and Futures Act (the “SFA”) under Section 274 of the SFA, or (ii) to a relevant person (as defined under section 275(2) of the SFA) pursuant to Section 275(1), or to any person pursuant to an offer that is made on terms that such shares are acquired at a consideration of not less than S$200,000 (or its equivalent in a foreign currency) for each transaction, whether such amount is to be paid for in cash or by exchange of securities or assets, subject to the terms set out in Section 275(1A). This prospectus is not a prospectus as defined in the SFA and, accordingly, statutory liability under the SFA in relation to the content of prospectuses will not apply.

Where the shares are subscribed or purchased under Section 275 of the SFA by a relevant person which is:

 

   

a corporation (which is not an accredited investor (as defined in Section 4A(1) of the SFA)) the sole business of which is to hold investments and the entire share capital of which is owned by one or more individuals, each of whom is an accredited investor; or

 

   

a trust (where the trustee is not an accredited investor (as defined in Section 4A(1) of the SFA)) whose sole purpose is to hold investments and each beneficiary of the trust is an individual who is an accredited investor,

 

160


Table of Contents

shares, debentures and units of shares and debentures of that corporation or the beneficiaries’ rights and interest (howsoever described) in that trust shall not be transferred within six months after that corporation or that trust has acquired the shares pursuant to an offer made under Section 275 of the SFA except:

 

   

to an institutional investor or to a relevant person (as defined in Section 275(2) of the SFA), or to any person pursuant to an offer that is made on terms that such shares, debentures and units of shares and debentures of that corporation or such rights and interest in that trust are acquired at a consideration of not less than $200,000 (or its equivalent in a foreign currency) for each transaction, whether such amount is to be paid for in cash or by exchange of securities or other assets;

 

   

where no consideration is or will be given for the transfer; or

 

   

where the transfer is by operation of law.

Investors should therefore ensure that their own transfer arrangements comply with the restrictions. Investors should seek legal advice to ensure compliance with the above arrangement. Investment involves risk. Investors should read all applicable offering documents for further details before investing. Investors should seek advice from a financial adviser before making a commitment to purchase the shares. In the event that an investor chooses not to seek advice from a financial adviser, he should consider whether the shares are suitable for him. Please note that we do not act as your adviser in any way and do not and are not willing to, take on any fiduciary obligations to you.

CONFLICTS OF INTEREST

More than 5% of the net proceeds of the offering is expected to be used to repay borrowings we have received from both JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., an affiliate of J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., an affiliate of Wells Fargo Securities, LLC. Because J.P. Morgan Securities LLC and Wells Fargo Securities, LLC are participating underwriters in this offering, a “conflict of interest” is deemed to exist under the applicable provisions of Rule 2720 of the Conduct Rules of the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc., or FINRA. Accordingly, this offering will be made in compliance with the applicable provisions of Rule 2720 of the Conduct Rules. Rule 2720 currently requires that a “qualified independent underwriter,” as defined by the FINRA rules, participate in the preparation of the registration statement and the prospectus and exercise the usual standards of due diligence in respect thereto. Goldman, Sachs & Co. is serving in that capacity and Goldman, Sachs & Co. will receive $10,000 from us as compensation for such role. We have agreed to indemnify Goldman, Sachs & Co. against certain liabilities incurred in connection with acting as qualified independent underwriter for the offering, including liabilities under the Securities Act. In addition, in accordance with Rule 2720, neither J.P. Morgan Securities LLC nor Wells Fargo Securities, LLC will make sales to discretionary accounts without the prior written consent of the customer.

LEGAL MATTERS

Lowenstein Sandler PC, New York, New York, will pass upon the validity of the common stock offered hereby. Davis Polk & Wardwell LLP, New York, New York, is counsel for the underwriters in connection with this offering.

EXPERTS

The consolidated financial statements of Tower Automotive, LLC and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2009 and 2008 (successor) and for each of the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008 (successor), for the five-month period ended December 31, 2007 (successor), and of Tower Automotive, Inc. (d/b/a TA Delaware, Inc.) (the Predecessor) for the seven-month period ended July 31, 2007 included in this Prospectus, except for Metalsa S. de R.L. and subsidiaries (“Metalsa”), an entity which was accounted for by the Company using the equity method of accounting for the five-month period ended December 31, 2007 (successor) and for the seven-month period ended July 31, 2007 (predecessor), and the related financial statement schedule

 

161


Table of Contents

included elsewhere in the Registration Statement, have been audited by Deloitte & Touche LLP as stated in their report appearing herein and elsewhere in the Registration Statement (which report expresses an unqualified opinion on the consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedule and includes an explanatory paragraph relating to the application of the purchase accounting method to account for the acquisition of Tower Automotive, Inc. and the change in the measurement date of the defined benefit plan assets and liabilities to coincide with the Company’s year end). The financial statements of Metalsa have been audited by KPMG Cárdenas Dosal, S.C., as stated in their report included herein. Such consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedule of the Company are included herein in reliance upon the report of Deloitte & Touche LLP given upon their authority as experts in accounting and auditing and Deloitte & Touche LLP is an independent registered public accounting firm.

The consolidated financial statements of Metalsa, S. de R.L. and subsidiaries as of and for the year ended December 31, 2007 have been included herein, in reliance upon the report of KPMG Cárdenas Dosal, S.C., independent registered public accounting firm, appearing elsewhere herein, and upon the authority of said firm as experts in accounting and auditing.

The audit report of KPMG Cárdenas Dosal, S.C. covering the December 31, 2007 consolidated financial statements of Metalsa, S. de R.L. and subsidiaries refers to the adoption of the provisions of FASB Interpretation No. 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes an Interpretation of FASB Statement No. 109 , as of January 1, 2007, and to the adoption of the recognition and disclosure provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standard No. 158, Employers’ Accounting for Defined Benefit Pension and Other Postretirement Plans , as of December 31, 2007.

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

We have filed with the SEC a registration statement on Form S-1 under the Securities Act to register our common stock being offered in this prospectus. This prospectus, which forms part of the registration statement, does not contain all the information included in the registration statement and the amendments, exhibits and schedules thereto. For further information about us and the common stock being offered in this prospectus, we refer you to the registration statement and the exhibits and schedules thereto. We are not currently subject to the informational requirements of the Exchange Act. As a result of the offering of the shares of our common stock, we will become subject to the informational requirements of the Exchange Act, and, in accordance therewith, will file quarterly and annual reports and other information with the SEC. The registration statement, including the exhibits and schedules thereto, such reports and other information may be read and copied at the SEC’s Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, NE, Washington, DC 20549. The public may obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. The SEC also maintains an Internet site ( http://www.sec.gov ) that contains our SEC filings. Statements made in this prospectus about legal documents may not necessarily be complete and you should read the documents which are filed as exhibits to the registration statement otherwise filed with the SEC.

 

162


Table of Contents

INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

       Page

Tower Automotive LLC and Tower Automotive Inc. and Subsidiaries

  

Consolidated Financial Statements:

  

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

   F-2

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2009 and 2008

   F-3

Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Years Ended December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007

   F-4

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007

   F-5

Consolidated Statements of Members’ Equity (Deficit) and Redeemable Preferred Units for the Years Ended December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007

   F-6

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

   F-8

Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements:

  

Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets as of June 30, 2010 and December 31, 2009

   F-49

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2010 and 2009

   F-50

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2010 and 2009

   F-51

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements

   F-52

Metalsa, S. de R.L. and Subsidiaries

  

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

   F-71

Consolidated Balance Sheet as of December 31, 2007

   F-72

Consolidated Income Statement for the Year Ended December 31, 2007

   F-73

Consolidated Statement of Partners’ Capital and Comprehensive Income for the Year Ended December  31, 2007

   F-74

Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows for the Year Ended December 31, 2007

   F-75

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

   F-76

 

F-1


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Board of Directors and Members of

Tower Automotive, LLC

Livonia, MI

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Tower Automotive, LLC and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2009 and 2008 (the “Successor”) and the related consolidated statements of operations, members’ equity (deficit) and redeemable preferred units, and cash flows for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008 (Successor), for the five-month period ended December 31, 2007 (Successor), and of Tower Automotive, Inc., d/b/a TA Delaware, Inc. (the “Predecessor”) for the seven-month period ended July 31, 2007 (Predecessor). Our audits also included the financial statement schedule listed in the Index at Item 16. These financial statements and financial statement schedule are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements and financial statement schedule based on our audits. We did not audit the consolidated financial statements of Metalsa S. de R.L. and subsidiaries (“Metalsa”), an entity which was accounted for by the Company using the equity method of accounting. The Company’s equity earnings in Metalsa’s net income of $7,148,000 for the five months ended December 31, 2007 (successor) and $12,424,000 for the seven months ended July 31, 2007 (predecessor), is included in the accompanying financial statements. Those statements were audited by other auditors whose report has been furnished to us, and our opinion, insofar as it relates to the amounts included for Metalsa, is based solely on the report of the other auditors.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. The Company is not required to have, nor were we engaged to perform, an audit of its internal control over financial reporting. Our audits included consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, based on our audits and the report of the other auditors, such consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Tower Automotive, LLC and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2009 and 2008 (Successor) and the results of their operations and their cash flows for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008 (Successor), for the five-month period ended December 31, 2007 (Successor), and for the seven-month period ended July 31, 2007 (Predecessor), in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also, in our opinion, such financial statement schedule, when considered in relation to the basic consolidated financial statements taken as a whole, presents fairly in all material respects the information set forth therein.

As discussed in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company accounted for the acquisition of Tower Automotive, Inc. using the purchase accounting method. As discussed in Note 11, effective August 1, 2007 the Company changed the measurement date of its defined benefit plan assets and liabilities to coincide with its fiscal year end.

/s/ DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP

Detroit, MI

March 3, 2010

 

F-2


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

(Amounts in thousands)

 

     December 31,
2009
    December 31,
2008
 

ASSETS

    

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 149,802      $ 126,820   

Accounts receivable, (net of allowance of $2,439 and $3,974)

     290,098        175,344   

Inventories (Note 4)

     62,611        76,174   

Deferred tax asset—current

     4,762        6,102   

Assets held for sale (Note 7)

     6,008          

Prepaid tooling and other

     60,139        73,022   
                

Total current assets

     573,420        457,462   
                

Property, plant and equipment, net (Note 4)

     640,148        689,089   

Goodwill (Note 3)

     70,565        68,079   

Deferred tax asset—non-current

     15,009        3,696   

Other assets

     35,279        51,454   
                

Total assets

   $ 1,334,421      $ 1,269,780   
                

LIABILITIES AND MEMBERS’ DEFICIT

    

Current maturities of long-term debt and capital lease obligations (Note 8)

   $ 137,499      $ 102,816   

Current maturities of long-term debt with affiliate (Note 8)

     4,132        2,044   

Accounts payable

     333,773        244,090   

Accrued liabilities

     127,823        130,535   
                

Total current liabilities

     603,227        479,485   
                

Long-term debt, net of current maturities (Note 8)

     112,602        306,472   

Long-term debt with affiliate, net of current maturities (Note 8)

     399,776        199,776   

Obligations under capital leases, net of current maturities (Note 8)

     15,544        17,037   

Deferred tax liability—non-current

     13,917        18,245   

Pension liability (Note 11)

     78,730        88,852   

Other non-current liabilities

     86,869        93,222   
                

Total non-current liabilities

     707,438        723,604   
                

Total liabilities

     1,310,665        1,203,089   
                

Commitments and contingencies (Note 17)

    

Redeemable preferred units, 10,000 units authorized and outstanding
(Note 12)

     170,915        155,216   
                

Members’ equity:

    

Tower Automotive, LLC’s members’ equity:
Common units, 8,500 units authorized and outstanding (Note 13)

     12,595        12,289   

     Accumulated deficit

     (144,955     (60,932

     Accumulated other comprehensive loss (Note 4)

     (54,363     (75,427
                

Total Tower Automotive, LLC’s members’ deficit

     (186,723     (124,070
                

Noncontrolling interests in subsidiaries

     39,564        35,545   
                

Total members’ deficit

     (147,159     (88,525
                

Total liabilities and members’ deficit

   $ 1,334,421      $ 1,269,780   
                

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-3


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

(Amounts in thousands, except per share amounts)

 

     Successor         Predecessor  
     Year Ended
December 31,
2009
    Year Ended
December 31,
2008
    Five Months
Ended
December 31,
2007
        Seven Months
Ended
July 31, 2007
 

Revenues

   $ 1,634,405      $ 2,171,705      $ 1,086,075        $ 1,455,484   

Cost of sales

     1,536,752        1,991,325        970,514          1,325,854   
                                  

Gross profit

     97,653        180,380        115,561          129,630   

Selling, general and administrative expenses

     118,331        138,618        57,000          77,252   

Amortization expense

     2,784        2,969        1,231            

Restructuring and related asset impairment charges, net (Note 6)

     13,436        4,837        1,808          22,401   
                                  

Operating income/(loss)

     (36,898     33,956        55,522          29,977   

Interest expense

     57,881        63,778        35,348          67,768   

Interest income

     982        3,588        1,297          2,283   

Chapter 11 and related reorganization items (Note 3)

                            62,220   

Other income, net (Note 8)

     (33,661                       
                                  

Income/(loss) before provision for income taxes and equity in earnings of joint ventures

     (60,136     (26,234     21,471          (97,728

Provision for income taxes (Note 10)

     (1,104     19,507        10,389          14,951   
                                  

Income/(loss) before equity in earnings of joint ventures

     (59,032     (45,741     11,082          (112,679

Equity in earnings of joint ventures, net of tax (Note 5)

                   7,148          12,424   
                                  

Income/(loss) from continuing operations

     (59,032     (45,741     18,230          (100,255

Loss from discontinued operations

                            (306
                                  

Net income/(loss)

     (59,032     (45,741     18,230          (100,561

Less: Net income attributable to the noncontrolling interests

     8,904        6,614        3,046          5,432   
                                  

Net income/(loss) attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC*

   $ (67,936   $ (52,355   $ 15,184        $ (105,993
                                  

Less: Preferred unit dividends

   $ (16,087   $ (14,940   $ (8,822     $   
                                  

Income/(loss) available to common unit holders

   $ (84,023   $ (67,295   $ 6,362        $ (105,993
                                  

Weighted average basic and diluted units/shares outstanding

     8,500        8,500        8,500          58,807,000   
 

Basic and diluted income/(loss) per unit attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC*:

          

Income/(loss) from continuing operations

   $ (9,885   $ (7,917   $ 748        $ (1.79

Income/(loss) from discontinued operations

                            (0.01
                                  

Income/(loss) per unit

   $ (9,885   $ (7,917   $ 748        $ (1.80
                                  

 

*   Tower Automotive Inc. for the Predecessor period

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-4


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

(Amounts in thousands)

 

     Successor         Predecessor  
     Year Ended
December 31,
2009
    Year Ended
December 31,
2008
    Five Months
Ended
December 31,
2007
        Seven Months
Ended
July 31, 2007
 

OPERATING ACTIVITIES:

          

Net income/(loss)

   $ (59,032   $ (45,741   $ 18,230        $ (100,561

Adjustments required to reconcile net income/(loss) to net cash provided by operating activities:

          

Non-cash Chapter 11 and related reorganization expenses

                            38,672   

Non-cash restructuring and asset impairment charges

                   1,861          23,627   

Deferred income tax provision

     (13,053     (269     3,226          4,967   

Depreciation and amortization

     147,705        170,267        61,323          90,460   

Gain from debt repurchase/letter of credit reduction

     (33,661                       

Pension expense, net of contributions

     (3,937     (10,974     (5,682         

Amortization of pension loss

     1,835                          

Equity in earnings of joint ventures, net of tax

                   (7,148       (12,424

Change in working capital and other operating items

     9,018        87,267        46,345          (26,472
                                  

Net cash provided by operating activities

     48,875        200,550        118,155          18,269   
                                  

INVESTING ACTIVITIES:

          

Cash disbursed for purchases of property, plant and equipment

     (85,995     (116,620     (57,115       (53,367

Net assets acquired, net of cash acquired

            (10,200     (769,139         

Proceeds from sale of joint venture investment

                   150,000            
                                  

Net cash used in investing activities

     (85,995     (126,820     (676,254       (53,367
                                  

FINANCING ACTIVITIES:

          

Proceeds from issuance of new term debt

                   608,146            

Proceeds from letter of credit reduction

     13,250                          

Repayments of term debt

     (16,381     (27,900     (100,000         

Proceeds from issuance of common units

                   11,250            

Proceeds from issuance of preferred units

                   213,750            

Redemption of preferred units

                   (68,375         

Noncontrolling interest dividends

     (4,866     (8,038     (838       (4,675

Preferred units dividends

     (388     (5,600     (8,320         

Proceeds from borrowings

     436,172        316,094        44,833          21,867   

Repayments of borrowings

     (375,501     (306,843     (49,009       (30,242

Financing costs

     (1,488                       

Proceeds from DIP credit facility

                            451,500   

Repayments of DIP credit facility

                            (385,500
                                  

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

     50,798        (32,287     651,437          52,950   
                                  

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

     9,304        (11,411     3,450            
                                  

NET CHANGE IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS

     22,982        30,032        96,788          17,852   

CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS:

          

Beginning of period

   $ 126,820      $ 96,788      $        $ 64,275   
                                  

End of period

   $ 149,802      $ 126,820      $ 96,788        $ 82,127   
                                  

Supplemental Cash Flow Information:

          

Interest paid, net of amounts capitalized

   $ 52,429      $ 61,187      $ 27,169        $ 58,285   

Income taxes paid

   $ 14,950      $ 18,739      $ 7,965        $ 11,903   

Reorganization payments

   $      $      $        $ 21,103   

Non-cash Investing and Financing Activities:

          

Capital expenditures in liabilities for purchases of property, plant and equipment

   $ 24,396      $ 30,410      $ 20,737        $ 34,855   

Cumulative preferred units accrued

   $ 15,699      $ 9,339      $ 502        $   

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-5


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF MEMBERS’ EQUITY (DEFICIT)* AND REDEEMABLE PREFERRED UNITS

(Amounts in thousands, except per share data)

 

    Common
Stock
    Additional
Paid- in
Capital
    Retained
Earnings
(Deficit)
    Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income (Loss)
    Treasury Stock     Total
Tower
Automotive,

LLC’s
Members’
Equity
(Deficit)*
    Noncontrolling
Interest
Amount
    Total
Members’
Equity
(Deficit)*
        Redeemable
Preferred Units
 
    Units/
Shares
    Amount           Shares     Amount             Units   Amount  

Balance at January 1, 2007 (Predecessor)

  66,646,838      $ 666      $ 682,031      $ (1,308,906   $ 12,861      (8,098,037   $ (49,324   $ (662,672   $ 30,341      $ (632,331       $   

Restricted stock grants earned and forfeited

                50                                  50               50              

Net income/(loss)

                       (105,993                                              

Other comprehensive income/(loss):

                         

Foreign currency translation adjustment (net of tax of $0)

                              11,438                                               

Total comprehensive income/(loss)

                                                 (94,555     7,610        (86,945           

Noncontrolling interest dividends

                                                        (4,675     (4,675           

Adoption of the recognition provisions of FASB ASC 450

                       (336                        (336            (336           
                                                                                         

Balance at July 31, 2007 (Predecessor)

  66,646,838      $ 666      $ 682,081      $ (1,415,235   $ 24,299      (8,098,037   $ (49,324   $ (757,513   $ 33,276      $ (724,237       $   
                                                                                         

Purchase accounting adjustments:

                         

Cancellation of common stock, treasury stock and additional paid in capital

  (66,646,838     (666     (682,081                 8,098,037        49,324        (633,423            (633,423           

Elimination of predecessor retained deficit and other comprehensive income

                       1,415,235        (24,299                 1,390,936               1,390,936              

Issuance of new equity interests in connection with purchase

  8,500        11,250                                         11,250               11,250        10,000     213,750   
                                                                                         

Balance at August 1, 2007 (Successor)

  8,500      $ 11,250      $      $      $           $      $ 11,250      $ 33,276      $ 44,526        10,000   $ 213,750   
                                                                                         

Net income

                       15,184                                       

Other comprehensive income/(loss):

                         

Foreign currency translation adjustment (net of tax of $0)

                              24,196                                               

Defined benefit plans, net (net of tax of $0)

                              (2,432                                            

Unrealized loss on qualifying cash flow hedge (net of tax of $0)

                              (6,799                                            

Total comprehensive income

                                                 30,149        1,905        32,054              

Redemption of preferred stock

                                                                          (68,375

Preferred unit dividends paid

                       (8,320                        (8,320            (8,320           

Cumulative preferred units accrued

                       (502                        (502            (502         502   

Noncontrolling interest dividends

                                                        (838     (838           
                                                                                         

Balance at December 31, 2007 (Successor)

  8,500      $ 11,250      $      $ 6,362      $ 14,965           $      $ 32,577      $ 34,343      $ 66,920        10,000   $ 145,877   
                                                                                         

 

F-6


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF MEMBERS’ EQUITY (DEFICIT)* AND REDEEMABLE PREFERRED UNITS—(Continued)

(Amounts in thousands, except per share data)

 

    Common
Stock
  Additional
Paid- in
Capital
  Retained
Earnings
(Deficit)
    Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income (Loss)
    Treasury Stock   Total
Tower
Automotive,
LLC’s
Members’
Equity
(Deficit)*
    Noncontrolling
Interest
Amount
    Total
Members’
Equity
(Deficit)*
        Redeemable
Preferred Units
    Units/
Shares
  Amount         Shares   Amount           Units   Amount

Net income/(loss)

              (52,355                           

Other comprehensive income/(loss):

                         

Foreign currency translation adjustment (net of tax of $0)

                     (15,455                                   

Defined benefit plans, net (net of tax of $0)

                     (65,156                                   

Unrealized loss on qualifying cash flow hedge (net of tax of $0)

                     (9,781                                   

Total comprehensive income/(loss)

                                  (142,747     9,240        (133,507        

Preferred unit dividends paid

              (5,600                  (5,600            (5,600        

Cumulative preferred units accrued

              (9,339                  (9,339            (9,339         9,339

Noncontrolling interest dividends

                                         (8,038     (8,038        

Compensation expense

      1,039                             1,039               1,039           
                                                                             

Balance at December 31, 2008 (Successor)

  8,500   $ 12,289   $   $ (60,932   $ (75,427     $   $ (124,070   $ 35,545      $ (88,525     10,000   $ 155,216
                                                                             

Net income (loss)

              (67,936                           

Other comprehensive income/(loss):

                         

Foreign currency translation adjustment (net of tax of $0)

                     12,470                                      

Defined benefit plans, net (net of tax of $2.9 million)

                     4,565                                      

Unrealized gain on qualifying cash flow hedge (net of tax of $2 million)

                     4,029                                      

Total comprehensive income/(loss)

                                  (46,872     8,885        (37,987        

Preferred unit dividends paid

              (388                  (388            (388        

Cumulative preferred units accrued

              (15,699                  (15,699            (15,699         15,699

Noncontrolling interest dividends

                                         (4,866     (4,866        

Compensation expense

      306                             306               306           
                                                                             

Balance at December 31, 2009 (Successor)

  8,500   $ 12,595   $   $ (144,955   $ (54,363     $   $ (186,723   $ 39,564      $ (147,159     10,000   $ 170,915
                                                                             

 

*   Predecessor Company refers to stockholders’ equity as the Predecessor Company was a public company with common stock outstanding

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-7


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Note 1. Nature of Business

Tower Automotive, LLC and its subsidiaries (collectively referred to as the “Company” or “Tower Automotive” or the “Successor Company”) is a leading integrated global producer of engineered structural metal components and assemblies primarily serving automotive original equipment manufacturers, or OEMs, including Volkswagen Group, Fiat, Ford, Hyundai/Kia, Volvo, Renault/Nissan, Daimler, Chrysler, Toyota, BMW, Chery, and Honda. Products include body structures stampings, chassis structures (including frames), and complex welded assemblies for small and large cars, crossovers, pickups and SUVs. Including both 100% owned subsidiaries and majority owned subsidiaries, the Company has strategically located production facilities in the United States, Belgium, Germany, Italy, Slovakia, Poland, Brazil, South Korea, and China and are supported by engineering and sales locations in the United States, Belgium, Germany, Italy, Slovakia, Poland, Brazil, South Korea, Japan, China, and India.

Note 2. Basis of Presentation and Organizational History

As indicated in Note 3, Tower Automotive, Inc. (the “Predecessor Company”) along with 25 of its United States (“U.S.”) subsidiaries (collectively, the “Debtors”) each filed a voluntary petition for relief under Chapter 11 of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code (the “Bankruptcy Code”) in the U.S. Bankruptcy Court, Southern District of New York (the “Court”) on February 2, 2005. On July 11, 2007, the Court confirmed the Chapter 11 Reorganization Plan of the Debtors (the “Plan”) and approved the sale of substantially all of the Debtors’ assets to Tower Automotive, LLC, an affiliate of Cerberus Capital Management, L.P. The Plan became effective on July 31, 2007 (the “Effective Date”), and in connection therewith, the Debtors completed the sale of substantially all of their assets to Tower Automotive, LLC. Upon the Effective Date, all of the remaining assets of the Debtors were transferred to a Post-Consummation Trust. As a result of the foregoing, the Debtors collectively have no assets and have ceased all operations.

The Company allocated the purchase price to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the date of acquisition in conformity with Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) No. 805, Business Combinations, (“FASB ASC No. 805”) as discussed separately in Note 3. As a result of the application of FASB ASC No. 805, the financial statements for periods before August 1, 2007 are not comparable with the financial statements for periods subsequent to August 1, 2007. References to “Successor Company” refer to Tower Automotive, LLC on or after August 1, 2007, after giving effect to the application of purchase accounting. References to “Predecessor Company” refer to Tower Automotive, Inc. on or before July 31, 2007.

The provisions in FASB ASC No. 852, Reorganizations , apply to the Debtors’ financial statements while the Debtors operated under the provisions of Chapter 11 of the Bankruptcy Code. FASB ASC No. 852 does not change the application of U.S. GAAP in the preparation of financial statements. However, FASB ASC No. 852 does require that the financial statements, for periods including and subsequent to the filing of the Chapter 11 petition, distinguish transactions and events that are directly associated with the reorganization from the ongoing operations of the Predecessor Company.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

Disclosures about Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities

In March 2008, the FASB issued new guidance codified in ASC No. 815, Derivatives and Hedging , which further expanded disclosure requirements. FASB ASC No. 815 requires additional disclosures regarding: (i) how and why an entity uses derivative instruments; (ii) how derivative instruments and related hedged items are accounted for; and (iii) how derivative instruments and related hedged items affect an entity’s financial position,

 

F-8


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

financial performance, and cash flows. The Company adopted this new guidance on January 1, 2009. For the additional information regarding the disclosures required by FASB ASC No. 815, see Note 9.

Noncontrolling Interests in Consolidated Financial Statements

In December 2007, the FASB issued new guidance codified in ASC No. 810, Consolidation , to establish new standards that govern the accounting for and reporting of noncontrolling interests in partially owned consolidated subsidiaries and the loss of control of subsidiaries. Also, FASB ASC No. 810 requires that (i) a noncontrolling interest, previously referred to as a minority interest, is reported as part of equity in the consolidated financial statements; (ii) losses are allocated to the noncontrolling interest even when such allocation might result in a deficit balance, reducing the losses attributed to the controlling interest; (iii) changes in ownership interests are treated as equity transactions if control is maintained; and (iv) upon a loss of control, any gain or loss on the interest sold will be recognized in earnings. The Company adopted this new guidance on January 1, 2009, which presentational aspects were retroactively applied to prior year presentation, and did not have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements. The Company’s financial statements and accumulated other comprehensive income discussion in Note 4 reflect the new presentation and updated disclosure requirements.

Fair Value Measurements

In September 2006, the FASB issued new guidance codified in ASC No. 820, Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures , which provides a consistent definition of fair value that focuses on exit price and prioritizes, within a measurement of fair value, the use of market-based inputs over entity-specific inputs. FASB ASC No. 820 requires expanded disclosures about fair value measurements and establishes a three-level hierarchy for fair value measurements based on the observability of inputs to the valuation of an asset or liability as of the measurement date. The standard also requires that a company consider its own non-performance risk when measuring liabilities carried at fair value, including derivatives.

The Company adopted this new guidance for financial assets and financial liabilities on January 1, 2008. The effect of the Company’s adoption of the new fair value guidance was not material. The Company adopted new fair value guidance for nonfinancial assets and nonfinancial liabilities (measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis) on January 1, 2009 the effect of which was not material.

Subsequent Events

In June 2009, the FASB issued new guidance codified in ASC No. 855, Subsequent Events , which establishes general standards of accounting for and disclosure of events that occur after the balance sheet date but before financial statements are issued or are available to be issued. Specifically, FASB ASC No. 855 defines (i) the period after the balance sheet date during which management of a reporting entity should evaluate events or transactions that may occur for potential recognition or disclosure in the financial statements, (ii) the circumstances under which an entity should recognize events or transactions occurring after the balance sheet date in its financial statements, and (iii) the disclosures that an entity should make about events or transactions that occurred after the balance sheet date. The Company adopted this new guidance on June 30, 2009, which did not have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements. We evaluated subsequent events through the issuance of our consolidated financial statements on March 3, 2010.

 

F-9


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The FASB Accounting Standards Codification and the Hierarchy of Generally Accepted Accounting Principles

In June 2009, the FASB issued new guidance which establishes the FASB Accounting Standards Codification as the sole source of authoritative generally accepted accounting principles. Rules and interpretive releases of the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) under authority of federal securities laws are also sources of authoritative GAAP for SEC registrants. Pursuant to the provisions of this new guidance, the Company has updated references to GAAP in its financial statements issued for all periods. The adoption of this new guidance did not impact the Company’s financial position or results of operations.

Transfers of Financial Assets

In June 2009, the FASB issued new guidance codified in ASC No. 860, Transfers and Servicing , to improve the relevance, representational faithfulness, and comparability of the information that a reporting entity provides in its financial reports about a transfer of financial assets; the effects of a transfer on its financial position, financial performance, and cash flows; and a transferor’s continuing involvement in transferred financial assets. This new guidance requires a determination of whether a transferor and all of the entities included in the transferor’s financial statements being presented have surrendered control over transferred financial assets, (ii) that a transferor recognize and initially measure at fair value all assets obtained and liabilities incurred as a result of a transfer of financial assets accounted for as a sale, and (iii) enhanced disclosures to provide greater transparency. The Company adopted this new guidance on December 31, 2009. The adoption of this new guidance did not impact the Company’s financial position or results of operations.

Note 3. Cerberus Acquisition and Chapter 11 Reorganization Proceedings and Going Concern

Successor Company

As indicated in Note 2, Tower Automotive, LLC completed the acquisition of the Debtors’ assets and liabilities on July 31, 2007. The acquisition was accounted for as a purchase in accordance with FASB ASC No. 805. The total purchase price of $779.3 million is net of cash acquired of $82.1 million and includes direct acquisition costs of approximately $27 million. The acquisition was recorded by allocating the purchase price to the assets acquired, including identifiable intangible assets which were primarily customer relationships, and liabilities assumed, based on their estimated fair values at the date of acquisition. The excess of the cost of the acquisition over the net amounts assigned to the fair value of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed is recorded as goodwill. The goodwill recorded is attributed to the Company’s European and South American reporting units. The amount allocated to goodwill reflects the benefits Tower Automotive, LLC expects to realize in the European and South American regions over the estimated fair value of the identifiable net assets in these regions and is not deductible for tax purposes. Supplemental Pro Forma disclosures are not included as the amounts are deemed immaterial.

Tower Automotive, LLC was formed on April 18, 2007 in connection with the acquisition of the Debtors’ assets and liabilities. The Company was capitalized through the issuance of new debt ($608.1 million), the issuance of common units ($11.3 million) and the issuance of preferred units ($213.8 million). See notes 12 and 13 to the Company’s consolidated financial statements. The common and preferred units were issued to funds and accounts associated with Cerberus Capital Management, L.P.

 

F-10


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The final allocation of the purchase price for the acquisition was made to the following major opening balance sheet categories (in millions):

 

Current assets, net of cash

   $ 580.5

Property, plant and equipment, net

     771.3

Investments in joint ventures

     142.8

Goodwill

     64.8

Other non-current assets

     104.4
      

Total assets acquired

     1,663.8

Accounts payable

     359.7

Accrued liabilities

     132.1

Other non-current liabilities

     119.9
      

Subtotal

     611.7

Long-term debt and capital lease obligations, foreign

     156.2

Other postretirement benefits

     24.8

Pension benefits

     37.9

Deferred transaction costs

     16.8
      

Total debt and debt-like instruments assumed

     235.7
      

Noncontrolling interest

     37.1
      

Total liabilities and noncontrolling interest assumed

     884.5
      

Cash paid in 2007

     769.1

Deferred transaction costs paid in 2008

     10.2
      

Net assets acquired, net of cash

   $ 779.3
      

The change in the carrying amount of goodwill is set forth below on a segment and consolidated basis (in thousands):

 

     International     Americas     Consolidated  

Balance at December 31, 2007

   $ 77,768      $ 4,231      $ 81,999   

Purchase accounting adjustments

     (9,600            (9,600

Currency translation adjustment

     (2,715     (1,605     (4,320
                        

Balance at December 31, 2008

     65,453        2,626        68,079   

Currency translation adjustment

     1,626        860        2,486   
                        

Balance at December 31, 2009

   $ 67,079      $ 3,486      $ 70,565   
                        

Predecessor Company

On February 2, 2005 (the “Petition Date”), the Debtors filed a voluntary petition for relief under the Bankruptcy Code in the United States Bankruptcy Court Southern District of New York. The cases were consolidated for administrative purposes. The filing was made necessary by customer pricing pressures, North American automotive production cuts, significantly higher material costs (primarily steel) and the termination of accelerated payment programs of certain customers adversely affecting the Debtors’ liquidity and financial condition, all of which raised substantial doubt as to the Predecessor Company’s ability to continue as a going concern. The Debtors operated their businesses as debtors-in-possession (“DIP”) pursuant to the Bankruptcy Code. An official committee of unsecured creditors was appointed.

 

F-11


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Pursuant to the provisions of the Bankruptcy Code, all actions to collect upon any of the Debtors’ liabilities as of the Petition Date or to enforce pre-petition date contractual obligations were automatically stayed. As a general rule, absent approval from the Bankruptcy Court, the Debtors were prohibited from paying pre-petition obligations. In addition, as a consequence of the Chapter 11 filing, pending litigation against the Debtors was generally stayed, and no party could take any action to collect pre-petition claims except pursuant to an order of the Bankruptcy Court. However, the Debtors requested that the Bankruptcy Court approve certain pre-petition liabilities, such as employee wages and benefits and certain other pre-petition obligations. After the filing, all orders sufficient to enable the Debtors to conduct normal business activities, including the approval of the Debtors’ DIP financing, were entered by the Bankruptcy Court.

The objectives of the Chapter 11 filing were to protect and preserve the value of the Debtors’ assets and to restructure and improve the Debtors’ operational and financial affairs in order to return to profitability. On July 11, 2007, the Court confirmed the Chapter 11 Reorganization Plan of the Debtors and approved the sale of substantially all of the Debtors’ assets to Tower Automotive, LLC, an affiliate of Cerberus Capital Management, L.P. The Plan became effective on July 31, 2007 (the “Effective Date”), and in connection therewith, the Debtors completed the sale of substantially all of their assets to Tower Automotive, LLC. Upon the Effective Date, all of the remaining assets of the Debtors not purchased by Tower Automotive, LLC were transferred to a Post-Consummation Trust. As a result of the foregoing, the Debtors collectively have no assets and have ceased all operations. The name of the Predecessor Company was also changed to TA Delaware, Inc. as of the Effective Date.

The Debtors incurred certain professional and other expenses directly associated with the bankruptcy proceedings. The Predecessor Company disbursed cash of approximately $21.1 million relating to these expenses during the seven months ended July 31, 2007. In addition, the Debtors made certain provisions to adjust the carrying value of certain pre-petition liabilities to reflect the Debtors’ estimate of allowed claims. Such costs were classified as Chapter 11 and related reorganization items in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations for the seven months ended July 31, 2007 and consisted of the following (in thousands):

 

     Predecessor  
     Seven Months
Ended July 31,
2007
 

Professional fees directly related to the filing

   $ 62,138   

Estimated executory contract rejection damages

     (6

Other expenses and recoveries directly attributable to the Predecessor Company’s reorganization

     88   
        

Total

   $ 62,220   
        

Note 4. Significant Accounting Policies

Financial Statement Presentation

a. Principles of Consolidation

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Tower Automotive, LLC and domestic and foreign subsidiaries that are controlled. The Company’s share of earnings or losses of nonconsolidated affiliates are included in the consolidated operating results using the equity method of accounting when the Company is able to exercise significant influence over the operating and financial decisions of the affiliates. All intercompany transactions and balances have been eliminated upon consolidation.

 

F-12


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The Predecessor Company disposed of Tower Automotive Lansing, LLC as of December 31, 2006, which was classified as discontinued operations. For the seven months ended July 31, 2007, the Company recorded a $0.3 million loss in relation to the discontinued operations.

b. Cash and Cash Equivalents

All highly liquid investments with an original maturity of three months or less are considered to be cash equivalents. Cash equivalents are stated at cost, which approximates fair value. Substantially all of the Company’s cash is concentrated in a few financial institutions.

c. Allowance for Doubtful Accounts

The Company maintains an allowance for doubtful receivables for estimated losses resulting from the inability of its trade customers to make required payments. The Company provides an allowance for specific customer accounts where collection is doubtful and also provides an allowance for customer deductions based on historical collection and write-off experience. Additional allowances would be required if the financial condition of the Company’s customers deteriorated. Bad debt expense is not material for any periods presented.

d. Inventories

Inventories are stated at the lower of cost or market. Cost is determined by the first-in, first-out (“FIFO”) method. In addition, the Company uses a valuation account for inventory obsolescence, which has not been material for any periods presented. Maintenance, repair and non-productive inventory, which are considered consumables, are expensed when acquired in cost of sales. Inventories consist of the following (in thousands):

 

     December 31,
2009
   December 31,
2008

Raw materials

   $ 21,911    $ 30,210

Work in process

     20,841      24,245

Finished goods

     19,859      21,719
             

Total inventory

   $ 62,611    $ 76,174
             

e. Tooling

Tooling represents costs incurred by the Company in the development of new tooling used in the manufacture of the Company’s products. All pre-production tooling costs, incurred for tools that the Company will not own and that will be used in producing products supplied under long-term supply agreements, are expensed as incurred unless the supply agreement provides the Company with the non-cancelable right to use the tools or the reimbursement of such costs is contractually guaranteed by the customer. At the time the customer awards a contract to the Company, the customer agrees to reimburse the Company for certain of its tooling costs.

 

F-13


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

When the part for which tooling has been developed reaches a production-ready status, the Company is reimbursed by its customer for the cost of the tooling at which time the tooling becomes the property of the customer. The Company has certain other tooling costs, which are capitalized and amortized over the life of the related product program, related to tools which the Company has the contractual right to use during the life of the supply arrangement. Company-owned tooling is included in prepaid tooling and other and customer-owned tooling is included in other assets in the Consolidated Balance Sheet. The components of capitalized tooling costs are as follows (in thousands):

 

     December 31,
2009
   December 31,
2008

Customer-owned tooling

     33,713      29,990

Company-owned tooling

     5,492      6,914
             

Total

   $ 39,205    $ 36,904
             

Any gain recognized, which is defined as the excess of reimbursement over cost, is amortized over the life of the program.

f. Property, Plant and Equipment

Property, plant and equipment are recorded at cost, less accumulated depreciation. Depreciation is computed using the straight-line method over the following estimated useful lives of assets as follows:

 

Buildings and improvements

   32 to 40 years

Machinery and equipment

   3 to 20 years

Leasehold improvements are amortized over the shorter of 10 years or the remaining lease term at the date of acquisition of the leasehold improvement.

Interest is capitalized during the preparation of facilities for product programs and is amortized over the estimated lives of the programs. Interest of $0.9 million, $0.6 million and $0.3 million was capitalized in 2009, 2008, and 2007, respectively.

Costs of maintenance and repairs are charged to expense as incurred in cost of sales. Spare parts are considered capital in nature when purchased during the initial investment of a fixed asset. Amounts relating to significant improvements, which extend the useful life or utility of the related asset, are capitalized and depreciated over the remaining life of the asset. Upon disposal or retirement of property, plant and equipment, the cost and related accumulated depreciation are eliminated from the respective accounts and the resulting gain or loss is recognized in the Consolidated Statements of Operations.

Property, plant and equipment consist of the following (in thousands):

 

     December 31,
2009
    December 31,
2008
 

Cost:

    

Land

   $ 87,774      $ 75,490   

Buildings and improvements

     164,529        167,484   

Machinery and equipment

     722,136        650,203   

Construction in progress

     55,604        66,271   
                
     1,030,043        959,448   

Less: accumulated depreciation

     (389,895     (270,359
                

Property, plant, and equipment, net

   $ 640,148      $ 689,089   
                

 

F-14


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

g. Asset Retirement Obligations

FASB ASC No. 410, Asset Retirement and Environmental Obligations, requires the recognition of a liability for the fair value of a conditional asset retirement obligation if the fair value can be reasonably estimated. An asset retirement obligation is a legal obligation to perform certain activities in connection with retirement, disposal or abandonment of assets. The fair value of a conditional asset retirement obligation should be recognized when incurred, generally upon acquisition, construction or development and through the normal operation of the asset. Uncertainty about the timing or method of settlement of a conditional asset retirement should be factored into the measurement of the liability. The liability is measured at discounted fair value and is adjusted to its present value in subsequent periods. The Company’s asset retirement obligations are primarily associated with renovating, upgrading, and returning leased property to the lessor in accordance with the requirements of the lease.

Asset retirement obligations are included in other long-term liabilities and accrued liabilities in the Consolidated Balance Sheet. The following table reconciles our asset retirement obligations as of December 31, 2009 and 2008 (in thousands):

 

     December 31,
2009
    December 31,
2008
 

Asset retirement obligation as of January 1

   $ 13,106      $ 14,820   

Accretion expense

     1,127        1,048   

Liabilities settled

     (1,327     (2,762
                

Asset retirement obligation as of December 31

   $ 12,906      $ 13,106   
                

h. Impairment of Long-Lived Assets

The Company monitors its long-lived assets for impairment indicators on an ongoing basis in accordance with FASB ASC No. 360, Property, Plant, and Equipment . If impairment indicators exist, the Company performs the required analysis and records impairment charges. In conducting its analysis, the Company compares the undiscounted cash flows expected to be generated from the long-lived assets to the related net book values. If the undiscounted cash flows exceed the net book value, the long-lived assets are considered not to be impaired. If the net book value exceeds the undiscounted cash flows, an impairment loss is measured and recognized. An impairment loss is measured as the difference between the net book value and the fair value of the long-lived assets. Fair value is estimated based upon discounted cash flow analyses. Cash flows are estimated using internal budgets based on recent sales data, independent automotive production volume estimates and customer commitments, as well as assumptions related to discount rates. Changes in economic or operating conditions impacting these estimates and assumptions could result in the impairment of long-lived assets. Refer to Note 6 for discussion of impairment charges for the periods presented.

Long-lived assets held for sale are recorded at the lower of their carrying amount or estimated fair value less cost to sell.

i. Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets

Goodwill represents the excess of the cost of an acquisition over the fair value of net assets acquired. Goodwill is not amortized but is tested for impairment on at least an annual basis. In accordance with FASB ASC No. 350, Intangibles—Goodwill and Other , goodwill is reviewed for impairment utilizing a two-step process. The first step of the impairment test requires the identification of the reporting units, and comparison of the fair value of each of these reporting units to the respective carrying value. The Company defines its reporting units as

 

F-15


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Europe, Asia, North America, and South America. The recoverability of goodwill is evaluated at the following reporting units for which goodwill exists: Europe and South America. These reporting units exist at a lower level than our reportable segments. If the carrying value is less than the fair value, no impairment exists and the second step is not performed. In the second step, the impairment is computed by comparing the implied fair value of reporting unit goodwill with the carrying amount of that goodwill. FASB ASC No. 350 requires goodwill to be tested for impairment annually at the same time every year, and when an event occurs or circumstances change such that it is reasonably possible that impairment may exist. The annual impairment test is performed at year end.

The Company utilizes an income approach to estimate the fair value of each of its reporting units. The income approach is based on projected debt free cash flow which is discounted to the present value using discount factors that consider the timing and risk of cash flows. The Company believes that this approach is appropriate because it provides a fair value estimate based upon the reporting units’ expected long-term operating cash flow performance. This approach also mitigates the impact of cyclical trends that occur in the industry. Fair value is estimated using recent automotive industry and specific platform production volume projections, which are based on internally-developed forecasts, as well as commercial, wage and benefit, inflation and discount rate assumptions. Other significant assumptions include terminal value growth rates, terminal value margin rates, future capital expenditures, known restructuring actions, and changes in future working capital requirements. While there are inherent uncertainties related to the assumptions used and to management’s application of these assumptions to this analysis, the Company believes that the income approach provides a reasonable estimate of the fair value of its reporting units. However, the Company’s assumptions and estimates may differ significantly from actual results. The Company also uses a second approach, which is the market multiple approach, to test the reasonableness of the income approach.

The Company’s 2009 and 2008 annual goodwill impairment analysis, completed as of each year end, indicated that the carrying value of the Europe and South America reporting units was less than the respective fair values; thus, no impairment existed at either date.

The Company has certain intangible assets that are related to customer relationships. These intangible assets have definite lives and are amortized on a straight-line basis, which approximates the recognition of related revenue, over the estimated lives of the related assets. The intangible assets are recorded in other non-current assets. The Company anticipates amortization expense of $2.8 million for each of the next four and a half years. The Company has incurred amortization expense of $2.8 million and $3 million, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008. The following table presents information about the intangible assets of the Company at December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively (in thousands):

 

          Year Ended
December 31, 2009
   Year Ended
December 31, 2008
     Weighted
Average
Life
   Gross
Carrying
Amount
   Accumulated
Amortization
   Gross
Carrying
Amount
   Accumulated
Amortization

Amortized intangible:

              

Europe

   7 years    $ 14,664    $ 5,074    $ 14,508    $ 3,034

Brazil

   7 years      5,790      1,911      4,725      1,166
                              

Total

      $ 20,454    $ 6,985    $ 19,233    $ 4,200
                              

 

F-16


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

j. Fair Value of Financial Instruments

Fair value is generally determined based on quoted market prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities. If quoted market prices are not available, the Company uses valuation techniques that place greater reliance on observable inputs and less reliance on unobservable inputs. In measuring fair value, the Company may make adjustments for risks and uncertainties, if a market participant would include such an adjustment in its pricing.

FASB ASC No. 820 establishes a fair value hierarchy that distinguishes between assumptions based on market data, referred to as observable inputs, and the Company’s assumptions, referred to as unobservable inputs. Determining where an asset or liability falls within that hierarchy depends on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement as a whole. An adjustment to the pricing method used within either level 1 or level 2 inputs could generate a fair value measurement that effectively falls in a lower level in the hierarchy. The hierarchy consists of three broad levels as follows:

 

  Level 1:   Quoted market prices in active markets for identical assets and liabilities;

 

  Level 2:   Inputs other than level 1 inputs that are either directly or indirectly observable; and

 

  Level 3: Unobservable inputs developed using our estimates and assumptions, which reflect those that market participants would use.

At December 31, 2009, the carrying value and estimated fair value of the Company’s long-term debt was $651.9 million and $651.9 million, respectively. At December 31, 2008, the carrying value and estimated fair value of the Company’s long-term debt was $608.8 million and $282.3 million, respectively. The majority of the Company’s long-term debt is owned by an affiliate of the preferred unit holder, which is classified as a level 3 measurement. We value the debt using significant unobservable inputs. The fair value was determined based on the estimated fair value of comparable instruments with quoted active market values.

The Company is party to certain derivative financial instruments, which are all classified as level 2 measurements determined using significant other observable inputs (See Note 9).

The carrying amounts of cash and cash equivalents and accruals approximate fair value because of the short maturity of these instruments.

k. Derivative Financial Instruments

Periodically, the Company uses derivative financial instruments to manage the risk that changes in interest rates will have on the amount of future interest payments. Interest rate swap contracts are used to adjust the proportion of total debt that is subject to variable and fixed interest rates. The Company is not a party to leveraged derivatives and does not enter into derivative financial instruments for trading or speculative purposes. Under FASB ASC No. 815, Derivatives and Hedging, all derivatives are recorded at fair value and the changes in fair value are immediately included in earnings if the derivatives do not qualify as effective cash flow hedges. If a derivative is a fair value hedge, then changes in the fair value of the derivative are offset against the changes in the fair value of the underlying hedged item. If a derivative is a cash flow hedge, then changes in the fair value of the derivative are recognized as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income until the underlying hedged item is recognized in earnings.

The Company formally documents hedge relationships, including the identification of the hedging instruments and the hedged items, as well as the risk management objectives and strategies for undertaking the hedge transaction. Effective hedges are recorded at fair value in other long-term liabilities with a corresponding offset to accumulated other comprehensive income in the Consolidated Balance Sheet. This process includes

 

F-17


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

linking derivatives that are designated as hedges of specific assets, liabilities, firm commitments or forecasted transactions. The Company also formally assesses, both at inception and at least quarterly thereafter, whether a derivative used in a hedging transaction is highly effective in offsetting changes in either the fair value or cash flows of the hedged item. The Company will discontinue hedge accounting when it is determined that a derivative ceases to be a highly effective hedge. For the period ended December 31, 2007, the Company entered into two cash flow hedges, which are considered effective, and a $6.8 million loss was recorded in other comprehensive income. During 2008 and 2009, the Company recorded an incremental loss of $9.8 million and a pre-tax gain of $6 million (net of tax of $4 million), respectively, in other comprehensive income. Refer to Note 9 for further discussion.

l. Revenue Recognition

The Company recognizes revenue once the criteria in FASB ASC No. 605, Revenue Recognition, have been met. These criteria are that persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists, delivery has occurred or services have been rendered, the Company’s price to the buyer is fixed or determinable, and collectability is reasonably assured.

The Company recognizes revenue as its products are shipped to its customers at which time title and risk of loss pass to the customer. The Company participates in certain customers’ steel repurchase programs. Under these programs, the Company purchases steel directly from a customer’s designated steel supplier for use in manufacturing products. The Company takes delivery and title to such steel and bears the risk of loss and obsolescence. The Company invoices its customers based upon annually negotiated selling prices, which inherently include a component for steel under such repurchase programs. For sales for which the Company participates in a customer’s steel repurchase program, revenue is recognized on the entire amount of such sale, including the component for purchases under that customer’s steel repurchase program.

The Company enters into agreements to produce products for its customers at the beginning of a given vehicle program life. Once such agreements are entered into by the Company, fulfillment of the customers’ purchasing requirements is the obligation of the Company for the entire production period of the vehicle programs, which range from three to ten years, and generally the Company has no provisions to terminate such contracts. Additionally, the Company tracks the aging of uncollected billings and adjusts its accounts receivable allowance on a quarterly basis as necessary based on its evaluation of the probability of collection. The adjustments the Company has made due to the write-off of uncollectible amounts have been negligible.

m. Income Taxes

The Company accounts for income taxes under the asset and liability method, which requires the recognition of deferred tax assets and liabilities for the expected future tax consequences of events that have been included in the financial statements. Under this method, deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined based on the differences between the financial statements and tax basis of assets and liabilities using enacted tax rates in effect for the year in which the differences are expected to reverse. The Company records net deferred tax assets to the extent it believes that these assets will more likely than not be realized. In making such determination, the Company considers all available positive and negative evidence, including future reversals of existing taxable temporary differences, projected future taxable income, tax planning strategies and recent financial operations. Valuation allowances have been recorded where it has been determined that it is more likely than not the Company will not be able to realize the net deferred tax assets. Due to the significant judgment involved in determining whether deferred tax assets will be realized, the ultimate resolution of these items may be materially different from the previously estimated outcome.

Pursuant to ASC 740, the Company has allocated a tax benefit of $4.9 million to continuing operations due to the gain in other comprehensive income offsetting a portion of the losses from continuing operations. There is a corresponding tax provision of $4.9 million charged to other comprehensive income.

 

F-18


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Reserves for taxes are established for taxes that may become payable in future years as a result of audits by tax authorities. These tax reserves are reviewed as circumstances warrant and adjusted as events occur that affect our potential liability for additional taxes, such as conclusion of tax audits, identification of new issues, changes in federal or state laws or interpretations of the law.

n. Segment Reporting

The Company determines its reportable segments based on the guidance in FASB ASC 280. The Company defines its operating segments as components of its business where separate financial information is available and is routinely evaluated by management. Management reviews financial information based on four operating segments: Europe, Asia, North America, and South America. The Company aggregates the four operating segments into two reportable segments consistent with the aggregation criteria in FASB ASC 280 as the Company’s operations have similar economic characteristics, and share fundamental characteristics including the nature of the products, production processes, customers, and distribution channels. The Company’s two reportable segments are the Americas, consisting of North and South America, and International, consisting of Europe and Asia. See Note 16 for further discussion.

o. Foreign Currency Translation

The functional currency of the Company’s foreign operations is the local currency in which they operate. Assets and liabilities of the Company’s foreign operations are translated into U.S. dollars using the applicable period end rates of exchange. Results of operations are translated at applicable average rates prevailing throughout the period. Translation gains or losses are reported as a separate component of accumulated other comprehensive income in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Members’ Equity / (Deficit) and Redeemable Preferred Units. Gains and losses resulting from foreign currency transactions, the amounts of which are not material in all periods presented, are included in net income / (loss).

p. Exit or Disposal Activities

Costs to idle, consolidate, or close facilities and provide postemployment benefits to employees on an other than temporary basis are accrued based on management’s best estimate of the wage and benefit costs that will be incurred. Costs related to idlings of employees that are expected to be temporary are expensed as incurred. Costs to terminate a contract without economic benefit to the Company are expensed at the time the contract is terminated. One-time termination benefits that are not subject to contractual arrangements provided to employees who are involuntarily terminated are recorded when management commits to a detailed plan of termination, that plan is communicated to employees, and actions required to complete the plan indicate that significant changes are not likely. If employees are required to render service until they are terminated in order to earn termination benefits, the benefits are recognized ratably over the future service period.

q. Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income / (Loss) (OCI)

The components of accumulated other comprehensive income / (loss), net of tax, in members’ equity is as follows (in thousands):

 

     December 31,
2009
    December 31,
2008
 

Foreign currency translation

   $ 21,211      $ 8,741   

Defined benefit plans, net

     (63,023     (67,588

Unrealized gain/(loss) on qualifying cash flow hedge

     (12,551     (16,580
                

Total accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

   $ (54,363   $ (75,427
                

 

F-19


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The components of comprehensive income attributable to the noncontrolling interests, net of tax, is as follows (in thousands):

 

     Successor          Predecessor
     Year Ended
December 31,
2009
    Year Ended
December 31,
2008
   Five months
Ended
December 31,
2007
           Seven Months
Ended
July  31,

2007

Net income attributable to the noncontrolling interests

   $ 8,904      $ 6,614    $ 3,046           $ 5,432

Foreign currency translation adjustment

     (19     2,626      (1,141          2,178
                                  

Total comprehensive income attributable to the noncontrolling interests

   $ 8,885      $ 9,240    $ 1,905           $ 7,610
                                  

r. Estimates

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Generally, matters subject to estimation and judgment include amounts related to accounts receivable realization, inventory obsolescence, fair value measurements, pension and other postretirement benefit plan assumptions, restructuring reserves, self-insurance accruals, asset valuation reserves and accruals related to environmental remediation costs, asset retirement obligations and income taxes. Actual results may differ from those estimates and assumptions, and changes in such estimates and assumptions may affect amounts reported in future periods.

s. Accounting Standards Not Yet Adopted

The FASB has not published any accounting standards affecting the Company that the Company has not yet adopted as of December 31, 2009.

Note 5. Investments in Joint Ventures

In December of 2007, the Company sold its 40% ownership interest in Metalsa S. de R.L. (“Metalsa”) to our joint venture partner, Promotora de Empresas Zano, S.A. de C.V. (“Proeza”). The sale of our interest generated cash proceeds of $150 million, which approximated book value; therefore, there was no gain or loss on the sale. The Company has no other non-consolidated affiliates.

Metalsa is the largest supplier of vehicle frames and structures in Mexico. In addition, the Company and Metalsa had a technology sharing arrangement, which was terminated at the time of the sale. Metalsa has manufacturing facilities in Monterrey, Saltillo and San Luis Potosi, Mexico and Roanoke, Virginia.

 

F-20


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Summarized financial information for Metalsa is as follows (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
2007

Condensed Statement of Earnings

  

Revenues

   $ 675,787

Gross Profit

     141,955

Operating income

     71,281

Net income

     51,946

The Company did not purchase components from Metalsa during 2009, 2008, or 2007. The Company received technology fees from Metalsa of $5.2 million and $3.4 million during the seven months ended July 31, 2007 and the five months ended December 31, 2007, respectively. The Company did not receive any such fees during 2009 or 2008.

Note 6. Restructuring and Asset Impairment Charges

The Company has executed various restructuring plans and may execute additional plans in the future to realign manufacturing capacity to prevailing global automotive production and to improve the utilization of remaining facilities. Estimates of restructuring charges are based on information available at the time such charges are recorded. Due to the inherent uncertainty involved in estimating restructuring expenses, actual amounts paid for such activities may differ from amounts initially recorded. Accordingly, the Company may record revisions of previous estimates by adjusting previously established reserves.

Restructuring Charges

Restructuring charges and asset impairments include the following (in thousands):

 

     Successor             Predecessor
     Year Ended
December 31,
2009
   Year Ended
December 31,
2008
   Five Months
Ended
December 31,
2007
            Seven Months
Ended
July 31, 2007

International

   $ 12,619    $ 1,427    $ 2,395          $ 896

Americas

     817      3,410      (587         21,505
                                

Total

   $ 13,436    $ 4,837    $ 1,808          $ 22,401
                                

The Company incurred restructuring expense of $20.3 million and $13.9 million, respectively, during the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, which were offset by $6.9 million and $9.1 million, respectively, of other restructuring income. The Company incurred restructuring expense of $8.6 million during the five months ended December 31, 2007, which was offset by $6.8 million of other restructuring income. The Predecessor Company incurred restructuring expense of $30.3 million during the seven months ended July 31, 2007, which was offset by $7.9 million of other restructuring income.

The other restructuring income was related to the cancellation of an old customer program relating to the Company’s closed facility in Milwaukee, Wisconsin. This income was recorded in the Americas segment. As of June 30, 2009, all recoveries had been received.

 

F-21


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The charges incurred during 2009, 2008, and 2007 primarily related to the following actions:

2009 Actions

In July 2009 in the International segment, the Company announced the closure of its press shop in Bergisch Gladbach, Germany. This closure impacted 57 employees, who ceased employment with the Company in October 2009. Total estimated costs of the closure of this facility are $10.2 million which is comprised of $9.1 million of severance costs and $1.1 million of other exit costs. The Company recorded the entire charge of $10.2 million during 2009 related to the closure of the Bergisch press shop. The additional charges incurred in 2009 in both the International and Americas segments relate to other severance costs, ongoing maintenance of facilities closed as a result of prior actions, and an additional impairment charge on an asset held for sale.

2008 Actions

In September 2008 in the Americas segment, the Company announced certain restructuring activities in its North American operations. The Company announced the closure of its Traverse City, Michigan facility. This closure impacted approximately 360 employees. The costs of the Traverse City, Michigan facility closure were recognized over the required service period of the employees through April 2009. Charges of $4 million and $4.5 million, respectively, were recognized during the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008 for a cumulative charge of $8.5 million. The charges incurred during 2009 were comprised of $0.1 million of severance costs, $1.8 million for an additional impairment charge on the facility, and $2.1 million of other exit costs. The charges incurred during 2008 were comprised of $4.4 million of severance costs and $0.1 million of other exit costs.

2007 Actions

During 2007 in the Americas segment, the Company announced the closure of certain facilities in its North American operations in an effort to realign capacity with demand during bankruptcy. The Company closed its Kendallville, Milan, Granite City, and Upper Sandusky facilities and incurred restructuring and asset impairment charges of $20.9 million relating to these closures.

Restructuring Reserve

The table below summarizes the activity in the accrual, reflected in accrued liabilities, for the above-mentioned actions through December 31, 2009 (in thousands):

 

     International     Americas     Consolidated  

Balance at December 31, 2007

   $ 2,226      $ 1,105      $ 3,331   

Payments

     (610     (2,097     (2,707

Increase in liability

     739        6,317        7,056   

Adjustment to liability

            (449     (449
                        

Balance at December 31, 2008

     2,355        4,876        7,231   

Payments

     (3,458     (3,755     (7,213

Increase in liability

     9,290        323        9,613   

Adjustment to liability

            117        117   
                        

Balance at December 31, 2009

   $ 8,187      $ 1,561      $ 9,748   
                        

Except as disclosed in the table above, the Company does not anticipate incurring additional material cash charges associated with the actions described above. The increase in the liability above does not agree with the restructuring charges in the table above as certain items are expensed as incurred related to the actions described.

 

F-22


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The liability increased during 2009 primarily due to new restructuring actions taken in the Company’s International operations. The increases to the liability primarily related to involuntary employee termination benefits. Of the $9.7 million restructuring reserve accrued as of December 31, 2009, the majority is expected to be paid in 2010. The liability increased during 2008 primarily due to restructuring actions taken in the Company’s Americas operations. The increases to the liability primarily related to involuntary employee termination benefits which have now all been paid.

During the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, the Company incurred severance payments related to prior accruals in North America of $3.1 million and $1.2 million, Europe of $2.4 million and $0.6 million, Asia of $1 million and $0 million, and Brazil of $0.7 million and $0.9 million, respectively.

The majority of the Company’s restructuring actions in 2009, 2008, and the 2007 Successor period related to severance payments and facility lease costs, with $1.8 million of asset impairments in 2009. The majority of the Predecessor Company’s 2007 restructuring actions were for asset impairments of approximately $21 million.

Note 7. Assets Held for Sale

The Company has two locations that are considered held for sale in accordance with FASB ASC No. 360. The two locations are Gunpo, South Korea and Traverse City, Michigan. Production ceased at the Traverse City location during the second quarter of 2009 and the Gunpo facility is an office building. The Company’s management has demonstrated intent to sell these locations by listing the properties with local real estate agencies at prices deemed reasonable in comparison to their respective fair values; thus, the Company expects to sell these locations within one year. Accordingly, the Company has recorded these locations at fair value, ceased depreciation on them, and classified them as held for sale. The following table summarizes assets held for sale by category (in thousands):

 

     December 31,
2009

Land

   $ 2,868

Building

     3,140
      

Total

   $ 6,008
      

Note 8. Debt

Long-Term Debt

Long-term debt consists of the following (in thousands):

 

     December 31,
2009
    December 31,
2008
 

First lien term borrowings, due July 31, 2013

   $ 471,033      $ 502,408   

Revolving credit facility

     24,500          

Other foreign subsidiary indebtedness

     156,403        106,410   
                

Total debt

     651,936        608,818   

Less current maturities

     (139,558     (102,570
                

Long-term debt

   $ 512,378      $ 506,248   
                

 

F-23


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The current maturities do not include capital lease obligations of $2.1 million and $2.3 million as of December 31, 2009 and 2008.

Future maturities of long-term debt as of December 31, 2009 are as follows (in thousands):

 

2010

   $ 139,558

2011

     13,618

2012

     42,183

2013

     456,577

2014

    

Thereafter

    
      

Total

   $ 651,936
      

Successor Debt

First Lien Term Loan

As of December 31, 2009, the outstanding principal balance on the U.S. Dollar and Euro tranches was $204.3 million and $266.7 (or €186.3) million, respectively. The interest rates in effect as of December 31, 2009 were 4.56% and 4.86% on the U.S. Dollar and Euro tranches, respectively. Refer to Note 15 for related party discussion.

Second Lien Term Loan

On January 31, 2008 and May 5, 2008, the Company elected to make $10 million and $17.9 million early payments of the second lien term loan, respectively. The payments were made in accordance with Amendment No.1 to the second lien term loan, and therefore, the Company did not incur an early payment penalty. With the May 5, 2008 payment, the second lien term loan was repaid in full.

Revolving Credit Facility

Advances under the revolving credit facility bear interest at a base rate plus a margin or LIBOR plus a margin. The applicable margins are determined by the average availability under the revolving credit facility over the preceding three months. The applicable margins as of December 31, 2009 were 0.75% and 1.75% for base rate and LIBOR based borrowings, respectively. As of December 31, 2009 there was $100.3 million of borrowing availability under the revolving credit facility of which $24.5 million of borrowings and $0.3 million of letters of credit were outstanding.

The revolving credit facility is secured by (1) a first-priority lien on all accounts receivable, inventory, cash, investments and property, plant and equipment of the U.S. Borrower and guarantors, (2) a second-priority pledge of 65% of any voting and 100% of any non-voting equity interests held in any foreign subsidiary by the U.S. Borrower and guarantors, and (3) a second-priority lien on all other tangible and intangible assets of the U.S. Borrower and guarantors.

Letter of Credit Facility

The letter of credit facility, which is part of the first lien term loan agreement, is fully cash collateralized by third parties for purposes of replacing or backstopping letters of credit outstanding at the time of the original

 

F-24


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

acquisition by Cerberus. The cash collateral was deposited by such third parties in a deposit account, and the Company has no right, title or interest in the deposit account. On April 8, 2009, the letter of credit facility was reduced by $30 million from $60 million to $30 million. On September 30, 2009, the letter of credit facility was reduced by $2.5 million from $30 million to $27.5 million. As of December 31, 2009, the outstanding letters of credit under the letter of credit facility were $27.3 million. Applicable fees were initially 4.25% of the aggregate letters of credit outstanding for commissions and fronting fees and a deposit fee of 0.15% based on the amount of the cash collateral deposit.

As of December 31, 2009, the weighted average interest rate of the Company’s credit facilities (first lien term loan and revolving credit facility) was 4.59%. The Company incurred interest expense related to the amortization of debt issue costs of $3.5 million and $2.9 million during the years ended December 31, 2009 and December 31, 2008, respectively. The Successor Company and the Predecessor Company incurred interest expense related to the amortization of debt issue costs of $3.7 million and $10.5 million during the five months ended December 31, 2007 and the seven months ended July 31, 2007, respectively.

Amendment

During the first quarter of 2009, the Company reached an agreement to amend certain terms of its revolving credit facility, first lien term loan agreement, and letter of credit facility. As part of the amendment, the Company agreed to reduce the $200 million revolving credit facility to $150 million.

The amendment also allowed the Company to redeem a portion of its letter of credit facility for cash. On April 8, 2009, the Company received cash proceeds of $12 million, in exchange for a $30 million reduction of the letter of credit facility from $60 million to $30 million. A gain of $11.5 million, net of fees, was recognized as other income as a result of this transaction. In addition, the Company had the ability to redeem up to an additional $10 million of the letter of credit facility by the end of the third quarter of 2009. On September 30, 2009, the Company received cash proceeds of $1.2 million, in exchange for a $2.5 million reduction of the letter of credit facility to decrease the facility from $30 million to $27.5 million. A gain of $1.2 million, net of fees, was recognized as other income as a result of this transaction.

Also pursuant to the amendment, the Company was required to use the proceeds from the first letter of credit reduction to repurchase a portion of the U.S. tranche of the first lien term loan. The amendment provides the Company with an eighteen-month window to repurchase the first lien term loans up to an aggregate of $50 million in cash. On May 1, 2009, the Company agreed to a tender offer to repurchase $32.9 million of the first lien term loan using the net proceeds from the letter of credit facility reduction. On May 6, 2009, the Company executed the agreement by transferring $11.5 million to complete the transaction, which resulted in a net gain of $20.9 million after fees, recognized as other income.

These actions assisted the Company in remaining compliant with debt covenants during 2009.

Other Foreign Subsidiary Indebtedness

As of December 31, 2009, other foreign subsidiary indebtedness of $156.4 million consists primarily of borrowings in South Korea of $114 million, receivable factoring in Europe of $29.1 million, and borrowings in Brazil of $13.3 million.

 

F-25


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

South Korea

The Company has borrowings in South Korea of $114 million which have interest rates ranging from 3.95% to 9.96%. The majority of these borrowings are subject to annual renewal. Substantially all of the assets of the Company’s South Korean subsidiary serve as collateral.

During the second quarter of 2009, the Company obtained commitments of $21 million (KRW 24.5 billion) from two local banks and through participation in the South Korean government’s Collateralized Bond Obligation program. As of December 31, 2009, the Company has drawn $19.3 million (KRW 22.5 billion) against these new commitments, leaving $1.7 million (KRW 2 billion) undrawn and available. This new debt is primarily unsecured and has maturities of between one and three years, with an average maturity of 2.3 years.

During the third quarter of 2009, the Company obtained new term loan financing from a local bank in South Korea of $4.3 million (KRW 5 billion) at face value. The Company used $2.1 million (KRW 2.4 billion) of the proceeds to repay a portion of an existing, higher interest rate term loan at another local bank at face value. The Company did not incur an early payment penalty. The remainder of the proceeds is to be used to support increased inter-company sales from the Company’s South Korean tool shop to overseas affiliates. This new debt is unsecured and has a one year maturity.

During the fourth quarter of 2009, the Company obtained $7.9 million (KRW 9.2 billion) of new loans. The proceeds were used to refinance maturing higher cost loans at face value. The Company also extended by one year the maturity of $9.4 million (KRW 11 billion) of loans previously scheduled to mature in the quarter.

Brazil

The Company obtained new term loan financing of $16.1 million (R$ 28 million) in its Brazilian operations in January 2009. This new credit was provided through bilateral agreements with three local banks. All loans have a duration of one year or less, are secured by certain fixed and current assets, and bear interest rates ranging from 12.7% to 18.85% per annum. Periodic interest and principal payments are required. During June 2009, one of the banks provided a new $2.3 million (R$ 4 million) loan to replace principal payments that had occurred since January. Throughout the year, the banks provided new loans to replace principal payments that had occurred since January; $2.3 million, $5.7 million, and $4.6 million (R$ 4 million, R$ 10 million, and R$ 8 million), respectively, in June, October, and November of 2009. As of December 31, 2009, the aggregate balance outstanding is $13.3 million (R$ 23.2 million).

Italy

During the second quarter of 2009, local banks in Italy increased the receivable factoring facilities available to the Company by $21 million (€14.7 million). As of December 31, 2009, the receivable factoring facilities available to the Company are $39.2 million (€27.4 million). These are uncommitted, demand facilities which are subject to termination at the discretion of the banks, and bear interest rates based on the average 3 month EURIBOR plus a spread ranging from 1.45% to 2.00%. The effective rates as of December 31, 2009 ranged from 2.16% to 2.71% per annum. Any receivable factoring under these facilities is with recourse, and is secured by the accounts receivable factored. These receivable factoring transactions are recorded in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheet in current maturities of long term debt.

Generally, borrowings of foreign subsidiaries are made under credit agreements with commercial lenders and are used to fund working capital and other operating requirements.

 

F-26


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Capital Leases

The Company had capital lease obligations of $17.6 million and $19.3 million as of December 31, 2009 and December 31, 2008, respectively. Property under capital leases was $25.2 million and $24.6 million with $4.1 million and $2.4 million of accumulated depreciation as of December 31, 2009 and December 31, 2008, respectively.

As of December 31, 2009, the Company believes that it is in full compliance with the financial covenants that govern its credit agreements.

Predecessor Debt

Chapter 11 Impact

Under the terms of the Predecessor Company’s pre-petition credit agreement, the Chapter 11 filing created an event of default. Upon the Chapter 11 filing, the lenders’ obligation to loan additional money to the Predecessor Company terminated, the outstanding principal of all obligations became immediately due and payable and the Debtors were required to immediately deposit funds into a collateral account to cover the outstanding amounts under the letters of credit issued pursuant to the credit agreement. Outstanding obligations under the credit agreement amounted to $425 million, which were refinanced through debtor-in-possession financing.

In addition, the Chapter 11 filing created an event of default under the Predecessor Company’s Convertible Debentures, Senior Notes, Senior Euro Notes and the Subordinated Debentures (see Note 3).

Pursuant to FASB ASC No. 852, Reorganizations , the Predecessor Company ceased recognizing interest expense on its Convertible Debentures, Senior Notes, Senior Euro Notes and the Subordinated Debentures effective February 2, 2005. Contractual interest not accrued during the period from January 1, 2007 through July 31, 2007 was $43.2 million.

The debt of the Predecessor Company’s foreign subsidiaries was not subject to compromise in the bankruptcy proceedings as the Predecessor Company’s operating foreign subsidiaries were not included in the Chapter 11 filing.

 

F-27


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Note 9. Derivative Financial Instruments

The Company was required by its credit agreements to enter into two interest rate swap agreements during the third quarter of 2007. These derivative agreements effectively fix interest rates on a portion of the Company’s European and U.S. first lien term loan tranches at 5.06% and 4.62%, respectively, and qualify for cash flow hedge accounting treatment under FASB ASC No. 815, Derivatives and Hedging . The swaps were designated as hedging instruments to offset the changes in cash flows resulting from changes in interest rates on this variable rate debt through August 31, 2010. Under FASB ASC No. 815, each swap is recorded as a cash flow hedge in which the fair value is recorded as an asset or liability and the changes in the fair value are recorded as a component of other comprehensive income. Periodic measurement of hedge effectiveness is performed quarterly. Any changes in the effective portion of these derivatives are recorded as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), a component of members’ equity, while any ineffective portion will be recorded in earnings and reflected in the consolidated statement of income as part of interest expense. The following table presents the notional amount of interest rate swaps by class (in thousands):

 

Financial Instruments

   Hedge Type    Notional Amount    Start Date    Maturity Date

Floating to fixed

   Cash Flow    $ 182,500    8/31/2007    8/31/2010

Floating to fixed

   Cash Flow    100,000    8/31/2007    8/31/2010

During 2009, a pre-tax gain of $6 million was recorded in other comprehensive income relating to the two cash flow hedges. As of December 31, 2009, no ineffective portion exists and the fair values of these derivatives are recorded as a liability of $10.6 million in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheet in accrued liabilities. A $9.8 million loss was recorded in other comprehensive income at December 31, 2008 and a corresponding liability of $16.6 million was recorded in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheet. The fair value of our interest rate swaps was determined based on third-party valuation models. As the swaps are still outstanding and effective hedges, amounts transferred from accumulated other comprehensive income to net income / (loss) for the periods presented were not significant. The swaps will settle in 2010; therefore, the amount currently recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income / (loss) of $12.5 million will be reclassified to net income / (loss) in 2010.

Note 10. Income Taxes

The summary of income/(loss) before provision for income taxes, equity in earnings of joint ventures and noncontrolling interests consisted of the following (in thousands):

 

     Successor             Predecessor  
     Year Ended
December 31,
2009
    Year Ended
December 31,
2008
    Five Months
Ended
December 31,
2007
            Seven Months Ended
July  31,

2007
 

Domestic

   $ (38,811   $ (75,763   $ (1,768       $ (119,873

Foreign

     (21,325     49,529        23,239            22,145   
                                    
   $ (60,136   $ (26,234   $ 21,471          $ (97,728
                                    

 

F-28


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The provision for income taxes consisted of the following (in thousands):

 

     Successor       Predecessor  
     Year Ended
December 31,
2009
    Year Ended
December 31,
2008
    Five Months Ended
December  31,

2007
      Seven Months Ended
July  31,

2007
 

Current:

          

Domestic—Federal

   $      $      $     $   

Domestic—State

     192        (157     109       (28

Foreign

     16,658        19,933        7,054       10,012   
                                
     16,850        19,776        7,163       9,984   

Tax benefit of gain recognition in OCI:

          

Domestic—Federal

     (4,398                    

Domestic—State

     (503                    
                                
     (4,901                    

Deferred:

          

Domestic—Federal

                           

Domestic—State

     238        438                

Foreign

     (13,291     (707     3,226       4,967   
                                
     (13,053     (269     3,226       4,967   
                                

Total

   $ (1,104   $ 19,507      $ 10,389     $ 14,951   
                                

A reconciliation of income taxes computed at the statutory rates to the reported income tax provision is as follows (in thousands):

 

    Successor             Predecessor  
    Year Ended
December 31,
2009
    Year Ended
December 31,
2008
    Five Months Ended
December  31,

2007
            Seven Months Ended
July  31,

2007
 

Taxes at federal statutory rates

  $ (21,057   $ (9,182   $ 7,515          $ (34,205

Foreign tax rate differential

    (1,706     (3,657     (3,514         (5,410

Inflation adjustment—Mexico

    (1,277     (991                  

Audit settlements

                             1,780   

Sale of investment in subsidiaries

           4,847        (31,374         32,630   

Taxable foreign dividends

                             7,800   

Other permanent differences

    5,209        2,737        (3,586         10,451   

Bankruptcy costs

                             19,329   

Disallowed interest expense

    1,506        3,431        2,929              

Tax benefit of gain recognized in OCI

    (4,901                         

State deferreds and credits

    1,626        (5,751     (1,312           

Valuation allowance

    19,496        28,073        39,731            (17,424
                                   
  $ (1,104   $ 19,507      $ 10,389          $ 14,951   
                                   

 

F-29


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

A summary of deferred income tax assets (liabilities) is as follows (in thousands):

 

     2009     2008  

Accrued compensation costs

   $ 29,926      $ 36,848   

Postretirement benefit obligations

     1,328        5,770   

Purchase accounting adjustments

            4,733   

MRO Inventory

     8,251          

Facility closure and consolidation costs

     1,427        6,057   

Net operating loss carryforwards and tax credits

     112,896        73,337   

Other reserves and adjustments

     24,888        27,322   

Goodwill and intangibles

     (3,932     (2,280

Fixed asset, and leases

     3,164        9,859   
                
     177,948        161,646   

Less: valuation allowance

     (172,358     (170,093
                

Net deferred income tax assets (liabilities)

   $ 5,590      $ (8,447
                

The Company has U.S. net operating loss carryforwards (“NOLs”) of $148.5 million that expire during the years 2027 through 2029 and state NOL carryforwards of $64.2 million and state credit carryforwards of $21.5 million that expire during the years 2012 through 2029. The Company has recorded deferred tax assets of $52.0 million, and $16.6 million related to federal NOL carryforwards and state NOL and credit carryforwards, respectively. The Company assesses the available positive and negative evidence to estimate if sufficient future taxable income will be generated to utilize the existing deferred tax assets. Based on this assessment, the Company continues to record a full valuation allowance against its U.S. federal and state net deferred tax assets.

The Company’s foreign subsidiaries have tax NOL carryforwards of $162.4 million and other NOL carryforwards of $40.0 million at December 31, 2009 of which some expire in 2010 and others are carried forward indefinitely. The Company has recorded deferred tax assets of $44.3 million related to the foreign NOL carryforwards. The Company has recorded a full valuation allowance in certain foreign jurisdictions against its foreign net deferred tax assets.

The Company’s foreign subsidiaries are held by a pass-through entity that is not subject to income tax, any repatriation of foreign earnings will not result in tax at the entity level. As such, the Company does not provide for deferred taxes on the excess of the financial reporting over the tax basis in its investments in foreign subsidiaries.

The Predecessor Company had U.S. net operating loss carryforwards (“NOLs”) of $1 billion that would have expired during the years 2019 through 2027. The Predecessor Company had a U.S. alternative minimum tax (“AMT”) credit carryforward of $2.9 million that would have carried forward indefinitely. Certain Predecessor Company assets, including U.S. NOLs and other U.S. tax attributes, remained with the Post Consummation Trust.

The Predecessor Company had various state tax credits and state NOL carryforwards. In 2007, a valuation allowance amount of $0.6 million was established in association with state deferred tax assets. The cumulative valuation allowance at July 31, 2007 was $49.9 million for state deferred tax assets.

 

F-30


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

A reconciliation of the beginning and ending amounts of unrecognized tax benefits are as follows (in thousands):

 

     Unrecognized
Tax Benefits
 

Balance at January 1, 2007

   $ 6,992   

Increase in prior year tax positions

       

Decrease in prior year tax positions

     (3,952

Increase in current year tax positions

     967   
        

Balance at December 31, 2007

     4,007   
        

Increase in prior year tax positions

     228   

Decrease in prior year tax positions

       

Increase in current year tax positions

     1,840   

Audit settlements

     (118

Lapse in statute of limitations

     (91

Foreign currency translation

     (219
        

Balance at December 31, 2008

     5,647   
        

Increase in prior year tax positions

     882   

Decrease in prior year tax positions

       

Increase in current year tax positions

     1,718   

Audit settlements

     (303

Lapse in statute of limitations

     (75

Foreign currency translation

     358   
        

Balance at December 31, 2009

   $ 8,227   
        

Included in the balance of unrecognized tax benefits at December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007 respectively, are $7.4 million, $5.2 million and $3.5 million of tax benefits that, if recognized, would affect the effective tax rate, subject to valuation allowance adjustments. Also included in the balance of unrecognized tax benefits at December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007 respectively, are $0.8 million, $0.4 million and $0.5 million of tax benefits that, if recognized, would result in adjustments to other tax accounts, primarily deferred taxes.

The Company recognizes interest and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits as income tax expense. During the year ended December 31, 2009, the Company recognized less than $0.1 million of interest due to audit settlements from Brazil and $0.4 million in penalties as income tax expense.

The Company files income tax returns in the U.S. federal jurisdiction, as well as various states and foreign jurisdictions. As of December 31, 2009 the Company’s tax years for 2002 through 2009 are subject to examination by the tax authorities.

At this time, the Company is also under audit in several foreign jurisdictions. Based on the status of the audits and the protocol of finalizing audits by the relevant tax authorities, the Company does not believe there will be material changes within the next twelve months to previously recorded uncertain tax positions. However, as of December 31, 2009, the foreign tax authorities proposed certain adjustments that would impact the Company’s liability for unrecognized tax benefits. Although it is not possible to predict the timing of the conclusion of all ongoing audits with accuracy, it is reasonably possible that a reduction in the unrecognized tax benefits may occur; however, quantification of an estimated range cannot be made at this time.

 

F-31


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Note 11. Employee Benefit Plans

The Company sponsors various pension and other postretirement benefit plans for its employees.

In accordance with FASB ASC No. 805, Business Combinations , on August 1, 2007, the Company recorded a liability for the total projected benefit obligation in excess of plan assets for the pension plans and a liability for the total accumulated postretirement benefit obligation in excess of the fair value of plan assets for other postretirement benefit plans and for postretirement benefit settlement agreements, which were approved by the Bankruptcy Court and assumed by the Successor Company.

The Successor Company elected to early adopt the measurement provisions of FASB ASC No. 715, Compensation-Retirement Benefits, on August 1, 2007. Those provisions require the measurement date for plan assets and liabilities to coincide with the sponsor’s year-end. As a result of the application of purchase accounting the adoption did not have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements.

Defined Benefit Retirement Plans

The Tower Automotive Consolidated Pension Plan (the “Pension Plan”), which resulted from the Predecessor Company’s merger of the Tower Automotive Pension Plan and the UAW Retirement Income Plan, provides benefits for certain current and former U.S. employees. Benefits under the Pension Plan are based on years of service, compensation, and other factors. Effective October 1, 2006, the plan was frozen and ceased accruing any additional benefits. Contributions by the Company are intended to fund benefits that accrued through October 1, 2006.

The Company’s funding policy is to annually contribute amounts to the Pension Plan’s related trust sufficient to meet the minimum funding requirements of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended (“ERISA”) and the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”). The Company expects minimum contribution requirements to the Pension Plan of $9.7 million during 2010. Benefit payments under the Pension Plan are estimated to be $20.5 million, $19.8 million, $19.5 million, $18.6 million, and $18.6 million for the years ending December 31, 2010, 2011, 2012, 2013, and 2014, respectively, for a total of $97 million during that five-year period. Aggregate benefit payments under the Pension Plan for the years 2015 through 2018 are estimated to be $87 million.

 

F-32


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The following table provides a reconciliation of the changes in the benefit obligations and fair value of assets for the Pension Plan (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
2009
    Year Ended
December 31,
2008
 

Reconciliation of fair value of plan assets:

    

Fair value of plan assets at the beginning of the period

   $ 154,697      $ 216,497   

Actual return on plan assets

     24,882        (51,543

Employer contributions

     8,208        11,563   

Plan expenses paid

     (927     (589

Benefits paid

     (21,002     (21,231
                

Fair value of plan assets at the end of the period

   $ 165,858      $ 154,697   
                

Change in Benefit Obligations:

    

Benefit obligations at the beginning of the period

   $ 243,549      $ 251,161   

Service cost

     28        30   

Interest cost

     14,305        14,889   

Actuarial loss (gain)

     7,708        (1,300

Benefits paid

     (21,002     (21,231
                

Benefit obligations at the end of the period

   $ 244,588      $ 243,549   
                

Funded status

   $ (78,730   $ (88,852
                

At December 31, 2009 and 2008, the funded status is recorded in non-current liabilities in the Consolidated Balance Sheet.

At the December 31, 2009 measurement date, the accumulated benefit obligation of the Pension Plan was approximately $244.4 million. At December 31, 2008 and 2007, the accumulated benefit obligation of the Pension Plan was approximately $243.3 million and $250.8 million, respectively.

The following table provides the components of net periodic pension benefit cost for the Pension Plan (in thousands):

 

     Successor         Predecessor  
     Year Ended
December 31,
2009
    Year Ended
December 31,
2008
    Five Months
Ended
December 31,
2007
        Seven Months
Ended
July  31,

2007
 

Service cost

   $ 28      $ 30      $ 12        $ 68   

Interest cost

     14,305        14,889        6,480          5,911   

Expected return on plan assets

     (10,063     (14,511     (6,024       (7,991

Amortization of prior service cost

                            460   

Amortization of net losses

     1,835                        1,201   

Curtailment loss

                            2,444   
                                    

Net periodic benefit cost

   $ 6,105      $ 408      $ 468        $ 2,093   
                                    

In accordance with FASB ASC No. 805, unrecognized net actuarial losses and net prior service cost included in accumulated other comprehensive loss as of July 31, 2007 were eliminated.

 

F-33


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Amounts recognized in other comprehensive income/(loss), pre-tax, at December 31, 2009 and 2008 consist of the following:

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
     2009     2008

Net actuarial loss/(gain)

   $ (6,185   $ 65,343

Amortization of net losses

     (1,835    
              

Amount recognized

   $ (8,020   $ 65,343
              

The net periodic benefit cost for the year ending December 31, 2010 will contain an estimated $1.6 million to be amortized from accumulated other comprehensive income.

The assumptions used in the measurement of the Company’s benefit obligation, based upon a December 31, 2009 and December 31, 2008 measurement date, are as follows:

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
 
     2009     2008  

Discount rate

   5.75   6.25

Rate of compensation increase

   4.50   4.50

The assumptions used in determining net periodic benefit cost are shown below:

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
 
     2009     2008     2007  

Discount rate

   6.25   6.25   6.25

Expected return on plan assets

   7.25   7.25   7.25

Rate of compensation increase

   4.50   4.50   4.50

The present value of the Company’s pension benefit obligation is calculated through the use of a discount rate. The discount rate used is established annually at the measurement date and reflects the construction of a yield curve analysis from a third party, which calculates the yield to maturity that mirrors the timing and amounts of future benefit payments.

The Company’s allocations of Pension Plan assets on the December 31, 2009 and 2008 measurement dates are as follows:

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
 
     2009     2008     2009
Target
 

Fixed income investments

   43   38   48

Equity securities

   38   46   35

Non-equity investments

   12   0   12

Real estate

   6   7   5

Cash equivalents

   1   9   0
                  

Total

   100   100   100

 

F-34


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The expected long-term rate of return on Pension Plan assets is based on the expected return of each of the above categories, weighted based on the median of the target allocation for each class. Over the long term, equity securities are expected to return between 9% and 12%, fixed income investments are expected to return between 5% and 7%, and non-equity investments are expected to return between 7% and 9%.

The investment policy, as established by the Company’s Benefit Plans Committee (the “Committee”), allows for effective supervision, monitoring, and evaluating of the investment of the Company’s retirement plan assets. This includes setting forth an investment structure for managing assets and providing guidelines for each portfolio to control the level of overall risk and liquidity. The cash inflows and outflows will be deployed in a manner consistent with the above target allocations. If the Committee determines cash flows to be insufficient within the strategic allocation target ranges, the Committee shall decide whether to effect transactions to bring the strategic allocation within the threshold ranges. Plan assets do not include equity securities of the Company.

Pension Plan assets are recorded at fair value. Fixed income and equity securities may each be combined into commingled fund investments. Commingled funds are valued to reflect the Company’s interest in the fund based on the reported year-end net asset value. Non-equity investments, which represent approximately 12% of Pension Plan assets, include investments in private equity and hedge funds, and are value based on year-end reported net asset value. For Pension Plan assets, the balance sheet includes the funded status of the benefit plans, which represents the difference between the benefit obligations and fair value of Pension Plan assets.

The fair value of the Company’s Pension Plan assets at December 31, 2009 by asset category are as follows (in millions):

 

     Fair Value Measurements at December 31, 2009

Asset Category

   Total    Quoted Prices
in Active
Markets for
Identical
Assets

(Level 1)
   Significant
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
   Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)

Cash

   $ 2    $ 2    $    $

Equity securities:

           

U.S. companies

     27      27          

International companies

     10      10          

Mutual funds(a)

     34      18      16     

Real estate investment trusts

     9      9          

U.S. Treasuries

     31      31          

Corporate bonds

     32      32          

Equity long/short hedge funds(b)

     20                20
                           

Total

   $ 165    $ 129    $ 16    $ 20
                           

 

(a)   This category consists of mutual fund investments that are focused on international equity securities.
(b)   This category includes hedge funds that invest both long and short in a variety of U.S. equities, and international equities and currencies. Management of the hedge funds has the ability to shift investments from value to growth strategies, from small to large capitalization stocks, and from a net long position to a net short position.

 

F-35


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

For Pension Plan assets with a fair value measurement using significant unobservable inputs (level 3), the reconciliation of the beginning and ending balances are as follows (in millions):

Fair Value Measurements Using Significant

Unobservable Inputs (Level 3)

 

     Equity Long/
Short Hedge Funds

Beginning balance at December 31, 2008

   $

Actual return on plan assets:

  

Relating to assets still held at the reporting date

     2

Purchases

     18
      

Ending balance at December 31, 2009

   $ 20
      

Defined Contribution Retirement Plans

The Company sponsors various qualified defined contribution retirement plans. Each plan serves a defined group of employees and has varying levels of Company contributions. The Company’s contributions may be required by collective bargaining agreements for certain plans. Effective January 1, 2007, the Predecessor Company reinstated matching contributions for non-union employees. Effective July 30, 2007, the Predecessor Company terminated the Tower Automotive Retirement Plan and the Tower Automotive Union 401(k) Plan. Effective July 31, 2007, the Successor Company adopted the Tower Automotive Retirement Savings Plan and the Tower Automotive Union Retirement Savings Plan. The Predecessor Company contributions related to these plans were $1.9 million under the terminated plans for the seven months ended July 31, 2007, and the Successor Company contributed $1.5 million under the newly adopted plans for the five months ended December 31, 2007. The Successor Company contributions were $3 million and $3.8 million, respectively, during 2009 and 2008.

Retirement Plans of Non-U.S. Operations

The Company has no defined benefit pension plans associated with its non-U.S. operations. The Company primarily provides severance benefits to employees that have terminated their employment due to retirement or otherwise. The amount associated with such benefits depends upon the length of service of the employee and also upon whether the termination was voluntary or at the request of the Company. During 2007, the Predecessor Company recorded expenses associated with these non-U.S. plans of $0.9 million and the Successor Company recorded $0.8 million. During 2009 and 2008, the Company recorded expenses associated with these non-U.S. plans of $3.1 million and $3.9 million, respectively.

Other Postretirement Plans

The Predecessor Company provided certain medical insurance and life insurance benefits for retired employees. Certain U.S. employees of the Predecessor Company were eligible for these benefits if they fulfilled the eligibility requirements specified by the plans. Certain retirees were required to contribute all or a portion of the cost of their coverage. Benefit coverage continued for dependents of eligible retiree participants subsequent to the death of the retiree. During 2006, the Predecessor Company reached agreements with certain retirees and active U.S. employees to modify the benefits payable under the various plans.

 

F-36


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Defined-Dollar Capped Medical Plans

In April 2006, the Predecessor Company submitted for approval to the Bankruptcy Court settlement agreements with two groups representing current and future retirees. Both settlements included modifications of retiree health care benefits for both retired salaried employees as well as certain current and future retirees of the Company’s Milwaukee, Wisconsin facility.

In May 2006, the Bankruptcy Court approved the agreements with the official committee representing the Predecessor Company’s salaried retirees (the “Retiree Committee Stipulation”) and with the unions representing retirees at the Predecessor Company’s Milwaukee, Wisconsin facility (the “Milwaukee Stipulation”). Pursuant to the Retiree Committee Stipulation, salaried retirees continued to receive current benefits through June 30, 2006. The salaried retirees established a Voluntary Employee Benefit Association (“VEBA”) trust to administer medical insurance benefits after June 30, 2006. As of July 31, 2007, the Predecessor Company made contributions of $0.2 million

Pursuant to the Milwaukee Stipulation, a separate VEBA Trust was established and began administering medical insurance benefits for retirees and their dependents beginning July 1, 2006. The Predecessor Company contributed cash of approximately $4.4 million on July 31, 2007.

A separate VEBA Trust was established and began administering benefits for retirees from the Company’s Greenville facilities and their dependents beginning September 1, 2006. As of July 31, 2007, the Predecessor Company made contributions of $1.4 million.

As of July 31, 2007, the Successor Company assumed the liabilities associated with the settlement agreements defined above. Pursuant to the Predecessor Company’s plan of reorganization, future benefit payments were capped at specified amounts to be paid through 2011. As a result, the Successor Company determined that these arrangements represent defined benefit postretirement plans and defined-dollar capped plans in accordance with FASB ASC No. 715. As of July 31, 2007, these liabilities were recorded at fair value, which was approximately $11.8 million. The Successor Company will accrete the interest cost through cost of sales until settlement in accordance with FASB ASC No. 715. Benefit payments during the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008 was $2 million and $6.3 million, respectively. Interest accretion during the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008 was $0.2 million and $0.5 million, respectively. The accumulated postretirement benefit obligation at December 31, 2009 was $1.7 million. Expected benefit payments and future Company contributions amount to $1.2 million, and $0.6 million, respectively, for the years 2010 and 2011, for a total of $1.8 million.

Life Insurance Plans

Life insurance benefits to certain U.S. retirees of the Predecessor Company continue to be provided under the settlement agreements described above. The Successor Company has assumed the benefit plans pursuant to which such life insurance benefits are provided. Expected future life insurance benefit payments amount to $0.9 million for each year 2010 through 2014 for a total of $4.5 million during the five-year period. Aggregate expected benefit payments for the years 2015 through 2019 are $4.7 million.

 

F-37


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The following table provides a reconciliation of the changes in the benefit obligations and funded status of the Company’s other post employment benefit plans (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
2009(1)
    Year Ended
December 31,
2008(1)
 

Reconciliation of fair value of plan assets:

    

Fair value of plan assets at the beginning of the period

   $      $   

Employer contributions

     500        658   

Benefits paid

     (500     (658
                

Fair value of plan assets at the end of the period

   $      $   
                

Change in Benefit Obligations:

    

Benefit obligations at the beginning of the period

   $ 12,999      $ 13,065   

Service cost

              

Interest cost

     778        781   

Actuarial loss (gain)

     554        (189

Benefits paid

     (500     (658
                

Benefit obligations at the end of the period

   $ 13,831      $ 12,999   
                

Funded status

   $ (13,831   $ (12,999
                

 

(1)   Excludes defined-dollar capped plans as described above.

The following table provides the components of net periodic benefit cost for the plans (in thousands):

 

     Successor   Predecessor  
     Year Ended
December 31,
2009(1)
   Year Ended
December 31,
2008(1)
      Five Months
Ended
December 31,
2007(1)
  Seven Months
Ended
July  31,

2007
 

Service cost

   $    $     $   $   

Interest cost

     778      781       333     2,822   

Expected return on plan assets

                    (312

Amortization of prior service cost

                    (2,053

Amortization of net losses

                    2,291   
                             

Net periodic benefit cost

   $ 778    $ 781     $ 333   $ 2,748   
                             

 

(1)   Excludes defined-dollar capped plans as described above.

In accordance with FASB ASC No. 805, Business Combinations, unrecognized net actuarial losses and net prior service cost included in accumulated other comprehensive loss as of July 31, 2007 were eliminated.

Amounts recognized in other comprehensive income at December 31, 2009 and 2008, pre-tax, consist of the following (in thousands):

 

     2009    2008  

Net actuarial (gain) or loss

   $ 554    $ (189

Net prior service cost

            
               

Amount recognized

   $ 554    $ (189
               

 

F-38


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The discount rate used to measure the Company’s post employment benefit obligation was 5.75% and 6.25% for 2009 and 2008. The discount rate used to determine net periodic benefit costs was 6.25% in 2009, 6.25% in 2008, and 6.25% in 2007. The rate used reflects the construction of a yield curve analysis from a third party, which calculates the yield to maturity that mirrors the timing of future benefits. The measurement dates for the Company’s post retirement benefit plans were December 31, 2009 and December 31, 2008.

Note 12. Redeemable Preferred Units

The Company has outstanding 10,000 units of Membership Interest (designated as “Redeemable Preferred Units”) at December 31, 2009 and 2008. This is the total number of units authorized, issued, and outstanding. Cerberus owned and/or affiliated entities (“Members”) made initial capital contributions for all of the Redeemable Preferred Units in the amount of $213.8 million in July 2007. Redeemable Preferred Units are entitled to all of the rights of ownership, including a profits interest and a distribution preference, but have no conversion rights. Redeemable Preferred Units are non-voting, unless required by the Limited Liability Act of the State of Delaware. In accordance with FASB ASC No. 480, Distinguishing Liabilities from Equity , the Redeemable Preferred Units have been recorded as mezzanine equity at their issuance price, as they are redeemable at the option of the holder, based on the Members control of the Board of the Company. The initial carrying amount of redeemable preferred stock was its fair value, which was equal to the redemption value at date of issue.

The redemption value of the Redeemable Preferred Units is an amount that is equal to the holder’s initial capital contribution less all distributions previously made to such Redeemable Preferred Unit Holders (the “Unpaid Preference Amount”) plus an amount accruing at the rate of 10% per quarter on the holder’s Unpaid Preference Amount (the “Preferred Return Amount”). Therefore, if distributions are not made with respect to any fiscal year, the Redeemable Preferred Unit holders’ distributions will be cumulative. These units are recorded at redemption value at each balance sheet date and the Preferred Return Amount is recorded as an adjustment to retained earnings. During 2009, 2008, and 2007 the Company paid distributions of $0.4 million and $5.6 million, and $8.3 million, respectively.

In conjunction with the sale of the Company’s 40% ownership interest in Metalsa in December 2007, the Company made a payment of $68.4 million to the preferred members. No redeemable preferred units were redeemed.

Note 13. Members’ Equity / (Deficit) and Share Based Compensation

Members Equity

The Membership Interests in the Company are represented by issued and outstanding “Units” divided into series consisting of “Redeemable Preferred Units,” “Common Units” and “MIP Units”.

Common Units

The Company has authorized, issued, and outstanding 8,500 units of Membership Interest (designated as “Common Units”). Cerberus owned and/or affiliated entities made initial capital contributions for all of the Common Units, for total cash proceeds of $11.3 million. The Common Units are entitled to all of the rights of ownership, including voting rights.

MIP Units/Share Based Compensation

The Company authorized 1,500 units of Membership Interest (designated as “MIP Units”) to be eligible for grants in connection with the Company’s Management Incentive Plan (“MIP”). The Board approved MIP is

 

F-39


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

designed to promote the long-term success of the Company through share-based compensation by aligning the interests of participants with those of its members. The Company’s management determines vesting at the date of grant and awards have service and performance conditions. The awards based solely on service conditions generally vest based on 3 years of continuous service. The performance condition awards vest upon achievement of a profit goal, which represents a cumulative profit allocation target to the preferred holders. Certain of these awards provide for accelerated vesting if there is a change in control (as defined in the Plan).

In December of 2007 and first quarter of 2008, MIP Units were granted to certain key senior management and Board of Managers members and consultants of the Company pursuant to the MIP.

Under the fair value recognition provisions, share-based compensation cost is measured at the grant date based on the fair value of the award and is recognized as expense over the applicable vesting period of the award. The fair value of each MIP was based on the fair value of the common units on the date of grant. The compensation cost for the MIP Plan was insignificant for the periods ended December 31, 2009, 2008, and the five month period ending 2007, respectively, with no income tax benefit due to the valuation allowance in the United States recognized during 2009, 2008, and 2007.

MIP Units are entitled to all of the rights of ownership but are not entitled to vote, unless required by the Limited Liability Act of the State of Delaware. In addition, MIP Units are entitled to share in the residual value of the Company based on the liquidation preferences described below. At December 31, 2009, 2008, and 2007 MIP units outstanding were 1,465, 1,465, and 450. At December 31, 2009, 2008, and 2007 471.5, 236, and 0 MIP Units were vested, respectively.

Any additional Membership Interests must be approved by the Board of Managers of the Company. There is no established trading market for the Company’s Common, Preferred or MIP Units.

Membership Interest Distributions

Each fiscal year, the Company may make certain distributions to its Members, absent a Liquidation Event (as defined below), and after all amounts are paid by the Company for such fiscal year for ordinary and necessary business expenses, employee salaries and benefits, and payments of principal and interest on any Company indebtedness, in accordance with the following order of priority. First, to the Members, a tax distribution amount, which is intended to enable the Members to use such distributions to satisfy their estimated and final income tax liabilities for that fiscal year. Second, to the Preferred Unit holders, an amount that is equal to the Unpaid Preference Amount plus an amount for the Preferred Return Amount. If distributions are not made with respect to any fiscal year, the Preferred Unit holder’s distributions will be cumulative. Upon payment of the full Preferred Return Amount to the holders Preferred Units, then amounts may be distributed, to the holders of Common Units and MIP Units.

In the event of (i) a liquidation, dissolution, or winding up of the Company; (ii) a sale of all or substantially all of the assets of the Company to an unrelated third party; (iii) a merger, acquisition, or sale of Membership Interests, in which Members immediately prior to such event have received consideration for no less than half of the value of their Membership Interests, or (iv) a recapitalization, reorganization, reclassification, or other similar transaction in which the Company receives proceeds from a financing for the purpose of distributing such proceeds to the Members and the consummation of which the Board determines is a liquidation event (each a “Liquidation Event”), the Board is required to make distributions in the following order of priority. First, payment of all debts and liabilities owing to creditors including, if applicable, Members in their capacity as creditors and the expenses of dissolution or liquidation; second, establishment of such reserves as are deemed necessary by the Board for any contingent or unforeseen liabilities of the Company; third, to the holders of

 

F-40


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Preferred Units, in proportion to their respective Unpaid Preference Amounts, until each such holder of Preferred Units has received its Unpaid Preference Amount. Thereafter, to the holders of Common Units and MIP Units.

Predecessor Company—Share-Based Compensation

As of July 31, 2007, a total of 1.4 million stock options of Tower Automotive, Inc. were outstanding. Under the Plan of Reorganization, these stock options were canceled. No material share-based compensation expense was incurred as a result of these options in 2007.

Note 14. Earnings per Unit/Share

Predecessor

Basic earnings (loss) per share is computed by dividing net loss by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the period. The Predecessor Company had a loss for the seven months ended July 31, 2007. As a result, diluted loss per share is the same as basic loss per share in those periods presented, as any potentially dilutive securities would reduce the loss per share.

Successor

As discussed in Note 13, MIP units share in the undistributed earnings with the common units. These MIP units are classified as participating securities as defined by FASB ASC 260. Therefore, the Company uses the two-class method for calculating EPS. For the periods ending December 31, 2009 and 2008, undistributed losses of the company are not allocated to the participating securities as the MIP unit holders do not have a contractual obligation to share in the losses. For the five month period ended December 31, 2007 no undistributed earnings are allocated to the participating securities based on the contractual participation rights (See Note 13) of the MIP Units to share in the current undistributed earnings, as undistributed earnings would go to the preferred unit holders to the extent of their Unpaid Preference Amount.

Due to net losses from continuing operations for 2009 and 2008, the MIP units had an anti-dilutive effect and therefore were excluded from the computation of diluted loss per share. The number of MIP units not included in the computation of diluted loss per share was 1,465 for 2009 and 2008. The impact of potentially dilutive securities outstanding for the five-month period ending December 31, 2007 are deemed immaterial based on the calculation of the two class and treasury methods.

Note 15. Related Party Transactions

During July 2009, a company affiliated with the Company’s preferred unit holder purchased an additional portion of the first lien term loan which resulted in the affiliate having ownership of approximately 86% of the first lien term loan. A company affiliated with the Company’s preferred unit holder initially purchased approximately 40% of the first lien term loan in December 2008.

The Company has made certain payments to Cerberus for certain operational consulting services post acquisition. The Company made minor payments to its parent totaling less than $0.1 million during the year ended December 31, 2009 and made payments of $0.8 million and $0.3 million during the years ended December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2007. The Company has also made certain payments to its parent for acquisition related services of approximately $1.1 million during the year ended December 31, 2007. No such payments were made during the years ended December 31, 2009 or December 31, 2008. The Company also has certain service agreements with Board members whereby the Successor Company has paid them approximately $2 million, $3.2 million, and $1.5 million for 2009, 2008, and 2007, respectively.

 

F-41


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

On August 3, 2007, an affiliate of Cerberus Capital Management LLC acquired 80% of the Chrysler division from DaimlerChrysler Corporation. The Company sells certain products from its North American operations to Chrysler. The sale of these products was $144.9 million during 2008 and $81.1 million from August 1, 2007 to December 31, 2007. The Company’s accounts receivable with Chrysler at December 31, 2008 and 2007 was $6.5 million and $4.9 million, respectively. On April 30, 2009, Chrysler filed for bankruptcy and Cerberus divested its ownership in Chrysler. The Company’s sales to Chrysler during the four months ended April 30, 2009 were $17.7 million.

The Company sells certain products from its Asian operations to our joint venture partners, FAW-VW and Chery. The sale of these products to FAW-VW was $90.6 million, $74.6 million, and $78.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2009, 2008, and 2007, respectively. The sale of these products to Chery was $42.8 million, $28.5 million, and $30.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively. The Company’s accounts receivable with FAW-VW and Chery at December 31, 2009 was $12.4 million and $8.7 million, respectively.

The Company received technology fees from Metalsa of $5.2 million and $3.4 million during the seven months ended July 31, 2007 and the five months ended December 31, 2007, respectively. The Company did not receive any of such fees during 2009 or 2008.

Note 16. Segment Information

The Company defines its operating segments as components of its business where separate financial information is available and is routinely evaluated by management. The company’s chief operating decision maker (CODM) is the Chief Executive Officer. The Company produces engineered structural metal components and assemblies primarily serving the global automotive industry. The Company’s operations have similar economic characteristics, and share fundamental characteristics including the nature of the products, production processes, customers, and distribution channels. The Company’s products include body structures stampings, chassis structures (including frames), and complex welded assemblies for small and large cars, crossovers, pickups and SUVs. The Company is comprised of four operating segments: Europe, Asia, North America, and South America. These operating segments are aggregated into two reportable segments. The International segment consists of Europe and Asia while the Americas segment consists of North and South America.

The Company measures segment operating performance based on Adjusted EBITDA. The Company uses segment Adjusted EBITDA as the basis for the CODM to evaluate the performance of each of the Company’s reportable segments.

 

F-42


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The following is a summary of selected data for each of our segments, excluding discontinued operations (in thousands):

 

     International    Americas    Total

2009:

        

Revenues

   $ 990,523    $ 643,882    $ 1,634,405

Adjusted EBITDA

     108,650      16,350      125,000

Capital expenditures

     49,753      29,185      78,938

Total assets

   $ 886,936    $ 447,485    $ 1,334,421

2008:

        

Revenues

   $ 1,251,361    $ 920,344    $ 2,171,705

Adjusted EBITDA

     163,875      48,979      212,854

Capital expenditures

     75,956      53,153      129,109

Total assets

   $ 831,990    $ 437,790    $ 1,269,780

2007 (Successor—5 months):

        

Revenues

   $ 577,087    $ 508,988    $ 1,086,075

Adjusted EBITDA

     67,230      56,337      123,567

Capital expenditures

     28,018      11,409      39,427

Total assets

   $ 1,143,988    $ 438,955    $ 1,582,943

2007 (Predecessor—7 months):

        

Revenues

   $ 772,092    $ 683,392    $ 1,455,484

Adjusted EBITDA

     85,980      58,666      144,646

Capital expenditures

     20,607      17,843      38,450

Total assets

   $ 1,137,245    $ 978,864    $ 2,116,109

Inter-segment sales are not significant for any period presented. Capital expenditures do not equal cash disbursed for purchases of property, plant, and equipment as presented in the accompanying consolidated statements of cash flows, as capital expenditures above include amounts paid and accrued during the periods presented.

The following is a reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to net income before provision for income taxes (in millions):

 

     2009     2008     Successor
2007
        Predecessor
2007
 

Adjusted EBITDA

   $ 125.0      $ 212.9      $ 123.6        $ 144.6   

Restructuring

     (13.4     (4.8     (1.8       (22.4

Depreciation and amortization

     (147.7     (170.3     (61.3       (90.5

Receivable factoring charges

     (0.8     (0.7     (1.6       (1.7

Other adjustments

            (3.1     (3.4         

Interest expense, net

     (56.9     (60.2     (34.0       (65.5

Other income, net

     33.7                          

Chapter 11 and related reorganization items

                            (62.2
                                  

Net income / (loss) before provision for income taxes

   $ (60.1   $ (26.2   $ 21.5        $ (97.7
                                  

 

F-43


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The following is a summary of revenues and long-lived assets by geographic location (in thousands):

 

     Years Ended and End of Year December 31,
     2009    2008    2007
     Revenues     Long-Lived
Assets
   Revenues     Long-Lived
Assets
   Revenues(1)     Long-Lived
Assets

Belgium

   $ 161,821      $ 45,887    $ 214,589      $ 63,693    $ 229,849      $ 55,747

Italy

     158,483        56,722      182,030        61,825      206,058        71,008

Germany

     250,142        96,121      378,996        102,650      392,801        125,531

Slovakia

     75,980        59,698      119,727        47,341      112,453        39,389

Other Europe

     54,117        11,536      58,951        14,149      49,357        9,221

Asia

     337,765        120,759      370,892        113,931      418,908        143,124

US

     472,622        216,337      702,743        259,975      1,041,732        301,964

Brazil

     171,273        38,580      217,804        32,332      156,151        36,266

Intercompany eliminations

     (47,798          (74,027          (65,750    
                                            
   $ 1,634,405      $ 645,640    $ 2,171,705      $ 695,896    $ 2,541,559      $ 782,250
                                            

 

(1)   The 2007 revenues are shown on a consolidated full year basis as revenue was not impacted by purchase accounting.

Revenues are attributed to geographic locations based on the location of specific production. Long-lived assets consist of net property, plant and equipment and capitalized tooling.

The following is a summary of the approximate composition by product category of the Company’s revenues (in thousands):

 

     Years Ended December 31,
     2009    2008    2007(1)

Body structures and assemblies

   $ 920,990    $ 1,272,920    $ 1,519,325

Complex body-in-white assemblies

     282,582      372,230      332,594

Chassis, lower vehicle structures and suspension components

     402,882      492,482      672,278

Other

     27,951      34,073      17,362
                    

Total

   $ 1,634,405    $ 2,171,705    $ 2,541,559
                    

 

(1)   The 2007 revenues are shown on a consolidated full year basis as revenue was not impacted by purchase accounting.

The Company sells its products directly to automotive manufacturers. Following is a summary of customers that accounted for 10 percent or more of consolidated revenues in any of the three years ended December 31, 2009:

 

     2009     2008     2007(1)  

Volkswagen Group

   17   14   11

Ford Motor Company

   13   14   17

Fiat

   13   11   9

Hyundai/Kia

   10   11   12

Volvo

   10   10   9

 

(1)   The 2007 revenues are shown on a consolidated full year basis as revenue was not impacted by purchase accounting.

 

F-44


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

All customers that accounted for 10 percent or more of consolidated revenues from the table above are customers in the automotive industry; therefore, the Company is potentially subject to a concentration of credit risk.

Note 17. Commitments and Contingencies

Leases

The Company leases office and manufacturing space and certain equipment under non-cancelable lease agreements, which require the Company to pay maintenance, insurance, taxes and other expenses in addition to rental payments. The Company has entered into leasing commitments with lease terms expiring between the years 2010 and 2020. The Company has options to extend the terms of certain leases in future periods. The properties covered under these leases include manufacturing equipment and facilities and administrative offices and equipment. Rent expense for all operating leases totaled $24.1 million, $32.1 million, and $42.4 million in 2009, 2008, and 2007, respectively.

Future minimum capital and operating lease payments at December 31, 2009 are as follows (in thousands):

 

Year

   Operating Leases    Capital Leases  

2010

   $ 23,414    $ 2,927   

2011

     16,776      2,277   

2012

     13,510      2,061   

2013

     10,437      1,476   

2014

     10,936      1,908   

Thereafter

     50,537      11,621   
               

Total future operating lease payments

   $ 125,610      22,270   
         

Less: amount representing interest

        (4,918
           

Present value of minimum lease payments

      $ 17,352   
           

Purchase Commitments

As of December 31, 2009, the Company was obligated under executory purchase orders for approximately $51 million of tooling, $33.1 million of capital expenditures, and $8.7 million of other expenditures.

Change in Control Agreements

The Successor Company agreed to assume certain executive contracts, which among other items, contain change-in-control termination payments if the employee was terminated within a certain period of time after the acquisition. Of the total amount assumed, the Company has paid $16.8 million related to these agreements. As of December 31, 2009, no further obligations remained.

Value Creation Plan (VC Plan)

The Board continuously examines certain strategic alternatives designed to enhance the Company’s value to its Members. The VC Plan provides for special cash bonuses to be paid to approximately 70 executives if a Liquidation Event were to occur (as defined in Note 13). The Value Creation Plan is the amount potentially available for distribution to participants based on the “Net Value Gained” as a result of a Liquidation Event. Net

 

F-45


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Value Gained is defined as the cash proceeds and/or marketable or tangible securities delivered to the Members due to a Liquidation Event, adjusted by (a) adding the amount of any debt assumed by the purchaser, and (b) subtracting all repayments on Tower-related debt, all exit-related costs, the Member’s investment in Tower Automotive, LLC, and all costs of the payments to be made under this Plan, all as determined by the Manager in good faith.

The Value Creation Pool that is available for distribution to the Company’s executives due to a Liquidation Event will be equal to the following amount:

 

   

0% of Net Value Gained if Net Value Gained is less than $200 million.

 

   

3.75% of Net Value Gained if Net Value Gained is $200 million or more but is less than $1 billion.

 

   

4.0% of Net Value Gained if Net Value Gained is $1 billion or more but less than $1.2 billion.

 

   

4.2% of Net Value Gained if Net Value Gained is $1.2 billion or more.

Participants will be assigned a percentage of the pool for distribution. The special bonuses are based on the aggregate value of a future Liquidation Event, and accordingly cannot be determined at this time. Therefore, no liability is recorded in the Company’s financial statements as of December 31, 2009.

Environmental Matters

The Company owns properties which have been impacted by environmental releases. The Company is actively involved in investigation and/or remediation at several of these locations. Total costs and liabilities associated with environmental contamination could be substantial and may have an adverse impact on the Company’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.

Accruals for environmental matters are recorded when it is probable that a liability has been incurred and the amount of the liability can be reasonably estimated. The established liability for environmental matters is based upon management’s best estimates of expected investigation/remediation costs related to environmental contamination. It is possible that actual costs associated with these matters will exceed the environmental reserves established by the Company. Inherent uncertainties exist in the estimates, primarily due to unknown environmental conditions, changing governmental regulations and legal standards regarding liability and evolving technologies for handling site remediation and restoration. At December 31, 2009 and 2008, the Company had accrued approximately $1.8 million for environmental matters.

Contingent Matters

The Company will establish reserves for matters in which losses are probable and can be reasonably estimated. These types of matters may involve additional claims that if granted, could require the Company to pay penalties or make other expenditures in amounts that will not be estimable at the time of discovery of the matter. In these cases, a liability will be recorded at the low end of the range if no amount within the range is a better estimate in accordance with FASB ASC No. 450, Accounting for Contingencies .

As part of the original acquisition, the Company agreed to pay up to $70 million to the Post-Consummation Trust to relinquish certain defined liabilities to date. The Company has made $57.5 million of payments and remains contingently liable to pay an additional $12.5 million. At this time, the Company has not recorded a liability for the $12.5 million since it does not believe that it will be probable to make any additional payments to the trust; therefore, these amounts were eliminated as part of the final purchase accounting adjustments. To the extent that future payments are required, the payments will be expensed.

 

F-46


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Litigation

The Company is subject to various legal actions and claims incidental to its business. Litigation is subject to many uncertainties and the outcome of individual litigated matters is not predictable with assurance. After discussions with counsel litigating these matters, it is the opinion of management that the outcome of such matters will not have a material adverse impact on the Company’s financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

On February 2, 2005, the Predecessor Company filed a voluntary petition for relief under the Bankruptcy Code.

Following the above-referenced February 2, 2005 filing, certain claims were filed against certain then current and former officers and directors of the Predecessor Company, alleging various (1) violations of the federal securities laws (the “Securities Litigation”), and (2) breaches of fiduciary duties to participants in and beneficiaries of the Company’s various 401(k) retirement plans in connection with the availability of the common stock of Tower Automotive, Inc. as an investment option under the plans (the “ERISA Litigation”). A Stipulation of Settlement in the Securities Litigation was executed on February 10, 2009 and a Judgment approving the settlement was entered on May 28, 2009. Neither the Successor Company nor any of its current officers or directors was a party to this litigation. However, the Successor Company, as holder of certain historical records of the Predecessor Company, had provided ongoing support in the period for discovery of those documents and cooperation and assistance to the Post Consummation Trust on such litigation in accordance with the terms of the acquisition described in Note 2. The Predecessor Company and the parties to the ERISA Litigation reached an agreement to settle the ERISA Litigation, which settlement was approved by the Bankruptcy Court as part of the Plan of Reorganization.

On November 29, 2005, the Company’s joint venture partner in Metalsa, Groupo Proeza, S.A. de C.V. (“Proeza”) filed a lawsuit in Mexico against Tower Mexico, Metalsa and certain of Tower Mexico’s directors. Proeza’s lawsuit alleged certain breaches of Tower Mexico’s obligations under the governing documents of the joint venture and asserted certain rights in connection with an alleged change in control of Tower Mexico. As a result of these allegations, Proeza sought either the rescission of the joint venture relationship or the redemption of Tower Mexico’s investment in Metalsa.

In December 2007, the Successor Company agreed to sell its 40% interest in Metalsa to its joint venture partner, Proeza, for cash proceeds of $150 million. As part of this sale, both parties agreed to dismiss all of the above lawsuits and proceedings.

 

F-47


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Note 18. Change in Working Capital and Other Operating Items

The following table summarizes the sources (uses) of cash provided by changes in working capital and other operating items (in thousands):

 

     Successor         Predecessor  
     Year Ended
December 31,
2009
    Year Ended
December 31,
2008
    Five Months
Ended
December 31,
2007
        Seven Months
Ended July 31,
2007
 

Accounts receivable

   $ (114,754   $ 165,791      $ 40,266        $ (22,374

Inventories

     13,563        34,356        8,761          (8,562

Prepaid tooling and other current assets

     6,875        (4,844     6,045          894   

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities

     92,999        (137,288     (3,623       (29,475

Other assets and liabilities

     10,335        29,252        (5,104       33,045   
                                  

Change in working capital

   $ 9,018      $ 87,267      $ 46,345        $ (26,472
                                  

Note 19. Subsequent Events

On February 26, 2010, a foreign subsidiary of the Company signed a definitive agreement, subject to normal closing conditions, to purchase the assets of the manufacturing plant of TWB Fahrzeugtechnik GmbH & Co. KG i.L. located in Artern, Germany from an insolvency administrator. The aggregate purchase price of the assets will be approximately $19.2 (or €13.4) million consisting of the assumption of certain capital leases, cash payment to the administrator, and certain transaction costs. The transaction is expected to close during the first quarter of 2010.

 

F-48


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

(Amounts in thousands—unaudited)

 

     June 30,
2010
    December 31,
2009
 

ASSETS

    

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 149,620      $ 149,802   

Accounts receivable, (net of allowance of $1,731 and $2,439)

     310,341        290,098   

Inventories (Note 3)

     69,040        62,611   

Deferred tax asset—current

     3,540        4,762   

Assets held for sale (Note 4)

     9,523        6,008   

Prepaid tooling and other

     62,735        60,139   
                

Total current assets

     604,799        573,420   
                

Property, plant and equipment, net

     581,257        640,148   

Goodwill (Note 5)

     60,668        70,565   

Deferred tax asset—non-current

     15,045        15,009   

Other assets, net

     38,881        35,279   
                

Total assets

   $ 1,300,650      $ 1,334,421   
                

LIABILITIES AND MEMBERS’ DEFICIT

    

Current maturities of long-term debt and capital lease obligations (Note 7)

   $ 110,354      $ 137,499   

Current maturities of long-term debt with affiliate (Note 7)

     3,984        4,132   

Accounts payable

     335,939        333,773   

Accrued liabilities

     118,471        127,823   
                

Total current liabilities

     568,748        603,227   
                

Long-term debt, net of current maturities (Note 7)

     140,666        112,602   

Long-term debt with affiliate, net of current maturities (Note 7)

     383,465        399,776   

Obligations under capital leases, net of current maturities (Note 7)

     15,584        15,544   

Deferred tax liability—non-current

     12,708        13,917   

Pension liability

     76,083        78,730   

Other non-current liabilities

     80,214        86,869   
                

Total non-current liabilities

     708,720        707,438   
                

Total liabilities

     1,277,468        1,310,665   
                

Commitments and contingencies (Note 17)

    
                

Redeemable preferred units, 10,000 units authorized and outstanding (Note 11)

     179,467        170,915   
                

Members’ deficit:

    

Tower Automotive, LLC’s members’ deficit:

    

     Common units, 8,500 units authorized and outstanding (Note 12)

     12,858        12,595   

     Accumulated deficit

     (156,175     (144,955

     Accumulated other comprehensive loss

     (57,353     (54,363
                

Total Tower Automotive, LLC’s members’ deficit

     (200,670     (186,723
                

Noncontrolling interests in subsidiaries

     44,385        39,564   
                

Total members’ deficit

     (156,285     (147,159
                

Total liabilities and members’ deficit

   $ 1,300,650      $ 1,334,421   
                

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-49


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share amounts—unaudited)

 

     Six Months Ended June 30,  
             2010                     2009          

Revenues

   $ 980,811      $ 697,850   

Cost of sales

     872,048        681,883   
                

Gross profit

     108,763        15,967   

Selling, general and administrative expenses

     64,961        53,261   

Amortization expense (Note 5)

     1,541        1,313   

Restructuring and asset impairment charges, net (Note 6)

     4,686        (1,146
                

Operating income / (loss)

     37,575        (37,461

Interest expense

     27,825        27,815   

Interest income

     569        571   

Other (income)/loss, net (Note 7)

     —          (32,449
                

Income/(loss) before provision for income taxes

    
10,319
  
    (32,256

Provision / (benefit) for income taxes (Note 8)

     8,362        2,796   
                

Net income/(loss)

     1,957        (35,052

Less: Net income attributable to the noncontrolling interests

     4,528        3,983   
                

Net income/(loss) attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC

   $ (2,571   $ (39,035
                

Less: Preferred unit dividends

   $ (8,649   $ (7,851
                

Income/(loss) available to common unit holders

   $ (11,220   $ (46,886
                

Weighted average basic and diluted units outstanding

     8,500        8,500   

Basic and diluted income/(loss) per unit attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC:

    

Income/(loss) per unit

   $ (1,320   $ (5,516

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-50


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

(Amounts in thousands—unaudited)

 

     Six months ended June 30,  
             2010                     2009          

OPERATING ACTIVITIES:

    

Net income/(loss)

   $ 1,957      $ (35,052

Adjustments required to reconcile net income/(loss) to net cash provided by/(used in) operating activities:

    

Depreciation and amortization

     58,706        79,439   

Gain from debt repurchase/letter of credit reduction

     —          (32,449

Pension expense, net of contributions

     (2,646     (1,003

Amortization of pension loss

     798        1,086   

Change in working capital and other operating items

     (31,745     (28,595
                

Net cash provided by/(used in) operating activities

   $ 27,070      $ (16,574
                

INVESTING ACTIVITIES:

    

Cash disbursed for purchases of property, plant and equipment

   $ (40,096   $ (45,618

Net assets acquired, net of cash acquired

     (16,687     —     
                

Net cash used in investing activities

   $ (56,783   $ (45,618
                

FINANCING ACTIVITIES:

    

Proceeds from letter of credit reduction

   $ —        $ 12,000   

Repayments of term debt

     (2,340     (13,974

Preferred unit dividends

     (95     (388

Noncontrolling interest dividends

     —          (1,980

Proceeds from borrowings

     276,357        256,106   

Repayments of borrowings

     (237,612     (182,002

Financing costs

     —          (1,451
                

Net cash provided by financing activities

   $ 36,310      $ 68,311   
                

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

   $ (6,779   $ 2,464   
                

NET CHANGE IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS

   $ (182   $ 8,583   
                

CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS:

    

Beginning of period

   $ 149,802      $ 126,820   
                

End of period

   $ 149,620      $ 135,403   
                

Supplemental Cash Flow Information:

    

Interest paid, net of amounts capitalized

   $ 26,008      $ 25,670   

Income taxes paid

     4,583        6,108   

Non-cash Activities:

    

Capital expenditures in liabilities for purchases of property, plant and equipment

   $ 16,291      $ 12,632   

Cumulative preferred stock units accrued

     8,554        7,463   

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-51


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(UNAUDITED)

Note 1. Basis of Presentation

The accompanying Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements have been prepared by Tower Automotive, LLC (the “Company” or the “Successor Company”), without audit, pursuant to the rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”). The information furnished in the Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements includes normal recurring adjustments and reflects all adjustments, which are, in the opinion of management, necessary for a fair presentation of such financial statements. Certain information and disclosures normally included in financial statements prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (“U.S. GAAP”) have been condensed or omitted pursuant to the rules and regulations of the SEC. Although the Company believes that the disclosures are adequate to make the information presented not misleading, these Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements should be read in conjunction with the audited year end financial statements and the notes thereto included elsewhere herein. The interim results for the periods presented are not indicative of the Company’s actual annual results.

Changes in Accounting Principles

Variable Interest Entities

In January 2010, the Company adopted amendments to ASC 810-10, “Consolidation” (ASC 810-10). These amendments require an enterprise to qualitatively assess the determination of the primary beneficiary of a variable interest entity (a “VIE”) based on whether the enterprise: (i) has the power to direct the activities of a VIE that most significantly affect the entity’s economic performance; and (ii) has the obligation to absorb losses of the entity or the right to receive benefits from the entity that could potentially be significant to the VIE. These amendments also require, among other considerations, an ongoing reconsideration of the primary beneficiary. The adoption of this standard did not have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements.

Financial accounting standards board, or FASB, accounting standards update, or ASU, 2010-06 “fair value measurements and disclosures (Topic 820): improving disclosures about fair value measurements,” or ASU 2010-06

In January 2010, the FASB issued ASU 2010-06 which amended the Accounting Standards Codification, or ASC, Topic 820-10 “Fair Value Measurement and Disclosures-Overall.” ASU 2010-06 requires new disclosures regarding transfers in and out of asset and liabilities measured at fair value classified within the valuation hierarchy as either Level 1 or Level 2 and information about sales, issuances and settlements on a gross basis for assets and liabilities classified as Level 3. ASU 2010-06 clarifies existing disclosures on the level of disaggregation required and inputs and valuation techniques. The provisions of ASU 2010-06 became effective for the Company on January 1, 2010, except for disclosure of information about sales, issuances and settlements on a gross basis for assets and liabilities classified as Level 3, which is effective for the Company on January 1, 2011. The provisions of ASU 2010-06 impact disclosures only and the Company has disclosed information in accordance with the revised provisions of ASU 2010-06 within this filing.

Note 2. New Accounting Pronouncements Not Yet Adopted

As of June 30, 2010, the Company has adopted all new accounting pronouncements affecting the Company.

 

F-52


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(UNAUDITED)

 

Note 3. Inventories

Inventories are stated at the lower of cost or market. Cost is determined by the first-in, first-out (“FIFO”) method. In addition, the Company uses a valuation account for inventory obsolescence, which has not been material for any periods presented. Maintenance, repair and non-productive inventory, which are considered consumables, are expensed when acquired in cost of sales. Inventories consist of the following (in thousands):

 

     June 30,
2010
   December 31,
2009

Raw materials

   $ 26,616    $ 21,911

Work in process

     21,114      20,841

Finished goods

     21,310      19,859
             

Total Inventory

   $ 69,040    $ 62,611
             

Note 4. Assets Held for Sale

The Company has four locations that are considered held for sale in accordance with FASB ASC No. 360, “ Property, Plant, and Equipment.” The four locations are Gunpo, South Korea; Traverse City, Michigan; Bergisch Gladbach, Germany; and Milwaukee, Wisconsin. The Company’s management has demonstrated intent to sell these locations by listing the properties with local real estate agencies at prices deemed reasonable in comparison to their respective fair values; thus, the Company expects to sell these locations within one year. Accordingly, the Company has recorded these locations at fair value, ceased depreciation on them, and classified them as held for sale. The following table summarizes assets held for sale by category (in thousands):

 

    June 30,
2010
  December 31,
2009

Land

  $ 6,461   $ 2,868

Building

    3,062     3,140
           

Total

  $ 9,523   $ 6,008
           

Note 5. Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets

Goodwill

The change in the carrying amount of goodwill is set forth below on a reportable segment and consolidated basis (in thousands):

 

     International     Americas     Consolidated  

Balance at December 31, 2009

   $ 67,079      $ 3,486      $ 70,565   

Currency translation adjustment

     (9,779     (118     (9,897
                        

Balance at June 30, 2010

   $ 57,300      $ 3,368      $ 60,668   
                        

Intangibles

The Company has certain intangible assets that are related to customer relationships and contracts in Europe and Brazil. These intangible assets have definite lives and are amortized on a straight-line basis, which approximates the recognition of related revenue, over the estimated lives of the related assets. The intangible assets are recorded in other non-current assets. The Company anticipates amortization expense of $3.4 million for each of the next three years and $2.7 million for the subsequent one and a half years. The Company incurred

 

F-53


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(UNAUDITED)

 

amortization expense of $1.5 million and $1.3 million, respectively, during the six months ended June 30, 2010 and 2009. The following table presents information about the intangible assets of the Company at June 30, 2010 and December 31, 2009, respectively (in thousands):

 

    Weighted
Average
Life
  As of June 30, 2010   As of December 31, 2009
    Gross
Carrying
Amount
  Accumulated
Amortization
  Gross
Carrying
Amount
   Accumulated
Amortization

Amortized intangible:

          

Europe

  6 years   $ 15,184   $ 6,235   $ 14,664    $ 5,074

Brazil

  7 years     5,659     2,321     5,790      1,911
                          

Total

    $ 20,843   $ 8,556   $ 20,454    $ 6,985
                          

Note 6. Restructuring and Asset Impairment Charges

The Company has executed various restructuring plans and may execute additional plans in the future to realign manufacturing capacity to prevailing global automotive production and to improve the utilization of remaining facilities. Estimates of restructuring charges are based on information available at the time such charges are recorded. Due to the inherent uncertainty involved in estimating restructuring expenses, actual amounts paid for such activities may differ from amounts initially recorded. Accordingly, the Company may record revisions of previous estimates by adjusting previously established reserves.

Restructuring Charges

Restructuring charges and asset impairments include the following (in thousands):

 

     Six Months
Ended June 30,
2010
   Six Months
Ended June 30,
2009
 

International

   $ 2,867    $ 2,007   

Americas

     1,819      (3,153
               

Total

   $ 4,686    $ (1,146
               

The following table sets forth the Company’s net restructuring expense by type for the periods presented (in thousands):

 

     Six Months
Ended June 30,
 
         2010            2009      

Employee termination costs

   $ 219    $ 2,603   

Other exit costs

     1,768      3,161   

Asset impairments

     2,699      —     

Restructuring income

     —        (6,910
               

Total

   $ 4,686    $ (1,146
               

 

F-54


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(UNAUDITED)

 

The charges incurred during 2010 and 2009 primarily related to the following actions:

2010 Actions

During the first quarter of 2010, the Company classified its Bergisch Gladbach facility as held for sale (See Note 4) which resulted in an impairment charge of $2.7 million to align the book value with the estimated fair value. The additional charges incurred in 2010 in both the International and Americas segments related to other severance costs and ongoing maintenance of facilities closed as a result of prior actions.

2009 Actions

During the six months ended June 30, 2009, the Company incurred restructuring expense of $5.8 million, which was offset by $6.9 million of restructuring income. The charges incurred during the first six months of 2009 in both the International and Americas segments related to severance costs and ongoing maintenance of facilities closed as a result of prior actions. The restructuring income was related to recoveries for the cancellation of an old customer program relating to the Company’s closed facility in Milwaukee, Wisconsin. This income was recorded in the Americas segment. As of June 30, 2009, all recoveries had been received.

Restructuring Reserve

The table below summarizes the activity in the accrual, reflected in accrued liabilities, for the above-mentioned actions through June 30, 2010 (in thousands):

 

     International     Americas     Consolidated  

Balance at December 31, 2008

   $ 2,355      $ 4,876      $ 7,231   

Payments

     (3,458     (3,755     (7,213

Increase in liability

     9,290        323        9,613   

Adjustment to liability

     —          117        117   
                        

Balance at December 31, 2009

     8,187        1,561        9,748   
                        

Payments

     (7,008     (746     (7,754

Increase in liability

     84        1,219        1,303   

Adjustment to liability

     —          (653     (653
                        

Balance at June 30, 2010

   $ 1,263      $ 1,381      $ 2,644   
                        

Except as disclosed in the table above, the Company does not anticipate incurring additional material cash charges associated with the actions described above. The increase in the liability above differs from the restructuring charges in the table above as certain items are expensed as incurred.

The liability decreased during 2010 primarily due to severance payments made relating to the Bergisch closure. Of the $2.6 million restructuring reserve accrued as of June 30, 2010, the majority is expected to be paid in 2010. The liability increased during 2009 primarily due to restructuring actions taken in the Company’s International operations.

During the six months ended June 30, 2010 the Company incurred severance payments related to prior accruals in Europe of $7 million and in North America of $0.7 million. During the year ended December 31, 2009 the Company incurred severance payments related to prior accruals in Europe of $2.4 million, Asia of $1 million, North America of $3.1 million, and Brazil of $0.7 million.

 

F-55


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(UNAUDITED)

 

In July 2009 in the International segment, the Company announced the closure of its press shop in Bergisch Gladbach, Germany and colleagues ceased employment with the Company in October 2009. Total estimated costs of the closure of this facility were $10.2 million which was comprised of $9.1 million of severance costs and $1.1 million of other exit costs. The Company recorded the entire charges of $10.2 million during 2009.

Note 7. Debt

First Lien Term Loan

As of June 30, 2010, the outstanding principal balance on the U.S. Dollar and Euro tranches was $203.3 million and $226.7 million (or €185.3 million), respectively. The interest rates in effect as of June 30, 2010 were 4.79% and 4.84% on the U.S. Dollar and Euro tranches, respectively. The effective rates on the U.S. Dollar and Euro tranches increase to 8.85% and 6.96%, respectively, when taking into account the impact of interest rate swaps (discussed in detail under “Interest Rate Swaps” below). Both tranches mature in July 2013. As of June 30, 2010, an affiliate of the preferred unit holder owns approximately 90% of the first lien term loan.

The first lien term loan is secured by (i) a first-priority lien on 65% of any voting and 100% of any non-voting equity interests held in any foreign subsidiary by the US borrower and the guarantors; (ii) a first-priority lien on all other tangible and intangible assets of the U.S. borrower and the guarantors; (iii) a first-priority lien on all accounts receivable, inventory, cash, investments, property, plant and equipment of the European borrower and the guarantors; and (iv) a second-priority lien on all accounts receivable, inventory, cash, investments, property, plant and equipment of the US borrower and the guarantors. The first lien term loan is guaranteed by the Company, by certain intermediate holding companies, by the Company’s direct and indirect domestic subsidiaries and by certain of the Company’s foreign subsidiaries.

Revolving Credit Facility

Advances under the revolving credit facility bear interest at a base rate plus a margin or LIBOR plus a margin. The applicable margins are determined by the average availability under the revolving credit facility over the preceding three months. The applicable margins as of June 30, 2010 were 0.75% and 1.75% for base rate and LIBOR based borrowings, respectively. As of June 30, 2010 there was $110.3 million of borrowing availability under the revolving credit facility of which $53.5 million of borrowings and no letters of credit were outstanding. The facility matures July 2012.

The revolving credit facility is secured by (i) a first-priority lien on all accounts receivable, inventory, cash, investments and property, plant and equipment of the U.S. Borrower and guarantors; (ii) a second-priority pledge of 65% of any voting and 100% of any non-voting equity interests held in any foreign subsidiary by the U.S. Borrower and guarantors; and (iii) a second-priority lien on all other tangible and intangible assets of the U.S. Borrower and guarantors.

Letter of Credit Facility

The letter of credit facility, which is part of the first lien term loan agreement, is fully cash collateralized by third parties for purposes of replacing or backstopping letters of credit outstanding at the time of the original acquisition by the Company of the assets of its predecessor. The cash collateral was deposited by such third parties in a deposit account, and the Company has no right, title or interest in the deposit account. As of June 30, 2010, the outstanding letters of credit under the letter of credit facility were $23.1 million. The facility matures in July 2013. Applicable fees are 0.25% of the aggregate letters of credit outstanding for commissions. The $27.5 million letter of credit facility has 4.25% facility commitment fees and a facility deposit fee of 0.15%.

 

F-56


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(UNAUDITED)

 

As of June 30, 2010, the weighted average interest rate of the Company’s credit facilities (first lien term loan and revolving credit facility) was 4.57%. The weighted average interest rate of such credit facilities increase to 7.26% when taking into account the impact of the interest rate swaps (discussed in detail under “Interest Rate Swaps” below). The Company incurred interest expense related to the amortization of debt issue costs of $1.1 million and $2.1 million, respectively, during the six months ended June 30, 2010 and 2009.

2009 Amendment

During the first quarter of 2009, the Company reached an agreement to amend certain terms of its revolving credit facility, first lien term loan agreement, and letter of credit facility. As part of the amendment, the Company agreed to reduce the $200 million revolving credit facility to $150 million.

The amendment also allowed the Company to redeem a portion of its letter of credit facility for cash. On April 8, 2009, the Company received cash proceeds of $12 million, in exchange for a $30 million reduction of the letter of credit facility from $60 million to $30 million. A gain of $11.5 million, net of fees, was recognized as other income as a result of this transaction. In addition, the Company had the ability to redeem up to an additional $10 million of the letter of credit facility by the end of the third quarter of 2009. On September 30, 2009, the Company received cash proceeds of $1.2 million, in exchange for a $2.5 million reduction of the letter of credit facility to decrease the facility from $30 million to $27.5 million. A gain of $1.2 million, net of fees, was recognized as other income as a result of this transaction.

Also pursuant to the amendment, the Company was required to use the proceeds from the first letter of credit reduction to repurchase a portion of the U.S. tranche of the first lien term loan. The amendment provides the Company with an eighteen-month window to repurchase the first lien term loans up to an aggregate of $50 million in cash. On May 1, 2009, the Company agreed to a tender offer to repurchase $32.9 million of the first lien term loan using the net proceeds from the letter of credit facility reduction. On May 6, 2009, the Company executed the agreement by transferring $11.5 million to complete the transaction, which resulted in a net gain of $20.9 million after fees, recognized as other income.

Interest Rate Swaps

The Company was required by its credit agreements to enter into two interest rate swap agreements during the third quarter of 2007 with notional principal amounts of $182.5 million and €100 million. These derivative agreements effectively fix interest rates at 5.06% and 4.62%, respectively, on a portion of floating debt and qualify for cash flow hedge accounting treatment under FASB ASC 815, Derivatives and Hedging . The swaps were designated as hedging instruments to offset the changes in cash flows resulting from changes in interest rates on this variable rate debt through August 31, 2010. Under FASB ASC No. 815, each swap is recorded as a cash flow hedge in which the fair value is recorded as an asset or liability and the changes in the fair value are recorded as a component of other comprehensive income. Periodic measurement of hedge effectiveness is performed quarterly. Any changes in the effective portion of these derivatives are recorded as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss), a component of members’ deficit, while any ineffective portion will be recorded in earnings and reflected in the consolidated statement of income as part of interest expense.

During the first six months of 2010, a pre-tax gain of $7.2 million was recorded in other comprehensive income relating to the two cash flow hedges. As of June 30, 2010, no ineffective portion exists and the fair values of these derivatives are recorded as a liability of $3.4 million within accrued liabilities on the Company’s Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheet in accrued liabilities. The fair value of our interest rate swaps was determined based on third-party valuation models. The swaps remain outstanding and designated as effective hedges as of June 30, 2010. Amounts transferred from accumulated other comprehensive income to net income/

 

F-57


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(UNAUDITED)

 

(loss) for the periods presented were not significant. The swaps will settle in 2010; therefore, the amount currently recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss) of $5.4 million will be reclassified to net income/(loss) in 2010.

Other Foreign Subsidiary Indebtedness

As of June 30, 2010, other foreign subsidiary indebtedness of $152.1 million consists primarily of borrowings in South Korea of $111.7 million, receivable factoring in Europe of $27.4 million, and borrowings in Brazil of $13 million.

Generally, borrowings of foreign subsidiaries are made under credit agreements with commercial lenders and are used to fund working capital and other operating requirements.

South Korea

The Company has borrowings in South Korea of $111.7 million, consisting of secured indebtedness of $39.7 million, secured bonds of $31.2 million, unsecured indebtedness of $20.4 million, and unsecured corporate bonds of $20.4 million issued in connection with a government sponsored collateralized bond program, which have interest rates ranging from 4.23% to 9.96% and maturity dates ranging from July 2010 to April 2012. The majority of these borrowings are subject to annual renewal. Substantially all of the assets of the Company’s South Korean subsidiary serve as collateral for the secured bonds and the other secured indebtedness.

During the first quarter of 2010, the Company renewed $13.5 million of maturing secured indebtedness for an additional year. There were no material changes to the terms of the loans except the average annual interest rate was reduced from 7.1% to 6.3%.

During the second quarter of 2010, the Company renewed $20.4 million of maturing secured bonds for an additional two years. The Company also renewed three additional facilities with aggregate indebtedness of $7.8 million for an additional year. There were no material changes to the terms of the loans except for the extension of the maturities. In addition, the Company obtained a new $4.1 million unsecured bond from the South Korean Government. The bond has a three year maturity with an interest rate of 8.32%.

Brazil

The Company has borrowings in Brazil of $13 million (R$ 23.4 million) which have interest rates ranging from 12.68% to 14.57% with maturity dates ranging from July 2010 to May 2011. This credit is provided through bilateral agreements with three local banks. Periodic interest and principal payments are required. All loans have a duration of one year or less and are secured by certain fixed and current assets.

During the first quarter of 2010, two of the local banks provided the Company with a combined $8 million (R$ 14.5 million) of new one-year term loans that refinance previous principal payments made on the existing term loan portfolio. The terms of the new loans are substantially the same as the other portfolio loans except for a reduction in interest rates from the portfolio average of 13.8% to 13.2% for the new loans.

During the second quarter of 2010, one of the local banks provided the Company with a $3 million (R$ 5.3 million) new one-year term loan. The terms of the new loan are substantially the same as the other portfolio loans.

Italy

As of June 30, 2010, the receivable factoring facilities available to the Company are $33.5 million (€27.4 million), of which $27.4 million (€22.4 million) is outstanding. These are uncommitted, demand facilities which

 

F-58


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(UNAUDITED)

 

are subject to termination at the discretion of the banks, and bear interest rates based on the average three month EURIBOR plus a spread ranging from 1.45% to 2.00%. The effective rates as of June 30, 2010 ranged from 2.18% to 2.73% per annum. Any receivable factoring under these facilities is with recourse, and is secured by the accounts receivable factored. These receivable factoring transactions are recorded in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheet in current maturities of long term debt.

Capital Leases

The Company had capital lease obligations of $18.5 million and $17.6 million as of June 30, 2010 and December 31, 2009, respectively, which expire between April 2011 and March 2018.

As of June 30, 2010, the Company believes that it is in full compliance with the financial covenants that govern its credit agreements.

Note 8. Income Taxes

During the six months ended June 30, 2010, the Company recognized income tax expense of $8.4 million, in relation to income before provision for income taxes of $10.3 million. This income tax expense resulted primarily from the recognition of foreign income taxes, withholding taxes, and certain state taxes. Full valuation allowances were provided for tax benefits generated during the 2010 period on losses incurred in the U.S. and various foreign locations, including South Korea.

During the six months ended June 30, 2009, the Company recognized income tax expense of $2.8 million in relation to a loss before provision for income taxes of $32.3 million. This income tax expense resulted primarily from the recognition of foreign income taxes and state taxes. Full valuation allowances were provided for various foreign locations, including South Korea, and U.S. Federal income tax benefits generated during the 2009 period.

Note 9. Retirement Plans

The Company sponsors various pension and other postretirement benefit plans for its employees.

In accordance with FASB ASC 805, “Business Combinations,” on August 1, 2007, the Company recorded a liability for the total projected benefit obligation in excess of plan assets for the pension plans and a liability for the total accumulated postretirement benefit obligation in excess of the fair value of plan assets for other postretirement benefit plans and for postretirement benefit settlement agreements, which were approved by the Bankruptcy Court and assumed by the Successor Company. The following table provides the components of net periodic pension benefit cost and other post-retirement benefit cost (in thousands):

 

     Pension Benefits     Other Benefits
     Six Months
Ended

June 30,
    Six Months
Ended

June 30,
     2010     2009     2010    2009

Service cost

   $ 16      $ 16      $ —      $ —  

Interest cost

     6,714        7,262        504      518

Expected return on plan assets

     (5,318     (5,052     —        —  

Amortization of prior service cost

     —          —          —        —  

Amortization of net losses

     798        1,086        —        —  

Curtailment loss

     —          —          —        —  
                             

Net periodic benefit cost

   $ 2,210      $ 3,312      $ 504    $ 518
                             

 

F-59


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(UNAUDITED)

 

The Company expects its minimum pension funding requirements to be $9.7 million during 2010 of which the Company made contributions of $4.1 million during the six months ended June 30, 2010. Effective October 1, 2006, the plan was frozen and ceased accruing any additional benefits. Contributions by the Company are intended to fund benefits that accrued through October 1, 2006.

The Company contributed $1.6 million during the six months ended June 30, 2010 to its defined contribution employee savings plans.

As part of the Company’s reorganization in 2007, future post-retirement benefit payments were capped at specified amounts to be paid through 2011. During the six months ended June 30, 2010, the Company made contributions of $0.6 million to VEBA trusts.

 

Note 10. Members’ Deficit and Noncontrolling Interests

The table below provides a reconciliation of the carrying amount of total members’ deficit, including members’ deficit attributable to Tower Automotive, LLC, and equity attributable to the noncontrolling interests (“NCI”) (in thousands):

 

     Six Months Ended June 30,  
     2010     2009  
     Tower     NCI    Total     Tower     NCI     Total  

Members’ deficit beginning balance

   $ (186,723   $ 39,564    $ (147,159   $ (124,070   $ 35,545      $ (88,525

Net income

     (2,571     4,528      1,957        (39,035     3,983        (35,052

Other comprehensive income/(loss):

             

Change in cumulative translation adjustment

     (10,961     293      (10,668     2,897        (38     2,859   

Amortization of actuarial loss

     798           798        1,086          1,086   

Unrealized gain/(loss) on qualifying cash flow hedge

     7,173           7,173        1,116          1,116   
                                               

Total comprehensive income/(loss)

     (5,561     4,821      (740     (33,936     3,945        (29,991

Preferred unit dividends paid

     (95     —        (95     (388       (388

Cumulative preferred units accrued

     (8,554     —        (8,554     (7,463     —          (7,463

Noncontrolling interest dividends

              (1,980     (1,980

Compensation expense

     263           263        154          154   
                                               

Members’ deficit ending balance

   $ (200,670   $ 44,385    $ (156,285   $ (165,703   $ 37,510      $ (128,193
                                               

The following table presents the components of accumulated other comprehensive income (“AOCI”) (in thousands):

 

     As of
June 30,
2010
    As of
December 31,
2009
 

Foreign currency translation adjustment

   $ 10,250      $ 21,211   

Defined benefit plans, net

     (62,225     (63,023

Unrealized gain/(loss) on qualifying cash flow hedge

     (5,378     (12,551
                

Accumulated other comprehensive income

   $ (57,353   $ (54,363
                

 

F-60


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(UNAUDITED)

 

Note 11. Redeemable Preferred Units

The Company has outstanding 10,000 units of Membership Interest (designated as “Redeemable Preferred Units”) at June 30, 2010 and December 31, 2009. This is the total number of units authorized, issued, and outstanding. Cerberus Capital Management, L.P. owned and/or affiliated entities (“Members”) made initial capital contributions for all of the Redeemable Preferred Units in the amount of $213.8 million in July 2007. Redeemable Preferred Units are entitled to all of the rights of ownership, including a profits interest and a distribution preference, but have no conversion rights. Redeemable Preferred Units are non-voting, unless required by the Limited Liability Act of the State of Delaware. In accordance with FASB ASC No. 480, Distinguishing Liabilities from Equity , the Redeemable Preferred Units have been recorded as mezzanine equity at their issuance price, as they are redeemable at the option of the holder, based on the Members control of the Board of the Company. The initial carrying amount of redeemable preferred stock was its fair value, which was equal to the redemption value at date of issue.

The redemption value of the Redeemable Preferred Units is an amount that is equal to the holder’s initial capital contribution less all distributions previously made to such Redeemable Preferred Unit Holders (the “Unpaid Preference Amount”) plus an amount accruing at the rate of 10% per quarter on the holder’s Unpaid Preference Amount (the “Preferred Return Amount”). Therefore, if distributions are not made with respect to any fiscal year, the Redeemable Preferred Unit holders’ distributions will be cumulative. These units are recorded at redemption value at each balance sheet date and the Preferred Return Amount is recorded as an adjustment to retained earnings. During the six months ended June 30, 2010 and 2009, the Company paid distributions of $0.1 million and $0.4 million, respectively.

 

Note 12. Members’ Equity / (Deficit) and Share Based Compensation

Members’ Equity

The membership interests in the Company are represented by issued and outstanding “Units” divided into series consisting of “Preferred Units,” “Common Units” and “MIP Units”.

Common Units

The Company has authorized, issued, and outstanding 8,500 units of membership interest (designated as “Common Units”). Cerberus owned and/or affiliated entities made initial capital contributions for all of the Common Units, for total cash proceeds of $11.3 million. The Common Units are entitled to all of the rights of ownership, including voting rights.

MIP Units/Share Based Compensation

The Company authorized 1,500 units of Membership Interest (designated as “MIP Units”) to be eligible for grants in connection with the Company’s Management Incentive Plan (“MIP”). The Board approved MIP is designed to promote the long-term success of the Company through share-based compensation by aligning the interests of participants with those of its members. The Company’s management determined vesting at the date of grant and assigned the original units with both service and performance conditions. Effective February 19, 2010, the Board removed the performance conditions from the MIP Units, which resulted in only a service condition remaining to each unit. The modification resulted in no incremental compensation cost as the fair value of the awards did not change based on the modified terms.

Under the fair value recognition provisions, share-based compensation cost is measured at the grant date based on the fair value of the award and is recognized as expense over the applicable vesting period of the award.

 

F-61


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(UNAUDITED)

 

The fair value of each MIP was based on the fair value of the common units on the date of grant. The compensation cost for the MIP Plan was insignificant for the periods ended June 30, 2010 and 2009, respectively, with no income tax benefit due to the valuation allowance in the United States recognized during 2010 and 2009.

MIP Units are entitled to all of the rights of ownership but are not entitled to vote, unless required by the Limited Liability Act of the State of Delaware. In addition, MIP Units are entitled to share in the residual value of the Company based on the liquidation preferences described below. At June 30, 2010, MIP units outstanding were 1,465, of which 732.5 were vested.

Any additional Membership Interests must be approved by the Board of Managers of the Company. There is no established trading market for the Company’s Common, Preferred or MIP Units.

Membership Interest Distributions

Each fiscal year, the Company may make certain distributions to its Members, absent a Liquidation Event (as defined below), and after all amounts are paid by the Company for such fiscal year for ordinary and necessary business expenses, employee salaries and benefits, and payments of principal and interest on any Company indebtedness, in accordance with the following order of priority. First, to the Members, a tax distribution amount which is intended to enable the Members to use such distributions to satisfy their estimated and final income tax liabilities for that fiscal year. Second, to the Preferred Unit holders, an amount that is equal to the Unpaid Preference Amount plus an amount for the Preferred Return Amount. If distributions are not made with respect to any fiscal year, the Preferred Unit holder’s distributions will be cumulative. Upon payment of the full Preferred Return Amount to the holders of Preferred Units, amounts may be distributed to holders of Common Units and MIP Units.

In the event of (i) a liquidation, dissolution, or winding up of the Company; (ii) a sale of all or substantially all of the assets of the Company to an unrelated third party; (iii) a merger, acquisition, or sale of Membership Interests, in which Members immediately prior to such event have received consideration for no less than half of the value of their Membership Interests; or (iv) a recapitalization, reorganization, reclassification, or other similar transaction in which the Company receives proceeds from a financing for the purpose of distributing such proceeds to the Members and the consummation of which the Board determines is a liquidation event (each a “Liquidation Event”), the Board is required to make distributions in the following order of priority. First, payment of all debts and liabilities owing to creditors including, if applicable, Members in their capacity as creditors and the expenses of dissolution or liquidation; second, establishment of such reserves as are deemed necessary by the Board for any contingent or unforeseen liabilities of the Company; third, to the holders of Preferred Units, in proportion to their respective Unpaid Preference Amounts, until each such holder of Preferred Units has received its Unpaid Preference Amount; and thereafter, to the holders of Common Units and MIP Units.

Note 13. Earnings per Unit/Share

As discussed in Note 12, MIP Units share in the undistributed earnings with the Common Units. These MIP Units are classified as participating securities as defined by FASB ASC 260 , “Earnings per Share.”  Therefore, the Company uses the two-class method for calculating EPS. For the six months ended June 30, 2010 and 2009, undistributed losses of the Company are not allocated to the participating securities as the MIP Unit holders do not have a contractual obligation to share in the losses.

Due to net losses available to Common Unit holders for the six months ended June 30, 2010 and 2009, the MIP Units had an anti-dilutive effect and therefore were excluded from the computation of diluted loss per share. The number of MIP Units not included in the computation of diluted loss per share was 1,465 for 2010 and 2009.

 

F-62


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(UNAUDITED)

 

Note 14. Segment Information

The Company defines its operating segments as components of its business where separate financial information is available and is routinely evaluated by management. The Company’s chief operating decision maker (CODM) is the Chief Executive Officer.

The Company produces engineered structural metal components and assemblies primarily serving the global automotive industry. The Company’s operations have similar economic characteristics, and share fundamental characteristics including the nature of the products, production processes, customers, and distribution channels. The Company’s products include body structure stampings, chassis structures (including frames), and complex welded assemblies for small and large cars, crossovers, pickups and SUVs. The Company is comprised of four operating segments: Europe, Asia, North America, and South America. These operating segments are aggregated into two reportable segments. The International segment consists of Europe and Asia while the Americas segment consists of North and South America.

The Company measures segment operating performance based on Adjusted EBITDA. The Company uses segment Adjusted EBITDA as the basis for the CODM to evaluate the performance of each of the Company’s reportable segments.

The following is a summary of selected data for each of the Company’s segments (in thousands):

 

     International    Americas     Total

Six months ended June 30, 2010

       

Revenues

   $ 558,583    $ 422,228      $ 980,811

Adjusted EBITDA

     65,500      36,925        102,425

Capital expenditures

     13,601      19,631        33,232

Total assets

   $ 819,191    $ 481,459      $ 1,300,650

Six months ended June 30, 2009

       

Revenues

   $ 438,220    $ 259,630      $ 697,850

Adjusted EBITDA

     45,996      (4,950     41,046

Capital expenditures

     20,570      6,376        26,946

Total assets

   $ 868,529    $ 429,701      $ 1,298,230

Inter-segment sales are not significant for any period presented. Capital expenditures do not equal cash disbursed for purchases of property, plant, and equipment as presented in the accompanying consolidated statements of cash flows, as capital expenditures above include amounts paid and accrued during the periods presented.

The following is a reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to net income/(loss) before provision for income taxes (in thousands):

 

     Six Months Ended June 30,  
             2010                     2009          

Adjusted EBITDA

   $ 102,425      $ 41,046   

Restructuring

     (4,686     1,146   

Depreciation and amortization

     (58,706     (79,439

Receivable factoring charges

     (272     (214

Acquisition costs

     (679     —     

Compensation pursuant to the special incentive program

     (507     —     

Interest expense, net

     (27,256     (27,244

Other income, net

     —          32,449   
                

Net income/(loss) before provision for income taxes

   $ 10,319      $ (32,256
                

 

F-63


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(UNAUDITED)

 

Note 15. Fair Value of Financial Instruments

Fair value is generally determined based on quoted market prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities. If quoted market prices are not available, the Company uses valuation techniques that place greater reliance on observable inputs and less reliance on unobservable inputs. In measuring fair value, the Company may make adjustments for risks and uncertainties, if a market participant would include such an adjustment in its pricing.

FASB ASC No. 820, “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures,” establishes a fair value hierarchy that distinguishes between assumptions based on market data, referred to as observable inputs, and the Company’s assumptions, referred to as unobservable inputs. Determining where an asset or liability falls within that hierarchy depends on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement as a whole. An adjustment to the pricing method used within either level 1 or level 2 inputs could generate a fair value measurement that effectively falls in a lower level in the hierarchy. The hierarchy consists of three broad levels as follows:

 

  Level   1: Quoted market prices in active markets for identical assets and liabilities;

 

  Level   2: Inputs other than level 1 inputs that are either directly or indirectly observable; and

 

  Level 3: Unobservable inputs developed using internal estimates and assumptions, which reflect those that market participants would use.

The Company has the following assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis during the period (in thousands):

 

          Fair value at reporting date using
     Six
months
ended
June 30,
2010
   Quoted
prices in
active markets
for identical
assets

(level 1)
   Significant
other
observable
inputs
(level 2)
   Significant
unobservable
inputs
(level 3)

Interest rate swaps

   $ 3,401    $ —      $ 3,401    $ —  

The fair value of the interest rate swaps is determined using third-party valuation models. The third party valuation models use quoted interest rate curves to calculate the forward value and then discount the forward values to the present period.

The Company has the following assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis during the period (in thousands):

 

          Fair value measurements using
     Six
months
ended
June 30,
2010
   Quoted
prices in
active markets
for identical
assets

(level 1)
   Significant
other
observable
inputs
(level 2)
   Significant
unobservable
inputs
(level 3)

Long-lived assets held for sale

   $ 9,523    $ —      $ —      $ 9,523

The fair value of the long-lived assets held for sale was determined using third-party appraisals. The third party appraisals use current market conditions to determine the fair market value.

 

F-64


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(UNAUDITED)

 

At June 30, 2010, the carrying value and estimated fair value of the Company’s long-term debt was $635.6 million and $635.6 million, respectively. At December 31, 2009, the carrying value and estimated fair value of the Company’s long-term debt was $651.9 million and $651.9 million, respectively. The majority of the Company’s long-term debt is owned by an affiliate of the preferred unit holder and is classified as a level 3 measurement. The Company values the debt using significant unobservable inputs. The fair value was determined based on the estimated fair value of comparable instruments with quoted active market values.

The carrying amounts of cash and cash equivalents and accruals approximate fair value because of the short maturity of these instruments.

Note 16. Acquisition of facility in Artern, Germany

On March 14, 2010, a foreign subsidiary of Tower Automotive, LLC acquired the assets of the manufacturing plant of TWB Fahrzeugtechnik GmbH & Co, KG i.L. located in Artern, Germany from an insolvency administrator. The acquisition was accounted for as a purchase under the acquisition method in accordance with FASB ASC No. 805, “ Business Combinations. ” The total purchase price was approximately $17.7 million which does not include direct acquisition costs of approximately $0.7 million. The acquisition was recorded by allocating the purchase price to the assets acquired, including identifiable intangible assets and liabilities assumed, based on their estimated fair values at the date of acquisition.

There was no goodwill recorded in connection with the acquisition. Supplemental Pro Forma disclosures are not included as the amounts are deemed immaterial. Revenues and earnings of the acquiree since the acquisition date included in the Company’s Condensed Consolidated Statement of Operations are immaterial for all periods presented.

In addition, the Company will be liable to pay back certain investment grants in the amount of $2.2 million if agreed upon levels of employment are not maintained through April 30, 2011. At present, the Company expects to maintain adequate employment through the period ending April 30, 2011.

In accordance with FASB ASC No. 805, the preliminary purchase price allocation is subject to additional adjustment within one year after the acquisition as additional information on asset and liability valuations becomes available. Through June 30, 2010, no adjustments to the initial purchase price allocation have been recorded. The Company expects that adjustments to recorded fair values may include those relating to:

 

   

Property, plant, and equipment, and intangibles, all of which may change based on consideration of additional analysis by the Company;

 

   

Accrued expenses, which may change based on identification of final fees and costs associated with the acquisition and resolution of any disputed claims, and preference claims; and

 

   

Tax liabilities and deferred taxes, which may be adjusted based upon additional information to be received from taxing authorities and which result from changes in the allocated book basis of items for which deferred taxes are provided.

 

F-65


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(UNAUDITED)

 

The preliminary allocation of the purchase price for the acquisition was made to the following major opening balance sheet categories (in thousands):

 

Assets Acquired

  

Current assets

   $ 1,925

Property, plant and equipment, net

     14,495

Intangibles

     2,055
      

Total assets acquired

     18,475

Other non-current liabilities assumed

     822
      

Net assets acquired

     17,653

Less: amount remaining to pay

     966
      

Cash paid in the first quarter of 2010

   $ 16,687
      

Note 17. Commitments and Contingencies

Compensation Programs

The primary objectives of the Company’s compensation programs are to (i) attract, motivate and retain the best executive officers with the skills necessary to successfully manage the Company’s business, and (ii) align the interests of the Company’s executive officers with equity owners by rewarding them for strong company performance.

Special Incentive Program

The Board established the Special Incentive Program on February 19, 2010. The Special Incentive Program provides for special cash bonuses to be paid to eight executives if a Qualifying Event were to occur. For this program, a qualifying event is defined as the consummation of an initial public offering or the repayment of the Company’s existing first lien term loan in full. The Company believes it will repay the first lien term loan on or before July 31, 2013; thus, the Company anticipates recording an expense of between $4.8 million and $5.5 million related to this program which will be recognized on a straight line basis through July 31, 2013. The Company recorded an expense of $0.5 million for the six months ended June 30, 2010. As of June 30, 2010, the Company has recorded a liability of $0.5 million relating to this Program.

Long Term Incentive Program

The Board established the Long Term Incentive Program on February 19, 2010. Participants will receive special cash bonuses if a Qualifying Transaction were to occur. For this program, a Qualifying Transaction is defined as a distribution to the Preferred Unit holders in excess of $50 million. In the event of an initial public offering, the special bonuses are expected to be in the form of restricted stock units that will be determined on the basis of the amount of value attributable to the Preferred Unit holders and a Qualifying Transaction is not a prerequisite to such award of restricted stock units. As these bonuses are based on the aggregate value of a future Qualifying Transaction, the value cannot be determined as of June 30, 2010. In addition, the Company does not deem the payment of the award as probable absent an initial public offering; therefore, no liability is recorded in the Company’s financial statements as of June 30, 2010.

 

F-66


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(UNAUDITED)

 

Amended Value Creation Plan (VC Plan)

The Board amended the VC Plan on February 19, 2010. The VC Plan provides for special cash bonuses to be paid to approximately 70 executives if a Funding Event were to occur. A Funding Event is defined as either the consummation of an initial public offering or the occurrence of a liquidation event (as defined in the Company’s operating agreement). In the case of a Funding Event that occurs upon the consummation of an initial public offering, payment of such bonuses will occur following the sale by the Preferred Unit holders with cumulative proceeds in an amount equal to the full value of their preferred investment in the Company. Under the VC Plan, the amount potentially available for distribution to participants is determined based on the Net Value Gained as a result of a Funding Event. Net Value Gained is defined as the net profit realized as a result of a Funding Event by the equity owners in respect of their investment in Common Units, all as determined by the Board of Managers in good faith.

The Value Creation Pool that is available for distribution due to a Qualifying Event will be equal to the following amount:

 

   

3.75% of Net Value Gained if Net Value Gained is less than $1 billion.

 

   

4.0% of Net Value Gained if Net Value Gained is $1 billion or more but less than $1.2 billion.

 

   

4.2% of Net Value Gained if Net Value Gained is $1.2 billion or more.

Participants will be assigned a percentage of the pool for distribution. The special bonuses are based on the aggregate value of a future Funding Event, and accordingly cannot be determined as of June 30, 2010. In addition, the Company does not deem the payment of the award as probable absent an initial public offering; therefore, no liability is recorded in the Company’s financial statements as of June 30, 2010.

Supplemental Value Creation Program

The Supplemental Value Creation Program was created in addition to the VC Plan discussed above on February 19, 2010. Participants will receive special cash bonuses if a Qualifying Liquidation Event were to occur. A Qualifying Liquidation Event is defined to have occurred if the Preferred Unit holders receive a cash distribution in an amount equal to the full value of their preferred investment in the Company. The special bonuses are based on the Company’s ability to make a distribution in full to the Preferred Unit holders, which is not deemed probable absent an initial public offering; therefore, no liability is recorded in the Company’s financial statements as of June 30, 2010. If the Company was to consummate an initial public offering, the Company estimates that it will incur an expense of between $6.8 million and $7.5 million.

Environmental Matters

The Company owns properties which have been impacted by environmental releases. The Company is actively involved in investigation and/or remediation at several of these locations. Total costs and liabilities associated with environmental contamination could be substantial and may have an adverse impact on the Company’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.

Accruals for environmental matters are recorded when it is probable that a liability has been incurred and the amount of the liability can be reasonably estimated. The established liability for environmental matters is based upon management’s best estimates of expected investigation/remediation costs related to environmental contamination. It is possible that actual costs associated with these matters will exceed the environmental reserves established by the Company. Inherent uncertainties exist in the estimates, primarily due to unknown

 

F-67


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(UNAUDITED)

 

environmental conditions, changing governmental regulations and legal standards regarding liability and evolving technologies for handling site remediation and restoration. At June 30, 2010 and December 31, 2009, the Company had accrued approximately $1.8 million for environmental matters.

Contingent Matters

The Company will establish reserves for matters in which losses are probable and can be reasonably estimated. These types of matters may involve additional claims that, if granted, could require the Company to pay penalties or make other expenditures in amounts that will not be estimable at the time of discovery of the matter. In these cases, a liability will be recorded at the low end of the range if no amount within the range is a better estimate in accordance with FASB ASC No. 450, Accounting for Contingencies .

As part of the original acquisition, the Company agreed to pay up to $70 million to the Post-Consummation Trust to relinquish certain defined liabilities. The Company has made $57.5 million of payments to date and remains contingently liable to pay an additional $12.5 million. At this time, the Company has not recorded a liability for the $12.5 million since it does not believe it is probable that any additional payments to the trust will be required; therefore, these amounts were eliminated as part of the final purchase accounting adjustments. To the extent that future payments are required, the payments will be expensed.

Litigation

The Company is subject to various legal actions and claims incidental to its business. Litigation is subject to many uncertainties and the outcome of individual litigated matters is not predictable with assurance. After discussions with counsel, it is the opinion of management that the outcome of such matters will not have a material adverse impact on the Company’s financial position, results of operations, or cash flows.

Note 18. Subsequent Events

The Company has evaluated subsequent events through the issuance of the Company’s consolidated financial statements on August 13, 2010.

Subsequent to June 30, 2010, the Company has initiated steps to refinance its first lien term loan (other than the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility included within its first lien term loan and guaranty agreement) pursuant to an unregistered offering of fixed term senior secured notes by two of its indirect subsidiaries. On August 12, 2010, prior to the completion of such offering, the Company’s operating agreement was amended and restated to provide for the conversion of the Company’s preferred, common and MIP units into a single class of membership interests, referred to as “capital units”. The capital units held by the former owner of MIP units will not be entitled to distributions until the holders of the other capital units have received distributions, in addition to tax distributions, equal to $180.9 million plus a return on the unpaid portion of such amount accruing from July 31, 2010 on a quarterly cumulative basis at a rate of 10% per annum.

On July 22, 2010, our Compensation Committee modified the Special Incentive Program to provide that in addition to the $5.5 million cash bonus payable upon consummation of an initial public offering or retirement of the Company’s first lien term loan, an additional cash bonus of $1.2 million will be payable to specified executive officers of the Company on the earlier of (i) the one year anniversary of the notes offering referenced above or (ii) the consummation of an initial public offering, provided that the first lien term loan is retired. In

 

F-68


Table of Contents

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(UNAUDITED)

 

addition, the Supplemental Value Creation Plan was modified to provide that the $7.5 million cash bonus payable under that plan will become payable, subject to vesting requirements, if either the Company retires its first lien term loan or consummates an initial public offering.

On August 13, 2010, in connection with the offering of notes described above, Cerberus committed to cause an affiliate of the Company’s former preferred unit holders to forgive $25 million aggregate principal amount of indebtedness under the first lien term loan and in exchange therefore such affiliate of Cerberus will receive equity in the Company. As a result of this transaction, the Company may experience cancellation of indebtedness income in the amount of up to $25 million. As of December 31, 2009, the Company had $148.5 million in net operating losses that it may use to offset any income tax payable as a result of this cancellation of indebtedness income.

 

F-69


Table of Contents

 

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Financial Statements

December 31, 2007

(With the Report of Independent

Registered Public Accounting Firm Thereon)

 

 

 

 

F-70


Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

The Board of Managers and Partners

Metalsa, S. de R.L.:

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheet of Metalsa, S. de R. L. and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2007, and the related consolidated statements of income, partners’ capital and comprehensive income, and cash flows for the year then ended. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audit.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Metalsa, S. de R. L. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2007, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for the year then ended in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

As discussed in Note 16 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company adopted the provisions of FASB Interpretation No. 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes , an interpretation of FASB Statement No. 109, as of January 1, 2007.

As discussed in the notes 1y and 14 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company adopted the recognition and disclosure provision of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 158, Employers’ Accounting for Defined Benefit Pension and Other Postretirement Plans, as of December 31, 2007.

KPMG Cárdenas Dosal, S. C.

/s/    Jaime García Garcíatorres

Jaime García Garcíatorres

Monterrey, N.L., Mexico, April 5, 2008

 

F-71


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Balance Sheet

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

Assets

  

Current assets:

  

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 34,698   

Derivative financial instruments (note 2)

     1,599   

Accounts receivable, net (note 4)

     103,111   

Inventories, net (note 5)

     69,752   

Prepaid expenses (note 6)

     2,144   

Deferred income taxes (note 16)

     4,168   
        

Total current assets

     215,472   

Note receivable from parent company (note 3)

     120,000   

Spare parts, less allowance for obsolescence and slow moving of $1,267

     4,410   

Property, plant and equipment, net (note 7)

     328,006   

Other non-current assets, net (note 8)

     5,182   

Goodwill, net

     12,809   
        
   $ 685,879   
        

Liabilities and Partners’ Capital

  

Current liabilities:

  

Current installments of long-term debt (note 9)

   $ 3,101   

Current installments of obligations under capital leases (note 10)

     89   

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities (note 11)

     87,239   

Pension and other postretirement benefits (note 14)

     1,436   
        

Total current liabilities

     91,865   

Long-term debt, excluding current installments (note 9)

     160,539   

Obligations under capital leases, excluding current installments (note 10)

     21   

Other long-term liabilities (note 13)

     2,674   

Pension and other postretirement benefits (note 14)

     8,692   

Deferred income taxes (note 16)

     48,479   
        

Total liabilities

     312,270   
        

Partners’ capital (note 15):

  

Contributed capital

     12,718   

Additional paid-in capital

     63,705   

Accumulated other comprehensive income (note 2)

     (1,605

Retained earnings

     298,791   
        

Total partners’ capital

     373,609   

Contingencies and commitments (note 19)

  
        
   $ 685,879   
        

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

F-72


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statement of Income

Year ended December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

Net sales (note 3)

   $ 675,787   

Cost of sales (note 3)

     533,832   
        

Gross profit

     141,955   

Selling, general and administrative expenses (notes 3 and 16)

     69,318   

Research and development costs—Launching cost of Tundra and DS projects

     1,356   
        

Operating income

     71,281   
        

Other income (expenses):

  

Interest expense

     (5,990

Interest income

     2,868   

Translation gain

     574   

(Loss) gain from valuation and liquidation of derivative financial instruments (note 2)

     (729

Other expenses, net

     (2,139
        

Other expenses, net

     (5,416
        

Income before income taxes

     65,865   
        

Income taxes (note 16):

  

Current

     (1,389

Deferred

     15,308   
        

Total income taxes

     13,919   
        

Net income

   $ 51,946   
        

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

F-73


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statement of Partners’ Capital and Comprehensive Income

Year ended December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

     Contributed
capital
   Additional
paid-in
capital
   Retained
earnings
   Accumulated
other
comprehensive
income
    Total
partners’

capital
 

Balances at January 1, 2007

   $ 12,718    63,705    246,845    1,715      324,983   

Other comprehensive income, net of tax:

             

Unrealized gains on derivative financial instruments, net of deferred income tax and reclassification adjustment for gains included in net income
(note 2)

              (1,715   (1,715

Net income

           51,946         51,946   
                 

Comprehensive income

                   50,231   

SFAS 158 adoption net of $624 taxes
(notes 1y and 14)

              (1,605   (1,605
                             

Balances as of December 31, 2007

   $ 12,718    63,705    298,791    (1,605   373,609   
                             

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

F-74


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows

Year ended December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

Net cash provided by operating activities (note 18)

   $ 79,287   
        

Cash flows from investing activities:

  

Acquisition of property, plant and equipment, including interest capitalized

     (35,124

Change in other non-current assets, net

     (789
        

Net cash used in investing activities

     (35,913
        

Cash flows from financing activities:

  

Note receivable from parent company

     (120,000

Proceeds from long-term debt

     110,000   

Payments of long-term debt

     (72,434
        

Net cash used in financing activities

     (82,434
        

Net decrease in cash and cash equivalents

     (39,060

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

     73,758   
        

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

   $ 34,698   
        

Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information:

  

Interest paid

   $ 5,674   
        

Net tax refunds received

   $ (1,748
        

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

F-75


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

(1) Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

a) Description of business

Activity

The Company is engaged in the manufacturing and sale of frames (chassis), heavy truck side rails, fuel tanks and steel stamped parts for the automotive industry, mainly to the North American Free Trade Agreement (NAFTA) market. There are four facilities: Apodaca, San Luis Potosí and Saltillo in México and the other in Virginia USA.

Outstanding Events

As of December 20, 2007, Grupo Proeza, S. A. de C. V. (Grupo Proeza) acquired the remaining 40% of the outstanding partnership interest in the Company from Tower Automotive México, S. de R. L., for $150 million. As a result of this transaction, Grupo Proeza, owns 100% of the Company. The financial statements are presented on an historical basis, without any consideration of the “push-down” basis derived from the purchase adjustments recorded by Grupo Proeza as the acquiring entity.

b) Use of Estimates

The preparation of the consolidated financial statements, in accordance with generally accepted principles in the United States of America, requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes. Significant items subject to such estimates and assumptions include the useful lives of fixed assets; allowances for doubtful accounts and sales returns; the valuation of derivatives, deferred tax assets, fixed assets, inventory and spare parts, investments and reserves for employee benefit obligations, income tax uncertainties and other contingencies. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

c) Basis of Presentation

The accompanying consolidated financial statements were prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in United States (U.S. GAAP), and are expressed in U.S. Dollars.

The accounting records of the Mexican companies are kept in Mexican pesos and in accordance with Mexican financial reporting standards (Mexican FRS). Mexican FRS vary in certain significant respects from U.S. GAAP and therefore, the financial statements of the company and its subsidiaries include certain adjustments to present them in accordance with U.S. GAAP and in U.S. Dollars.

d) Basis of Translation

The functional currency of the Company and all its subsidiaries has been defined as the U.S. Dollar in accordance with the SFAS No. 52 Foreign Currency Translation criteria. Therefore, monetary assets and liabilities are translated at the current exchange rate in effect at the end of the fiscal period, non-monetary assets and partners’ capital are remeasured at the historical exchange rate and revenue and expense accounts at the average rates that prevailed during the period, as applicable. Translation adjustments, including those related to income taxes, are recorded as translation gain or loss in the accompanying consolidated statement of income.

 

F-76


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

e) Principles of Consolidation

The accompanying consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Metalsa, S. de R.L. and its majority owned subsidiaries (collectively, the Company). All significant intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation. The consolidation was made based on the audited financial statements of the issuing companies, which were prepared under U.S. GAAP.

 

The subsidiaries are the following:

   Ownership  

Principal activity

Metalsa Roanoke, Inc.

   100%   Manufacturing and sale of heavy truck side rails

Metalsa Light Trucks, Inc.

   100%   Sequence service center

Grupo Metalsa S. de R.L.

   100%   Administrative services

Metalsa Servicios, S. de R.L.

   100%   Administrative services

f) Cash and Cash Equivalents

The Company considers all highly liquid investments with a maturity of three months or less when purchased to be cash equivalents. Cash and cash equivalents include $31,520 of overnight repurchase agreements and certificates of deposit with an initial term of less than three months at December 31, 2007.

g) Inventories

Inventories are stated at the lower of cost or market. Cost is determined using the first in, first out (FIFO) method.

h) Goodwill

Goodwill represents the excess of the acquisition cost over the fair value of net assets of the businesses acquired. Goodwill is reviewed for impairment at least annually in accordance with the provisions of FASB Statement No. 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets (Statement 142). The goodwill impairment test is a two-step test. Under the first step, the fair value of the reporting unit is compared with its carrying value (including goodwill). If the fair value of the reporting unit is less than its carrying value, an indication of goodwill impairment exist for the reporting unit and the enterprise must perform step two of the impairment test (measurement). Under step two, an impairment loss is recognized for any excess of the carrying value of the reporting unit’s goodwill over the implied fair value of that goodwill. The implied fair value of goodwill is determined by allocation the fair value of the reporting unit in a manner similar to a purchase price allocation, in accordance with FASB Statement No. 141, Business Combinations . The residual fair value after the allocation is the implied fair value of the reporting unit goodwill. The fair value of the reporting unit is determined using a discounted cash flow analysis. If the fair value of the reporting unit exceeds its carrying value, step two need not be performed.

During 2007, the Company performed its annual impairment review of goodwill and concluded that there was no impairment for that year.

i) Property, Plant and Equipment

Property, plant and equipment are stated at historical cost. Plant and equipment under capital leases are stated at the present value of minimum lease payments.

 

F-77


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

Depreciation and amortization is calculated using the straight-line method according to the useful life of the asset determined by the Company’s management as indicated in note 7.

The Company incurs maintenance costs on all its major equipment. Repair and maintenance costs are expensed when incurred.

j) Capitalized Interest

The Company’s policy is to capitalize interest cost incurred on debt during the construction of major projects exceeding one year. No interest was capitalized during the year ended December 31, 2007.

k) Spare Parts

The Company maintains a supply of spare and replacement parts that are critical parts in the operations of plant and equipment. Spare parts are recorded at net realizable value and are expensed when used.

l) Other Non-Current Assets

Other non-current assets are recorded at cost and represent primarily software with defined lives and deferred financing cost. Amortization expense is calculated on the straight-line method over a four year-period, except deferred financing cost which is being amortized under the effective interest method.

External direct costs of materials and services consumed in developing or obtaining internal computer software, and; payroll and payroll-related costs for employees who are directly associated with and who devote time to an internal use computer software project, to the extent of the time spent directly on the project, are capitalized.

m) Derivative Financial Instruments

As required by FASB Statement No. 133 , Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities , as amended the Company records all derivatives as either assets or liabilities on the balance sheet at fair value. The accounting for changes in the fair value of derivatives depends on the intended use of the derivative and the resulting designation. Derivatives used to hedge the exposure to changes in the fair value of an asset, liability, or firm commitment attributable to a particular risk, are considered fair value hedges. Derivatives used to hedge the exposure to variability in expected future cash flows, or other types of forecasted transactions, are considered cash flow hedges.

For derivatives designated as fair value hedges, changes in the fair value of the derivative and the hedged item related to the hedged risk are recognized in earnings. For derivatives designated as cash flow hedges, the effective portion of changes in the fair value of the derivative is initially recorded in other comprehensive income (outside of earnings) and subsequently reclassified to earnings when the hedged transaction affects earnings, and the ineffective portion of changes in the fair value of the derivative is recognized directly in earnings. The Company assesses the effectiveness of each hedging relationship on an ongoing basis by comparing the changes in fair value or cash flows of the derivative hedging instrument with the changes in fair value or cash flows of the designated hedged item or transaction. For derivatives not designated as hedges, changes in fair value are recognized in earnings. Furthermore, the Company has recorded derivatives as no hedging designations, which are recognized in earnings, since these derivatives do not fulfill all the requirements established by FASB Statement No. 133 , even though these derivatives find a logical economic hedge.

 

F-78


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

The Company discontinues hedge accounting prospectively when it is determined that the derivative is no longer effective in offsetting cash flows or fair value of the hedged item, the derivative expires or is sold, terminated, or exercised, the derivative is designated as a hedging instrument because it is unlikely that a forecasted transaction will occur, or management determines that designation of the derivative as a hedging instrument is no longer appropriate.

In all situations in which hedge accounting is discontinued and the derivative is retained, the Company continues to carry the derivative at its fair value on the consolidated balance sheet and recognizes any subsequent changes in its fair value in earnings. When it is probable that a forecasted transaction will not occur, the Company discontinues hedge accounting and recognizes immediately in earnings gains and losses that were accumulated in other comprehensive income.

n) Pension and Other Post Retirement Benefits and Health Insurance Programs

Metalsa—Roanoke, Inc. in principally self-insured for costs on health and medical claims. During 2007, the Company utilized commercial insurance to cover specific claims in excess of $90. Effective January 1 st , 2008, the commercial insurance covers specific claims in excess of $100.

The Company has a noncontributory defined benefit pension plan covering substantially all of its employees upon their retirement. The benefits are based on age, years of service and the level of compensation.

The Company records annual amounts relating to its pension and postretirement plans based on calculations that incorporate various actuarial and other assumptions including, discount rates, mortality, assumed rates of return, compensation increases, turnover rates and healthcare cost trend rates. The Company reviews its assumptions on an annual basis and makes modifications to the assumptions based on current rates and trends when it is appropriate to do so. The effect of modifications to those assumptions is recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income and amortized to net periodic cost over future periods using the corridor method. The Company believes that the assumptions utilized in recording its obligations under its plans are reasonable based on its experience and market conditions.

The net periodic costs are recognized as employees render the services necessary to earn the postretirement benefits.

Effective December 31, 2007, the Company adopted the recognition and disclosure provisions of FASB Statement No. 158, Employers’ Accounting for Defined Benefit Pension and Other Postretirement Plans (Statement 158). Statement 158 requires companies to recognize the funded status of defined benefit pension and other postretirement plans as a net asset or liability and to recognize changes in that funded status in the year in which the changes occur through other comprehensive income to the extent those changes are not included in the net periodic cost. The funded status reported on the balance sheet as of December 31, 2007 under Statement 158 was measured as the difference between the fair value of plan assets and the benefit obligation on a plan-by-plan basis. The adoption of the recognition provisions of Statement 158 did not impact the Company’s compliance with debt covenants or its cash position.

 

F-79


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

The incremental effect of applying SFAS 158 on the Company’s financial position as of December 31, 2007 for items not yet recognized as a component of net periodic cost that were directly recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income was as follows:

 

     Before
Application of
Statement 158
   Adjustments     After
Application  of
Statement 158

Pension and other postretirement benefits

   $ 7,899    2,229      10,128

Deferred income taxes assets (non-current)

     44,935    (624   44,311

Total liabilities

     310,665    1,605      312,270
                 

Total stockholders’ equity

   $ 363,499    3,210      366,709
                 

The recognition provisions of Statement 158 had no effect on the statement of income for the period presented. The Company will adopt the measurement date provisions of Statement 158 during fiscal year 2008 which will require the Company to change its measurement date for plan assets and benefit obligations to December 31.

o) Deferred Credit

The deferred credit resulted from the acquisition in 2003 of future tax benefits. The Company accounts for this transaction in accordance with EITF 98-11 Accounting for Acquired Temporary Differences in Certain Purchase Transactions that are not accounted for a Business Combinations , which requires that the difference between the amount paid and the future tax benefit be amortized to income tax expense in proportion to the realization of the tax benefits that give rise to the deferred credit.

p) Income Tax (IT), Tax on Assets (TA) and Employees’ Statutory Profit Sharing (ESPS)

IT and ESPS payable for the year are determined in conformity with tax regulations in force.

Income taxes are accounted for under the asset and liability method. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases and operating loss and asset tax and tax credit carryforwards. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled. The effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates is recognized in income in the period that includes the enactment date.

Deferred ESPS is recognized only for timing differences arising from the reconciliation of book income to income for profit sharing purposes, on which it may be reasonably estimated that a future liability or benefit will arise and there is no indication that the liabilities or benefits will not materialize.

Because the Company uses the US dollar as the functional currency for its Mexican operations, no deferred IT and ESPS are provided for the difference between the foreign currency equivalent of the US dollar cost and the indexed tax basis of the non monetary assets and liabilities.

Beginning with the adoption of FASB Interpretation No. 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes (FIN 48) as of January 1, 2007, the Company recognizes the effect of income tax positions only if those positions

 

F-80


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

are more likely than not of being sustained. Recognized income tax positions are measured at the largest amount that is greater than 50% likely of being realized. Changes in recognition or measurement are reflected in the period in which the change in judgment occurs. Prior to the adoption of FIN 48, the Company recognized the effect of income tax positions only if such positions were probable of being sustained.

The Company records interest related to unrecognized tax benefits in interest expense and penalties in selling, general and administrative expenses.

q) Contributed Capital and Additional Paid-in Capital

Contributed capital and additional paid-in capital were converted at the historical exchange rate at the date of the contributions if made in Mexican pesos or at the U.S. dollar value if the contributions were made in dollars.

r) Revenue Recognition

The Company recognizes revenues when the risks of ownership and the title is transferred to the customer, which is usually when the products are delivered and persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists, the price is fixed or determinable and collectability is reasonably assured. The Company records the necessary provisions to recognize sales commissions, refunds and discounts at the time the related income is recognized, which are deducted from sales or recognized as sales expense, as determined by the circumstances. Revenues from tools and dies projects are recognized as described in note 2w. The Company records the necessary reserves for losses in the recovery of accounts receivable based on management analysis and estimates.

Accounts receivable are recorded at the invoiced amount and do not bear interest. Amounts collected on accounts receivable are included in net cash provided by operating activities in the consolidated statements of cash flows. The Company maintains an allowance for doubtful accounts for estimated losses inherent in its accounts receivable portfolio. In establishing the required allowance, management considers historical losses, current receivable aging, and existing industry and national economic data. The Company’s customers in the automotive industry are affected by decreased corporate and consumer spending. The Company reviews its allowance for doubtful accounts monthly. All past due balances are reviewed individually for collectability. All other balances are reviewed on a pooled basis by industry. Account balances are charged off against the allowance after all means of collection have been exhausted and the potential for recovery is considered remote. The Company does not have any off balance sheet credit exposure related to its customers.

s) Business and Credit Concentration

The Company made net sales to four clients that represent approximately 84% of total net sales during 2007. These customer accounts receivable balances represent approximately 69% as of December 31, 2007 of total accounts receivable. The Company records the necessary reserves for losses in the recovery of accounts receivable based on management analysis and estimates.

Certain customers currently purchase all of the steel used by the Company for their models directly from steel producers. As a result, the Company has minimal exposure to changes in steel prices for parts supplied to these clients, which collectively represented 39% of the Company’s purchases in 2007. The balance amounts of $69,553 in 2007 is recorded as part of the accounts payable.

 

F-81


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

Since 2005, there has been significant distress in the automotive industry, brought on by continued competitive pressures, commodity price increases and relatively weak automotive production in North America, particularly with three of the most important customers of the Company, who have highly leveraged capital structures, among other factors. Sustained decline in overall industry production volumes could have an adverse effect on sales and profitability, if the Company is unable to further diversify its customer base or renegotiate payment terms. Currently, the Company has experienced modest price impacts but still has sales volumes sales levels similar to prior year.

t) Contingencies

Significant obligations or losses related to contingencies are recognized when it is likely that their effects will materialize and there are reasonable elements for their estimation. If these reasonable elements do not exist, qualitative disclosure about such contingencies is included in the notes to the consolidated financial statements. Contingent income, earnings or assets are recognized when there is almost absolute certainty of their realization.

u) Long-Lived Assets

In accordance with FASB Statement No. 144 (Statement 144), Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets, long-lived assets, such as property, plant, and equipment, and purchased intangible assets subject to amortization, are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may not be recoverable. If circumstances require a long-lived asset be tested for possible impairment, the Company first compares undiscounted cash flows expected to be generated by an asset to the carrying value of the asset. If the carrying value of the long-lived asset is not recoverable on an undiscounted cash flow basis, impairment is recognized to the extent that the carrying value exceeds its fair value. Fair value is determined through various valuation techniques including discounted cash flow models, quoted market values and third-party independent appraisals, as considered necessary.

v) Product Warranties

The Company generally warrants its products against certain manufacturing and other defects in material and workmanship. These product warranties are provided for specific periods of time and are applicable assuming the product has not been subjected to misuse, improper installation, and negligence or shipping damage. As of December 31, 2007, the Company had no accrual for estimated product warranty claims and there was no warranty claims expense for that year.

w) Preproduction Costs

The Company follows the provisions of Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) Issue No. 99-5, “Accounting for Pre-production Costs Related to Long-Term Supply Arrangements,” that requires all pre-production tooling costs incurred for tools that the Company will not own to be expensed as incurred, unless the supply agreement provides the supplier with the non-cancellable right to use the tools or the reimbursement costs are contractually guaranteed by the customer. At December 31, 2007, $23,588 was included in inventories as reimbursable costs.

Revenues associated with long-term construction-type contracts entered into with customers are recognized over the term of the contracts. Earnings are recognized when collection is assured. If during the project, the Company estimates a loss by comparing the incurred cost and the cost to be incurred with the total contract value, the excess is recognized in the results of the period immediately. For the year ending December 31, 2007, net sales include $41,850 of project tooling and dies income.

 

F-82


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

x) Reclassifications

Certain prior year amounts have been reclassified where necessary to conform to the current year presentation.

y) Recently Adopted Accounting Standards

Effective December 31, 2007, the Company adopted the recognition and disclosure provisions of FASB Statement No. 158, Employers’ Accounting for Defined Benefit Pension and Other Postretirement Plans (Statement 158) (refer to Note 14 for information regarding the impact of adopting the recognition provisions of Statement 158).

The Company has not yet adopted the measurement date provisions which are not effective until fiscal year 2008. The Company does not anticipate a material effect on its financial statements as a result of adoption of the measurement date provisions of Statement 158.

Effective January 1, 2007, the Company adopted provisions of FIN 48. FIN 48 addresses the accounting for uncertainty in income taxes recognized in an enterprise’s financial statements and prescribes a threshold of more-likely-than-not for recognition and derecognition of tax positions taken or expected to be taken in a tax return. FIN 48 also provides related guidance on measurement, classification, interest and penalties, and disclosure. See note 16 for the impact of adopting FIN 48 on the Company’s results of operations and financial position.

(2) Derivative Financial Instruments and Hedge Activities

For derivatives used as a hedge of a risk exposure the Company, at the inception of the hedge, establishes a formal documentation of the hedging relationship and the risk management objective and strategy for undertaking the hedge, including identification of the hedging instrument, the hedged item, the nature of the risk being hedged and how the hedge effectiveness will be assessed.

Derivatives designated as hedge

The Company’s objective in using derivatives is to add stability to interest expense and to manage its exposure to both interest and currency rate movements or other identified risks. To accomplish this objective, the Company primarily uses Cross Currency Swap as part of its fair value hedging strategy. Following are the details of this strategy:

Fair Value Hedge —The Company has recognized in liabilities a credit issued by Banamex in May 2006 which expires in May 2011. The principal is 500 million Mexican pesos and the Company’s commitment is to pay a fixed-rate (8%) for the first two years and a variable-rate (TIIE) for the last 3 years.

Since its functional currency is the U.S. dollar, the Company decided to use a cross currency swap in order to hedge its interest and currency rates risk exposure. This derivative was designated as a fair value hedge and involves the receipt of fixed-rate payments in Mexican pesos for the first two years of the term and variable-rate (TIIE) payments in Mexican pesos for the reminder of them in exchange for variable-rate (LIBOR) payments in dollars over the life of the agreement (5 years).

 

F-83


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

As of December 31, 2007, the fair value of this cross currency swap was $1,369 which is included within current assets. Following are the details of the derivative:

 

       Notional   

Basis Conditions

   Fair market value

Counterparty

         2007

Banamex

   500 million
Mexican pesos
   Metalsa receives Libor over 500 million Mexican Pesos and pays fixed rate at 5.32% over $44.7 million USD.    $ 1,369
            

Changes in fair market value were recognized as part of loss from valuation and liquidation of derivate financial instruments. The primary position effects amounted to $(198) in 2007 and are recognized as a part of long-term debt and bank loans (see note 9).

Derivatives without Hedging designation

Interest Rate Swaps

The Company has recognized in its balance sheet two Interest Rate Swaps that involve the receipt of variable-rate (LIBOR) payments in exchange for fixed-rate payments over the life of the agreement without exchange of the underlying principal amount. Following are the details of these swaps:

 

       Notional   

Basis Conditions

   Fair market value

Counterparty

         2007

Banamex

   80.0 and 20.0
million
Mexican pesos
   Metalsa receives a Libor reference rate and pays a fixed rate of 4.055% and 2.4975% respectively.    $ 448
            

The total fair value is a gain of $448 and is included within current assets. During the year a gain of $1,751 was reclassified from other comprehensive income to current year earnings as a result of the liquidation of certain instruments that qualified for hedge accounting. In addition a loss of $3,372 was recognized from valuation and liquidation of derivative financial instruments that do not qualify for hedge accounting.

FX Options

The Company recognized during 2007 a loss of $218 related to an options portfolio that involves short call and long put positions associated with zero cost collar strategies. Following are the details for this portfolio:

 

Derivative

   Counterparty    Strike
price
   Notional
USD
   Main Conditions    Fair value
USD
 

Short Call

   Banamex    11.32    $ 48,000    Commitment to sale
dollars at 11.32
   $ (742

Long Put

   Banamex    11.32      24,000    Right to sale dollars
at 11.32
     524   

 

F-84


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

(3) Related Parties

At December 31, 2007 balances and transactions with related parties are as follows:

(a) Due from

 

Ogihara Proeza México, S. de R.L. de C.V. (Ogihara)

   $ 650

NovoCast, S.A. de C.V. (NovoCast)

     520

Teknik, S.A. de C.V. (Teknik)

     194

Proeza, S.A. de C.V.

     132

Others

     54
      

Total short-term (note 4)

     1,550

Grupo Proeza, S.A. de C.V.

     120,000
      
   $ 121,550
      

$500 due from Ogihara will be recovered on December 2008. This loan bears interest at LIBOR plus 2.5%. Additionally, $150 of anticipated payments is related with tooling manufacturing.

NovoCast and Teknik accounts receivables are related to scrap sales.

The amount due from Grupo Proeza is related to a loan granted for use in the transactions described in note 1, and amounted to $120 million. This loan bears interest at an ordinary rate of 5.75% to be recovered at the termination of the loan.

(b) Due to

 

Grupo Proeza, S.A. de C.V. (Grupo Proeza)

   $ 1,991

Ogihara Proeza México, S. de R.L. de C.V. (Ogihara)

    

Tower Automotive, Inc. (Tower Automotive)

    

Proeza, S.A. de C.V. (Proeza)

    

Others

     17
      
   $ 2,008
      

The balance due to Ogihara is related to tooling manufacturing. The balances with Grupo Proeza and Tower Automotive (former parent company, see note 1) are related to the services and technical assistance mentioned below.

(c) Related Party Transactions

The transactions carried out during the year ended December 31, 2007, with related parties are as follows:

 

Sales

   $ 8,442
      

Purchases

   $ 5,259
      

Service and technical assistance

   $ 30,207
      

Loans granted

   $ 120,000
      

 

F-85


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

The Company has a contract with its parent companies Grupo Proeza and Tower, (former parent company, see note 1) whereby it agrees to pay for administrative services and technical assistance provided, respectively. The amount to be paid for these services is determined based on a percentage of sales (3.6% for Grupo Proeza and 1.5% for Tower) and amounted to $30,207 in 2007.

The Company agreed with Tower Automotive and Grupo Proeza to pay amounts due under these contracts since 2001 and the following six years on a monthly basis. The amount being paid on a monthly basis to Tower Automotive is approximately $58 and to Grupo Proeza is $112.

During 2007 Metalsa Roanoke (a subsidiary) was charged a management fee of $1.0 million, due to Grupo Proeza. At December 31, 2007, $7 has been recorded under this arrangement.

(4) Accounts Receivable

At December 31, 2007, accounts receivable are as follows:

 

Trade

   $ 90,869   

Advances for taxes and other accounts receivable

     10,713   

Related parties (note 3)

     1,550   
        
     103,132   

Less allowance for doubtful accounts

     (21
        
   $ 103,111   
        

A summary of the changes in the allowance for doubtful accounts for the year ended December 31, 2007, is as follows:

 

Description

   Balance at
beginning

of year
   Charge to
expense
   Write-offs     Balance at
end of year

Year ended:

          

December 31, 2007

   168    5    (152   21
                    

(5) Inventories

At December 31, 2007 inventories consist of:

 

Raw material

   $ 17,741   

Work-in-process

     11,015   

Finished goods

     12,265   

Tools and dies projects

     23,588   

Materials in transit

     5,547   

Advances to suppliers

     317   
        
     70,473   

Allowance for obsolescence and slow moving

     (721
        
   $ 69,752   
        

 

F-86


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

(6) Prepaid Expenses

At December 31, 2007, prepaid expenses are as follows:

 

Prepaid insurance

   $ 1,298

Brokers fees prepaid

     397

Other

     449
      
   $ 2,144
      

(7) Property, Plant and Equipment

At December 31, 2007, the investment in property, plant and equipment is as follows:

 

           Estimated
useful life

Land

   $ 1,339      —  

Building

     106,248      28 years

Plant and equipment

     424,267      18 years

Transportation equipment

     792      4 years

Furniture and fixtures

     12,719      10 years

Computer equipment

     9,629      3 years

Tools and dies

     4,423      9 years

Construction in progress

     29,236      —  
          
     588,653     

Less accumulated depreciation

     (260,647  
          
   $ 328,006     
          

Property, plant and equipment include capitalized interest of $3,028 net of accumulated depreciation. No interest was capitalized during the year ended December 31, 2007.

As of December 31, 2007, the Company estimates an additional investment of $94.7 million related with construction in progress; this will be concluded and capitalized at the end of 2008.

The Company has written-off assets for $1,754, for 2007, net of the related accumulated depreciation as these assets are no longer in use and have no residual value.

(8) Other Non-Current Assets, net

At December 31, 2007, other non-current assets are as follows:

 

Software

   $ 14,717   

Others

     299   
        
     15,016   

Less accumulated amortization

     (9,834
        
   $ 5,182   
        

 

F-87


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

For the year ended December 31, 2007, interest expense includes $882, of related amortization expense and $813 of deferred financing costs written off as a result of refinancing the related debt.

(9) Long-Term Debt and Bank Loans

At December 31, 2007, long-term debt is as follows:

 

a)      Syndicated credit contract amounting to $155 million, five-year amortizing facility beginning in July 2008.

   $ 115,000   

b)      Credit amounting to 500 million pesos, four years amortizing facility beginning November 2008.

     45,844   

c)      Loan agreement for EUR 4.9 million, bearing interest at LIBOR plus applicable margin, seven year amortizing starting in 2004.

     2,796   
        

Total long-term debt

     163,640   

Less current installments of long-term debt

     (3,101
        

Long-term debt, excluding current installments

   $ 160,539   
        

In 2005, the Company and Metalsa Roanoke entered into a syndicated credit contract for $180 million. The syndicated credit contract has been amended to be 100% revolving. As of December 31, 2007, the Company has a balance of $115 million used ($5 million are used by Metalsa Roanoke), and $40 million available.

The loan has a 36-month grace period, then semi-annual amortizations as follows: 10% in months 36 and 42; 20% in month 48 and 30% in month 54 and 60.

The syndicated credit contract bears interest at a rate equal to LIBOR plus a margin (between 60 and 100 basis points) according to the leveraged level. At the end of 2007 the applicable rate was LIBOR plus 60 basis points. At December 31, 2007 the interest rate for this loan amount 5.82%.

In 2006 the Company obtained a Loan facility for 500 million pesos. Additionally, the Company entered into a cross currency swap contract in order to fix the obligation at $44.7 million U.S. dollar. Also this debt includes a fair value valuation of $366 related to the cross currency swap as describe in note 2. The interest rate after the swap effect on this loan is LIBOR plus 30 basis points for the first two years and LIBOR plus 50 basis points thereafter. The credit is a four-year amortizing facility to be paid on a quarterly basis through November 2008 at 5% in the first two amortizations and 10% thereafter. At December 31, 2007 the interest rate for this loan amount 5.33%.

The notes payable to the bank and the long-term debt contracts described in this note establish certain restrictive covenants, the most significant of which refer to limitations on dividend payments, investments and contractual debt. As of December 31, 2007, the Company was in compliance with the covenants or has obtained necessary waivers.

The maturities of long-term debt are as follows:

 

Years ending December 31:

  

2009

   $ 33,913

2010

     117,215

2011

     9,411
      
   $ 160,539
      

 

F-88


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

The company has contracted several lines of credit for approximately $45 million. As of December 31, 2007, the Company has not used these lines of credit.

(10) Leases

The Company is obligated under capital leases covering machinery and equipment that expire in 2009. The Company also has several non-cancelable operating leases, primarily for machinery and equipment that expire over the next two years. These leases generally contain renewal options for periods ranging from three to five years and require the Company to pay all executory costs such as maintenance and insurance. Rent expense under operating leases during 2007 approximated $109.

Future minimum lease payments under non-cancelable operating leases (with initial or remaining lease terms in excess of one year) and future minimum capital lease payments as of December 31, 2007 are:

 

     Capital
leases
    Operating
leases

Year ending December 31:

    

2008

   $ 110      37

2009

     9      7
            

Total minimum lease payments

     119      44
      

Less estimated executory costs

     (7  
          

Net minimum lease payments

     112     

Less: amount representing interest (at the rate of 4%)

     (2  
          

Present value of net minimum capital lease payments

     110     

Less current portion of obligations under capital leases

     (89  
          

Obligations under capital leases, excluding current portion

   $ 21     
          

(11) Accounts Payable and Accrued Liabilities

At December 31, 2007, liabilities and accruals are as follows:

 

Trade

   $ 69,553

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities

     15,137

Related parties (note 3)

     2,008

Interest payable

     541
      
   $ 87,239
      

The accounts payable and accrued liabilities are as follows:

 

Accrued liabilities

   $ 8,227

Taxes payable and employee’s statutory profit sharing

     1,454

Advanced payments from clients

     1,342

Vacations payables

     1,324

Other current liabilities

     2,790
      
   $ 15,137
      

 

F-89


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

Accrued liabilities are as follows:

 

     Freight     Salaries     Other     Total  

Balance as of December 31, 2006

   $ 701      9,119      1,014      10,834   

Increases

     2,430      7,056      411      9,897   

Payments

     (2,761   (9,120   (623   (12,504
                          

Balance as of December 31, 2007

   $ 370      7,055      802      8,227   
                          

The Company made purchases of raw material from three suppliers that represented 49% of its total purchases made during 2007. The balance of the accounts payable to these suppliers as of December 31, 2007 represents 16% of total accounts payable, respectively.

Other accruals include provisions related to utilities expenses and other minor expenses primarily.

(12) Deferred Credit

At December 31, 2007 the deferred credit balance is as follows:

 

Deferred credit

   $ 35,614   

Transaction loss

     (520

Less accumulated amortization

     (35,094
        
   $ —     
        

In 2003, through a subsidiary, the Company paid $6,200 for an entity whose primary asset was $42,752 of tax loss carryforwards. The difference between the purchase price and the fair value was recorded as a deferred credit, as required by EITF 98-11 Accounting for Acquired Temporary Differences in Certain Purchase Transactions That Are Not Accounted for as Business Combinations .

(13) Other Long-Term Liabilities

Other long-term liabilities represent deferred current tax from years ended 2000, 2001 and 2002 as a result of the use of the lower preference tax rate instead of the enacted tax rate. This amount will be payable to the tax authorities when the Company pays dividends out of taxable earnings. As of December 31, 2007 the Company had not paid any dividends.

(14) Pension and other postretirement benefits

The Company has a noncontributory defined benefit pension plan covering substantially all of its employees upon their retirement. The benefits are based on age, years of service and the level of compensation during the five years before retirement. The Company makes annual contributions to the plan equal to the maximum amount that can be deducted for income tax purposes.

In addition to the Company’s defined benefit pension plan, the Company sponsors a defined benefit health care plan that provides postretirement medical benefits to full-time employees who meet minimum age and

 

F-90


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

service requirements. The plan is contributory with retiree contributions adjusted annually, and contains other cost-sharing features such as deductibles and coinsurance. The accounting for the plan anticipates future cost-sharing changes to the written plan that are consistent with the Company’s expressed intent to increase the retiree contribution rate annually for the expected general inflation rate for that year. The Company’s policy is to fund the cost of medical benefits in amounts determined at the discretion of management.

As discussed in note 1n, effective December 31, 2007, the Company adopted the recognition and disclosure provisions of Statement 158. Statement 158 requires companies to recognize the funded status of defined benefit pension and other postretirement plans as a net asset or liability on its balance sheet.

Actuarial gains and losses are generally amortized subject to the corridor, over the average remaining service life of the Company’s active employees.

The Company uses a January 1 measurement date.

The following table sets forth the plan’s benefit obligations, fair value of plan assets, and funded status at December 31, 2007:

 

     Pension
benefits
    Termination
benefits
 

Benefit obligation and funded status at December 31, 2007

   $ (5,549   (4,579

Unrecognized items

            

Additional minimum liability

            
              

Funded status at December 31, 2007

   $ (5,549   (4,579
              

Amounts recognized in the balance sheet consist of:

    

Non-current assets

   $        

Current liabilities

     (464   (972

Non-current liabilities

     (5,085   (3,607

Accumulated other comprehensive income

     2,229        
              

Net amount recognized

   $ (3,320   (4,579
              

Amounts recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income consist of:

 

     Pension
benefits
    Termination
benefits

Net actuarial gain (loss)

   $ (51  

Prior service credits (costs)

     (2,178  
            
   $ (2,229  
            

 

F-91


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

The accumulated benefit obligation for the pension plan was $8,408 at December 31, 2007. Net periodic benefit cost recognized in 2007 was:

 

     Pension
benefits
   Termination
benefits

Net periodic benefit cost recognized

   $ 902    2,994
           

Other changes in plan assets and benefit obligations recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income in 2007 are as follows:

 

     Pension
benefits
    Termination
benefits

Adjustment to minimum liability

   $ (1,979  

Intangible assets

         

Net (loss)

     (51  

Prior services (cost) credit

     (2,178  

Elimination of minimum liability

     1,979     
            

Total recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income

   $ (2,229  
            

Total recognized in net periodic benefit cost and accumulated other comprehensive income

   $ (1,327   2,994
            

The net loss and prior service cost for the defined benefit pension plan that will be amortized from accumulated other comprehensive income into net periodic benefit cost over the next fiscal year are $144 and $0, respectively.

Weighted average assumptions used to determine benefit obligations for 2007 were as follows:

 

     Pension
benefits
    Termination
benefits
 

Discount rate

   8.5   8.5

Rate of comprehensive increase

   4.5   4.5
            

Weighted average assumptions used to determine net benefit cost for 2007 were as follows:

 

     Pension
benefits
    Termination
benefits
 

Discount rate

   9.0   9.0

Rate compensation increase

   4.5   4.5
            

The following table summarizes benefit costs, employer contributions, plan participants’ contributions and benefits paid during 2007:

 

     Pension
benefits
   Termination
benefits

Benefit cost

   $ 902    935

Benefits paid

     232    1,664
           

 

F-92


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

The benefits expected to be paid from the pension plan in each year from 2008 to 2012 are $345, $359, $260, $383, and $398, respectively. The aggregate benefits expected to be paid in the five years from 2013-2017 are $2,044. The expected benefits are based on the same assumptions used to measure the Company’s benefit obligation at December 31 and include estimated future employee service.

The benefits expected to be paid from the termination benefits plan in each year 2008-2012 are $1,091, $973, $880, $798, and $662, respectively. The aggregate benefits expected to be paid in the five years from 2013-2017 are $2,949. The expected benefits are based on the same assumptions used to measure the company’s benefit obligation at September 30 and include estimated future employee service.

(15) Partners’ Capital

The characteristics of partners’ capital are as follows:

(a) Partnership Interests

 

   

Partnership interests represent the capital of the Company, each one representing the value of the contribution made by the respective partner. Each partner has one voting rights for each Mexican peso of contributed capital;

 

   

Partnership interests can be divided into up to four series. As of December 31, 2007 only one series of partnership interests is in use. Series A must be owned by individuals or groups of partners that have an affiliate, parent, or subsidiary relationship and are of Mexican nationality, and whose by-laws have the direct and indirect exclusion clause for foreign national residents regardless of whether they are a Company or individual or whether they reside in Mexico as legal residents, or live abroad. Series B can be subscribed to any person or legal entity;

 

   

The partnership interests of the Company amount to $12,718 including both Series A and B;

 

   

The partners have the first right of refusal to subscribe new interests of each series in the proportion held by them at the moment at which a capital increase has been approved.

(c) Retained Earnings

The principal restrictions to retained earnings are:

 

   

The Company is required to maintain a legal reserve as defined in the Mexican Business Law. At December 31, 2007, the legal reserve is $271.

 

   

Earnings distributed as dividends in excess of accumulated tax earnings will be subject to payment of income taxes in accordance with the Mexican Income Tax Law. At December 31, 2007, no deferred income tax has been recognized over this excess because it is expected that dividends will be paid free of taxes.

(16) Income Tax (IT), Flat Rate Business Tax (IETU), Tax on Assets (TA), Employees’ Statutory Profit Sharing (ESPS) and Deferred Taxes

The income tax law in Mexico provides that companies must pay either IT or TA depending on which amount is greater with respect to their Mexican operations. Both taxes recognize the effects of inflation. ESPS is calculated on a similar basis as IT without recognizing the effects of inflation.

 

F-93


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

On October 1, 2007 new laws were published, a number of tax laws were revised, and additionally a presidential decree was issued on November 5, 2007, which will come into effect on January 1, 2008. The most important changes are: (i) derogation of the Asset Tax Law and (ii) the introduction of a new tax (Flat Rate Business Tax or IETU) which is based on cash flows and limits certain deductions; additionally, certain tax credits are granted mainly with respect to inventories, salaries taxed for IT purposes and social security contributions, tax losses arising from accelerated deductions, recoverable asset tax, and deductions related to investments in fixed assets, deferred charges and expenses. The IETU rate is 16.5% for 2008, 17% for 2009 and 17.5% for 2010 and thereafter.

Accordingly, beginning in 2008, companies will be required to pay the greater of IETU or IT. If, IETU results, the payment will be considered final, not subject to recovery in subsequent years (with certain exceptions).

Pre tax book income for the Mexican operations and its foreign subsidiaries for the years ended December 31, 2007, were as follows:

 

Mexican Operations

   $ 68,928   

Foreign Operations

     (3,063
        
   $ 65,865   
        

Because the Company and its subsidiaries file their income tax returns separately, the income tax expense represents the combined tax expense of the Company and its subsidiaries. Income tax expense for the year ended December 31, 2007, is summarized as follows:

 

Current Mexican taxes

   $   

Current US Federal and state taxes

     (1,389

Deferred Mexican taxes

     19,189   

Deferred US Federal and state taxes

     294   

Amortization of deferred credit

     (4,175
        
   $ 13,919   
        

Income tax expense attributable to income from continuing operations before IT differed from the amounts computed by applying the Mexican rate of 28% is presented below:

 

Computed expected tax expense

   $ 18,442   

Non-deductible expenses

     25   

Excess of income tax rate of foreign subsidiary

     (340

Excess of depreciation expense due to exchange rate for which there is no tax benefit

     249   

Amortization of deferred credit related to acquired loss carryforwards

     (4,175

Effects of inflation and others, net

     (2,143

Non-deductible amount for accelerated depreciation

     1,958   

Technological tax benefit

     (419

Change evaluation allowance

     322   
        

Actual income tax expense

   $ 13,919   
        

 

F-94


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

The tax effects of temporary differences that give rise to significant portions of the deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities, as of December 31, 2007, for Mexican operations are presented below:

 

Deferred tax assets:

  

Allowance for doubtful accounts

   $ 5   

ESPS to be deducted

     677   

Tax on assets recoverable

     1,151   

Liability accruals

     5,333   

Tax loss carryforwards

     2,805   
        

Total gross tax assets

     9,971   

Less valuation allowance

     (1,151
        

Total deferred tax assets

     8,820   
        

Deferred tax liabilities:

  

Inventories

     (3,843

Tools and dies projects

     (6,549

Property, plant, equipment and intangible assets

     (27,389

Derivative financial instruments

     (448
        

Total deferred tax liabilities

     (38,229
        

Deferred tax liability, net

   $ (29,409
        

The rollforward for the net deferred IT asset for the year ended December 31, 2007 for the Mexican operations is presented below:

 

Initial balance of deferred income tax

   $ (11,740

Deferred IT of other comprehensive income

     1,320   

Deferred IT expense

     (19,189

Transaction loss

     200   
        

Ending balance

   $ (29,409
        

 

F-95


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

The tax effects of temporary differences that give rise to significant portions of the deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities, as of December 31, 2007 for the foreign subsidiary operations, are presented below:

 

Deferred tax assets:

  

Allowance for doubtful accounts

   $ 1   

AMT credit carryforward

     152   

Allowance for slow-moving of inventory and excess of tax inventory value over book value

     190   

Other

     872   
        

Total deferred tax assets

     1,215   
        

Deferred tax liabilities:

  

Property, plant and equipment

     (12,161

Goodwill

     (3,842

Other

     (114
        

Total deferred tax liabilities

     (16,117
        

Total deferred income tax liabilities, net

   $ (14,902
        

The rollforward for the net deferred IT liability for the year ended December 31, 2007 for the foreign subsidiary is presented below:

 

Initial balance of deferred income tax

   $ (14,608)   

Deferred IT expense

     (294)   
        

Ending balance

   $ (14,902
        

At December 31, 2007, the company wrote-off the balance of deferred ESPS due to the transfer of employees from Metalsa, S. de R.L. to Grupo Metalsa, S. de R.L. a subsidiary of Metalsa. The effect of the write-off was included as part of selling, general and administrative expenses.

The rollforward for the net deferred ESPS liability for the year ended December 31, 2007 is presented below:

 

     ESPS  

Initial balance of ESPS liability

   $ (5,223

Deferred ESPS benefit

     4,958   

Deferred ESPS on derivative financial instruments in partners’ capital

     252   

Transaction gain

     13   
        

Ending balance

   $   
        

Net operating loss for the year ended December 31, 2007 was approximately $8,971. Based upon the level of historical taxable income and projections for future taxable income over the periods in which the deferred tax assets are deductible, management believes it is more likely than not that the Company will realize the benefits of these deductible differences and tax carryforwards. The amount of the deferred tax asset considered realizable, however, could be reduced in the near term if estimates of future taxable income during the carryforward period are reduced.

 

F-96


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

In assessing the realization of deferred tax on assets, management considers whether it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. The ultimate realization of deferred tax assets is dependent upon the generation of future taxable income during the periods in which those temporary differences become deductible or tax carryforwards are utilizable. Management considers the scheduled reversal of deferred tax liabilities, projected future taxable income, and tax planning strategies in making this assessment.

At December 2007, TA recoverable and tax loss carryforwards for the Mexican subsidiaries amounted to and will expire as follows:

 

Year

   Tax on
assets
   Tax loss
carryforwards

2011

   $    1,046

2015

     383   

2016

     446   

2017

     322    8,971
           
   $ 1,151    10,017
           

The Company has not recognized a deferred tax liability of approximately $7,181 for the undistributed earnings of its foreign operations that arose in 2007 and prior years because the Company currently does not expect those unremitted earnings to reverse and become taxable to the Company in the foreseeable future. A deferred tax liability will be recognized when the Company is no longer able to demonstrate that it plans to permanently reinvest undistributed earnings. As of December 31, 2007 the undistributed earnings of these subsidiaries were approximately $25,648.

Since the Mexican peso could potentially decline in value relative to the U.S. dollar, a translation loss could be realized for the deferred tax assets denominated in Mexican pesos. Alternatively, translation gain could potentially be realized in future periods in the event of an increase in the value of the Mexican peso.

The Company adopted the interpretation of FASB Interpretation No. 48 (FIN 48) effective January 1, 2007. FIN 48 requires entities to analyze all positions taken and recognize its benefit only if it is “more-likely-than-not” to be sustained based only on its technical merits as of the reporting date. If a tax position does not meet the more-likely-than-not threshold, no benefits of the position are to be recognized. In subsequent periods, the more-likely-than-not threshold must continue to be met to support continued recognition of a benefit.

FIN 48 requires that each position be analyzed considering that the authority will examine each position and will have full access and knowledge of all information and the Company has adopted this principle as part of the implementation process.

The cumulative effect of applying the new requirements of FIN 48 are reflected as adjustments to the company’s retained earnings and reported as a change in accounting principle. In further periods, any unrecognized benefit will be recorded to the income statement.

As of January 1, 2007, the Company did not have any positions to be recorded under the FIN 48 requirements. There are no unrecognized benefits to be disclosed, provided that under the rules established by the interpretation all positions taken by the Company surpass the confidence level required by the interpretation.

 

F-97


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

During 2007, the Company followed procedures for analyzing all tax positions taken before 2007 and during 2007 to confirm whether they still meet the threshold imposed by the regulation. As a result of this management analysis, no position taken during 2007 needs to be disclosed as a unrecognized benefit.

The Company files income tax returns in Mexico and the United States and is subject to examination by taxing authorities in these jurisdictions, the years open for review are:

 

Jurisdiction

   Years open for review

Mexico

   2002 - 2007

United States of America

   2004 - 2007

The Company’s policy, in the event of interest and penalties arising from unrecognized benefits derived from uncertain tax positions, will be to classify them as interest expense and penalties in selling, general and administrative expenses.

(17) Employee Benefit Plan

(a) Savings Plan

The Company has a 401(k) investment plan (the Plan) for the benefit of its employees. Employees who have attained age 18 or older are eligible to participate in the Plan in the month following their first 60 days of service. Under the Plan, employees may elect to have up to 100% of their salary, subject to Internal Revenue Service limitations, withheld on a pretax basis. The Company matches 100% of employees’ contributions up to 3% of their compensation, and then matches 50% of employees’ contributions up to an additional 2% of their compensation. The Company made matching contributions of $413 for the year ended December 31, 2007.

As an additional incentive, the Company established a deferred profit sharing component as a part of the 401(k) Plan. The deferred profit sharing contribution is a discretionary contribution based on the Parent Company reaching 75% of the target operating income as defined by the Board of Directors. Employees receive a percentage of their wages including bonuses and are 100% vested after three years of service. If the target operating income of the Parent Company is below 75%, there is no profit sharing in the plan year. For the year ended December 31, 2007 the Company made profit sharing contributions of $607.

(b) Self-Insured Medical Plan

Effective January 1, 2005, the Company began sponsoring a self-funded health care plan for all employees. The Company makes monthly contributions to the plan to be used to pay claims which are processed by a third-party administrator. To limit its liability, the Company has purchased aggregate and specific stop loss excess risk insurance. The aggregate stop loss limit is calculated based on a percentage of annual estimated claims expense. The aggregate limits as of December 31, 2007 cover total paid claims in excess of 125% of the expected liability and the specific stop loss insurance covers the amount of claims paid with respect to a single individual in excess of $90. At December 31, 2007 the Company had provided an accrual of $183, for claims incurred but not paid based on management’s estimate of the self-insured liability. For the year ended December 31, 2007 the Company incurred claims, premium expenses, and administration fees related to this plan totaling $1,972.

 

F-98


Table of Contents

METALSA, S. DE R.L. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—(Continued)

December 31, 2007

(Thousands of US dollars)

 

(18) Reconciliation of Net Earnings to Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities

The reconciliation of net earnings to net cash provided by operating activities for the year ended December 31, 2007 is as follows:

 

Consolidated net income

   $ 51,946   

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:

  

Depreciation and amortization

     42,331   

Write-off of property, plant and equipment

     1,754   

Bad debt expense

     5   

Amortization and write-off of deferred financing costs

     813   

Deferred ESPS

     (5,570

Inventory reserve

     380   

Amortization of deferred credit

     (4,175

Deferred income tax

     19,483   

Accrual for post retirement plans and pension

     2,214   

Derivative financial instruments

     729   

Translation (gain) loss

     (574

Change in operating assets and liabilities:

  

Derivative financial instruments

     1,416   

Accounts receivable

     (3,176

Inventories

     (7,343

Prepaid expenses

     734   

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities

     (21,534

Other long-term liabilities

     (146
        

Net cash provided by operating activities

   $ 79,287   
        

(19) Contingencies and Commitments

The Company has the following contingencies and commitments:

 

  (a)   There is an agreement with a related party to solicit bids for the supply of certain parts and accessories required by the Company. This agreement establishes that if the Company is required to purchase Japanese origin parts and accessories, they will be purchased from this related party, if the costs are similar to those available from a third party.

 

  (b)   In accordance with the tax law in force, the tax authorities have the right to review up to the five tax periods prior to the last income tax return filed.

 

  (c)   According to the Income Tax Law in Mexico, companies carrying out operations with related parties, residing in the country or abroad, are subject to tax limitations and obligations, regarding the determination of agreed-upon prices, since they must be equivalent to those that would be used with or between independent parties in comparable operations.

 

         In case the tax authorities review the prices and reject the determined amounts, they could demand, besides collection of corresponding tax and other assessments (interest and late charges), fines over the assessed deficiency, which could reach up to 100% of the calculated amount of the deficient contributions.

 

F-99


Table of Contents

            Shares

LOGO

Tower International, Inc.

Common Stock

 

 

PROSPECTUS

 

 

Goldman, Sachs & Co.

Citi

J.P. Morgan

Wells Fargo Securities

Baird

Lazard Capital Markets

                    , 2010


Table of Contents

PART II

INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

 

Item 13: Other Expenses of Issuance and Distribution

The following table sets forth the expenses (other than the underwriting discount and commissions) expected to be incurred by the registrant while issuing and distributing the securities registered pursuant to this Registration Statement. All amounts (other than the SEC registration fee, FINRA filing fee and the New York Stock Exchange listing fee) are estimates.

 

Registration fee

   $ 7,130

FINRA filing fee

     10,500

New York Stock Exchange listing fee

     *

Legal fees and expenses

     *

Accounting fees and expenses

     *

Printing and engraving

     *

Transfer agent fees

     *

Miscellaneous

     *
      

Total

   $ *      
      

 

* To be completed by amendment.

 

Item 14: Indemnification of Directors and Officers

Section 145 of the Delaware General Corporation Law permits indemnification of the registrant’s officers and directors under certain conditions and subject to certain limitations. Section 145 of the Delaware General Corporation Law also provides that a corporation has the power to purchase and maintain insurance on behalf of its officers and directors against any liability asserted against such person and incurred by him or her in such capacity, or arising out of his or her status as such, whether or not the corporation would have the power to indemnify him or her against such liability under the provisions of Section 145 of the Delaware General Corporation Law.

Article VII of the registrant’s bylaws provides that the registrant will indemnify its directors and officers to the fullest extent authorized by law. The rights to indemnity thereunder continue as to a person who has ceased to be a director, officer, employee or agent and inure to the benefit of the heirs, executors and administrators of the person. In addition, expenses incurred by a director or officer in defending any civil or criminal action, suit or proceeding by reason of the fact that he or she is or was a director or officer of the registrant (or was serving at the registrant’s request as a director, officer employee or agent of another entity) will be paid by the registrant in advance of the final disposition of such action, suit or proceeding upon receipt of an undertaking by or on behalf of such director or officer to repay such amount if it shall ultimately be determined that he or she is not entitled to be indemnified by the registrant as authorized by the registrant’s bylaws.

As permitted by Section 102(b)(7) of the Delaware General Corporation Law, Article VII of the registrant’s certificate of incorporation provides that a director of the registrant will not be personally liable for monetary damages for breach of fiduciary duty as a director, except for liability (i) for any breach of the director’s duty of loyalty to the registrant or its stockholders, (ii) for acts or omissions not in good faith or which involve intentional misconduct or a knowing violation of law, (iii) under Section 174 of the Delaware General Corporation Law or (iv) for any transaction from which the director derived an improper personal benefit.

 

II-1


Table of Contents

The registrant has purchased directors’ and officers’ liability insurance. The registrant believes that this insurance is necessary to attract and retain qualified directors and officers.

The underwriting agreement (Exhibit 1.1 hereto) contains provisions by which the underwriter has agreed to indemnify the registrant, each person, if any, who controls the registrant within the meaning of Section 15 of the Securities Act, each director of the registrant, and each officer of the registrant who signs this registration statement, with respect to information furnished in writing by or on behalf of the underwriters for use in the registration statement.

The indemnification agreement for our directors and officers (Exhibit 10.24 hereto) provides that the registrant shall indemnify the director or officer party to each such agreement to the fullest extent permitted by law against all expenses, judgments, liabilities, fines, penalties and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably incurred by such person, or on his or her behalf, in connection with any proceeding or any action, discovery, event, claim, issue or matter therein or related thereto, if such person acted in good faith and in a manner he reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the registrant and, in the case of a criminal proceeding, in addition, had no reasonable cause to believe that his or her conduct was unlawful.

 

Item 15: Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities

Set forth below is information regarding all unregistered securities sold, issued or granted by us within the past three years.

Preferred Units

On August 1, 2007 the Company issued 10,000 preferred membership interests (“Preferred Units”) to funds and accounts associated with Cerberus Capital Management, L.P. (collectively, “Cerberus”) in respect of capital contributions made by Cerberus in the aggregate amount of $213,750,000.

The issuances and sales of our Preferred Units described above were exempt from the registration requirements of the Securities Act pursuant to Section 4(2) thereof promulgated thereunder because the transactions were by an issuer not involving a public offering.

Common Units, Management Incentive Units and Common Stock

Securities Act Section 4(2):

On August 1, 2007 the Company issued 8,500 common membership interests (“Common Units”) to Cerberus in respect of capital contributions made by Cerberus in the aggregate amount of $11.3 million.

In January 2008 the Company issued 1,500 management incentive interests (“MIP Units”) to Tower Automotive Management, LLC (“Tower Management”).

Tower Management sold 300 management incentive interests (“Management MIP Units”) to Mark Malcolm on January 2, 2008 for $150,000.

Tower Management sold 100 Management MIP Units to James Gouin on January 4, 2008 for $50,000.

Tower Management sold 175 Management MIP Units to Michael Rajkovic on January 2, 2008 for $87,500.

Tower Management sold 100 Management MIP Units to William Pumphrey on January 9, 2008 for $50,000.

 

II-2


Table of Contents

Tower Management sold 100 Management MIP Units to Dr. Gyula Meleghy on January 8, 2008 for $50,000.

Tower Management sold 50 MIP Management MIP Units to William Cook on January 3, 2008 for $25,000.

Tower Management sold 50 Management MIP Units to Paul Radoski on January 7, 2008 for $25,000.

Tower Management sold 50 Management MIP Units to Jeffrey Kersten on January 9, 2008 for $25,000.

Tower Management sold 300 Management MIP Units to Eagle Trust, LLC on December 19, 2007 for $150,000.

Tower Management sold 150 Management MIP Units to MGT4VALUE, LLC on December 17, 2007 for $75,000.

Tower Management sold 50 Management MIP Units to Rande Somma on January 16, 2008 for $25,000.

Tower Management sold 20 Management MIP Units to Thomas Hagan on December 20, 2007 for $10,000.

Tower Management sold 20 Management MIP Units to Timothy Crimmins on December 20, 2007 for $10,000.

On August 12, 2010, the Preferred Units, Common Units and MIP Units were converted into capital units. In connection with the notes offering described herein, Cerberus caused one of its affiliates to cancel $25 million aggregate principal amount of first lien term loans in exchange for an equity interest in the registrant. Such interest will represent an interest in the capital units held by Cerberus. In connection with the corporate conversion to occur immediately prior to consummation of this offering, each of the holders of capital units will contribute such units to Tower International Holdings, LLC, the registrant will convert from a limited liability company to a Delaware corporation and the registrant will issue shares of its common stock to Tower International Holdings, LLC. Immediately prior to the consummation of this offering, Tower International Holdings, LLC will own all of the registrant’s outstanding shares of common stock.

The issuances and sales of the registrant’s Common Units, MIP Units, Management MIP Units, capital units and common stock described above were exempt from the registration requirements of the Securities Act pursuant to Section 4(2) thereof promulgated thereunder because the transactions were by an issuer not involving a public offering.

 

II-3


Table of Contents
Item 16: Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

 

  (a) Exhibits

 

No.

  

Description

  1.1*    Form of Underwriting Agreement
  2.1**    Asset Purchase Agreement, dated as of May 1, 2007, by and among Tower Automotive, Inc., a debtor-in-possession and certain of its subsidiaries, and Tower Automotive, LLC f/k/a TA Acquisition Company, LLC
  2.2**    Form of Contribution Agreement
  3.1**    Form of Certificate of Incorporation of Tower International, Inc.
  3.2**    Form of Bylaws of Tower International, Inc.
  4.1**    See Exhibits 3.1 and 3.2 for provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws of Tower International, Inc. defining the rights of holders of common stock of Tower International, Inc.
  4.2**    Specimen Stock Certificate
  4.3**    Form of Registration Rights Agreement between Tower International, Inc. and Tower International Holdings, LLC
  4.4    Indenture, dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc., as issuers, the guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, as trustee and collateral agent
  5.1*    Opinion of Lowenstein Sandler PC with respect to the validity of the securities offered
  8.1**    Tax Opinion of Lowenstein Sandler PC with respect to certain U.S. tax matters
10.1**    Revolving Credit and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007, by and among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the Guarantors named therein, the Lenders named therein and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Administrative Agent
10.2**    Amendment No. 1 to Revolving Credit and Guaranty Agreement, dated May 5, 2008, by and among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the Guarantors from time to time party thereto, the Lenders from time to time party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Administrative Agent
10.3    Amendment No. 2 to the Revolving Credit and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of August 4, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the guarantors from time to time party thereto, the lenders from time to time party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent
10.4**    First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007, by and among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, Tower Automotive Holding Europe B.V., the Guarantors named therein, the Lenders, named therein and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Agent
10.5**    Amendment No 1 to First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of December 24, 2007, by and among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, Tower Automotive Holding Europe B.V., the Guarantors named therein, the Lenders named therein and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Agent
10.6**    Amendment No 2 to First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of May 5, 2008, by and among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, Tower Automotive Holding Europe B.V., the Guarantors named therein, the Lenders named therein and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Agent
10.7**    Waiver and Amendment No 3 to First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement, April 1, 2009, by and among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, Tower Automotive Holding Europe B.V., the Guarantors named therein, the Lenders named therein and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Agent
10.8   

Amendment No. 4 to the First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings Europe B.V., the guarantors from time to time party thereto, the lenders from time to time party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.

 

II-4


Table of Contents
10.9   

Amended and Restated Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, among JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as representative with respect to certain agreements identified therein, Wilmington Trust FSB, as representative with respect to the notes agreement identified therein, each additional representative from time to time party thereto, Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the other loan parties party thereto and Tower Automotive, LLC

10.10   

Term Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, among JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as synthetic letter of credit facility agent, Wilmington Trust FSB, as notes collateral agent, each additional term agent from time to time party thereto, each grantor from time to time party thereto and Tower Automotive, LLC

10.11   

Amended and Restated ABL Security Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the guarantors party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent

10.12   

Amended and Restated First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the guarantors party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent

10.13   

Notes Security Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, TA Holdings Finance, Inc., the subsidiary guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, as collateral agent

10.14   

Intentionally omitted.

10.15   

Intentionally omitted.

10.16   

Intentionally omitted.

10.17**    Employment Agreement with James Gouin (filed as Exhibit 10.25 to this registration statement as originally filed on March 4, 2010)
10.18**    Employment Agreement with Mark Malcolm (filed as Exhibit 10.26 to this registration statement as originally filed on March 4, 2010)
10.19**    Employment Agreement with Michael Rajkovic (filed as Exhibit 10.27 to this registration statement as originally filed on March 4, 2010)
10.20**    Employment Agreement with William Cook (filed as Exhibit 10.28 to this registration statement as originally filed on March 4, 2010)
10.21**    Employment Agreement with Gyula Meleghy (filed as Exhibit 10.29 to this registration statement as originally filed on March 4, 2010)
10.22**    Compensation Agreement with William Pumphrey (filed as Exhibit 10.30 to this registration statement as originally filed on March 4, 2010)
10.23**    Compensation Agreement with Paul Radkoski (filed as Exhibit 10.31 to this registration statement as originally filed on March 4, 2010)
10.24**   

Form of Indemnification Agreement

10.25**    Service Agreement with Rande Somma & Associates LLC (filed as Exhibit 10.33 to this registration statement as originally filed on March 4, 2010)
10.26**    Service Agreement with Larry Schwentor and MGT4VALUE LLC (filed as Exhibit 10.34 to this registration statement as originally filed on March 4, 2010)
10.27*    Second Amended and Restated Value Creation Plan of Tower Automotive, LLC
10.28**    Form of 2010 Equity Incentive Plan
10.29*    Form of Restricted Stock Award Agreement
10.30*    Form of Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement
10.31*    Form of Nonqualified Stock Option Grant Agreement

 

II-5


Table of Contents
10.32*    Form of Incentive Stock Option Grant Agreement
10.33**    Tower Management, LLC 2007 Management Incentive Plan
10.34*    Form of Award Letter, Tower Automotive, LLC Supplemental Value Creation Program
10.35**    Form of Award Letter, Tower Automotive, LLC 2010 Long-Term Incentive Program
10.36*    Form of Award Letter, Tower Automotive, LLC Special Incentive Program
10.37†**    Lease Agreement, dated as of April 10, 2002, by and among Module (DE) Limited Partnership, Tower Automotive Products Company, Inc. and Tower Automotive Tool LLC
10.38**    Amendment No. 1 to Lease Agreement, dated as of November 15, 2002, by and among Module (DE) Limited Partnership, Tower Automotive Products Company, Inc. and Tower Automotive Tool LLC
10.39†**    Amendment No. 2 to Lease Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007, by and among Module (DE) Limited Partnership, Tower Automotive Products Company, Inc. and Tower Automotive Tool LLC
10.40†**    Lease Agreement, dated as of April 10, 2002, by and among Chassis (DE) Limited Partnership, Tower Automotive Products Company, Inc. and Tower Automotive Tool LLC
10.41**    Amendment No. 1 to Lease Agreement, dated as of October 9, 2002, by and among Chassis (DE) Limited Partnership, Tower Automotive Products Company, Inc. and Tower Automotive Tool LLC
10.42†**    Amendment No. 2 to Lease Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007, by and among Chassis (DE) Limited Partnership, Tower Automotive Products Company, Inc. and Tower Automotive Tool LLC
10.43**    Unit Sale and Purchase Agreement of Mark Malcolm
10.44**    Unit Sale and Purchase Agreement of James Gouin
10.45**    Unit Sale and Purchase Agreement of Michael Rajkovic
10.46**    Unit Sale and Purchase Agreement of William Pumphrey
10.47**    Unit Sale and Purchase Agreement of Gyula Meleghy
10.48**    Unit Sale and Purchase Agreement of Rande Somma and Associates LLC
10.49**    Unit Sale and Purchase Agreement of MGT4VALUE LLC
10.50**    Letter Agreement Amendment to Employment Agreement, dated as of May 27, 2010, between Tower Automotive, LLC and Mark Malcolm.
10.51**    Letter Agreement Amendment to Employment Agreement, dated as of June 1, 2010, between Tower Automotive, LLC and Michael Rajkovic.
10.52**    Letter Agreement Amendment to Employment Agreement, dated as of June 1, 2010, between Tower Automotive, LLC and James Gouin.
10.53*    Form of Amendment to Form of Award Letter, Tower Automotive, LLC 2010 Long-Term Incentive Program
10.54*    Form of Award Letter, Tower Automotive, LLC Special Incentive Program
21.1**    List of subsidiaries of Tower International, Inc.
23.1    Consent of Deloitte and Touche LLP
23.2    Consent of KPMG Cárdenas Dosal, S.C.
23.3*    Consent of Lowenstein Sandler PC (to be included in Exhibit 5.1)
23.4**    Consent of Lowenstein Sandler PC (included in Exhibit 8.1)

 

II-6


Table of Contents
24.1**    Power of Attorney of Mark Malcolm, James Gouin, Jeffrey L. Kersten, Dev Kapadia, Larry Schwentor and Rande Somma
24.2    Power of Attorney of Nicholas Chabraja
24.3    Power of Attorney of Dennis Donovan
24.4    Power of Attorney of Frank English, Jr.
24.5    Power of Attorney of Allan Gilmour
24.6    Power of Attorney of Chan Galbato
99.1**    Consent of Dennis Donovan
99.2**    Consent of Frank E. English, Jr.
99.3**    Consent of Allan Gilmour
99.4**    Consent of Chan Galbato

 

 

* To be filed by amendment
** Previously filed
Confidential treatment has been requested for certain provisions of this Exhibit pursuant to Rule 406 promulgated under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

 

(b) Financial Statement Schedules:

Below is Schedule II, Schedule of Valuation and Qualifying Accounts. All other consolidated financial statement schedules are omitted because they are not applicable or the information is included in the consolidated financial statements or related notes.

SCHEDULE II

Valuation and Qualifying Accounts for the years ended December 31, 2009, 2008, and 2007 (in thousands)

 

Column A

  Column B     Column C     Column D     Column E
            Additions            

Description

  Balance at
Beginning of
Year
    Charged to
Costs and
Expenses
    Charged to
Other
Accounts
    Deductions     Balance at
End of Year

Year Ended December 31, 2009

         

Allowance for doubtful accounts

  $ 3,974      $ 930      $ —        $ (2,465 )(a)    $ 2,439

Deferred tax asset valuation allowance

    170,093        19,496        (17,231     —          172,358

Year Ended December 31, 2008

         

Allowance for doubtful accounts

    4,890        3,124        —          (4,040 )(a)      3,974

Deferred tax asset valuation allowance

    125,530        28,073        16,490 (c)      —          170,093

Successor–August 1, 2007 through
December 31, 2007

         

Allowance for doubtful accounts

    3,758        1,378        —          (246 )(a)      4,890

Deferred tax asset valuation allowance

    85,799 (d)      39,731        —          —          125,530

Predecessor–January 1, 2007 through
July 31, 2007

         

Allowance for doubtful accounts

    4,750        899        —          (1,891 )(a)      3,758

Deferred tax asset valuation allowance

    427,819        (17,424     (370,783 )(b)      —          39,612

 

(a) Write off of uncollectible accounts
(b) Discharge of debt charged to Post Consummation Trust
(c) Currency translation adjustment and other comprehensive income
(d) Beginning balance does not tie to prior ending balance due to purchase accounting adjustments

 

II-7


Table of Contents
Item 17: Undertakings

(a) The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes to provide to the underwriter at the closing specified in the underwriting agreements, certificates in such denominations and registered in such names as required by the underwriters to permit prompt delivery to each purchaser.

(b) Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the Registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the Registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the Registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the Registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the Registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.

(c) The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes that:

(1) For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part of this registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of prospectus filed by the Registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities Act will be deemed to be part of this registration statement as of the time it was declared effective.

(2) For the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time will be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

 

II-8


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, the registrant has duly caused this Amendment No. 6 to the registrant’s registration statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the city of Livonia and state of Michigan, on the 7 th day of September, 2010.

 

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC
By:  

/ S /    J AMES G OUIN

Name:   James Gouin
Title:   Executive Vice President and
Chief Financial Officer

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, this Amendment No. 6 to the registrant’s registration statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

 

Signature

 

Title

 

Date

/ S /    M ARK M ALCOLM *        

Mark Malcolm

 

Chief Executive Officer and Director

(Principal Executive Officer)

  September 7, 2010

/ S /    J AMES G OUIN        

James Gouin

 

Executive Vice President and
Chief Financial Officer

(Principal Financial Officer)

 

September 7, 2010

/ S /    J EFFREY L. K ERSTEN *        

Jeffrey L. Kersten

 

Senior Vice President and Corporate

Controller

(Principal Accounting Officer)

 

September 7, 2010

/ S /    N ICHOLAS C HABRAJA *        

Nicholas Chabraja

 

Director

 

September 7, 2010

/ S /    D ENNIS D ONOVAN *

Dennis Donovan

 

Director

 

September 7, 2010

/ S /    F RANK E NGLISH , J R .*        

Frank S. English

 

Director

 

September 7, 2010

/ S /    C HAN G ALBATO *        

Chan Galbato

 

Director

 

September 7, 2010

/ S /    A LLAN G ILMOUR *        

Allan Gilmour

 

Director

 

September 7, 2010

/ S /    D EV K APADIA *        

Dev Kapadia

 

Director

 

September 7, 2010

/ S /    L ARRY S CHWENTOR *        

Larry Schwentor

 

Director

 

September 7, 2010

/ S /    R ANDE S OMMA *        

Rande Somma

 

Director

 

September 7, 2010

 

*By  

/ S /    J AMES G OUIN        

   

James Gouin

Attorney-in-Fact

 

II-9


Table of Contents

EXHIBIT INDEX

 

No.

  

Description

  1.1*    Form of Underwriting Agreement
  2.1**    Asset Purchase Agreement, dated as of May 1, 2007, by and among Tower Automotive, Inc., a debtor-in-possession and certain of its subsidiaries, and Tower Automotive, LLC f/k/a TA Acquisition Company, LLC
  2.2**    Form of Contribution Agreement
  3.1**    Form of Certificate of Incorporation of Tower International, Inc.
  3.2**    Form of Bylaws of Tower International, Inc.
  4.1**    See Exhibits 3.1 and 3.2 for provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws of Tower International, Inc. defining the rights of holders of common stock of Tower International, Inc.
  4.2**    Specimen Stock Certificate
  4.3**    Form of Registration Rights Agreement between Tower International, Inc. and Tower International Holdings, LLC
  4.4    Indenture, dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc., as issuers, the guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, as trustee and collateral agent
  5.1*    Opinion of Lowenstein Sandler PC with respect to the validity of the securities offered
  8.1**    Tax Opinion of Lowenstein Sandler PC with respect to certain U.S. tax matters
10.1**    Revolving Credit and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007, by and among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the Guarantors named therein, the Lenders named therein and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Administrative Agent
10.2**    Amendment No. 1 to Revolving Credit and Guaranty Agreement, dated May 5, 2008, by and among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the Guarantors from time to time party thereto, the Lenders from time to time party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Administrative Agent
10.3   

Amendment No. 2 to the Revolving Credit and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of August 4, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the guarantors from time to time party thereto, the lenders from time to time party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent

10.4**    First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007, by and among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, Tower Automotive Holding Europe B.V., the Guarantors named therein, the Lenders, named therein and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Agent
10.5**    Amendment No 1 to First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of December 24, 2007, by and among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, Tower Automotive Holding Europe B.V., the Guarantors named therein, the Lenders named therein and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Agent
10.6**    Amendment No 2 to First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of May 5, 2008, by and among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, Tower Automotive Holding Europe B.V., the Guarantors named therein, the Lenders named therein and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Agent
10.7**    Waiver and Amendment No 3 to First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement, April 1, 2009, by and among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, Tower Automotive Holding Europe B.V., the Guarantors named therein, the Lenders named therein and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Agent
10.8   

Amendment No. 4 to the First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings Europe B.V., the guarantors from time to time party thereto, the lenders from time to time party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.

10.9   

Amended and Restated Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, among JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as representative with respect to certain agreements identified therein, Wilmington Trust FSB, as representative with respect to the notes agreement identified therein, each additional representative from time to time party thereto, Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the other loan parties party thereto and Tower Automotive, LLC


Table of Contents
10.10   

Term Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, among JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as synthetic letter of credit facility agent, Wilmington Trust FSB, as notes collateral agent, each additional term agent from time to time party thereto, each grantor from time to time party thereto and Tower Automotive, LLC

10.11   

Amended and Restated ABL Security Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the guarantors party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent

10.12   

Amended and Restated First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the guarantors party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent

10.13    Notes Security Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, TA Holdings Finance, Inc., the subsidiary guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, as collateral agent
10.14    Intentionally omitted.
10.15    Intentionally omitted.
10.16    Intentionally omitted.
10.17**    Employment Agreement with James Gouin (filed as Exhibit 10.25 to this registration statement as originally filed on March 4, 2010)
10.18**    Employment Agreement with Mark Malcolm (filed as Exhibit 10.26 to this registration statement as originally filed on March 4, 2010)
10.19**    Employment Agreement with Michael Rajkovic (filed as Exhibit 10.27 to this registration statement as originally filed on March 4, 2010)
10.20**    Employment Agreement with William Cook (filed as Exhibit 10.28 to this registration statement as originally filed on March 4, 2010)
10.21**    Employment Agreement with Gyula Meleghy (filed as Exhibit 10.29 to this registration statement as originally filed on March 4, 2010)
10.22**    Compensation Agreement with William Pumphrey (filed as Exhibit 10.30 to this registration statement as originally filed on March 4, 2010)
10.23**    Compensation Agreement with Paul Radkoski (filed as Exhibit 10.31 to this registration statement as originally filed on March 4, 2010)
10.24**   

Form of Indemnification Agreement

10.25**    Service Agreement with Rande Somma & Associates LLC (filed as Exhibit 10.33 to this registration statement as originally filed on March 4, 2010)
10.26**    Service Agreement with Larry Schwentor and MGT4VALUE LLC (filed as Exhibit 10.34 to this registration statement as originally filed on March 4, 2010)
10.27*    Second Amended and Restated Value Creation Plan of Tower Automotive, LLC
10.28**    Form of 2010 Equity Incentive Plan
10.29*    Form of Restricted Stock Award Agreement
10.30*    Form of Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement
10.31*    Form of Nonqualified Stock Option Grant Agreement
10.32*    Form of Incentive Stock Option Grant Agreement
10.33**    Tower Management, LLC 2007 Management Incentive Plan
10.34*    Form of Award Letter, Tower Automotive, LLC Supplemental Value Creation Program
10.35**    Form of Award Letter, Tower Automotive, LLC 2010 Long-Term Incentive Program


Table of Contents
10.36*    Form of Award Letter, Tower Automotive, LLC Special Incentive Program
10.37†**    Lease Agreement, dated as of April 10, 2002, by and among Module (DE) Limited Partnership, Tower Automotive Products Company, Inc. and Tower Automotive Tool LLC
10.38**    Amendment No. 1 to Lease Agreement, dated as of November 15, 2002, by and among Module (DE) Limited Partnership, Tower Automotive Products Company, Inc. and Tower Automotive Tool LLC
10.39†**    Amendment No. 2 to Lease Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007, by and among Module (DE) Limited Partnership, Tower Automotive Products Company, Inc. and Tower Automotive Tool LLC
10.40†**    Lease Agreement, dated as of April 10, 2002, by and among Chassis (DE) Limited Partnership, Tower Automotive Products Company, Inc. and Tower Automotive Tool LLC
10.41**    Amendment No. 1 to Lease Agreement, dated as of October 9, 2002, by and among Chassis (DE) Limited Partnership, Tower Automotive Products Company, Inc. and Tower Automotive Tool LLC
10.42†**    Amendment No. 2 to Lease Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007, by and among Chassis (DE) Limited Partnership, Tower Automotive Products Company, Inc. and Tower Automotive Tool LLC
10.43**    Unit Sale and Purchase Agreement of Mark Malcolm
10.44**    Unit Sale and Purchase Agreement of James Gouin
10.45**    Unit Sale and Purchase Agreement of Michael Rajkovic
10.46**    Unit Sale and Purchase Agreement of William Pumphrey
10.47**    Unit Sale and Purchase Agreement of Gyula Meleghy
10.48**    Unit Sale and Purchase Agreement of Rande Somma and Associates LLC
10.49**    Unit Sale and Purchase Agreement of MGT4VALUE LLC
10.50**    Letter Agreement Amendment to Employment Agreement, dated as of May 27, 2010, between Tower Automotive, LLC and Mark Malcolm.
10.51**    Letter Agreement Amendment to Employment Agreement, dated as of June 1, 2010, between Tower Automotive, LLC and Michael Rajkovic.
10.52**    Letter Agreement Amendment to Employment Agreement, dated as of June 1, 2010, between Tower Automotive, LLC and James Gouin.
10.53*    Form of Amendment to Form of Award Letter, Tower Automotive, LLC 2010 Long-Term Incentive Program
10.54*    Form of Award Letter, Tower Automotive, LLC Special Incentive Program
21.1**    List of subsidiaries of Tower International, Inc.
23.1    Consent of Deloitte and Touche LLP
23.2    Consent of KPMG Cárdenas Dosal, S.C.
23.3*    Consent of Lowenstein Sandler PC (to be included in Exhibit 5.1)
23.4**    Consent of Lowenstein Sandler PC (included in Exhibit 8.1)
24.1**    Power of Attorney of Mark Malcolm, James Gouin, Jeffrey L. Kersten, Dev Kapadia, Larry Schwentor and Rande Somma
24.2    Power of Attorney of Nicholas Chabraja
24.3    Power of Attorney of Dennis Donovan


Table of Contents
24.4    Power of Attorney of Frank English, Jr.
24.5    Power of Attorney of Allan Gilmour
24.6    Power of Attorney of Chan Galbato
99.1**   

Power of Attorney of Dennis Donovan

99.2**   

Power of Attorney of Frank English, Jr.

99.3**   

Power of Attorney of Allan Gilmour

99.4**   

Power of Attorney of Chan Galbato

 

* To be filed by amendment
** Previously filed
Confidential treatment has been requested for certain provisions of this Exhibit pursuant to Rule 406 promulgated under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

Exhibit 4.4

 

 

 

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC

and

TA HOLDINGS FINANCE, INC.,

as Issuers,

the Guarantors party hereto

and

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB

as Trustee and Collateral Agent

 

 

Indenture

Dated as of August 24, 2010

 

 

10.625%

Senior Secured Notes

Due 2017

 

 

 


CROSS-REFERENCE TABLE

 

TIA Sections

  

Indenture Sections

§310   (a)    7.10
  (b)    7.08
§311      7.03
§312      12.02
§313      7.06
§314   (a)    4, 4.02
  (c)    12.04
  (e)    12.05
§315   (a)    7.01, 7.02
  (b)    7.02, 7.05
  (c)    7.01
  (d)    7.02
  (e)    6.12, 7.02
§316   (a)    2.05, 6.02, 6.04, 6.05
  (b)    6.06, 6.07
  (c)    12.02
§317   (a) (1)    6.08
  (a) (2)    6.09
  (b)    2.03
§318      12.01

 

2


RECITALS

 

ARTICLE 1
D EFINITIONS AND I NCORPORATION BY R EFERENCE
Section 1.01.    Definitions    2
Section 1.02 .    Other Definitions    46
Section 1.03.    Rules of Construction    47
ARTICLE 2
T HE N OTES
Section 2.01 .    Form, Dating and Denominations; Legends    47
Section 2.02.    Execution and Authentication; Additional Notes    48
Section 2.03.    Registrar, Paying Agent and Authenticating Agent; Paying Agent to Hold Money in Trust    49
Section 2.04.    Replacement Notes    50
Section 2.05.    Outstanding Notes    51
Section 2.06 .    Temporary Notes    52
Section 2.07 .    Cancellation    52
Section 2.08 .    CUSIP and CINS Numbers    52
Section 2.09 .    Registration, Transfer and Exchange    52
Section 2.10.    Restrictions on Transfer and Exchange    56
Section 2.11.    Temporary Offshore Global Notes    58
ARTICLE 3
R EDEMPTION ; O FFER TO P URCHASE
Section 3.01 .    Optional Redemption    59
Section 3.02 .    Redemption With Proceeds of Public Equity Offering    59
Section 3.03 .    105% Redemptions    60
Section 3.04 .    Make-whole Redemptions    60
Section 3.05 .    Method and Effect of Redemption    61
Section 3.06 .    Offer to Purchase    63
ARTICLE 4
C OVENANTS
Section 4.01.    Payment of Notes    65
Section 4.02 .    Maintenance of Office or Agency    66
Section 4.03 .    Existence    66
Section 4.04 .    Payment of Taxes and other Claims    66
Section 4.05 .    Maintenance of Properties and Insurance    67
Section 4.06.    Limitation on Indebtedness    67
Section 4.07 .    Limitation on Restricted Payments    72

 

3


Section 4.08.    Limitation on Liens    79
Section 4.09.    Limitation on Sale and Leaseback Transactions    79
Section 4.10.    Limitation on Restrictions on Distributions from Restricted Subsidiaries    80
Section 4.11 .    Change of Control    82
Section 4.12 .    Limitation on Sales of Assets and Subsidiary Stock    84
Section 4.13.    Limitation on Transactions with Affiliates    88
Section 4.14 .    Future Subsidiary Guarantors    91
Section 4.15 .    Suspension of Certain Covenants    91
Section 4.16 .    SEC Reports    93
Section 4.17.    Reports to Trustee    94
ARTICLE 5
M ERGER AND C ONSOLIDATION
Section 5.01.    Merger and Consolidation    95
ARTICLE 6
D EFAULT AND R EMEDIES
Section 6.01.    Events of Default    98
Section 6.02 .    Acceleration    100
Section 6.03.    Other Remedies    101
Section 6.04.    Waiver of Past Defaults    101
Section 6.05.    Control by Majority    101
Section 6.06.    Limitation on Suits    101
Section 6.07.    Rights of Holders to Receive Payment    102
Section 6.08.    Collection Suit by Trustee    102
Section 6.09.    Trustee May File Proofs of Claim    102
Section 6.10.    Priorities    103
Section 6.11.    Restoration of Rights and Remedies    103
Section 6.12.    Undertaking for Costs    103
Section 6.13.    Rights and Remedies Cumulative    103
Section 6.14.    Delay or Omission Not Waiver    104
Section 6.15.    Waiver of Stay, Extension or Usury Laws    104
ARTICLE 7
T HE T RUSTEE
Section 7.01.    General    104
Section 7.02.    Certain Rights of Trustee    105
Section 7.03.    Individual Rights of Trustee    107
Section 7.04.    Trustee’s Disclaimer    107
Section 7.05.    Notice of Default    107
Section 7.06.    Reports by Trustee to Holders    107
Section 7.07.    Compensation and Indemnity    108

 

4


Section 7.08.    Replacement of Trustee    108
Section 7.09.    Successor Trustee by Merger    109
Section 7.10.    Eligibility    109
Section 7.11.    Money Held in Trust    110
ARTICLE 8
D EFEASANCE AND D ISCHARGE
Section 8.01.    Discharge of Issuers’ Obligations    110
Section 8.02.    Legal Defeasance    111
Section 8.03.    Covenant Defeasance    113
Section 8.04.    Application of Trust Money    113
Section 8.05.    Repayment to the Issuers    114
Section 8.06.    Reinstatement    114
ARTICLE 9
A MENDMENTS , S UPPLEMENTS AND W AIVERS
Section 9.01.    Amendments Without Consent of Holders    114
Section 9.02.    Amendments With Consent of Holders    116
Section 9.03.    Effect of Consent    117
Section 9.04.    Trustee’s Rights and Obligations    118
Section 9.05.    Conformity With TIA    118
Section 9.06.    Payments for Consents    118
ARTICLE 10
S ECURITY I NTEREST
Section 10.01.    Grant of Security Interest    119
Section 10.02.    Release of Security Interest    121
Section 10.03.    Pledge of Additional Collateral, Etc    122
Section 10.04.    Collateral Agent    122
Section 10.05.    Replacement of Collateral Agent    123
Section 10.06.    Ranking    123
Section 10.07.    Notes Obligations Not Subordinated    124
ARTICLE 11
N OTES G UARANTEES
Section 11.01.    The Notes Guarantees    124
Section 11.02.    Notes Guarantee Unconditional    125
Section 11.03.    Discharge; Reinstatement    125
Section 11.04.    Waiver by the Guarantors    126
Section 11.05.    Subrogation and Contribution    126
Section 11.06.    Stay of Acceleration    126
Section 11.07.    Limitation on Amount of Notes Guarantee    126

 

5


Section 11.08.    Execution and Delivery of Notes Guarantee    126
Section 11.09.    Release of Notes Guarantee    127
ARTICLE 12
M ISCELLANEOUS
Section 12.01.    TIA    127
Section 12.02.    Noteholder Communications; Noteholder Actions    128
Section 12.03.    Notices    128
Section 12.04.    Certificate and Opinion as to Conditions Precedent    130
Section 12.05.    Statements Required in Certificate or Opinion    130
Section 12.06.    Payment Date Other Than a Business Day    131
Section 12.07.    Governing Law    131
Section 12.08.    No Adverse Interpretation of Other Agreements    131
Section 12.09.    Successors    131
Section 12.10.    Duplicate Originals    131
Section 12.11.    Separability    131
Section 12.12.    Table of Contents and Headings    131
Section 12.13.    No Liability of Directors, Officers, Employees, Incorporators, Members and Stockholders    131

 

6


EXHIBITS   
EXHIBIT A    Form of Note
EXHIBIT B    Form of Supplemental Indenture
EXHIBIT C    Restricted Legend
EXHIBIT D    DTC Legend
EXHIBIT E    OID Legend
EXHIBIT F    Regulation S Certificate
EXHIBIT G    Rule 144A Certificate
EXHIBIT H    Institutional Accredited Investor Certificate
EXHIBIT I    Certificate of Beneficial Ownership
EXHIBIT J    Temporary Offshore Global Note Legend

 

7


INDENTURE, dated as of August 24, 2010, between Tower Automotive USA Holdings, LLC, a limited liability company organized under the laws of Delaware, and TA Holdings Finance, Inc., a Delaware corporation, as issuers (collectively, the “ Issuers ”), the Guarantors party hereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, as trustee (in such capacity, the “ Trustee ”) and collateral agent (in such capacity, the “ Collateral Agent ”).

RECITALS

The Issuers have duly authorized the execution and delivery of this Indenture to provide for the issuance of $430,000,000 in aggregate principal amount of the Issuers’ 10.625% Senior Secured Notes Due 2017, and, if and when issued, any Additional Notes as provided in this Indenture (the “ Notes ”). All things necessary to make this Indenture a valid agreement of the Issuers, in accordance with its terms, have been done, and the Issuers have done all things necessary to make the Notes (and in the case of any Additional Notes, when duly authorized), when executed by the Issuers and authenticated and delivered by the Trustee and duly issued by the Issuers, the valid obligations of the Issuers as hereinafter provided.

In addition, the Guarantors party hereto have duly authorized the execution and delivery of this Indenture as guarantors of the Notes. All things necessary to make this Indenture a valid agreement of each Guarantor, in accordance with its terms, have been done, and each Guarantor has done all things necessary to make the Notes Guarantees, when the Notes are executed by the Issuers and authenticated and delivered by the Trustee and duly issued by the Issuers, the valid obligations of such Guarantor as hereinafter provided.

This Indenture is subject to, and will be governed by, the provisions of the TIA that are required to be a part of and govern indentures qualified under the TIA, excluding Sections 314(b) and 314(d) thereof (so long as this Indenture is not qualified pursuant to the TIA).

THIS INDENTURE WITNESSETH

For and in consideration of the premises and the purchase of the Notes by the Holders thereof, the parties hereto covenant and agree, for the equal and proportionate benefit of all Holders, as follows:


ARTICLE 1

D EFINITIONS AND I NCORPORATION BY R EFERENCE

Section 1.01. Definitions .

ABL Agent ” means the representative(s) from time to time administrating the Collateral on behalf of the lenders under the ABL Facility. For the avoidance of doubt, to the extent that more than one Credit Facilities then constitute the ABL Facility, the term “ABL Agent” shall refer each of the respective representative(s) from time to time administrating the Collateral on behalf of the lenders under each such Credit Facility (or the authorized representative of such representatives).

ABL Facility ” means the Revolving Credit and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007, as amended, by and among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, as borrower, the Guarantors, as guarantors, the lenders party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Administrative Agent, as such agreement may be amended (including any amendment and restatement thereof), supplemented, replaced, renewed, refinanced, extended or otherwise modified from time to time. For avoidance of doubt, the term “ABL Facility” includes each Credit Facility that Refinances all or a portion of the ABL Facility (and any successive Refinancings thereof).

ABL Intercreditor Agreement ” means the Amended and Restated Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of the Issue Date, among the ABL Agent, on its own behalf and in its capacity as representative of the ABL Secured Parties, the Collateral Agent, on its own behalf and in its capacity as representative of the Notes Secured Parties, the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent, on its own behalf and in its capacity as representative of the Synthetic Letter of Credit Secured Parties, Parent, the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors, as amended, amended and restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.

ABL Obligations ” means (i) all Indebtedness and other Obligations under the ABL Facility, (ii) all Banking Services Obligations and (iii) all Secured Hedging Obligations.

ABL Obligations Liens ” means the Liens granted, or purported to be granted, pursuant to the ABL Obligations Security Documents securing any ABL Obligations.

ABL Obligations Security Documents ” means each agreement, document or instrument pursuant to which a Lien is granted or purported to be granted securing ABL Obligations or under which rights or remedies with respect to such Liens are governed, in each case to the extent relating to the Collateral securing ABL Obligations.

 

2


ABL Priority Collateral ” includes (i) all present and after-acquired Inventory, Accounts, related contracts and other rights, cash, Deposit Accounts, Securities Accounts, machinery and Equipment, together with all Proceeds of the foregoing (with each such capitalized term having the meaning set forth in the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect in the State of New York) but excluding the Term Proceeds Account and any cash or funds held in any Deposit or Securities Account that constitutes Proceeds of Term Priority Collateral and (ii) all interests in real property (including any fixtures attached thereto) to the extent that a Lien has been (or is hereafter) granted thereon by any Issuer or Subsidiary Guarantor to secure any Secured Obligations (including, as of the Issue Date, the Existing Real Property Collateral), in each case of the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors and subject to the exceptions set forth in the applicable Security Documents. For the avoidance of doubt, unless otherwise agreed by the requisite lenders under the Existing ABL Facility after the Issue Date, all “ABL Collateral” (as defined in the Existing Intercreditor Agreement) and the proceeds thereof shall continue to be included in the ABL Priority Collateral.

ABL Secured Parties ” means the holders of the ABL Obligations.

Additional Assets ” means:

(1) any property or assets (other than Indebtedness) to be used by an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary;

(2) the Capital Stock of a Person that becomes a Restricted Subsidiary as a result of the acquisition of such Capital Stock by an Issuer or another Restricted Subsidiary; or

(3) Capital Stock constituting a minority interest in any Person that at such time is a Restricted Subsidiary; provided , however , that any such Restricted Subsidiary described in clauses (2) or (3) above is primarily engaged in a Permitted Business.

Additional Notes ” means any Notes issued under this Indenture in addition to the Initial Notes, having identical terms and conditions to the Initial Notes, or identical to the Initial Notes in all respects except with respect to interest paid or payable on or prior to the first interest payment date after the issuance of such Notes.

Additional Term Obligations ” means any Term Obligations that are Incurred after the Issue Date (other than Indebtedness Incurred under the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility and Indebtedness in respect of Additional Notes) and secured by Liens on the Common Collateral which are pari passu with the Liens securing the Notes Obligations granted pursuant to the Security Documents.

 

3


Additional Term Secured Parties ” means the holders of the Additional Term Obligations.

Affiliate ” of any specified Person means any other Person, directly or indirectly, controlling or controlled by or under direct or indirect common control with such specified Person. For the purposes of this definition, “control” when used with respect to any Person means the power to direct the management and policies of such Person, directly or indirectly, whether through the ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise; and the terms “controlling” and “controlled” have meanings correlative to the foregoing.

Agent ” means any Registrar, Paying Agent or Authenticating Agent.

Agent Member ” means a member of, or a participant in, the Depositary.

Applicable Hedging Obligations ” means, with respect to any Person, all Obligations of such Person, whether absolute or contingent and howsoever and whensoever created, arising, evidenced or acquired (including all renewals, extensions and modifications thereof and substitutions therefor), under (a) any and all agreements with respect to any swap, forward, future or derivative transaction or option or similar agreement involving, or settled by reference to, one or more rates, currencies, commodities, equity or debt instruments or securities, or economic, financial or pricing indices or measures of economic, financial or pricing risk or value or any similar transaction or any combination of these transactions (other than any phantom stock or similar plan providing for payments only on account of services provided by current or former directors, officers, employees or consultants of any Issuer or any Subsidiary Guarantor) and (b) any and all cancellations, buy backs, reversals, terminations or assignments of any of the foregoing transactions.

Asset Disposition ” means any sale, lease, transfer or other disposition (or series of sales, leases, transfers or dispositions that are part of a common plan) by an Issuer, Parent, or any Subsidiary of Parent that owns any Capital Stock of a Restricted Subsidiary, (if involving (1) below) or any Restricted Subsidiary, including any disposition by means of a merger, consolidation, or similar transaction (each referred to for the purposes of this definition as a “ disposition ”), of:

(1) any shares of Capital Stock of an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary (other than directors’ qualifying shares or shares required by applicable law to be held by a Person other than Parent, an Issuer, or a Restricted Subsidiary),

(2) all or substantially all the assets of any division or line of business of any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary, or

 

4


(3) any other assets of any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary outside of the ordinary course of business of the Issuers or such Restricted Subsidiary,

other than, in the case of clauses (1), (2) and (3) above,

(A) a disposition by a Restricted Subsidiary to any of the Issuers or by any of the Issuers or a Restricted Subsidiary to a Restricted Subsidiary;

(B) for purposes of Section 4.12 only, a disposition subject to Section 4.07 or a Permitted Investment;

(C) a disposition of assets with a Fair Market Value of less than $10.0 million;

(D) a sale of accounts receivable and related assets pursuant to factoring programs on customary market terms for such transactions and with respect to receivables of, and generated by, a Foreign Subsidiary;

(E) any sale, lease, transfer or other disposition of assets of a Foreign Subsidiary of Parent (but not Capital Stock of a Foreign Subsidiary held by Parent) to Joint Ventures that are not Restricted Subsidiaries so long as such Foreign Subsidiary has received Fair Market Value for such assets;

(F) the exchange or transfer within China of Chinese Acceptance Notes by Chinese Subsidiaries of Parent;

(G) a disposition of all or substantially all the Issuers’ and the Restricted Subsidiaries’ assets (as determined on a Consolidated basis) in accordance with Article 5;

(H) sales or other dispositions of cash or Temporary Cash Investments;

(I) the sale and leaseback of any property, plant or equipment within 180 days after the acquisition or completion of construction of such property, plant or equipment or improvements thereto (or, if later, the commencement of commercial operation of any such property, plant or equipment), as the case may be, to finance the cost of such property, plant or equipment or such improvements, as the case may be;

(J) the sale or other disposition of obsolete or permanently retired equipment, and the sale or other disposition of

 

5


assets that, in the good faith judgment of the Board of Directors, are no longer used or useful in the business of the Issuers or the Restricted Subsidiaries;

(K) any trade-in of equipment in exchange for other equipment; provided that in the good faith judgment of the Board of Directors, such Issuer or such Restricted Subsidiary receives equipment having a Fair Market Value equal to or greater than the equipment being traded in;

(L) the concurrent sale (or exchange of assets of any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary) and receipt of Additional Assets to be acquired from another Person to the extent that the Additional Assets received by any Issuers or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries are of equivalent or better Fair Market Value than the assets disposed of in such transaction;

(M) the creation of a Lien (but not the sale or other disposition of the property subject to such Lien) in accordance with the provisions of this Indenture;

(N) any transfer, conveyance, sale or other disposition of property or assets consisting of auction rate securities for Fair Market Value; and

(O) the unwinding of any Hedging Obligations.

Attributable Debt ” means, with respect to any Sale and Leaseback Transaction that does not result in a Capitalized Lease Obligation, the present value (computed in accordance with GAAP) of the total obligations of the lessee for rental payments during the remaining term of the lease included in such Sale and Leaseback Transaction (including any period for which such lease has been extended). In the case of any lease which is terminable by the lessee upon payment of a penalty, the Attributable Debt shall be the lesser of:

(i) the Attributable Debt determined assuming termination upon the first date such lease may be terminated (in which case the Attributable Debt shall also include the amount of the penalty, but no rent shall be considered as required to be paid under such lease subsequent to the first date upon which it may be so terminated) and

(ii) the Attributable Debt determined assuming no such termination.

Authenticating Agent ” refers to a Person engaged to authenticate the Notes in the stead of the Trustee.

 

6


Authorized Representative ” means (a) in the case of any obligations under the First Lien Term Loan Agreement or the secured parties under the First Lien Term Loan Agreement, the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent, (b) in the case of the Notes Obligations, the Collateral Agent, (c) in the case of the ABL Facility, the ABL Agent and (d) in the case of any Series of Additional Term Obligations that become subject to the Term Intercreditor Agreement, the Authorized Representative named for such Series in the applicable joinder agreement.

Authorized Term Collateral Agent ” shall have the meaning ascribed to such term in the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

Average Life ” means, as of the date of determination, with respect to any Indebtedness or Preferred Stock, the quotient obtained by dividing:

(1) the sum of the products of the number of years from the date of determination to the dates of each successive scheduled principal payment of such Indebtedness or scheduled redemption or similar payment with respect to such Preferred Stock multiplied by the amount of such payment by

(2) the sum of all such payments.

Banking Services ” means each and any of the following bank services provided to any Issuer or any guarantor of the Obligations under the Existing ABL Facility or the First Lien Term Loan Agreement by any Person that is (i) a lender under the Existing ABL Facility or a holder of Obligations under the First Lien Term Loan Agreement or (ii) an Affiliate of a Person described in clause (i): (a) commercial credit cards, (b) stored value cards and (c) treasury management services (including, without limitation, controlled disbursement, automated clearinghouse transactions, return items, overdrafts and interstate depository network services).

Banking Services Obligations ” means any and all obligations, whether absolute or contingent and howsoever and whensoever created, arising, evidenced or acquired (including all renewals, extensions and modifications thereof and substitutions therefor) in connection with Banking Services.

Bankruptcy Code ” means the United States Bankruptcy Code (11 U.S.C. § 101 et seq.), as amended from time to time.

Board of Directors ” means: (a) with respect to an Issuer, its board of directors or, if any Issuers do not have a board of directors, the board of directors or managers of Parent, as the case may be; (b) with respect to Parent, its board of directors or managers, as the case may be; and (c) with respect to any other Person, (1) if the Person is a corporation, the board of directors of the corporation,

 

7


(2) if the Person is a partnership, the board of directors of the general partner of the partnership, (3) if the Person is a member managed limited liability company, the Board of Directors of its managing member, and (4) with respect to any other Person, the board or committee of such Person serving a similar function. Board of Directors shall also include any committee thereof duly authorized to act on behalf of the Board of Directors.

Business Day ” means each day which is not a Legal Holiday.

Capitalized Lease Obligations ” means an obligation that is required to be classified and accounted for as a capitalized lease for financial reporting purposes in accordance with GAAP, and the amount of Indebtedness represented by such obligation shall be the capitalized amount of such obligation determined in accordance with GAAP.

Capital Stock ” of any Person means any and all shares, interests, rights to purchase, warrants, options, participations or other equivalents of or interests in (however designated) equity of such Person, including any Preferred Stock, but excluding any debt securities convertible into such equity.

Certificate of Beneficial Ownership ” means a certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit H.

Certificated Note ” means a Note in registered individual form without interest coupons.

Chinese Acceptance Notes ” means acceptance notes issued by Chinese banks in the ordinary course of business for the account of any direct or indirect Chinese Subsidiary of Parent or customers thereof to effect the current payment of goods and services in accordance with customary trade terms in China.

Chinese Subsidiary ” means any Restricted Subsidiary of Parent that was formed under the laws of the People’s Republic of China.

Code ” means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

Collateral ” means all property subject or purported to be subject, from time to time, to a Lien under any Security Documents.

Collateral Agent ” means the party named as such in the first paragraph of this Indenture until a successor or assign replaces it, and thereafter, means such successor or assign.

Common Collateral ” means, at any time, all assets of the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors on which Liens have been granted (x) to secure both Term Obligations and ABL Obligations or (y) to secure two or more series of Term Obligations.

 

8


Comparable Treasury Price ” means, with respect to any Redemption Date, if clause (2) of the definition of “Adjusted Treasury Rate” is applicable, the average of three, or if not possible, such lesser number as is obtained by the Issuers, Reference Treasury Dealer Quotations for such Redemption Date.

Consolidated Income Taxes ” means, for any period, taxes imposed upon the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries (including their Subsidiaries) or other payments required to be made by the Issuers or the Restricted Subsidiaries (including their Subsidiaries) by or to any governmental authority or otherwise which taxes or other payments are calculated by reference to the income, gross receipts or profits or capital of the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries (including their Subsidiaries) (to the extent such income, gross receipts or profits were included in computing Consolidated Net Income for such period), including, without limitation, state, franchise, and similar taxes and tax distributions made to the holders of Capital Stock of the Issuers or the Restricted Subsidiaries (including their Subsidiaries) or direct or indirect parents of the Issuers or the Restricted Subsidiaries (including their Subsidiaries) and foreign withholding taxes regardless of whether such taxes or payments are required to be remitted to any governmental authority.

Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio ” as of any date of determination means the ratio of:

(1) the aggregate amount of EBITDA for the period of the most recent four consecutive fiscal quarters ending prior to the date of such determination for which financial statements are available, taken as one accounting period, to

(2) Consolidated Interest Expense for such four fiscal quarters, taken as one accounting period; provided , however , that:

(A) if any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary has Incurred any Indebtedness since the beginning of such period that remains outstanding on such date of determination or if the transaction giving rise to the need to calculate the Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio is an Incurrence of Indebtedness, EBITDA and Consolidated Interest Expense for such period shall be calculated after giving effect on a pro forma basis to such Indebtedness as if such Indebtedness had been Incurred on the first day of such period and the discharge of any other Indebtedness repaid, repurchased, defeased or otherwise discharged with the proceeds of such new Indebtedness as if such discharge had occurred on the first day of such period;

(B) if any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary has repaid, repurchased, defeased or otherwise discharged any Indebtedness

 

9


since the beginning of such period or if any Indebtedness is to be repaid, repurchased, defeased or otherwise discharged (in each case other than Indebtedness Incurred under any revolving credit facility unless such Indebtedness has been permanently repaid and has not been replaced) on the date of the transaction giving rise to the need to calculate the Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio, EBITDA and Consolidated Interest Expense for such period shall be calculated on a pro forma basis as if such discharge had occurred on the first day of such period and as if such Issuer or such Restricted Subsidiary had not earned the interest income actually earned during such period in respect of cash or Temporary Cash Investments used to repay, repurchase, defease or otherwise discharge such Indebtedness;

(C) if since the beginning of such period any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary shall have made any Asset Disposition, EBITDA for such period shall be reduced by an amount equal to the EBITDA (if positive) directly attributable to the assets that are the subject of such Asset Disposition for such period or increased by an amount equal to EBITDA (if negative) directly attributable thereto for such period and Consolidated Interest Expense for such period shall be reduced by an amount equal to the Consolidated Interest Expense directly attributable to any Indebtedness of any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary repaid, repurchased, defeased or otherwise discharged with respect to the Issuers and the continuing Restricted Subsidiaries in connection with such Asset Disposition for such period (or, if the Capital Stock of any Restricted Subsidiary is sold, the Consolidated Interest Expense for such period directly attributable to the Indebtedness of such Restricted Subsidiary to the extent the Issuers and the continuing Restricted Subsidiaries are no longer liable for such Indebtedness after such sale);

(D) if since the beginning of such period any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary (by merger or otherwise) shall have made an Investment in any Restricted Subsidiary (or any Person that becomes a Restricted Subsidiary) or an acquisition of assets, including any acquisition of assets occurring in connection with a transaction causing a calculation to be made hereunder, which constitutes all or substantially all of an operating unit, division or line of a business, EBITDA and Consolidated Interest Expense for such period shall be calculated after giving pro forma effect thereto (including the Incurrence of any Indebtedness) as if such Investment or acquisition occurred on the first day of such period; and

 

10


(E) if since the beginning of such period any Person that subsequently became a Restricted Subsidiary or was merged with or into any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary since the beginning of such period shall have made any Asset Disposition or any Investment or acquisition of assets that would have required an adjustment pursuant to clause (C) or (D) above if made by any Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary during such period, EBITDA and Consolidated Interest Expense for such period shall be calculated after giving pro forma effect thereto as if such Asset Disposition, Investment or acquisition of assets occurred on the first day of such period.

For purposes of this definition, whenever pro forma effect is to be given to an acquisition of assets, Asset Disposition or other Investment, the amount of income, EBITDA or earnings relating thereto and the amount of Consolidated Interest Expense associated with any Indebtedness Incurred in connection therewith, the pro forma calculations shall be determined in good faith by a responsible Financial Officer of the Issuers; provided that any pro forma adjustments shall be limited to those that are (a) reasonably identifiable and factually supportable, and (b) have occurred or are reasonably expected to occur in the twelve months following the applicable date of such calculation, in the reasonable judgment of a Financial Officer of the Issuers. For the avoidance of doubt, such pro forma adjustments may include, among other things, any cost savings or synergies that are reasonably expected to result or be derived from any applicable transaction.

If any Indebtedness bears a floating rate of interest and is being given pro forma effect, the interest expense on such Indebtedness shall be calculated as if the rate in effect on the date of determination had been the applicable rate for the entire period (taking into account any Interest Rate Agreement applicable to such Indebtedness if such Interest Rate Agreement has a remaining term as at the date of determination in excess of 12 months). If any Indebtedness is Incurred or repaid under a revolving credit facility and is being given pro forma effect, the interest on such Indebtedness shall be calculated based on the average daily balance of such Indebtedness for the four fiscal quarters subject to the pro forma calculation.

Consolidated Interest Expense ” means, for any period, the total interest expense of the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries (on a Consolidated basis), plus , to the extent Incurred by the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries in such period but not included in such interest expense, without duplication:

(1) interest expense attributable to Capitalized Lease Obligations and the interest expense attributable to leases constituting part of a Sale and Leaseback Transaction that does not result in a Capitalized Lease Obligation,

 

11


(2) amortization of debt discount and debt issuance costs,

(3) capitalized interest,

(4) non-cash interest expense,

(5) commissions, discounts and other fees and charges attributable to letters of credit and bankers’ acceptance financing,

(6) interest accruing on any Indebtedness of any other Person to the extent such Indebtedness is Guaranteed by (or secured by the assets of) any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary and such Indebtedness is in Default under its terms or any payment is actually made in respect of such Guarantee,

(7) net payments made or received pursuant to Hedging Obligations under Interest Rate Agreements (including amortization of fees),

(8) dividends paid in cash or Disqualified Stock in respect of all Preferred Stock, in each case held by Persons other than an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary, and

(9) interest Incurred in connection with Investments in discontinued operations,

and less , to the extent included in such total interest expense, (A) any breakage costs of Hedging Obligations terminated in connection with the offering of the Notes on the Issue Date and the application of the net proceeds therefrom, (B) the amortization during such period of capitalized financing costs, provided , however , that, for any financing consummated after the Issue Date, the aggregate amount of amortization relating to any such capitalized financing costs deducted in calculating Consolidated Interest Expense shall not exceed 5% of the aggregate amount of the financing giving rise to such capitalized financing costs and (C) any accrued interest expense subsequently discharged pursuant to applicable bankruptcy provisions. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Indenture, the calculation of Consolidated Interest Expense for any period shall be net of any interest income during such period.

Consolidated Net Income ” means, for any period, the net income of the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries (on a Consolidated basis) for such period; provided , however , that there shall not be included in such Consolidated Net Income:

(1) any net income of any Person (other than the Issuers) if such Person is not a Restricted Subsidiary, except that:

 

12


(A) the Issuers’ or the Restricted Subsidiaries’ equity in the net income of any such Person for such period shall be included in such Consolidated Net Income up to the aggregate amount of cash actually distributed by such Person during such period to the Issuers or a Restricted Subsidiary as a dividend or other distribution (subject, in the case of a dividend or other distribution made to a Restricted Subsidiary, to the limitations contained in clause (3) below);

(B) the Issuers’ or the Restricted Subsidiaries’ equity in a net loss of any such Person for such period shall be included in determining such Consolidated Net Income to the extent such loss has been funded with cash from the Issuers or a Restricted Subsidiary; and

(C) the Issuers’ or any Restricted Subsidiary’s equity in the net income of a Joint Venture that is not a Restricted Subsidiary shall be included in such Consolidated Net Income to the extent permissible under GAAP; provided , however , that such equity in the net income of such Joint Venture shall not be included if cash equal to such equity in the net income of such Joint Venture is not readily procurable by the Issuers or any Restricted Subsidiary from such Joint Venture;

(2) any net income (or loss) of any Person acquired by the Issuers, the Restricted Subsidiaries or a Subsidiary thereof in a pooling of interests transaction for any period prior to the date of such acquisition;

(3) any net income of any Restricted Subsidiary if such Restricted Subsidiary is subject to restrictions on the payment of dividends or the making of distributions or contributions by such Restricted Subsidiary, directly or indirectly, to the Issuers (but, in the case of any Foreign Subsidiary, only to the extent that the payment of cash dividends or the making of cash distributions or cash contributions, in each case equal to such net income (or a portion thereof) for such period, by such Foreign Subsidiary to the Issuers is contractually restricted (with the amount of such cash payments that is contractually restricted being determined in good faith by a Financial Officer of the Issuers)), except that:

(A) the equity in the net income of any such Restricted Subsidiary for such period shall be included in Consolidated Net Income up to the aggregate amount of cash actually distributed or contributed by such Restricted Subsidiary during such period to an Issuer or another Restricted Subsidiary (not subject to the restrictions set forth in (3) above) as a dividend or other

 

13


distribution or contribution (subject, in the case of a dividend or other distribution or contribution made to another Restricted Subsidiary, to the limitation contained in this clause); and

(B) the net loss of any such Restricted Subsidiary for such period shall not be excluded in determining such Consolidated Net Income; provided , however , that such net losses may be applied to the computation of Consolidated Net Income in subsequent periods (i) if Consolidated Net Income in any period is zero or less or (ii) to the extent that the application of such losses in any period would reduce Consolidated Net Income for such period to less than zero;

(4) any gain (or loss) realized upon the sale or other disposition of any asset of any of the Issuers or the Restricted Subsidiaries or their Consolidated Subsidiaries (including pursuant to any Sale and Leaseback Transaction) that is not sold or otherwise disposed of in the ordinary course of business and any gain (or loss) realized upon the sale or other disposition of any Capital Stock of any Person;

(5) any net after-tax extraordinary, nonrecurring or unusual gains or losses or income or expenses (including the effect of all fees and expenses relating thereto), including, without limitation, any expenses related to any reconstruction, any severance or relocation expenses and fees, any restructuring costs, any retention payments, any fees, expenses or charges related to any Equity Offering, Investment, acquisition (including earn-out provisions) or Indebtedness permitted to be Incurred by this Indenture (in each case, whether or not successful);

(6) any non-cash compensation expense realized from employee benefit plans or post-employment benefit plans, grants of stock appreciation or similar rights, stock options or other rights to officers, directors and employees of the Issuers or any Restricted Subsidiaries;

(7) cash compensation, costs, charges and expenses related to the Special Incentive Program in an amount not to exceed $7.0 million, the Value Creation Plan in an amount not to exceed $5.5 million and the Supplemental Value Creation Program in an amount not to exceed $7.5 million, each as described in the offering memorandum dated August 13, 2010 for the Initial Notes under “Compensation discussion and analysis—Compensation for employees who are not named executive officers or directors—Special incentive plan, value creation plan, supplemental value creation program”;

(8) any non-cash FASB ASC 815 Derivatives and Hedging income (or loss) related to hedging activities;

 

14


(9) the effects of purchase accounting adjustments (including the effects of such adjustments pushed down to such Person and such Restricted Subsidiaries) in amounts required or permitted by GAAP, resulting from the application of purchase accounting in relation to any consummated acquisition or the amortization or write-off of any amounts thereof, net of taxes;

(10) any non-cash impairment charges or asset write-off resulting from the application of FASB ASC 350 Goodwill Impairment and FASB ASC 360 Impairment of Long-Lived Assets ;

(11) the cumulative effect of a change in accounting principles; and

(12) any non-cash dividends or distributions on any Preferred Stock made by the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries.

Consolidated Non-cash Charges ” means for any period, the aggregate depreciation, amortization (including amortization of intangibles but excluding amortization of prepaid cash expenses that were paid in a prior period), impairment, compensation, rent (all for the avoidance of doubt to the extent such expense is non-cash) and other non-cash expenses of the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries reducing Consolidated Net Income for such period on a Consolidated basis and otherwise determined in accordance with GAAP, but excluding (i) any such charge which consists of or requires an accrual of, or cash reserve for, anticipated cash charges for any future period and (ii) the non-cash impact of recording the change in fair value of any embedded derivatives under FASB ASC 815 Derivatives and Hedgin g and related interpretations as a result of the terms of any agreement or instrument to which such Consolidated Non-cash Charges relate.

Consolidated Secured Debt Ratio ” means, as of any date of determination, the ratio of (a) the sum of, without duplication (i) total Consolidated Indebtedness of the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries that is secured by Liens as of the end of the most recent fiscal period for which internal financial statements are available, and (ii) total Indebtedness of the Restricted Subsidiaries excluding the Subsidiary Guarantors as of the end of the most recent fiscal period for which internal financial statements are available, to (b) the aggregate amount of EBITDA for the then most recent four fiscal quarters for which financial statements of Parent and its Subsidiaries are available, with such pro forma adjustments to Consolidated Indebtedness and EBITDA as are consistent with the adjustment provisions set forth in the definition of Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio (except that, for purposes of determining the amount of total Consolidated Indebtedness pursuant to clause (a) of this definition, the amount of revolving Indebtedness under the Credit Facilities and any other revolving credit facility shall be computed based upon the average daily

 

15


balance of such Indebtedness during the most recent four fiscal quarters for which financial statements of Parent and its Subsidiaries are available).

Consolidated Total Assets ” means the total Consolidated assets of the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries, as shown on the most recent balance sheet of Parent.

consolidation ” means, unless the context otherwise requires, the combination (but without duplication) of (1) in the case of the Parent, the accounts of each of the Parent and each of the Restricted Subsidiaries with those of the Issuers, (2) in the case of the Issuers, the accounts of each of the Restricted Subsidiaries with those of the Issuers and (3) in the case of a Restricted Subsidiary, the accounts of each Subsidiary of such Restricted Subsidiary that is a Restricted Subsidiary with those of such Restricted Subsidiary, in each case in accordance with GAAP consistently applied; provided , however , that “consolidation” will not include consolidation of the accounts of any Unrestricted Subsidiary, but the interest of the Issuers or any Restricted Subsidiary in an Unrestricted Subsidiary will be accounted for as an Investment. The terms “consolidate” and “consolidated” have a correlative meaning.

Controlling Term Secured Parties ” means, with respect to any Common Collateral, holders of the Series of Term Obligations whose Authorized Representative is the Authorized Term Collateral Agent for such Common Collateral.

Corporate Trust Office ” means the office of the Trustee at which the corporate trust business of the Trustee is principally administered, which at the date of this Indenture is located at 1100 North Market Street, Rodney Square North, Wilmington, Delaware 19890.

Credit Facilities ” means (1) the ABL Facility, (2) the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility and (3) whether or not any of the credit facilities agreement referred to in clause (1) or (2) remains outstanding, if designated by the Issuers to be included in the definition of “Credit Facilities,” one or more (A) debt facilities, indentures or commercial paper facilities providing for revolving credit loans, term loans, Notes, debentures, receivables financing (including through the sale of receivables to lenders or to special purpose entities formed to borrow from lenders against such receivables) or letters of credit, (B) debt securities, indentures or other forms of debt financing (including convertible or exchangeable debt instruments or bank guarantees or bankers’ acceptances), or (C) instruments or agreements evidencing any other Indebtedness, in each case, with the same or different borrowers or issuers and, in each case, as amended, supplemented, modified, extended, restructured, renewed, refinanced, restated, replaced or refunded in whole or in part from time to time.

 

16


Currency Agreement ” means with respect to any Person any foreign exchange contract, currency swap agreements or other similar agreement or arrangement to which such Person is a party or of which it is a beneficiary.

Default ” means any event which is, or after notice or passage of time or both would be, an Event of Default.

Depositary ” means the depositary of each Global Note, which will initially be DTC.

Disqualified Stock ” means, with respect to any Person, any Capital Stock which by its terms (or by the terms of any security into which it is convertible or for which it is exchangeable or exercisable) or upon the happening of any event:

(1) matures or is mandatorily redeemable pursuant to a sinking fund obligation or otherwise;

(2) is convertible or exchangeable for Indebtedness or Disqualified Stock (excluding Capital Stock convertible or exchangeable solely at the option of the Issuers or a Restricted Subsidiary; provided , however , that any such conversion or exchange shall be deemed an Incurrence of Indebtedness or Disqualified Stock, as applicable); or

(3) is redeemable at the option of the holder thereof, in whole or in part;

in the case of each of clauses (1), (2) and (3), on or prior to 180 days after the Stated Maturity of the Notes.

Domestic Subsidiary ” means any Restricted Subsidiary that was formed under the laws of the United States, any state of the United States or the District of Columbia.

DTC ” means The Depository Trust Company, a New York corporation, and its successors.

EBITDA ” means Consolidated Net Income for such period plus, without duplication, to the extent the same was deducted in calculating Consolidated Net Income:

(1) Consolidated Income Taxes; plus

(2) Consolidated Interest Expense; plus

(3) Consolidated Non-cash Charges; plus

 

17


(4) the amount of any minority interest expense; plus

(5) any non-cash ASC 830 foreign currency income (or loss) related to the mark-to-market of Indebtedness denominated in a currency other than U.S. Dollars; plus

(6) any costs, expenses (or revenue offsets) attributable to accelerated payments on the accounts receivable of the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries; plus

(7) the amount of taxes incurred or the tax effect in respect of the items set forth in clauses (5) and (9) of “Consolidated Net Income”; plus / minus

(8) gains or losses due solely to fluctuations in currency values and the related tax effects; minus

(9) all non-cash items of income of the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries, on a Consolidated basis, in each case for such period, other than (i) the accrual of revenue consistent with past practice and (ii) the reversal in such period of an accrual of, or cash reserve for, cash expenses in a prior period, to the extent such accrual or reserve did not increase EBITDA in a prior period.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, the provision for taxes based on the income or profits of, and the depreciation and amortization and non-cash charges of, a Restricted Subsidiary shall be added to Consolidated Net Income to compute EBITDA only to the extent (and in the same proportion) that the net income of such Restricted Subsidiary was included in calculating Consolidated Net Income and only if (A) a corresponding amount would be permitted at the date of determination to be dividended or contributed to the Issuers by such Restricted Subsidiary without prior approval (that has not been obtained), pursuant to the terms of its charter and all agreements, instruments, judgments, decrees, orders, statutes, rules and governmental regulations applicable to such Restricted Subsidiary or its shareholders or (B) in the case of any Foreign Subsidiary, the payment of cash dividends or the making of cash distributions or contributions, in each case in a corresponding amount, by such Foreign Subsidiary to the Issuers is not contractually restricted (as determined in good faith by a Financial Officer of the Issuers); provided that to the extent cash of such Foreign Subsidiary provided the basis for including the net income of such Foreign Subsidiary in Consolidated Net Income pursuant to clause (3) of the definition of “Consolidated Net Income,” such cash shall not be taken into account for the purposes of determining the amount of cash that is not contractually restricted under this clause (B).

Equity Offering ” means a public or private offering of Capital Stock (other than Disqualified Stock) of the Parent or any Affiliate of the Parent (to the

 

18


extent the proceeds thereof are contributed to the common equity of the Issuers or a Restricted Subsidiary).

Exchange Act ” means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

Existing ABL Facility ” means the Revolving Credit and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007, as amended, by and among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, as borrower, the Guarantors, as guarantors, the lenders party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Administrative Agent, as such agreement may be amended (including any amendment and restatement thereof), supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.

Existing Intercreditor Agreement ” means the Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007, as amended, by and among Parent, Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the other Subsidiaries of Parent party thereto, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and Goldman Sachs Credit Partners L.P., as in effect immediately prior to the Issue Date.

Existing Real Property Collateral ” means the three real properties owned in fee, located in Kentucky, Michigan and Ohio, and the one leasehold interest located in Mississippi which in each case have been mortgaged by a Subsidiary Guarantor prior to the Issue Date to secure the ABL Obligations (on a first priority basis) and the Obligations under the First Lien Term Loan Agreement (on a second priority basis).

Fair Market Value ” means, with respect to any asset or property, the price which could be negotiated in an arm’s-length, free market transaction, for cash, between a willing seller and a willing and able buyer, neither of whom is under undue pressure or compulsion to complete the transaction as such price is, unless specified otherwise in this Indenture, determined in good faith by a Financial Officer of the Issuers or by the Board of Directors. Fair Market Value (other than of any asset with a public trading market) of any asset or property (or group of assets or property subject to an event giving rise to a requirement in this Indenture that “Fair Market Value” be determined) in excess of $150.0 million shall be determined by the Board of Directors of the Issuers or a duly authorized committee thereof.

Financial Officer ” means the Chief Financial Officer, the Treasurer or the Chief Accounting Officer of each of the Issuers.

First Lien Term Loan Agreement ” means the First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007, as amended, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and Tower Automotive Holdings Europe B.V., as borrowers, the guarantors party thereto, and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent, as such agreement may be amended (including any

 

19


amendment and restatement thereof), supplemented, replaced, renewed, refinanced, extended or otherwise modified from time to time.

First Priority Lien ” means any Lien on any Type of Common Collateral securing any First Priority Obligation with respect to such Type of Common Collateral.

First Priority Obligations ” means (i) with respect to the ABL Priority Collateral, all ABL Obligations and (ii) with respect to the Term Priority Collateral, all Term Obligations.

First Priority Secured Party ” means, with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the holders of the First Priority Obligations with respect to such Common Collateral.

Foreign Subsidiary ” means any Restricted Subsidiary that is not organized under the laws of the United States of America or any State thereof or the District of Columbia.

GAAP ” means generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America as in effect as of the Issue Date. All ratios and computations based on GAAP contained in this Indenture shall be computed in conformity with GAAP.

Global Note ” means a Note in registered global form without interest coupons.

Guarantee ” means any obligation, contingent or otherwise, of any Person, directly or indirectly, guaranteeing any Indebtedness of any other Person and any obligation, direct or indirect, contingent or otherwise, of such Person:

(1) to purchase or pay (or advance or supply funds for the purchase or payment of) such Indebtedness of such other Person (whether arising by virtue of partnership arrangements, or by agreement to keep-well, to purchase assets, goods, securities or services, to take-or-pay, or to maintain financial statement conditions or otherwise) or

(2) entered into for purposes of assuring in any other manner the obligee of such Indebtedness of the payment thereof or to protect such obligee against loss in respect thereof (in whole or in part);

provided , however , that the term “ Guarantee ” shall not include endorsements for collection or deposit in the ordinary course of business. The term “Guarantee” used as a verb has a corresponding meaning.

Guarantor ” means any Person Guaranteeing any obligation.

 

20


Guarantors ” means Parent and all of Parent’s Domestic Subsidiaries that are guarantors under the Existing ABL Facility.

Hedging Obligations ” of any Person means the obligations of such Person pursuant to any Interest Rate Agreement, Currency Agreement, any hedging agreements relating to commodities, energy or raw materials, or any hedging agreement entered into in connection with the issuance of convertible debt.

Holder ” means the Person in whose name a Note is registered on the Registrar’s books.

Incur ” means issue, assume, Guarantee, incur or otherwise become liable for; provided , however , that any Indebtedness or Capital Stock of a Person existing at the time such Person becomes a Subsidiary (whether by merger, consolidation, acquisition or otherwise) shall be deemed to be Incurred by such Person at the time it becomes a Subsidiary. The term “Incurrence” when used as a noun shall have a correlative meaning. The accretion of principal of a non-interest bearing or other discount security shall not be deemed the Incurrence of Indebtedness.

Indebtedness ” means, with respect to any Person on any date of determination, without duplication:

(1) the principal of and premium (if any, to the extent such premium is determinable) in respect of indebtedness of such Person for borrowed money;

(2) the principal of and premium (if any, to the extent such premium is determinable) in respect of obligations of such Person evidenced by bonds, debentures, Notes or other similar instruments;

(3) all obligations of such Person for the reimbursement of any obligor on any letter of credit, bank guarantee, bankers’ acceptance or similar credit transaction (other than obligations with respect to letters of credit, bank guarantees, bankers’ acceptances or similar credit transactions securing obligations (other than obligations described in clauses (1), (2) and (5)) entered into in the ordinary course of business of such Person to the extent such letters of credit, bank guarantees, bankers’ acceptances or similar credit transactions are not drawn upon or, if and to the extent drawn upon, such drawing is reimbursed no later than the tenth Business Day following payment on the letter of credit, bank guarantee, bankers’ acceptance or similar credit transaction); provided , that the undrawn face amount of all outstanding Synthetic Letters of Credit and the obligations of an Issuer or any Subsidiary in respect of any unreimbursed drawing in

 

21


respect of Synthetic Letters of Credit shall constitute Indebtedness (all such Indebtedness, “ Synthetic LC Indebtedness ”);

(4) all obligations of such Person to pay the deferred and unpaid purchase price of property or services (except Trade Payables), which purchase price is due more than six months after the date of placing such property in service or taking delivery and title thereto or the completion of such services;

(5) all Capitalized Lease Obligations and Attributable Debt of such Person;

(6) the amount of all obligations of such Person with respect to the redemption, repayment or other repurchase of any Disqualified Stock or, with respect to any Subsidiary that is not a Subsidiary Guarantor, any Preferred Stock (but excluding, in each case, any accrued and unpaid dividends);

(7) all indebtedness of other Persons secured by a Lien on any asset of such Person, whether or not such indebtedness is assumed by such Person; provided , however , that the amount of Indebtedness of such Person pursuant to this clause (7) shall be the lesser of:

(A) the Fair Market Value of such asset at such date of determination and

(B) the amount of such indebtedness of such other Persons so secured;

(8) to the extent not otherwise included in this definition, net Hedging Obligations of such Person (the amount of any such obligations to be equal at any time to the termination value of such agreement or arrangement giving rise to such Hedging Obligation that would be payable by such Person at such time); and

(9) all obligations of the type referred to in clauses (1) through (8) of other Persons for the payment of which such Person is responsible or liable, directly or indirectly, as obligor, guarantor or otherwise, including by means of any Guarantee.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, in connection with the acquisition by the Issuers or any Restricted Subsidiary of any business, the term “Indebtedness” will exclude post-closing payment adjustments to which the seller may become entitled to the extent such payment is determined by a final closing balance sheet, such payment depends on the performance of such business after the closing of the acquisition or such post-closing payment is otherwise contingent upon events

 

22


outside the control of the purchaser; provided , however , that, at the time of closing, the amount of any such payment is not determinable and, to the extent such payment thereafter becomes fixed and determined, the amount is paid within 30 days thereafter. In addition, the term “Indebtedness” will exclude obligations of Chinese Subsidiaries in respect of Chinese Acceptance Notes in the ordinary course of business.

The amount of Indebtedness of any Person at any date shall be the outstanding balance at such date of all unconditional obligations as described above; provided , however , that in the case of Indebtedness sold at a discount, the amount of such Indebtedness at any time will be the accreted value thereof at such time.

Indenture ” means this indenture, as amended or supplemented from time to time.

Initial Notes ” means the Notes issued on the Issue Date and any Notes issued in replacement thereof.

Initial Public Offering ” means the initial public offering by Parent or an Affiliate of Parent, but not including the initial public offering of another portfolio company of the Sponsor.

Initial Purchasers ” means the initial purchasers listed on Schedule 1 to the Purchase Agreement, dated as of August 13, 2010, among the Issuers, Parent, the Subsidiary Guarantors and the representative of such initial purchasers relating to the sale of the Initial Notes by the Issuers.

Institutional Accredited Investor ” means an institutional “accredited investor” (as defined) in Rule 501(a), (2), (3) or (7) under the Securities Act.

Institutional Accredited Investor Certificate ” means a certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit G hereto.

Intercompany Receivables Collateral ” means all intercompany receivables owed to any Issuer or any Subsidiary Guarantor by any Foreign Subsidiary.

Interest Payment Date ” means each September 1 and March 1 of each year, commencing March 1, 2011.

Interest Rate Agreement ” means, with respect to any Person, any interest rate protection agreement, interest rate future agreement, interest rate option agreement, interest rate swap agreement, interest rate cap agreement, interest rate collar agreement, interest rate hedge agreement or other similar agreement or arrangement to which such Person is party or of which it is a beneficiary.

 

23


Investment ” in any Person means any direct or indirect advance, loan or other extension of credit (including by way of Guarantee or similar arrangement) or capital contribution to (by means of any transfer of cash or other property to others or any payment for property or services for the account or use of others), or any purchase or acquisition of Capital Stock, Indebtedness or other similar instruments issued by, such Person.

Investment Company Act ” means the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended.

Investment Grade Rating ” means a rating equal to or higher than Baa3 (or the equivalent) by Moody’s and BBB (or the equivalent) by Standard & Poor’s, or an equivalent rating by any other Rating Agency.

Issue Date ” means August 24, 2010, the date the Initial Notes were first issued under this Indenture.

Issuers ” means Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc. and not any of their respective Subsidiaries (other than TA Holdings Finance, Inc. in the case of Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC).

Joint Venture ” means any joint venture or similar entity; provided , however , that the Issuers or a Restricted Subsidiary owns, through securities or otherwise, at least 25% of the voting or economic interests of the joint venture or similar entity.

Legal Holiday ” means a Saturday, Sunday or other day on which the Trustee or banking institutions are not required by law or regulation to be open in the State of New York.

Lien ” means any mortgage, pledge, security interest, encumbrance, lien or charge in the nature of an encumbrance of any kind (including any conditional sale or other title retention agreement or lease in the nature thereof).

Moody’s ” means Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. and any successor to its rating business.

Net Cash Proceeds ,” with respect to any issuance or sale of Capital Stock or any contribution made by an owner of Capital Stock, means the cash proceeds of such issuance, sale or contribution net of attorneys’ fees, accountants’ fees, underwriters’ or placement agents’ fees, listing fees, discounts or commissions and brokerage, consultant and other fees actually incurred in connection with such issuance, sale or contribution and net of taxes paid or payable as a result thereof.

Net Proceeds ” means the aggregate cash proceeds received by the Issuers, Parent or any Restricted Subsidiaries in respect of any Asset Disposition

 

24


(including any cash payments received by way of deferred payment of principal pursuant to a note or installment receivable or otherwise, but only as and when received, but excluding the assumption by the acquiring Person of Indebtedness relating to the disposed assets or other consideration received in any other non-cash form), net of the costs (including, without limitation attorney’s fees, accountants’ fees, commissions, consultant and other fees actually incurred) relating to such Asset Disposition, and any relocation expenses Incurred as a result thereof, taxes paid or payable as a result thereof (after taking into account any available tax credits or deductions and any tax sharing arrangements related thereto), all distributions and other payments required to be made to minority interest holders in Subsidiaries or Joint Ventures as a result of such Asset Disposition, amounts required to be applied to the repayment of principal, premium (if any) and interest on Indebtedness required (other than pursuant to paragraph (b) of Section 4.12) to be paid as a result of such transaction, and any deduction of appropriate amounts to be provided by the Issuers as a reserve in accordance with GAAP against any liabilities associated with the asset disposed of in such transaction and retained by any Issuer, Parent (solely in the case of an Asset Disposition pursuant to clause (1) of the definition thereof), or a Restricted Subsidiary after such sale or other disposition thereof, including, without limitation, pension and other post-employment benefit liabilities and liabilities related to environmental matters or against any indemnification obligations associated with such transaction.

Non-Controlling Term Secured Parties ” means, with respect to any Common Collateral, the Term Secured Parties which are not Controlling Term Secured Parties with respect to such Common Collateral.

Non-U.S. Person ” means a Person that is not a U.S. person, as defined in Regulation S.

Notes ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the Recitals.

Notes Obligations ” means the obligations of the Issuers under the Notes, this Indenture and the Security Documents and the obligations of the Guarantors under the Notes Guarantees (including without limitation, the fees and expenses of the Trustee, the Collateral Agent and any of their counsel, agents and professional advisers).

Notes Secured Parties ” means the Holders of the Notes, the Trustee or the Collateral Agent.

Obligations ” means any principal, interest, penalties, fees, indemnifications, reimbursements (including, without limitation, reimbursement obligations with respect to letters of credit and bankers’ acceptances), damages and other liabilities payable under the documentation governing any Indebtedness.

 

25


Officer ” of each the Issuers means the Chairman of the Board, the Chief Executive Officer, the Chief Financial Officer, the President, any Vice President, the Treasurer or the Secretary of such Issuer. “Officer” of a Guarantor has a correlative meaning.

Officers’ Certificate ” means a certificate signed by two Officers of each Issuer, that meets the requirements of Section 12.05 hereof.

Offshore Global Note ” means a Global Note representing Notes issued and sold pursuant to Regulation S.

OID Legend ” means the legend set forth in Exhibit E.

Opinion of Counsel ” means a written opinion from legal counsel who is acceptable to the Trustee. The counsel may be an employee of or counsel to an Issuer or Guarantor.

Parent ” means Tower Automotive, LLC and, in any event, such term shall include any Successor Parent.

Parent Owner Tax Distribution Amount ” means, with respect to Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC, the amount of federal, state and local taxes for a fiscal year, based on the income of Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC and its Subsidiaries that are Pass-Through Entities; and the maximum combined net federal, state and local tax rate applicable to holders of an equity interest in the Parent in respect of the net taxable income of Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC and its Subsidiaries that are Pass-Through Entities.

Parent Tax Distribution Amount ” means, with respect to Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC, the amount of federal, state and local income and similar taxes for a fiscal year that the Parent (or if the Parent is owned directly or indirectly by a parent company, such parent company) would be required to pay with respect to income for such fiscal year attributable to Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC (and its Subsidiaries that are Pass-Through Entities) assuming that the Parent is, and always has been, treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

Pari Passu Indebtedness ” means:

(1) with respect to the Issuers, the Notes and any Indebtedness which ranks pari passu in right of payment to the Notes; and

(2) with respect to any Guarantor, its obligations in respect of the Notes and any Indebtedness which ranks pari passu in right of payment to such Guarantor’s obligations in respect of the Notes Guarantees.

 

26


Pass-Through Entity ” means any entity that is not treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

Paying Agent ” refers to a Person engaged to perform the obligations of the Trustee in respect of payments made or funds held hereunder in respect of the Notes.

Permanent Offshore Global Note ” means an Offshore Global Note that does not bear the Temporary Offshore Global Note Legend.

Permitted Business ” means any business engaged in by the Issuers or any Restricted Subsidiary on the Issue Date and any Related Business.

Permitted Investment ” means an Investment by any Issuer or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries in:

(1) any Issuer or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries, including, without limitation, through the purchase of Capital Stock of a Restricted Subsidiary;

(2) any Investment by any Issuer or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries in a Person that is engaged in a Related Business if as a result of such Investment:

(a) such Person becomes a Restricted Subsidiary; or

(b) such Person, in one transaction or a series of related transactions, is merged or consolidated with or into, or transfers or conveys substantially all of its assets to, or is liquidated into, any Issuer or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries, and, in each case, any Investment held by such Person; provided that such Investment was not acquired by such Person in contemplation of such acquisition, merger, consolidation or transfer;

(3) cash and Temporary Cash Investments;

(4) receivables owing to any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary created or acquired in the ordinary course of business and payable or dischargeable in accordance with customary trade terms; provided , however , that such trade terms may include such concessionary trade terms as any Issuer or any such Restricted Subsidiary deems reasonable under the circumstances;

(5) payroll, travel and similar advances to cover matters that are expected at the time of such advances ultimately to be treated as expenses for accounting purposes and that are made in the ordinary course of business;

 

27


(6) loans or advances to, or guarantees of Indebtedness of, employees, officers or directors of any Issuer or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practices in an aggregate amount outstanding at any time not in excess of $5.0 million with respect to all loans, advances or guarantees made since the Issue Date (without giving effect to the forgiveness of any such loan);

(7) any Investment acquired by any Issuer or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries:

(a) in exchange for any other Investment or accounts receivable held by any Issuer or any such Restricted Subsidiary in connection with or as a result of a bankruptcy, workout, reorganization or recapitalization of the issuer of such other Investment or accounts receivable;

(b) as a result of a foreclosure by any Issuer or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries with respect to any secured Investment or other transfer of title with respect to any secured Investment in default;

(c) in the form of notes payable, stock or other securities issued by account debtors to any Issuer or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries pursuant to negotiated agreements with respect to the settlement of such account debtor’s accounts, and other Investments arising in connection with the compromise, settlement or collection of accounts receivable, in each case in the ordinary course of business; or

(d) in the form of notes payable, stock or other securities that are received in satisfaction of judgment;

(8) Investments made as a result of the receipt of consideration (other than cash and Temporary Cash Investments) from an Asset Disposition that was made pursuant to and in compliance with Section 4.12 or any other disposition of assets not constituting an Asset Disposition;

(9) Investments in existence on the Issue Date, and any extension, modification, replacement, or renewal of any such Investments existing on the Issue Date, but only to the extent not involving additional advances, contributions or other Investments of cash or other assets or other increases thereof (other than as a result of the accrual or accretion of interest or original issue discount or the issuance of pay-in-kind securities, in each case, pursuant to the terms of such Investment as in effect on the Issue Date);

 

28


(10) any Person to the extent such Investments consist of Hedging Obligations, which transactions or obligations are Incurred in compliance with Section 4.06;

(11) Guarantees of Indebtedness issued in accordance with Section 4.06;

(12) Investments made in connection with the funding of contributions under any nonqualified retirement plan or similar employee compensation plan;

(13) any Person to the extent such Investments consist of prepaid expenses, negotiable instructions held for collection and lease, utility and workers’ compensation, performance and other similar deposits made in the ordinary course of business by any Issuer or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries;

(14) prepayments and other credits to suppliers made in the ordinary course of business;

(15) endorsements of negotiable instruments and documents in the ordinary course of business;

(16) Investments in the ordinary course of business consisting of endorsements for collection or deposit and customary trade arrangements with customers consistent with past practices;

(17) Investments in any Person, including any Joint Venture, primarily engaged in any Related Business, together with all other Investments pursuant to this clause (17), in an aggregate amount at the time of such Investment not to exceed $50.0 million outstanding at any one time (with the Fair Market Value of such Investment being measured at the time made and without giving effect to subsequent changes in value);

(18) Investments the payment for which consists of Capital Stock of the Parent (other than Disqualified Stock) or any direct or indirect parent company of the Parent, as applicable;

(19) Investments the payment for which consists of the Net Cash Proceeds of an Equity Offering which is contributed, directly or indirectly, to an Issuer or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries;

(20) Investments consisting of the licensing or contribution of intellectual property pursuant to joint marketing arrangements with other Persons;

 

29


(21) Investments of a Restricted Subsidiary acquired after the Issue Date or of an entity merged into or consolidated with a Restricted Subsidiary or merged into or consolidated with an Issuer in a transaction that is not prohibited by Article 5 after the Issue Date to the extent that such Investments were not made in contemplation of such acquisition, merger or consolidation and were in existence on the date of such acquisition, merger or consolidation;

(22) Investments consisting of purchases and acquisitions of inventory, supplies, materials, tooling and equipment or purchases of contract rights or licenses or leases of intellectual property, in each case in the ordinary course of business; and

(23) Investments by any Issuer or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries, together with all other Investments pursuant to this clause (23), in an aggregate amount at the time of such Investment not to exceed, at any one time outstanding, the greater of (a) 2.5% of the Consolidated Total Assets of the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries (determined as of the end of the most recent fiscal quarter of the Issuers and Restricted Subsidiaries for which financial statements of the Issuers and Restricted Subsidiaries are available) and (b) $30.0 million (with the Fair Market Value of such Investment being measured at the time made and without giving effect to subsequent changes in value).

Permitted Liens ” means, with respect to any Person:

(1) Liens to secure Indebtedness permitted pursuant to clause (b)(1) of Section 4.06; provided , however , that any Lien on Term Priority Collateral or ABL Priority Collateral securing obligations permitted pursuant to clause (b)(1) must be expressly subject to the terms of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement;

(2) pledges or deposits by such Person under workers’ compensation laws, unemployment insurance laws or similar legislation, or good faith deposits in connection with bids, tenders, contracts (other than for the payment of Indebtedness) or leases to which such Person is a party, or deposits to secure public or statutory or similar obligations of such Person or deposits of cash or United States government bonds to secure surety or appeal bonds to which such Person is a party, or deposits as security for contested taxes or import duties or for the payment of rent, in each case Incurred in the ordinary course of business;

(3) Liens imposed by law, such as landlords’, materialmen’s, carriers’, warehousemen’s and mechanics’ Liens, in each case for sums not yet due or being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings or other Liens arising out of judgments or awards against such Person with

 

30


respect to which such Person shall then be proceeding with an appeal or other proceedings for review;

(4) Liens for taxes, assessments or other governmental charges or levies not yet due or payable or subject to penalties for non-payment or which are being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings;

(5) Liens in favor of issuers of surety, appeal, warranty, indemnity, performance or similar bonds or letters of credit, bank guarantees, bankers’ acceptances or similar credit transactions issued pursuant to the request of and for the account of such Person in the ordinary course of its business; provided , however , that such letters of credit, bank guarantees, bankers’ acceptances and similar credit transactions do not constitute Indebtedness;

(6) survey exceptions, encumbrances, encroachments, variations, easements or reservations of, or rights of others for, licenses, rights-of-way, sewers, electric lines, telegraph and telephone lines and other similar purposes, or zoning or other restrictions as to the use of real property or Liens incidental to the conduct of the business of such Person or to the ownership of its properties which were not Incurred in connection with Indebtedness for borrowed money and which do not in the aggregate materially adversely affect the value of said properties or materially impair their use in the operation of the business of such Person;

(7) Liens securing Indebtedness Incurred to finance the construction (including customer-funded tooling), purchase or lease of, or repairs, improvements or additions to, property of such Person (including Indebtedness Incurred under clause (b)(6) of Section 4.06; provided , however , that the Lien may not extend to any other property (other than property related to the property being financed) owned by such Person or any of its Subsidiaries at the time the Lien is Incurred, and the Indebtedness (other than any interest thereon) secured by the Lien may not be Incurred more than 180 days after the later of the acquisition, completion of construction, repair, improvement, addition or commencement of full operation of the property subject to the Lien;

(8) Liens existing on the Issue Date (other than Liens referred to in the foregoing clause (1)) and extensions, refinancings, renewals and replacements (which in the case of the Notes redeemed or repurchased may be replaced on a date subsequent to such redemption or repurchase) of any such Liens so long as the principal amount of Indebtedness or other obligations secured thereby is not increased (other than by an amount necessary to pay any fees and expenses, including premiums, related to such extensions, refinancing, renewals or replacements) and so long as such Liens are not extended to any other property of the Issuers or any of

 

31


the Restricted Subsidiaries, except pursuant to after-acquired property clauses existing in the applicable agreements on the Issue Date; provided , however , that (x) no such Liens securing Synthetic LC Indebtedness shall extend to the properties or assets of any Subsidiary that is not an Issuer or a Subsidiary Guarantor and (y) all such Liens securing Synthetic LC Indebtedness shall be pari passu with respect to the Collateral with the Liens securing all other Term Obligations pursuant to the Term Intercreditor Agreement and the ABL Intercreditor Agreement

(9) Liens on property or shares of stock of another Person at the time such other Person becomes a Subsidiary of such Person; provided , however , that such Liens are not created, Incurred or assumed in connection with, or in contemplation of, such other Person becoming such a Subsidiary; provided , further , however , that such Liens do not extend to any other property owned by such Person or any of its Subsidiaries, except pursuant to after-acquired property clauses existing in the applicable agreements at the time such Person becomes a Subsidiary which do not extend to property transferred to such Person by the Issuers or a Restricted Subsidiary;

(10) Liens on property at the time such Person or any of its Subsidiaries acquires the property, including any acquisition by means of a merger or consolidation with or into such Person or any Subsidiary of such Person; provided , however , that such Liens are not created, Incurred or assumed in connection with, or in contemplation of, such acquisition; provided , further , however , that the Liens do not extend to any other property owned by such Person or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries;

(11) Liens securing Indebtedness or other obligations of a Subsidiary of such Person owing to such Person or a Restricted Subsidiary;

(12) Liens or deposits securing Hedging Obligations so long as such Hedging Obligations are permitted to be Incurred under this Indenture;

(13) Liens to secure any Refinancing (or successive Refinancings) as a whole, or in part, of any Indebtedness secured by any Lien referred to in clause (7), (8), (9), (10), and (32); provided , however , that:

(A) such new Lien shall be limited to all or part of the same property that secured the original Lien (plus improvements, accessions, proceeds, dividends or distributions in respect thereof) and

 

32


(B) the Indebtedness secured by such Lien at such time is not increased to any amount greater than the sum of:

(i) the outstanding principal amount or, if greater, committed amount of the Indebtedness secured by Liens described under clause (7), (8), (9), (10), and (32) at the time the original Lien became a Permitted Lien under this Indenture; and

(ii) an amount necessary to pay any fees and expenses, including premiums, related to such Refinancings;

(14) judgment Liens not giving rise to an Event of Default;

(15) Liens arising from Uniform Commercial Code financing statement filings regarding leases or consignments that do not otherwise constitute Indebtedness entered into in the ordinary course of business;

(16) leases and subleases of real property which do not materially interfere with the ordinary conduct of the business of the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries;

(17) Liens which constitute bankers’ Liens, rights of set-off or similar rights and remedies as to deposit accounts or other funds maintained with any bank or other financial institution, whether arising by operation of law or pursuant to contract;

(18) Liens solely on any cash earnest money deposits made by the Issuers or any Restricted Subsidiaries in connection with any letter of intent or purchase agreement permitted to be entered into under this Indenture;

(19) Liens on specific items of inventory or other goods and related documentation (and proceeds thereof) securing reimbursement obligations in respect of trade letters of credit issued to ensure payment of the purchase price for such items of inventory or other goods;

(20) Liens on assets of Foreign Subsidiaries securing Indebtedness of a Foreign Subsidiary permitted by clause (b)(11) of Section 4.06 and securing other obligations under the agreements governing or relating to such Indebtedness, so long as such Liens do not encumber the Capital Stock of the Issuers or any Domestic Subsidiaries;

(21) Liens on deposit accounts maintained with, or other property in the custody of, a depositary bank pursuant to its general business terms and in the ordinary course of business, and similar Liens on accounts of

 

33


Foreign Subsidiaries of such Person organized under the laws of The Netherlands arising under clause 18 of the general terms and conditions of any member of the Dutch Bankers’ Association or any similar term applied by a financial institution in The Netherlands pursuant to its general terms and conditions;

(22) Liens consisting of pledges and deposits in the ordinary course of business securing liability for reimbursement or indemnification obligations to (including obligations in respect of letters of credit or bank guarantees for the benefit of) insurance carriers providing property, casualty or liability insurance to Parent or any of its Subsidiaries;

(23) Liens consisting of customary transfer restrictions in joint venture agreements, stockholder agreements or other similar agreements applicable to joint ventures;

(24) Liens in favor of customs and revenue authorities arising as a matter of law to secure payment of customs duties in connection with the importation of goods in the ordinary course of business;

(25) Liens (A) on cash advances in favor of the seller of any property to be acquired in an Investment to be applied against the purchase price for such Investment, and (B) consisting of an agreement to transfer any property in a disposition permitted under this Indenture, in each case, solely to the extent disposition, as the case may be, would have been permitted on the date of the creation of such Lien;

(26) Liens that are contractual rights of set-off relating to purchase orders and other agreements entered into with customers of Parent or any of its Subsidiaries in the ordinary course of business;

(27) Liens arising out of conditional sale, title retention, consignment or similar arrangements for sale of goods entered into by Parent or its Subsidiaries in the ordinary course of business;

(28) Liens deemed to exist in connection with Investments in repurchase agreements, provided that such Liens do not extend to any assets other than those assets that are the subject of such repurchase agreements;

(29) Liens Incurred to secure cash management services owed to a lender under any Credit Facility in the ordinary course of business;

(30) Liens on equipment of any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary granted in the ordinary course of business to such Issuer’s or such Restricted Subsidiary’s client at which such equipment is located;

 

34


(31) Liens securing the Notes (not including any Additional Notes) and the Subsidiary Guarantees; and

(32) Liens on assets of the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors securing Permitted Secured Additional Pari Passu Obligations.

Permitted Secured Additional Pari Passu Obligations ” means Pari Passu Indebtedness secured by Liens on the Collateral that are pari passu with the Liens securing the Notes Obligations and any other Term Obligations then outstanding and subject to the Term Intercreditor Agreement and the ABL Intercreditor Agreement; provided that, as of the date of Incurrence of such Permitted Secured Additional Pari Passu Indebtedness, after giving effect thereto and the application of proceeds therefrom, either (x) the amount of outstanding Permitted Secured Additional Pari Passu Indebtedness would be no greater than $50.0 million or (y) the Consolidated Secured Debt Ratio of the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries would be no greater than 2.5:1.0.

Person ” means any individual, corporation, partnership, limited liability company, joint venture, association, joint-stock company, trust, unincorporated organization, government or any agency or political subdivision thereof or any other entity.

Preferred Stock ”, as applied to the Capital Stock of any Person, means Capital Stock of any class or classes (however designated) that is preferred as to the payment of dividends, or as to the distribution of assets upon any voluntary or involuntary liquidation or dissolution of such Person, over shares of Capital Stock of any other class of such Person.

principal ” of a Note means the principal of the Note plus the premium, if any, payable on the Note which is due or overdue or is to become due at the relevant time.

Purchase Money Indebtedness ” means Indebtedness:

(1) consisting of the purchase price of property, plant or equipment whether through the direct purchase of such assets or the Capital Stock of any Person owning such assets, conditional sale obligations, obligations under any title retention agreement and other obligations Incurred in connection with the acquisition, construction, restoration or improvement of such asset, in each case where the amount of such Indebtedness does not exceed the greater of

(A) the cost of the asset being financed and

(B) the Fair Market Value of such asset; and

 

35


(2) Incurred to finance such acquisition, construction, restoration or improvement by the Issuers or a Restricted Subsidiary of such asset whether through the direct purchase of such asset or the Capital Stock of any Person owning such asset;

provided , however , that such Indebtedness is Incurred within 180 days after such acquisition or the completion of such acquisition, construction or improvement.

Quotation Agent ” means one of the Reference Treasury Dealers selected by the Issuers.

Rating Agency ” means Standard & Poor’s and Moody’s or, if Standard & Poor’s or Moody’s or both shall not make a rating on the Notes publicly available, a nationally recognized statistical rating agency or agencies, as the case may be, selected by the Issuers (as certified by a resolution of the Board of Directors) which shall be substituted for Standard & Poor’s or Moody’s or both, as the case may be.

Redemption Date ” when used with respect to any Note to be redeemed or purchased means the date fixed for such redemption or purchase by or pursuant to this Indenture.

Redemption Price ” when used with respect to any Note to be redeemed or purchased means the price at which it is to be redeemed or purchased pursuant to this Indenture.

Reference Treasury Dealer ” means (1) each of J.P. Morgan Securities Inc., Citigroup Global Markets Inc. and Goldman, Sachs & Co. and their successors and assigns and (2) any other nationally recognized investment banking firms selected by the Issuers that are primary U.S. Government securities dealers.

Reference Treasury Dealer Quotations ” means, with respect to each Reference Treasury Dealer and any Redemption Date, the average, as determined by the Issuers, of the bid and asked prices for the Comparable Treasury Issue, expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount, quoted in writing to the Issuers by such Reference Treasury Dealer at 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the third Business Day immediately preceding such Redemption Date.

Refinance ” means, in respect of any Indebtedness, to refinance, extend, renew, refund, repay, prepay, redeem, defease or retire, or to issue other Indebtedness in exchange or replacement for, such Indebtedness, including, in any such case from time to time, after the discharge of the Indebtedness being Refinanced. “Refinanced” and “Refinancing” shall have correlative meanings.

Refinancing Indebtedness ” means Indebtedness that is Incurred to Refinance (including pursuant to any defeasance or discharge mechanism) any

 

36


Indebtedness of an Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary existing on the Issue Date or Incurred in compliance with this Indenture (including Indebtedness of any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary that Refinances Refinancing Indebtedness); provided , however , that:

(1) the Refinancing Indebtedness has a Stated Maturity no earlier than the Stated Maturity of the Indebtedness being Refinanced,

(2) the Refinancing Indebtedness has an Average Life at the time such Refinancing Indebtedness is Incurred that is equal to or greater than the remaining Average Life of the Indebtedness being refinanced,

(3) such Refinancing Indebtedness is Incurred in an aggregate principal amount (or if Incurred with original issue discount, an aggregate issue price) that is equal to or less than the aggregate principal amount of the Indebtedness being refinanced (or if issued with original issue discount, the aggregate accreted value) then outstanding (or that would be outstanding if the entire committed amount of any credit facility being Refinanced were fully drawn (other than any such amount that would have been prohibited from being drawn pursuant to Section 4.06)) (plus fees, taxes and expenses, including any premium and defeasance costs), and

(4) if the Indebtedness being Refinanced is subordinated in right of payment to the Notes, such Refinancing Indebtedness is subordinated in right of payment to the Notes at least to the same extent as the Indebtedness being Refinanced; provided , further , however , that Refinancing Indebtedness shall not include:

(A) Indebtedness of a Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Subsidiary Guarantor that Refinances Indebtedness of an Issuer or a Subsidiary Guarantor; or

(B) Indebtedness of a Restricted Subsidiary that is a Subsidiary Guarantor that Refinances Indebtedness of a Subsidiary that is not a Subsidiary Guarantor.

Registrar ” means a Person engaged to maintain the Register.

Regular Record Date ” for the interest payable on any Interest Payment Date means the August 15 or February 15 (whether or not a Business Day) next preceding such Interest Payment Date.

Regulation S ” means Regulation S under the Securities Act.

Regulation S Certificate ” means a certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit E hereto.

 

37


Related Business ” means (i) any business engaged in by any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary on the Issue Date, and (ii) any business or other activities that are reasonably similar, ancillary, complementary or related to, or a reasonable extension, development or expansion of, the businesses in which any of the Issuers or the Restricted Subsidiaries are engaged on the Issue Date.

Restricted Investment ” means an Investment other than a Permitted Investment.

Restricted Legend ” means the legend set forth in Exhibit C.

Restricted Period ” means the relevant 40-day distribution compliance period as defined in Regulation S.

Restricted Subsidiary ” means Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC and any Subsidiary of Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC other than the Issuers or any Unrestricted Subsidiary.

Rule 144A ” means Rule 144A under the Securities Act.

Rule 144A Certificate ” means (i) a certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit F hereto or (ii) a written certification addressed to the Issuers and the Trustee to the effect that the Person making such certification (x) is acquiring such Note (or beneficial interest) for its own account or one or more accounts with respect to which it exercises sole investment discretion and that it and each such account is a qualified institutional buyer within the meaning of Rule 144A, (y) is aware that the transfer to it or exchange, as applicable, is being made in reliance upon the exemption from the provisions of Section 5 of the Securities Act provided by Rule 144A, and (z) acknowledges that it has received such information regarding the Issuers as it has requested pursuant to Rule 144A(d)(4) or has determined not to request such information.

Sale and Leaseback Transaction ” means an arrangement relating to property, plant or equipment now owned or hereafter acquired by an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary whereby an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary transfers such property to a Person and the Issuers or such Restricted Subsidiary leases it from such Person, other than (i) leases between the Issuers and a Restricted Subsidiary or between Restricted Subsidiaries or (ii) any such transaction entered into with respect to any property, plant or equipment or any improvements thereto at the time of, or within 180 days after, the acquisition or completion of construction of such property, plant or equipment or such improvements (or, if later, the commencement of commercial operation of any such property, plant or equipment), as the case may be, to finance the cost of such property, plant or equipment or such improvements, as the case may be.

SEC ” means the United States Securities and Exchange Commission.

 

38


Second Priority Obligations ” means (i) with respect to the ABL Priority Collateral, all Term Obligations and (ii) with respect to Term Priority Collateral, all ABL Obligations.

Second Priority Secured Party ” means, with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the holders of the Second Priority Obligations with respect to such Common Collateral.

Secured Hedging Obligations ” means (i) all Applicable Hedging Obligations of the Issuers or any Subsidiary Guarantor owing to any Person who is the ABL Agent with respect to the Existing ABL Facility, acted as an arranger with respect to the Existing ABL Facility or is a lender under the Existing ABL Facility at the time any such agreements were entered into and (ii) all Applicable Hedging Obligations of any Issuer or any Subsidiary Guarantor or any Subsidiary of Parent that is an obligor or a guarantor with respect to the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility owing to any Person who is the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent, acted as an arranger with respect to the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility or is a holder of Obligations under the First Lien Term Loan Agreement at the time any such agreements were entered into; provided that at or prior to the time that any transaction relating to such Applicable Hedging Obligation is executed, the holder of such obligations shall have delivered notice to the ABL Agent with respect to the Existing ABL Facility that such a transaction has been entered into and is entitled to the benefits of the Collateral security for the Existing ABL Facility.

Secured Indebtedness ” means any Indebtedness of an Issuer secured by a Lien. “Secured Indebtedness” of a Restricted Subsidiary has a correlative meaning.

Secured Obligations ” means, collectively, the First Priority Obligations and the Second Priority Obligations.

Securities Act ” means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

Security Agreement ” means the Notes Security Agreement, dated as of the Issue Date, among the Issuers, the Subsidiary Guarantors and the Collateral Agent (as amended, supplemented, modified, extended, restructured, renewed, restated or replaced in whole or in part from time to time).

Security Documents ” means the security agreements (including the Security Agreement), pledge agreements, collateral assignments, mortgages and related agreements, as amended, supplemented, modified, extended, restructured, renewed, restated or replaced in whole or in part from time to time, creating the security interests in the properties and assets of the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors, as contemplated by this Indenture.

 

39


Series ” means (a) with respect to the Term Secured Parties, each of (i) the secured parties under the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility (in their capacities as such), (ii) the Holders of the Notes, the Collateral Agent and the Trustee, each in their capacity as such) and (iii) the Additional Term Secured Parties that become subject to the Term Intercreditor Agreement after the date hereof that are represented by a common Authorized Representative (in its capacity as such for such Additional Term Secured Parties) and (b) with respect to any Term Obligations, each of (i) the Obligations under the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility, (ii) the Notes Obligations and (iii) the Additional Term Obligations Incurred pursuant to any applicable agreement which pursuant to joinder agreement, are to be represented under the Term Intercreditor Agreement by a common Authorized Representative (in its capacity as such for such Additional Term Obligations).

Significant Subsidiary ” means any Restricted Subsidiary that would be a “significant subsidiary” of the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries on a Consolidated basis within the meaning of Rule 1-02(w) under Regulation S-X promulgated by the SEC.

Specified ABL Facility Assets ” means any ABL Priority Collateral, the net proceeds of an Asset Disposition of which are required to be applied as a prepayment of the ABL Facility.

Sponsor ” means Cerberus Capital Management, L.P.

Sponsor Group ” means Sponsor and funds and accounts Affiliated with Sponsor.

Standard & Poor’s ” means Standard & Poor’s Ratings Services, a division of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc., and any successor to its rating business.

Stated Maturity ” means, with respect to any security, the date specified in such security as the fixed date on which the final payment of principal of such security is due and payable, including pursuant to any mandatory redemption provision (but excluding any provision providing for the repurchase of such security at the option of the holder thereof upon the happening of any contingency unless such contingency has occurred).

Subordinated Obligation ” means any Indebtedness of an Issuer or a Guarantor (whether outstanding on the Issue Date or thereafter Incurred), as the case may be, that by its terms is subordinate or junior in right of payment to the Notes or such Guarantor’s Notes Guarantee, as the case may be.

Subsidiary ” of any Person means any corporation, association, partnership or other business entity of which more than 50% of the total voting

 

40


power of shares of Capital Stock or other interests (including partnership interests) entitled (without regard to the occurrence of any contingency) to vote in the election of directors, managers or trustees thereof is at the time owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by:

(1) such Person,

(2) such Person and one or more Subsidiaries of such Person or

(3) one or more Subsidiaries of such Person.

The term “ Subsidiary ” also shall include any corporation, limited liability company, partnership or other entity that: (1) under GAAP may be consolidated with such Person for financial reporting purposes; and (2) has been designated as a Subsidiary of such Person by the Board of Directors of such Person for so long as such designation remains in effect.

Subsidiary Guarantee ” means each Notes Guarantee of a Subsidiary Guarantor.

Subsidiary Guarantor ” means each Subsidiary of Parent which Guarantees the Notes.

Synthetic LC Indebtedness ” has the meaning set forth in clause (3) of the definition of “Indebtedness.”

Synthetic Letter of Credit ” means a letter of credit issued pursuant Section 2.02 of the First Lien Term Loan Agreement.

Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility ” means the letter of credit facility made available pursuant to Section 2.02 of the First Lien Term Loan Agreement.

Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent ” means JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent under the First Lien Term Loan Agreement, or its successors.

Synthetic Letter of Credit Secured Parties ” means the “Secured Parties,” as defined in the First Lien Term Loan Agreement.

Temporary Cash Investments ” means any of the following:

(1) direct obligations of, or obligations the principal of and interest on which are unconditionally guaranteed by, the United States of America (or by any agency thereof to the extent such obligations are backed by the full faith and credit of the United States of America), in each case maturing within one year from the date of acquisition thereof;

 

41


(2) investments in commercial paper maturing within 270 days from the date of acquisition thereof, and having, at such date of acquisition, ratings of A1 from Standard & Poor’s and P1 from Moody’s;

(3) investments in certificates of deposit, banker’s acceptances and time deposits maturing within 180 days from the date of acquisition thereof and issued or guaranteed by or placed with, and money market deposit accounts issued or offered by any commercial bank organized under the laws of the United States of America or any state thereof which has a short-term deposit rating of A1 from Standard & Poor’s and P1 from Moody’s and has a combined capital and surplus and undivided profits of not less than $500 million;

(4) fully collateralized repurchase agreements with a term of not more than 30 days for securities described in clause (1) above and entered into with a financial institution described in clause (3) above;

(5) money market funds that

(A) comply with the criteria set forth in SEC Rule 2a-7 under the Investment Company Act,

(B) are rated AAA by Standard & Poor’s and Aaa by Moody’s and

(C) have portfolio assets of at least $5.0 billion; and

(6) in the case of any Foreign Subsidiary,

(A) marketable direct obligations issued or unconditionally guaranteed by the sovereign nation in which such Foreign Subsidiary is organized and is conducting business or issued by any agency of such sovereign nation and backed by the full faith and credit of such sovereign nation, in each case maturing within one year from the date of acquisition, so long as the indebtedness of such sovereign nation is rated at least A by Standard & Poor’s or A2 by Moody’s or carries an equivalent rating from a comparable foreign rating agency,

(B) investments of the type and maturity described in clauses (2) through (5) of foreign obligors, which investments or obligors have ratings described in such clauses or equivalent ratings from comparable foreign rating agencies,

(C) investments of the type and maturity described in clause (3) in any obligor organized under the laws of a jurisdiction other than the United States that (i) is a branch or subsidiary of a

 

42


lender or the ultimate parent company of a lender under any Credit Facilities (but only if such lender meets the ratings and capital, surplus and undivided profits requirements of such clause (3)) or (ii) carries a rating at least equivalent to the rating of the sovereign nation in which it is located, and

(D) other investments of the type and maturity described in clause (3) in obligors organized under the laws of a jurisdiction other than the United States in any country in which such Subsidiary is located; provided that the investments permitted under this subclause (D) shall be made in amounts and jurisdictions consistent with Parent’s policies governing short-term investments.

Temporary Offshore Global Note ” means an Offshore Global Note that bears the Temporary Offshore Global Note Legend.

Temporary Offshore Global Note Legend ” means the legend set forth in Exhibit I.

Term Intercreditor Agreement ” means the Term Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of the Issue Date, as amended, among the Collateral Agent, the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent, Parent, the Issuers and the Secured Guarantors.

Term Obligations ” means (i) all Indebtedness and other Obligations under the First Lien Term Loan Agreement (including, for the avoidance of doubt, all Synthetic LC Indebtedness), (ii) the Notes Obligations and (iii) Permitted Secured Additional Pari Passu Obligations.

Term Obligations Liens ” means the Liens granted, or purported to be granted, pursuant to the Term Obligations Security Documents securing any Term Obligations.

Term Obligations Security Documents ” means the Security Documents and any other agreement, document or instrument pursuant to which a Lien is granted or purported to be granted securing Term Obligations or under which rights or remedies with respect to such Liens are governed, in each case to the extent relating to the Collateral securing Term Obligations.

Term Priority Collateral ” means all assets of the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors on which Liens have been granted pursuant to the Security Documents, other than ABL Priority Collateral.

Term Proceeds Account ” means a deposit account established in the name of an Issuer or a Subsidiary Guarantor at a financial institution where the

 

43


Issuers and Subsidiary Guarantors maintain their cash management accounts where all principal payments made on the Intercompany Receivables Collateral will be deposited, concurrently with the receipt thereof.

Term Secured Parties ” means (a) the Notes Secured Parties, (b) the Synthetic Letter of Credit Secured Parties and (c) any Additional Term Secured Parties.

TIA ” means the Trust Indenture Act of 1939 (15 U.S.C. §§ 77aaa-77bbbb), as amended, as in effect on the Issue Date and except as set forth in Section 9.05.

Trade Payables ” means, with respect to any Person, any accounts payable or any Indebtedness or monetary obligation to trade creditors created, assumed or Guaranteed by such Person arising in the ordinary course of business in connection with the acquisition of goods or services (including expense accruals and deferred compensation items).

Trust Officer ” means any officer of the Trustee in its Corporate Trust Department with direct responsibility for the administration of the trusts established hereby and, also, with respect to any particular matter, any other officer of the Trustee to whom such matter is referred because of such officer’s knowledge of, and familiarity with, the particular subject and who shall in each case have direct responsibility for the administration of this Indenture.

Trustee ” means the party named as such in the first paragraph of this Indenture until a successor replaces it, and thereafter, means the successor.

Type ” with respect to any Common Collateral, refers to whether such Common Collateral is ABL Priority Collateral or Term Priority Collateral.

U.S. Dollar Equivalent ” means with respect to any monetary amount in a currency other than U.S. dollars, at any time for determination thereof, the amount of U.S. dollars obtained by converting such foreign currency involved in such computation into U.S. dollars at the spot rate for the purchase of U.S. dollars with the applicable foreign currency as published in The Wall Street Journal in the “Exchange Rates” column under the heading “Currency Trading” on the date two Business Days prior to such determination.

U.S. Global Note ” means a Global Note that bears the Restricted Legend representing Notes issued and sold pursuant to Rule 144A.

U.S. Government Obligations ” means direct obligations (or certificates representing an ownership interest in such obligations) of the United States of America (including any agency or instrumentality thereof) for the payment of

 

44


which the full faith and credit of the United States of America is pledged and which are not callable or redeemable at the issuer’s option.

Unrestricted Subsidiary ” means:

(1) any Subsidiary of Parent that at the time of determination shall be designated an Unrestricted Subsidiary by the Board of Directors of the Issuers in the manner provided below; and

(2) any Subsidiary of an Unrestricted Subsidiary.

The Board of Directors of the Issuers may designate any Subsidiary of Parent (including any newly acquired or newly formed Subsidiary of Parent) to be an Unrestricted Subsidiary unless such Subsidiary or any of its Subsidiaries owns any Capital Stock or Indebtedness of, or owns or holds any Lien on any property of, the Issuers or any other Subsidiary of Parent that is not a Subsidiary of the Subsidiary to be so designated; provided , however , that (i) the Subsidiary to be so designated has total Consolidated assets of $1,000 or less; (ii) at the time of such designation, the Issuers could have made a Restricted Payment under clauses (a)(C) and (b)(13) of Section 4.07 in an amount equal to the lesser of (A) the Parent’s, Issuers’ and the Restricted Subsidiaries’ Restricted Investment in such Restricted Subsidiary and (B) the Fair Market Value of the net assets of such Restricted Subsidiary, in each case at the time of such designation; or (iii) such Subsidiary is a Foreign Subsidiary that is a joint venture or similar entity.

The Board of Directors of the Issuers may designate any Unrestricted Subsidiary to be a Restricted Subsidiary; provided , however , that immediately after giving effect to such designation:

(x) (1) the Issuers could Incur $1.00 of additional Indebtedness under paragraph (a) of Section 4.06 or (2) the Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio for the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries would be the same or greater after giving effect to such designation than before such designation; and

(y) no Default shall have occurred and be continuing.

Any such designation of a Subsidiary as a Restricted Subsidiary or Unrestricted Subsidiary by the Board of Directors of the Issuers shall be evidenced to the Trustee by promptly filing with the Trustee a copy of the resolution of the Board of Directors of the Issuers giving effect to such designation and an Officers’ Certificate certifying that such designation complied with the foregoing provisions.

Voting Stock ” of a Person means all classes of Capital Stock or other interests (including partnership interests) of such Person then outstanding and normally entitled without regard to the occurrence of any contingency) to vote in the election of directors, managers or trustees thereof.

 

45


Section 1.02. Other Definitions .

 

Term

   Defined in Section

“act”

   12.02

“Adjusted Treasury Rate”

   3.04

“Affiliate Transaction”

   4.13

“Applicable Premium”

   3.04

“Asset Disposition Offer”

   4.12

“Authentication Order”

   2.02

“bankruptcy default”

   6.01

“cash transaction”

   7.03

“Change of Control”

   4.11

“Change of Control Group”

   4.11

“Change of Control Offer”

   4.11

“Collateral Disposition Offer”

   4.12

“Collateral Excess Proceeds”

   4.12

“Comparable Treasury Issue”

   3.04

“covenant defeasance”

   8.03

“cross acceleration provision”

   6.01

“defeasance trust”

   8.02

“DTC Legend”

   Exhibit D

“Event of Default”

   6.01

“Excess Proceeds”

   4.12

“expiration date”

   3.06

“Guaranteed Obligations”

   11.01

“judgment default provision”

   6.01

“Material Capital Markets Indebtedness”

   4.14

“Notes Guarantee”

   11.01

“offer”

   3.06

“Offer to Purchase”

   3.06

“protected purchaser”

   2.04

“Purchase”

   4.07

“purchase amount”

   3.06

“purchase date”

   3.06

“Register”

   2.09

“Representative”

   10.01

“Restricted Payment”

   4.07

“Restricted Purchase Amount”

   4.07

“Reversion Date”

   4.15

“Second Commitment”

   4.12

“self-liquidating paper”

   7.03

“Successor Company”

   5.01

“Successor Guarantor”

   5.01

“Successor Parent”

   5.01

“Suspended Covenants”

   4.15

 

46


“Suspension Date”

   4.15

“Suspension Period”

   4.15

Section 1.03. Rules of Construction . Unless the context otherwise requires or except as otherwise expressly provided,

(1) an accounting term not otherwise defined has the meaning assigned to it in accordance with GAAP;

(2) “herein,” “hereof” and other words of similar import refer to this Indenture as a whole and not to any particular Section, Article or other subdivision;

(3) all references to Sections or Articles or Exhibits refer to Sections or Articles or Exhibits of or to this Indenture unless otherwise indicated; and

(4) references to agreements or instruments, or to statutes or regulations, are to such agreements or instruments, or statutes or regulations, as amended from time to time (or to successor statutes and regulations).

ARTICLE 2

T HE N OTES

Section 2.01. Form, Dating and Denominations; Legends . (a) The Notes and the Trustee’s certificate of authentication will be substantially in the form attached as Exhibit A. The terms and provisions contained in the form of the Notes annexed as Exhibit A constitute, and are hereby expressly made, a part of this Indenture. The Notes may have notations, legends or endorsements required by law, rules of or agreements with national securities exchanges to which the Issuers are subject, or usage. Each Note will be dated the date of its authentication. The Notes will be issuable in denominations of $2,000 in principal amount and any higher integral multiple of $1,000.

(b) (1) Except as otherwise provided in Section 2.01(c), Section 2.09(b)(4), the last sentence of Section 2.10(b)(3), the last sentence of Section 2.10(b)(5), or Section 2.10(c), each Initial Note or Initial Additional Note (other than a Permanent Offshore Note) will bear the Restricted Legend.

(2) Each Global Note, whether or not an Initial Note or Additional Note, will bear the DTC Legend.

(3) Each Temporary Offshore Global Note will bear the Temporary Offshore Global Note Legend.

 

47


(4) Initial Notes and Additional Notes offered and sold in reliance on Regulation S will be issued as provided in Section 2.11(a).

(5) Initial Notes and Additional Notes offered and sold in reliance on any exemption under the Securities Act other than Regulation S and Rule 144A will be issued, and upon the request of the Issuers to the Trustee, Initial Notes offered and sold in reliance on Rule 144A may be issued, in the form of Certificated Notes.

(6) Notes sold or transferred to Affiliates of the Issuers shall be issued in the form of Certificated Notes bearing a Restricted Legend.

(7) Each Note will bear the OID Legend.

(c) (1) If the Issuers determine (upon the advice of counsel and such other certifications and evidence as the Issuers may reasonably require) that a Note is eligible for resale pursuant to Rule 144 under the Securities Act (or a successor provision) and that the Restricted Legend is no longer necessary or appropriate in order to ensure that subsequent transfers of the Note (or a beneficial interest therein) are effected in compliance with the Securities Act, or

(2) after an Initial Note or any Additional Note is sold pursuant to a registration statement that is effective under the Securities Act at the time of such sale or transfer, the Issuers may instruct the Trustee to cancel the Note and issue to the non-Affiliate Holder thereof (or its transferee) a new Note of like tenor and amount, registered in the name of the Holder thereof (or its transferee), that does not bear the Restricted Legend, and the Trustee will comply with such instruction.

(d) By its acceptance of any Note bearing the Restricted Legend (or any beneficial interest in such a Note), each Holder thereof and each owner of a beneficial interest therein acknowledges the restrictions on transfer of such Note (and any such beneficial interest) set forth in this Indenture and in the Restricted Legend and agrees that it will transfer such Note (and any such beneficial interest) only in accordance with this Indenture and such legend.

Section 2.02. Execution and Authentication; Additional Notes . (a) An Officer shall execute the Notes for the Issuers by facsimile or manual signature in the name and on behalf of the Issuers. If an Officer whose signature is on a Note no longer holds that office at the time the Note is authenticated, the Note will still be valid.

(b) A Note will not be valid until the Trustee manually signs the certificate of authentication on the Note, with the signature conclusive evidence that the Note has been authenticated under this Indenture.

 

48


(c) At any time and from time to time after the execution and delivery of this Indenture, the Issuers may deliver Notes executed by the Issuers to the Trustee for authentication. The Trustee will authenticate and deliver

(1) Initial Notes for original issue in the aggregate principal amount not to exceed $430,000,000, and

(2) Additional Notes from time to time for original issue in aggregate principal amounts specified by the Issuers,

in each case so long as the Trustee shall have received (i) an Officers’ Certificate specifying (an “ Authentication Order ”)

(A) the amount of Notes to be authenticated and the date on which the Notes are to be authenticated,

(B) whether the Notes are to be Initial Notes or Additional Notes,

(C) in the case of Additional Notes, that the issuance of such Notes does not contravene any provision of Section 2.02(d) or (e), or Article 4,

(D) whether the Notes are to be issued as one or more Global Notes or Certificated Notes and

(E) other information the Issuers may determine to include or the Trustee may reasonably request,

and, (ii) in the case of Additional Notes, unless the Issuers shall have obtained “CUSIP” and “CINS” numbers different from the Initial Notes for such series of Additional Notes, the Issuers shall deliver to the Trustee an Opinion of Counsel confirming that such Additional Notes will be fungible with the Initial Notes for federal income tax purposes.

(d) The Issuers will only be permitted to issue Additional Notes if at the time of, and giving effect to, such issuance the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries (and Parent where applicable) are in compliance with the covenants contained in this Indenture, including Sections 4.06 and 4.08, and subject to the limitation on Term Obligations set forth in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

(e) Any Additional Notes will be part of the same Series as the Initial Notes, and will vote on all matters with the Initial Notes.

Section 2.03. Registrar, Paying Agent and Authenticating Agent; Paying Agent to Hold Money in Trust . (a) The Issuers may appoint one or more Registrars and one or more Paying Agents, and the Trustee may appoint an

 

49


Authenticating Agent, in which case each reference in this Indenture to the Trustee in respect of the obligations of the Trustee to be performed by that Agent will be deemed to be references to the Agent. The Issuers may act as Registrar or (except for purposes of Article 8) Paying Agent. In each case the Issuers and the Trustee will enter into an appropriate agreement with the Agent implementing the provisions of this Indenture relating to the obligations of the Trustee to be performed by the Agent and the related rights. The Issuers initially appoint the Trustee as Registrar and the Corporate Trust Office of the Trustee to act as Paying Agent.

(b) The Issuers will require each Paying Agent other than the Trustee to agree in writing that the Paying Agent will hold in trust for the benefit of the Holders or the Trustee all money held by the Paying Agent for the payment of principal of and interest on the Notes and will promptly notify the Trustee of any default by the Issuers in making any such payment. The Issuers at any time may require a Paying Agent to pay all money held by it to the Trustee and account for any funds disbursed, and the Trustee may at any time during the continuance of any payment default, upon written request to a Paying Agent, require the Paying Agent to pay all money held by it to the Trustee and to account for any funds disbursed. Upon doing so, the Paying Agent will have no further liability for the money so paid over to the Trustee.

Section 2.04. Replacement Notes . If a mutilated Note is surrendered to the Trustee or if a Holder claims that its Note has been lost, destroyed or wrongfully taken, the Issuers will issue and the Trustee will authenticate a replacement Note if the requirements of Section 8-405 of the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect in the State of New York are met such that the Holder (a) notifies the Issuers and the Trustee within a reasonable time after such Holder has notice of such loss, destruction or wrongful taking and the Registrar has not registered a transfer prior to receiving such notification, (b) makes such request to the Issuers prior to the Issuers having notice that the Note has been acquired by a protected purchaser as defined in Section 8-303 of the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect in the State of New York (a “ protected purchaser ”) and (c) satisfies any other reasonable requirements of the Issuers and the Trustee; then, in the absence of notice to the Issuers or the Trustee that such Note has been acquired by a protected purchaser, the Issuer shall execute and the Trustee shall authenticate and deliver, in exchange for any such mutilated Note or in lieu of any such destroyed, lost or stolen Note, a new Note of like tenor and principal amount, bearing a number not contemporaneously outstanding. Every replacement Note is an additional obligation of the Issuers and entitled to the benefits of this Indenture. If required by the Trustee or the Issuers, an indemnity must be furnished that is sufficient in the judgment of both the Trustee and the Issuers to protect the Issuers, the Trustee, the Paying Agent and the Registrar from any loss they may suffer if a Note is replaced. The Issuers may charge the Holder for the expenses of the Issuers and the Trustee in replacing a Note, including, to the extent applicable, a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other

 

50


governmental charge that may be imposed in relation thereto and any other expenses incurred by the Issuers or the Trustee in connection therewith. In case the mutilated, lost, destroyed or wrongfully taken Note has become or is about to become due and payable, the Issuers in its discretion may pay the Note instead of issuing a replacement Note. The provisions of this Section are exclusive and shall preclude (to the extent lawful) all other rights and remedies with respect to the replacement or payment of mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Notes.

Section 2.05. Outstanding Notes . (a) Notes outstanding at any time are all Notes that have been authenticated by the Trustee except for

(1) Notes cancelled by the Trustee or delivered to it for cancellation;

(2) any Note which has been replaced pursuant to Section 2.04 unless and until the Trustee and the Issuers receive proof satisfactory to them that the replaced Note is held by a bona fide purchaser; and

(3) on or after the maturity date or any Redemption Date or date for purchase of the Notes pursuant to an Offer to Purchase, those Notes payable or to be redeemed or purchased on that date for which the Trustee (or Paying Agent, other than the Issuers or an Affiliate of the Issuers) holds money sufficient to pay all amounts then due.

(b) A Note does not cease to be outstanding because the Issuers or one of its Affiliates holds the Note, provided that in determining whether the Holders of the requisite principal amount of the outstanding Notes have given or taken any request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent, waiver or other action hereunder, Notes owned by the Issuers or any Affiliate of the Issuers will be disregarded and deemed not to be outstanding (it being understood that in determining whether the Trustee is protected in relying upon any such request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent, waiver or other action, only Notes which the Trustee knows to be so owned will be so disregarded). Notes so owned which have been pledged in good faith may be regarded as outstanding if the pledgee establishes to the satisfaction of the Trustee the pledgee’s right so to act with respect to such Notes and that the pledgee is not the Issuers or any Affiliate of the Issuers. In the case of a dispute as to such right, any decision by the Trustee taken upon the advice of counsel shall be full protection to the Trustee. Upon request of the Trustee, the Issuers shall furnish to the Trustee promptly an Officers’ Certificate listing and identifying all Notes, if any, known by the Issuers to be owned or held by or for the account of any of the above described Persons, and the Trustee shall be entitled to accept such Officers’ Certificate as conclusive evidence of the facts therein set forth and of the fact that all Notes not listed therein are outstanding for the purpose of any determination.

 

51


Section 2.06 . Temporary Notes . Until definitive Notes are ready for delivery, the Issuers may prepare and the Trustee, upon receipt of an Authentication Order, will authenticate temporary Notes. Temporary Notes will be substantially in the form of definitive Notes but may have insertions, substitutions, omissions and other variations determined to be appropriate by the Officer executing the temporary Notes, as evidenced by the execution of the temporary Notes. If temporary Notes are issued, the Issuers will cause definitive Notes to be prepared without unreasonable delay. After the preparation of definitive Notes, the temporary Notes will be exchangeable for definitive Notes upon surrender of the temporary Notes at the office or agency of the Issuers designated for the purpose pursuant to Section 4.02, without charge to the Holder. Upon surrender for cancellation of any temporary Notes the Issuers will execute and the Trustee will authenticate and deliver in exchange therefor a like principal amount of definitive Notes of authorized denominations. Until so exchanged, the temporary Notes will be entitled to the same benefits under this Indenture as definitive Notes.

Section 2.07. Cancellation . The Issuers at any time may deliver to the Trustee for cancellation any Notes previously authenticated and delivered hereunder which the Issuers may have acquired in any manner whatsoever, and may deliver to the Trustee for cancellation any Notes previously authenticated hereunder which the Issuers have issued and sold. Any Registrar or the Paying Agent will forward to the Trustee any Notes surrendered to it for transfer, exchange or payment. The Trustee will cancel all Notes surrendered for transfer, exchange, payment or cancellation and dispose of them in accordance with its normal procedures or the written instructions of the Issuers. The Issuers may not issue new Notes to replace Notes they have paid in full or delivered to the Trustee for cancellation.

Section 2.08. CUSIP and CINS Numbers . The Issuers in issuing the Notes may use “CUSIP” and “CINS” numbers, and the Trustee will use CUSIP numbers or CINS numbers in notices of redemption or exchange or in Offers to Purchase as a convenience to Holders, the notice to state that no representation is made as to the correctness of such numbers either as printed on the Notes or as contained in any notice of redemption or exchange or Offer to Purchase. The Issuers will promptly notify the Trustee of any change in CUSIP or CINS numbers.

Section 2.09. Registration, Transfer and Exchange . (a) The Notes will be issued in registered form only, without coupons, and the Issuers shall cause the Registrar to maintain a register (the “ Register ”) of the Notes, for registering the record ownership of the Notes by the Holders and transfers and exchanges of the Notes.

 

52


(b) (1) Each Global Note will be registered in the name of the Depositary or its nominee and, so long as DTC is serving as the Depositary thereof, will bear the DTC Legend.

(2) Each Global Note will be delivered to the Trustee as custodian for the Depositary. Transfers of a Global Note (but not a beneficial interest therein) will be limited to transfers thereof in whole, but not in part, to the Depositary, its successors or their respective nominees, except (A) as set forth in Section 2.09(b)(4) and (B) transfers of portions thereof in the form of Certificated Notes may be made upon request of an Agent Member (for itself or on behalf of a beneficial owner) by written notice given to the Trustee by or on behalf of the Depositary in accordance with customary procedures of the Depositary and in compliance with this Section 2.09 and Section 2.10.

(3) Agent Members will have no rights under this Indenture with respect to any Global Note held on their behalf by the Depositary, and the Depositary may be treated by the Issuers, the Trustee and any agent of the Issuers or the Trustee as the absolute owner and Holder of such Global Note for all purposes whatsoever. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Depositary or its nominee may grant proxies and otherwise authorize any Person (including any Agent Member and any Person that holds a beneficial interest in a Global Note through an Agent Member) to take any action which a Holder is entitled to take under this Indenture or the Notes, and nothing in this Indenture will impair, as between the Depositary and its Agent Members, the operation of customary practices governing the exercise of the rights of a holder of any security.

(4) If (x) the Depositary notifies the Issuers that it is unwilling or unable to continue as Depositary for any of the Global Notes and a successor depositary is not appointed by the Issuers within 90 days of the notice or (y) an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing and the Trustee has received a request from the Depositary, the Trustee will promptly exchange each beneficial interest in the Global Note for one or more Certificated Notes in authorized denominations having an equal aggregate principal amount registered in the name of the owner of such beneficial interest, as identified to the Trustee by the Depositary, and thereupon the Global Note will be deemed canceled. If such Note does not bear the Restricted Legend, then the Certificated Notes issued in exchange therefor will not bear the Restricted Legend. If such Note bears the Restricted Legend, then the Certificated Notes issued in exchange therefor will bear the Restricted Legend, provided that any Holder of any such Certificated Note issued in exchange for a beneficial interest in a Temporary Offshore Global Note will have the right upon presentation to the Trustee of a duly completed Certificate of Beneficial

 

53


Ownership after the Restricted Period to exchange such Certificated Note for a Certificated Note of like tenor and amount that does not bear the Restricted Legend, registered in the name of such Holder.

(c) Each Certificated Note will be registered in the name of the Holder thereof or its nominee.

(d) A Holder may transfer a Note (or a beneficial interest therein) to another Person or exchange a Note (or a beneficial interest therein) for another Note or Notes of any authorized denomination by presenting to the Registrar a written request therefor stating the name of the proposed transferee or requesting such an exchange, accompanied by any certification, opinion or other document required by Section 2.10. The Registrar will promptly register any transfer or exchange that meets the requirements of this Section by noting the same in the register maintained by the Registrar for the purpose; provided that

(x) no transfer or exchange will be effective until it is registered in such register and

(y) the Registrar will not be required (i) to issue, register the transfer of or exchange any Note for a period of 15 days before a selection of Notes to be redeemed or purchased pursuant to an Offer to Purchase, (ii) to register the transfer of or exchange any Note so selected for redemption or purchase in whole or in part, except, in the case of a partial redemption or purchase, that portion of any Note not being redeemed or purchased, or (iii) if a redemption or a purchase pursuant to an Offer to Purchase is to occur after a Regular Record Date but on or before the corresponding Interest Payment Date, to register the transfer of or exchange any Note on or after the Regular Record Date and before the date of redemption or purchase. Prior to the registration of any transfer, the Issuers, the Trustee and their agents will treat the Person in whose name the Note is registered as the owner and Holder thereof for all purposes (whether or not the Note is overdue), and will not be affected by notice to the contrary.

From time to time the Issuers will execute and the Trustee, upon receipt of an Authentication Order, will authenticate additional Notes as necessary in order to permit the registration of a transfer or exchange in accordance with this Section.

No service charge will be imposed in connection with any transfer or exchange of any Note, but the Issuers may require payment of a sum sufficient to cover any transfer tax or similar governmental charge payable in connection therewith (other than a transfer tax or other similar governmental charge payable upon exchange pursuant to subsection (b)(4)).

 

54


(e) (1) Global Note to Global Note . If a beneficial interest in a Global Note is transferred or exchanged for a beneficial interest in another Global Note, the Trustee will (x) record a decrease in the principal amount of the Global Note being transferred or exchanged equal to the principal amount of such transfer or exchange and (y) record a like increase in the principal amount of the other Global Note. Any beneficial interest in one Global Note that is transferred to a Person who takes delivery in the form of an interest in another Global Note, or exchanged for an interest in another Global Note, will, upon transfer or exchange, cease to be an interest in such Global Note and become an interest in the other Global Note and, accordingly, will thereafter be subject to all transfer and exchange restrictions, if any, and other procedures applicable to beneficial interests in such other Global Note for as long as it remains such an interest.

(2) Global Note to Certificated Note . If a beneficial interest in a Global Note is transferred or exchanged for a Certificated Note, the Trustee will (x) record a decrease in the principal amount of such Global Note equal to the principal amount of such transfer or exchange and (y) deliver one or more new Certificated Notes in authorized denominations having an equal aggregate principal amount to the transferee (in the case of a transfer) or the owner of such beneficial interest (in the case of an exchange), registered in the name of such transferee or owner, as applicable.

(3) Certificated Note to Global Note . If a Certificated Note is transferred or exchanged for a beneficial interest in a Global Note, the Trustee will (x) cancel such Certificated Note, (y) record an increase in the principal amount of such Global Note equal to the principal amount of such transfer or exchange and (z) in the event that such transfer or exchange involves less than the entire principal amount of the canceled Certificated Note, deliver to the Holder thereof one or more new Certificated Notes in authorized denominations having an aggregate principal amount equal to the untransferred or unexchanged portion of the canceled Certificated Note, registered in the name of the Holder thereof.

(4) Certificated Note to Certificated Note . If a Certificated Note is transferred or exchanged for another Certificated Note, the Trustee will (x) cancel the Certificated Note being transferred or exchanged, (y) deliver one or more new Certificated Notes in authorized denominations having an aggregate principal amount equal to the principal amount of such transfer or exchange to the transferee (in the case of a transfer) or the Holder of the canceled Certificated Note (in the case of an exchange), registered in the name of such transferee or Holder, as applicable, and (z) if such transfer or exchange involves less than the entire principal amount of the canceled Certificated Note, deliver to the

 

55


Holder thereof one or more Certificated Notes in authorized denominations having an aggregate principal amount equal to the untransferred or unexchanged portion of the canceled Certificated Note, registered in the name of the Holder thereof.

(f) All certifications, certificates and Opinions of Counsel required to be submitted to the Registrar pursuant to this Section to effect a registration of transfer or exchange may be submitted by facsimile.

(g) Each Holder of a Note agrees to indemnify the Company and the Trustee against any liability that may result from the transfer, exchange or assignment of such Holder’s Note in violation of any provision of this Indenture and/or applicable United States federal or state securities laws.

(h) Neither the Trustee nor any agent of the Trustee shall have any responsibility for any actions taken or not taken by the Depositary.

(i) The Trustee shall have no obligation or duty to monitor, determine or inquire as to compliance with any restrictions on transfer imposed under this Indenture or under applicable law with respect to any transfer of any interest in any Note (including any transfers between or among Agent Members in any Global Note) other than to require delivery of such certificates and other documentation or evidence as are expressly required by, and to do so if and when expressly required by, the terms of this Indenture, and to examine the same to determine substantial compliance as to form with the express requirements hereof.

Section 2.10. Restrictions on Transfer and Exchange . (a) The transfer or exchange of any Note (or a beneficial interest therein) may only be made in accordance with this Section 2.10 and Section 2.09 and, in the case of a Global Note (or a beneficial interest therein), the applicable rules and procedures of the Depositary. The Registrar shall refuse to register any requested transfer or exchange that does not comply with the preceding sentence.

(b) Subject to paragraph 2.10(c), the transfer or exchange of any Note (or a beneficial interest therein) of the type set forth in column A below for a Note (or a beneficial interest therein) of the type set forth opposite in column B below may only be made in compliance with the certification requirements (if any) described in the clause of this paragraph set forth opposite in column C below.

 

A

  

B

   C  

U.S. Global Note

   U.S. Global Note    (1

U.S. Global Note

   Offshore Global Note    (2

U.S. Global Note

   Certificated Note    (3

Offshore Global Note

   U.S. Global Note    (4

 

56


A

  

B

   C  

Offshore Global Note

   Offshore Global Note    (1

Offshore Global Note

   Certificated Note    (5

Certificated Note

   U.S. Global Note    (4

Certificated Note

   Offshore Global Note    (2

Certificated Note

   Certificated Note    (3

(1) No certification is required.

(2) The Person requesting the transfer or exchange must deliver or cause to be delivered to the Registrar a duly completed Regulation S Certificate; provided that if the requested transfer or exchange is made by the Holder of a Certificated Note that does not bear the Restricted Legend, then no certification is required.

(3) The Person requesting the transfer or exchange must deliver or cause to be delivered to the Registrar (x) a duly completed Rule 144A Certificate, (y) a duly completed Regulation S Certificate or (z) a duly completed Institutional Accredited Investor Certificate, and/or an Opinion of Counsel and such other certifications and evidence as the Issuers may reasonably require in order to determine that the proposed transfer or exchange is being made in compliance with the Securities Act and any applicable securities laws of any state of the United States; provided that if the requested transfer or exchange is made by the Holder of a Certificated Note that does not bear the Restricted Legend, then no certification is required. In the event that (i) the requested transfer or exchange takes place after the Restricted Period and a duly completed Regulation S Certificate is delivered to the Registrar or (ii) a Certificated Note that does not bear the Restricted Legend is surrendered for transfer or exchange, upon transfer or exchange the Registrar will deliver a Certificated Note that does not bear the Restricted Legend.

(4) The Person requesting the transfer or exchange must deliver or cause to be delivered to the Registrar a duly completed Rule 144A Certificate.

(5) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Indenture, no such exchange is permitted if the requested exchange involves a beneficial interest in a Temporary Offshore Global Note. If the requested transfer involves a beneficial interest in a Temporary Offshore Global Note, the Person requesting the transfer must deliver or cause to be delivered to the Registrar (x) a duly completed Rule 144A Certificate or (y) a duly completed Institutional Accredited Investor Certificate and/or an Opinion of Counsel and such other certifications and evidence as the Issuers may reasonably require in order to determine that the proposed transfer is being made in compliance with the

 

57


Securities Act and any applicable securities laws of any state of the United States. If the requested transfer or exchange involves a beneficial interest in a Permanent Offshore Global Note, no certification is required and the Registrar will deliver a Certificated Note that does not bear the Restricted Legend.

(c) No certification is required in connection with any transfer or exchange of any Note (or a beneficial interest therein)

(1) after such Note is eligible for resale pursuant to Rule 144 under the Securities Act (or a successor provision); provided that the Issuers have provided the Registrar with an Officers’ Certificate to that effect, and the Issuers may require from any Person requesting a transfer or exchange in reliance upon this clause (1) an opinion of counsel and any other reasonable certifications and evidence in order to support such certificate; or

(2) sold pursuant to a registration statement that is effective under the Securities Act at the time of such transfer or exchange.

Subject to Section 2.01(b)(6), any Certificated Note delivered in reliance upon this paragraph will not bear the Restricted Legend.

(d) The Registrar will retain copies of all certificates, opinions and other documents received in connection with the transfer or exchange of a Note (or a beneficial interest therein), and the Issuers will have the right to inspect and make copies thereof at any reasonable time upon written notice to the Registrar.

Section 2.11. Temporary Offshore Global Notes . (a) Each Note originally sold by the Initial Purchasers in reliance upon Regulation S will be evidenced by one or more Offshore Global Notes that bear the Temporary Offshore Global Note Legend.

(b) An owner of a beneficial interest in a Temporary Offshore Global Note (or a Person acting on behalf of such an owner) may provide to the Registrar (and the Registrar will accept) a duly completed Certificate of Beneficial Ownership at any time after the Restricted Period (it being understood that the Registrar will not accept any such certificate during the Restricted Period). Promptly after acceptance of a Certificate of Beneficial Ownership with respect to such a beneficial interest, the Registrar will cause such beneficial interest to be exchanged for an equivalent beneficial interest in a Permanent Offshore Global Note, and will (x) permanently reduce the principal amount of such Temporary Offshore Global Note by the amount of such beneficial interest and (y) increase the principal amount of such Permanent Offshore Global Note by the amount of such beneficial interest.

 

58


(c) Notwithstanding paragraph (b), if after the Restricted Period any Initial Purchaser owns a beneficial interest in a Temporary Offshore Global Note, such Initial Purchaser may, upon written request to the Registrar accompanied by a certification as to its status as an Initial Purchaser, exchange such beneficial interest for an equivalent beneficial interest in a Permanent Offshore Global Note, and the Registrar will comply with such request and will (x) permanently reduce the principal amount of such Temporary Offshore Global Note by the amount of such beneficial interest and (y) increase the principal amount of such Permanent Offshore Global Note by the amount of such beneficial interest.

(d) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Indenture, any owner of a beneficial interest in a Temporary Offshore Global Note shall not be entitled to receive payment of principal or interest on such beneficial interest or other amounts in respect of such beneficial interest until such beneficial interest is exchanged for an interest in a Permanent Offshore Global Note or transferred for an interest in another Global Note or a Certificated Note.

ARTICLE 3

R EDEMPTION ; O FFER TO P URCHASE

Section 3.01. Optional Redemption . Except as set forth under this Article 3, the Issuers may not redeem the Notes prior to September 1, 2014. After this date, the Issuers may redeem the Notes, in whole or in part, on not less than 30 nor more than 60 days’ prior written notice in accordance with Section 3.05, at the following Redemption Prices (expressed as percentages of principal amount), plus accrued and unpaid interest to the Redemption Date (subject to the right of Holders of record on the Regular Record Date to receive interest due on the relevant Interest Payment Date), if redeemed during the 12-month period commencing on September 1 of the years set forth below:

 

Year

   Redemption Price  

2014

   105.313

2015

   102.656

2016 and thereafter

   100.000

Section 3.02. Redemption With Proceeds of Public Equity Offering . Prior to September 1, 2013, the Issuers may, on one or more occasions, redeem up to an aggregate maximum of 35% of the original aggregate principal amount of the Notes (calculated giving effect to any issuance of Additional Notes) with the Net Cash Proceeds of one or more Equity Offerings subsequent to the Issue Date, at a Redemption Price equal to 110.625% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest to the Redemption Date (subject to the right of

 

59


Holders of record on the Regular Record Date to receive interest due on the relevant Interest Payment Date); provided , however , that:

(1) at least 65% of the original aggregate principal amount of the Notes (calculated giving effect to any issuance of Additional Notes) remains outstanding after giving effect to any such redemption (excluding Notes held by Parent or any of its Subsidiaries); and

(2) any such redemption by the Issuers must be made within 90 days after the closing of such Equity Offering and must be made in accordance with certain procedures set forth in this Indenture.

Section 3.03. 105% Redemptions . Prior to September 1, 2014, during any 12-month period commencing on the Issue Date, the Issuers may, at their option, redeem up to 10% of the aggregate principal amount of the Notes issued under this Indenture (calculated giving effect to any issuance of Additional Notes) at a Redemption Price equal to 105.000% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest to the Redemption Date (subject to the right of Holders of record on the Regular Record Date to receive interest due on the relevant Interest Payment Date).

Section 3.04. Make-whole Redemptions . Prior to September 1, 2014, the Issuers may at their option redeem the Notes, in whole or in part, at a Redemption Price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the Notes plus the Applicable Premium as of, and accrued and unpaid interest to, the Redemption Date (subject to the right of Holders on the Regular Record Date to receive interest due on the relevant Interest Payment Date). Notice of such redemption must be mailed by first-class mail to each Holder’s registered address, not less than 30 nor more than 60 days prior to the Redemption Date.

Applicable Premium ” means, with respect to a Note at any applicable Redemption Date, the greater of (1) 1.00% of the then outstanding principal amount of such Note and (2) the excess of (A) the present value at such Redemption Date of (i) the Redemption Price of such Note on September 1, 2014 (such Redemption Price being described in Section 3.01 exclusive of any accrued interest), plus (ii) all required remaining scheduled interest payments due on such Note through September 1, 2014 (but excluding accrued and unpaid interest to the Redemption Date), computed using a discount rate equal to the Adjusted Treasury Rate, over (B) the principal amount of such Note on such Redemption Date.

Adjusted Treasury Rate ” means, with respect to any Redemption Date for the Notes, (1) the yield, under the heading which represents the average for the immediately preceding week, appearing in the most recently published statistical release designated “H.15(519)” or any successor publication which is published weekly by the Board of

 

60


Governors of the Federal Reserve System and which establishes yields on actively traded United States Treasury securities adjusted to constant maturity under the caption “Treasury Constant Maturities,” for the maturity corresponding to the Comparable Treasury Issue (if no maturity is within three months before or after September 1, 2014, yields for the two published maturities most closely corresponding to the Comparable Treasury Issue shall be determined and the Adjusted Treasury Rate shall be interpolated or extrapolated from such yields on a straight line basis, rounding to the nearest month) or (2) if such release (or any successor release) is not published during the week preceding the calculation date or does not contain such yields, the rate per year equal to the semiannual equivalent yield to maturity of the Comparable Treasury Issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the Comparable Treasury Price for such Redemption Date, in each case calculated on the third Business Day immediately preceding the Redemption Date, in each case of (1) and (2), plus 0.50%.

Comparable Treasury Issue ” means, with respect to the Notes the United States Treasury security selected by the Quotation Agent as having a maturity comparable to the remaining term of the Notes from the Redemption Date to September 1, 2014, that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of U.S. Dollar denominated corporate debt securities of a maturity most nearly equal to September 1, 2014.

All such Redemption Prices in this Article 3 shall be calculated in good faith by a Financial Officer of the Issuers.

Section 3.05. Method and Effect of Redemption . (a) If the Issuers elect to redeem Notes, they must notify the Trustee of (i) the Redemption Date, (ii) the clause of this Indenture pursuant to which the redemption shall occur, (iii) the Redemption Price, and (iv) the principal amount of Notes to be redeemed by delivering an Officers’ Certificate at least 30 days but not more than 60 days before the Redemption Date (unless a shorter period is satisfactory to the Trustee). If fewer than all of the Notes are being redeemed, the Officers’ Certificate must also specify a record date not less than 15 days after the date of the notice of redemption is given to the Trustee, and the Trustee will select the Notes to be redeemed on a pro rata basis to the extent practicable, by lot or by such other method in accordance with the procedures of DTC to the extent applicable, in denominations of $2,000 principal amount and higher integral multiples of $1,000. The Trustee will notify the Issuers promptly of the Notes or portions of Notes to be called for redemption. Notice of redemption must be sent by the Issuers or at the Issuers’ request, by the Trustee in the name and at the expense of the Issuers, to Holders whose Notes are to be redeemed at least 30 days but not more than 60 days before the Redemption Date; provided , that the Issuers have delivered to the Trustee, at least 45 days prior to the Redemption

 

61


Date, an Officers’ Certificate requesting that the Trustee give such notice and setting forth the information to be stated in such notice as provided below.

(b) The notice of redemption will identify the Notes to be redeemed and will include or state the following:

(1) the Redemption Date;

(2) the Redemption Price, including the portion thereof representing any accrued interest;

(3) the place or places where Notes are to be surrendered for redemption;

(4) Notes called for redemption must be so surrendered in order to collect the Redemption Price;

(5) on the Redemption Date the Redemption Price will become due and payable on Notes called for redemption, and interest on Notes called for redemption will cease to accrue on and after the Redemption Date;

(6) if any Note is redeemed in part, on and after the Redemption Date, upon surrender of such Note, new Notes equal in principal amount to the unredeemed portion will be issued;

(7) if any Note is redeemed in part only, the portion of the principal amount thereof to be redeemed;

(8) the paragraph of the Notes and/or Section of this Indenture pursuant to which the Notes called for redemption are being redeemed; and

(9) if any Note contains a CUSIP or CINS number, no representation is being made as to the correctness of the CUSIP or CINS number either as printed on the Notes or as contained in the notice of redemption and that the Holder should rely only on the other identification numbers printed on the Notes.

(c) Once notice of redemption is sent to the Holders, Notes called for redemption become due and payable at the Redemption Price on the Redemption Date, and upon surrender of the Notes called for redemption, the Issuers shall redeem such Notes at the Redemption Price. On and after the Redemption Date, interest will cease to accrue on Notes or portions thereof called for redemption so long as the Issuers have deposited with the Paying Agent funds sufficient to pay the principal of the Notes to be redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest (and premium, if any) thereon. Upon cancellation of any Note redeemed in part,

 

62


the Holder will receive a new Note equal in principal amount to the unredeemed portion of the surrendered Note in the name of such Holder.

Section 3.06. Offer to Purchase . (a) An “ Offer to Purchase ” means an offer by the Issuers to purchase Notes as required by this Indenture. An Offer to Purchase must be made by written offer (the “ offer ”), mailed by the Issuers by first class mail, postage prepaid, to each Holder of Notes at such Holder’s registered address, with a copy to the Trustee.

(b) The offer must include or state the following as to the terms of the Offer to Purchase:

(1) the provision of this Indenture pursuant to which the Offer to Purchase is being made;

(2) the aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Notes offered to be purchased by the Issuers pursuant to the Offer to Purchase (including, if less than 100%, the manner by which such amount has been determined pursuant to this Indenture) (the “ purchase amount ”), which in the case of an Offer to Purchase pursuant to a Change of Control shall be a purchase price in cash equal to 101% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest to the date of purchase (subject to the right of Holders of record on the Regular Record Date to receive interest on the relevant Interest Payment Date);

(3) the purchase price, including the portion thereof representing accrued interest;

(4) an expiration date (the “ expiration date ”) and a settlement date for purchase (the “ purchase date ”), which purchase date shall be no earlier than 30 days nor later than 60 days after notice of the Offer to Purchase is mailed to Holders and no later than five Business Days after the expiration date;

(5) the circumstances and relevant facts and financial information concerning the business of the Parent and its Subsidiaries in connection with the Offer to Purchase which the Issuers in good faith reasonably believe will enable the Holders to make an informed decision with respect to the Offer to Purchase;

(6) a Holder may tender all or any portion of its Notes, subject to the requirement that any portion of a Note tendered must be in denominations of $2,000 in principal amount and any higher integral multiple of $1,000;

 

63


(7) the place or places where Notes are to be surrendered for tender pursuant to the Offer to Purchase;

(8) each Holder electing to tender a Note pursuant to the offer will be required to surrender such Note at the place or places specified in the offer prior to the close of business on the expiration date (such Note being, if the Issuers or the Trustee so requires, duly endorsed or accompanied by a duly executed written instrument of transfer);

(9) interest on any Note not tendered, or tendered but not purchased by the Issuers pursuant to the Offer to Purchase, will continue to accrue;

(10) on the purchase date the purchase price will become due and payable on each Note accepted for purchase, and interest on Notes purchased will cease to accrue on and after the purchase date;

(11) Holders are entitled to withdraw Notes tendered by giving notice, which must be received by the Issuers or the Trustee not later than the close of business on the expiration date, setting forth the name of the Holder, the principal amount of the tendered Notes, the certificate number of the tendered Notes and a statement that the Holder is withdrawing all or a portion of the tender;

(12) (i) if Notes in an aggregate principal amount less than or equal to the purchase amount are duly tendered and not withdrawn pursuant to the Offer to Purchase, the Issuers will purchase all such Notes, and (ii) if the Offer to Purchase is for less than all of the outstanding Notes and Notes in an aggregate principal amount in excess of the purchase amount are tendered and not withdrawn pursuant to the offer, the Issuers will purchase Notes having an aggregate principal amount equal to the purchase amount on a pro rata basis, with adjustments so that only Notes in denominations of $2,000 in principal amount and any higher integral multiple of $1,000 will be purchased;

(13) if any Note is purchased in part, new Notes equal in principal amount to the unpurchased portion of the Note will be issued; and

(14) if any Note contains a CUSIP or CINS number, no representation is being made as to the correctness of the CUSIP or CINS number either as printed on the Notes or as contained in the offer and that the Holder should rely only on the other identification numbers printed on the Notes.

(c) Prior to the purchase date, the Issuers will accept tendered Notes for purchase as required by the Offer to Purchase and deliver to the Trustee all

 

64


Notes so accepted together with an Officers’ Certificate specifying which Notes have been accepted for purchase. If any Note is to be purchased in part only, any notice of purchase that relates to such Note shall state the portion of the principal amount thereof that has been or is to be purchased. On the purchase date the purchase price will become due and payable on each Note accepted for purchase, and interest on Notes purchased will cease to accrue on and after the purchase date. The Trustee will promptly return to Holders any Notes not accepted for purchase and send to Holders new Notes equal in principal amount to any unpurchased portion of any Notes accepted for purchase in part.

(d) The Issuers will comply, to the extent applicable, with the requirements of Section 14(e) of the Exchange Act and any other securities laws or regulations in connection with the purchase of Notes pursuant to this Section. To the extent that the provisions of any securities laws or regulations conflict with provisions of this Section, the Issuers will comply with the applicable securities laws and regulations and will not be deemed to have breached their respective obligations under this Section by virtue thereof.

ARTICLE 4

C OVENANTS

Section 4.01. Payment of Notes . (a) The Issuers agree to pay the principal of and interest on the Notes on the dates and in the manner provided in the Notes and this Indenture. Not later than 9:00 A.M. (New York City time) on the due date of any principal of or interest on any Notes, or any redemption or purchase price of the Notes, the Issuers will deposit with the Trustee (or Paying Agent) money in immediately available funds sufficient to pay such amounts, provided that if the Issuers or any Affiliate of the Issuers is acting as Paying Agent, it will, on or before each due date, segregate and hold in a separate trust fund for the benefit of the Holders a sum of money sufficient to pay such amounts until paid to such Holders or otherwise disposed of as provided in this Indenture. In each case the Issuers will promptly notify the Trustee of their compliance with this paragraph.

(b) An installment of principal or interest will be considered paid on the date due if the Trustee (or Paying Agent, other than the Issuers or any Affiliate of the Issuers) holds on that date money designated for and sufficient to pay the installment. If the Issuers or any Affiliate of the Issuers acts as Paying Agent, an installment of principal or interest will be considered paid on the due date only if paid to the Holders.

(c) The Issuers agree to pay interest on overdue principal and overdue installments of interest at the rate per annum specified in the Notes.

 

65


(d) Payments in respect of the Notes represented by the Global Notes are to be made by wire transfer of immediately available funds to the accounts specified by the Holders of the Global Notes. With respect to Certificated Notes, the Issuers will make all payments by wire transfer of immediately available funds to the accounts specified by the Holders thereof or, if no such account is specified, by mailing a check to each Holder’s registered address.

Section 4.02. Maintenance of Office or Agency . The Issuers will maintain in the United States of America an office or agency where Notes may be surrendered for registration of transfer or exchange or for presentation for payment and where notices and demands to or upon the Issuers in respect of the Notes and this Indenture may be served. The Issuers hereby initially designate the Corporate Trust Office of the Trustee as such office of the Issuers. The Issuers will give prompt written notice to the Trustee of the location, and any change in the location, of such office or agency. If at any time the Issuers fail to maintain any such required office or agency or fails to furnish the Trustee with the address thereof, such presentations, surrenders, notices and demands may be made or served to the Trustee.

The Issuers may also from time to time designate one or more other offices or agencies where the Notes may be surrendered or presented for any of such purposes and may from time to time rescind such designations. The Issuers will give prompt written notice to the Trustee of any such designation or rescission and of any change in the location of any such other office or agency.

Section 4.03. Existence . The Issuers and Parent will do or cause to be done all things necessary to preserve and keep in full force and effect their existence and the existence of each Restricted Subsidiary in accordance with their respective organizational documents, and the material rights, licenses and franchises of the Issuers and each Restricted Subsidiary, provided that the Issuers and Parent are not required to preserve any such right, license or franchise, or the existence of any Restricted Subsidiary that does not hold any Capital Stock, directly or indirectly, of either of the Issuers, if the maintenance or preservation thereof is no longer desirable in the conduct of the business of the Issuers and each Restricted Subsidiary taken as a whole; and provided further that this Section does not prohibit any transaction otherwise permitted by Section 4.12 or Article 5.

Section 4.04. Payment of Taxes and other Claims . The Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries will pay or discharge, and cause each of their Subsidiaries to pay or discharge before the same become delinquent (i) all material taxes, assessments and governmental charges levied or imposed upon the Issuers, the Restricted Subsidiaries or any of their Subsidiaries or their income or profits or property, and (ii) all material lawful claims for labor, materials and supplies that, if unpaid, might by law become a Lien upon the property of the Issuers, the Restricted Subsidiaries or any of their Subsidiaries, other than any such tax,

 

66


assessment, charge or claim the amount, applicability or validity of which is being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings and for which adequate reserves have been established.

Section 4.05. Maintenance of Properties and Insurance . (a) The Issuers and Parent will cause all properties used or useful in the conduct of an Issuer’s business or the business of any Restricted Subsidiary to be maintained and kept in good condition, repair and working order as in the judgment of the Issuers may be necessary so that the business of the Issuers and each Restricted Subsidiary may be properly and advantageously conducted at all times; provided that nothing in this Section prevents the Issuers or any Restricted Subsidiary from discontinuing the use, operation or maintenance of any of such properties or disposing of any of them, if such discontinuance or disposal is, in the judgment of the Issuers and Parent, desirable in the conduct of the business of the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries taken as a whole.

(b) The Issuers will maintain, and Parent will cause each of the Restricted Subsidiaries to maintain, with financially sound and reputable carriers having a financial strength rating of at least A- by A.M. Best Company (A) insurance in such amounts (with no greater risk retention) and against such risks and such other hazards, as is customarily maintained by companies of established repute engaged in the same or similar businesses operating in the same or similar locations and (B) all insurance required pursuant to the Security Documents. The Issuers will furnish to any Holder, upon request of the Trustee, information in reasonable detail as to the insurance so maintained.

(c) The Issuers will cause the Collateral Agent to at all times be named as loss payee or an additional insured (but without any liability for any premiums) under each insurance policy maintained pursuant to Section 4.05(b) covering physical damage to or theft of any Collateral. The requirement set forth in the preceding sentence is subject to the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement.

Section 4.06. Limitation on Indebtedness . (a) The Issuers will not, and Parent will not permit any Restricted Subsidiary to, Incur, directly or indirectly, any Indebtedness; provided , however , that any Issuer or any Subsidiary Guarantor may Incur Indebtedness if on the date of such Incurrence and after giving effect thereto and the application of the proceeds therefrom the Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio would be greater than 2.0:1.0.

(b) Notwithstanding the foregoing paragraph (a), the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries may Incur any or all of the following Indebtedness:

(1) Indebtedness under the Credit Facilities in an aggregate principal amount not to exceed $175.0 million, less the aggregate amount of all prepayments of principal applied to permanently reduce any such

 

67


Indebtedness in satisfaction of the Issuers’ or the Restricted Subsidiaries’ obligations under Section 4.12;

(2) Indebtedness of an Issuer owed to and held by any Restricted Subsidiary or another Issuer or Indebtedness of a Restricted Subsidiary owed to and held by an Issuer or any other Restricted Subsidiary; provided , however , that any subsequent event that results in any such Restricted Subsidiary ceasing to be a Restricted Subsidiary or any subsequent transfer of any such Indebtedness (except to an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary) shall be deemed, in each case, to constitute the Incurrence of such Indebtedness by the issuer thereof;

(3) Indebtedness (A) represented by the Notes (not including any Additional Notes) and the Subsidiary Guarantees, (B) outstanding on the Issue Date (other than the Indebtedness described in clauses (1) and (2) above) and (C) consisting of Refinancing Indebtedness Incurred in respect of any Indebtedness described in this clause (3) (including Indebtedness that is Refinancing Indebtedness) or the foregoing paragraph (a); provided , however , that Indebtedness of any Foreign Subsidiaries existing on the Issue Date (or any Refinancing Indebtedness related thereto) which is repaid with the Net Proceeds of any Equity Offering may be Refinanced pursuant to this clause (3) at a later date if such Indebtedness would otherwise constitute Refinancing Indebtedness;

(4) (A) Indebtedness of a Restricted Subsidiary Incurred and outstanding on or prior to the date on which such Restricted Subsidiary was acquired by Parent, an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary (other than Indebtedness Incurred in contemplation of, in connection with, as consideration in, or to provide all or any portion of the funds or credit support utilized to consummate, the transaction or series of related transactions pursuant to which such Restricted Subsidiary became a Subsidiary of or was otherwise acquired by Parent, an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary); provided , however , that on the date that such Restricted Subsidiary is acquired by Parent, an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary (i) the Issuers would have been able to Incur $1.00 of additional Indebtedness pursuant to the foregoing paragraph (a) after giving effect to the Incurrence of such Indebtedness pursuant to this clause (4), or (ii) the Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio immediately after giving effect to such Incurrence and acquisition would be equal to or greater than such ratio immediately prior to such transaction and (B) Refinancing Indebtedness Incurred by a Restricted Subsidiary in respect of Indebtedness Incurred by such Restricted Subsidiary pursuant to this clause (4);

(5) Indebtedness in respect of (A) performance bonds, bankers’ acceptances, letters of credit, bank guarantees and surety or appeal bonds

 

68


or similar bonds entered into by the Issuers or any Restricted Subsidiary in the ordinary course of business, and (B) Hedging Obligations entered into in the ordinary course of business to hedge or manage risks with respect to an Issuer’s or a Restricted Subsidiary’s interest rate, currency, commodities, energy or raw materials pricing exposure or in connection with the issuance of convertible debt and not entered into for speculative purposes;

(6) Purchase Money Indebtedness, Capitalized Lease Obligations and Attributable Debt and Refinancing Indebtedness in respect thereof in an aggregate principal amount on the date of Incurrence that, when added to all other Indebtedness Incurred pursuant to this clause (6) and then outstanding, will not exceed the greater of (A) $100.0 million and (B) 6.5% of Consolidated Total Assets of the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries as of the end of the most recent fiscal quarter for which financial statements are available;

(7) Indebtedness arising from the honoring by a bank or other financial institution of a check, draft or similar instrument drawn against insufficient funds, or any related liabilities arising from treasury, depository or cash management services or in connection with any automated clearing house transfers of funds, in each case, in the ordinary course of business; provided , however , that such Indebtedness is extinguished within five Business Days after a Financial Officer has acquired actual knowledge of the same;

(8) Indebtedness incurred by Foreign Subsidiaries pursuant to working capital lines of credit or any overdraft line or other cash management system in the ordinary course of business;

(9) Indebtedness owed by an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary to a Joint Venture in an amount not to exceed $25.0 million at any time;

(10) (A) Indebtedness of an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary in an amount not to exceed $35.0 million Incurred in contemplation of, in connection with, as consideration in, or to provide all or any portion of the funds or credit support utilized to consummate, the transaction or series of related transactions pursuant to which such Restricted Subsidiary became a Subsidiary of or was otherwise acquired by Parent, an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary whether by means of the acquisition of assets or the Capital Stock of such entity; provided , however , that on the date that such Restricted Subsidiary is acquired by Parent, an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary (i) the Issuers would have been able to Incur $1.00 of additional Indebtedness pursuant to the foregoing paragraph (a) after giving effect to the Incurrence of such Indebtedness pursuant to this clause (10) or (ii) the Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio immediately

 

69


after giving effect to such Incurrence and acquisition would be equal to or greater than such ratio immediately prior to such transaction and (B) Refinancing Indebtedness Incurred by a Restricted Subsidiary in respect of Indebtedness Incurred by such Restricted Subsidiary pursuant to this clause (10);

(11) Indebtedness of all Foreign Subsidiaries in an aggregate principal amount not to exceed $75.0 million at any time;

(12) Indebtedness under tax-favored or government-sponsored financing transactions; provided that (A) such Indebtedness is not senior in right of payment to the Notes and (B) the aggregate principal amount of such Indebtedness shall not exceed $50.0 million at any time;

(13) in each case to the extent (if any) that such obligations constitute Indebtedness, (A) customary indemnification obligations, purchase price or other similar adjustments in connection with acquisitions and dispositions permitted under this Indenture, (B) reimbursement or indemnification obligations owed to any Person providing workers’ compensation, health, disability or other employee benefits or property, casualty or liability insurance, (C) obligations for deferred payment of insurance premiums, or (D) take-or-pay obligations contained in supply arrangements; provided , in each case, that such obligation arises in the ordinary course of business and not in connection with the obtaining of financing;

(14) Indebtedness in an aggregate principal amount not in excess of $2.5 million at any time consisting of obligations under deferred compensation or other similar arrangements incurred in connection with any Investment; and

(15) Indebtedness of the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries in an aggregate principal amount on the date of Incurrence that, when added to all other Indebtedness Incurred pursuant to this paragraph (15) and then outstanding, will not exceed $60.0 million.

(c) For purposes of determining the outstanding principal amount of any particular Indebtedness Incurred pursuant to this Section 4.06:

(1) Outstanding Indebtedness Incurred pursuant to the ABL Facility prior to or on the Issue Date shall be deemed to have been Incurred pursuant to clause (1) of paragraph (b) above and Outstanding Indebtedness Incurred pursuant to the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility prior to or on the Issue Date shall be deemed to have been Incurred pursuant to clause (3) of paragraph (b) above; provided , however , that for these purposes unused amounts under the Synthetic Letter of Credit

 

70


Facility as of the Issue Date shall be deemed Incurred prior to or on the Issue Date; provided , further , however , that if the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility (or any Refinancing Indebtedness related thereto) is reduced, terminated or matures, notwithstanding such reduction, termination or maturity, the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility (or any Refinancing Indebtedness related thereto) may be Refinanced, as if the entire amount of the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility (or any such Refinancing Indebtedness) is Incurred and outstanding, pursuant to clause (3)(C) of paragraph (b) above at a later date; notwithstanding the foregoing, (i) the undrawn face amount of Synthetic Letters of Credit issued for the account of Subsidiaries that are not Subsidiary Guarantors and (ii) the obligations of such Subsidiaries in respect of unreimbursed drawings of Synthetic Letters of Credit shall for purposes of clause (b)(3) not exceed the amount in existence on the Issue Date;

(2) Indebtedness permitted by this Section 4.06 need not be permitted solely by reference to one provision permitting such Indebtedness but may be permitted in part by one such provision and in part by one or more other provisions of this Section 4.06 permitting such Indebtedness; and

(3) in the event that Indebtedness meets the criteria of more than one of the types of Indebtedness described in this Section 4.06, the Issuers, in their sole discretion, shall classify such Indebtedness (or any portion thereof) as of the time of Incurrence and will only be required to include the amount of such Indebtedness in one of such clauses ( provided that any Indebtedness originally classified as Incurred pursuant to clauses (b)(2) through (b)(15) above may later be reclassified as having been Incurred pursuant to paragraph (a) or any other of clauses (b)(2) through (b)(15) above to the extent that such reclassified Indebtedness could be Incurred pursuant to paragraph (a) or one of clauses (b)(2) through (b)(15) above, as the case may be, if it were Incurred at the time of such reclassification).

(d) For purposes of determining compliance with any U.S. dollar denominated restriction on the Incurrence of Indebtedness where the Indebtedness Incurred is denominated in a different currency, the amount of such Indebtedness will be the U.S. Dollar Equivalent determined on the date of the Incurrence of such Indebtedness; provided , however , that if any such Indebtedness denominated in a different currency is subject to a Currency Agreement with respect to U.S. dollars covering all principal, premium, if any, and interest payable on such Indebtedness, the amount of such Indebtedness expressed in U.S. dollars will be as provided in such Currency Agreement. The principal amount of any Refinancing Indebtedness Incurred in the same currency as the Indebtedness being Refinanced will be the U.S. Dollar Equivalent of the Indebtedness Refinanced determined on the date of the Incurrence of such

 

71


Indebtedness, except to the extent that (1) such U.S. Dollar Equivalent was determined based on a Currency Agreement, in which case the Refinancing Indebtedness will be determined in accordance with the immediately preceding sentence, and (2) the principal amount of the Refinancing Indebtedness exceeds the principal amount of the Indebtedness being Refinanced, in which case the U.S. Dollar Equivalent of such excess, as appropriate, will be determined on the date such Refinancing Indebtedness is Incurred. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the maximum amount of Indebtedness that may be incurred pursuant to this Section 4.06 shall not be deemed to be exceeded with respect to any outstanding Indebtedness due solely to the fluctuations in the exchange rates of currencies.

Section 4.07. Limitation on Restricted Payments . (a) The Issuers will not, and Parent will not permit any Restricted Subsidiary, directly or indirectly, to:

(1) declare or pay any dividend, make any distribution on or in respect of its Capital Stock or make any similar payment (including any payment in connection with any merger or consolidation involving any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary) to the direct or indirect holders of its Capital Stock in their capacity as such, except (A) dividends or distributions payable solely in its Capital Stock (other than Preferred Stock) and (B) dividends or distributions payable to any Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary (and, if such Issuer or Subsidiary of Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC has Capital Stock held by Persons other than the Issuers or other Restricted Subsidiaries (but not Parent or a Subsidiary of Parent that is not a Restricted Subsidiary), to such other Persons on no more than a pro rata basis);

(2) purchase, repurchase, redeem, retire or otherwise acquire (“ Purchase ”) for value any Capital Stock of the Issuers, any Restricted Subsidiary, or any direct or indirect parent of a Restricted Subsidiary, including Parent and any direct or indirect parent of Parent (other than Capital Stock of an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary held by an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary);

(3) Purchase for value, prior to scheduled maturity, any scheduled repayment or any scheduled sinking fund payment, any Subordinated Obligations, including subordinated obligations of any direct or indirect parent of a Restricted Subsidiary, including Parent and any direct or indirect parent of Parent, (other than (x) the Purchase for value of Subordinated Obligations of an Issuer or Restricted Subsidiary acquired in anticipation of satisfying a sinking fund obligation, principal installment or final maturity, in each case due within one year of the date of such Purchase or (y) any Subordinated Obligations owed by an Issuer to any Restricted Subsidiary or another Issuer or owed by a Restricted Subsidiary to an Issuer or another Restricted Subsidiary); or

 

72


(4) make any Restricted Investment,

(any such dividend, distribution, payment, Purchase or Restricted Investment being herein referred to as a “ Restricted Payment ”), if at the time the Issuers or such Restricted Subsidiary makes such Restricted Payment:

(A) a Default will have occurred and be continuing (or would result therefrom);

(B) the Issuers could not Incur at least $1.00 of additional Indebtedness under paragraph (a) of Section 4.06; or

(C) the aggregate amount of such Restricted Payment and all other Restricted Payments (the amount so expended, if other than in cash, to be determined in good faith by a Financial Officer of the Issuers, whose determination will be conclusive; provided , however , that with respect to any non-cash Restricted Payment in excess of $25.0 million, the amount so expended shall be determined in accordance with the provisions of the definition of Fair Market Value) declared or made subsequent to the Issue Date would exceed the sum, without duplication, of:

(i) 50% of the Consolidated Net Income accrued during the period (treated as one accounting period) from the beginning of the fiscal quarter during which the Issue Date occurs to the end of the most recent fiscal quarter for which financial statements are available prior to the date of such Restricted Payment (or, in case such Consolidated Net Income will be a deficit, minus 100% of such deficit);

(ii) 100% of (x) any cash capital contribution received by the Issuers or the Restricted Subsidiaries from Parent subsequent to the Issue Date and (y) the Fair Market Value of Temporary Cash Investments, Additional Assets and other non-cash property contributed as capital to the Issuers or the Restricted Subsidiaries by Parent subsequent to the Issue Date (other than in the case of (x) and (y) from the proceeds of the Initial Public Offering);

(iii) the amount by which Indebtedness of the Issuers or the Restricted Subsidiaries is reduced upon the conversion or exchange (other than by

 

73


Parent or a Subsidiary of Parent) subsequent to the Issue Date of any Indebtedness of the Issuers or the Restricted Subsidiaries into or for Capital Stock (other than Disqualified Stock) of Parent (less the amount of any cash or the Fair Market Value of other property distributed by any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary upon such conversion or exchange);

(iv) (a) 100% of the Net Cash Proceeds and the Fair Market Value of property other than cash and Temporary Cash Investments from the sale or other disposition (other than to any Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary) of Restricted Investments made after the Issue Date and redemptions and repurchases of such Restricted Investments from any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary and repayment of Restricted Investments in the form of loans or advances from any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary (other than in each case to the extent the Restricted Investment was made pursuant to clause (13) of the next succeeding paragraph) and (b) the amount of net reduction (without duplication) in Restricted Investments as a result of releases of Guarantees that constitute Restricted Investments by the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries;

(v) 100% of the Net Cash Proceeds and the Fair Market Value of property other than cash and Temporary Cash Investments received by any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary from the sale (other than to an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary) of the stock of an Unrestricted Subsidiary (other than in each case to the extent the Investment in such Unrestricted Subsidiary was made by any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary pursuant to clause (13) of the next succeeding paragraph or to the extent such Investment constituted a Permitted Investment); and

(vi) to the extent that any Unrestricted Subsidiary designated as such after the Issue Date is redesignated as a Restricted Subsidiary or any Unrestricted Subsidiary merges into or consolidates with any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary, in each case after the Issue Date, the Fair Market

 

74


Value of such Subsidiary as of the date of such redesignation or such merger or consolidation, or in the case of the transfer, dividend or distribution of assets of an Unrestricted Subsidiary to any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary, the Fair Market Value of such assets of the Unrestricted Subsidiary at the time of the redesignation of such Unrestricted Subsidiary as a Restricted Subsidiary or at the time of such merger, consolidation or transfer of assets (other than an Unrestricted Subsidiary to the extent the Investment in such Unrestricted Subsidiary was made by a Restricted Subsidiary pursuant to clause (13) of the next succeeding paragraph or to the extent such Investment constituted a Permitted Investment).

Notwithstanding the foregoing, the effect of the forgiveness of Indebtedness under the First Lien Term Loan Agreement on or prior to the Issue Date by one or more Affiliates of the Sponsor, including the transactions relating thereto, and the accounting consequences thereof, shall be disregarded for purposes of clauses (a)(C)(i)-(vi) of this Section 4.07.

(b) The provisions of the foregoing paragraph (a) will not prohibit:

(1) any Restricted Payment made out of the Net Cash Proceeds (other than the Net Cash Proceeds from the Initial Public Offering) of a substantially concurrent cash capital contribution received by any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary from Parent; provided , however , that:

(A) such Restricted Payment shall be excluded in the calculation of the amount of Restricted Payments, and

(B) the Net Cash Proceeds from such sale applied in the manner set forth in this clause (1) shall be excluded from the calculation of amounts under clause (C)(ii) of paragraph (a) above;

(2) any prepayment, repayment or Purchase for value of Subordinated Obligations of any Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary made by exchange for, or out of the proceeds of the substantially concurrent sale of, other Subordinated Obligations; provided , however , that such prepayment, repayment or Purchase for value shall be excluded in the calculation of the amount of Restricted Payments;

(3) dividends paid within 60 days after the date of declaration thereof if at such date of declaration such dividends would have complied with this Section 4.07; provided , however , that such dividends

 

75


shall be included in the calculation of the amount of Restricted Payments;

(4) any Purchase for value of Capital Stock of Parent from Parent’s or its Subsidiaries’ employees, former employees, consultants, former consultants, officers, former officers, directors or former directors (or permitted transferees of such employees, former employees, consultants, former consultants, officers, former officers, directors or former directors) (including, without limitation, trustees, administrators, executors, powers of attorney, heirs, assignees, estates or beneficiaries of estates), pursuant to the terms of agreements (including employment agreements) entered into with any such Person (or the permitted transferees thereof) or plans (as amended, supplemented, restated or otherwise modified from time to time) approved by the Board of Directors of Parent under which such Persons purchase or sell or are granted the option to purchase or sell, shares of such Capital Stock (including payments, directly or indirectly, to Parent, for the foregoing purpose); provided , however , that the aggregate amount of such Purchases for value will not exceed the sum of $10.0 million in any calendar year (including for this purpose any amounts paid, directly or indirectly, through Parent, in respect of tax withholding in connection with the net share settlement of any restricted stock units issued to any such Person in connection with the Initial Public Offering); provided that the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries (A) shall, irrespective of this Section 4.07, be permitted on each date the right to make such payments with respect to such restricted stock units (directly or indirectly) and (B) shall be permitted to make other Purchases for value pursuant to this clause (4) in an amount of at least $2.0 million in any calendar year in which any such vesting date falls; provided , further, that such vesting dates shall not occur more than twice and the last such vesting date shall occur prior to the third anniversary of the Initial Public Offering, plus the amount of Net Cash Proceeds received by any Issuer or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries (including from a contribution by Parent) subsequent to the Issue Date in respect of (x) purchases for value of Capital Stock (other than Disqualified Stock and other than in connection with the Initial Public Offering) of Parent by any employee, consultant, officer or director of Parent or any of its Subsidiaries, to the extent the cash proceeds from the sale of such Capital Stock have not otherwise been applied to the payment of Restricted Payments and will be excluded from (C)(ii) of Section 4.07(a) the preceding paragraph) and (y) any key-man life insurance policies maintained on any of the foregoing Persons during such calendar year (such amount, the “ Restricted Purchase Amount ”); provided , further , however , that any of the Restricted Purchase Amount permitted to be applied for Purchases under this clause (4) in a calendar year (and not so applied) may be carried forward for use

 

76


in the following two calendar years; provided , further , however , that such Purchases for value shall (except as set forth above in clause (x) above) be excluded in the calculation of the amount of Restricted Payments;

(5) so long as no Default has occurred and is continuing, payments of dividends on Disqualified Stock issued after the Issue Date pursuant to Section 4.06; provided , however , that such dividends shall be included in the calculation of the amount of Restricted Payments;

(6) repurchases of Capital Stock deemed to occur upon exercise or conversion of stock options, warrants, rights and other convertible instruments if such Capital Stock represents a portion of the exercise or conversion price of such instruments; provided , however , that such Restricted Payments shall be excluded in the calculation of the amount of Restricted Payments;

(7) with respect to any period (A) in which each of the Parent (or if the Parent is owned directly or indirectly by a parent company, such parent company) and Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC is a Pass-Through Entity, in the case of a declaration, payment or loan made by Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC, the declaration and payment of distributions by Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC to, or the making of loans to, the Parent (i) not in excess of the Parent Owner Tax Distribution Amount, and (ii) with respect to the Parent or such direct or indirect parent company of the Parent, in amounts required for such entity to pay (without duplication of amounts described in clause (A)(i)) franchise and excise taxes and other similar fees, taxes and expenses required to maintain each such company’s corporate existence; or (B) in which (x) the Parent (or if the Parent is owned directly or indirectly by a parent company, such parent company) is treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes and (y) Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC is a Pass-Through Entity, in the case of a declaration, payment or loan by Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC, the declaration and payment of distributions by Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC to, or the making of loans to, Parent (i) not in excess of the Parent Tax Distribution Amount with respect to Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC, and (ii) with respect to the Parent or such direct or indirect parent company of the Parent, in amounts required for such entity to pay (without duplication of amounts described in clause (B)(i)) franchise and excise taxes and other similar fees, taxes and expenses required to maintain each such company’s corporate existence; provided , however , that such Restricted Payments shall be excluded in the calculation of the amount of Restricted Payments;

(8) payments to holders of Capital Stock (or to the holders of Indebtedness that is convertible into or exchangeable for Capital Stock

 

77


upon such conversion or exchange) in lieu of the issuance of fractional shares; provided , however , that such payments shall be excluded in the calculation of the amount of Restricted Payments;

(9) the purchase, repurchase, redemption, defeasance or other acquisition or retirement for value of any Subordinated Obligations of an Issuer or a Subsidiary Guarantor at a purchase price not greater than 101% of the principal amount of such Subordinated Obligations in the event of a Change of Control in accordance with provisions similar to Section 4.11; provided that, prior to or simultaneously with such purchase, repurchase, redemption, defeasance or other acquisition or retirement, the Issuers have made a Change of Control Offer and have completed the repurchase or redemption of all Notes validly tendered for payment in connection with such Change of Control Offer; provided , further , however , that such payments shall be excluded in the calculation of the amount of Restricted Payments;

(10) the repurchase, redemption, acquisition or retirement of Subordinated Obligations of an Issuer or a Subsidiary Guarantor with Excess Proceeds or Collateral Excess Proceeds remaining after an Asset Disposition Offer or Collateral Disposition Offer, as applicable, pursuant to Section 4.12; provided , however , that such payments shall be excluded in the calculation of the amount of Restricted Payments;

(11) payments made to Parent for general corporate operating and overhead costs and expenses (including customary salary, bonus and other benefits payable to employees, directors, officers and managers) of any direct or indirect parent company including Parent to the extent such costs and expenses are attributable solely to the ownership or operation of the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries, including the Issuers’ and the Restricted Subsidiaries’ proportionate share of such amounts relating to such parent entity being a public company, not to exceed $2.5 million in the aggregate in any fiscal year; provided , however , that such Restricted Payments shall be excluded in the calculation of the amount of Restricted Payments;

(12) the declaration and payment of dividends to Parent to fund a payment of dividends or distributions on Parent’s Capital Stock (or the Capital Stock of any direct or indirect parent of Parent), other than with respect to any redemptions or the making or payment of any sinking fund obligations in respect of any Disqualified Stock) of up to 6.0% per calendar year of the Net Cash Proceeds received by or contributed to Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC or any Restricted Subsidiaries from any public Equity Offerings (other than the Initial Public Offering), which amount in the aggregate shall not exceed 6.0% of the aggregate Net Proceeds received by or contributed to the Issuers or any Restricted

 

78


Subsidiary from all public Equity Offerings (other than the Initial Public Offering) from the Issue Date through and including the date such dividends or distributions are paid; provided , however , that such dividends or distributions shall be included in the calculation of the amount of Restricted Payments; provided , further , however , that at the time of such dividend or distribution, no Default shall have occurred and be continuing (or result therefrom); or

(13) any Restricted Payment in an amount which, when taken together with all Restricted Payments made after the Issue Date pursuant to this clause (13), does not exceed $15.0 million; provided , however , that (A) at the time of each such Restricted Payment, no Default shall have occurred and be continuing (or result therefrom) and (B) such Restricted Payments shall be excluded in the calculation of the amount of Restricted Payments.

(c) Parent shall, or shall cause the applicable Affiliate, to promptly contribute the Net Cash Proceeds from the Initial Public Offering to an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary.

Section 4.08. Limitation on Liens . The Issuers will not, and Parent will not permit any Restricted Subsidiary to, directly or indirectly, Incur or permit to exist any Lien of any nature whatsoever on any of its property or assets (including Capital Stock of the Issuers or a Restricted Subsidiary), whether owned at the Issue Date or thereafter acquired, which Lien secures any Indebtedness, other than Permitted Liens and other than Liens securing Indebtedness that are junior in priority in all respects to the Liens on such property or assets securing the Notes, on terms no less favorable in any material respect to the Holders of the Notes than those set forth in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

Section 4.09. Limitation on Sale and Leaseback Transactions . The Issuers will not, and Parent will not permit any Restricted Subsidiary to, enter into any Sale and Leaseback Transaction with respect to any property unless:

(a) the Issuers or such Restricted Subsidiary would be entitled to:

(1) Incur Indebtedness with respect to such Sale and Leaseback Transaction pursuant to Section 4.06; and

(2) create a Lien (other than a junior lien) on such property securing such Indebtedness pursuant to Section 4.08;

(b) the gross proceeds payable to any Issuer or such Restricted Subsidiary in connection with such Sale and Leaseback Transaction are at least equal to the Fair Market Value of such property; and

 

79


(c) the transfer of such property is permitted by, and, if applicable, the Issuers or such Restricted Subsidiaries apply the proceeds of such transaction in compliance with Section 4.12.

Section 4.10. Limitation on Restrictions on Distributions from Restricted Subsidiaries . (a) The Issuers will not, and Parent will not permit any Restricted Subsidiary to, create or otherwise cause or permit to exist or become effective any contractual encumbrance or restriction on the ability of any Restricted Subsidiary to:

(1) pay dividends or make any other distributions on its Capital Stock to any Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary;

(2) pay any Indebtedness or other obligations owed to the Issuers or a Restricted Subsidiary;

(3) make any loans or advances to any Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary; or

(4) transfer any of its property or assets to any Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary;

except, in the case of (1), (2), (3) or (4) above:

(A) any encumbrance or restriction pursuant to (i) applicable law, rule, regulation or order or (ii) an agreement in effect at or entered into on the Issue Date;

(B) any encumbrance or restriction with respect to a Restricted Subsidiary pursuant to an agreement relating to any Indebtedness Incurred by such Restricted Subsidiary prior to the date on which such Restricted Subsidiary was acquired by Parent, an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary (other than Indebtedness Incurred as consideration in, in contemplation of, or to provide all or any portion of the funds or credit support utilized to consummate the transaction or series of related transactions pursuant to which such Restricted Subsidiary became a Restricted Subsidiary or was otherwise acquired by Parent, an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary) and outstanding on such date;

(C) any encumbrance or restriction pursuant to an agreement effecting a Refinancing of Indebtedness Incurred pursuant to an agreement referred to in clause (A) or (B) above or this clause (C) or contained in any amendment to an agreement referred to in clause (A) or (B) above or this clause (C); provided , however , that the encumbrances and restrictions contained in any

 

80


such Refinancing agreement or amendment are no less favorable in any material respect to the Holders than the encumbrances and restrictions contained in such predecessor agreements;

(D) any encumbrance or restriction pursuant to an agreement with respect to Indebtedness incurred in reliance on clause (b)(1) or (b)(11) of Section 4.06 or other Indebtedness under the Credit Facilities to be incurred in reliance on clause (a) of Section 4.06;

(E) in the case of clause (4) above, any encumbrance or restriction that

(i) restricts in a customary manner the subletting, assignment or transfer of any property or asset that is subject to a lease, license or similar contract, or the assignment or transfer of any such lease, license or other contract; or

(ii) is contained in mortgages, pledges and other security agreements securing Indebtedness of an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary to the extent such encumbrance or restriction restricts the transfer of the property subject to such security agreements;

(F) with respect to a Restricted Subsidiary, any restriction imposed pursuant to an agreement entered into for the sale or disposition of all or substantially all the Capital Stock or assets of such Restricted Subsidiary pending the closing of such sale or disposition;

(G) purchase money obligations for property acquired in the ordinary course of business and Capitalized Lease Obligations that impose restrictions on the property purchased or leased of the nature described in clause (4) above;

(H) provisions with respect to the disposition or distribution of assets or property in or with respect to joint venture agreements, asset sale agreements, stock sale agreements and other similar agreements;

(I) restrictions on cash or other deposits or net worth imposed by customers, lenders, suppliers or, in the ordinary course of business, other third parties;

 

81


(J) with respect to any Foreign Subsidiary, any encumbrance or restriction contained in the terms of any Indebtedness, or any agreement pursuant to which such Indebtedness was issued or any amendments, modifications, restatements, renewals, increases, supplements, refundings, replacements or refinancings thereof;

(K) restrictions or conditions contained in any trading, netting, operating, construction, service, supply, purchase, sale or other agreement to which any Issuer or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries is a party entered into in the ordinary course of business; provided that such agreement prohibits the encumbrance of solely the property or assets of such Issuer or such Restricted Subsidiary that are the subject to such agreement, the payment rights arising thereunder or the proceeds thereof and does not extend to any other asset or property of the Issuers or such Restricted Subsidiary or the assets or property of another Restricted Subsidiary; and

(L) any encumbrance or restriction of the type referred to in clause (1), (2), (3) or (4) above imposed by any amendments, modifications, restatements, renewals, increases, supplements, refundings, replacements or refinancings of the contracts, instruments or obligations referred to in any of clauses (A) through (K) above; provided that such amendments, modifications, restatements, renewals, increases, supplements, refundings, replacements or refinancings are, in the good faith judgment of the Board of Directors of the Issuers, no more restrictive in any material respect with respect to such encumbrance and other restrictions taken as a whole than those prior to such amendment, modification, restatement, renewal, increase, supplement, refunding, replacement or refinancing.

Section 4.11. Change of Control . (a) Upon the occurrence of any of the following events (each a “ Change of Control ”), each Holder will have the right to require the Issuers to purchase all or any part of such Holder’s Notes at a purchase price in cash equal to 101% of the principal amount thereof plus accrued and unpaid interest to the date of purchase (subject to the right of Holders of record on the Regular Record Date to receive interest due on the relevant Interest Payment Date), by mailing a notice to each Holder with a copy to the Trustee within 30 days following any Change of Control, in accordance with the procedures set forth in Section 3.06 for an Offer to Purchase:

(1) any “person” or “group” (as such terms are used in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) of the Exchange Act) other than the Sponsor Group (or any Person or Persons comprising the Sponsor Group) becomes the

 

82


beneficial owner (as defined in Rules 13d-3 and 13d-5 under the Exchange Act, except that for purposes of this clause (1) such person or group shall be deemed to have “beneficial ownership” of all shares that any such person or group has the right to acquire, whether such right is exercisable immediately or only after the passage of time), directly or indirectly, of more than 50% of the total voting power of the Voting Stock of Parent, any Restricted Subsidiary that, directly or indirectly, owns Capital Stock of either of the Issuers, or the Issuers (the “ Change of Control Group ”);

(2) the adoption of a plan relating to the liquidation or dissolution of any member of the Change of Control Group;

(3) the merger or consolidation of any member of the Change of Control Group with or into another Person or the merger of another Person with or into any member of the Change of Control Group, or the sale of all or substantially all the assets of any member of the Change of Control Group (as determined on a Consolidated basis) to another Person, and, in the case of any such merger or consolidation, the securities of such member of the Change of Control Group, that are outstanding immediately prior to such transaction and which represent 100% of the aggregate voting power of such member of the Change of Control Group are changed into or exchanged for cash, securities or property, unless pursuant to such transaction such securities are changed into or exchanged for, in addition to any other consideration, securities of the surviving Person or transferee that represent immediately after such transaction, at least a majority of the aggregate voting power of the Voting Stock of the surviving Person or transferee; or

(4) Parent ceases to, directly or indirectly, own all Capital Stock of the Issuers.

(b) The Issuers will not be required to make the Offer to Purchase upon a Change of Control if a third party makes an Offer to Purchase in the manner, at the times and otherwise in compliance with the requirements set forth in Section 3.06 applicable to an Offer to Purchase made by the Issuers and purchases all Notes validly tendered and not withdrawn under such Offer to Purchase. In addition, the Issuers will not be required to make Offer to Purchase upon a Change of Control if the Notes have been or are called for redemption by the Issuers prior to it being required to mail notice of the Offer to Purchase, and thereafter redeems all Notes called for redemption in accordance with the terms set forth in such redemption notice. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Indenture, a revocable Offer to Purchase may be made in advance of a Change of Control, conditioned upon the consummation of such Change of Control, if a definitive agreement is in place for the Change of Control at the time the Offer to Purchase is made.

 

83


Section 4.12 . Limitation on Sales of Assets and Subsidiary Stock . (a) The Issuers will not, Parent, and any Subsidiary of Parent that owns any Capital Stock of a Restricted Subsidiary, will not (with respect to clause (1) of the definition of Asset Disposition) and Parent will not permit any of the Restricted Subsidiaries to, cause or make an Asset Disposition, unless (x) an Issuer, Parent, such Subsidiary of Parent that owns any Capital Stock of a Restricted Subsidiary, or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries, as the case may be, receives consideration at the time of such Asset Disposition at least equal to the Fair Market Value of the assets sold or otherwise disposed of, and (y) at least 75% of the consideration therefor received by an Issuer, Parent, such Subsidiary of Parent that owns any Capital Stock of a Restricted Subsidiary, or the Restricted Subsidiary, as the case may be, is in the form of cash or Temporary Cash Investments; provided that the amount of:

(1) any liabilities (as shown on such Issuer’s, Parent’s, such Subsidiary’s of Parent that owns any Capital Stock of a Restricted Subsidiary, or such Restricted Subsidiary’s most recent balance sheet or in the Notes thereto) of such Issuer, Parent, and such Subsidiary of Parent that owns any Capital Stock of a Restricted Subsidiary, (solely with respect to an Asset Disposition of Capital Stock of its Restricted Subsidiaries) or such Restricted Subsidiary (other than liabilities that are by their terms subordinated to the Notes or Parent’s, such Subsidiary’s of Parent that owns any Capital Stock of a Restricted Subsidiary, or such Restricted Subsidiary’s obligations in respect of the Notes) that are assumed by the transferee of any such assets, and

(2) any Notes or other obligations or other securities or assets received by such Issuer, Parent, and such Subsidiary of Parent that owns any Capital Stock of a Restricted Subsidiary, (solely with respect to an Asset Disposition of Capital Stock of its Restricted Subsidiaries) or such Restricted Subsidiary from such transferee that are converted by such Issuer, Parent, such Subsidiary of Parent that owns any Capital Stock of a Restricted Subsidiary, or such Restricted Subsidiary into cash within 180 days of the receipt thereof (to the extent of the cash received), shall be deemed to be Temporary Cash Investments for the purposes of this provision.

(b) Within 15 months after an Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary’s receipt of the Net Proceeds of any Asset Disposition, such Issuer or such Restricted Subsidiary shall apply the Net Proceeds from such Asset Disposition, at its option in accordance with the following. Within 15 months after Parent’s, or such Subsidiary’s of Parent, receipt of the Net Proceeds pursuant to clause (1) of the definition of Asset Disposition, Parent and such Subsidiary of Parent (who is not an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary) shall contribute the Net Proceeds therefrom to an Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary who shall subsequently apply such Net Proceeds in accordance with the following at such Issuer’s or

 

84


Restricted Subsidiary’s option; provided , that any Net Proceeds shall be deemed to constitute Asset Dispositions of Collateral to the extent the assets of the Restricted Subsidiary would constitute Collateral (other than Specified ABL Facility Assets):

(1) to repay (A) Indebtedness constituting Term Obligations (and, if the Indebtedness repaid is revolving credit Indebtedness, to correspondingly reduce commitments with respect thereto); provided that if the Issuers shall so reduce Term Obligations, the Issuers will equally and ratably reduce Notes Obligations in any manner set forth in clause (D) below at a purchase price equal to at least 100% of the principal amount thereof, (B) Indebtedness constituting Pari Passu Indebtedness other than Term Obligations so long as the Asset Disposition proceeds are with respect to non-Collateral ( provided that if the Issuers shall so reduce Pari Passu Indebtedness, the Issuers will equally and ratably reduce Notes Obligations in any manner set forth in clause (D) below), (C) Indebtedness of a Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Subsidiary Guarantor, or (D) Notes Obligations as provided under Article 3, through open-market purchases ( provided that such purchases are at or above 100% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any) or by making an offer in accordance with the procedures set forth below for an Asset Disposition Offer or a Collateral Disposition Offer, as applicable; or

(2) to make an Investment in any one or more businesses ( provided that if such Investment is in the form of the acquisition of Capital Stock of a Person, such acquisition results in such Person becoming a Restricted Subsidiary), assets or property, in each case (A) used or useful in a Permitted Business or (B) that replace the properties and assets that are the subject of such Asset Disposition; provided , however , that with respect to any Asset Disposition of Collateral only, the assets or property subject to such Investment shall be pledged as Collateral to the extent required by the Security Documents.

(3) In the case of clause (2) above, a binding commitment shall be treated as a permitted application of the Net Proceeds from the date of such commitment; provided that in the event such binding commitment is later canceled or terminated for any reason before such Net Proceeds are so applied, such Issuer or such Restricted Subsidiary enters into another binding commitment (a “ Second Commitment ”) within six months of such cancellation or termination of the prior binding commitment; provided , further , that such Issuer or such Restricted Subsidiary may only enter into a Second Commitment under the foregoing provision one time with respect to each Asset Disposition and to the extent such Second Commitment is later canceled or terminated for any reason before such Net Proceeds are applied, then such Net Proceeds shall constitute

 

85


Collateral Excess Proceeds or Excess Proceeds, as applicable. Pending the final application of any such Net Proceeds, such Issuer or such Restricted Subsidiary may temporarily reduce Indebtedness under a revolving credit facility, if any, or otherwise invest such Net Proceeds in any manner not prohibited by this Indenture.

(4) Any Net Proceeds from Asset Dispositions of Collateral (other than Specified ABL Facility Assets) that are not invested or applied as set forth in paragraph (b)(1) or (2) of this Section 4.12 (it being understood that any portion of such Net Proceeds used to purchase or make an Offer to Purchase Notes, as described in clause (b)(1) above, shall be deemed to have been invested whether or not such offer is accepted) will be deemed to constitute “ Collateral Excess Proceeds .” The Issuers shall make an offer to all Holders of the Notes and, if required by the terms of any Term Obligations or obligations secured by a Lien permitted under this Indenture (which Lien is not subordinate to the Lien of the Notes with respect to the Collateral), to the holders of such Term Obligations or such other obligations (a “ Collateral Disposition Offer ”), to purchase the maximum aggregate principal amount of the Notes and such Term Obligations or such other obligations that may be purchased out of the Collateral Excess Proceeds at an offer price in cash in an amount equal to 100% of the principal amount thereof (or, in the event such Term Obligations (other than the Notes) were issued with significant original issue discount in connection with accreting or pay-in-kind Indebtedness, 100% of the accreted value thereof), plus accrued and unpaid interest and additional interest thereon, if any (or, in respect of other Term Obligations, such lesser price, if any, as may be provided for by the terms of such other Term Obligations), to the purchase date fixed for such offer, in accordance with the procedures set forth in Section 3.06 for an Offer to Purchase. The Issuers will commence a Collateral Disposition Offer with respect to Collateral Excess Proceeds within 10 Business Days after the date that Collateral Excess Proceeds exceed $20.0 million by mailing written notice to all Holders of the Notes in accordance with the procedures set forth in Section 3.06 for an Offer to Purchase, and, if required, such notice as is required to the holders of such Term Obligations or such other obligations as referred to in this paragraph, with a copy to the Trustee.

(5) Any Net Proceeds from any Asset Disposition of non-Collateral (other than Specified ABL Facility Assets) that are not invested or applied as provided and within the time period set forth in paragraph (b)(1) or (2) of this Section 4.12 (it being understood that any portion of such Net Proceeds used to purchase or make an Offer to Purchase Notes, as described in clause (b)(1) above, shall be deemed to have been invested whether or not such offer is accepted) will be deemed to constitute “ Excess Proceeds .” When the aggregate amount of Excess

 

86


Proceeds exceeds $20.0 million, the Issuers shall make an offer to all Holders of Notes (and, at the option of the Issuers, to holders of any Pari Passu Indebtedness) (an “ Asset Disposition Offer ”) to purchase the maximum principal amount of Notes (and such Pari Passu Indebtedness) that may be purchased out of the Excess Proceeds at an offer price in cash in an amount equal to 100% of the principal amount thereof (or, in the event such Pari Passu Indebtedness (other than the Notes) was issued with significant original issue discount, 100% of the accreted value thereof), plus accrued and unpaid interest and additional interest, if any (or, in respect of such other Pari Passu Indebtedness, such lesser price, if any, as may be provided for by the terms of such Pari Passu Indebtedness), to the date fixed for the closing of such offer, in accordance with the procedures set forth in Section 3.06 for an Offer to Purchase. The Issuers will commence an Asset Disposition Offer with respect to Excess Proceeds within 10 Business Days after the date that Excess Proceeds exceeds $20.0 million by mailing written notice to all Holders of Notes in accordance with the procedures set forth in Section 3.06 for an Offer to Purchase, and, if required, such notice as is required to holders of any Pari Passu Indebtedness, with a copy to the Trustee.

(6) To the extent that the aggregate amount of Notes and such other Term Obligations or obligations secured by a Lien permitted by this Indenture (which Lien is not subordinate to the Lien of the Notes with respect to the Collateral) tendered pursuant to a Collateral Disposition Offer is less than the Collateral Excess Proceeds, the Issuers may use any remaining Collateral Excess Proceeds for any purpose that is not prohibited by this Indenture. If the aggregate principal amount of Notes or other Term Obligations or such other obligations surrendered by such holders thereof exceeds the amount of Collateral Excess Proceeds, the Trustee shall select the Notes and such other Term Obligations or such other obligations to be purchased pursuant to clause (8) below. To the extent that the aggregate amount of Notes (and such Pari Passu Indebtedness) tendered pursuant to an Asset Disposition Offer is less than the Excess Proceeds, the Issuers may use any remaining Excess Proceeds for any purpose that is not prohibited by this Indenture. If the aggregate principal amount of Notes (and such Pari Passu Indebtedness) surrendered by holders thereof exceeds the amount of Excess Proceeds, the Trustee shall select the Notes to be purchased pursuant to clause (8) below. Upon completion of any such Collateral Disposition Offer or Asset Disposition Offer, the amount of Collateral Excess Proceeds or Excess Proceeds, as the case may be, shall be reset at zero.

(7) The Issuers must comply with the requirements of Rule 14e-1 under the Exchange Act and any other securities laws and regulations to the extent such laws or regulations are applicable in connection with the repurchase of the Notes pursuant to an Asset

 

87


Disposition Offer or a Collateral Disposition Offer. To the extent that the provisions of any securities laws or regulations conflict with the provisions of this Indenture, the Issuers will comply with the applicable securities laws and regulations and shall not be deemed to have breached its obligations under this Indenture by virtue thereof.

(8) If more Notes (and such Term Obligations or Pari Passu Indebtedness, as applicable) are tendered pursuant to an Asset Disposition Offer or a Collateral Disposition Offer than the Issuers are required to purchase, Notes tendered will be repurchased on a pro rata basis; provided that no Notes of $2,000 or less shall be purchased in part. Selection of such Term Obligations or Pari Passu Indebtedness, as applicable, will be made pursuant to the terms of such Term Obligations or Pari Passu Indebtedness.

Section 4.13. Limitation on Transactions with Affiliates. (a) The Issuers will not, and Parent will not permit any Restricted Subsidiary to, directly or indirectly, enter into or conduct any transaction or series of related transactions (including the purchase, sale, lease or exchange of any property or the rendering of any service) with any Affiliate of the Issuers (an “ Affiliate Transaction ”) that involves an aggregate amount in excess of $2.5 million unless such transaction is on terms:

(1) that are no less favorable to any Issuer or such Restricted Subsidiary, as the case may be, than those that could be obtained at the time of such transaction in arm’s length dealings with a Person who is not such an Affiliate;

(2) that, in the event such Affiliate Transaction involves an aggregate amount in excess of $25.0 million;

(A) are set forth in writing; and

(B) have been approved by a majority of the members of the Board of Directors who are disinterested directors as to such Affiliate Transaction; and

(3) that, in the event such Affiliate Transaction involves an amount in excess of $50.0 million, have been determined by a nationally recognized appraisal, accounting or investment banking firm to be fair, from a financial standpoint, to each applicable Issuer and the Restricted Subsidiary.

(b) The provisions of Section 4.13(a) do not apply to

 

88


(1) any Restricted Payment permitted to be paid pursuant to Section 4.07;

(2) any issuance of securities, or other payments, awards or grants in cash, securities or otherwise pursuant to, or the funding of, employment arrangements, stock options and stock ownership plans approved by the Board of Directors;

(3) the grant of stock options or similar rights to employees, officers, consultants and directors of the Issuers or the Restricted Subsidiaries pursuant to plans, agreements or arrangements approved by the Board of Directors;

(4) loans or advances to employees of the Issuers, the Restricted Subsidiaries or Parent in the ordinary course of business of the Issuers or the Restricted Subsidiaries in an aggregate amount not to exceed $5.0 million at any one time outstanding;

(5) the payment of reasonable fees and compensation to, reimbursement of costs incurred by or the provision of employee benefit arrangements and indemnity, or pursuant to employment agreements, employee benefits plans, stock option plans, management incentive plans, indemnification agreements, severance arrangements, and other similar compensatory arrangements for the benefit of, directors, officers, consultants and employees of the Issuers or the Restricted Subsidiaries in the ordinary course of business (and including former directors, officers, consultants and employees of the Issuers or the Restricted Subsidiaries and their respective heirs, estates, successors and assigns and other beneficiaries of such Person’s arrangements, with respect to any such benefits or obligations that survive the death, disability, retirement or termination of such Person);

(6) any transaction between or among any of the Issuers and/or any Restricted Subsidiary and/or any Joint Venture, which if involving a Joint Venture would constitute an Affiliate Transaction solely because the Issuers or a Restricted Subsidiary owns an equity interest in or otherwise controls such Joint Venture;

(7) payments pursuant to tax sharing agreements involving Unrestricted Subsidiaries of Parent, minority holders of Capital Stock of Subsidiaries of Restricted Subsidiaries and any Joint Venture;

(8) any agreement as in effect on the Issue Date and disclosed in the final offering memorandum (including in any financial statements included therewith, or the footnotes to such financial statements) relating to the Notes issued on the Issue Date, or any renewals, extensions or

 

89


amendments of any such agreement (so long as such renewals, extensions or amendments are not less favorable in any material respect to the Issuers or the Restricted Subsidiaries) and the transactions evidenced thereby (including for the avoidance of doubt, any repayment, pre-payment or other retirement of value pursuant to the terms of the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility, or the exchange or conversion of any of the Indebtedness under the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility into Capital Stock (other than Preferred Stock) of any of the Issuers or the Restricted Subsidiaries, or any direct or indirect parent company thereof including Parent);

(9) transactions with customers, clients, suppliers or purchasers or sellers of goods or services in each case in the ordinary course of business and otherwise in compliance with the terms of this Indenture which are fair to the Issuers or the Restricted Subsidiaries, in the reasonable determination of the Board of Directors or the senior management thereof, or are on terms at least as favorable as might reasonably have been obtained at such time from an unaffiliated party;

(10) the entering into of any agreement (and any amendment or modification of any such agreement) to pay, and the payment of, annual management, consulting, monitoring and advisory fees to the Sponsor or any of its Affiliates in an aggregate amount in any fiscal year not to exceed $2.0 million, plus all out-of-pocket reasonable expenses Incurred by the Sponsor or any of its Affiliates in connection with the performance of management, consulting, monitoring, advisory or other services with respect to the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries;

(11) payments by the Issuers or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries to the Sponsor or any of its Affiliates (including, without limitation, Cerberus Operations and Advisory Company, LLC) made for any specific financial advisory, financing, underwriting or placement services or in respect of other specific investment banking activities, including, without limitation, in connection with specific acquisitions or divestitures, which payments are approved by a majority of the Board of Directors of the Issuers in good faith (but not, for the avoidance of doubt, payment for ongoing services contemplated by clause (10) above);

(12) the payment to Sponsor or any of its Affiliates (including, without limitation, Cerberus Operations and Advisory Company, LLC) of fees, customary indemnities and reimbursements for out-of-pocket costs and expenses incurred by the Sponsor or any of its Affiliates (including, without limitation, amounts paid by Sponsor or any such Affiliates to employees, agents, personnel, professionals or consultants hired or retained by Sponsor or any such Affiliates, as payment for specific services rendered by such Personnel for the benefit of Tower

 

90


Automotive Holdings USA, LLC or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries), in each case in connection with their performance of management, auditing, diligence, consulting, monitoring, financial advisory or other services with respect to the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries (but not, for the avoidance of doubt, payment for ongoing services contemplated by clause (10) above); and

(c) periodic allocations of overhead expenses attributable to and paid by any Unrestricted Subsidiaries at Fair Market Value.

Section 4.14. Future Subsidiary Guarantors. Parent will cause each Domestic Subsidiary that, after the Issue Date

(a) becomes a guarantor or a borrower under the ABL Facility;

(b) becomes a guarantor of obligations under the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility (or a Subsidiary in whose favor letters of credit thereunder are issued);

(c) becomes a guarantor or a borrower under any Credit Facilities incurred in reliance on clause (b)(1) of Section 4.06;

(d) becomes a guarantor of any single issuance of capital markets indebtedness incurred under paragraph (a) or clause (b)(15) of Section 4.06 in an aggregate principal amount equal to or greater than $75.0 million (“ Material Capital Markets Indebtedness ”); or

(e) that directly or indirectly owns any Capital Stock of the Issuers

to execute and deliver to the Trustee a supplemental indenture pursuant to which such Subsidiary will provide a Notes Guarantee.

Section 4.15. Suspension of Certain Covenants. (a) Following the first day (the “ Suspension Date ”) that:

(1) the Notes have an Investment Grade Rating from both of the Rating Agencies; and

(2) no Default has occurred and is continuing;

the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries will not be subject to Sections 4.06, 4.07, 4.10, 4.12, 4.13, 4.14, 10.03, and clauses (a)(3) and (c)(2)(B) of Section 5.01 (collectively, the “ Suspended Covenants ”).

(b) In addition, the Issuers may elect to suspend the Subsidiary Guarantees (but not of any Guarantor that, directly or indirectly, owns Capital Stock of either of the Issuers) and the Issuers may elect to release any or all of

 

91


the Collateral from the Liens securing the Notes and the Subsidiary Guarantees. In the event that the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries are not subject to the Suspended Covenants for any period of time as a result of the foregoing and on any subsequent date (the “ Reversion Date ”) one or both of the Rating Agencies withdraws its Investment Grade Rating or downgrades the rating assigned to the Notes below an Investment Grade Rating, then the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries will thereafter again be subject to the Suspended Covenants with respect to future events and the Subsidiary Guarantees will be reinstated to the extent required by this Indenture and any Collateral that was released from Liens securing the Notes and the Subsidiary Guarantees, as well as any Collateral acquired since the Suspension Date, will be restored and pledged to secure the Notes and the Subsidiary Guarantees in accordance with the Security Documents and Section 10.03. The period of time between the Suspension Date and the Reversion Date is referred to in this description as the “ Suspension Period .” Notwithstanding that the Suspended Covenants may be reinstated, no Default will be deemed to have occurred as a result of a failure to comply with the Suspended Covenants during the Suspension Period. During any Suspension Period, the Issuers may not designate any Subsidiary to be an Unrestricted Subsidiary unless the Issuers would have been permitted to designate such Subsidiary to be an Unrestricted Subsidiary if a Suspension Period had not been in effect for any period.

(c) The Issuers shall provide written notice to the Holders and the Trustee upon the occurrence of a Suspension Date or a Reversion Date. In the case of a Suspension Date, such notice shall list the Suspended Covenants, shall identify the Subsidiary Guarantees the Issuers have elected to suspend and shall identify the Collateral the Issuers shall have elected to release from the Liens securing the Notes and the Subsidiary Guarantees.

(d) On the Reversion Date, all Indebtedness Incurred during the Suspension Period will be classified to have been Incurred pursuant to Section 4.06(a) or one of the clauses of Section 4.06(b) (to the extent such Indebtedness would be permitted to be Incurred thereunder as of the Reversion Date and after giving effect to Indebtedness Incurred prior to the Suspension Period and outstanding on the Reversion Date). To the extent such Indebtedness would not be so permitted to be Incurred pursuant to Section 4.06(a) or (b) such Indebtedness will be deemed to have been outstanding on the Issue Date, so that it is classified as permitted under Section 4.06(b)(3)(B). Calculations made after the Reversion Date of the amount available to be made as Restricted Payments under Section 4.07 will be made as though Section 4.07 had been in effect since the Issue Date and throughout the Suspension Period. Accordingly, Restricted Payments made during the Suspension Period will reduce the amount available to be made as Restricted Payments under Section 4.07(a) and the items specified in Section 4.07(a)(C) will increase the amount available to be made under paragraph (a) thereof. For purposes of determining compliance with Section

 

92


4.12, the Net Proceeds from all Asset Dispositions not applied in accordance with Section 4.12 will be deemed to be reset to zero after the Reversion Date.

(e) In addition, without causing a Default or Event of Default, the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries shall be permitted to honor any contractual commitments to take actions in the future after any date on which the Notes no longer have an Investment Grade Rating from both of the Rating Agencies as long as such contractual commitments were entered into during a Suspension Period and not in anticipation of the Notes no longer having an Investment Grade Rating from both of the Rating Agencies.

Section 4.16 . SEC Reports. (a) Whether or not required by the rules and regulations of the SEC, so long as any Notes are outstanding, the Issuers and Parent will provide the Trustee and Holders and prospective Holders within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and regulations (plus any extensions granted pursuant to SEC rules), copies of:

(1) annual reports on Form 10-K, or any successor or comparable form, containing the information required to be contained therein, or required in such successor or comparable form;

(2) quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, containing the information required to be contained therein, or any successor or comparable form;

(3) from time to time after the occurrence of an event required to be therein reported, such other reports on Form 8-K, or any successor or comparable form; and

(4) any other information, documents and other reports which the Issuers or Parent would be required to file with the SEC if it were subject to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act.

Notwithstanding whether Parent or the Issuers is subject to the periodic reporting requirements of the Exchange Act, Parent and the Issuers will nevertheless continue filing the reports specified above unless the SEC will not accept such a filing. Parent and the Issuers will not take any action for the purpose of causing the SEC not to accept any such filings.

(b) Notwithstanding the foregoing, to the extent Parent and the Issuers file the information and reports referred to in clauses (1) through (4) of Section 4.16(a) with the SEC and such information is publicly available on the internet, Parent and the Issuers shall be deemed to be in compliance with its obligations to furnish such information to the Holders of the Notes. If, notwithstanding the foregoing, the SEC will not accept Parent and the Issuers filings for any reason, Parent and the Issuers will post the reports referred to in the preceding paragraph on their website within the time periods that would apply if Parent and the

 

93


Issuers were required to file those reports with the SEC. Parent shall also conduct a public earnings call with senior management (not later than 10 days after providing each annual report on Form 10-K or quarterly report on Form 10-Q) which shall include a question and answer period.

(c) Notwithstanding the foregoing, if Parent (and any other direct or indirect parent), and any Subsidiary thereof which, directly or indirectly, owns any Capital Stock of either Issuer, fully and unconditionally Guarantees the Notes, the filing of such reports by such ultimate parent within the time periods specified above will satisfy such obligations, which for the avoidance of doubt need not include the information otherwise required by Rule 3-10 and Rule 3-16 of Regulation S-X promulgated by the SEC.

(d) In addition, Parent and the Issuers shall furnish to the Trustee and the Holders, upon their request, copies of the annual report to shareholders and, following the consummation of the Initial Public Offering, any other information provided by Parent to its public shareholders generally.

(e) For so long as any of the Notes remain outstanding and constitute “restricted securities” under Rule 144 under the Securities Act, Parent, the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors will furnish to the Holders of the Notes and prospective investors, upon their request, the information required to be delivered pursuant to Rule 144A(d)(4) under the Securities Act.

(f) Delivery of these reports and information to the Trustee is for informational purposes only and the Trustee’s receipt of them will not constitute constructive notice of any information contained therein or determinable from information contained therein, including the Issuers’ compliance with any of its covenants hereunder (as to which the Trustee is entitled to rely exclusively on Officers’ Certificates).

Section 4.17. Reports to Trustee . (a) The Issuers will deliver to the Trustee, within 120 days after the end of each fiscal year (which as of the date of this Indenture ends on December 31; and the Issuers shall provide prompt written notice to the Trustee in the event of a change to such fiscal year end), a certificate from the principal executive, financial or accounting officer of the Parent stating that the officer has conducted or supervised a review of the activities of the Parent and its Restricted Subsidiaries and their performance under this Indenture and whether, based upon such review, the signers thereof know of any Default that occurred during the previous year and if there has been a Default, specifying the Default and its nature and status.

(b) The Issuers will deliver to the Trustee within 30 days after the occurrence of a Default or Event of Default, an Officers’ Certificate setting forth the details of the Default or Event of Default, its status and what action the Issuers are taking or propose to take in respect thereto.

 

94


(c) The Issuers will deliver to the Trustee within 120 days after the end of each fiscal year of the Parent (which as of the date of this Indenture ends on December 31; and the Issuers shall provide prompt written notice to the Trustee in the event of a change to such fiscal year end) a written statement by the Parent’s independent public accountants stating (i) that their audit examination has included a review of the terms of this Indenture and the Notes as they relate to accounting matters, and (ii) whether, in connection with their audit examination, any Default or Event of Default has come to their attention and, if a Default or Event of has come to their attention, specifying the nature and period of the existence thereof.

(d) The Issuers will notify the Trustee, in writing, when any Notes are listed on any national securities exchange and of any delisting.

ARTICLE 5

M ERGER AND C ONSOLIDATION

Section 5.01. Merger and Consolidation . (a) An Issuer will not, directly or indirectly, consolidate with or merge with or into, or convey, transfer or lease all or substantially all its assets in one or a series of related transactions to, any Person, unless:

(1) the resulting, surviving or transferee Person (the “ Successor Company ”) will be a corporation organized and existing under the laws of the United States of America, any State thereof or the District of Columbia and the Successor Company (if not such Issuer) will expressly assume, by a supplemental indenture (or other joinder agreement, as applicable) executed and delivered to the Trustee, in form satisfactory to the Trustee, all the obligations of such Issuer under the Notes, this Indenture, and the Security Documents and in compliance with the terms and conditions of the Term Intercreditor Agreement and the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, to the extent applicable;

(2) immediately after giving effect to such transaction (and treating any Indebtedness which becomes an obligation of the Successor Company or any Restricted Subsidiary as a result of such transaction as having been Incurred by the Successor Company or such Restricted Subsidiary at the time of such transaction), no Default shall have occurred and be continuing;

(3) immediately after giving effect to such transaction, (A) the Successor Company would be able to Incur an additional $1.00 of Indebtedness under paragraph (a) of Section 4.06 or (B) the Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio for the Successor Company would be equal to or greater than such ratio for the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries immediately prior to such transaction;

 

95


(4) the Successor Company shall be a Subsidiary of Parent or shall be Parent or the successor of Parent; and

(5) the Issuers shall have delivered to the Trustee an Officers’ Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel, each stating that such consolidation, merger or transfer and such supplemental indenture (if any) comply with this Indenture.

(b) The Successor Company will succeed to, and be substituted for, and may exercise every right and power of, such Issuer under this Indenture, and the predecessor Issuer, other than in the case of a lease, will be released from the obligation to pay the principal of and interest on the Notes.

(c) Parent will not permit any Subsidiary Guarantor to, directly or indirectly, consolidate with or merge with or into, or convey, transfer or lease all or substantially all of its assets in one or a series of related transactions to, any Person unless:

(1) except in the case of a Subsidiary Guarantor (A) that has been disposed of in its entirety to another Person (other than to an Issuer or a Subsidiary of Parent), whether through a merger, consolidation or sale of Capital Stock or assets or (B) that, as a result of the disposition of all or a portion of its Capital Stock, ceases to be a Subsidiary, the resulting, surviving or transferee Person (the “ Successor Guarantor ”) will be a corporation organized and existing under the laws of the United States of America, any State thereof or the District of Columbia, and such Person (if not any Subsidiary Guarantor or an Issuer) will expressly assume, by a supplemental indenture or other joinder agreement, as applicable), executed and delivered to the Trustee, in form satisfactory to the Trustee, all the obligations of such Subsidiary Guarantor under its Subsidiary Guarantee and the Security Documents;

(2) (A) immediately after giving effect to such transaction (and treating any Indebtedness which becomes an obligation of the Successor Guarantor or any Restricted Subsidiary as a result of such transaction as having been Incurred by the Successor Guarantor or such Restricted Subsidiary at the time of such transaction), no Default shall have occurred and be continuing and (B) in the case of any Restricted Subsidiary that owns any Capital Stock, directly or indirectly, of an Issuer, (i) the Restricted Subsidiary would be able to Incur an additional $1.00 of Indebtedness under paragraph (a) of Section 4.06 or (ii) the Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio for the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries would be equal to or greater than such ratio for the Issuers and the Restricted Subsidiaries immediately prior to such transaction; and

 

96


(3) the Issuers will have delivered to the Trustee an Officers’ Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel, each stating that such consolidation, merger or transfer and such supplemental indenture (if any) comply with this Indenture.

(d) Parent will not, directly or indirectly, consolidate with or merge with or into, or convey, transfer or lease all or substantially all its assets in one or a series of related transactions to, any Person, unless:

(1) the resulting, surviving or transferee Person (the “ Successor Parent ”) will be a corporation (unless the Successor Parent is Parent, in which case it may be either a limited liability company or a corporation) organized and existing under the laws of the United States of America, any State thereof or the District of Columbia and the Successor Parent (if not Parent) will expressly assume, by a supplemental indenture (or other joinder agreement, as applicable), executed and delivered to the Trustee, in form satisfactory to the Trustee, all the obligations of Parent under this Indenture and Parent’s Notes Guarantee;

(2) immediately after giving effect to such transaction, no Default shall have occurred and be continuing; and

(3) the Issuers shall have delivered to the Trustee an Officers’ Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel, each stating that such consolidation, merger or transfer and such supplemental indenture (if any) comply with this Indenture.

(e) Notwithstanding the foregoing paragraphs (a) through (d) of this Section 5.01:

(1) any Restricted Subsidiary may Consolidate with, merge into or transfer all or part of its properties and assets to any Issuer or any Subsidiary Guarantor;

(2) any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Subsidiary Guarantor may consolidate with, merge into or transfer all or part of its properties and assets to another Restricted Subsidiary; provided that such Restricted Subsidiary is wholly-owned, either directly or indirectly, by an Issuer, Parent or a Subsidiary Guarantor; and

(3) an Issuer or a Subsidiary Guarantor may merge with an Affiliate incorporated solely for the purpose of reincorporating or incorporating, as the case may be, such Issuer or such Subsidiary Guarantor in another jurisdiction within the United States of America, any state thereof or the District of Columbia to realize tax or other benefits; provided , however , that clauses (1), (2) and (5) of Section

 

97


5.01(a) shall continue to apply in a merger involving an Issuer and clauses (1), (2)(A) and (3) of Section 5.01(c) shall continue to apply in a merger involving a Subsidiary Guarantor.

ARTICLE 6

D EFAULT AND R EMEDIES

Section 6.01. Events of Default . (a) Each of the following is an Event of Default with respect to the Notes:

(1) a Default in any payment of interest on the Notes when due and payable continued for 30 days;

(2) a Default in the payment of principal of any Note when due and payable at its Stated Maturity, upon optional redemption or required repurchase, upon declaration of acceleration or otherwise;

(3) the failure by the Issuers, Parent or any Guarantor to comply with its obligations under Article 5;

(4) the failure by the Issuers, Parent (where applicable) or any Restricted Subsidiary to comply for 30 days after notice with any of its obligations under Article 4 (other than Section 4.16), in each case, other than a failure to purchase the Notes;

(5) the failure by the Issuers, Parent or any Restricted Subsidiary to comply for 60 days after notice as specified in this Indenture with its other agreements contained in this Indenture;

(6) the failure by the Issuers, Parent or any Restricted Subsidiary to pay any Indebtedness (other than Indebtedness owing to the Issuers or a Restricted Subsidiary) within any applicable grace period after final maturity or the acceleration of any such Indebtedness by the holders thereof because of a Default if the total amount of such Indebtedness unpaid or accelerated exceeds $50.0 million or its foreign currency equivalent or is with respect to the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility or other Indebtedness owed to the Sponsor or an Affiliate of the Sponsor (other than a portfolio company of the Sponsor) (the “ cross acceleration provision ”);

(7) an involuntary case or other proceeding is commenced against any Issuer, Parent or a Significant Subsidiary with respect to it or its debts under any bankruptcy, insolvency or other similar law now or hereafter in effect seeking the appointment of a trustee, receiver, liquidator, custodian or other similar official of it or any substantial part of its property, and such involuntary case or other proceeding remains

 

98


undismissed and unstayed for a period of 60 days; or an order for relief is entered against any Issuer, Parent or a Significant Subsidiary under the federal bankruptcy laws as now or hereafter in effect;

(8) any Issuer, Parent or a Significant Subsidiary (i) commences a voluntary case under any applicable bankruptcy, insolvency or other similar law now or hereafter in effect, or consents to the entry of an order for relief in an involuntary case under any such law, (ii) consents to the appointment of or taking possession by a receiver, liquidator, assignee, custodian, trustee, sequestrator or similar official of any Issuer, Parent or a Significant Subsidiary or for all or substantially all of the property and assets of any Issuer, Parent or a Significant Subsidiary or (iii) effects any general assignment for the benefit of creditors (an event of default specified in clause (7) or (8) a “ bankruptcy default ”);

(9) the rendering of any final and nonappealable judgment or decree (not covered by insurance) for the payment of money in excess of $50.0 million or its foreign currency equivalent (treating any deductibles, self-insurance or retention as not so covered) against the Issuers, Parent or a Significant Subsidiary if such final judgment or decree remains outstanding and is not satisfied, discharged or waived within a period of 60 days following such judgment (the “ judgment default provision ”);

(10) any Notes Guarantee by Parent, any Subsidiary Guarantor which, directly or indirectly, owns any Capital Stock of an Issuer, or any Significant Subsidiary, or any group of Restricted Subsidiaries which collectively (as of the latest audited Consolidated financial statements for Parent) would constitute a Significant Subsidiary, ceases to be in full force and effect in all material respects (except as contemplated by the terms thereof) or Parent, or any Subsidiary Guarantor which, directly or indirectly, owns any Capital Stock of an Issuer or any Significant Subsidiary, or any group of Restricted Subsidiaries which collectively (as of the latest audited Consolidated financial statements for Parent) would constitute a Significant Subsidiary, denies or disaffirms such Guarantor’s obligations under this Indenture or any Notes Guarantee and such Default continues for 10 days after receipt of the notice as specified in this Indenture;

(11) unless all of the Term Priority Collateral has been released from the first priority Liens in accordance with the provisions of the Security Documents, the First Priority Liens granted pursuant to the Security Documents on all or substantially all of the Term Priority Collateral cease to be valid, enforceable or, to the extent required by the Security Documents, perfected, and such Default continues for 30 days, or the Issuers or any Guarantor shall assert, in any pleading in any court

 

99


of competent jurisdiction, that any such security interest is invalid or unenforceable and Parent fails to cause such Subsidiary to rescind such assertions within 30 days after Parent has actual knowledge of such assertions, or

(12) the failure by the Issuers or any Subsidiary Guarantor to comply for 60 days after notice with its other agreements contained in the Security Documents except for a failure that would not be material to the Holders of the Notes and would not materially affect the value of the Collateral taken as a whole.

(b) The foregoing will constitute Events of Default whatever the reason for any such Event of Default and whether it is voluntary or involuntary or is effected by operation of law or pursuant to any judgment, decree or order of any court or any order, rule or regulation of any administrative or governmental body.

(c) However, a Default under clause (4), (5), (6), (9) or (12) of Section 6.01(a) will not constitute an Event of Default until the Trustee notifies the Issuers or the Holders of at least 25% in principal amount of the outstanding Notes notify the Issuers and the Trustee of the Default and the Issuers, Parent or the Guarantors, as applicable, do not cure such Default within the time specified in clause (4), (5), (6), (9) or (12) of Section 6.01(a) after receipt of such notice.

Section 6.02. Acceleration. (a) If an Event of Default (other than an Event of Default pursuant to clauses (7) and (8) of Section 6.01(a) of an Issuer, Parent or any Subsidiary Guarantor that owns Capital Stock, directly or indirectly, of an Issuer) occurs and is continuing, the Trustee or the Holders of at least 25% in principal amount of the outstanding Notes, by notice in writing to the Issuers, may declare the principal of and accrued but unpaid interest on all the Notes to be due and payable. Upon proper delivery of such a declaration, such principal and interest will be due and payable immediately. If an Event of Default relating to certain events of bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization of an Issuer, Parent or any Subsidiary Guarantor that owns Capital Stock, directly or indirectly, of an Issuer occurs, the principal of and interest on all the Notes will become immediately due and payable without any declaration or other act on the part of the Trustee or any Holders.

(b) The Holders of a majority in principal amount of the outstanding Notes by written notice to the Issuers and to the Trustee may waive all past defaults and rescind and annul a declaration of acceleration and its consequences if

(1) all existing Events of Default, other than the nonpayment of the principal of, premium, if any, and interest on the Notes that have

 

100


become due solely by the declaration of acceleration, have been cured or waived, and

(2) the rescission would not conflict with any judgment or decree of a court of competent jurisdiction.

Section 6.03. Other Remedies. If an Event of Default occurs and is continuing, the Trustee may pursue, in its own name or as trustee of an express trust, any available remedy by proceeding at law or in equity to collect the payment of principal of and interest on the Notes or to enforce the performance of any provision of the Notes or this Indenture. The Trustee may maintain a proceeding even if it does not possess any of the Notes or does not produce any of them in the proceeding.

Section 6.04. Waiver of Past Defaults. Except as otherwise provided in Sections 6.02, 6.07 and 9.02, the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the outstanding Notes may, by notice to the Trustee, waive an existing Default and its consequences. Upon such waiver, the Default will cease to exist, and any Event of Default arising therefrom will be deemed to have been cured, but no such waiver will extend to any subsequent or other Default or impair any right consequent thereon.

Section 6.05. Control by Majority. The Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Notes may direct the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee or exercising any trust or power conferred on the Trustee with respect to the Notes. However, the Trustee may refuse to follow any direction that conflicts with law or this Indenture, or that the Trustee determines is unduly prejudicial to the rights of any other Holder of a Note or that would involve the Trustee in personal liability, and may take any other action it deems proper that is not inconsistent with any such direction received from Holders of Notes. Furthermore, (a) the rights of the Trustee to direct the Collateral Agent to exercise remedies with respect to the Collateral are subject in all respects to the Term Intercreditor Agreement and (b) the rights of the Collateral Agent, in its capacity as Authorized Term Collateral Agent to exercise remedies with respect to the Collateral are subject in all respects to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, notwithstanding any directions received from the Holders of the Notes and any other Term Obligations.

Section 6.06. Limitation on Suits. Except to enforce the right to receive payment of principal, premium (if any) or interest when due, no Holder of a Note may pursue any remedy with respect to this Indenture or the Notes unless:

(1) such Holder has previously given the Trustee notice that an Event of Default is continuing;

 

101


(2) Holders of at least 25% in principal amount of the outstanding Notes have requested the Trustee in writing to pursue the remedy;

(3) such Holders have offered the Trustee indemnity satisfactory to it against any loss, liability or expense;

(4) the Trustee has not complied with such request within 60 days after the receipt of the request and the offer of indemnity; and

(5) the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the outstanding Notes have not given the Trustee a direction inconsistent with such request within such 60-day period.

Section 6.07. Rights of Holders to Receive Payment. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary, the right of a Holder of a Note to receive payment of principal of or interest on its Note on or after the Stated Maturities thereof, or to bring suit for the enforcement of any such payment on or after such respective dates, may not be impaired or affected without the consent of that Holder.

Section 6.08. Collection Suit by Trustee. If an Event of Default in payment of principal or interest specified in clause (1) or (2) of Section 6.01(a) occurs and is continuing, the Trustee may recover judgment in its own name and as trustee of an express trust for the whole amount of principal and accrued interest remaining unpaid, together with interest on overdue principal and overdue installments of interest, in each case at the rate specified in the Notes, and such further amount as is sufficient to cover the costs and expenses of collection, including the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel and any other amounts due the Trustee hereunder.

Section 6.09. Trustee May File Proofs of Claim. The Trustee may file proofs of claim and other papers or documents as may be necessary or advisable in order to have the claims of the Trustee (including any claim for the compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel, and any other amounts due the Trustee hereunder) and the Holders allowed in any judicial proceedings relating to the Issuers or any Guarantor or their respective creditors or property, and is entitled and empowered to collect, receive and distribute any money, securities or other property payable or deliverable upon conversion or exchange of the Notes or upon any such claims. Any custodian, receiver, assignee, trustee, liquidator, sequestrator or other similar official in any such judicial proceeding is hereby authorized by each Holder to make such payments to the Trustee and, if the Trustee consents to the making of such payments directly to the Holders, to pay to the Trustee any amount due to it for the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agent and counsel, and any other amounts due the Trustee hereunder.

 

102


Nothing in this Indenture will be deemed to empower the Trustee to authorize or consent to, or accept or adopt on behalf of any Holder, any plan of reorganization, arrangement, adjustment or composition affecting the Notes or the rights of any Holder thereof, or to authorize the Trustee to vote in respect of the claim of any Holder in any such proceeding.

Section 6.10. Priorities. If the Trustee collects any money pursuant to this Article, it shall pay out the money in the following order:

First: to the Trustee for all amounts due hereunder;

Second: to Holders for amounts then due and unpaid for principal of and interest on the Notes, ratably, without preference or priority of any kind, according to the amounts due and payable on the Notes for principal and interest; and

Third: to the Issuers or as a court of competent jurisdiction may direct.

The Trustee, upon written notice to the Issuers, may fix a record date and payment date for any payment to Holders pursuant to this Section.

Section 6.11. Restoration of Rights and Remedies. If the Trustee or any Holder has instituted a proceeding to enforce any right or remedy under this Indenture and the proceeding has been discontinued or abandoned for any reason, or has been determined adversely to the Trustee or to the Holder, then, subject to any determination in the proceeding, the Issuers, any Guarantors, the Trustee and the Holders will be restored severally and respectively to their former positions hereunder and thereafter all rights and remedies of the Issuers, any Guarantors, the Trustee and the Holders will continue as though no such proceeding had been instituted.

Section 6.12. Undertaking for Costs. In any suit for the enforcement of any right or remedy under this Indenture or in any suit against the Trustee for any action taken or omitted by it as Trustee, a court may require any party litigant in such suit (other than the Trustee) to file an undertaking to pay the costs of the suit, and the court may assess reasonable costs, including reasonable attorneys fees, against any party litigant (other than the Trustee) in the suit having due regard to the merits and good faith of the claims or defenses made by the party litigant. This Section does not apply to a suit by a Holder to enforce payment of principal of or interest on any Note on the respective due dates, or a suit by Holders of more than 10% in principal amount of the outstanding Notes.

Section 6.13. Rights and Remedies Cumulative. No right or remedy conferred or reserved to the Trustee or to the Holders under this Indenture is intended to be exclusive of any other right or remedy, and all such rights and

 

103


remedies are, to the extent permitted by law, cumulative and in addition to every other right and remedy hereunder or now or hereafter existing at law or in equity or otherwise. The assertion or exercise of any right or remedy hereunder, or otherwise, will not prevent the concurrent assertion or exercise of any other right or remedy.

Section 6.14. Delay or Omission Not Waiver. No delay or omission of the Trustee or of any Holder to exercise any right or remedy accruing upon any Event of Default will impair any such right or remedy or constitute a waiver of any such Event of Default or an acquiescence therein. Every right and remedy given by this Article or by law to the Trustee or to the Holders may be exercised from time to time, and as often as may be deemed expedient, by the Trustee or by the Holders, as the case may be.

Section 6.15. Waiver of Stay, Extension or Usury Laws . Each Issuer and each Guarantor covenants, to the extent that it may lawfully do so, that it will not at any time insist upon, or plead, or in any manner whatsoever claim or take the benefit or advantage of, any stay or extension law or any usury law or other law that would prohibit or forgive the Issuers or the Guarantor from paying all or any portion of the principal of, or interest on the Notes as contemplated in this Indenture, wherever enacted, now or at any time hereafter in force, or that may affect the covenants or the performance of this Indenture. Each Issuer and each Guarantor hereby expressly waives, to the extent that it may lawfully do so, all benefit or advantage of any such law and covenants that it will not hinder, delay or impede the execution of any power in this Indenture granted to the Trustee, but will suffer and permit the execution of every such power as though no such law had been enacted.

ARTICLE 7

T HE T RUSTEE

Section 7.01. General. (a) The duties and responsibilities of the Trustee are as provided by the TIA and as set forth in this Indenture. Whether or not expressly so provided, every provision of this Indenture relating to the conduct or affecting the liability of or affording protection to the Trustee is subject to this Article.

(b) Except during the continuance of an Event of Default, the Trustee need perform only those duties that are specifically set forth in this Indenture and no others, and no implied covenants or obligations will be read into this Indenture against the Trustee. In case an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, the Trustee shall exercise those rights and powers vested in it by this Indenture, and use the same degree of care and skill in their exercise, as a prudent man would exercise or use under the circumstances in the conduct of his own affairs.

 

104


(c) No provision of this Indenture shall be construed to relieve the Trustee from liability for its own negligent action, its own negligent failure to act or its own willful misconduct, as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final and non-appealable decision.

Section 7.02. Certain Rights of Trustee. Subject to TIA Sections 315(a) through (d):

(1) In the absence of bad faith on its part, the Trustee may rely, and will be protected in acting or refraining from acting, upon any resolution, certificate, statement, instrument, opinion, report, notice, request, direction, consent, order, bond, debenture, Note, other evidence of indebtedness or other paper or document believed by it to be genuine and to have been signed or presented by the proper Person. The Trustee need not investigate any fact or matter stated in the document, but, in the case of any document which is specifically required to be furnished to the Trustee pursuant to any provision hereof, the Trustee shall examine the document to determine whether it conforms to the requirements of this Indenture (but need not confirm or investigate the accuracy of mathematical calculations or other facts stated therein). The Trustee, in its discretion, may make further inquiry or investigation into such facts or matters as it sees fit.

(2) Before the Trustee acts or refrains from acting, it may require an Officers’ Certificate or an Opinion of Counsel or both conforming to Section 12.05 and the Trustee will not be liable for any action it takes or omits to take in good faith in reliance on the certificate or opinion.

(3) The Trustee may act through its attorneys and agents and will not be responsible for the misconduct or negligence of any agent appointed with due care.

(4) The Trustee will be under no obligation to exercise any of the rights or powers vested in it by this Indenture at the request or direction of any of the Holders, unless such Holders have offered to the Trustee security and indemnity satisfactory to it in its sole discretion against any loss, liability, claim or expense that might be incurred by it in compliance with such request or direction.

(5) The Trustee will not be liable for any action it takes or omits to take in good faith that it believes to be authorized or within its rights or powers or for any action it takes or omits to take in accordance with the direction of the Holders in accordance with Section 6.04 relating to the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for any

 

105


remedy available to the Trustee, or exercising any trust or power conferred upon the Trustee, under this Indenture.

(6) The Trustee may consult with counsel, and the written advice of such counsel or any Opinion of Counsel will be full and complete authorization and protection in respect of any action taken, suffered or omitted by it hereunder in good faith and in reliance thereon.

(7) No provision of this Indenture will require the Trustee to expend or risk its own funds or otherwise incur any financial liability in the performance of its duties hereunder, or in the exercise of its rights or powers, unless it receives indemnity satisfactory to it in its sole discretion against any loss, liability, claim or expense.

(8) Unless otherwise specifically provided in this Indenture, any demand, request, direction or notice from the Issuers will be sufficient if signed by an Officer of each Issuer.

(9) In no event shall the Trustee be required to take notice of any default or breach hereof or any Default or Event of Default hereunder, except for Defaults or Events of Default specified in Section 6.01(a)(1) or (2) hereof, unless and until the Trustee shall have received from a Holder or from the Issuers express written notice of the circumstances constituting the breach, default, Default or Event of Default and stating that said circumstances constitute breach, default, Default or Event of Default.

(10) In no event shall the Trustee be responsible or liable for special, indirect, or consequential loss or damage of any kind whatsoever (including, but not limited to, loss of profit) irrespective of whether the Trustee has been advised of the likelihood of such loss or damage and regardless of the form of action.

(11) The rights, privileges, protections, immunities and benefits given to the Trustee, including, without limitation, its right to be indemnified, are extended to, and shall be enforceable by, the Trustee in each of its capacities hereunder (including, without limitation, as Collateral Agent, Registrar and Paying Agent), and each agent, custodian and other Person employed to act hereunder.

(12) The Trustee may request that the Issuers deliver a certificate setting forth the names of individuals and/or titles of officers authorized at such time to take specified actions pursuant to this Indenture.

(13) The Trustee shall have no duty to inquire as to the performance of the Issuers with respect to the covenants contained in Article 4.

 

106


(14) Any permissive right or authority granted to the Trustee shall not be construed as a mandatory duty.

Section 7.03. Individual Rights of Trustee. The Trustee, in its individual or any other capacity, may become the owner or pledgee of Notes and may otherwise deal with the Issuers or their Affiliates with the same rights it would have if it were not the Trustee. Any Agent may do the same with like rights. However, the Trustee is subject to TIA Sections 310(b) and 311. For purposes of TIA Section 311(b)(4) and (6):

(a) “ cash transaction ” means any transaction in which full payment for goods or securities sold is made within seven days after delivery of the goods or securities in currency or in checks or other orders drawn upon banks or bankers and payable upon demand; and

(b) “ self-liquidating paper ” means any draft, bill of exchange, acceptance or obligation which is made, drawn, negotiated or incurred for the purpose of financing the purchase, processing, manufacturing, shipment, storage or sale of goods, wares or merchandise and which is secured by documents evidencing title to, possession of, or a lien upon, the goods, wares or merchandise or the receivables or proceeds arising from the sale of the goods, wares or merchandise previously constituting the security, provided the security is received by the Trustee simultaneously with the creation of the creditor relationship arising from the making, drawing, negotiating or incurring of the draft, bill of exchange, acceptance or obligation.

Section 7.04. Trustee’s Disclaimer. The Trustee (i) makes no representation as to the validity or adequacy of this Indenture or the Notes, (ii) is not accountable for the Issuers’ use or application of the proceeds from the Notes and (iii) is not responsible for any statement in the Notes other than its certificate of authentication.

Section 7.05. Notice of Default. If any Default occurs and is continuing and is known to the Trustee, the Trustee must mail to each Holder of the Notes notice of the Default within the earlier of 90 days after it occurs or 30 days after it is actually known to a Trust Officer or written notice of it is received by the Trustee, unless the Default has been cured; provided that, except in the case of a Default in the payment of principal of, premium (if any) or interest on any Note (including payments pursuant to the redemption provisions of such Note), the Trustee may withhold notice if and so long as a committee of its Trust Officers in good faith determines that withholding the notice is in the interest of the Holders. Notice to Holders under this Section will be given in the manner and to the extent provided in TIA Section 313(c).

Section 7.06. Reports by Trustee to Holders. Within 60 days after each May 15, beginning with May 15, 2011, the Trustee will mail to each Holder, as

 

107


provided in TIA Section 313(c), a brief report dated as of such May 15, if required by TIA Section 313(a), and file such reports with each securities exchange upon which its Notes are listed and with the SEC as required by TIA Section 313(d).

Section 7.07. Compensation and Indemnity. (a) The Issuers, jointly and severally, will pay the Trustee compensation as agreed upon in writing for its services. The compensation of the Trustee is not limited by any law on compensation of a Trustee of an express trust. The Issuers, jointly and severally, will reimburse the Trustee upon request for all reasonable out-of-pocket expenses, disbursements and advances incurred or made by the Trustee, including the reasonable compensation and expenses of the Trustee’s agents, professional advisors and counsel.

(b) The Issuers, jointly and severally, will indemnify the Trustee for, and hold it harmless against, any loss or liability or expense incurred by it without negligence or bad faith on its part arising out of or in connection with the acceptance or administration of this Indenture and its duties under this Indenture and the Notes, including the costs and expenses of defending itself against any claim or liability and of complying with any process served upon it or any of its officers in connection with the exercise or performance of any of its powers or duties under this Indenture and the Notes.

(c) To secure the Issuers’ payment obligations in this Section 7.07, the Trustee will have a lien prior to the Notes on all money or property held or collected by the Trustee, in its capacity as Trustee, except money or property held in trust to pay principal of, and interest on particular Notes.

Section 7.08. Replacement of Trustee. (a) (1) The Trustee may resign at any time by written notice to the Issuers.

(2) The Holders of a majority in principal amount of the outstanding Notes may remove the Trustee by written notice to the Trustee.

(3) If the Trustee is no longer eligible under Section 7.10 or in the circumstances described in TIA Section 310(b), any Holder that satisfies the requirements of TIA Section 310(b) may petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the removal of the Trustee and the appointment of a successor Trustee.

(4) The Issuers may remove the Trustee if: (A) the Trustee is no longer eligible under Section 7.10; (B) the Trustee is adjudged a bankrupt or an insolvent; (C) a receiver or other public officer takes charge of the Trustee or its property; or (D) the Trustee becomes incapable of acting.

 

108


A resignation or removal of the Trustee and appointment of a successor Trustee will become effective only upon the successor Trustee’s acceptance of appointment as provided in this Section.

(b) If the Trustee has been removed by the Holders, Holders of a majority in principal amount of the Notes may appoint a successor Trustee with the consent of the Issuers. Otherwise, if the Trustee resigns or is removed, or if a vacancy exists in the office of Trustee for any reason, the Issuers will promptly appoint a successor Trustee. If the successor Trustee does not deliver its written acceptance within 30 days after the retiring Trustee resigns or is removed, the retiring Trustee, the Issuers or the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the outstanding Notes may petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the appointment of a successor Trustee.

(c) Upon delivery by the successor Trustee of a written acceptance of its appointment to the retiring Trustee and to the Issuers, (1) the retiring Trustee will transfer all property held by it as Trustee to the successor Trustee, subject to the lien provided for in Section 7.07, (2) the resignation or removal of the retiring Trustee will become effective, and (3) the successor Trustee will have all the rights, powers and duties of the Trustee under this Indenture. Upon the reasonable request of any successor Trustee, the Issuers will execute any and all instruments for fully and vesting in and confirming to the successor Trustee all such rights, powers and trusts. The Issuers will give notice of any resignation and any removal of the Trustee and each appointment of a successor Trustee to all Holders, and include in the notice the name of the successor Trustee and the address of its Corporate Trust Office.

(d) Notwithstanding replacement of the Trustee pursuant to this Section, the Issuers’ obligations under Section 7.07 will continue for the benefit of the retiring Trustee.

(e) The Trustee agrees to give the notices provided for in, and otherwise comply with, TIA Section 310(b).

Section 7.09. Successor Trustee by Merger . If the Trustee consolidates with, merges or converts into, or transfers all or substantially all of its corporate trust business to, another corporation or national banking association, the resulting, surviving or transferee corporation or national banking association without any further act will be the successor Trustee with the same effect as if the successor Trustee had been named as the Trustee in this Indenture.

Section 7.10. Eligibility . This Indenture must always have a Trustee that satisfies the requirements of TIA Section 310(a) and has a combined capital and surplus of at least $25,000,000 as set forth in its most recent published annual report of condition.

 

109


Section 7.11. Money Held in Trust . The Trustee will not be liable for interest on any money received by it except as it may agree with the Issuers. Money held in trust by the Trustee need not be segregated from other funds except to the extent required by law and except for money held in trust under Article 8.

ARTICLE 8

D EFEASANCE AND D ISCHARGE

Section 8.01. Discharge of Issuers’ Obligations . (a) Subject to paragraph (b), the Issuers’ obligations under the Notes and this Indenture, and each Guarantor’s obligations under its Notes Guarantee (other than of Parent, Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC or any Subsidiary Guarantor that, directly or indirectly, owns Capital Stock of either of the Issuers), and the obligations of the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors under the Security Documents (except to the extent specifically provided for therein following the termination of the obligations of the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors under such Security Documents), will terminate if:

(1) all Notes previously authenticated and delivered (other than (A) destroyed, lost or stolen Notes that have been replaced or (B) Notes that are paid pursuant to Section 4.01 or (C) Notes for whose payment money or U.S. Government Obligations have been held in trust and then repaid to the Issuers pursuant to Section 8.05) have been delivered to the Trustee for cancellation and the Issuers have paid all sums payable by them hereunder; or

(2) (A) the Notes have become due and payable, whether at maturity or on a Redemption Date, within sixty days, as a result of the mailing of notice of redemption, under arrangements satisfactory to the Trustee for giving the notice of redemption,

(B) the Issuers irrevocably deposit in trust with the Trustee, as trust funds solely for the benefit of the Holders, funds or U.S. Government Obligations or a combination thereof sufficient, in the opinion of a nationally recognized firm of independent public accountants expressed in a written certificate delivered to the Trustee, without consideration of any reinvestment, to pay at maturity or upon redemption all outstanding Notes, including premium, if any, and interest thereon to maturity or such Redemption Date, as the case may be, and to pay all other sums payable under this Indenture by the Issuers with respect to the Notes,

(C) no Default has occurred and is continuing on the date of the deposit,

 

110


(D) the deposit will not result in a breach or violation of, or constitute a default under, this Indenture or any other agreement or instrument to which the Issuers are a party or by which they are bound, and

(E) the Issuers deliver to the Trustee an Officers’ Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel, in each case stating that all conditions precedent provided for in this Indenture relating to the satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture have been complied with.

(b) After satisfying the conditions in clause (1), only the Issuers’ obligations under Section 7.07 will survive. After satisfying the conditions in clause (a)(2), only the Issuers’ obligations in Article 2 and Sections 4.01, 4.02, 7.07, 7.08, 8.05 and 8.06 will survive. In either case, the Trustee upon request will acknowledge in writing the discharge of the Issuers’ obligations under the Notes and this Indenture other than the surviving obligations.

Section 8.02. Legal Defeasance . (a) After the 123rd day following the deposit referred to in clause (1) below, the Issuers will be deemed to have paid and will be discharged from their obligations in respect of the Notes and this Indenture, and all obligations of Parents and the Restricted Subsidiaries, other than their obligations in Article 2 and Sections 4.01, 4.02, 7.07, 7.08, 8.05 and 8.06, and each Guarantor’s obligations under its Notes Guarantee will terminate (other than the Notes Guarantee of Parent, Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC or any Subsidiary Guarantor that, directly or indirectly, owns Capital Stock of either of the Issuers), and the obligations of the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors under the Security Documents (except to the extent specifically provided for therein following the termination of the obligations of the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors under such Security Documents) will terminate, provided the following conditions have been satisfied:

(1) The Issuers have irrevocably deposited in trust (the “ defeasance trust ”) with the Trustee, as trust funds solely for the benefit of the Holders, money in an amount sufficient or U.S. Government Obligations, the principal of and interest on which will be sufficient, or a combination thereof sufficient, without consideration of any reinvestment of such principal and interest, in the opinion of a nationally recognized firm of independent public accountants expressed in a written certification thereof delivered to the Trustee, to pay the principal of, premium (if any) and interest in respect of the Notes to redemption or maturity, as the case may be, provided for under arrangements satisfactory to the Trustee.

 

111


(2) No Default has occurred and is continuing on the date of the deposit or occurs at any time during the 123-day period following the deposit.

(3) The deposit will not result in a breach or violation of, or constitute a default under, this Indenture or any other agreement or instrument to which the Issuers are a party or by which they are bound.

(4) The Issuers have delivered to the Trustee

(A) an Opinion of Counsel to the effect that Holders will not recognize income, gain or loss for federal income tax purposes as a result of such deposit and defeasance and will be subject to federal income tax on the same amounts and in the same manner and at the same times as would have been the case if such deposit and defeasance had not occurred (and such Opinion of Counsel must be based on a ruling of the Internal Revenue Service or other change in applicable federal income tax law), and

(B) an Opinion of Counsel to the effect that (i) the creation of the defeasance trust does not violate the Investment Company Act, (ii) the Holders have a valid first priority Note interest in the trust funds (subject to customary exceptions), and (iii) after the passage of 123 days following the deposit, the trust funds will not be subject to the effect of Section 547 of the United States Bankruptcy Code or Section 15 of the New York Debtor and Creditor Law.

(5) If the Notes are listed on a national securities exchange, the Issuers have delivered to the Trustee an Opinion of Counsel to the effect that the deposit and defeasance will not cause the Notes to be delisted.

(6) The Issuers have delivered to the Trustee an Officers’ Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel, in each case stating that all conditions precedent provided for in this Indenture relating to the defeasance have been complied with.

Prior to the end of the 123-day period, none of the Issuers’ obligations under this Indenture will be discharged. Thereafter, the Trustee upon request will acknowledge in writing the discharge of the Issuers’ obligations under the Notes and this Indenture except for the surviving obligations specified above.

The Issuers may exercise their legal defeasance option pursuant to this Section 8.02 notwithstanding their prior exercise of their covenant defeasance option pursuant to Section 8.03 below. If the Issuers exercise their legal

 

112


defeasance option with respect to the Notes, payment of the Notes may not be accelerated because of an Event of Default with respect thereto.

Section 8.03. Covenant Defeasance . After the 123rd day following the deposit referred to in clause (1) of Section 8.02, the Issuers may elect to terminate their obligations, and the obligations of Parent (where applicable) and the Restricted Subsidiaries, under Sections 4.06 through 4.15, inclusive, Section 10.03 and under the Security Documents (except to the extent specifically provided for therein following the termination of the obligations of the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors under such Security Documents), and elect that the operation of the cross acceleration provision, the bankruptcy defaults with respect to Significant Subsidiaries (other than any Subsidiary Guarantor that owns Capital Stock, directly or indirectly, in an Issuer) and the judgment default provision and the limitations contained in clause (3) of Section 5.01(a) and clause (2)(B) of Section 5.01(c) will no longer constitute Events of Default, provided the Issuers have complied with clauses (1), (2), (3), (4) (except that the parenthetical of clause (4) shall not apply), (5) and (6) of Section 8.02 (such election, “ covenant defeasance ”).

(1) If the Issuers elect covenant defeasance pursuant to this Section 8.03, the Guarantors’ obligations under their Notes Guarantee will terminate (other than the Notes Guarantee of Parent, Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC or any Subsidiary Guarantor that, directly or indirectly, owns Capital Stock of either of the Issuers).

(2) If the Issuers exercise their covenant defeasance option with respect to the Notes, payment of the Notes may not be accelerated because of an Event of Default specified in clause (4), (5), (6), (7), (8) (but in the case of (7) and (8) only with respect to Significant Subsidiaries that do not own any Capital Stock, directly or indirectly, of either of the Issuers), or (9) under Section 6.01(a) or because of the failure of the Issuers to comply with clause (3) of Section 5.01(a) or the Subsidiary Guarantors to comply with clause (2)(B) of Section 5.01(c).

Except as specifically stated above, none of the Issuers’ obligations under this Indenture will be discharged.

Section 8.04. Application of Trust Money . Subject to Section 8.05, the Trustee will hold in trust the money or U.S. Government Obligations deposited with it pursuant to Section 8.01, 8.02 or 8.03, and apply the deposited funds, money and the proceeds from deposited U.S. Government Obligations to the payment of principal of and interest on the Notes in accordance with the Notes and this Indenture. Such funds, money and U.S. Government Obligations need not be segregated from other funds except to the extent required by law.

 

113


Section 8.05. Repayment to the Issuers . Subject to Sections 7.07, 8.01, 8.02 and 8.03, the Trustee will promptly pay to the Issuers upon request any excess money held by the Trustee at any time and thereupon be relieved from all liability with respect to such money. The Trustee will pay to the Issuers upon request any money held for payment with respect to the Notes that remains unclaimed for two years, provided that before making such payment the Trustee may at the expense of the Issuers publish once in a newspaper of general circulation in New York City, or send to each Holder entitled to such money, notice that the money remains unclaimed and that after a date specified in the notice (at least 30 days after the date of the publication or notice) any remaining unclaimed balance of money will be repaid to the Issuers. After payment to the Issuers, Holders entitled to such money must look solely to the Issuers for payment, unless applicable law designates another Person, and all liability of the Trustee with respect to such money will cease.

Section 8.06. Reinstatement . If and for so long as the Trustee is unable to apply any funds, money or U.S. Government Obligations held in trust pursuant to Section 8.01, 8.02 or 8.03 by reason of any legal proceeding or by reason of any order or judgment of any court or governmental authority enjoining, restraining or otherwise prohibiting such application, the Issuers’ obligations under this Indenture, the Notes and the applicable Security Documents and the Guarantors’ obligations under the Notes Guarantees and the applicable Security Documents will be reinstated as though no such deposit in trust had been made. If the Issuers make any payment of principal of or interest on any Notes because of the reinstatement of their obligations, they will be subrogated to the rights of the Holders of such Notes to receive such payment from the funds, money or U.S. Government Obligations held in trust.

ARTICLE 9

A MENDMENTS , S UPPLEMENTS AND W AIVERS

Section 9.01. Amendments Without Consent of Holders . (a) Without the consent of any Holder of Notes, the Issuers, the Guarantors, the Collateral Agent and the Trustee, as applicable, may amend or supplement this Indenture, the Notes or the Security Documents in order to:

(1) cure any ambiguity, omission, defect or inconsistency;

(2) provide for the assumption by a successor corporation of the obligations of any Issuer or any Guarantor under this Indenture and the Security Documents in compliance with the terms of this Indenture and the Security Documents;

(3) provide for uncertificated Notes in addition to or in place of certificated Notes ( provided , however , that the uncertificated Notes are issued in registered form for purposes of Section 163(f) of the Code, or in

 

114


a manner such that the uncertificated Notes are described in Section 163(f)(2)(B) of the Code);

(4) add additional Subsidiary Guarantees or other Notes Guarantees or to confirm and evidence the release, termination or discharge of any Notes Guarantee when such release, termination or discharge is permitted under this Indenture;

(5) add additional assets as Collateral to secure the Notes and the Subsidiary Guarantees;

(6) release Collateral in compliance with this Indenture, the Term Intercreditor Agreement or the ABL Intercreditor Agreement;

(7) add additional secured creditors holding Additional Term Obligations or any other Secured Indebtedness permitted to be Incurred, so long as such obligations are in compliance with this Indenture and the Security Documents;

(8) add to the covenants of any Issuer, Parent or any Restricted Subsidiary for the benefit of the Holders of Notes or to surrender any right or power conferred upon any Issuer, Parent or any Restricted Subsidiary;

(9) make any change that does not adversely affect the rights of any Holder in any material respect, subject to the provisions of this Indenture;

(10) make any amendment to the provisions of this Indenture relating to the form, authentication, transfer and legending of Notes; provided , however , that

(A) compliance with this Indenture as so amended would not result in Notes being transferred in violation of the Securities Act or any other applicable securities law and

(B) such amendment does not materially and adversely affect the rights of Holders to transfer Notes;

(11) comply with any requirement of the SEC in connection with the qualification of this Indenture under the TIA;

(12) convey, transfer, assign, mortgage or pledge as security for the Notes any property or assets in accordance with Section 4.08;

 

115


(13) evidence and provide for the acceptance and appointment under this Indenture of a successor Trustee thereunder pursuant to the requirements thereof;

(14) add any Additional Notes as permitted by this Indenture; or

(15) conform the text of this Indenture, the Notes, the Subsidiary Guarantees, the Security Documents, the ABL Intercreditor Agreement or the Term Intercreditor Agreement to any provision of the “Description of notes” contained in the offering memorandum relating to the Initial Notes to the extent that such provision in the “Description of notes” was intended to be a verbatim recitation of a provision of this Indenture, the Notes, the Notes Guarantees, the Security Documents, the ABL Intercreditor Agreement or the Term Intercreditor Agreement (subject, in the case of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement and the Term Intercreditor Agreement, to the restrictions on amendments contained therein), which intent shall be evidenced by an Officers’ Certificate to that effect.

Section 9.02. Amendments With Consent of Holders . (a) Except as otherwise provided in Sections 6.02, 6.04 and 6.07 or paragraph (b) of this Section 9.02, this Indenture, the Notes and the Security Documents may be amended with the written consent of the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the Notes then outstanding voting as a single class (including consents obtained in connection with a purchase of or tender offer or exchange offer for the Notes) and any past Default or compliance with any provisions with respect to the Notes may be waived with the consent of the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the Notes then outstanding voting as a single class (including consents obtained in connection with a purchase of or tender offer or exchange offer for the Notes).

(b) Notwithstanding the provisions of paragraph (a), without the consent of each Holder of an outstanding Note affected, an amendment or waiver may not

(1) reduce the amount of the Notes whose Holders must consent to an amendment;

(2) reduce the rate of or extend the time for payment of interest on any Note;

(3) reduce the principal amount of or extend the Stated Maturity of any installment of principal of any Note;

(4) reduce the amount payable (including premium) upon the redemption of any Note or change the time of any mandatory redemption or, in respect of an optional redemption, the times at which any Note may

 

116


be redeemed or, once notice of redemption has been given, the time at which it must thereupon be redeemed;

(5) make any Note payable in money other than that stated in the Note;

(6) impair the right of any Holder of Notes to receive payment of principal of, and interest on, such Holder’s Notes on or after the due date thereof, or to institute suit for the enforcement of any payment on or with respect to such Holder’s Notes;

(7) make any change in the amendment provisions which require each Holder’s consent or in the waiver provisions;

(8) modify the Notes Guarantees in any manner adverse to the Holders of Notes;

(9) make any change in the provisions of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, the Term Intercreditor Agreement or this Indenture dealing with the application of proceeds of Collateral that would adversely affect the Holders of the Notes; or

(10) modify or change any provision of this Indenture affecting the ranking of the Notes or any Notes Guarantee in a manner adverse to the Holders of the Notes.

(c) Without the consent of the Holders of at least 66% in aggregate principal amount of the Notes then outstanding, no amendment or waiver may release all or substantially all of the Collateral from the Lien of this Indenture and the Security Documents with respect to the Notes.

(d) It is not necessary for Noteholders to approve the particular form of any proposed amendment, supplement or waiver, but is sufficient if their consent approves the substance thereof.

(e) An amendment, supplement or waiver under this Section will become effective on receipt by the Trustee of written consents from the Holders of the requisite percentage in principal amount of the outstanding Notes. After an amendment, supplement or waiver under this Section becomes effective, the Issuers will send to the Holders affected thereby a notice briefly describing the amendment, supplement or waiver. The Issuers will send supplemental indentures to Holders upon request. Any failure of the Issuers to send such notice, or any defect therein, will not, however, in any way impair or affect the validity of any such supplemental indenture or waiver.

Section 9.03. Effect of Consent . (a) After an amendment, supplement or waiver becomes effective, it will bind every Holder unless it is of the type

 

117


requiring the consent of each Holder affected. If the amendment, supplement or waiver is of the type requiring the consent of each Holder affected, the amendment, supplement or waiver will bind each Holder that has consented to it and every subsequent Holder of a Note that evidences the same debt as the Note of the consenting Holder.

(b) If an amendment, supplement or waiver changes the terms of a Note, the Trustee may require the Holder to deliver it to the Trustee so that the Trustee may place an appropriate notation of the changed terms on the Note and return it to the Holder, or exchange it for a new Note that reflects the changed terms. The Trustee may also place an appropriate notation on any Note thereafter authenticated. However, the effectiveness of the amendment, supplement or waiver is not affected by any failure to annotate or exchange Notes in this fashion.

Section 9.04. Trustee’s Rights and Obligations . The Trustee is entitled to receive, and will be fully protected in relying upon, an Opinion of Counsel and Officers’ Certificate stating that the execution of any amendment, supplement or waiver authorized pursuant to this Article is authorized or permitted by this Indenture and that such amended or supplemental indenture is the legal, valid and binding obligation of the Issuers and any Guarantor party thereto, enforceable against them in accordance with its terms, subject to customary exceptions and complies with the provisions of this Indenture. If the Trustee has received such an Opinion of Counsel and Officers’ Certificate, it shall sign the amendment, supplement or waiver so long as the same does not adversely affect the rights, duties, liabilities or immunities of the Trustee. The Trustee may, but is not obligated to, execute any amendment, supplement or waiver that affects the Trustee’s own rights, duties, liabilities or immunities under this Indenture.

Section 9.05. Conformity With TIA . Every amendment or supplement to this Indenture or the Notes shall be set forth in an amendment or supplemental indenture that complies with the TIA as then in effect.

Section 9.06. Payments for Consents . Neither of Parent, the Issuers nor any of their Subsidiaries or Affiliates may, directly or indirectly, pay or cause to be paid any consideration, whether by way of interest, fee or otherwise, to any Holder for or as an inducement to any consent, waiver or amendment of any of the terms or provisions of this Indenture or the Notes unless such consideration is offered to be paid or agreed to be paid to all Holders of the Notes that consent, waive or agree to amend such term or provision within the time period set forth in the solicitation documents relating to the consent, waiver or amendment.

 

118


ARTICLE 10

S ECURITY I NTEREST

Section 10.01. Grant of Security Interest . (a) The Issuers’ and the Subsidiary Guarantors’ obligations to pay the principal (and Applicable Premium, if any) and interest on the Notes in accordance with the terms of the Notes and this Indenture and all other Notes Obligations of the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors hereunder, under the Notes, the Notes Guarantees and the Security Documents shall be secured as provided in the Security Documents.

(b) As among the Holders, the Collateral as now or hereafter constituted shall be held for the equal and ratable benefit of the Holders, without preference, priority or distinction of any thereof over any other by reason of differences in time of issuance, sale or otherwise, as security for the Obligations under this Indenture and the Notes.

(c) To the extent applicable, within 60 days after each May 15, beginning with May 15, 2011, the Issuers will comply with Section 313(b) of the TIA relating to reports with respect to the Collateral (which for such purposes may assume that the certificate or opinion required by paragraph (1) of subsection (d) of Section 314 of the TIA is so required pursuant to this Indenture).

(d) Each Holder, by its acceptance of the Notes, (i) appoints the Trustee as Collateral Agent, (ii) authorizes and directs the Collateral Agent (x) to enter into the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, the Term Intercreditor Agreement (including in its capacity as Authorized Term Collateral Agent as of the Issue Date) and the Security Documents, whether as Trustee, Collateral Agent or Representative (under and as defined in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, “ Representative ”), and to perform its obligations and exercise its rights thereunder in accordance therewith, and (y) to receive for the benefit of the Holders any funds collected or distributed under the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, the Term Intercreditor Agreement or the Security Documents to which the Trustee, whether as Trustee, Collateral Agent or Representative, is a party and to make further distributions of such funds to the Holders according to the provisions of this Indenture and (iii) without limiting the foregoing, consents and agrees to all of the terms and conditions of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, the Term Intercreditor Agreement, the Security Agreement and the other Security Documents (including, without limitation, the provisions providing for foreclosure and release of Collateral); provided that if any provision of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, the Term Intercreditor Agreement or Security Documents limit or conflict with the requirements of the TIA, the TIA will control if this Indenture is required to be qualified under the TIA.

 

119


(e) In acting in its capacity as Collateral Agent, Authorized Term Collateral Agent or Representative, the Trustee shall not be (i) deemed to have breached its fiduciary duty as Trustee to the Holders as a result of the performance of its duties as Collateral Agent, Authorized Term Collateral Agent or Representative to the extent that it acts in compliance with the terms and provisions of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, the Term Intercreditor Agreement and the Security Documents or (ii) liable to the Holders for any action taken or omitted in compliance with the terms and provisions of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, Term Intercreditor Agreement or the Security Documents.

(f) In the event (i) the Trustee shall receive any written request from an Issuer, a Subsidiary Guarantor or any other party to a Security Document, the ABL Intercreditor Agreement or the Term Intercreditor Agreement for consent or approval with respect to any matter or thing relating to any Collateral or such Issuer’s or such Subsidiary Guarantor’s obligations with respect thereto, (ii) there shall be due to or from the Trustee or the Collateral Agent under the provisions of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement (including in its capacity as a “Representative”), the Term Intercreditor Agreement or any Security Document any material performance or the delivery of any material instrument or (iii) the Trustee shall become aware of any nonperformance by an Issuer or a Subsidiary Guarantor of any covenant or any breach of any representation or warranty of such Issuer or such Subsidiary Guarantor set forth in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, the Term Intercreditor Agreement or any Security Document, then, in each such event, the Trustee shall be entitled to hire experts, consultants, agents and attorneys to advise the Trustee on the manner in which the Trustee should respond, or direct the Collateral Agent to respond, to such request or render any requested performance or respond, or direct the Collateral Agent to respond, to such nonperformance or breach; provided that the Trustee’s right to direct the Collateral Agent to respond shall be subject to the terms of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, the Term Intercreditor Agreement and the Security Documents. The Trustee shall be fully protected in the taking of any action recommended or approved by any such expert, consultant, agent or attorney or agreed to by the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the Notes then outstanding.

(g) In acting in its capacity as Collateral Agent, Authorized Term Collateral Agent or Representative, the Trustee shall not have any duty as to any Collateral in its possession or control or in the possession or control of any agent or bailee or any income thereon or as to preservation of rights against prior parties or any other rights pertaining thereto and shall not be responsible for the filing, form or content of any financing or continuation statements or recording any documents or instruments in any public office at any time or times or otherwise perfecting or maintaining the perfection of any security interest in the Collateral. The Collateral Agent shall be deemed to have exercised reasonable care in the custody of the Collateral in its or their possession if the Collateral is

 

120


accorded treatment substantially equal to that which it or they accord their own property and shall not be liable or responsible for any loss or diminution in the value of any of the Collateral, by reason of the act or omission of any carrier, forwarding agency or other agent or bailee selected by the Collateral Agent in good faith.

(h) In acting in its capacity as Collateral Agent, Authorized Term Collateral Agent or Representative, the Trustee shall not be responsible for the existence, genuineness or value of any of the Collateral or for the validity, perfection, priority or enforceability of the Liens in any of the Collateral, whether impaired by operation of law or by reason of any action or omission to act on its or their part hereunder, except to the extent such action or omission constitutes gross negligence, bad faith or willful misconduct on the part of the Collateral Agent, as applicable, for the validity or sufficiency of the Collateral or any agreement or assignment contained therein, for the validity of the title of the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors to the Collateral, for insuring the Collateral or for the payment of taxes, charges, assessments or Liens upon the Collateral or otherwise as to the maintenance of the Collateral.

Section 10.02. Release of Security Interest . (a) The Collateral Agent’s Liens on the Collateral shall be released in accordance with, and to the extent provided for in, Section 19 of the Security Agreement. Upon delivery by the Issuers to the Trustee and the Collateral Agent of an Officers’ Certificate describing the event which has resulted in the release of such Liens (and the Collateral subject to such release) and certifying that the release of such Liens has occurred in accordance with the Security Agreement (and, to the extent provided for in the Security Agreement, that the applicable transaction resulting in such release (if any) was effected in accordance with this Indenture, the Security Documents, the ABL Intercreditor Agreement and/or the Term Intercreditor Agreement), the Trustee and/or the Collateral Agent, as applicable, shall, if necessary, execute any reasonable document or termination statement necessary to release, or confirm the release of, such Liens, all at the written request and expense of the Issuers. Nothing set forth in this Section 10.02 shall limit the automatic Lien release provisions of any Security Document, the ABL Intercreditor Agreement or the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

(b) The release of the Collateral Agent’s Liens in any part of the Collateral shall not be deemed to impair any such Liens in other parts of the Collateral under this Indenture or the Security Documents, the ABL Intercreditor Agreement or the Term Intercreditor Agreement or be deemed to be in contravention of the provisions of this Indenture, any Security Document, the ABL Term Intercreditor Agreement or the Term Intercreditor Agreement if and to the extent such Liens in such part of the Collateral are released pursuant to the terms of this Indenture, the Security Documents, the ABL Intercreditor Agreement and the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

 

121


Section 10.03. Pledge of Additional Collateral, Etc . (a) If any Issuer or any Subsidiary Guarantor acquires or holds any assets or property that are not subject to the Liens securing the Notes Obligations (including because such Person was not previously party to the Security Agreement or any other applicable Security Document), subject to the following two sentences and certain exceptions described in Section 2 of the Security Agreement, such Issuer or such Subsidiary Guarantor shall execute and deliver such additional Security Documents (which may include supplements or joinders to any of the Security Documents) and certificates and opinions of counsel as shall be reasonably necessary to vest in the Collateral Agent a perfected first priority security interest (to the extent such assets constitute Term Priority Collateral) or second priority security interest (to the extent such assets constitute ABL Priority Collateral), subject only to Permitted Liens, in such assets or property and to have such assets or property added to the Collateral, and thereupon all provisions of this Indenture relating to the Collateral shall be deemed to relate to such assets or property to the same extent and with the same force and effect. If granting a security interest in such assets or property requires the consent of a third party, the Issuers will use commercially reasonable efforts to obtain such consent. If such third party does not consent to the granting of the first priority security interest after the use of such commercially reasonable efforts, the applicable Issuer or Subsidiary Guarantor will not be required to provide such security interest.

(b) The Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors shall comply with (i) the requirements set forth in the Security Agreement (including, without limitation, Sections 4(e), 4(f), 4(g) and 4(h) thereof), the ABL Intercreditor Agreement and the Term Intercreditor Agreement with respect to the pledge of additional Collateral, the perfection of the related security interests and the taking of related actions and (ii) all other covenants, agreements and obligations applicable to them contained in the Security Documents, the ABL Intercreditor Agreement or the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

(c) If an Issuer or any Subsidiary Guarantor shall at any time after the Issue Date grant a mortgage on any real property to secure the ABL Obligations, such Issuer or Subsidiary Guarantor shall provide a mortgage on such real property to secure the Term Obligations (including the Notes Obligations), subject to the priorities and other provisions set forth in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement and the Term Intercreditor Agreement. Other than to comply with the preceding sentence, the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors are not required to grant a security interest to secure the Notes Obligations in (x) any owned or leased real property having a Fair Market Value (as determined in good faith by Parent) of $1.0 million or less or (y) any leasehold interests to the extent that the landlord therefor shall have not consented thereto notwithstanding the Issuers’ commercially reasonable efforts to secure such consent.

Section 10.04. Collateral Agent . (a) Wilmington Trust FSB is appointed as Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Holders of the Notes and shall initially

 

122


act as Collateral Agent under this Indenture, the Security Documents and the Term Intercreditor Agreement and as “Representative” with respect to this Indenture under the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

(b) Subject to the terms of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement and the Term Intercreditor Agreement, the Collateral Agent will hold (directly or through co-trustees or agents), and will be entitled to enforce on behalf of the Holders of Notes, all Liens on the Collateral securing the Notes Obligations.

(c) All of the rights, protections, benefits, privileges, indemnities and immunities granted to the Trustee hereunder shall inure to the benefit of the Collateral Agent acting hereunder and under the Security Documents, the ABL Intercreditor Agreement and the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

Section 10.05. Replacement of Collateral Agent . The Collateral Agent shall automatically be deemed to have resigned or been removed upon the resignation or removal, as applicable, of the Trustee in accordance with Section 7.08 hereof.

Section 10.06. Ranking . The Trustee and each Holder of Notes by accepting a Note agrees, that:

(a) To the extent and in the manner provided in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, (i) the Term Obligations Liens (including the Liens securing the Notes Obligations) are (x) subject to and junior in ranking to all present and future ABL Obligations Liens with respect to Collateral that is ABL Priority Collateral and (y) senior in ranking to all present and future ABL Obligations Liens with respect to Collateral that is Term Priority Collateral.

(b) As among the ABL Agent, the Term Agents, and the ABL Secured Parties and the Term Secured Parties, (i) the ABL Secured Parties and the ABL Agent will have the sole ability to control and obtain remedies with respect to all ABL Priority Collateral without the necessity of any consent or of any notice to any Term Agent or Term Secured Party, and (ii) the Term Secured Parties and Term Agents will have the sole ability to control and obtain remedies with respect to all Term Priority Collateral without the necessity of any consent or of any notice to any ABL Agent or ABL Secured Party, each subject to the limitations set forth in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement and the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

(c) To the extent and in the manner provided in the Term Intercreditor Agreement, the Liens securing the Notes Obligations are equal in ranking with the other present and future Term Obligations Liens on the Common Collateral.

(d) As among the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, the other Term Agents, the Controlling Term Secured Parties and the Non-Controlling Term

 

123


Secured Parties, the Authorized Term Collateral Agent will have the sole ability to control and obtain remedies with respect to the Common Collateral without the necessity of any consent or any notice to any other Term Agent or Term Secured Party, subject to the limitations set forth in, and the other provisions of, the ABL Intercreditor Agreement and the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

Section 10.07. Notes Obligations Not Subordinated . The provisions of Section 10.06 are intended solely to set forth the relative ranking, as Liens, of the Liens on the ABL Priority Collateral and the Term Priority Collateral securing the Notes Obligations as against (1) the Liens on the ABL Priority Collateral and the Term Priority Collateral securing the ABL Obligations and (2) the Liens on the ABL Priority Collateral and the Term Priority Collateral securing the other Term Obligations. The Notes Obligations are senior obligations of the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors. Neither the Notes Obligations nor the exercise or enforcement of any right or remedy for the payment or collection thereof (other than the exercise of rights and remedies in respect of the Collateral, which are subject to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement and Term Intercreditor Agreement) are intended to be, or will ever be by reason of the provisions of Section 10.06, in any respect subordinated, deferred, postponed, restricted or prejudiced.

ARTICLE 11

N OTES G UARANTEES

Section 11.01. The Notes Guarantees . (a) Subject to the provisions of this Article, the Guarantors, as primary obligors and not merely as sureties, will jointly and severally irrevocably and unconditionally Guarantee (each such Guarantee, a “ Notes Guarantee ”), on a senior unsecured basis in the case of Parent and a senior secured basis in the case of the Subsidiary Guarantors, the performance and full and punctual payment when due, whether at Stated Maturity, by acceleration or otherwise, of all obligations of the Issuers and Parent (where applicable) under this Indenture (including obligations to the Trustee and Collateral Agent) and the Notes, whether for payment of principal of or interest on the Notes, fees, expenses, indemnification or otherwise (all such obligations guaranteed by such Guarantors being herein called the “ Guaranteed Obligations ”). Each of the Guarantors also agrees to pay, in addition to the amount stated above, any and all costs and expenses (including reasonable fees and expenses of counsel, agents and professional advisors) incurred by the Trustee, Collateral Agent and/or the Holders in enforcing any rights under the Notes Guarantees and such fees and expenses shall also be deemed “Guaranteed Obligations”. Upon failure by the Issuers to pay punctually any such amount, each Guarantor shall forthwith on demand pay the amount not so paid at the place and in the manner specified in this Indenture.

 

124


(b) Each Notes Guarantee is a continuing guarantee and shall (a) other than as provided elsewhere in this Article, remain in full force and effect until payment in full of all the Guaranteed Obligations, (b) be binding upon each Guarantor and its successors and (c) inure to the benefit of, and be enforceable by, the Trustee, the Holders and their successors, transferees and assigns.

Section 11.02. Notes Guarantee Unconditional . The obligations of each Guarantor hereunder are unconditional and absolute and, without limiting the generality of the foregoing, will not be released, discharged or otherwise affected by

(a) any extension, renewal, settlement, compromise, waiver or release in respect of any obligation of the Issuers under this Indenture or any Note, by operation of law or otherwise;

(b) any modification or amendment of or supplement to this Indenture or any Note;

(c) any change in the corporate existence, structure or ownership of the Issuers, or any insolvency, bankruptcy, reorganization or other similar proceeding affecting the Issuers or their assets or, except as set forth in Article 8 any resulting release or discharge of any obligation of the Issuers contained in this Indenture or any Note;

(d) the existence of any claim, set off or other rights which the Guarantor may have at any time against the Issuers, the Trustee or any other Person, whether in connection with this Indenture or any unrelated transactions, provided that nothing in this Indenture prevents the assertion of any such claim by separate suit or compulsory counterclaim;

(e) any invalidity or unenforceability relating to or against the Issuers for any reason of this Indenture or any Note, or any provision of applicable law or regulation purporting to prohibit the payment by the Issuers of the principal of or interest on any Note or any other amount payable by the Issuers under this Indenture; or

(f) any other act or omission to act or delay of any kind by the Issuers, the Trustee or any other Person or any other circumstance whatsoever which might, but for the provisions of this paragraph, constitute a legal or equitable discharge of or defense to such Guarantor’s obligations hereunder.

Section 11.03. Discharge; Reinstatement . Each Guarantor’s obligations hereunder will remain in full force and effect until the principal of, premium, if any, and interest on the Notes and all other amounts payable by the Issuers under this Indenture have been paid in full. If at any time any payment of the principal of, premium, if any, or interest on any Note or any other amount payable by the

 

125


Issuers under this Indenture is rescinded or must be otherwise restored or returned upon the insolvency, bankruptcy or reorganization of the Issuers or otherwise, each Guarantor’s obligations hereunder with respect to such payment will be reinstated as though such payment had been due but not made at such time.

Section 11.04. Waiver by the Guarantors . Each Guarantor irrevocably waives acceptance hereof, presentment, demand, protest and any notice not provided for in this Indenture, as well as any requirement that at any time any action be taken by any Person against the Issuers or any other Person.

Section 11.05. Subrogation and Contribution . Upon making any payment with respect to any obligation of the Issuers under this Article, the Guarantor making such payment will be subrogated to the rights of the payee against the Issuers with respect to such obligation, provided that the Guarantor may not enforce either any right of subrogation, or any right to receive payment in the nature of contribution, or otherwise, from any other Guarantor, with respect to such payment so long as any amount payable by the Issuers hereunder or under the Notes remains unpaid.

Section 11.06. Stay of Acceleration . If acceleration of the time for payment of any amount payable by the Issuers under this Indenture or the Notes is stayed upon the insolvency, bankruptcy or reorganization of the Issuers, all such amounts otherwise subject to acceleration under the terms of this Indenture are nonetheless payable by the Guarantors hereunder forthwith on demand by the Trustee or the Holders.

Section 11.07. Limitation on Amount of Notes Guarantee . Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Article, each Guarantor, and by its acceptance of Notes, each Holder, hereby confirms that it is the intention of all such parties that the Notes Guarantee of such Guarantor not constitute a fraudulent conveyance or fraudulent transfer under applicable fraudulent conveyance or fraudulent transfer provisions of the United States Bankruptcy Code or any comparable provision of state law. To effectuate that intention, the Trustee, the Holders and the Guarantors hereby irrevocably agree that the obligations of each Guarantor under its Notes Guarantee are limited to the maximum amount that would not render such Guarantor’s obligations subject to avoidance or voidable under applicable fraudulent conveyance or fraudulent transfer provisions of the United States Bankruptcy Code or any comparable provision of state or federal law affecting the rights of creditors generally.

Section 11.08. Execution and Delivery of Notes Guarantee . The execution by each Guarantor of this Indenture (or a supplemental indenture in the form of Exhibit B) evidences the Notes Guarantee of such Guarantor, whether or not the person signing as an officer of the Guarantor still holds that office at the time of authentication of any Note. The delivery of any Note by the Trustee after

 

126


authentication constitutes due delivery of the Notes Guarantee set forth in this Indenture on behalf of each Guarantor.

Section 11.09. Release of Notes Guarantee . (a) The Subsidiary Guarantee of a Subsidiary Guarantor (but not of Parent, Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC or any Subsidiary Guarantor that, directly or indirectly, owns Capital Stock of either of the Issuers) will be released automatically:

(1) upon the sale (including any sale pursuant to any exercise of remedies by a holder of Indebtedness of the Issuers or of such Subsidiary Guarantor) or other disposition (including by way of consolidation or merger) of a Subsidiary Guarantor;

(2) if such Subsidiary Guarantor no longer Guarantees or is otherwise obligated as an issuer or borrower under any of: (a) the ABL Facility; (b) the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility, (c) Indebtedness under Credit Facilities Incurred in reliance on clause (b)(1) of Section 4.06; or (d) any Material Capital Markets Indebtedness;

(3) upon the sale or disposition of all or substantially all the assets of such Subsidiary Guarantor;

(4) upon the designation of such Subsidiary Guarantor as an Unrestricted Subsidiary;

(5) at our election, during any Suspension Period; or

(6) if the Issuers exercise their legal defeasance option or their covenant defeasance option pursuant to Section 8.02 or Section 8.03 or if their obligations under this Indenture are discharged in accordance with the terms of this Indenture pursuant to Section 8.01.

(b) The Issuers shall notify the Trustee and the Holders if the Subsidiary Guarantee of any Subsidiary Guarantor is released and shall provide the Trustee with an Officers’ Certificate and Opinion of Counsel upon which the Trustee may conclusively rely. The Trustee shall execute and deliver an appropriate instrument confirming the release of any such Subsidiary Guarantor upon request of the Issuers.

ARTICLE 12

M ISCELLANEOUS

Section 12.01. TIA . This Indenture shall incorporate and be governed by the provisions of the TIA that are required to be part of and to govern indentures qualified under the TIA, excluding Sections 314(b) and 314(d) thereof (so long as this Indenture is not qualified pursuant to the TIA); it being understood, for the avoidance of doubt, that the Issuers are not required to have the Indenture

 

127


qualified under the TIA and have not covenanted or agreed to qualify the Indenture under the TIA except to the extent so required, if at all, under the TIA.

Section 12.02. Noteholder Communications; Noteholder Actions . (a) The rights of Holders to communicate with other Holders with respect to this Indenture or the Notes are as provided by the TIA, and the Issuers and the Trustee shall comply with the requirements of TIA Sections 312(a) and 312(b). Neither the Issuers nor the Trustee will be held accountable by reason of any disclosure of information as to names and addresses of Holders made pursuant to the TIA.

(b) (1) Any request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent to amendment, supplement or waiver or other action provided by this Indenture to be given or taken by a Holder (an “ act ”) may be evidenced by an instrument signed by the Holder delivered to the Trustee. The fact and date of the execution of the instrument, or the authority of the person executing it, may be proved in any manner that the Trustee deems sufficient.

(2) The Trustee may make reasonable rules for action by or at a meeting of Holders, which will be binding on all the Holders.

(c) Any act by the Holder of any Note binds that Holder and every subsequent Holder of a Note that evidences the same debt as the Note of the acting Holder, even if no notation thereof appears on the Note. Subject to paragraph (d), a Holder may revoke an act as to its Notes, but only if the Trustee receives the notice of revocation before the date the amendment or waiver or other consequence of the act becomes effective.

(d) The Issuers may, but are not obligated to, fix a record date (which need not be within the time limits otherwise prescribed by TIA Section 316(c)) for the purpose of determining the Holders entitled to act with respect to any amendment or waiver or in any other regard, except that during the continuance of an Event of Default, only the Trustee may set a record date as to notices of default, any declaration or acceleration or any other remedies or other consequences of the Event of Default. If a record date is fixed, those Persons that were Holders at such record date and only those Persons will be entitled to act, or to revoke any previous act, whether or not those Persons continue to be Holders after the record date. No act will be valid or effective for more than 90 days after the record date.

Section 12.03. Notices . (a) Any notice or communication to the Issuers will be deemed given if in writing (1) when delivered in person or (2) five days after mailing when mailed by first class mail, or (3) when sent by facsimile transmission, with transmission confirmed. Notices or communications to a Guarantor will be deemed given if given to the Issuers. Any notice to the Trustee will be effective only upon receipt. In each case the notice or communication should be addressed as follows:

 

128


if to the Issuers:

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC

c/o Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC

17672 N. Laurel Park Drive, Suite 400E

Livonia, Michigan 48152

Facsimile: (248) 675-6800

Attention: James Gouin

      Nanette Dudek

and

TA HOLDINGS FINANCE, INC.

c/o Tower Automotive, LLC

299 Park Avenue

New York, NY 10171

Facsimile: (212) 891-1541

Attention: Dev B. Kapadia, Member of Board of Managers

with a copy to (which shall not constitute notice):

Lowenstein Sandler PC

1251 Avenue of the Americas

New York, NY 10020

Facsimile: (973) 597-2425

Attention: Robert G. Minion, Esq.

      Lowell A. Citron, Esq.

if to the Trustee and/or the Collateral Agent:

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB

1100 North Market Street

Rodney Square North

Wilmington, Delaware 19890

Attention: Corporate Capital Markets

Facsimile: (302) 636-4145

with a copy to (which shall not constitute notice):

Pillsbury Winthrop Shaw Pittman LLP

1540 Broadway

New York, New York 10036

Facsimile: (212) 881-9368

Attention: Bart Pisella, Esq.

      Timothy P. Kober, Esq.

 

129


The Issuers or the Trustee by notice to the other may designate additional or different addresses for subsequent notices or communications.

(b) Except as otherwise expressly provided with respect to published notices, any notice or communication to a Holder will be deemed given when mailed to the Holder at its address as it appears on the Register by first class mail or, as to any Global Note registered in the name of DTC or its nominee, as agreed by the Issuers, the Trustee and DTC. Copies of any notice or communication to a Holder, if given by the Issuers, will be mailed to the Trustee at the same time. Defect in mailing a notice or communication to any particular Holder will not affect its sufficiency with respect to other Holders.

(c) Where this Indenture provides for notice, the notice may be waived in writing by the Person entitled to receive such notice, either before or after the event, and the waiver will be the equivalent of the notice. Waivers of notice by Holders must be filed with the Trustee, but such filing is not a condition precedent to the validity of any action taken in reliance upon such waivers.

Section 12.04. Certificate and Opinion as to Conditions Precedent . Upon any request or application by the Issuers to the Trustee to take any action under this Indenture, the Issuers will furnish to the Trustee:

(1) an Officers’ Certificate stating that, in the opinion of the signers, all conditions precedent, if any, provided for in this Indenture relating to the proposed action have been complied with; and

(2) an Opinion of Counsel stating that all such conditions precedent have been complied with.

Section 12.05. Statements Required in Certificate or Opinion . Each certificate or opinion with respect to compliance with a condition or covenant provided for in this Indenture must include:

(1) a statement that each person signing the certificate or opinion has read the covenant or condition and the related definitions;

(2) a brief statement as to the nature and scope of the examination or investigation upon which the statement or opinion contained in the certificate or opinion is based;

(3) a statement that, in the opinion of each such person, that person has made such examination or investigation as is necessary to enable the person to express an informed opinion as to whether or not such covenant or condition has been complied with; and

(4) a statement as to whether or not, in the opinion of each such person, such condition or covenant has been complied with, provided

 

130


that an Opinion of Counsel may rely on an Officers’ Certificate or certificates of public officials with respect to matters of fact.

Section 12.06. Payment Date Other Than a Business Day . If any payment with respect to a payment of any principal of, premium, if any, or interest on any Note (including any payment to be made on any date fixed for redemption or purchase of any Note) is due on a day which is not a Business Day, then the payment need not be made on such date, but may be made on the next Business Day with the same force and effect as if made on such date, and no interest will accrue for the intervening period.

Section 12.07. Governing Law . This Indenture, including any Notes Guarantees, and the Notes shall be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the laws of the State of New York without giving effect to applicable principles of conflicts of law to the extent that the application of the law of another jurisdiction would be required thereby.

Section 12.08. No Adverse Interpretation of Other Agreements . This Indenture may not be used to interpret another indenture or loan or debt agreement of the Issuers or any Subsidiary of the Issuers, and no such indenture or loan or debt agreement may be used to interpret this Indenture.

Section 12.09. Successors . All agreements of the Issuers or any Guarantor in this Indenture and the Notes will bind its successors. All agreements of the Trustee in this Indenture will bind its successor.

Section 12.10. Duplicate Originals . The parties may sign any number of copies of this Indenture. Each signed copy shall be an original, but all of them together represent the same agreement.

Section 12.11. Separability . In case any provision in this Indenture or in the Notes is invalid, illegal or unenforceable, the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions will not in any way be affected or impaired thereby.

Section 12.12. Table of Contents and Headings . The Table of Contents, Cross-Reference Table and headings of the Articles and Sections of this Indenture have been inserted for convenience of reference only, are not to be considered a part of this Indenture and in no way modify or restrict any of the terms and provisions of this Indenture.

Section 12.13. No Liability of Directors, Officers, Employees, Incorporators, Members and Stockholders . No director, officer, employee, incorporator, member or stockholder of any Issuer or any Guarantor, as such, will have any liability for any obligations of such Issuer or such Guarantor under the Notes, any Notes Guarantee, this Indenture or the Security Documents or for any

 

131


claim based on, in respect of, or by reason of, such obligations or the creation thereof. Each Holder of Notes by accepting a Note waives and releases all such liability. The waiver and release are part of the consideration for issuance of the Notes.

[remainder of page intentionally left blank]

 

132


SIGNATURES

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Indenture to be duly executed as of the date first written above.

 

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC,
as an Issuer
By:   /s/ Mark Malcolm
  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President
TA HOLDINGS FINANCE, INC.,
as an Issuer
By:   /s/ Mark Malcolm
  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC,
as Parent and as a Guarantor
By:   /s/ Mark Malcolm
  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS I, LLC,
as a Guarantor
By:   /s/ Mark Malcolm
  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President

[Signature Page to the Indenture]


TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS II(a), LLC,
as a Guarantor
By:   /s/ Mark Malcolm
  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS II(b), LLC,
as a Guarantor
By:   /s/ Mark Malcolm
  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS USA I, LLC,
as a Guarantor
By:   /s/ Mark Malcolm
  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS USA II, LLC,
as a Guarantor
By:   /s/ Mark Malcolm
  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President

[Signature Page to the Indenture]


TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS USA III, LLC,
as a Guarantor
By:   /s/ Mark Malcolm
  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President
WILMINGTON TRUST FSB,
as Trustee and as Collateral Agent
By:   /s/ Michael G. Oller, Jr.
  Name:   Michael G. Oller, Jr.
  Title:   Assistant Vice President

[Signature Page to the Indenture]


EXHIBIT A

[FACE OF NOTE]

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC

TA HOLDINGS FINANCE, INC.

10.625% Senior Secured Note Due September 1, 2017

 

   [CUSIP]                                 
No.    $                                  

Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, a limited liability company organized under the laws of Delaware, and TA Holdings Finance, Inc., a Delaware corporation (collectively, the “ Issuers ”), for value received, promises to pay to                                          , or its registered assigns, the principal sum of                      DOLLARS ($              ) [or such other amount as indicated on the Schedule of Exchange of Notes attached hereto] 1 on September 1, 2017.

Interest Rate: 10.625% per annum.

Interest Payment Dates: September 1 and March 1 of each year, commencing March 1, 2011.

Regular Record Dates: August 15 and February 15 of each year.

Reference is hereby made to the further provisions of this Note set forth on the reverse hereof, which will for all purposes have the same effect as if set forth at this place.

 

1

To be included in any Global Note.

 

A-1


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Issuers have caused this Note to be signed manually or by facsimile by its duly authorized officers.

 

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC
By:    
  Name:  
  Title:  
TA HOLDINGS FINANCE, INC.
By:    
  Name:  
  Title:  

 

A-2


(Form of Trustee’s Certificate of Authentication)

This is one of the 10.625% Senior Secured Notes Due 2017 described in the Indenture referred to in this Note.

Date:                                         

 

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB, as Trustee
By:    
  Authorized Signatory

 

A-3


[REVERSE SIDE OF NOTE]

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC

TA HOLDINGS FINANCE, INC.

10.625% Senior Secured Note Due September 1, 2017

 

1. Principal and Interest.

The Issuers promise to pay the principal of this Note on September 1, 2017.

The Issuers promise to pay interest on the principal amount of this Note on each interest payment date, as set forth on the face of this Note, at the rate of 10.625% per annum.

Interest will be payable semiannually (to the holders of record of the Notes at the close of business on the August 15 or February 15 immediately preceding the interest payment date) on each interest payment date, commencing March 1, 2011.

Interest on this Note will accrue from the most recent date to which interest has been paid on this Note (or, if there is no existing default in the payment of interest and if this Note is authenticated between a regular record date and the next interest payment date, from such interest payment date) or, if no interest has been paid, from [the Issue Date]. 2 Interest will be computed in the basis of a 360-day year of twelve 30-day months.

The Issuers will pay interest on overdue principal, at a rate per annum that is 1% in excess of 10.625%, and pay interest on overdue interest, premium or otherwise, at a rate per annum equal to 10.625%. Interest not paid when due and any interest on principal, premium or interest not paid when due will be paid to the Persons that are Holders on a special record date, which will be the 15th day preceding the date fixed by the Issuers for the payment of such interest, whether or not such day is a Business Day. At least 15 days before a special record date, the Issuers will send to each Holder and to the Trustee a notice that sets forth the special record date, the payment date and the amount of interest to be paid.

 

2. Indentures; Notes Guarantee

 

2

For Additional Notes, should be the date of their original issue.

 

A-4


This is one of the Notes issued under an Indenture dated as of August 24, 2010 (as amended from time to time, the “ Indenture ”), among the Issuers, the Guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, as Trustee and Collateral Agent. Capitalized terms used herein are used as defined in the Indenture unless otherwise indicated. The terms of the Notes include those stated in the Indenture and those made part of the Indenture by reference to the TIA. The Notes are subject to all such terms, and Holders are referred to the Indenture and the TIA for a statement of all such terms. To the extent permitted by applicable law, in the event of any inconsistency between the terms of this Note and the terms of the Indenture, the terms of the Indenture will control.

The Notes are general secured obligations of the Issuers. The Indenture limits the original aggregate principal amount of the Notes to $430,000,000, but Additional Notes may be issued pursuant to the Indenture, and the originally issued Notes and all such Additional Notes vote together for all purposes as a single class. This Note is guaranteed, as set forth in the Indenture.

 

3. Redemption and Repurchase; Discharge Prior to Redemption or Maturity.

This Note is subject to optional redemption, and may be the subject of an Offer to Purchase, as further described in the Indenture. There is no sinking fund or mandatory redemption applicable to this Note.

If the Issuers deposit with the Trustee funds, money or U.S. Government Obligations sufficient to pay the then outstanding principal of, premium, if any, and accrued interest on the Notes to redemption or maturity, the Issuers may in certain circumstances be discharged from the Indenture and the Notes or may be discharged from certain of its obligations under certain provisions of the Indenture.

 

4. Registered Form; Denominations; Transfer; Exchange.

The Notes are in registered form without coupons in denominations of $2,000 in principal amount and any higher integral multiple of $1,000. A Holder may register the transfer or exchange of Notes in accordance with the Indenture. The Trustee may require a Holder to furnish appropriate endorsements and transfer documents and to pay any taxes and fees required by law or permitted by the Indenture. Pursuant to the Indenture, there are certain periods during which the Trustee will not be required to issue, register the transfer of or exchange any Note or certain portions of a Note.

 

5. Defaults and Remedies.

 

A-5


If an Event of Default, as defined in the Indenture, occurs and is continuing, the Trustee or the Holders of at least 25% in principal amount of the Notes may declare all the Notes to be due and payable. If a bankruptcy or insolvency default with respect to the Issuers, Parent or any Subsidiary Guarantor that owns Capital Stock, directly or indirectly, of an Issuer occurs and is continuing, the Notes become immediately due and payable. Holders may not enforce the Indenture or the Notes except as provided in the Indenture. The Trustee may require indemnity satisfactory to it in its sole discretion before it enforces the Indenture or the Notes. Subject to certain limitations, Holders of a majority in principal amount of the Notes then outstanding may direct the Trustee in its exercise of remedies.

 

6. Amendment and Waiver.

Subject to certain exceptions, the Indenture and the Notes may be amended, or default may be waived, with the consent of the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the outstanding Notes. Without notice to or the consent of any Holder, the Issuers and the Trustee may amend or supplement the Indenture or the Notes to, among other things, cure any ambiguity, defect or inconsistency or make any change that does not adversely affect the rights of any Holder in any material respect.

 

7. Authentication.

This Note is not valid until the Trustee (or Authenticating Agent) signs the certificate of authentication on the other side of this Note.

 

8. Governing Law.

This Note shall be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the laws of the State of New York without giving effect to applicable principles of conflicts of law to the extent that the application of the law of another jurisdiction would be required thereby.

 

9. Abbreviations.

Customary abbreviations may be used in the name of a Holder or an assignee, such as: TEN COM (= tenants in common), TEN ENT (= tenants by the entireties), JT TEN (= joint tenants with right of survivorship and not as tenants in common), CUST (= Custodian) and U/G/M/A/ (= Uniform Gifts to Minors Act).

The Issuers will furnish a copy of the Indenture to any Holder upon written request and without charge.

 

A-6


[FORM OF TRANSFER NOTICE]

FOR VALUE RECEIVED the undersigned registered holder hereby sell(s), assign(s) and transfer(s) unto

 

Insert Taxpayer Identification No.

 
 
Please print or typewrite name and address including zip code of assignee
 
the within Note and all rights thereunder, hereby irrevocably constituting and appointing
 
attorney to transfer said Note on the books of the Issuers with full power of substitution in the premises.

 

A-7


[THE FOLLOWING PROVISION TO BE INCLUDED ON ALL CERTIFICATES BEARING A RESTRICTED LEGEND]

In connection with any transfer of this Note occurring prior to August 24, 2011, the undersigned confirms that such transfer is made without utilizing any general solicitation or general advertising and further as follows:

Check One

¨ (1) This Note is being transferred to a “qualified institutional buyer” in compliance with Rule 144A under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended and certification in the form of Exhibit F to the Indenture is being furnished herewith.

¨ (2) This Note is being transferred to a Non-U.S. Person in compliance with the exemption from registration under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, provided by Regulation S thereunder, and certification in the form of Exhibit E to the Indenture is being furnished herewith.

or

¨ (3) This Note is being transferred other than in accordance with (1) or (2) above and documents are being furnished which comply with the conditions of transfer set forth in this Note and the Indenture.

If none of the foregoing boxes is checked, the Trustee is not obligated to register this Note in the name of any Person other than the Holder hereof unless and until the conditions to any such transfer of registration set forth herein and in the Indenture have been satisfied.

 

Date:        
     
      Seller
    By    
    NOTICE: The signature to this assignment must correspond with the name as written upon the face of the within-mentioned instrument in every particular, without alteration or any change whatsoever.

 

A-8


Signature  Guarantee: 5    
 

 

By    
To be executed by an executive officer

 

5

Signatures must be guaranteed by an “ eligible guarantor institution ” meeting the requirements of the Registrar, which requirements include membership or participation in the Securities Transfer Association Medallion Program (“ STAMP ”) or such other “ signature guarantee program ” as may be determined by the Registrar in addition to, or in substitution for, STAMP, all in accordance with the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

 

A-9


OPTION OF HOLDER TO ELECT PURCHASE

If you wish to have all of this Note purchased by the Issuers pursuant to Section 4.11 or Section 4.12 of the Indenture, check the box: 9

If you wish to have a portion of this Note purchased by the Issuers pursuant to Section 4.11 or Section 4.12 of the Indenture, state the amount (in original principal amount) below:

$                                           .

 

Date:    
Your Signature:    

(Sign exactly as your name appears on the other side of this Note)

Signature Guarantee: 1                                                               

 

1

Signatures must be guaranteed by an “ eligible guarantor institution ” meeting the requirements of the Trustee, which requirements include membership or participation in the Securities Transfer Association Medallion Program (“ STAMP ”) or such other “ signature guarantee program ” as may be determined by the Trustee in addition to, or in substitution for, STAMP, all in accordance with the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

 

A-10


SCHEDULE OF EXCHANGES OF NOTES 1

The following exchanges of a part of this Global Note for Physical Notes or a part of another Global Note have been made:

 

Date of Exchange

 

Amount of decrease
in principal amount
of this Global Note

 

Amount of increase
in principal amount
of this Global Note

   Principal amount of
this Global Note
following such
decrease
(or increase)
   Signature of
authorized officer of
Trustee
         
         
         
         
         

 

1

For Global Notes

 

A-11


EXHIBIT B

SUPPLEMENTAL INDENTURE

dated as of                      ,             

among

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC

TA HOLDINGS FINANCE, INC.

as Issuers,

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC

as Parent,

the Guarantors party hereto

and

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB,

as Trustee

 

 

10.625%

Senior Secured Notes

Due 2017


THIS SUPPLEMENTAL INDENTURE (this “ Supplemental Indenture ”), entered into as of                      ,              , among TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC, a limited liability company organized under the laws of Delaware, and TA HOLDINGS FINANCE, INC., a Delaware corporation (collectively, the “ Issuers ”), TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC (the “ Parent ”), [insert each Guarantor executing this Supplemental Indenture and its jurisdiction of incorporation] (each an “ Undersigned ”) and WILMINGTON TRUST FSB, as trustee (the “ Trustee ”).

RECITALS

WHEREAS, the Issuers, the Parent, the Guarantors party thereto and the Trustee entered into the Indenture, dated as of August 24, 2010 (the “ Indenture ”), relating to the Issuers’ 10.625% Senior Secured Notes due September 1, 2017 (the “ Notes ”);

WHEREAS, as a condition to the Trustee entering into the Indenture and the purchase of the Notes by the Holders, the Parent agreed pursuant to the Indenture to cause Domestic Subsidiaries to provide Notes Guarantees in certain circumstances.

AGREEMENT

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and mutual covenants herein contained and intending to be legally bound, the parties to this Supplemental Indenture hereby agree as follows:

Section 1. Capitalized terms used herein and not otherwise defined herein are used as defined in the Indenture.

Section 2. Each Undersigned (other than the Issuers), by its execution of this Supplemental Indenture, agrees to be a Guarantor under the Indenture and to be bound by the terms of the Indenture applicable to Guarantors, including, but not limited to, Article 11 thereof.

Section 3. This Supplemental Indenture shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of New York without giving effect to applicable principles of conflicts of law to the extent that the application of the law of another jurisdiction would be required thereby.

Section 4. This Supplemental Indenture may be signed in various counterparts which together will constitute one and the same instrument.

 

B-1


Section 5. This Supplemental Indenture is an amendment supplemental to the Indenture and the Indenture and this Supplemental Indenture will henceforth be read together.

Section 6. The Trustee makes no representations as to the validity or sufficiency of this Supplemental Indenture. The recitals and statements herein and in the Notes are deemed to be those of the Issuers and not of the Trustee, and the Trustee assumes no responsibility for the correctness thereof.

 

B-2


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Supplemental Indenture to be duly executed as of the date first above written.

 

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC
as an Issuer
By:    
  Name:  
  Title:  
TA HOLDINGS FINANCE, INC.
as an Issuer
By:    
  Name:  
  Title:  
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC
as Parent
By:    
  Name:  
  Title:  
[GUARANTOR]
By:    
  Name:  
  Title:  

 

B-3


WILMINGTON TRUST FSB
as Trustee
By:    
  Name:  
  Title:  

 

B-4


EXHIBIT C

RESTRICTED LEGEND

THIS NOTE HAS NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE “SECURITIES ACT”), AND MAY NOT BE OFFERED, SOLD, PLEDGED OR OTHERWISE TRANSFERRED EXCEPT IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE FOLLOWING SENTENCE. BY ITS ACQUISITION HEREOF OR OF A BENEFICIAL INTEREST HEREIN, THE ACQUIRER:

(1) REPRESENTS THAT:

(A) IT AND ANY ACCOUNT FOR WHICH IT IS ACTING IS A “QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER” (WITHIN THE MEANING OF RULE 144A UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT) AND THAT IT EXERCISES SOLE INVESTMENT DISCRETION WITH RESPECT TO EACH SUCH ACCOUNT,

(B) IT IS AN INSTITUTIONAL “ACCREDITED INVESTOR” (WITHIN THE MEANING OF RULE 501(a)(1), (2), (3) OR (7) UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT) (AN “INSTITUTIONAL ACCREDITED INVESTOR”),

(C) IT IS NOT A U.S. PERSON (WITHIN THE MEANING OF REGULATION S UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT), OR

(D) IT AND ANY TRANSFEREE OF A NOTE WILL BE DEEMED TO HAVE REPRESENTED BY ITS PURCHASE AND HOLDING OF THE NOTE THAT (A) ITS PURCHASE AND HOLDING OF THE NOTE IS NOT MADE ON BEHALF OF OR WITH “PLAN ASSETS” OF ANY PLAN SUBJECT TO TITLE I OF THE EMPLOYEE RETIREMENT INCOME SECURITY ACT OF 1974, AS AMENDED (“ERISA”), SECTION 4975 OF THE CODE OR ANY SIMILAR LAW OR (B) ITS PURCHASE AND HOLDING OF THE NOTE WILL NOT RESULT IN A NON-EXEMPT PROHIBITED TRANSACTION UNDER SECTION 406 OF ERISA, SECTION 4975 OF THE CODE OR ANY SIMILAR LAW, AND

(2) AGREES FOR THE BENEFIT OF THE ISSUERS THAT IT WILL NOT OFFER, SELL, PLEDGE OR OTHERWISE TRANSFER THIS NOTE OR ANY BENEFICIAL INTEREST HEREIN, EXCEPT IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE SECURITIES ACT AND ANY APPLICABLE SECURITIES LAWS OF ANY STATE OF THE UNITED STATES AND ONLY:

 

C-1


(A) TO THE ISSUERS;

(B) PURSUANT TO A REGISTRATION STATEMENT WHICH HAS BECOME EFFECTIVE UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT,

(C) TO A QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER IN COMPLIANCE WITH RULE 144A UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT,

(D) IN AN OFFSHORE TRANSACTION IN COMPLIANCE WITH RULE 904 OF REGULATION S UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT,

(E) IN A PRINCIPAL AMOUNT OF NOT LESS THAN $100,000, TO AN INSTITUTIONAL ACCREDITED INVESTOR THAT, PRIOR TO SUCH TRANSFER, DELIVERS TO THE TRUSTEE A DULY COMPLETED AND SIGNED CERTIFICATE (THE FORM OF WHICH MAY BE OBTAINED FROM THE TRUSTEE) RELATING TO THE RESTRICTIONS ON TRANSFER OF THIS NOTE, OR

(F) PURSUANT TO AN EXEMPTION FROM REGISTRATION PROVIDED BY RULE 144 UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OR ANY OTHER AVAILABLE EXEMPTION FROM THE REGISTRATION REQUIREMENTS OF THE SECURITIES ACT.

PRIOR TO THE REGISTRATION OF ANY TRANSFER IN ACCORDANCE WITH (2)(C) ABOVE OR (2)(D) ABOVE, A DULY COMPLETED AND SIGNED CERTIFICATE (THE FORM OF WHICH MAY BE OBTAINED FROM THE TRUSTEE) MUST BE DELIVERED TO THE TRUSTEE. PRIOR TO THE REGISTRATION OF ANY TRANSFER IN ACCORDANCE WITH (2)(E) OR (F) ABOVE, THE ISSUERS RESERVE THE RIGHT TO REQUIRE THE DELIVERY OF SUCH LEGAL OPINIONS, CERTIFICATIONS OR OTHER EVIDENCE AS MAY REASONABLY BE REQUIRED IN ORDER TO DETERMINE THAT THE PROPOSED TRANSFER IS BEING MADE IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE SECURITIES ACT AND APPLICABLE STATE SECURITIES LAWS. NO REPRESENTATION IS MADE AS TO THE AVAILABILITY OF ANY RULE 144 EXEMPTION FROM THE REGISTRATION REQUIREMENTS OF THE SECURITIES ACT.

 

C-2


EXHIBIT D

DTC LEGEND

UNLESS THIS CERTIFICATE IS PRESENTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF THE DEPOSITORY TRUST COMPANY, A NEW YORK CORPORATION (“ DTC ”), TO THE ISSUERS OR THEIR AGENT FOR REGISTRATION OF TRANSFER, EXCHANGE OR PAYMENT, AND ANY CERTIFICATE ISSUED IS REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF CEDE & CO. OR IN SUCH OTHER NAME AS IS REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC (AND ANY PAYMENT IS MADE TO CEDE & CO. OR TO SUCH OTHER ENTITY AS IS REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC), ANY TRANSFER, PLEDGE OR OTHER USE HEREOF FOR VALUE OR OTHERWISE BY OR TO ANY PERSON IS WRONGFUL INASMUCH AS THE REGISTERED OWNER HEREOF, CEDE & CO., HAS A BENEFICIAL INTEREST HEREIN.

TRANSFERS OF THIS GLOBAL NOTE ARE LIMITED TO TRANSFERS IN WHOLE, BUT NOT IN PART, TO NOMINEES OF CEDE & CO. OR TO A SUCCESSOR THEREOF OR SUCH SUCCESSOR’S NOMINEE AND TRANSFERS OF PORTIONS OF THIS GLOBAL NOTE ARE LIMITED TO TRANSFERS MADE IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE TRANSFER PROVISIONS OF THE INDENTURE.

 

D-1


EXHIBIT E

OID LEGEND

FOR PURPOSES OF SECTIONS 1272, 1273 AND 1275 OF THE INTERNAL REVENUE CODE OF 1986, AS AMENDED, THIS NOTE IS BEING ISSUED WITH ORIGINAL ISSUE DISCOUNT AND THE ISSUE DATE OF THIS SECURITY IS AUGUST 24, 2010. A HOLDER MAY OBTAIN THE ISSUE PRICE, THE AMOUNT OF ORIGINAL ISSUE DISCOUNT, THE ISSUE DATE AND THE YIELD TO MATURITY FOR THESE NOTES BY SUBMITTING A WRITTEN REQUEST FOR SUCH INFORMATION TO TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC, 17672 LAUREL PARK DRIVE NORTH, SUITE 400E, LIVONIA, MICHIGAN 48152, ATTENTION: JAMES GOUIN, CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER.

 

E-1


EXHIBIT F

Regulation S Certificate

                     ,             

Wilmington Trust FSB, as Trustee and Registrar

1100 North Market Street

Rodney Square North

Wilmington, Delaware 19890

Attention: Corporate Capital Markets

Facsimile: (302) 636-4145

 

  Re: Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC
     TA Holdings Finance, Inc.
     10.625% Senior Secured Notes due 2017 (the “ Notes ”)
     Issued under the Indenture (the “ Indenture ”) dated as
     as of August 24, 2010 relating to the Notes

Ladies and Gentlemen:

Terms are used in this Certificate as used in Regulation S (“Regulation S”) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), except as otherwise stated herein.

[CHECK A OR B AS APPLICABLE.]

 

  ¨  A. This Certificate relates to our proposed transfer of $              principal amount of Notes issued under the Indenture. We hereby certify as follows:

 

  1. The offer and sale of the Notes was not and will not be made to a person in the United States (unless such person is excluded from the definition of “U.S. person” pursuant to Rule 902(k)(2)(vi) or the account held by it for which it is acting is excluded from the definition of “U.S. person” pursuant to Rule 902(k)(2)(i) under the circumstances described in Rule 902(h)(3)) and such offer and sale was not and will not be specifically targeted at an identifiable group of U.S. citizens abroad.

 

  2.

Unless the circumstances described in the parenthetical in paragraph 1 above are applicable, either (a) at the time the

 

F-1


 

buy order was originated, the buyer was outside the United States or we and any person acting on our behalf reasonably believed that the buyer was outside the United States or (b) the transaction was executed in, on or through the facilities of a designated offshore securities market, and neither we nor any person acting on our behalf knows that the transaction was pre-arranged with a buyer in the United States.

 

  3. Neither we, any of our affiliates, nor any person acting on our or their behalf has made any directed selling efforts in the United States with respect to the Notes.

 

  4. The proposed transfer of Notes is not part of a plan or scheme to evade the registration requirements of the Securities Act.

 

  5. If we are a dealer or a person receiving a selling concession, fee or other remuneration in respect of the Notes, and the proposed transfer takes place during the Restricted Period (as defined in the Indenture), or we are an officer or director of the Issuers or an Initial Purchaser (as defined in the Indenture), we certify that the proposed transfer is being made in accordance with the provisions of Rule 904(b) of Regulation S.

 

  ¨  B. This Certificate relates to our proposed exchange of $              principal amount of Notes issued under the Indenture for an equal principal amount of Notes to be held by us. We hereby certify as follows:

 

  1. At the time the offer and sale of the Notes was made to us, either (i) we were not in the United States or (ii) we were excluded from the definition of “U.S. person” pursuant to Rule 902(k)(2)(vi) or the account held by us for which we were acting was excluded from the definition of “U.S. person” pursuant to Rule 902(k)(2)(i) under the circumstances described in Rule 902(h)(3); and we were not a member of an identifiable group of U.S. citizens abroad.

 

  2.

Unless the circumstances described in paragraph 1(ii) above are applicable, either (a) at the time our buy order was originated, we were outside the United States or (b) the transaction was executed in, on or through the facilities of a

 

F-2


 

designated offshore securities market and we did not pre-arrange the transaction in the United States.

 

  3. The proposed exchange of Notes is not part of a plan or scheme to evade the registration requirements of the Securities Act.

 

F-3


You and the Issuers are entitled to rely upon this Certificate and are irrevocably authorized to produce this Certificate or a copy hereof to any interested party in any administrative or legal proceeding or official inquiry with respect to the matters covered hereby.

 

Very truly yours,
[NAME OF SELLER (FOR TRANSFERS)
    OR OWNER (FOR EXCHANGES)]
By:    
  Name:
  Title:
  Address:

Date:                     

 

F-4


EXHIBIT G

Rule 144A Certificate

                     ,             

Wilmington Trust FSB, as Trustee and Registrar

1100 North Market Street

Rodney Square North

Wilmington, Delaware 19890

Attention: Corporate Capital Markets

Facsimile: (302) 636-4145

 

  Re: Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC
     TA Holdings Finance, Inc.
     10.625% Senior Secured Notes due 2017 (the “ Notes ”)
     Issued under the Indenture (the “ Indenture ”) dated as
     as of August 24, 2010 relating to the Notes

Ladies and Gentlemen:

TO BE COMPLETED BY PURCHASER IF (1) ABOVE IS CHECKED.

This Certificate relates to:

[CHECK A OR B AS APPLICABLE.]

 

  ¨  A. Our proposed purchase of $              principal amount of Notes issued under the Indenture.

 

  ¨  B. Our proposed exchange of $              principal amount of Notes issued under the Indenture for an equal principal amount of Notes to be held by us.

We and, if applicable, each account for which we are acting in the aggregate owned and invested more than $100,000,000 in securities of issuers that are not affiliated with us (or such accounts, if applicable), as of                      , 200    , which is a date on or since close of our most recent fiscal year. We and, if applicable, each account for which we are acting, are a qualified institutional buyer within the meaning of Rule 144A (“Rule 144A”) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”). If we are acting on behalf of an account, we exercise sole investment discretion with respect to such account. We are aware that the transfer of Notes to us, or such exchange, as applicable, is being

 

G-1


made in reliance upon the exemption from the provisions of Section 5 of the Securities Act provided by Rule 144A. Prior to the date of this Certificate we have received such information regarding the Issuers as we have requested pursuant to Rule 144A(d)(4) or have determined not to request such information.

You and the Issuers are entitled to rely upon this Certificate and are irrevocably authorized to produce this Certificate or a copy hereof to any interested party in any administrative or legal proceeding or official inquiry with respect to the matters covered hereby.

 

Very truly yours,
[NAME OF PURCHASER (FOR TRANSFERS)
    OR OWNER (FOR EXCHANGES)]
By:    
  Name:
  Title:
  Address:

Date:                                         

 

G-2


EXHIBIT H

Institutional Accredited Investor Certificate

Wilmington Trust FSB, as Trustee and Registrar

1100 North Market Street

Rodney Square North

Wilmington, Delaware 19890

Attention: Corporate Capital Markets

Facsimile: (302) 636-4145

 

  Re: Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC
     TA Holdings Finance, Inc.
     10.625% Senior Secured Notes due 2017 (the “ Notes ”)
     Issued under the Indenture (the “ Indenture ”) dated as
     as of August 24, 2010 relating to the Notes

Ladies and Gentlemen:

This Certificate relates to:

[CHECK A OR B AS APPLICABLE.]

 

  ¨  A. Our proposed purchase of $              principal amount of Notes issued under the Indenture.

 

  ¨  B. Our proposed exchange of $              principal amount of Notes issued under the Indenture for an equal principal amount of Notes to be held by us.

We hereby confirm that:

 

  1. We are an institutional “accredited investor” within the meaning of Rule 501(a)(1), (2), (3) or (7) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”) (an “Institutional Accredited Investor”).

 

  2. Any acquisition of Notes by us will be for our own account or for the account of one or more other Institutional Accredited Investors as to which we exercise sole investment discretion.

 

  3.

We have such knowledge and experience in financial and business matters that we are capable of evaluating the merits and risks of an investment in the Notes and we and any accounts for which we are

 

H-1


 

acting are able to bear the economic risks of and an entire loss of our or their investment in the Notes.

 

  4. We are not acquiring the Notes with a view to any distribution thereof in a transaction that would violate the Securities Act or the securities laws of any State of the United States or any other applicable jurisdiction; provided that the disposition of our property and the property of any accounts for which we are acting as fiduciary will remain at all times within our and their control.

 

  5. We acknowledge that the Notes have not been registered under the Securities Act and that the Notes may not be offered or sold within the United States or to or for the benefit of U.S. persons except as set forth below.

 

  6. The principal amount of Notes to which this Certificate relates is at least equal to $100,000.

We agree for the benefit of the Issuers, on our own behalf and on behalf of each account for which we are acting, that such Notes may be offered, sold, pledged or otherwise transferred only in accordance with the Securities Act and any applicable securities laws of any State of the United States and only (a) to the Issuers, (b) pursuant to a registration statement which has become effective under the Securities Act, (c) to a qualified institutional buyer in compliance with Rule 144A under the Securities Act, (d) in an offshore transaction in compliance with Rule 904 of Regulation S under the Securities Act, (e) in a principal amount of not less than $100,000, to an Institutional Accredited Investor that, prior to such transfer, delivers to the Trustee a duly completed and signed certificate (the form of which may be obtained from the Trustee) relating to the restrictions on transfer of the Notes or (f) pursuant to an exemption from registration provided by Rule 144 under the Securities Act or any other available exemption from the registration requirements of the Securities Act.

Prior to the registration of any transfer in accordance with (c) or (d) above, we acknowledge that a duly completed and signed certificate (the form of which may be obtained from the Trustee) must be delivered to the Trustee. Prior to the registration of any transfer in accordance with (e) or (f) above, we acknowledge that the Issuers reserves the right to require the delivery of such legal opinions, certifications or other evidence as may reasonably be required in order to determine that the proposed transfer is being made in compliance with the Securities Act and applicable state securities laws. We acknowledge that no representation is made as to the availability of any Rule 144 exemption from the registration requirements of the Securities Act.

 

H-2


We understand that the Trustee will not be required to accept for registration of transfer any Notes acquired by us, except upon presentation of evidence satisfactory to the Issuers and the Trustee that the foregoing restrictions on transfer have been complied with. We further understand that the Notes acquired by us will be in the form of definitive physical certificates and that such certificates will bear a legend reflecting the substance of the preceding paragraph. We further agree to provide to any person acquiring any of the Notes from us a notice advising such person that resales of the Notes are restricted as stated herein and that certificates representing the Notes will bear a legend to that effect.

We agree to notify you promptly in writing if any of our acknowledgments, representations or agreements herein ceases to be accurate and complete.

We represent to you that we have full power to make the foregoing acknowledgments, representations and agreements on our own behalf and on behalf of any account for which we are acting.

You and the Issuers are entitled to rely upon this Certificate and are irrevocably authorized to produce this Certificate or a copy hereof to any interested party in any administrative or legal proceeding or official inquiry with respect to the matters covered hereby.

 

Very truly yours,

[NAME OF PURCHASER (FOR TRANSFERS) OR OWNER (FOR EXCHANGES)]

By:    
  Name:
  Title:
  Address:

Date:                                         

 

H-3


Upon transfer, the Notes would be registered in the name of the new beneficial owner as follows:

 

By:    
Date:    
Taxpayer ID number:    

 

H-4


EXHIBIT I

[COMPLETE FORM I OR FORM II AS APPLICABLE.]

[FORM I]

Certificate of Beneficial Ownership

 

To: Wilmington Trust FSB, as Trustee and Registrar
   1100 North Market Street
   Rodney Square North
   Wilmington, Delaware 19890
   Attention: Corporate Capital Markets
   Facsimile: (302) 636-4145 OR

 

   [Name of DTC Participant]]

 

  Re: Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC
     TA Holdings Finance, Inc.
     10.625% Senior Secured Notes due 2017 (the “ Notes ”)
     Issued under the Indenture (the “ Indenture ”) dated as
     as of August 24, 2010 relating to the Notes

Ladies and Gentlemen:

We are the beneficial owner of $              principal amount of Notes issued under the Indenture and represented by a Temporary Offshore Global Note (as defined in the Indenture).

We hereby certify as follows:

[CHECK A OR B AS APPLICABLE.]

 

  ¨  A. We are a non-U.S. person (within the meaning of Regulation S under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended).

 

  ¨  B. We are a U.S. person (within the meaning of Regulation S under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended) that purchased the Notes in a transaction that did not require registration under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

You and the Issuers are entitled to rely upon this Certificate and are irrevocably authorized to produce this Certificate or a copy hereof to any interested party in any administrative or legal proceeding or official inquiry with respect to the matters covered hereby.

 

I-1


Very truly yours,
[NAME OF BENEFICIAL OWNER]
By:    
  Name:
  Title:
  Address:

Date:                                         

[FORM II]

Certificate of Beneficial Ownership

 

To: Wilmington Trust FSB, as Trustee and Registrar
   1100 North Market Street
   Rodney Square North
   Wilmington, Delaware 19890
   Attention: Corporate Capital Markets
   Facsimile: (302) 636-4145

 

Re: Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC
   TA Holdings Finance, Inc.
   10.625% Senior Secured Notes due 2017 (the “ Notes ”)
   Issued under the Indenture (the “ Indenture ”) dated as
   as of August 24, 2010 relating to the Notes

Ladies and Gentlemen:

This is to certify that based solely on certifications we have received in writing, by tested telex or by electronic transmission from Institutions appearing in our records as persons being entitled to a portion of the principal amount of Notes represented by a Temporary Offshore Global Note issued under the above-referenced Indenture, that as of the date hereof, $              principal amount of Notes represented by the Temporary Offshore Global Note being submitted herewith for exchange is beneficially owned by persons that are either (i) non-U.S. persons (within the meaning of Regulation S under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended) or (ii) U.S. persons that purchased the Notes in a transaction that did not require registration under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

 

I-2


We further certify that (i) we are not submitting herewith for exchange any portion of such Temporary Offshore Global Note excepted in such certifications and (ii) as of the date hereof we have not received any notification from any Institution to the effect that the statements made by such Institution with respect to any portion of such Temporary Offshore Global Note submitted herewith for exchange are no longer true and cannot be relied upon as of the date hereof.

You and the Issuers are entitled to rely upon this Certificate and are irrevocably authorized to produce this Certificate or a copy hereof to any interested party in any administrative or legal proceeding or official inquiry with respect to the matters covered hereby.

 

Yours faithfully,
[Name of DTC Participant]
By:    
  Name:
  Title:
  Address:

Date:                                         

 

I-3


EXHIBIT J

THIS NOTE IS A TEMPORARY GLOBAL NOTE. PRIOR TO THE EXPIRATION OF THE RESTRICTED PERIOD APPLICABLE HERETO, BENEFICIAL INTERESTS HEREIN MAY NOT BE HELD BY ANY PERSON OTHER THAN (1) A NON-U.S. PERSON OR (2) A U.S. PERSON THAT PURCHASED SUCH INTEREST IN A TRANSACTION EXEMPT FROM REGISTRATION UNDER THE U.S. SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE “ SECURITIES ACT ”). BENEFICIAL INTERESTS HEREIN ARE NOT EXCHANGEABLE FOR PHYSICAL NOTES OTHER THAN A PERMANENT GLOBAL NOTE IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE TERMS OF THE INDENTURE. TERMS IN THIS LEGEND ARE USED AS USED IN REGULATION S UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT.

NO BENEFICIAL OWNERS OF THIS TEMPORARY GLOBAL NOTE SHALL BE ENTITLED TO RECEIVE PAYMENT OF PRINCIPAL OR INTEREST HEREON UNTIL SUCH BENEFICIAL INTEREST IS EXCHANGED OR TRANSFERRED FOR AN INTEREST IN ANOTHER NOTE

 

J-1

Exhibit 10.3

EXECUTION COPY

AMENDMENT NO. 2 TO REVOLVING CREDIT AND GUARANTY

AGREEMENT

AMENDMENT NO. 2 (this “ Amendment ”) dated as of August 4, 2010 to the Revolving Credit and Guaranty Agreement dated as of July 31, 2007 (as heretofore amended, the “ Credit Agreement ”), among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the Guarantors from time to time party thereto, the Lenders from time to time party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent for the Lenders (the “ Agent ”).

WHEREAS, the parties hereto wish to amend the Credit Agreement on the terms and subject to the conditions set forth below.

NOW THEREFORE, the parties hereto agree as follows:

Section 1 . Defined Terms; References. Unless otherwise specifically defined herein, each term used herein that is defined in the Credit Agreement has the meaning assigned to such term in the Credit Agreement. Each reference to “hereof”, “hereunder”, “herein” and “hereby” and each other similar reference and each reference to “this Agreement” and each other similar reference contained in the Credit Agreement shall, after this Amendment becomes effective, refer to the Credit Agreement as amended hereby.

Section 2 . Amendments. The Credit Agreement is hereby amended as follows:

(a) Section 1.01 of the Credit Agreement is amended by adding the following terms in proper alphabetical order:

Secured Notes Documents ” shall mean, collectively, the Secured Notes Indenture and all documents granting or purporting to grant any security interests to secure the Secured Notes or to provide for any Guarantee thereof.

Secured Notes Indenture ” shall mean the indenture pursuant to which the Secured Notes are to be issued.

Secured Notes ” shall mean the Indebtedness contemplated by clause (i) of Section 6.03(q).

(b) The definition of “Change of Control” in Section 1.01 of the Credit Agreement is amended by replacing the parenthetical at the end of clause (d) of the definition with the following parenthetical:


“(other than Liens created by the Loan Documents, the First Lien Term Loan Documents, the Secured Notes Documents or the documents governing any Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred pursuant to clause (ii) or clause (iii) of Section 6.03(b) or clause (ii) of Section 6.03(q))”

(c) The parenthetical appearing in clause (x) of the last paragraph of the definition of “Consolidated EBITDA” in Section 1.01 of the Credit Agreement is amended and restated to read in its entirety as follows:

“(other than (i) the Loan Documents, (ii) the First Lien Term Facility Loan Documents, (iii) the Secured Notes Documents and (iv) the documents governing any Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred pursuant to clause (ii) or clause (iii) of Section 6.03(b) or clause (ii) of Section 6.03(q); provided that (x) any such restrictions imposed by the Secured Notes Documents are customary for issuances of high yield securities and (y) any such restrictions imposed by the documents referred to in the preceding clause (iv) are prohibitions customarily contained in such type of Indebtedness at the time such Indebtedness is incurred, in the case of each of clauses (x) and (y) as determined in good faith by a Financial Officer of Holdco)”.

(d) The parenthetical appearing in clause (c) of the definition of “Consolidated Net Income” in Section 1.01 of the Credit Agreement is amended and restated to read in its entirety as follows:

“(other than (i) the Loan Documents, (ii) the First Lien Term Facility Loan Documents, (iii) the Secured Notes Documents and (iv) the documents governing any Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred pursuant to clause (ii) or clause (iii) of Section 6.03(b) or clause (ii) of Section 6.03(q); provided that (x) any such prohibitions imposed by the Secured Notes Documents are customary for issuances of high yield securities and (y) any such prohibitions imposed by the documents referred to in the preceding clause (iv) are prohibitions customarily contained in such type of Indebtedness at the time such Indebtedness is incurred, in the case of each of clauses (x) and (y) as determined in good faith by a Financial Officer of Holdco)”.

(e) The parenthetical appearing in clause (y) of the definition of “Net Global Availability” in Section 1.01 of the Credit Agreement is amended and restated to read in its entirety as follows:

“(other than any restriction on such cash imposed by (i) the Loan Documents, (ii) the First Lien Term Facility Loan Documents, (iii) the Secured Notes Documents or (iv) the documents governing any Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred pursuant to clause (ii) or clause (iii) of Section 6.03(b) or clause (ii) of Section 6.03(q); provided that (x) any such prohibitions imposed by the Secured Notes Documents are customary for issuances of high yield securities and (y) any such prohibitions imposed by the documents referred to in the preceding clause (iv) are prohibitions customarily contained in such type of

 

2


Indebtedness at the time such Indebtedness is incurred, in the case of each of clauses (x) and (y) as determined in good faith by a Financial Officer of Holdco)”

(f) The definition of “Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness” in Section 1.01 of the Credit Agreement is amended by inserting “(collectively, to “ Refinance ”)” immediately following the words “to refinance, refund, extend, renew or replace” in the third line and by inserting “(a)” immediately following the words “provided that” in the fourth line.

(g) The definition of “Unrestricted Cash” in Section 1.01 of the Credit Agreement is amended and restated to read in its entirety as follows:

Unrestricted Cash ” shall mean all cash and Permitted Investments of the Holdco Group that are not subject to any Liens or other restrictions on disposition except pursuant to (i) the Loan Documents, (ii) the First Lien Term Facility Loan Documents, (iii) the Secured Notes Documents or (iv) the documents governing any Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred pursuant to clause (ii) or clause (iii) of Section 6.03(b) or clause (ii) of Section 6.03(q); provided that (x) any such prohibitions imposed by the Secured Notes Documents are customary for issuances of high yield securities and (y) any such prohibitions imposed by the documents referred to in the preceding clause (iv) are prohibitions customarily contained in such type of Indebtedness at the time such Indebtedness is incurred, in the case of each of clauses (x) and (y) as determined in good faith by a Financial Officer of Holdco.

(h) Section 3.06 of the Credit Agreement is amended by inserting “or the Term Loan Documents” immediately following “Loan Documents” at the end thereof.

(i) Section 3.17 of the Credit Agreement is amended by deleting “the Term Loan Documents” at the end of clause (b) and replacing it with “(x) the Term Loan Documents, (y) the Secured Note Documents and (z) the documents governing any Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred pursuant to clause (ii) or clause (iii) of Section 6.03(b) or clause (ii) of Section 6.03(q), in each case to the extent such Indebtedness and Liens are permitted hereunder”.

(j) Section 6.01 of the Credit Agreement is amended by:

(i) deleting “and” at the end of clause (k);

(ii) deleting “.” at the end of clause (l) and replacing it with “; and”; and

(iii) inserting a new clause (m), as follows:

“(m) Liens on the Collateral securing Indebtedness permitted under clause (ii) or clause (iii) of Section 6.03(b) or under

 

3


Section 6.03(q); provided , that pursuant to the Intercreditor Agreement, such Liens shall have the same priority with respect to the Collateral as the Liens securing the obligations under the First Lien Term Facility Loan Documents.”

(k) Section 6.03(b) of the Credit Agreement is amended and restated to read in its entirety as follows:

“(b) (i) Indebtedness under the Loan Documents and the First Lien Term Facility Loan Documents, (ii) Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness (other than under the Secured Notes Documents) incurred to Refinance Indebtedness under the First Lien Term Facility Loan Documents and (iii) Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred to Refinance Indebtedness incurred pursuant to clause (ii) or this clause (iii);”

(l) Section 6.03 of the Credit Agreement is further amended by:

(i) deleting “and” at the end of clause (o);

(ii) deleting “.” at the end of clause (p) and replacing it with “; and”; and

(iii) inserting a new clause (q), as follows:

“(q) (i) Indebtedness incurred on a single date pursuant to an issuance of high yield notes, provided , that (x) the proceeds thereof shall have been used simultaneously with the receipt thereof to Refinance the First Lien Term Loans and to pay any premiums or penalties and accrued and unpaid interest thereon and reasonable fees and expenses related thereto and (y) such Indebtedness constitutes Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness in respect of the First Lien Term Loans (determined without regard to clause (a) of the definition thereof); provided further , that solely to the extent that the First Lien Term Loans shall have been Refinanced in full in accordance with the preceding proviso, the proceeds of such Indebtedness in excess of the amounts required to effect such Refinancing in full of the First Lien Term Loans shall have been used simultaneously with the receipt thereof to prepay Revolving Credit Loans (without any corresponding reduction in the Revolving Credit Commitments) and for no other purpose, so long as such Indebtedness constitutes Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness in respect of the Revolving Credit Loans (determined without regard to clause (a) of the definition thereof) and (ii) Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred to Refinance Indebtedness permitted pursuant to clause (i) or this clause (ii).”

 

4


(m) Section 6.07(b) of the Credit Agreement is amended by deleting “by law or by any Loan Document” at the end of clause (A) of the proviso thereto and replacing it with “(i) by law, (ii) by any Loan Document, any First Lien Term Facility Loan Document or any Secured Notes Document, or (iii) by the documents governing any Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred pursuant to clause (ii) or clause (iii) of Section 6.03(b) or clause (ii) of Section 6.03(q); provided that (x) any such restrictions or conditions imposed by the Secured Notes Documents are customary restrictions and conditions for issuances of high yield securities and (y) any such restrictions and conditions imposed by the documents governing any such Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness are not more restrictive than the restrictions and conditions contained in the applicable Refinanced Indebtedness, in the case of each of clauses (x) and (y) as determined in good faith by a Financial Officer of Holdco”.

Section 3 . Intercreditor Agreement; Security Documents. The Required Lenders hereby authorize the Agent to enter into amendments to the Intercreditor Agreement and the other Security Documents (which may take the form of an amendment and restatement of any such agreements) (i) to provide for the issuance of the Secured Notes and the granting and perfection of the Liens securing the Secured Notes as contemplated by this Amendment, including without limitation, the lien priorities required by Section 2(j)(iii) of this Amendment, (ii) to cause the Intercreditor Agreement to accommodate the refinancing of certain indebtedness to the extent such refinancing is otherwise permitted under the Credit Agreement, (iii) to increase the cap on ABL Secured Obligations (as defined in the Intercreditor Agreement) that is imposed by the Intercreditor Agreement from $275 million to $300 million (or, if greater, an amount based on a percentage of receivables and inventory), it being understood that such change does not increase the amount of such obligations that the Credit Agreement permits the Loan Parties to incur, (iv) to eliminate provisions that are no longer applicable as a result of the previous prepayment in full of the obligations under the Second Lien Term Facility Loan Documents and (v) to make such other modifications as are necessary or desirable in the reasonable judgment of the Agent; provided , that no such amendments described in the preceding clauses (i) through (v) shall alter the priority of Liens securing the Secured Obligations or otherwise have any adverse effect on such Liens.

Section 4 . Representations of Borrower. The Borrower represents and warrants that (i) the representations and warranties of the Loan Parties set forth in Article 3 of the Credit Agreement will be true and correct in all material respects on and as of the Amendment Effective Date (as defined below); provided , that any representation and warranty that is qualified as to “materiality” “Material Adverse Effect” or similar language will be true and correct in all respects on and as of the Amendment Effective Date and (ii) no Default will have occurred and be continuing on such date.

Section 5 . Governing Law. This Amendment shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of New York.

 

5


Section 6 . Counterparts. This Amendment may be signed in any number of counterparts, each of which shall be an original, with the same effect as if the signatures thereto and hereto were upon the same instrument.

Section 7. Effectiveness . This Amendment shall become effective on the date (the “ Amendment Effective Date ”) on which each of the following conditions have been met:

(a) the Agent shall have received from the Borrower and Lenders constituting the Required Lenders a counterpart hereof signed by such party or facsimile or other written confirmation (in form satisfactory to the Agent) that such party has signed a counterpart hereof;

(b) the Agent shall have received payment from the Borrower, for the account of each Lender that has delivered an executed counterpart of this Amendment on or prior to such date, of a consent fee in an amount equal to 0.25% of such Lender’s Revolving Credit Commitment; and

(c) the Agent shall have received payment from the Borrower of all fees and expenses due to JPMCB or JPMorgan for its services in arranging this Amendment that are payable pursuant to the engagement letter relating to this Amendment dated as of July 27, 2010, and all out of pocket expenses required to be reimbursed pursuant to Section 10.05(a)(i) of the Credit Agreement.

[signature pages follow]

 

6


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Amendment to be duly executed as of the date first above written.

 

BORROWER:
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC
By:  

/s/ James C. Gouin

  Name:   James C. Gouin
  Title:   Chief Financial Officer and Vice President
GUARANTORS:
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC
By:  

/s/ James C. Gouin

  Name:   James C. Gouin
  Title:   Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS I, LLC
By:  

/s/ James C. Gouin

  Name:   James C. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS II(a), LLC
By:  

/s/ James C. Gouin

  Name:   James C. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President


TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS II(b), LLC
By:  

/s/ James C. Gouin

  Name:   James C. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS USA I, LLC
By:  

/s/ James C. Gouin

  Name:   James C. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS USA II, LLC
By:  

/s/ James C. Gouin

  Name:   James C. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS USA III, LLC
By:  

/s/ James C. Gouin

  Name:   James C. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President


JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as a Lender
By:  

/s/ Richard W. Duker

  Name:   Richard W. Duker
  Title:   Managing Director
State of California Public Employees’ Retirement System (“CalPERS”), as a Lender
By:  

/s/ [Illegible signature]

  Name:   [Illegible]
  Title:   [Illegible]
BANK OF AMERICA, N.A., as a Lender
By:  

/s/ Kindra M. Mullarky

  Name:   Kindra M. Mullarky
  Title:   Assistant Vice President
Wells Fargo Capital Finance, LLC, as a Lender
By:  

/s/ Rohan Damani

  Name:   Rohan Damani
  Title:   Vice President
Allied Irish Banks, plc, as a Lender
By:  

/s/ Martin Chin

  Name:   Martin Chin
  Title:   Senior Vice President
By:  

/s/ Brent Philips

  Name:   Brent Philips
  Title:   Vice President


General Electric Capital Corporation, as a Lender
By:  

/s/ Paul Sleet

  Name:   Paul Sleet
  Title:   Duly Authorized Signatory
GE Business Financial Services Inc. (formerly known as Merrill Lynch Business Financial Services Inc.), as a Lender
By:  

/s/ Paul Sleet

  Name:   Paul Sleet
  Title:   Duly Authorized Signatory

Exhibit 10.8

Execution Copy

CONSENT AND AMENDMENT NO. 4 TO FIRST LIEN TERM LOAN

AND GUARANTY AGREEMENT

AMENDMENT NO. 4 (this “ Amendment ”) dated as of August 24, 2010 to the First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement dated as of July 31, 2007 (as heretofore amended, the “ Loan Agreement ”), among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings Europe B.V., the Guarantors from time to time party thereto, the Lenders from time to time party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent for the Lenders (the “ Agent ”).

WHEREAS, the parties hereto wish to amend the Loan Agreement on the terms and subject to the conditions set forth below.

NOW THEREFORE, the parties hereto agree as follows:

Section 1 . Defined Terms; References. Unless otherwise specifically defined herein, each term used herein that is defined in the Loan Agreement has the meaning assigned to such term in the Loan Agreement. Each reference to “hereof”, “hereunder”, “herein” and “hereby” and each other similar reference and each reference to “this Agreement” and each other similar reference contained in the Loan Agreement shall, after this Amendment becomes effective, refer to the Loan Agreement as amended hereby.

Section 2 . Amendments. The Loan Agreement is hereby amended as follows:

(a) Section 1.01 of the Loan Agreement is amended by adding the following terms in proper alphabetical order:

Secured Notes Documents ” shall mean, collectively, the Secured Notes Indenture and all documents granting or purporting to grant any security interests to secure the Secured Notes or to provide for any Guarantee thereof.

Secured Notes Indenture ” shall mean the indenture pursuant to which the Secured Notes are to be issued.

Secured Notes ” shall mean the Indebtedness contemplated by clause (i) of Section 6.03(r).

(b) The definition of “Change of Control” in Section 1.01 of the Loan Agreement is amended by replacing the parenthetical at the end of clause (d) of the definition with the following parenthetical:


“(other than Liens created by the Loan Documents, the Revolving Credit Facility Loan Documents, the Secured Notes Documents or the documents governing any Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred pursuant to clause (ii) or clause (iii) of Section 6.03(b) or clause (ii) of Section 6.03(r))”

(c) The parenthetical appearing in clause (x) of the last paragraph of the definition of “Consolidated EBITDA” in Section 1.01 of the Loan Agreement is amended and restated to read in its entirety as follows:

“(other than (i) the Loan Documents, (ii) the Revolving Credit Facility Loan Documents, (iii) the Secured Notes Documents and (iv) the documents governing any Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred pursuant to clause (ii) or clause (iii) of Section 6.03(b) or clause (ii) of Section 6.03(r); provided that (x) any such restrictions imposed by the Secured Notes Documents are customary for issuances of high yield securities and (y) any such restrictions imposed by the documents referred to in the preceding clause (iv) are prohibitions customarily contained in such type of Indebtedness at the time such Indebtedness is incurred, in the case of each of clauses (x) and (y) as determined in good faith by a Financial Officer of Holdco)”.

(d) The parenthetical appearing in clause (c) of the definition of “Consolidated Net Income” in Section 1.01 of the Loan Agreement is amended and restated to read in its entirety as follows:

“(other than (i) the Loan Documents, (ii) the Revolving Credit Facility Loan Documents, (iii) the Secured Notes Documents and (iv) the documents governing any Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred pursuant to clause (ii) or clause (iii) of Section 6.03(b) or clause (ii) of Section 6.03(r); provided that (x) any such prohibitions imposed by the Secured Notes Documents are customary for issuances of high yield securities and (y) any such prohibitions imposed by the documents referred to in the preceding clause (iv) are prohibitions customarily contained in such type of Indebtedness at the time such Indebtedness is incurred, in the case of each of clauses (x) and (y) as determined in good faith by a Financial Officer of Holdco)”.

(e) The definition of “Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness” in Section 1.01 of the Loan Agreement is amended by inserting “(collectively, to “ Refinance ”)” immediately following the words “to refinance, refund, extend, renew or replace” in the third line and by inserting “(a)” immediately following the words “ provided that” in the fourth line.

(f) The definition of “Unrestricted Cash” in Section 1.01 of the Loan Agreement is amended and restated to read in its entirety as follows:

 

2


Unrestricted Cash ” shall mean all cash and Permitted Investments of the Holdco Group that are not subject to any Liens or other restrictions on disposition except pursuant to (i) the Loan Documents, (ii) the Revolving Credit Facility Loan Documents, (iii) the Secured Notes Documents or (iv) the documents governing any Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred pursuant to clause (ii) or clause (iii) of Section 6.03(b) or clause (ii) of Section 6.03(r); provided that (x) any such prohibitions imposed by the Secured Notes Documents are customary for issuances of high yield securities and (y) any such prohibitions imposed by the documents referred to in the preceding clause (iv) are prohibitions customarily contained in such type of Indebtedness at the time such Indebtedness is incurred, in the case of each of clauses (x) and (y) as determined in good faith by a Financial Officer of Holdco.

(g) Section 1.01 of the Loan Agreement is further amended by deleting the definitions of “Additional US Loan Commitment”, “Incremental US Loans” and “US Loan Increase”.

(h) Section 2.28 of the Loan Agreement is amended and restated to read “[Reserved]”.

(i) Section 3.06 of the Loan Agreement is amended by inserting “or the Other Loan Documents” immediately following “Loan Documents” at the end thereof.

(j) Section 3.17 of the Loan Agreement is amended by deleting “the Revolving Credit Facility Loan Documents” at the end of clause (b) and replacing it with “(x) the Revolving Credit Facility Loan Documents, (y) the Secured Note Documents and (z) the documents governing any Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred pursuant to clause (ii) or clause (iii) of Section 6.03(b) or clause (ii) of Section 6.03(r), in each case to the extent such Indebtedness and Liens are permitted hereunder”.

(k) Section 6.01 of the Loan Agreement is amended by:

(i) deleting “and” at the end of clause (k);

(ii) deleting “.” at the end of clause (l) and replacing it with “; and”; and

(iii) inserting a new clause (m), as follows:

“(m) Liens on the Collateral securing Indebtedness permitted under clause (ii) or clause (iii) of Section 6.03(b) or under Section 6.03(r); provided , that pursuant to the Intercreditor Agreement, such Liens shall have the same priority with respect to

 

3


the Collateral as the Liens securing the obligations under the Loan Documents.”

(l) Section 6.03(b) of the Loan Agreement is amended and restated to read in its entirety as follows:

“(b) (i) Indebtedness under the Loan Documents and the Revolving Credit Facility Loan Documents, (ii) Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness (other than under the Secured Notes Documents) incurred to Refinance Indebtedness under the Loan Documents and (iii) Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred to Refinance Indebtedness incurred pursuant to clause (ii) or this clause (iii);”

(m) Section 6.03 of the Loan Agreement is further amended by:

(i) deleting “and” at the end of clause (p);

(ii) deleting “.” at the end of clause (q) and replacing it with “; and”; and

(iii) inserting a new clause (r), as follows:

“(r) (i) Indebtedness incurred on a single date pursuant to an issuance of high yield notes, provided , that (x) the proceeds thereof shall have been used simultaneously with the receipt thereof to Refinance the Loans and to pay any premiums or penalties and accrued and unpaid interest thereon and reasonable fees and expenses related thereto and (y) such Indebtedness constitutes Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness in respect of the Loans (determined without regard to clause (a) of the definition thereof); provided further , that solely to the extent that the Loans shall have been Refinanced in full in accordance with the preceding proviso, the proceeds of such Indebtedness in excess of the amounts required to effect such Refinancing in full of the Loans shall have been used simultaneously with the receipt thereof to prepay Revolving Credit Loans (without any corresponding reduction in the Revolving Credit Commitments (as defined in the Revolving Credit Facility Agreement)) and for no other purpose, so long as such Indebtedness constitutes Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness in respect of the Revolving Credit Loans (determined without regard to clause (a) of the definition thereof) and (ii) Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred to Refinance Indebtedness permitted pursuant to clause (i) or this clause (ii).”

(n) Section 6.07(b) of the Loan Agreement is amended by deleting “by law or by any Loan Document” at the end of clause (A) of the proviso thereto and

 

4


replacing it with “(i) by law, (ii) by any Loan Document, any Revolving Credit Facility Loan Document or any Secured Notes Document, or (iii) by the documents governing any Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred pursuant to clause (ii) or clause (iii) of Section 6.03(b) or clause (ii) of Section 6.03(r); provided that (x) any such restrictions or conditions imposed by the Secured Notes Documents are customary restrictions and conditions for issuances of high yield securities and (y) any such restrictions and conditions imposed by the documents governing any such Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness are not more restrictive than the restrictions and conditions contained in the applicable Refinanced Indebtedness, in the case of each of clauses (x) and (y) as determined in good faith by a Financial Officer of Holdco”.

Section 3 . Intercreditor Agreement; Security Documents. The Required Lenders hereby authorize the Agent to enter into amendments to the Intercreditor Agreement and the other Security Documents (which may take the form of an amendment and restatement of any such agreements) (i) to provide for the issuance of the Secured Notes and the granting and perfection of the Liens securing the Secured Notes as contemplated by this Amendment, including without limitation the lien priorities required by Section 2(k)(iii) of this Amendment, (ii) to cause the Intercreditor Agreement to accommodate the refinancing of certain indebtedness to the extent such refinancing is otherwise permitted under the Loan Agreement, (iii) to increase the cap on ABL Secured Obligations (as defined in the Intercreditor Agreement) that is imposed by the Intercreditor Agreement from $275 million to $300 million (or, if greater, an amount based on a percentage of receivables and inventory), (iv) to eliminate provisions that are no longer applicable as a result of the previous prepayment in full of the obligations under the Second Lien Term Facility Loan Documents and (v) to make such other modifications as are necessary or desirable in the reasonable judgment of the Agent; provided , that no such amendments described in the preceding clauses (i) through (v) shall alter the priority of Liens securing the Secured Obligations or otherwise have any adverse effect on such Liens.

Section 4 . Consent to Certain Transactions. The US Borrower has advised the Agent that, immediately following the time at which this Amendment becomes effective, (x) the following assignments (the “ Effective Date Assignments ”) of US Loans shall be effected, each pursuant to an Assignment and Acceptance delivered to the Agent and in accordance with Section 10.03 of the Loan Agreement, and in the order in which such assignments appear below:

(a) Promontoria Holding B.V. shall assign US Loans having an aggregate principal amount of $25,000,000 (the “ Specified US Loans ”) to Holdings;

(b) Holdings shall assign the Specified US Loans to Holdco; and

(c) Holdco shall assign the Specified US Loans to the US Borrower;

 

5


and (y) the US Borrower shall retire all Indebtedness in respect of the entire principal amount of the Specified US Loans (the “ Loan Retirement ”).

The Lenders hereby consent to, and agree that Section 8.08 shall be inapplicable to, the Effective Date Assignments and the Loan Retirement.

Section 5 . Representations of Borrower. The Borrower represents and warrants that (i) the representations and warranties of the Loan Parties set forth in Article 3 of the Loan Agreement will be true and correct in all material respects on and as of the Amendment Effective Date (as defined below); provided , that any representation and warranty that is qualified as to “materiality” “Material Adverse Effect” or similar language will be true and correct in all respects on and as of the Amendment Effective Date and (ii) no Default will have occurred and be continuing on such date.

Section 6 . Governing Law. This Amendment shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of New York.

Section 7 . Counterparts. This Amendment may be signed in any number of counterparts, each of which shall be an original, with the same effect as if the signatures thereto and hereto were upon the same instrument.

Section 8. Effectiveness . This Amendment shall become effective on the date (the “ Amendment Effective Date ”) on which the Agent shall have received from the Borrower and Lenders constituting the Required Lenders a counterpart hereof signed by such party or facsimile or other written confirmation (in form satisfactory to the Agent) that such party has signed a counterpart hereof.

[signature pages follow]

 

6


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Amendment to be duly executed as of the date first above written.

 

US BORROWER:
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC
By:  

/s/ Mark Malcolm

  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President & CEO
EUROPEAN BORROWER:

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS EUROPE B.V.

By:  

/s/ James C. Gouin

  Name:   James C. Gouin
  Title:   Manager
By:  

/s/ Mike Rajkovic

  Name:   Mike Rajkovic
  Title:   Manager


EURO LENDER:
CERBERUS PARTNERS, L.P.
By:   Cerberus Associates, L.L.C., its General Partner
By:  

/s/ Jeffrey Lomasky

  Name:  
  Title:  
PROMONTORIA HOLDING VI B.V., as a Lender
By:  

/s/ D.A.J. Hoogenkamp

  Name:   D.A.J. Hoogenkamp
  Title:   Managing Director
By:  

/s/ J.C.A. van Beek

  Name:   J.C.A. van Beek
  Title:   Managing Director
JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Administrative Agent
By:  

/s/ Mary E. Gherty

  Name:   Mary E. Gherty
  Title:   Managing Director

Exhibit 10.9

Execution Copy

AMENDED AND RESTATED INTERCREDITOR AGREEMENT

Dated as of

August 24, 2010

Among

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,

as Representative with respect to the ABL Credit Agreement,

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,

as Representative with respect to the Term Loan Agreement,

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB,

as Representative with respect to the Notes Agreement,

each additional Representative from time to time party hereto,

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC,

THE OTHER LOAN PARTIES PARTY HERETO

and

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC


TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

 

 

               PAGE
SECTION 1.   

Definitions

   3
   1.1   

Definitions

   3
   1.2   

Certain Interpretive Provisions

   16
SECTION 2.    Lien Priorities    17
   2.1   

Subordination of Liens

   17
   2.2   

Nature of Obligations

   18
   2.3   

Agreements Regarding Actions to Perfect Liens

   18
   2.4   

No New Liens

   20
SECTION 3.    Enforcement Rights    21
   3.1   

Exclusive Enforcement

   21
   3.2   

Standstill and Waivers

   22
   3.3   

Judgment Creditors

   24
   3.4   

Cooperation

   24
   3.5   

No Additional Rights for the Loan Parties Hereunder

   24
   3.6   

Actions Upon Breach

   24
SECTION 4.    Application of Proceeds of Common Collateral; Dispositions and Releases of Common Collateral; Inspection and Insurance    25
   4.1   

Application of Proceeds; Turnover Provisions

   25
   4.2   

Releases of Second Priority Lien

   26
   4.3   

Inspection Rights and Insurance

   27
SECTION 5.    Insolvency Proceedings    27
   5.1   

Filing of Motions

   27
   5.2   

Financing Matters

   27
   5.3   

Relief From the Automatic Stay

   28
   5.4   

Adequate Protection

   28
   5.5   

Avoidance Issues

   30
   5.6   

Asset Dispositions in an Insolvency Proceeding

   30
   5.7   

Separate Grants of Security and Separate Classification

   31
   5.8   

Plans of Reorganization

   31
   5.9   

Other Matters

   32
   5.10   

No Waiver of Rights of First Priority Secured Parties

   32
   5.11   

Effectiveness in Insolvency Proceedings

   32
SECTION 6.    Matters Relating to Loan Documents    33
   6.1   

General

   33
   6.2   

Restrictions on Refinancings

   34
   6.3   

Restrictions on Amendments, Supplements and Modifications

   34

 

i


SECTION 7.   

Cooperation with Respect to ABL Priority Collateral

   35
   7.1   

Consent to License to Use Intellectual Property

   35
   7.2   

Access to Information

   36
   7.3   

First Priority Representatives Assurances

   36
   7.4   

Loan Party Consent

   37
SECTION 8.   

Reliance; Waivers; etc .

   37
   8.1   

Reliance

   37
   8.2   

No Warranties or Liability

   37
   8.3   

No Waivers

   37
SECTION 9.   

Obligations Unconditional

   38
   9.1   

First Priority Obligations Unconditional

   38
   9.2   

Second Priority Obligations Unconditional

   38
SECTION 10.   

Miscellaneous

   39
   10.1   

Effectiveness of Term Intercreditor Agreement

   39
   10.2   

Conflicts

   39
   10.3   

Continuing Nature of Provisions

   39
   10.4   

Amendments; Waivers

   40
   10.5   

Information Concerning Financial Condition of the ABL Borrower and the other Loan Parties

   40
   10.6   

Governing Law

   41
   10.7   

Jurisdiction; Consent to Service of Process

   41
   10.8   

Notices

   41
   10.9   

Successors and Assigns

   43
   10.10   

Headings

   43
   10.11   

Severability

   43
   10.12   

Counterparts; Integration; Effectiveness

   44
SECTION 11.   

Additional ABL Secured Obligations and Term Secured Obligations

   44

 

ii


AMENDED AND RESTATED INTERCREDITOR AGREEMENT

AMENDED AND RESTATED INTERCREDITOR AGREEMENT (this “ Agreement ”) dated as of August 24, 2010, among JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Representative with respect to the ABL Credit Agreement, JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Representative with respect to the Term Loan Agreement, WILMINGTON TRUST FSB, as Representative with respect to the Notes Agreement, each other Representative from time to time party hereto, TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC (the “ ABL Borrower ”), each of the other Loan Parties party hereto and TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC.

WHEREAS, the ABL Borrower, the Guarantors, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent, and certain financial institutions are parties to that certain Revolving Credit and Guaranty Agreement dated as of July 31, 2007 (the “ ABL Credit Agreement ”), pursuant to which such financial institutions agreed to make loans and extend other financial accommodations to the ABL Borrower; and

WHEREAS, the ABL Borrower, Tower Automotive Holdings Europe, B.V. (the “ European Borrower ”), the Guarantors, certain foreign subsidiaries of Holdco (the “ Foreign Guarantors ”), JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent, and certain financial institutions are parties to that certain First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement dated as of July 31, 2007 (the “ Term Loan Agreement ”), pursuant to which such financial institutions agreed to make loans and extend other financial accommodations to the ABL Borrower and to the European Borrower; and

WHEREAS, the ABL Borrower, the Guarantors (other than Holdings) and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent (in such capacity, the “ ABL Agent ”) are parties to that certain ABL Security Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007 (as amended, modified, replaced or otherwise supplemented to the extent permitted hereunder, the “ ABL Security Agreement ”); and

WHEREAS, the ABL Borrower, the Guarantors (other than Holdings) and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent (in such capacity, the “ Term Loan Agent ”) are parties to that certain First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007 (the “ Term Loan Security Agreement ”); and

WHEREAS, the European Borrower had granted liens on certain of its assets to secure its obligations under the Term Loan Agreement, and the Foreign Guarantors had guaranteed those obligations and granted liens on certain of their respective assets to secure such guarantees; and

WHEREAS, the Issuers, the Guarantors (other than TA Finance) and Wilmington Trust FSB, as trustee and collateral agent, are entering into that


certain Indenture dated as of August 24, 2010 (the “ Notes Agreement ”), pursuant to which the Issuers issued on the date hereof their 10.625% Senior Secured Notes due 2017 (the “ 2017 Notes ”) in an aggregate principal amount of $430,000,000; and

WHEREAS, the Issuers, the Guarantors (other than Holdings and TA Finance) and Wilmington Trust FSB, as collateral agent (in such capacity, the “ Notes Agent ”) are entering into that certain Notes Security Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010 (as amended, modified or otherwise supplemented to the extent permitted hereunder, the “ Notes Security Agreement ”); and

WHEREAS, the ABL Borrower, the European Borrower, the other Loan Parties (as defined in the Term Loan Agreement as in effect on the date hereof), the ABL Agent, the Term Loan Agent and certain other parties are parties to that certain Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007 (as amended prior to the date hereof, the “ Existing Intercreditor Agreement ”); and

WHEREAS, the Second Lien Term Loan Facility Secured Obligations (as defined in the Existing Intercreditor Agreement) have previously been paid in full, and all Liens that had secured such obligations have previously been discharged; and

WHEREAS, effective on the date hereof, (i) the obligations of the European Borrower in respect of the Loans (as defined in the Term Loan Agreement) made under the Term Loan Agreement have been paid in full, (ii) the guarantees of the Secured Obligations (as defined in the Term Loan Agreement) made by each Person that is not a US Loan Party (as defined in the Term Loan Agreement) have been released and (iii) the Liens granted by each Person that is not a US Loan Party (as defined in the Term Loan Agreement) to secure any Secured Obligations (as defined in the Term Loan Agreement) have been released; and

WHEREAS, it is the desire of the parties hereto to set forth their respective rights and priorities with respect to the Common Collateral (as defined below); and

WHEREAS, in furtherance of the foregoing, the parties to the Existing Intercreditor Agreement have agreed to amend and restate the Existing Intercreditor Agreement in the form of this Agreement;

NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing and the mutual covenants herein contained and other good and valuable consideration, the existence and sufficiency of which is expressly recognized by all of the parties hereto, the parties agree as follows:

 

2


SECTION 1. Definitions

1.1 Definitions . The following terms, as used herein, have the following meanings:

ABL Agent ” has the meaning set forth in the fourth WHEREAS clause of this Agreement; provided , that the term “ABL Agent” shall also mean each Representative for the holders of any Indebtedness outstanding under any Additional ABL Credit Agreement then extant.

ABL Borrower ” has the meaning set forth in the preamble of this Agreement.

ABL Credit Agreement ” (i) has the meaning set forth in the first WHEREAS clause of this Agreement and (ii) also means any Additional ABL Credit Agreement, in each case as any such agreement may be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified in accordance with the terms hereof and thereof.

ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents ” means (i) the “Loan Documents” as defined in the ABL Credit Agreement and (ii) the “Loan Documents” (or comparable term) as defined in any Additional ABL Credit Agreement.

ABL Priority Collateral ” means any and all present and future right, title and interest of the ABL Borrower and the Guarantors in and to the following, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, existing or arising, and wherever located: (i) all accounts and chattel paper; (ii) all inventory; (iii) all cash; (iv) all deposit accounts (other than the Term Proceeds Account), including all funds credited thereto or deposited therein; (v) all securities accounts, including all funds credited thereto or deposited therein; (vi) all machinery and equipment; (vii) all interests in real property (including any fixtures attached thereto), (viii) to the extent evidencing, governing, securing or otherwise related to the items referred to in the preceding clauses (i), (ii), (iii), (iv), (v), (vi) and (vii) of this definition, all related contracts, contract rights, documents, instruments and other evidences of indebtedness, payment intangibles, letter-of-credit rights and other supporting obligations and other claims or causes of action; (ix) all books and records relating to the foregoing; and (x) all proceeds of any and all of the foregoing; provided , that (w) any of the foregoing constituting identifiable proceeds of Term Priority Collateral shall be deemed Term Priority Collateral, (x) any contract rights, claims, supporting obligations or other general intangibles to the extent relating solely and directly to Term Priority Collateral or rights of payment to the extent relating solely and directly to Term Priority Collateral shall be deemed Term Priority Collateral, (y) for the avoidance of doubt, Intellectual Property (other than Intellectual Property that is embedded in goods), Pledged

 

3


Equity Interests, the Foreign Intercompany Receivables Collateral (and any other intercompany receivables to the extent that a Lien has been granted thereon pursuant to any Term Secured Credit Document) and the Term Proceeds Account shall be deemed Term Priority Collateral and (z) for the avoidance of doubt, unless otherwise agreed after the date hereof by the requisite lenders under the ABL Credit Agreement (determined without giving effect to clause (ii) of the definition thereof), all assets constituting “ABL Collateral” (as defined in the Existing Intercreditor Agreement) shall be included in the ABL Priority Collateral. Terms used in the foregoing definition which are defined in the Uniform Commercial Code and not otherwise defined in this Agreement have the meanings specified in the Uniform Commercial Code.

ABL Priority Collateral Enforcement Action ” means the commencement by any ABL Agent of the exercise of any rights or remedies with respect to the ABL Priority Collateral (including, but not limited to, any action of foreclosure, enforcement, collection or execution).

ABL Priority Collateral Processing and Sale Period ” means the period commencing on (x) the date of commencement of an ABL Collateral Enforcement Action or the date of delivery of a Term Collateral Enforcement Action Notice, as the case may be, and (y) ending on the date occurring 180 days thereafter.

ABL Secured Obligations ” means (i) all “Secured Obligations” as defined in the ABL Credit Agreement or (ii) all “Secured Obligations” (or comparable term) as defined in any Additional ABL Credit Agreement, as the case may be. For the avoidance of doubt, ABL Secured Obligations shall include all obligations properly designated as such in accordance with Section 11 of this Agreement, to the extent the requirements set forth in said Section 11 and any other requirements set forth in this Agreement shall have been complied with.

ABL Secured Parties ” shall mean holders from time to time of the ABL Secured Obligations.

ABL Security Agreement ” has the meaning set forth in the fourth WHEREAS clause of this Agreement.

ABL Termination Date ” means the first date on which (i) the ABL Secured Obligations (other than those that constitute Unasserted Contingent Obligations) have been indefeasibly paid in cash in full (or, if applicable, cash collateralized or defeased in accordance with the terms of the applicable ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents), (ii) all commitments to extend credit under the ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents have been terminated, (iii) there are no outstanding letters of credit or similar instruments issued under the ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents (other than such as have been cash collateralized or

 

4


defeased in accordance with the terms of the ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents). For avoidance of doubt, a Refinancing of ABL Secured Obligations that is permitted hereby shall not give rise to the ABL Termination Date unless the terms thereof expressly so provide with reference to this Agreement.

Additional ABL Credit Agreement ” means (i) any replacement credit agreement entered into by the Loan Parties (or any of them) to Refinance, in whole or in part, the Indebtedness outstanding under a then-extant ABL Credit Agreement (so long as the commitments under such then-extant ABL Credit Agreement shall have also been terminated), (ii) in the event that no Indebtedness is outstanding under any then-extant ABL Credit Agreement, each replacement credit agreement entered into by the Loan Parties (or any of them) (so long as the commitments under each then-extant ABL Credit Agreement shall have also been terminated) and (iii) any new credit, loan or similar agreement entered into by the Loan Parties (or any of them); provided that (1) the incurrence of such Indebtedness and the Liens securing same is permitted by (x) the ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents, (y) the Term Secured Credit Documents and (z) this Agreement (including, without limitation, Section 6.2), (2) such Indebtedness is secured or purported to be secured by first priority Liens on the ABL Priority Collateral and second priority Liens on the Term Priority Collateral, (3) the ABL Borrower shall have designated such credit agreement as an “Additional ABL Credit Agreement” and the Representative of the holders of the Indebtedness under each such credit agreement as an “ABL Agent” by delivering a writing to such effect to each other ABL Agent, each Term Loan Agent and each Notes Agent, (4) the provisions of Section 6.2(a) of this Agreement shall have been complied with and (5) the ABL Borrower shall have delivered to each other ABL Agent, each Term Loan Agent and each Notes Agent a certificate of a Financial Officer of Holdco certifying that the preceding conditions have been satisfied.

Additional Grantor ” means any Grantor which becomes party to this Agreement pursuant to a Grantor Joinder Agreement.

Additional Notes Agreement ” means (i) any replacement indenture, term loan agreement or similar agreement entered into by the Loan Parties (or any of them) to Refinance, in whole or in part, the Indebtedness outstanding under a then-extant Notes Agreement and (ii) any new indenture, term loan or similar agreement entered into by the Loan Parties (or any of them); provided that (1) the incurrence of such Indebtedness and the Liens securing same is permitted by (x) the ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents, (y) the Term Secured Credit Documents and (z) this Agreement (including, without limitation, Section 6.2), (2) such Indebtedness is secured or purported to be secured by first priority Liens on the Term Priority Collateral and second priority Liens on the ABL Priority Collateral, (3) the ABL Borrower shall have designated such indenture, term loan agreement or similar agreement as an “Additional Notes Agreement” and the Representative of the holders of the Indebtedness under such indenture, term loan

 

5


agreement or similar agreement as a “Notes Agent” by delivering a writing to such effect to each ABL Agent, each Term Loan Agent and each other Notes Agent, (4) the provisions of Section 6.2(b) of this Agreement shall have been complied with and (5) the ABL Borrower shall have delivered to each ABL Agent, each Term Loan Agent and each other Notes Agent a certificate of a Financial Officer of Holdco certifying that the preceding conditions have been satisfied. It is understood and agreed that an indenture, loan agreement or similar agreement may not be both an Additional Notes Agreement and an Additional Term Loan Agreement.

Additional Term Loan Agreement ” means (i) any replacement indenture, term loan or similar agreement entered into by the Loan Parties (or any of them) to Refinance, in whole or in part, the Indebtedness outstanding under a then-extant Term Loan Agreement and (ii) any new indenture, term loan or similar agreement entered into by the Loan Parties (or any of them); provided that (1) the incurrence of such Indebtedness and the Liens securing same is permitted by (x) the ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents, (y) the Term Secured Credit Documents and (z) this Agreement (including, without limitation, Section 6.2, (2) such Indebtedness is secured or purported to be secured by first priority Liens on the Term Priority Collateral and second priority Liens on the ABL Priority Collateral, (3) the ABL Borrower shall have designated such indenture, term loan agreement or similar agreement as an “Additional Term Loan Agreement” and the Representative of the holders of the Indebtedness under such indenture, term loan agreement or similar agreement as a “Term Loan Agent” by delivering a writing to such effect to each ABL Agent, each Notes Agent and each other Term Loan Agent, (4) the provisions of Section 6.2(b) of this Agreement shall have been complied with and (5) the ABL Borrower shall have delivered to each ABL Agent, each Notes Agent and each other Term Loan Agent a certificate of a Financial Officer of Holdco certifying that the preceding conditions have been satisfied. It is understood and agreed that an indenture, loan agreement or similar agreement may not be both an Additional Term Loan Agreement and an Additional Notes Agreement.

Adequate Protection Liens ” means any Liens granted in any Insolvency Proceeding to any Secured Party as adequate protection of the Secured Obligations held by such Secured Party.

Authorized Term Collateral Agent ” means the “Authorized Term Collateral Agent” as defined in the Term Intercreditor Agreement. On the date of this Agreement, the Authorized Term Collateral Agent is the Notes Agent. Upon a change of the Person acting as “Authorized Term Collateral Agent” pursuant to the terms of the Term Intercreditor Agreement, such Person acting as the succeeding Authorized Term Collateral Agent shall provide written notice to each other party hereto that such Person is acting in such capacity in the manner set forth in Section 10.8 hereof.

 

6


Bankruptcy Code ” means the United States Bankruptcy Code (11 U.S.C. §101 et seq.), as amended from time to time.

Class ” refers to the determination in relation to any particular Type of Common Collateral, (i) with respect to any Secured Obligations, whether such Secured Obligations are First Priority Obligations or Second Priority Obligations and (ii) with respect to any Secured Party, whether such Secured Party is a First Priority Secured Party or a Second Priority Secured Party.

Common Collateral ” means all assets on which Liens have been granted to secure both ABL Secured Obligations and Term Secured Obligations. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Agreement, none of the assets of any Person that is not organized under the laws of the United States of America, any State thereof or the District of Columbia shall constitute Common Collateral, except to the extent that the applicable Liens are granted after the date of this Agreement (other than pursuant to an after-acquired property clause contained in any agreement in effect prior to the date of this Agreement).

Comparable Second Lien Security Document ” means, in relation to any Common Collateral subject to any First Priority Security Document, that Second Priority Security Document that creates a security interest in the same Common Collateral, granted by the same Loan Party, as applicable.

Copyright License ” shall mean any agreement now or hereafter in existence granting to any Loan Party, or pursuant to which any Loan Party grants to any other Person, any right to use, copy, reproduce, distribute, prepare derivative works, display or publish any records or other materials on which a Copyright is in existence or may come into existence.

Copyrights ” shall mean all the following: (i) all copyrights under the laws of the United States or any other country (whether or not the underlying works of authorship have been published), all registrations and recordings thereof, all copyrightable works of authorship (whether or not published), and all applications for copyrights under the laws of the United States or any other country, including registrations, recordings and applications in the United States Copyright Office or in any similar office or agency of the United States, any State thereof or any other country or any political subdivision thereof, (ii) all renewals of any of the foregoing, (iii) all claims for, and rights to sue for, past or future infringements of any of the foregoing, and (iv) all income, royalties, damages and payments now or hereafter due or payable with respect to any of the foregoing, including damages and payments for past or future infringements thereof.

Enforcement Action ” means, with respect to any Class of Secured Obligations, any demand for payment or acceleration thereof, the exercise of any rights and remedies with respect to any Common Collateral securing such

 

7


obligations or the commencement or prosecution of enforcement of any of the rights and remedies under the Loan Documents of such Class, or applicable law, including without limitation the exercise of any rights of set-off or recoupment, and the exercise of any rights or remedies of a secured creditor under the Uniform Commercial Code, the Bankruptcy Code or other similar creditors’ rights, bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization or similar laws of any applicable jurisdiction.

Financial Officer ” means, with respect to any Person, the chief financial officer, controller or treasurer of such Person.

First Priority Documents ” means, with respect to any Type of Common Collateral, the Loan Documents governing the related First Priority Obligations. If more than one series of First Priority Obligations is extant, the First Priority Documents shall include any intercreditor agreement governing the relationship between each series of First Priority Obligations then extant.

First Priority Lien ” means any Lien on any Type of Common Collateral securing any First Priority Obligation.

First Priority Obligations ” means (i) with respect to the ABL Priority Collateral, all ABL Secured Obligations and (ii) with respect to the Term Priority Collateral, the Term Secured Obligations. To the extent any payment with respect to any First Priority Obligation (whether by or on behalf of any Loan Party, as proceeds of security, enforcement of any right of setoff or otherwise) is declared to be a fraudulent conveyance or a preference in any respect, set aside or required to be paid to a debtor in possession, any Second Priority Secured Party, receiver or similar Person, then the obligation or part thereof originally intended to be satisfied shall, for the purposes of this Agreement and the rights and obligations of the First Priority Secured Parties and the Second Priority Secured Parties, be deemed to be reinstated and outstanding as if such payment had not occurred.

First Priority Obligations Payment Date ” means, with respect to each Type of Common Collateral the first date on which (i) the First Priority Obligations (other than those that constitute Unasserted Contingent Obligations) with respect to such Common Collateral have been indefeasibly paid in cash in full (or, if applicable, cash collateralized or defeased in accordance with the terms of the applicable First Priority Documents), (ii) all commitments to extend credit under the applicable First Priority Documents have been terminated, (iii) there are no outstanding letters of credit or similar instruments issued under the applicable First Priority Documents (other than such as have been cash collateralized or defeased in accordance with the terms of the applicable First Priority Documents) and (iv) the First Priority Representative with respect to such Common Collateral has delivered a written notice to the Second Priority Representative with respect to such Common Collateral stating that the events described in clauses (i), (ii) and

 

8


(iii) have occurred to the satisfaction of the First Priority Secured Parties with respect to such Common Collateral. For avoidance of doubt, a Refinancing of First Priority Obligations with respect to any Type of Common Collateral that is permitted hereby shall not give rise to the First Priority Obligations Payment Date unless the terms thereof expressly so provide with reference to this Agreement.

First Priority Representative ” means, with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, each Representative for the holders of the First Priority Obligations with respect to such Common Collateral.

First Priority Secured Parties ” means, with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the First Priority Representative and the holders of the First Priority Obligations.

First Priority Security Documents ” means each agreement or document granting or purporting to grant a Lien on any Common Collateral to secure First Priority Obligations.

Foreign Intercompany Receivables Collateral ” has the meaning given such term in the Notes Security Agreement as in effect on the date hereof.

Governmental Authority ” shall mean the government of the United States of America, any other nation or any political subdivision thereof, whether state or local, and any agency, authority, instrumentality, regulatory body, court, central bank or other entity exercising executive, legislative, judicial, taxing, regulatory or administrative powers or functions of or pertaining to government.

Grantor Joinder Agreement ” means a supplement to this Agreement substantially in the form of Annex III, appropriately completed.

Guarantors ” has the meaning given such term in the ABL Credit Agreement.

Holdco ” means Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC.

Holdings ” means Tower Automotive, LLC.

Indebtedness ” means, at any time and with respect to any Person, (i) all indebtedness of such Person for borrowed money, (ii) all indebtedness of such Person for the deferred purchase price of property or services (other than accounts payable for property, including inventory and services purchased, and expense accruals and deferred compensation items arising in the ordinary course of business), (iii) all obligations of such Person evidenced by notes, bonds, debentures or other similar instruments (other than performance, surety and appeal bonds arising in the ordinary course of business), (iv) the principal portion of all obligations of such Person under capitalized leases, (v) all reimbursement,

 

9


payment or similar obligations of such Person, contingent or otherwise, under acceptance, letter of credit or similar facilities, (vi) all obligations of such Person in respect of (x) currency swap agreements, currency future or option contracts and other similar agreements designed to hedge against fluctuations in foreign interest or exchange rates and (y) interest rate swap, cap or collar agreements and interest rate future or option contracts, in each case on a marked-to-market basis, (vii) all Indebtedness referred to in clauses (i) through (vi) above guaranteed directly or indirectly by such Person, (viii) all Indebtedness referred to in clauses (i) through (vii) above secured by (or for which the holder of such Indebtedness has an existing right, contingent or otherwise, to be secured by) any Lien upon or in property (including, without limitation, accounts and contract rights) owned by such Person, even though such Person has not assumed or become liable for the payment of such Indebtedness; provided , that with respect to any Loan Party, “Indebtedness” shall also include all Synthetic LC Indebtedness (as defined in the Indenture).

Insolvency Proceeding ” means any proceeding in respect of bankruptcy, insolvency, winding up, receivership, dissolution or assignment for the benefit of creditors, in each of the foregoing events whether under the Bankruptcy Code or any similar federal, state or foreign bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, receivership or similar law.

Intellectual Property ” shall mean, collectively, the Patents, Patent Licenses, Trademarks, Trademark Licenses, Copyrights and Copyright Licenses to the extent that a Lien has been granted thereon pursuant to any Term Secured Credit Document.

Issuers ” shall mean, collectively, the ABL Borrower and TA Finance.

Joinder Agreement ” means a supplement to this Agreement substantially in the form of Annex II, appropriately completed.

Lien ” shall mean (a) any mortgage, deed of trust, pledge, hypothecation, security interest, encumbrance, lien or charge of any kind whatsoever, (b) the interest of a vendor or a lessor under any conditional sale, capital lease or other title retention agreement (or any financing lease having substantially the same economic effect as any of the foregoing) and (c) in the case of securities, any purchase option, call or similar right of a third party with respect to such securities.

Loan Document ” means any of the ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents or the Term Secured Credit Documents.

Loan Party ” means the ABL Borrower and each other Person (including an Additional Grantor) that has at any time granted a Lien on any assets that

 

10


constitute Common Collateral (other than any Person that is not organized under the laws of the United States of America, any State thereof or the District of Columbia, except to the extent that such Person has, after the date of this Agreement, granted a Lien on any assets that constitute Common Collateral (other than pursuant to an after-acquired property clause contained in any agreement in effect prior to the Closing Date).

Maximum Obligations Amount ” means (x) with respect to the ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents, $275,000,000 and (y) with respect to the Term Secured Credit Documents, $570,000,000.

Mortgage ” means mortgage, deed of trust, leasehold mortgage, assignment of leases and rents, modifications and any other agreement, document or instrument pursuant to which any Lien on real property is granted to secure any Secured Obligations or under which rights or remedies with respect to any such Lien are governed.

Notes Agent ” has the meaning set forth in the seventh WHEREAS clause of this Agreement; provided , that, except for purposes of the definition of “Authorized Term Collateral Agent”, the term “Notes Agent” shall also mean each Representative for the holders of any Indebtedness outstanding under any Additional Notes Agreement then extant.

Notes Agreement ” has the meaning set forth in the sixth WHEREAS clause of this Agreement; provided , that the term “Notes Agreement” shall also include any Additional Notes Agreement (and if more than one Notes Agreement exists at any time, “Notes Agreement” shall be deemed to be a collective reference to each Notes Agreement), as any such agreement may be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified in accordance with the terms hereof and thereof.

Notes Documents ” means, collectively, the Notes Agreement, the Notes Security Agreement and each other document (including any Mortgages) that grants or purports to grant a Lien on any assets of any Loan Party to secure the 2017 Notes or any Indebtedness outstanding under any Additional Notes Agreement.

Notes Security Agreement ” has the meaning set forth in the seventh WHEREAS clause of this Agreement.

Patent License ” means any agreement now or hereafter in existence granting to any Loan Party, or pursuant to which any Loan Party grants to any other Person, any right with respect to any Patent or any invention now or hereafter in existence, whether patentable or not, whether a patent or application

 

11


for patent is in existence on such invention or not, and whether a patent or application for patent on such invention may come into existence or not.

Patents ” means (i) all letters patent and design letters patent of the United States or any other country and all applications for letters patent or design letters patent of the United States or any other country, including applications in the United States Patent and Trademark Office or in any similar office or agency of the United States, any State thereof or any other country or any political subdivision thereof, (ii) all reissues, divisions, continuations, continuations in part, revisions and extensions of any of the foregoing, (iii) all claims for, and rights to sue for, past or future infringements of any of the foregoing and (iv) all income, royalties, damages and payments now or hereafter due or payable with respect to any of the foregoing, including damages and payments for past or future infringements thereof.

Person ” means any natural person, corporation, division of a corporation, partnership, limited liability company, trust, joint venture, association, company, estate, unincorporated organization or Governmental Authority or any agency or political subdivision thereof.

Pledged Equity Interests ” shall mean, collectively, the Equity Interests (as defined in the Notes Security Agreement as in effect on the date hereof) to the extent that a Lien has been granted thereon pursuant to any Term Secured Credit Document.

Post-Petition Interest ” means any interest, fees, expenses or other amount that accrues or would have accrued after the commencement of any Insolvency Proceeding, whether or not allowed or allowable in any such Insolvency Proceeding.

Refinance ” means, in respect of any indebtedness, to refinance, extend, renew, defease, amend, increase, modify, supplement, restructure, refund, replace or repay, or to issue other indebtedness or enter alternative financing arrangements, in exchange or replacement for such indebtedness (in whole or in part), including by adding or replacing lenders, creditors, agents, borrowers and/or guarantors, and including in each case, but not limited to, after the original instrument giving rise to such indebtedness has been terminated and including, in each case, through any credit agreement, indenture or other agreement. “ Refinanced ” and “ Refinancing ” have correlative meanings.

Representative ” means the agent, trustee, or other representative for the holders of the Secured Obligations of any Class designated pursuant to the applicable Loan Documents.

 

12


Second Priority Documents ” means, with respect to any Type of Common Collateral, the Loan Documents governing the related Second Priority Obligations. If more than one series of Second Priority Obligations is extant, the Second Priority Documents shall include any intercreditor agreement governing the relationship between each series of Second Priority Obligations then extant.

Second Priority Lien ” means any Lien on any Type of Common Collateral securing any Second Priority Obligation.

Second Priority Obligations ” means (i) with respect to the ABL Priority Collateral, all Term Secured Obligations and (ii) with respect to Term Priority Collateral, all ABL Secured Obligations. To the extent any payment with respect to any Second Priority Obligation (whether by or on behalf of any Loan Party, as proceeds of security, enforcement of any right of setoff or otherwise) is declared to be a fraudulent conveyance or a preference in any respect, set aside or required to be paid to a debtor in possession, any First Priority Secured Party, receiver or similar Person, then the obligation or part thereof originally intended to be satisfied shall, for the purposes of this Agreement and the rights and obligations of the First Priority Secured Parties and the Second Priority Secured Parties, be deemed to be reinstated and outstanding as if such payment had not occurred.

Second Priority Obligations Payment Date ” means, with respect to each Type of Common Collateral the first date on which (i) the Second Priority Obligations (other than those that constitute Unasserted Contingent Obligations) with respect to such Common Collateral have been indefeasibly paid in cash in full (or, if applicable, cash collateralized or defeased in accordance with the terms of the applicable Second Priority Documents), (ii) all commitments to extend credit under the applicable Second Priority Documents have been terminated, (iii) there are no outstanding letters of credit or similar instruments issued under the applicable Second Priority Documents (other than such as have been cash collateralized or defeased in accordance with the terms of the applicable Second Priority Documents), and (iv) the Second Priority Representative with respect to such Common Collateral has delivered a written notice to the First Priority Representative with respect to such Common Collateral stating that the events described in clauses (i), (ii) and (iii) have occurred to the satisfaction of the Second Priority Secured Parties with respect to such Common Collateral. For avoidance of doubt, a Refinancing of Second Priority Obligations with respect to any Type of Common Collateral that is permitted hereby shall not give rise to the Second Priority Obligations Payment Date unless the terms thereof expressly so provide with reference to this Agreement.

Second Priority Representative ” means, with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, each Representative for the holders of the Second Priority Obligations with respect to such Common Collateral.

 

13


Second Priority Secured Parties ” means, with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the Second Priority Representative and the holders of the Second Priority Obligations with respect to such Common Collateral.

Second Priority Security Documents ” means each agreement or document granting or purporting to grant a Lien on any Common Collateral to secure Second Priority Obligations.

Secured Obligations ” means the First Priority Obligations and the Second Priority Obligations.

Secured Parties ” means the First Priority Secured Parties and the Second Priority Secured Parties.

Subsidiary Guarantors ” means each Guarantor other than Holdings.

TA Finance ” mean TA Holdings Finance, Inc.

Term Intercreditor Agreement ” means that certain Term Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, by and among JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as synthetic letter of credit facility agent, Wilmington Trust FSB, as notes collateral agent, each additional term agent from time to time party thereto, the Issuers and each of the affiliates of the Issuers party thereto.

Term Loan Agent ” has the meaning set forth in the fourth WHEREAS clause of this Agreement; provided , that the term “Term Loan Agent” shall also mean each Representative for the holders of any Indebtedness outstanding under each Additional Term Loan Agreement then extant (and, if more than one Term Loan Agent exists at any time, “Term Loan Agent” shall be deemed to be a collective reference to each Term Loan Agent).

Term Loan Agreement ” has the meaning set forth in the second WHEREAS clause of this Agreement; provided , that the term “Term Loan Agreement” shall also include any Additional Term Loan Agreement (and if more than one Term Loan Agreement exists at any time, “Term Loan Agreement” shall be deemed to be a collective reference to each Term Loan Agreement), as any such agreement may be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified in accordance with the terms hereof and thereof.

Term Loan Documents ” means, collectively, the “Loan Documents” (or comparable term) as defined in each Term Loan Agreement.

Term Loan Security Agreement ” has the meaning set forth in the fourth WHEREAS clause of this Agreement.

 

14


Term Obligations Termination Date ” means the first date on which (i) the Term Secured Obligations (other than those that constitute Unasserted Contingent Obligations) have been indefeasibly paid in cash in full (or, if applicable, cash collateralized or defeased in accordance with the terms of the applicable Term Secured Credit Documents), (ii) all commitments to extend credit under the Term Secured Credit Documents have been terminated, (iii) there are no outstanding letters of credit or similar instruments issued under the Term Secured Credit Documents (other than such as have been cash collateralized or defeased in accordance with the terms of the Term Secured Credit Documents). For avoidance of doubt, a Refinancing of Term Secured Obligations that is permitted hereby shall not give rise to the Term Obligations Termination Date unless the terms thereof expressly so provide with reference to this Agreement.

Term Priority Collateral ” means all Common Collateral, other than ABL Priority Collateral.

Term Priority Collateral Enforcement Action ” means the commencement by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent (or any other First Priority Representative with respect to the Term Priority Collateral) of any action or proceeding with respect to any of its rights or remedies (including, but not limited to, any action of foreclosure), enforcement, collection or execution with respect to the Term Priority Collateral.

Term Priority Collateral Enforcement Action Notice ” means a written request delivered by any ABL Agent to the Authorized Term Collateral Agent made after the commencement of a Term Priority Collateral Enforcement Action.

Term Proceeds Account ” has the meaning set forth in the Notes Agreement.

Term Secured Credit Documents ” has the meaning given the term “Secured Credit Documents” in the Term Intercreditor Agreement as in effect on the date hereof.

Term Secured Obligations ” has the meaning given the term “Term Obligations” in the Term Intercreditor Agreement as in effect on the date hereof. For the avoidance of doubt, Term Secured Obligations shall include all obligations properly designated as such in accordance with Section 11 of this Agreement, to the extent the requirements set forth in said Section 11 and any other requirements set forth in this Agreement shall have been complied with.

Trademark License ” means any agreement now or hereafter in existence granting to any Loan Party, or pursuant to which any Loan Party grants to any other Person, any right to use any Trademark.

 

15


Trademarks ” means (i) all trademarks, trade names, corporate names, company names, business names, fictitious business names, trade styles, service marks, logos, brand names, trade dress, prints and labels on which any of the foregoing have appeared or appear, package and other designs, and all other source or business identifiers, and all general intangibles of like nature, and the rights in any of the foregoing which arise under applicable law, (ii) the goodwill of the business symbolized thereby or associated with each of them, (iii) all registrations and applications in connection therewith, including registrations and applications in the United States Patent and Trademark Office or in any similar office or agency of the United States, any State thereof or any other country or any political subdivision thereof, (iv) all renewals of any of the foregoing, (v) all claims for, and rights to sue for, past or future infringements of any of the foregoing and (vi) all income, royalties, damages and payments now or hereafter due or payable with respect to any of the foregoing, including damages and payments for past or future infringements thereof.

Type ” when used to describe any Common Collateral, refers to whether such Common Collateral is ABL Priority Collateral or Term Priority Collateral.

Unasserted Contingent Obligations ” means, at any time, with respect to any Class of Secured Obligations, Secured Obligations of such Class for taxes, costs, indemnifications, reimbursements, damages and other liabilities (excluding (i) the principal of, and interest and premium (if any) on, and fees and expenses relating to, any Secured Obligation of such Class and (ii) contingent reimbursement obligations in respect of amounts that may be drawn under outstanding letters of credit) in respect of which no assertion of liability (whether oral or written) and no claim or demand for payment (whether oral or written) has been made (and, in the case of Secured Obligations of such Class for indemnification, no notice for indemnification has been issued by the indemnitee) at such time.

Uniform Commercial Code ” means the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in the State of New York.

1.2 Certain Interpretive Provisions .

(a) Subject to Section 1.2(c), whenever there are two or more First Priority Representatives with respect to a Type of Common Collateral, each reference herein to the First Priority Representative shall be deemed to be a reference to each First Priority Representative with respect to such Type of Common Collateral.

(b) Subject to Section 1.2(c), whenever there are two or more Second Priority Representatives with respect to a Type of Common Collateral, each reference herein to the Second Priority Representative shall be deemed to be a

 

16


reference to each Second Priority Representative with respect to such Type of Common Collateral.

(c) Notwithstanding Sections 1.2(a) and 1.2(b) or anything to the contrary in this Agreement:

(i) with respect to the Term Priority Collateral, the enforcement and other rights vested in the First Priority Representative pursuant to Sections 3.1, 3.4, 4.1(c), 4.3(a), 4.3(b) and 5.9 may be exercised only by and/or shall be available only to the Authorized Term Collateral Agent;

(ii) with respect to the ABL Priority Collateral, the enforcement and other rights vested in the Second Priority Representative pursuant to Section, 3.1 may be exercised only by and/or shall be available only to the Authorized Term Collateral Agent; and

(iii) in connection with the exercise by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent of any right referred to in clause (i) or (ii) above, to the extent that the terms of any applicable First Priority Security Document or Second Priority Security Document governed by non-U.S. law require that such action be taken by Notes Agent or the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent (as defined in the Term Intercreditor Agreement), the Notes Agent or the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent, as the case may be, shall take such action in accordance with the written instructions of the Authorized Term Collateral Agent.

SECTION 2. Lien Priorities .

2.1 Subordination of Liens .

(a) Any and all Second Priority Liens now existing or hereafter created or arising, regardless of how acquired, whether by grant, statute, operation of law, subrogation or otherwise, are expressly junior in priority, operation and effect to any and all First Priority Liens now existing or hereafter created or arising, notwithstanding (i) anything to the contrary contained in any agreement or filing to which any Second Priority Secured Party may now or hereafter be a party, and regardless of the time, order or method of grant, attachment, recording or perfection of any financing statements or other security interests, assignments, pledges, deeds, mortgages and other liens, charges or encumbrances or any defect or deficiency or alleged defect or deficiency in any of the foregoing, (ii) any provision of the Uniform Commercial Code or any applicable law or any First Priority Document or Second Priority Document or any other circumstance whatsoever and (iii) the fact that any such First Priority Liens are (x) subordinated to any Lien securing any obligation of any Loan Party other than the Second

 

17


Priority Obligations or (y) otherwise subordinated, voided, avoided, invalidated or lapsed.

(b) No Secured Party shall object to or contest, or support any other Person in contesting or objecting to, in any proceeding (including without limitation, any Insolvency Proceeding), the validity, extent, perfection, priority or enforceability of any security interest in the Common Collateral granted to any other Secured Party. No Second Priority Secured Party shall take, or cause to be taken, any action the purpose of which is to make any Second Priority Lien pari passu with or senior to the First Priority Lien. It is understood that nothing in this clause (b) is intended to prohibit any Second Priority Secured Party from exercising any rights expressly granted to it under this Agreement.

(c) Notwithstanding any failure by any Secured Party to perfect its security interests in the Common Collateral or any avoidance, invalidation or subordination by any third party or court of competent jurisdiction of the security interests in the Common Collateral granted to such Secured Party, the priority and rights as among the Secured Parties with respect to the Common Collateral shall be as set forth herein.

2.2 Nature of Obligations . Each Secured Party acknowledges that certain of the Secured Obligations are revolving in nature and that the amount thereof that may be outstanding at any time or from time to time may be increased or reduced and subsequently reborrowed, and that the terms of such Secured Obligations may be modified, extended or amended from time to time, and that the aggregate amount of the Secured Obligations may be increased, replaced or Refinanced, in each event, without notice to or consent by the Secured Parties (except to the extent required under Section 6) and without affecting the provisions hereof. The lien priorities provided in Section 2.1 shall not be altered or otherwise affected by any such amendment, modification, supplement, extension, repayment, reborrowing, increase, replacement, renewal, restatement or Refinancing of or waiver, consent or accommodation with respect to any Secured Obligations, or any portion thereof, except as permitted under Section 6.

2.3 Agreements Regarding Actions to Perfect Liens .

(a) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the Second Priority Representative agrees, on behalf of itself and the other Second Priority Secured Parties, that UCC-1 financing statements, patent, trademark or copyright filings or other filings or recordings filed or recorded by or on behalf of such Second Priority Representative or any other Second Priority Secured Party (or any agent or other representative thereof) shall be in form reasonably satisfactory to the First Priority Representative.

 

18


(b) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the First Priority Representative hereby acknowledges that, to the extent that it holds, or a third party holds on its behalf, physical possession of or “control” (as defined in the Uniform Commercial Code) over such Common Collateral pursuant to the First Priority Documents, such possession or control is also for the benefit of the Second Priority Representative and the other Second Priority Secured Parties, but solely as a gratuitous bailee to the extent required to perfect their security interest in such Common Collateral. With respect to each Type of Common Collateral (including, without limitation, the Term Proceeds Account), if for any reason (whether pursuant to the Second Priority Documents or otherwise) the Second Priority Representative holds, or a third party holds on its behalf, physical possession of or “control” (as defined in the Uniform Commercial Code) over such Common Collateral, such possession or control is also for the benefit of the First Priority Representative and the other First Priority Secured Parties, but solely a gratuitous bailee to the extent required to perfect their security interest in such Common Collateral. Nothing in the preceding two sentences shall be construed to impose any duty on the First Priority Representative (or the Second Priority Representative, as the case may be) (or any third party acting on either of their behalf) with respect to such Common Collateral or provide any Second Priority Representative or any other Second Priority Secured Party (or any First Priority Representative or any other First Priority Secured Party, as the case may be) with respect to the applicable Common Collateral with any rights with respect to such Common Collateral beyond those specified in this Agreement and the Second Priority Documents (or the First Priority Documents, as the case may be); provided that with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, (A) after the First Priority Obligations Payment Date,(i) the First Priority Representative shall (x) deliver to the Second Priority Representative (and each Loan Party hereby directs such First Priority Representative to so deliver) at the Loan Parties’ sole cost and expense, any stock certificates or promissory notes evidencing or constituting such Common Collateral in its possession or control together with any necessary endorsements to the extent required by the Second Priority Documents or (y) direct and deliver such Common Collateral as a court of competent jurisdiction otherwise directs and (ii) in the case of any Common Collateral consisting of deposit accounts or securities accounts as to which the First Priority Representative has control pursuant to an account control agreement, the First Priority Representative and the applicable Loan Party, at the Loan Parties’ sole cost and expense, shall take such actions, if any, as are required to cause control over such Common Collateral to become vested in the Second Priority Representative and (B) after the Second Priority Obligations Payment Date,(i) the Second Priority Representative shall (x) deliver to the First Priority Representative (and each Loan Party hereby directs such Second Priority Representative to so deliver) at the Loan Parties’ sole cost and expense, any stock certificates or promissory notes evidencing or constituting such Common Collateral in its possession or control together with any necessary endorsements

 

19


to the extent required by the First Priority Documents or (y) direct and deliver such Common Collateral as a court of competent jurisdiction otherwise directs and (ii) in the case of any Common Collateral consisting of deposit accounts or securities accounts as to which the Second Priority Representative has control pursuant to an account control agreement, the Second Priority Representative and the applicable Loan Party, at the Loan Parties’ sole cost and expense, shall take such actions, if any, as are required to cause control over such Common Collateral to become vested in the First Priority Representative, and provided , further , that the provisions of this Agreement are intended solely to govern the respective Lien priorities as between the First Priority Secured Parties and the Second Priority Secured Parties and shall not impose on the First Priority Secured Parties (or the Second Priority Secured Parties, as applicable) any obligations in respect of the disposition of any Common Collateral (or any proceeds thereof) that would conflict with prior perfected Liens or any claims thereon in favor of any other Person that is not a Secured Party.

(c) Other than as set forth in the first proviso to the third sentence of the immediately preceding clause (b), any Secured Party with physical possession of or control over Common Collateral shall not have any duty or liability to protect or preserve any rights pertaining to any of such Common Collateral and, except for gross negligence or willful misconduct as determined pursuant to a final non-appealable order of a court of competent jurisdiction, each other Secured Party hereby waives and releases such Person from all claims and liabilities arising pursuant to such Person’s role as gratuitous bailee with respect to such Common Collateral.

2.4 No New Liens . The parties hereto agree that there shall be no Lien, and no Loan Party shall have any right to create any Lien, on any asset of such Loan Party securing any Secured Obligation of such Loan Party if such asset is not also subject to a Lien securing each other Secured Obligation of such Loan Party, except that nothing contained in this Section 2.4 shall preclude (i) the First Priority Secured Parties from being granted Adequate Protection Liens regardless of whether any Adequate Protection Liens are granted to the holders of any other Secured Obligations or (ii) the Second Priority Secured Parties from being granted Adequate Protection Liens in accordance with Section 5.4. If any Secured Party shall (nonetheless and in breach hereof) acquire or hold any Lien on any assets of any Loan Party securing the Secured Obligations of such Loan Party (other than any Adequate Protection Liens that may be granted to the First Priority Secured Parties), which assets are not also subject to a Lien securing the other Secured Obligations of such Loan Party as required by the first sentence of this Section 2.4, then such Secured Party shall, without the need for any further consent of any other Secured Party, and notwithstanding anything to the contrary in any Loan Document, be deemed to hold and have held such Lien for the benefit of the Secured Parties holding Secured Obligations that are required to have a Lien on such assets by the first sentence of this Section 2.4 (and each such Lien so

 

20


deemed to have been held shall be subject in all respects to the provisions of this Agreement, including without limitation the lien subordination provisions set forth in Section 2.1).

SECTION 3. Enforcement Rights .

3.1 Exclusive Enforcement .

(a) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, until the First Priority Obligations Payment Date, whether or not an Insolvency Proceeding has been commenced by or against any Loan Party, the First Priority Secured Parties shall have the exclusive right to take and continue (or refrain from taking or continuing) any Enforcement Action with respect to such Common Collateral, without any consultation with or consent of any Second Priority Secured Party with respect to such Common Collateral. With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, upon the occurrence and during the continuance of a default or an event of default under the First Priority Documents (and subject to the provisions thereof), the First Priority Representative and the other First Priority Secured Parties may take and continue any Enforcement Action with respect to the applicable First Priority Obligations and such Common Collateral in such order and manner as they may determine in their sole discretion.

(b) It is understood that Section 3.1(a) does not restrict the following:

 

  (i) in any Insolvency Proceeding commenced by or against any Loan Party, the Second Priority Representative with respect to each Type of Common Collateral may file a claim or statement of interest with respect to such Type of Common Collateral;

 

  (ii) the Second Priority Representative with respect to each Type of Common Collateral may take any action (not adverse to the prior Liens securing the First Priority Obligations with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, or the rights of the First Priority Representative or the First Priority Secured Parties with respect to such Type of Common Collateral to exercise remedies in respect thereof) in order to preserve, perfect or protect the First Priority Lien on such Type of Common Collateral;

 

  (iii)

the Second Priority Secured Parties with respect to each Type of Common Collateral shall be entitled to file any necessary responsive or defensive pleadings in opposition to any motion, claim, adversary proceeding or other pleading made by any Person objecting to or otherwise

 

21


 

seeking the disallowance of the claims of the Second Priority Secured Parties with respect to such Type of Common Collateral, if any in each case in accordance with the terms of this Agreement;

 

  (iv) the Second Priority Secured Parties with respect to each Type of Common Collateral shall be entitled to file any pleadings, objections, motions or agreements which assert rights or interests available to unsecured creditors of the Loan Parties arising under either any bankruptcy, insolvency or similar law or applicable non-bankruptcy law, in each case in accordance with the terms of this Agreement; and

 

  (v) the Second Priority Secured Parties with respect to each Type of Common Collateral shall be entitled to vote on any plan of reorganization and file any proof of claim in an Insolvency Proceeding or otherwise and other filings and make any arguments and motions that are, in each case, in accordance with the terms of this Agreement, with respect to such Type of Common Collateral.

3.2 Standstill and Waivers .

(a) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the Second Priority Representative, on behalf of itself and the other Second Priority Secured Parties, for the benefit of the First Priority Representative and each other First Priority Secured Party, agrees that, until the First Priority Obligations Payment Date, subject to Section 3.1(b), they will not oppose, object to, interfere with, hinder or delay, in any manner, whether by judicial proceedings (including without limitation the filing of an Insolvency Proceeding) or otherwise, any foreclosure, sale, lease, exchange, transfer or other disposition of such Common Collateral pursuant to an Enforcement Action (or pursuant to a sale, lease, exchange or transfer as a result of which the Second Priority Lien is automatically released pursuant to Section 4.2(a)) or any other Enforcement Action taken by or on behalf of the First Priority Representative or any other First Priority Secured Party;

(b) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral the Second Priority Representative, on behalf of itself and the other Second Priority Secured Parties agrees, for the benefit of the First Priority Representative and each other First Priority Secured Party, that until the First Priority Obligations Payment Date, they have no right to (x) direct the First Priority Representative or any other First Priority Secured Party to take any Enforcement Action with respect to such Common Collateral or (y) consent or object to the taking by the First Priority

 

22


Representative or any other First Priority Secured Party of any Enforcement Action with respect to such Common Collateral or to the timing or manner thereof (or, to the extent it may have any such right described in this clause (b) as a junior lien creditor, they hereby irrevocably waives such right);

(c) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the Second Priority Representative, on behalf of itself and the other Second Priority Secured Parties, agrees, for the benefit of the First Priority Representative and each other First Priority Secured Party, that until the First Priority Obligations Payment Date, they will not institute any suit or other proceeding or assert in any suit, Insolvency Proceeding or other proceeding any claim against the First Priority Representative or any other First Priority Secured Party seeking damages from or other relief by way of specific performance, instructions or otherwise, with respect to, and none of the First Priority Representative nor any other First Priority Secured Party shall be liable for, any action taken or omitted to be taken by the First Priority Representative or any First Priority Secured Party with respect to such Common Collateral or pursuant to the First Priority Documents; provided that nothing in this Section 3.2(c) shall be construed to prevent or limit any party hereto from instituting any such suit or other proceeding to enforce the terms of this Agreement;

(d) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the Second Priority Representative, on behalf of itself and the other Second Priority Secured Parties, agrees, for the benefit of the First Priority Representative and each other First Priority Secured Party, that until the First Priority Obligations Payment Date, they will not take any Enforcement Action with respect to such Common Collateral;

(e) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the Second Priority Representative, on behalf of itself and the other Second Priority Secured Parties, agrees, for the benefit of the First Priority Representative and each other First Priority Secured Party, that until the First Priority Obligations Payment Date, they will not commence judicial or nonjudicial foreclosure proceedings with respect to, seek to have a trustee, receiver, liquidator or similar official appointed for or over, attempt any action to take possession of, exercise any right, remedy or power with respect to, or otherwise take any action to enforce their interest in or realize upon, such Common Collateral; and

(f) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, (i) the Second Priority Representative, on behalf of itself and the other Second Priority Secured Parties, agrees, for the benefit of the First Priority Representative and each other First Priority Secured Party, that until the First Priority Obligations Payment Date, they will not seek, and hereby waive any right, to have such Common Collateral or any part thereof marshaled upon any foreclosure or other disposition of such Common Collateral.

 

23


3.3 Judgment Creditors . In the event that any Second Priority Secured Party becomes a judgment lien creditor as a result of its enforcement of its rights as an unsecured creditor in respect of its Second Priority Obligations (it being understood that any such party may exercise its rights and remedies as an unsecured creditor against the relevant Loan Parties in accordance with the terms of the Second Priority Documents and applicable law, provided that such exercise of rights or remedies is not a violation of this Agreement), such judgment lien shall be subject to the terms of this Agreement for all purposes (including in relation to the First Priority Liens and the First Priority Obligations) to the same extent as all other Second Priority Liens (created pursuant to the Second Priority Documents), subject to this Agreement.

3.4 Cooperation . With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the Second Priority Representative, on behalf of itself and the other Second Priority Secured Parties, agrees that each of them shall take such actions as the First Priority Representative shall reasonably request in connection with an Enforcement Action or the exercise by the First Priority Secured Parties of their rights set forth herein.

3.5 No Additional Rights for the Loan Parties Hereunder . Except as provided in Section 3.6, if any Secured Party shall enforce its rights or remedies in violation of the terms of this Agreement, no Loan Party shall be entitled to use such violation as a defense to any action by any Secured Party, nor to assert such violation as a counterclaim or basis for set off or recoupment against any Secured Party.

3.6 Actions Upon Breach .

(a) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, if any Second Priority Secured Party commences or participates in any action or proceeding against any Loan Party in respect of the such Common Collateral contrary to this Agreement, such Loan Party, with the prior written consent of the First Priority Representative, may interpose as a defense or dilatory plea the making of this Agreement, and any First Priority Secured Party may intervene and interpose such defense or plea in its or their name or in the name of such Loan Party.

(b) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, if any Second Priority Secured Party (or any agent or other representative thereof) in any way takes, attempts to take or threatens to take any action with respect to such Common Collateral (including, without limitation, any attempt to enforce any remedy on such Common Collateral) in violation of this Agreement, or fails to take any action required by this Agreement, any First Priority Secured Party (in its or their own name or in the name of any Loan Party) may obtain relief against such Second Priority Secured Party or agent or other representative thereof by injunction, specific performance and/or other appropriate equitable relief, it being

 

24


understood and agreed by the Second Priority Representative on behalf of each other Second Priority Secured Party that (i) the damages of the First Priority Secured Parties from its actions may at that time be difficult to ascertain and may be irreparable, and (ii) each Second Priority Secured Party waives any defense that any Loan Party and/or the First Priority Secured Parties cannot demonstrate damage and/or can be made whole by the awarding of damages.

SECTION 4. Application of Proceeds of Common Collateral; Dispositions and Releases of Common Collateral; Inspection and Insurance .

4.1 Application of Proceeds; Turnover Provisions .

(a) All proceeds of ABL Priority Collateral (to the extent such ABL Priority Collateral constitutes Common Collateral) (including any interest earned thereon) resulting from any Enforcement Action, and whether or not pursuant to an Insolvency Proceeding, shall be distributed as follows:

first , to the ABL Agent to be applied in accordance with Section 14 of the ABL Security Agreement (or, if an Additional ABL Agreement is in effect, in accordance with the applicable sections of the then-extant ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents) until the ABL Secured Obligations are paid in full;

second , to the Authorized Term Collateral Agent to be applied in accordance with Section 2.01 of the Term Intercreditor Agreement until the Term Secured Obligations are paid in full; and

finally , to the relevant Loan Party, or as a court of competent jurisdiction may direct.

(b) All proceeds of the Term Priority Collateral (to the extent such Term Loan Priority Collateral constitutes Common Collateral) (including any interest earned thereon) resulting from any Enforcement Action, and whether or not pursuant to an Insolvency Proceeding, shall be distributed as follows:

first , to the Authorized Term Collateral Agent to be applied in accordance with Section 2.01 of the Term Intercreditor Agreement until the Term Secured Obligations are paid in full;

second , to the ABL Agent to be applied in accordance with Section 17 of the ABL Security Agreement (or, if an Additional ABL Agreement is in effect, in accordance with the applicable sections of the then-extant ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents) until the ABL Secured Obligations are paid in full; and

finally , to the relevant Loan Party, or as a court of competent jurisdiction may direct.

 

25


(c) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, until the occurrence of the First Priority Obligations Payment Date, no Second Priority Secured Party may accept any such Common Collateral, including any such Common Collateral constituting proceeds, in satisfaction, in whole or in part, of the Second Priority Secured Obligations in violation of Sections 4.1(a) or 4.1(b). Any Common Collateral received by a Second Priority Secured Party that is not permitted to be received pursuant to the preceding sentence shall be segregated and held in trust and promptly turned over to the First Priority Representative with respect to such Common Collateral to be applied in accordance with Section 4.1(a) or 4.1(b), as the case may be, in the same form as received, with any necessary endorsements, and each Second Priority Secured Party hereby authorizes the First Priority Representative to make any such endorsements as agent for the Second Priority Representative (which authorization, being coupled with an interest, is irrevocable). Upon the turnover of such Common Collateral as contemplated by the immediately preceding sentence, the Second Priority Obligations purported to be satisfied by the payment of such Common Collateral shall be immediately reinstated in full as though such payment had never occurred.

4.2 Releases of Second Priority Lien .

(a) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, upon any release, sale or disposition of such Common Collateral that results in the release of the First Priority Lien on such Common Collateral and that is (i) permitted pursuant to the terms of the First Priority Documents and not prohibited under the Second Priority Documents or (ii) effected pursuant to an Enforcement Action, the Second Priority Lien on such Common Collateral (but not on any proceeds of such Common Collateral not required to be paid to the First Priority Secured Parties) shall be automatically and unconditionally released.

(b) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, until the First Priority Obligations Payment Date, the Second Priority Representative shall promptly execute and deliver such release documents and instruments and shall take such further actions as the First Priority Representative shall reasonably request to evidence any release of the Second Priority Lien described in Section 4.2(a). With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the Second Priority Representative hereby appoints the First Priority Representative and any officer or duly authorized person of the First Priority Representative, with full power of substitution, as its true and lawful attorney-in-fact with full irrevocable power of attorney in the place and stead of the Second Priority Representative and in the name of the Second Priority Representative or in the First Priority Representative’s own name; provided that such power of attorney may only be exercised if the Second Priority Representative has not executed and delivered such release documents and instruments in a timely manner following a request from the First Priority Representative, and must be exercised in the First Priority

 

26


Representative’s reasonable discretion, solely for the purposes of carrying out the terms of Section 4.2(a), to take any and all appropriate action and to execute and deliver any and all documents and instruments as may be necessary or desirable to accomplish the purposes of Section 4.2(a), including any financing statements, endorsements, assignments, releases or other documents or instruments of transfer (which appointment, being coupled with an interest, is irrevocable).

4.3 Inspection Rights and Insurance .

(a) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, until the First Priority Obligations Payment Date, any First Priority Secured Party and its representatives and invitees may, in accordance with the First Priority Documents, inspect, repossess, remove and otherwise deal with such Common Collateral, and, pursuant to an Enforcement Action, the First Priority Representative may advertise and conduct public auctions or private sales of such Common Collateral, in each case without notice (other than any notice required by law) to, the involvement of or interference by any Second Priority Secured Party or liability to any Second Priority Secured Party.

(b) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, until the First Priority Obligations Payment Date, the First Priority Representative will have the sole and exclusive right (i) to be named as additional insured and loss payee under any insurance policies maintained from time to time by any Loan Party with respect to such Common Collateral (except that, if the applicable insurer permits, the Second Priority Representative shall have the right to be named as an additional insured so long as its second lien status is identified in a manner reasonably satisfactory to the First Priority Representative); (ii) to adjust or settle any insurance policy or claim covering such Common Collateral in the event of any loss thereunder; and (iii) to approve any award granted in any condemnation or similar proceeding affecting such Common Collateral.

SECTION 5. Insolvency Proceedings .

5.1 Filing of Motions . No Secured Party shall, in or in connection with any Insolvency Proceeding, file any pleadings or motions, take any position at any hearing or proceeding of any nature, or otherwise take any action whatsoever, in each case to challenge, contest or otherwise object to the scope, validity, enforceability, perfection or priority of any Liens held by any other Secured Party and no Secured Party shall support any other Person doing any of the foregoing.

5.2 Financing Matters .

(a) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, if any Loan Party becomes subject to any Insolvency Proceeding, and if the First Priority

 

27


Representative consents (or does not object) to the use of such Common Collateral (for the avoidance of doubt, including but not limited to the use of cash collateral) by any Loan Party during any Insolvency Proceeding or provides financing to any Loan Party under the Bankruptcy Code or consents (or does not object) to the provision of such financing to any Loan Party by any third party (any such financing, whether provided by the First Priority Secured Parties or any third party, being referred therein as a “ DIP Financing ”), then the Second Priority Representative agrees, on behalf of itself and the other Second Priority Secured Parties, that each Second Priority Secured Party (a) will be deemed to have consented to, will raise no objection to, and will not support any other Person objecting to, the use of such Common Collateral or to such DIP Financing, (b) shall only request or accept adequate protection in connection with the use of such Common Collateral or such DIP Financing as permitted by Section 5.4 below, (c) will subordinate (and will be deemed hereunder to have subordinated) the Second Priority Liens and any Adequate Protection Liens provided in respect thereof, (i) to such DIP Financing with the same terms and conditions as the First Priority Liens are subordinated thereto (and such subordination will not alter in any manner the terms of this Agreement), (ii) to any adequate protection, including, without limitation, Adequate Protection Liens, provided to the First Priority Secured Parties and (iii) to any “carve-out” for professional and United States Trustee fees agreed to by the First Priority Representative or the other First Priority Secured Parties and (d) agrees that any notice of such events found to be adequate by the bankruptcy court shall be adequate notice.

(b) Notwithstanding the foregoing, the provisions of Section 5.2(a) shall only be applicable as to the Second Priority Secured Parties with respect to any DIP Financing to the extent the amount of such DIP Financing does not exceed the sum of (i) the aggregate principal amount of the ABL Secured Obligations Refinanced thereby plus (ii) the aggregate principal amount of the Term Secured Obligations Refinanced thereby plus (iii) $300,000,000.

5.3 Relief From the Automatic Stay . With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the Second Priority Representative agrees, on behalf of itself and the other Second Priority Secured Parties, that none of them will (a) seek relief from the automatic stay or from any other stay in any Insolvency Proceeding or take any action in violation thereof, or support any other Person seeking such relief or taking such action, in each case in respect of such Common Collateral, without the prior written consent of the First Priority Representative or (b) object to, contest, or support any other Person objecting to or contesting, any relief from the automatic stay or from any other stay in any Insolvency Proceeding requested by any First Priority Secured Party.

5.4 Adequate Protection .

 

28


(a) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the Second Priority Representative, on behalf of itself and the other Second Priority Secured Parties, agrees that none of them shall object to, contest, or support any other Person objecting to or contesting, (i) any request by the First Priority Representative or any other First Priority Secured Party for adequate protection, including, without limitation, in the form of Adequate Protection Liens, superpriority claims, interest, fees, expenses or other amounts or (ii) any objection by the First Priority Representative or any other First Priority Secured Party to any motion, relief, action or proceeding based on a claim of a lack of adequate protection to the First Priority Secured Parties. Notwithstanding anything contained in this Agreement, in any Insolvency Proceeding, the Second Priority Representative and the other Second Priority Secured Parties with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, may seek, support, accept or retain adequate protection solely in the form of (u) Permitted Cash Adequate Protection Payments in accordance with Section 5.4(b), (v) an Adequate Protection Lien on additional collateral, subordinated to the First Priority Liens and Liens securing any DIP Financing on the same basis as the other Second Priority Liens are so subordinated to the First Priority Liens under this Agreement, (w) only if the First Priority Secured Parties are granted superpriority claims, superpriority claims junior in all respects to the superpriority claims granted to the First Priority Secured Parties, (x) payment of the fees and expenses of the Second Priority Secured Parties, (y) any form of adequate protection that is consistent with the priorities set forth in this Agreement and (z) non-monetary adequate protection that is customarily provided in an Insolvency Proceeding, including, without limitation, the provision of information and the ability to monitor such Common Collateral. With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, in the event any Second Priority Secured Party receives adequate protection in the form of Adequate Protection Liens, then the Second Priority Representative, on behalf of itself and the other Second Priority Secured Parties, (i) consents to the First Priority Representative having a senior Adequate Protection Lien on such additional collateral as security for the First Priority Obligations and that any Adequate Protection Liens granted to the Second Priority Secured Parties, on any additional collateral shall be subordinated to the Liens on such collateral securing the First Priority Obligations and any DIP Financing (and all obligations relating thereto) and any Adequate Protection Liens granted to the First Priority Secured Parties, with such subordination to be on the same terms that the other Second Priority Liens are subordinated to such First Priority Liens under this Agreement and (ii) agrees that, if the bankruptcy court does not grant the First Priority Secured Parties a senior Adequate Protection Lien on such additional collateral, then the Second Priority Secured Parties shall be deemed to hold and have held their Adequate Protection Lien on such additional collateral for the benefit of the First Priority Secured Parties (and each such Lien so deemed to have been held shall be subject in all respects to the provisions of this Agreement, including without limitation the lien subordination provisions set forth in Section 2.1) and,

 

29


until the First Priority Obligations Payment Date, any distributions in respect of such additional collateral received by the Second Priority Secured Parties shall be segregated and held in trust and promptly turned over to the First Priority Representative to repay the First Priority Obligations. Upon the turnover of such distributions as contemplated by the immediately preceding sentence, the Second Priority Obligations purported to be satisfied by such distributions shall be immediately reinstated in full as though such payment had never occurred.

(b) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, if the First Priority Secured Parties are granted as adequate protection current cash payments at least equal to Post-Petition Interest accruing at the applicable non-default rate on the First Priority Obligations, the Second Priority Secured Parties may seek, support, accept or retain as adequate protection current cash payments in an amount equal to Post-Petition Interest accruing at the applicable non-default rate on the Second Priority Obligations (the “ Permitted Cash Adequate Protection Payments ”); provided that the consent of the Second Priority Secured Parties to, and the agreement of the Second Priority Secured Parties not to object or support any objection to, the use of such Common Collateral, any DIP Financing and any adequate protection provided to the First Priority Secured Parties as provided in Section 5.2 shall remain in full force and effect even if the Second Priority Secured Parties seek such Permitted Cash Adequate Protection Payments and whether or not such Permitted Cash Adequate Protection Payments are granted by the bankruptcy court.

5.5 Avoidance Issues . With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, if any First Priority Secured Party is required in any Insolvency Proceeding or otherwise to disgorge, turn over or otherwise pay to the estate of any Loan Party, because such amount was avoided or ordered to be paid or disgorged for any reason, including because it was found to be a fraudulent or preferential transfer, any amount (a “ Recovery ”), whether received as proceeds of security, enforcement of any right of set-off or otherwise, then the First Priority Obligations shall be reinstated to the extent of such Recovery and deemed to be outstanding as if such payment had not occurred, and the First Priority Obligations Payment Date shall be deemed not to have occurred. If this Agreement shall have been terminated prior to such Recovery, this Agreement shall be reinstated in full force and effect, and such prior termination shall not diminish, release, discharge, impair or otherwise affect the obligations of the parties hereto.

5.6 Asset Dispositions in an Insolvency Proceeding . With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the Second Priority Representative, on behalf of itself and the other Second Priority Secured Parties, agrees that (a) none of them shall, in an Insolvency Proceeding or otherwise, oppose any sale or disposition of any such Common Collateral that is supported by the First Priority Secured Parties, and (b) they will be deemed to have consented under Section 363

 

30


of the Bankruptcy Code (and otherwise) to any such sale supported by the First Priority Secured Parties and to have released their Liens in such assets.

5.7 Separate Grants of Security and Separate Classification . With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, each Secured Party acknowledges and agrees that (i) the grant of Liens pursuant to the First Priority Security Documents constitutes a separate and distinct grant of Liens from the grant of each of the Liens granted pursuant to any of the Second Priority Security Documents, (ii) because of, among other things, their differing rights in such Common Collateral, each of the First Priority Obligations and Second Priority Obligations is fundamentally different and must be separately classified in any plan of reorganization proposed or confirmed in an Insolvency Proceeding and (iii) it will object to, and not vote in favor of, any plan of reorganization that does not separately classify each such Class. To further effectuate the intent of the parties as provided in the immediately preceding sentence, if a court of competent jurisdiction holds that the claims of the First Priority Secured Parties and the claims held by the Second Priority Secured Parties in respect of any Type of Common Collateral constitute only one secured claim (rather than separate classes of senior and junior secured claims), then the Second Priority Secured Parties hereby acknowledge and agree that all distributions shall be made as if there were separate classes of senior and junior secured claims against the relevant Loan Parties in respect of such Common Collateral (with the effect being that, to the extent that the aggregate value of such Common Collateral is sufficient (for this purpose ignoring all claims held by the Second Priority Secured Parties), the First Priority Secured Parties shall be entitled to receive, in addition to distributions to them in respect of principal, pre-petition interest and other claims, all amounts owing in respect of Post-Petition Interest (at the applicable non-default rate) before any distribution is made in respect of the claims held by the Second Priority Secured Parties), with the Second Priority Secured Parties hereby acknowledging and agreeing to turn over to the First Priority Secured Parties distributions otherwise received or receivable by them in respect of such Common Collateral to the extent necessary to effectuate the intent of this sentence, even if such turnover has the effect of reducing the claim or recovery of the Second Priority Secured Parties.

5.8 Plans of Reorganization . With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, if the claims of the First Priority Secured Parties and the claims held by the Second Priority Secured Parties constitute only one secured claim pursuant to any plan of reorganization proposed in an Insolvency Proceeding (rather than separate classes of senior and junior secured claims), notwithstanding the objection to, and vote against, such plan by such Secured Parties in accordance with Section 5.7, no Second Priority Secured Party shall support or vote in favor of such plan of reorganization (and each shall vote and shall be deemed to have voted to reject any plan of reorganization) unless such plan (i) pays off, in cash in full, all First Priority Obligations or (ii) is supported by the First Priority

 

31


Representative. If any such Second Priority Secured Party votes in favor of any plan or reorganization in violation of this Section 5.8, such Second Priority Secured Party irrevocably agrees that such vote shall be deemed unauthorized, void and of no force and effect and the First Priority Representative shall be, and shall be deemed, such party’s “authorized agent” under Bankruptcy Rules 3018(c) and 9010, and that the First Priority Representative shall be authorized and entitled to withdraw such vote and submit a superseding ballot on behalf of such Second Priority Secured Party that is consistent herewith.

5.9 Other Matters . With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, to the extent that the Second Priority Representative or any other Second Priority Secured Party, has or acquires rights under Section 363 or Section 364 of the Bankruptcy Code with respect to any of such Common Collateral, the Second Priority Representative agrees, on behalf of itself and the other Second Priority Secured Parties, not to assert any of such rights without the prior written consent of the First Priority Representative with respect to such Common Collateral; provided that if requested by such First Priority Representative, the Second Priority Representative with respect to such Common Collateral shall timely exercise such rights in the manner requested by such First Priority Representative, including any rights to payments in respect of such rights.

5.10 No Waiver of Rights of First Priority Secured Parties . With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, nothing contained herein shall prohibit or in any way limit the First Priority Representative or any other First Priority Secured Party from objecting in any Insolvency Proceeding or otherwise to any action taken by any Second Priority Secured Party, including the seeking by any Second Priority Secured Party of adequate protection or the asserting by any Second Priority Secured Party of any of its rights and remedies under the Second Priority Documents or otherwise, other than any action taken by such Second Priority Secured Party, that is expressly permitted by this Agreement; provided , however , that, notwithstanding Section 5.4 hereof, the First Priority Representative and the First Priority Secured Parties may object to the provision of cash payments as adequate protection to the Second Priority Secured Parties.

5.11 Effectiveness in Insolvency Proceedings . This Agreement, which the parties hereto expressly acknowledge is a “subordination agreement” under Section 510(a) of the Bankruptcy Code, shall be effective before, during and after the commencement of an Insolvency Proceeding. All references in this Agreement to any Loan Party shall include such Loan Party as a debtor-in-possession and any receiver or trustee for such Loan Party in any Insolvency Proceeding, and the rights and obligations hereunder of the First Priority Secured Parties and the Second Priority Secured Parties with respect to each Type of Collateral shall be fully enforceable as between such parties regardless of the pendency of Insolvency Proceedings or any related limitations on the enforcement of this Agreement against any Loan Party.

 

32


SECTION 6. Matters Relating to Loan Documents.

6.1 General .

(a) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, each Loan Party and the Second Priority Representative, on behalf of itself and the Second Priority Secured Parties, agrees that it shall not at any time execute or deliver any amendment or other modification to any of the Second Priority Documents inconsistent with or in violation of this Agreement.

(b) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, each Loan Party and the First Priority Representative, on behalf of itself and the First Priority Secured Parties, agrees that it shall not at any time execute or deliver any amendment or other modification to any of the First Priority Documents inconsistent with or in violation of this Agreement.

(c) With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, until the First Priority Obligations Payment Date, in the event the First Priority Representative enters into any amendment, waiver or consent in respect of any of the First Priority Security Documents for the purpose of adding to, or deleting from, or waiving or consenting to any departures from any provisions of, any First Priority Security Document or changing in any manner the rights of any parties thereunder, then such amendment, waiver or consent shall apply automatically to any comparable provision of the Comparable Second Lien Security Document without the consent of or action by any Second Priority Secured Party (with all such amendments, waivers and modifications subject to the terms hereof); provided that (other than with respect to amendments, modifications or waivers that secure additional extensions of credit and add additional secured creditors and do not violate the express provisions of the Second Priority Security Documents), (i) no such amendment, waiver or consent shall have the effect of removing assets subject to the Lien of any Second Priority Security Document, except to the extent that a release of such Lien is permitted by Section 4.2, (ii) any such amendment, waiver or consent that materially and adversely affects the rights of the Second Priority Secured Parties and does not affect the First Priority Secured Parties in a like or similar manner shall not apply to the Second Priority Security Documents, without the consent of the Second Priority Representative and (iii) notice of such amendment, waiver or consent shall be given to the Second Priority Representative no later than 30 days after its effectiveness, provided that the failure to give such notice shall not affect the effectiveness and validity thereof.

(d) Each of the Loan Parties and each of the Representatives agrees that the ABL Credit Agreement, the Term Loan Agreement (any notes issued pursuant thereto), the Notes Agreement (any notes issued pursuant thereto) and each First Priority Security Document and Second Priority Security Document entered into

 

33


on or after the date hereof shall contain the applicable provisions set forth on Annex I hereto, or similar provisions approved by the Representatives, which approval shall not be unreasonably withheld or delayed. Each Loan Party party hereto and each of the Representatives further agrees that each Mortgage covering any Common Collateral granted in favor of the Representative of the Secured Parties of any Class shall contain such other language as the Representative of the Secured Parties of each other Class may reasonably request to reflect the subordination of such Mortgage pursuant to this Agreement.

6.2 Restrictions on Refinancings .

(a) The Indebtedness under the ABL Credit Agreement may be Refinanced, in whole or in part, with the same or different lenders or Representatives in a Refinancing, without the consent of the Term Loan Agent or the Notes Agent or the holders of the Term Secured Obligations; provided , that (x) the holders of any such Refinancing (or the Representative thereof) shall have become bound in writing to the terms of this Agreement in the manner set forth in Section 11 (and shall have delivered a copy of the Joinder Agreement pursuant to which such holders or such Representative shall have become bound to the terms of this Agreement to each other party to this Agreement in the manner set forth in Section 10.8) and (y) no such Refinancing shall have the effect of increasing the principal amount of ABL Secured Obligations then outstanding or permitted to be outstanding (without regard to any borrowing base restrictions) to an amount that exceeds the Maximum Obligations Amount with respect to the ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents.

(b) The Indebtedness under the Term Secured Credit Documents may be Refinanced, in whole or in part, with the same or different lenders or Representatives in a Refinancing, without the consent of the ABL Agent or the holders of the ABL Secured Obligations; provided , that (x) the holders of any such Refinancing (or the Representative thereof) shall have become bound in writing to the terms of this Agreement in the manner set forth in Section 11 (and shall have delivered a copy of the Joinder Agreement pursuant to which such holders or such Representative shall have become bound to the terms of this Agreement to each other party to this Agreement in the manner set forth in Section 10.8) and (y) no such Refinancing shall have the effect of increasing the principal amount of Term Secured Obligations then outstanding or permitted to be outstanding to an amount that exceeds the Maximum Obligations Amount with respect to the Term Secured Credit Documents.

6.3 Restrictions on Amendments, Supplements and Modifications .

(a) The ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents may be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified in accordance with their terms; provided , however , that no such amendment, supplement or modification shall, without the

 

34


consent of the Term Loan Agent and the Notes Agent, have the effect of increasing the principal amount of ABL Secured Obligations then outstanding or permitted to be outstanding (without regard to any borrowing base restrictions) to an amount that exceeds the Maximum Obligations Amount with respect to the ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents.

(b) The Term Secured Credit Documents may be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified in accordance with their terms; provided , however , that no such amendment, supplement or modification shall, without the consent of the ABL Agent:

(i) have the effect of increasing the principal amount of Term Secured Obligations then outstanding or permitted to be outstanding to an amount that exceeds the Maximum Obligations Amount with respect to the Term Secured Credit Documents, or

(ii) have the effect of increasing the “Applicable Margin” or similar component of the interest rate (determined on the basis of yield) applicable to the loans outstanding or permitted to be outstanding under the applicable Term Loan Agreement or Note Agreement by more than 300 basis points (excluding increases resulting from the accrual of interest at the default rate).

SECTION 7. Cooperation with Respect to ABL Priority Collateral.

7.1 Consent to License to Use Intellectual Property . The First Priority Representative with respect to the Term Priority Collateral (and any purchaser, assignee or transferee of assets in connection with a Term Priority Collateral Enforcement Action) (a) consents (without any representation, warranty or obligation whatsoever) to the grant by any Loan Party to the ABL Agent of a non-exclusive royalty-free license to use during the ABL Priority Collateral Processing and Sale Period any Patents, Patent Licenses, Trademarks, Trademark Licenses or proprietary information of such Loan Party that is Term Priority Collateral (or any Patent, Patent License, Trademark, Trademark License or proprietary information acquired by such purchaser, assignee or transferee from any Loan Party, as the case may be) and (b) grants, in its capacity as a secured party (or as a purchaser, assignee or transferee, as the case may be), to the ABL Agent a non-exclusive royalty-free license to use during the ABL Priority Collateral Processing and Sale Period, any Patent, Patent License, Trademark, Trademark License or proprietary information that is Term Priority Collateral (or subject to such purchase, assignment or transfer, as the case may be), in each case in connection with the enforcement of any Lien held by the ABL Agent upon any inventory or other ABL Priority Collateral of any Loan Party and to the extent the use of such Patent, Patent License, Trademark, Trademark License or proprietary information is necessary or appropriate, in the good faith opinion of the ABL

 

35


Agent, to process, ship, produce, store, complete, supply, lease, sell or otherwise dispose of any such inventory in any lawful manner.

7.2 Access to Information . If the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, as First Priority Representative with respect to the Term Priority Collateral (or any other First Priority Representative with respect to the Term Priority Collateral), takes actual possession of any documentation of a Loan Party (whether such documentation is in the form of a writing or is stored in any data equipment or data record in the physical possession of the Term Loan Agent), then upon request of the ABL Agent and reasonable advance notice, the Authorized Term Collateral Agent (or such other First Priority Representative with respect to the Term Priority Collateral) will permit the ABL Agent or its representative to inspect and copy such documentation if and to the extent the ABL Agent certifies in writing to the Authorized Term Collateral Agent (or such other First Priority Representative with respect to the Term Priority Collateral) that:

(a) such documentation contains or may contain information necessary or appropriate, in the good faith opinion of the ABL Agent, to the enforcement of the ABL Agent’s Liens upon any ABL Priority Collateral; and

(b) the ABL Agent and the ABL Secured Parties are entitled to receive and use such information under applicable law and, in doing so, will comply with all obligations imposed by law or contract in respect of the disclosure or use of such information.

7.3 First Priority Representatives Assurances . The Authorized Term Collateral Agent, as First Priority Representative with respect to the Term Priority Collateral, and each other First Priority Representative with respect to the Term Priority Collateral, may condition its performance of any obligation set forth in this Section 7 upon its prior receipt (without cost to it) of:

(a) such assurances as it may reasonably request to confirm that the performance of such obligation and all activities of the ABL Agent or its officers, employees and agents in connection therewith or incidental thereto:

(i) will be permitted, lawful and enforceable under applicable law; and

(ii) will not impose upon the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, as First Priority Representative with respect to the Term Priority Collateral (or such other First Priority Secured Party with respect to such Collateral) any legal duty, legal liability, expense or risk of uninsured loss; and

 

36


(b) such indemnity, security and insurance as the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, as First Priority Representative with respect to the Term Priority Collateral (or such other First Priority Secured Party with respect to such Collateral), may reasonably request in connection therewith.

7.4 Loan Party Consent . The ABL Borrower and the other Loan Parties consent to the performance by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, as First Priority Representative with respect to the Term Priority Collateral, of the obligations set forth in this Section 7 and acknowledge and agree that neither the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, as First Priority Representative with respect to the Term Priority Collateral, nor any other First Priority Secured Party with respect to such Collateral shall ever be accountable or liable for any action taken or omitted by the ABL Agent or any ABL Secured Party or its or any of their officers, employees, agents successors or assigns in connection therewith or incidental thereto or in consequence thereof, including any improper use or disclosure of any proprietary information or other intellectual property by the ABL Agent or any ABL Secured Party or its or any of their officers, employees, agents, successors or assigns or any other damage to or misuse or loss of any property of the Loan Parties as a result of any action taken or omitted by the ABL Agent or its officers, employees, agents, successors or assigns.

SECTION 8. Reliance; Waivers; etc .

8.1 Reliance . The First Priority Documents and the Second Priority Documents are deemed to have been executed and delivered, and all extensions of credit thereunder are deemed to have been made or incurred, in reliance upon this Agreement. With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the Second Priority Representative, on behalf of it itself and the other Second Priority Secured Parties, expressly waives all notice of the acceptance of and reliance on this Agreement by the other Secured Parties.

8.2 No Warranties or Liability . The Second Priority Representative and the First Priority Representative with respect to each Type of Common Collateral acknowledge and agree that neither has made any representation or warranty with respect to the execution, validity, legality, completeness, collectibility or enforceability of any First Priority Document or any Second Priority Document. Except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, the Second Priority Representative and the First Priority Representative with respect to each Type of Common Collateral will be entitled to manage and supervise their respective extensions of credit to any Loan Party in accordance with law and their usual practices, modified from time to time as they deem appropriate.

8.3 No Waivers . No right or benefit of any party hereunder shall at any time in any way be prejudiced or impaired by any act or failure to act on the part of such party or any other party hereto or by any noncompliance by any Loan

 

37


Party with the terms and conditions of any of the First Priority Documents or any of the Second Priority Documents.

SECTION 9. Obligations Unconditional .

9.1 First Priority Obligations Unconditional . With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, all rights of the First Priority Representative hereunder, and all agreements and obligations of the Second Priority Representative and the Loan Parties hereunder, to the extent applicable, shall remain in full force and effect irrespective of:

(i) any lack of validity or enforceability of any First Priority Document;

(ii) any change in the time, place or manner of payment of, or in any other term of, all or any portion of the First Priority Obligations, or any amendment, waiver or other modification, whether by course of conduct or otherwise, or any Refinancing, replacement, refunding or restatement of any First Priority Document;

(iii) prior to the First Priority Obligations Payment Date, any exchange, release, voiding, avoidance or non-perfection of any security interest in any Common Collateral or any other collateral, or any release, amendment, waiver or other modification, whether by course of conduct or otherwise, or any Refinancing, replacement, refunding or restatement of all or any portion of the First Priority Obligations or any guarantee or guaranty thereof; or

(iv) any other circumstances that otherwise might constitute a defense available to, or a discharge of, any Loan Party in respect of the First Priority Obligations, or of any of the Second Priority Representative, or any Loan Party, to the extent applicable, in respect of this Agreement.

9.2 Second Priority Obligations Unconditional . Subject to compliance with the terms of this Agreement, with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, all rights and interests of the Second Priority Representative under this Agreement, and all agreements and obligations of the First Priority Representative and the Loan Parties, to the extent applicable, hereunder, shall remain in full force and effect irrespective of:

(i) any lack of validity or enforceability of any Second Priority Document;

(ii) any change in the time, place or manner of payment of, or in any other term of, all or any portion of the Second Priority Obligations,

 

38


or any amendment, waiver or other modification, whether by course of conduct or otherwise, or any Refinancing, replacement, refunding or restatement of any Second Priority Document;

(iii) any exchange, release, voiding, avoidance or non-perfection of any security interest in any Common Collateral, or any release, amendment, waiver or other modification, whether by course of conduct or otherwise, or any Refinancing, replacement, refunding or restatement of all or any portion of the Second Priority Obligations or any guarantee or guaranty thereof; or

(iv) any other circumstances that otherwise might constitute a defense available to, or a discharge of, any Loan Party in respect of the Second Priority Obligations, or of any of the First Priority Representative or other Loan Party, to the extent applicable, in respect of this Agreement.

SECTION 10. Miscellaneous .

10.1 Effectiveness of Term Intercreditor Agreement . Each Term Loan Agent and each Notes Agent acknowledges, on behalf of itself and on behalf of the Secured Parties that it represents, that any rights of such parties with respect to the Term Priority Collateral shall in all cases be controlled by, and subject to the terms and limitations set forth in, the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

10.2 Conflicts . Except as otherwise provided herein, in the event of any conflict between the provisions of this Agreement and the provisions of any First Priority Document or any Second Priority Document the provisions of this Agreement shall govern. In the event of any conflict between the provisions of this Agreement and the provisions of the Term Intercreditor Agreement, the provisions of this Agreement shall govern.

10.3 Continuing Nature of Provisions . This Agreement shall continue to be effective, and shall not be revocable by any party hereto, until (i) the First Priority Obligations Payment Date shall have occurred with respect to each Type of Common Collateral or (ii) the Second Priority Obligations Payment Date shall have occurred with respect to each Type of Common Collateral. This is a continuing agreement and the First Priority Secured Parties and the Second Priority Secured Parties may continue, at any time and without notice to the other parties hereto, to extend credit and other financial accommodations, lend monies and provide indebtedness to, or for the benefit of, any Loan Party on the faith hereof. Notwithstanding the foregoing, this Agreement shall terminate with respect to a Representative of any Secured Obligations to the extent such Secured Obligations have been satisfied and paid in full in cash. Holdings is a party hereto and agrees to cause each of its Subsidiaries that is a Loan Party to comply with the provisions of this Agreement applicable to such Subsidiary; provided that

 

39


Holdings shall not be deemed to be a Loan Party hereunder until such time, if any, as it shall meet the definition of “Loan Party” set forth in Section 1.1.

10.4 Amendments; Waivers .

(a) No amendment or modification of any of the provisions of this Agreement (other than pursuant to a Joinder Agreement or a Grantor Joinder Agreement) shall be effective unless the same shall be in writing and signed by the First Priority Representative and the Second Priority Representative and, in the case of amendments or modifications of Section 3.5, 3.6, 6.2, 6.3, 10.6, 10.7, 10.8 or 11, the ABL Borrower.

(b) It is understood that the First Priority Representative and the Second Priority Representative, without the consent of any other First Priority Secured Party or Second Priority Secured Party, may in their discretion determine that a supplemental agreement (which make take the form of an amendment and restatement of this Agreement) is necessary or appropriate to facilitate having additional indebtedness or other obligations (“ Additional Debt ”) of any of the Loan Parties become, with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, First Priority Obligations or Second Priority Obligations, as the case may be, under this Agreement, which supplemental agreement shall specify whether such Additional Debt, with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, constitutes First Priority Obligations or Second Priority Obligations, provided , that such Additional Debt (and the Liens securing same) is permitted to be incurred by the First Priority Documents and Second Priority Documents then extant, and is permitted by such First Priority Documents and Second Priority Documents to be subject to the provisions of this Agreement as First Priority Obligations or Second Priority Obligations, as applicable, with respect to each Type of Common Collateral. The provisions of this Section 10.4(b) are not intended to limit the provisions of Section 11.

10.5 Information Concerning Financial Condition of the ABL Borrower and the other Loan Parties . With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the Second Priority Representative, on behalf of itself and the other Second Priority Secured Parties, and the First Priority Representative, on behalf of itself and the other First Priority Secured Parties, hereby agree that each Secured Party assumes responsibility for keeping itself informed of the financial condition of the relevant Loan Parties and all other circumstances bearing upon the risk of nonpayment of the First Priority Obligations or the Second Priority Obligations. With respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the Second Priority Representative, on behalf of itself and the other Second Priority Secured Parties, and the First Priority Representative, on behalf of itself and the other First Priority Secured Parties, hereby agree that no party shall have any duty to advise any other party of information known to it regarding such condition or any such circumstances. In the event any Secured Party, in its sole discretion, undertakes at any time or from

 

40


time to time to provide any information to any other Secured Party, it shall be under no obligation (a) to provide any such information to such other party or any other party on any subsequent occasion, (b) to undertake any investigation not a part of its regular business routine, or (c) to disclose any other information.

10.6 Governing Law . This Agreement shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the law of the State of New York , except as otherwise required by mandatory provisions of law and except to the extent that remedies provided by the laws of any jurisdiction other than the State of New York are governed by the laws of such jurisdiction.

10.7 Jurisdiction; Consent to Service of Process .

(a) Each party hereto hereby irrevocably and unconditionally submits, for itself and its property, to the nonexclusive jurisdiction of the Supreme Court of the State of New York sitting in New York County and of the United States District Court of the Southern District of New York, and any appellate court from any thereof, in any action or proceeding arising out of or relating to this Agreement, or for recognition or enforcement of any judgment, and each party hereto hereby irrevocably and unconditionally agrees that all claims in respect of any such action or proceeding may be heard and determined in such New York State or, to the extent permitted by law, in such Federal court. Each party hereto agrees that a final judgment in any such action or proceeding shall be conclusive and may be enforced in other jurisdictions by suit on the judgment or in any other manner provided by law.

(b) Each of the parties hereto hereby irrevocably and unconditionally waives, to the fullest extent it may legally and effectively do so, any objection which it may now or hereafter have to the laying of venue of any suit, action or proceeding arising out of or relating to this Agreement in any New York State or federal court referred to in Section 10.7(a). Each party hereto hereby irrevocably waives, to the fullest extent permitted by law, the defense of an inconvenient forum to the maintenance of such action or proceeding in any such court.

(c) Each party to this Agreement irrevocably consents to service of process in the manner provided for notices in Section 10.8. Nothing in this Agreement will affect the right of any party to this Agreement to serve process in any other manner permitted by law.

10.8 Notices .

(c) Unless otherwise specifically provided herein, any notice or other communication herein required or permitted to be given shall be in writing and shall be delivered by hand or overnight courier service, mailed by certified or registered mail or sent by telecopy, as follows:

 

41


(i) If to a Loan Party:

c/o Tower Automotive, LLC

299 Park Avenue

New York, NY 10171

Facsimile:   (212) 891-1541
Attention:  

Dev B. Kapadia, Managing Director

Seth Gardner, Managing Director

and

c/o Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC

17672 N. Laurel Park Drive, Suite 400E

Livonia, MI 48152

Facsimile:   (248) 675-6800
Attention:  

James Gouin

Nanette Dudek

with a copy to (which shall not constitute notice):

Lowenstein Sandler PC

1251 Avenue of the Americas

New York, NY 10020

Facsimile:   (973) 597-2425
Attention:  

Robert G. Minion, Esq.

Lowell A. Citron, Esq.

(ii) If to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.:

JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.

c/o Loan and Agency Services Group

1111 Fannin, 10th Floor

Houston, TX 77002

Facsimile:   (713) 750-2938
Attention:   Allice Telles

and

JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.

270 Park Avenue

New York, NY 10017

Facsimile:   (212) 270-5127
Attention:   Richard Duker

 

42


(iii) If to Wilmington Trust FSB:

Wilmington Trust FSB, as Notes Agent

1100 North Market Street

Rodney Square North

Wilmington, Delaware 19890

Facsimile:   (302) 636-4145
Attention:   Michael Oller, Jr.

with a copy to (which shall not constitute notice):

Pillsbury Winthrop Shaw Pittman LLP

1540 Broadway

New York, New York 10036

Facsimile:   (212) 881-9368
Attention:  

Bart Pisella, Esq.

Timothy P. Kober, Esq.

(iv) If to any other holder of Indebtedness or Representative with respect thereto that becomes party hereto after the date hereof, to the address designated by such holder or such Representative in the Joinder Agreement pursuant to which such holder or such Representative shall have become a party hereto.

10.9 Successors and Assigns . This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of each of the parties hereto and each of the First Priority Secured Parties and the Second Priority Secured Parties and their respective successors and assigns, and nothing herein is intended, or shall be construed to give, any other Person any right, remedy or claim under, to or in respect of this Agreement or any Common Collateral or any Type thereof. All references to any Loan Party shall include any Loan Party as debtor-in-possession and any receiver or trustee for such Loan Party in any Insolvency Proceeding.

10.10 Headings . Section headings used herein are for convenience of reference only, are not part of this Agreement and shall not affect the construction of, or be taken into consideration in interpreting, this Agreement.

10.11 Severability . Any provision of this Agreement held to be invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any jurisdiction shall, as to such jurisdiction, be ineffective to the extent of such invalidity, illegality or unenforceability without affecting the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions hereof; and the invalidity of a particular provision in a particular jurisdiction shall not invalidate such provision in any other jurisdiction.

 

43


10.12 Counterparts; Integration; Effectiveness . This Agreement may be executed in counterparts (and by different parties hereto on different counterparts), each of which shall constitute an original, but all of which when taken together shall constitute a single contract. Delivery of an executed counterpart of a signature page of this Agreement by telecopy shall be effective as delivery of a manually executed counterpart of this Agreement. This Agreement shall become effective when it shall have been executed by each party hereto.

SECTION 11. Additional ABL Secured Obligations and Term Secured Obligations .

Holdco may from time to time, subject to any limitations contained in the ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents and the Term Secured Credit Documents in effect at such time, designate additional indebtedness and related obligations that are, or are to be, secured by Liens on any assets of the Loan Parties that would, if such Liens were granted, constitute Common Collateral as ABL Secured Obligations or Term Secured Obligations, by delivering to each Representative party hereto at such time a certificate of a Financial Officer of Holdco:

(a) describing the indebtedness and other obligations being designated as ABL Secured Obligations or Term Secured Obligations (as the case may be) and including a statement of the maximum aggregate outstanding principal amount of such indebtedness as of the date of such certificate;

(b) in the case of ABL Secured Obligations, confirming that such obligations shall be First Priority Obligations with respect to the ABL Priority Collateral and Second Priority Obligations with respect to the Term Priority Collateral;

(c) in the case of Term Secured Obligations, confirming that such obligations shall be First Priority Obligations with respect to the Term Priority Collateral and Second Priority Obligations with respect to the ABL Priority Collateral;

(d) identifying the Person that serves as the Representative with respect to such indebtedness and related obligations;

(e) certifying that the incurrence of such ABL Secured Obligations or Term Secured Obligations (as the case may be), the creation of the Liens securing such ABL Secured Obligations or Term Secured Obligations (as the case may be) and the designation of such indebtedness and related obligations as ABL Secured Obligations or Term Secured Obligations (as the case may be) hereunder do not violate or result in a default under any provision of any ABL Credit Agreement Loan Document or Term Secured Credit Document in effect at such time; and

 

44


(f) attaching a fully completed Joinder Agreement executed and delivered by the Representative with respect to such ABL Secured Obligations or Term Secured Obligations (as the case may be).

Upon the delivery of such certificate and the related attachments as provided above, the obligations designated in such notice shall become ABL Secured Obligations or Term Secured Obligations for all purposes of this Agreement.

In the event of any conflict or inconsistency between the provisions of this Section 11 and the provisions of Section 10.4(b), the provisions of this Section 11 shall govern.

[remainder of page intentionally left blank]

 

45


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Agreement as of the date first written above.

 

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,

as Representative with respect to the ABL Credit Agreement

By:  

/s/ Mary E. Gherty

  Name:   Mary E. Gherty
  Title:   Managing Director

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,

as Representative with respect to the Term Loan Agreement

By:  

/s/ Mary E. Gherty

  Name:   Mary E. Gherty
  Title:   Managing Director

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB,

as Representative with respect to the Indenture

By:  

/s/ Michael G. Oller, Jr.

  Name:   Michael G. Oller, Jr.
  Title:   Assistant Vice President


TOWER AUTOMOTIVE, LLC
By:  

/s/ Mark Malcolm

  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President and CEO
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC
By:  

/s/ Mark Malcolm

  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President and CEO
TA HOLDINGS FINANCE, INC.
By:  

/s/ Mark Malcolm

  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President and CEO
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS I, LLC
By:  

/s/ Mark Malcolm

  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President and CEO
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS II(a), LLC
By:  

/s/ Mark Malcolm

  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President and CEO
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS II(b), LLC
By:  

/s/ Mark Malcolm

  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President and CEO


TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS USA I, LLC

By:  

/s/ Mike Rajkovic

  Name:   Mike Rajkovic
  Title:   Vice President

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS USA II, LLC

By:  

/s/ Mike Rajkovic

  Name:   Mike Rajkovic
  Title:   Vice President

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS USA III, LLC

By:  

/s/ Mike Rajkovic

  Name:   Mike Rajkovic
  Title:   Vice President


Annex I

Provision for the [ABL Credit Agreement] [Term Loan Agreement][Notes Agreement]

“Reference is made to the Amended and Restated Intercreditor Agreement dated as of August 24, 2010 (as amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time, the “Intercreditor Agreement”), among the ABL Borrower, each of the other Loan Parties party thereto, [JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.,], as Representative with respect to the ABL Credit Agreement (as defined therein), [JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.], as Representative with respect to the Term Loan Agreement (as defined therein) [Wilmington Trust FSB], as Representative with respect to the Notes Agreement (as defined therein). Each [Lender] [Holder] hereunder (a) acknowledges that it has received a copy of the Intercreditor Agreement, (b) consents to the subordination of Liens provided for in the Intercreditor Agreement and the priorities in respect of the application of proceeds arising from any enforcement action with respect to the Collateral, (c) agrees that it will be bound by and will take no actions contrary to the provisions of the Intercreditor Agreement and (d) authorizes and instructs the [Agent] to enter into the Intercreditor Agreement as Representative and on behalf of such [Lender] [Holder]. The foregoing provisions are intended as an inducement to the [Lenders] [Holders] and to the [lenders] [holders] under the [ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents] [Term Loan Documents] [Notes Documents] to [extend credit] [provide financing] to the Loan Parties and to permit the incurrence of Indebtedness under [the ABL Credit Agreement] [and the Term Loan Agreement] [and the Notes Agreement], and such [lenders] [holders] are intended third party beneficiaries of such provisions.”

Provision for each First Priority Security Document and Second Priority Security Document

Amended and Restated Intercreditor Agreement dated as of August 24, 2010 (as amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time, the “Intercreditor Agreement”), among the ABL Borrower, each of the other Loan Parties party thereto, [JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.,], as Representative with respect to the ABL Credit Agreement (as defined therein), [JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.], as Representative with respect to the Term Loan Agreement (as defined therein) [Wilmington Trust FSB], as Representative with respect to the Notes Agreement (as defined therein). Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, the lien and security interest granted to the [Agent], for the benefit of the [Secured Parties], pursuant to this Agreement and the exercise of any right or remedy by the [Agent] and the other [Secured Parties] hereunder are subject to the


provisions of the Intercreditor Agreement. In the event of any conflict or inconsistency between the provisions of the Intercreditor Agreement and this Agreement, the provisions of the Intercreditor Agreement shall control.”


Annex II

[FORM OF] JOINDER AGREEMENT NO. [    ] dated as of [            ], 20[    ] (the “ Joinder Agreement ”) to the AMENDED AND RESTATED INTERCREDITOR AGREEMENT dated as of August 24, 2010 (the “ ABL Intercreditor Agreement ”), among JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Representative with respect to the ABL Credit Agreement, JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Representative with respect to the Term Loan Agreement, WILMINGTON TRUST FSB, as Representative with respect to the Notes Agreement, each other Representative from time to time party thereto, TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC (the “ ABL Borrower ”) and each of the other Loan Parties party thereto.

A. Capitalized terms used herein but not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings assigned to such terms in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

B. Holdco and/or one or more of the other Loan Parties proposes to issue or incur additional [ABL Secured Obligations] [Term Secured Obligations] and the Person identified in the signature pages hereto as the “Representative” (the “ Additional Representative ”) will serve as the agent, trustee, or other representative for the holders of such [ABL Secured Obligations] [Term Secured Obligations]. The [ABL Secured Obligations] [Term Secured Obligations] are being designated as such by Holdco in accordance with Section 11 of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

C. The Additional Term Agent wishes to become a party to the Term Intercreditor Agreement and to acquire and undertake, for itself and on behalf of the Additional Term Secured Parties, the rights and obligations of an “Additional Term Agent” thereunder. The Additional Term Agent is entering into this Joinder Agreement in accordance with the provisions of the Term Intercreditor Agreement in order to become an Additional Term Agent thereunder.

Accordingly, the Additional Representative and Holdco agree as follows, for the benefit of the Additional Representative, the ABL Borrower and each other party to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement:

Section 1. Accession to the Intercreditor Agreement . The Additional Representative (a) hereby accedes and becomes a party to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement as a Representative for the holders of the additional [ABL Secured Obligations] [Term Secured Obligations] (the “ Additional Secured Parties ”), (b) agrees, for itself and on behalf of the Additional Secured Parties from time to time in respect of the additional [ABL Secured Obligations] [Term Secured Obligations], to all the terms and provisions of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement and (c) shall have all the rights and obligations of a Representative under the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.


Section 2. Representations, Warranties and Acknowledgement of the Additional Representative . The Additional Representative represents and warrants to each other Representative and to the Secured Parties that (a) it has full power and authority to enter into this Joinder Agreement, in its capacity as the Representative with respect to the additional [ABL Secured Obligations] [Term Secured Obligations], (b) this Joinder Agreement has been duly authorized, executed and delivered by it and constitutes its legal, valid and binding obligation, enforceable against it in accordance with the terms of this Joinder Agreement and (c) the [ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents] [Term Secured Credit Documents] relating to such additional [ABL Secured Obligations] [Term Secured Obligations] provide that, upon the Additional Representative’s entry into this Joinder Agreement, the secured parties in respect of such additional [ABL Secured Obligations] [Term Secured Obligations] will be subject to and bound by the provisions of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

Section 3. Counterparts . This Joinder Agreement may be executed in multiple counterparts, each of which shall constitute an original, but all of which when taken together shall constitute a single contract. This Joinder Agreement shall become effective when each other Representative shall have received a counterpart of this Joinder Agreement that bears the signature of the Additional Representative. Delivery of an executed signature page to this Joinder Agreement by facsimile or other electronic transmission (including PDF copies) shall be effective as delivery of a manually signed counterpart of this Joinder Agreement.

Section 4. Benefit of Agreement . The agreements set forth herein or undertaken pursuant hereto are for the benefit of, and may be enforced by, any party to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

Section 5. Governing Law . THIS JOINDER AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.

Section 6. Severability . In case any one or more of the provisions contained in this Joinder Agreement should be held invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any respect, none of the parties hereto shall be required to comply with such provision for so long as such provision is held to be invalid, illegal or unenforceable, but the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions contained herein and in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement shall not in any way be affected or impaired. The parties hereto shall endeavor in good-faith negotiations to replace the invalid, illegal or unenforceable provisions with valid provisions the economic effect of which comes as close as possible to that of the invalid, illegal or unenforceable provisions.

Section 7. Notices . All communications and notices hereunder shall be in writing and given as provided in Section 10.8 of the ABL Intercreditor


Agreement. All communications and notices hereunder to the Additional Representative shall be given to it at the address set forth under its signature hereto, which information supplements Section 10.8 of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

Section 8. Expenses . Holdco agrees to reimburse each Representative for its reasonable out-of-pocket expenses in connection with this Joinder Agreement, including the reasonable fees, other charges and disbursements of counsel for each Representative.


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Additional Representative has duly executed this Joinder Agreement to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement as of the day and year first above written.

 

[NAME OF ADDITIONAL REPRESENTATIVE], as REPRESENTATIVE with respect to [NAME OF AGREEMENT] and holders of the [Secured Obligations] thereunder
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
Address for notices:

 

 

 

  attention of:  

 

  Telecopy:  

 

 

57


Acknowledged by:

 

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Representative with respect to the ABL Credit Agreement

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Representative with respect to the Term Loan Agreement

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB, as Representative with respect to the Notes Agreement

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

[EACH OTHER REPRESENTATIVE], as Representative with respect to [the [            ] Agreement]


By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:


Annex III

[FORM OF] GRANTOR JOINDER AGREEMENT NO. [    ] dated as of [            ], 20[    ] (the “ Grantor Joinder Agreement ”) to the AMENDED AND RESTATED INTERCREDITOR AGREEMENT dated as of August 24, 2010 (the “ ABL Intercreditor Agreement ”), among JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Representative with respect to the ABL Credit Agreement, JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Representative with respect to the Term Loan Agreement, WILMINGTON TRUST FSB, as Representative with respect to the Notes Agreement, each other Representative from time to time party thereto, TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC (the “ ABL Borrower ”) and each of the other Loan Parties party thereto.

A. Capitalized terms used herein but not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings assigned to such terms in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

B. [        ], a Subsidiary of Holdco (the “ Additional Grantor ”), has granted a Lien on all or a portion of its assets to secure [ABL Secured Obligations] [and] [Term Secured Obligations] and such Additional Grantor is not a party to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

C. The Additional Grantor wishes to become a party to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement and to acquire and undertake the rights and obligations of a Loan Party thereunder. The Additional Grantor is entering into this Grantor Joinder Agreement in accordance with the provisions of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement in order to become a Loan Party thereunder.

Accordingly, the Additional Grantor agrees as follows, for the benefit of the Representatives, Holdco, the ABL Borrower and each other party to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement:

Section 1. Accession to the Intercreditor Agreement . The Additional Grantor (a) hereby accedes and becomes a party to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement as a Loan Party with the same force and effect as if originally named therein as a Loan Party, (b) agrees to all the terms and provisions of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement and (c) shall have all the rights and obligations of a Loan Party under the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

Section 2. Representations, Warranties and Acknowledgment of the Additional Grantor . The Additional Grantor represents and warrants to each Representative and to the Secured Parties that this Grantor Joinder Agreement has been duly authorized, executed and delivered by such Additional Grantor and constitutes the legal, valid and binding obligation, enforceable against it in accordance with its terms, subject to applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium or other laws affecting creditors’ rights generally and


subject to general principles of equity, regardless of whether considered in a proceeding in equity or at law.

Section 3. Counterparts . This Grantor Joinder Agreement may be executed in multiple counterparts, each of which shall constitute an original, but all of which when taken together shall constitute a single contract. This Grantor Joinder Agreement shall become effective when each Representative shall have received a counterpart of this Grantor Joinder Agreement that bears the signature of the Additional Grantor. Delivery of an executed signature page to this Grantor Joinder Agreement by facsimile or other electronic transmission (including PDF copies) shall be effective as delivery of a manually signed counterpart of this Grantor Joinder Agreement.

Section 4. Benefit of Agreement . The agreements set forth herein or undertaken pursuant hereto are for the benefit of, and may be enforced by, any party to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

Section 5. Governing Law . THIS GRANTOR JOINDER AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.

Section 6. Severability . In case any one or more of the provisions contained in this Grantor Joinder Agreement should be held invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any respect, none of the parties hereto shall be required to comply with such provision for so long as such provision is held to be invalid, illegal or unenforceable, but the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions contained herein and in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement shall not in any way be affected or impaired. The parties hereto shall endeavor in good-faith negotiations to replace the invalid, illegal or unenforceable provisions with valid provisions the economic effect of which comes as close as possible to that of the invalid, illegal or unenforceable provisions.

Section 7. Notices . All communications and notices hereunder shall be in writing and given as provided in Section 10.8 of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

Section 8. The Additional Grantor agrees to reimburse each Representative for its reasonable out-of-pocket expenses in connection with this Grantor Joinder Agreement, including the reasonable fees, other charges and disbursements of counsel for each Representative.


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Additional Grantor has duly executed this Grantor Joinder Agreement to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement as of the day and year first above written.

 

[NAME OF SUBSIDIARY]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:


Acknowledged by:

 

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Representative with respect to the ABL Credit Agreement

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
 

 

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Representative with respect to the Term Loan Agreement

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB, as Representative with respect to the Notes Agreement

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

[EACH OTHER REPRESENTATIVE], as Representative with respect to [the [            ] Agreement]


By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

Exhibit 10.10

Execution Copy

TERM INTERCREDITOR AGREEMENT

dated as of

August 24, 2010

among

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,

as Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB,

as Notes Collateral Agent,

each Additional Term Agent from time to time party hereto,

each Grantor from time to time party hereto

and

Tower Automotive, LLC


TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

 

 

     P AGE

ARTICLE 1

D EFINITIONS

Section 1.01. Construction; Certain Defined Terms

   1
ARTICLE 2
P RIORITIES AND A GREEMENTS WITH R ESPECT TO C OMMON C OLLATERAL

Section 2.01 . Priority of Claims

   10

Section 2.02 . Actions with Respect to Common Collateral; Prohibition on Contesting Liens

   12

Section 2.03 . No Interference; Payment Over

   14

Section 2.04 . Automatic Release of Liens; Amendments to Term Security Documents

   15

Section 2.05 . Certain Agreements with Respect to Bankruptcy or Insolvency Proceedings

   16

Section 2.06 . Reinstatement

   17

Section 2.07 . Insurance

   17

Section 2.08 . Refinancings

   17

Section 2.09 . Possessory or Control Collateral Agent

   18
ARTICLE 3
A DDITIONAL T ERM O BLIGATIONS
ARTICLE 4
E XISTENCE AND A MOUNTS OF L IENS AND O BLIGATIONS
ARTICLE 5
T HE A UTHORIZED T ERM C OLLATERAL A GENT

Section 5.01 . Authority

   21

Section 5.02 . Rights as a Term Secured Party

   22

Section 5.03 . Exculpatory Provisions

   22

Section 5.04 . Reliance by Authorized Term Collateral Agent

   24

Section 5.05 . Delegation of Duties

   25

Section 5.06 . Non-reliance on Authorized Term Collateral Agent and Term Secured Parties

   25

 

i


ARTICLE 6
M ISCELLANEOUS

Section 6.01 . Notices

   25

Section 6.02 . Waivers; Amendment; Joinder Agreements

   27

Section 6.03 . Parties in Interest

   27

Section 6.04 . Survival of Agreement

   28

Section 6.05 . Counterparts, Integration, Effectiveness

   28

Section 6.06 . Severability

   28

Section 6.07 . Governing Law

   28

Section 6.08 . Jurisdiction; Consent to Service of Process

   28

Section 6.09 . Waiver of Jury Trial

   29

Section 6.10 . Headings

   29

Section 6.11 . Conflicts

   29

Section 6.12 . Provisions Solely to Define Relative Rights

   29

Section 6.13 . Integration

   30

Section 6.14 . Cooperation

   30

 

ii


TERM INTERCREDITOR AGREEMENT (as amended, restated, modified or supplemented from time to time, this “ Agreement ”) dated as of August 24, 2010, among JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as agent for the Synthetic Letter of Credit Secured Parties (as defined below) (in such capacity and together with its successors in such capacity, the “ Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent ”), WILMINGTON TRUST FSB, as collateral agent for the Notes Secured Parties (as defined below) (in such capacity and together with its successors and assigns in such capacity, the “ Notes Collateral Agent ”), each Additional Term Agent (as defined below) from time to time party hereto for the Additional Term Secured Parties (as defined below) of the Series (as defined below) with respect to which it is acting in such capacity, each Grantor (as defined below), each Additional Grantor (as defined below) and Tower Automotive, LLC.

In consideration of the mutual agreements herein contained and other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent (for itself and on behalf of the Synthetic Letter of Credit Secured Parties), the Notes Collateral Agent (for itself and on behalf of the Notes Secured Parties), each Additional Term Agent (for itself and on behalf of the Additional Term Secured Parties of the applicable Series), each Grantor and each Additional Grantor agree as follows:

A RTICLE 1

D EFINITIONS

Section 1.01. Construction; Certain Defined Terms .

(a) The definitions of terms herein shall apply equally to the singular and plural forms of the terms defined. Whenever the context may require, any pronoun shall include the corresponding masculine, feminine and neuter forms. The words “include”, “includes” and “including” shall be deemed to be followed by the phrase “without limitation”. The word “will” shall be construed to have the same meaning and effect as the word “shall”. Unless the context requires otherwise, (i) any definition of or reference to any agreement, instrument, other document, statute or regulation herein shall be construed as referring to such agreement, instrument, other document, statute or regulation as from time to time amended, supplemented or otherwise modified, (ii) any reference herein to any Person shall be construed to include such Person’s successors and assigns, but shall not be deemed to include the Subsidiaries of such Person unless express reference is made to such Subsidiaries, (iii) the words “herein”, “hereof and “hereunder”, and words of similar import, shall be construed to refer to this Agreement in its entirety and not to any particular provision hereof, (iv) all references herein to Articles, Sections and Annexes shall be construed to refer to Articles, Sections and Annexes of this Agreement, (v) unless otherwise expressly


qualified herein, the words “asset” and “property” shall be construed to have the same meaning and effect and to refer to any and all tangible and intangible assets and properties, including cash, securities, accounts and contract rights and (vi) the term “or” is not exclusive.

(b) It is the intention of the Term Secured Parties of each Series that the holders of Term Obligations of such Series (other than the Authorized Term Collateral Agent and the other Collateral Agents, and not the Term Secured Parties of any other Series) bear the risk of (i) any determination by a court of competent jurisdiction that (x) any of the Term Obligations of such Series are unenforceable under applicable law or are subordinated to any other obligations (other than another Series of Term Obligations), (y) any of the Term Obligations of such Series do not have an enforceable security interest in any of the Collateral securing any other Series of Term Obligations and/or (z) any intervening security interest exists securing any other obligations (other than another Series of Term Obligations) on a basis ranking prior to the security interest of such Series of Term Obligations but junior to the security interest of any other Series of Term Obligations or (ii) the existence of any Collateral for any other Series of Term Obligations that is not Common Collateral (any such condition referred to in the foregoing clauses (i) or (ii) with respect to any Series of Term Obligations, an “ Impairment ” of such Series). In the event of any Impairment with respect to any Series of Term Obligations, the results of such Impairment shall be borne solely by the holders of such Series of Term Obligations (other than the Authorized Term Collateral Agent and the other Collateral Agents), and the rights of the holders of such Series of Term Obligations (including, without limitation, the right to receive distributions in respect of such Series of Term Obligations pursuant to Section 2.01) (except the rights of the Authorized Term Collateral Agent and the other Collateral Agents) set forth herein shall be modified to the extent necessary so that the effects of such Impairment are borne solely by the holders of the Series of such Term Obligations (other than the Authorized Term Collateral Agent and the other Collateral Agents) subject to such Impairment. Additionally, in the event the Term Obligations of any Series are modified pursuant to applicable law (including, without limitation, pursuant to Section 1129 of the Bankruptcy Code), any reference to such Term Obligations or the Secured Credit Documents governing such Term Obligations shall refer to such obligations or such documents as so modified.

(c) As used in this Agreement, the following terms have the meanings specified below:

ABL Borrower ” means Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC.

ABL Credit Agreement ” shall have the meaning assigned to such term in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

 

2


ABL Intercreditor Agreement ” means that certain Amended and Restated Intercreditor Agreement dated as of August 24, 2010 among the ABL Borrower, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as representative with respect to the ABL Credit Agreement, the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent, the Notes Collateral Agent and the other loan parties from time to time party thereto.

Additional Grantor ” means any Grantor which becomes party to this Agreement pursuant to a Grantor Joinder Agreement.

Additional Term Agent ” shall have the meaning assigned to such term in Section 3(b).

Additional Term Agreement ” means the each of the indentures or other agreements under which Additional Term Obligations of any Series are issued or incurred and all other instruments, agreements and other documents evidencing or governing Additional Term Obligations of such Series or providing any guarantee, Lien or other right in respect thereof.

Additional Term Obligations ” shall mean all obligations of the Grantors that shall have been designated as such pursuant to Article 3.

Additional Term Secured Parties ” means the holders of any Additional Term Obligations and the corresponding Authorized Representative with respect thereto.

Affiliate ” of any specified Person means any other Person, directly or indirectly, controlling or controlled by or under direct or indirect common control with such specified Person. For the purposes of this definition, “control” when used with respect to any Person means the power to direct the management and policies of such Person, directly or indirectly, whether through the ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise; and the terms “controlling” and “controlled” have meanings correlative to the foregoing.

Agreement ” shall have the meaning assigned to such term in the introductory paragraph of this Agreement.

Applicable Authorized Agent Date ” means the date upon which the Notes Obligations have been paid in full in cash.

Authorized Representative ” means (i) in the case of any Term Loan Obligations or the Synthetic Letter of Credit Secured Parties, the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent, (ii) in the case of the Notes Obligations or the Notes Secured Parties, the Notes Collateral Agent and (iii) in the case of any Series of Additional Term Obligations or Additional Term Secured Parties that become

 

3


subject to this Agreement after the date hereof, the Additional Term Agent named for such Series in the applicable Joinder Agreement.

Authorized Term Collateral Agent ” means, with respect to any Common Collateral, (i) until the earlier of (x) the Applicable Authorized Agent Date and (y) the Non-Controlling Authorized Representative Enforcement Date, the Notes Collateral Agent and (ii) from and after the earlier of (x) the Applicable Authorized Agent Date and (y) the Non-Controlling Authorized Representative Enforcement Date, the Major Non-Controlling Authorized Representative.

Bankruptcy Case ” shall have the meaning assigned to such term in Section 2.05(b).

Bankruptcy Code ” shall mean Title 11 of the United States Code, as amended.

Bankruptcy Law ” shall mean the Bankruptcy Code and any similar Federal, state or foreign law for the relief of debtors.

Business Day ” means each day which is not a Legal Holiday.

Collateral ” means all assets and properties subject to Liens created pursuant to any Term Security Document to secure one or more Series of Term Obligations.

Collateral Agents ” means, collectively, (a) the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent, (b) the Notes Collateral Agent and (c) each Additional Term Agent, and “ Collateral Agent ” means any of them.

Common Collateral ” means, at any time, Collateral on which Liens have been granted to secure two or more Series of Term Obligations; provided that “Common Collateral” shall also include rights to payment pursuant to Section 4.1 of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement to which the holders of two or more Series of Term Obligations (or their Authorized Representatives) would be entitled (and any reference in this Agreement to any valid and perfected lien of any Series of Term Obligations with respect to any such rights to payment under such Section shall mean that the holders of such Series (or their Authorized Representatives) are entitled to such payment pursuant to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement). If more than two Series of Term Obligations are outstanding at any time and not every Series of Term Obligations is secured by valid and perfected security interests in or Liens on any Collateral at such time, then such Collateral shall constitute Common Collateral for each Series of Term Obligations that is secured by valid and perfected security interests in or Liens on any Collateral at such time and shall not constitute Common Collateral for any Series of Term

 

4


Obligations that is not secured by valid and perfected security interests in or Liens on such Collateral at such time.

Control Collateral ” means any Common Collateral in the control of the Authorized Term Collateral Agent (or its agents or bailees), to the extent that control thereof perfects a Lien thereon under the Uniform Commercial Code of any jurisdiction or otherwise. Control Collateral includes, without limitation, Deposit Accounts, Electronic Chattel Paper, Investment Property or Letter-of-Credit Rights. All capitalized terms used in this definition and not defined elsewhere in this Agreement have the meanings assigned to them in the New York UCC.

Controlling Secured Parties ” means, with respect to any Common Collateral, the Series of Term Secured Parties whose Authorized Representative is the Authorized Term Collateral Agent for such Common Collateral.

DIP Financing ” shall have the meaning assigned to such term in Section 2.05(b).

DIP Financing Liens ” shall have the meaning assigned to such term in Section 2.05(b).

DIP Lenders ” shall have the meaning assigned to such term in Section 2.05(b).

Discharge ” means, with respect to any Series of Term Obligations, the date on which such Series of Term Obligations is no longer secured by any Common Collateral. The term “ Discharged ” shall have a corresponding meaning.

Event of Default ” shall have the meaning set forth in the Term Loan Agreement, Indenture or the relevant Additional Term Agreement, as applicable.

Existing Real Property Collateral ” means the fee and leasehold interests of the Grantors in the real property described on Schedule 3 to the Notes Security Agreement as in effect on the date hereof.

Financial Officer ” means, with respect to any Person, the chief financial officer, controller or treasurer of such Person.

Grantor Joinder Agreement ” means a supplement to this Agreement substantially in the form of Exhibit B, appropriately completed.

 

5


Grantors ” means Holdco, the ABL Borrower and each other Subsidiary of Holdco that has granted a security interest pursuant to any Term Security Document to secure any Series of Term Obligations.

Holdco ” means Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC.

Impairment ” shall have the meaning assigned to such term in Section 1.01(b).

Indenture ” means that certain Indenture dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Parent, the Issuers, the subsidiary guarantors identified therein and Wilmington Trust FSB, as trustee (in such capacity, the “ Trustee ”) and the Notes Collateral Agent.

Insolvency or Liquidation Proceeding ” shall mean, with respect to any Person, any (a) insolvency, bankruptcy, receivership, reorganization, readjustment, composition or other similar proceeding relating to such Person or its property or creditors in such capacity, (b) proceeding for any liquidation, dissolution or other winding up of such Person, voluntary or involuntary, whether or not involving insolvency or proceedings under the Bankruptcy Code, whether partial or complete and whether by operation of law or otherwise, (c) assignment for the benefit of creditors of such Person or (d) other marshalling of the assets of such Person.

Intervening Creditor ” shall have the meaning assigned to such term in Section 2.01(a).

Issue Date ” means the date Notes are first issued under the Indenture.

Issuers ” means, collectively, the ABL Borrower and TA Holdings Finance, Inc.

Joinder Agreement ” means a supplement to this Agreement substantially in the form of Exhibit A, appropriately completed.

Legal Holiday ” means a Saturday, Sunday or other day on which the Trustee or banking institutions are not required by law or regulation to be open in the State of New York.

Lien ” shall mean (a) any mortgage, deed of trust, pledge, hypothecation, security interest, encumbrance, lien or charge of any kind whatsoever, (b) the interest of a vendor or a lessor under any conditional sale, capital lease or other title retention agreement (or any financing lease having substantially the same economic effect as any of the foregoing) and (c) in the case of securities, any

 

6


purchase option, call or similar right of a third party with respect to such securities.

Major Non-Controlling Authorized Representative ” means, with respect to any Common Collateral, the Authorized Representative of the Series of Term Obligations that constitutes the largest outstanding principal amount of any then outstanding Series of Term Obligations with respect to such Common Collateral (but in no event shall be the Notes Collateral Agent).

New York UCC ” shall mean the Uniform Commercial Code as from time to time in effect in the State of New York.

Non-Controlling Authorized Representative ” means, at any time with respect to any Common Collateral, any Authorized Representative that is not the Authorized Term Collateral Agent at such time with respect to such Common Collateral.

Non-Controlling Authorized Representative Enforcement Date ” means, with respect to any Non-Controlling Authorized Representative, the date which is 180 days (throughout which 180-day period such Non-Controlling Authorized Representative was the Major Non-Controlling Authorized Representative) after the occurrence of both (i) an Event of Default (under and as defined in the Indenture, the Term Loan Agreement or the other indenture or credit agreement for that Series of Term Obligations under which such Non-Controlling Authorized Representative is the Authorized Representative) and (ii) the Authorized Term Collateral Agent’s and each other Authorized Representative’s receipt of written notice from such Non-Controlling Authorized Representative certifying that (x) such Non-Controlling Authorized Representative is and has been the Major Non-Controlling Authorized Representative for such preceding 180-day period and that an Event of Default (under and as defined in the Indenture, the Term Loan Agreement or the other indenture or credit agreement for that Series of Term Obligations under which such Non-Controlling Authorized Representative is the Authorized Representative) has occurred and is continuing and (y) the Term Obligations of the Series with respect to which such Non-Controlling Authorized Representative is the Authorized Representative are currently due and payable in full (whether as a result of acceleration thereof or otherwise) in accordance with the terms of the Indenture, the Term Loan Agreement or the other indenture or credit agreement for that Series of Term Obligations; provided that the Non-Controlling Authorized Representative Enforcement Date shall be stayed and shall not occur and shall be deemed not to have occurred with respect to any Common Collateral (1) at any time the Authorized Term Collateral Agent has commenced and is diligently pursuing any enforcement action with respect to any material portion of such Common Collateral or (2) at any time any Grantor that has granted a security

 

7


interest in such Common Collateral is then a debtor under or with respect to (or otherwise subject to) any Insolvency or Liquidation Proceeding.

Non-Controlling Secured Parties ” means, with respect to any Common Collateral, the Term Secured Parties which are not Controlling Secured Parties with respect to such Common Collateral.

Notes ” shall mean the 10.625% Senior Secured Notes due 2017 of the Issuers issued pursuant to the Indenture.

Notes Collateral Agent ” shall have the meaning assigned to such term in the introductory paragraph to this Agreement.

Notes Obligations ” means the “Secured Obligations” as defined in the Notes Security Agreement.

Notes Secured Parties ” means the “Secured Parties” as defined in the Notes Security Agreement.

Notes Security Agreement ” means the Notes Security Agreement, dated as of the date hereof, by and among the Issuers, the subsidiary guarantors party thereto and the Notes Collateral Agent, as the same may be amended, restated, supplemented or modified from time to time.

Other Agents ” means the administrative agent under the Term Loan Agreement, the Trustee and the Paying Agent.

Parent ” means Tower Automotive, LLC.

Paying Agent ” shall have the meaning assigned to such term in the Indenture.

Person ” means any individual, corporation, partnership, limited liability company, joint venture, association, joint-stock company, trust, unincorporated organization, government or any agency or political subdivision thereof or any other entity.

Possessory Collateral ” means any Common Collateral in the possession of the Authorized Term Collateral Agent (or its agents or bailees), to the extent that possession thereof perfects a Lien thereon under the Uniform Commercial Code of any jurisdiction or otherwise. Possessory Collateral includes, without limitation, Certificated Securities, Negotiable Documents, Goods, Money, Instruments, and Tangible Chattel Paper, in each case, delivered to or in the possession of the Authorized Term Collateral Agent under the terms of the Term Security Documents. All capitalized terms used in this definition and not defined

 

8


elsewhere in this Agreement have the meanings assigned to them in the New York UCC.

Proceeds ” shall have the meaning assigned to such term in Section 2.01(a).

Refinance ” means, in respect of any indebtedness, to refinance, extend, renew, defease, amend, increase, modify, supplement, restructure, refund, replace or repay, or to issue other indebtedness or enter alternative financing arrangements, in exchange or replacement for such indebtedness (in whole or in part), including by adding or replacing lenders, creditors, agents, borrowers and/or guarantors, and including in each case, but not limited to, after the original instrument giving rise to such indebtedness has been terminated and including, in each case, through any credit agreement, indenture or other agreement. “ Refinanced ” and “ Refinancing ” have correlative meanings.

Secured Credit Documents ” means (i) the Term Loan Agreement and the Loan Documents (as defined in the Term Loan Agreement), (ii) the Indenture and each Security Document (as defined in the Indenture) and (iii) each Additional Term Agreement.

Security Agreements ” means (i) the Term Loan Security Agreement and (ii) the Notes Security Agreement.

Series ” means (a) with respect to the Term Secured Parties, each of (i) the Synthetic Letter of Credit Secured Parties (in their capacities as such), (ii) the Notes Secured Parties (in their capacity as such) and (iii) the Additional Term Secured Parties that become subject to this Agreement after the date hereof that are represented by a common Authorized Representative (in its capacity as such for such Additional Term Secured Parties) and (b) with respect to any Term Obligations, each of (i) the Term Loan Obligations, (ii) the Notes Obligations and (iii) the Additional Term Obligations incurred pursuant to any Additional Term Agreement, which pursuant to any Joinder Agreement, are to be represented hereunder by a common Authorized Representative (in its capacity as such for such Additional Term Obligations).

Subsidiary ” shall have the meaning assigned to such term in the Indenture.

Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent ” shall have the meaning assigned to such term in the introductory paragraph hereof.

Synthetic Letter of Credit Secured Parties ” means the “Secured Parties” as defined in the Term Loan Agreement.

 

9


Term Loan Agreement ” means that certain First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007 (as amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, refinanced or replaced from time to time), among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and Tower Automotive Holdings Europe B.V., as borrowers, the guarantors party thereto, the lenders party thereto and the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent.

Term Loan Obligations ” means the “Secured Obligations” as defined in the Term Loan Agreement.

Term Loan Security Agreement ” means that certain First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement dated as of July 31, 2007 among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the guarantors from time to time party thereto and the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent, as the same may be amended, restated, supplemented or modified from time to time.

Term Obligations ” means, collectively, (i) the Term Loan Obligations, (ii) the Notes Obligations and (iii) each Series of Additional Term Obligations.

Term Security Documents ” means the Security Agreements and each other agreement entered into in favor of a Collateral Agent for purposes of securing any Series of Term Obligations.

Term Secured Parties ” means (a) the Synthetic Letter of Credit Secured Parties, (b) the Notes Secured Parties and (c) the Additional Term Secured Parties.

Trustee ” shall have the meaning assigned to such term in the definition of Indenture.

ARTICLE 2

P RIORITIES AND A GREEMENTS WITH R ESPECT TO C OMMON C OLLATERAL

Section 2.01 . Priority of Claims.

(a) Anything contained herein or in any of the Secured Credit Documents to the contrary notwithstanding (but subject to Section 1.01(b) of this Agreement), if an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, and the Authorized Term Collateral Agent is taking action to enforce rights in respect of any Common Collateral, or any distribution is made in respect of any Common Collateral in any Bankruptcy Case of any Grantor or any Term Secured Party receives any payment pursuant to any intercreditor agreement (other than this Agreement) with respect to any Common Collateral, the proceeds of any sale,

 

10


collection or other liquidation of any such Common Collateral by any Term Secured Party or received by any Collateral Agent pursuant to any such intercreditor agreement with respect to such Common Collateral and proceeds of any such distribution (subject, in the case of any such distribution, to the sentence immediately following) to which the Term Obligations are entitled under any intercreditor agreement (other than this Agreement) (all proceeds of any sale, collection or other liquidation of any Common Collateral and all proceeds of any such distribution being collectively referred to as “ Proceeds ”), shall be applied as follows:

FIRST, to the payment of all reasonable fees, costs and expenses incurred by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent in connection with such collection or sale or otherwise in connection with this Agreement, or any other Term Security Document or any of the Term Obligations, including all court costs and the reasonable fees and expenses of its agents, professional advisors and legal counsel, the repayment of all advances made by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent hereunder or under any other Term Security Document on behalf of the Grantors, if any, and any other reasonable costs or expenses incurred in connection with the exercise of any right or remedy hereunder or under any other Term Security Document;

SECOND, to the payment of all reasonable fees, costs and expenses incurred by the Collateral Agents (other than the Collateral Agent that is the Authorized Term Collateral Agent) and the Other Agents in connection with such collection or sale or otherwise in connection with this Agreement, or any other Term Security Document or any of the Term Obligations, including all court costs and the reasonable fees and expenses of their agents, professional advisors and legal counsel, the repayment of all advances made by such Collateral Agents and Other Agents, as applicable, hereunder or under any other Term Security Document on behalf of Grantors, if any, and any other reasonable costs or expenses incurred in connection with the exercise of any right or remedy hereunder or under any other Term Security Document;

THIRD, to the payment of all other Term Obligations (the amounts so applied to be distributed pro rata among the Term Secured Parties in accordance with the amounts of the applicable Term Obligations owed to them on the date of any such distribution);

FOURTH, after payment in full of all Term Obligations, to the ABL Agent, to be applied in accordance with Section 14 of the

 

11


ABL Security Agreement (or, if a Replacement ABL Agreement is in effect, in accordance with the applicable sections of the then-extant ABL Credit Agreement Loan Documents) until the ABL Secured Obligations are paid in full; and

FIFTH, to the Grantors or their successors or assigns, or as a court of competent jurisdiction may otherwise direct.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, with respect to any Common Collateral for which a third party (other than a Term Secured Party) has a lien or security interest that is junior in priority to the security interest of any Series of Term Obligations but senior (as determined by appropriate legal proceedings in the case of any dispute) to the security interest of any other Series of Term Obligations (such third party an “ Intervening Creditor ”), the value of any Common Collateral or Proceeds which are allocated to such Intervening Creditor shall be deducted on a ratable basis solely from the Common Collateral or Proceeds to be distributed in respect of the Series of Term Obligations with respect to which such Impairment exists.

(b) The Term Secured Parties hereby acknowledge that the Term Obligations of any Series may, subject to any limitations set forth in the then extant Secured Credit Documents, be increased, extended, renewed, replaced, restated, supplemented, restructured, repaid, refunded, Refinanced or otherwise amended or modified from time to time, all without affecting the priorities set forth in Section 2.01(a) or the provisions of this Agreement defining the relative rights of the Term Secured Parties of any Series.

(c) Notwithstanding the date, time, method, manner or order of grant, attachment or perfection of any Liens securing any Series of Term Obligations granted on the Common Collateral and notwithstanding any provision of the Uniform Commercial Code of any jurisdiction, or any other applicable law or the Secured Credit Documents or any defect or deficiencies in the Liens securing the Term Obligations of any Series or any other circumstance whatsoever (but, in each case, subject to Section 1.01(b)), each Term Secured Party hereby agrees that the Liens securing each Series of Term Obligations on any Common Collateral shall be of equal priority.

Section 2.02 . Actions with Respect to Common Collateral; Prohibition on Contesting Liens.

(a) With respect to any Common Collateral, (i) notwithstanding Section 2.01, only the Authorized Term Collateral Agent shall act or refrain from acting with respect to the Common Collateral (including with respect to any intercreditor agreement with respect to any Common Collateral) and (ii) no other Collateral

 

12


Agent with respect to Term Obligations or Non-Controlling Authorized Representative or other Term Secured Party (other than the Authorized Term Collateral Agent and the Controlling Secured Parties) shall or shall instruct the Authorized Term Collateral Agent to, commence any judicial or nonjudicial foreclosure proceedings with respect to, seek to have a trustee, receiver, liquidator or similar official appointed for or over, attempt any action to take possession of, exercise any right, remedy or power with respect to, or otherwise take any action to enforce its security interest in or realize upon, or take any other action available to it in respect of, any Common Collateral (including with respect to any intercreditor agreement with respect to any Common Collateral), whether under any Term Security Document, applicable law or otherwise, it being agreed that only the Authorized Term Collateral Agent shall be entitled to take any such actions or exercise any such remedies with respect to Common Collateral (subject to the right of any Non-Controlling Authorized Representative or other Term Secured Party to take limited protective measures with respect to the Liens securing Term Obligations and to take certain actions that would be permitted to be taken by unsecured creditors). Notwithstanding the equal priority of the Liens securing each Series of Term Obligations, the Authorized Term Collateral Agent may, subject to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, deal with the Common Collateral as if such Authorized Term Collateral Agent had a senior Lien on such Common Collateral. No Non-Controlling Authorized Representative or Non-Controlling Secured Party will contest, protest or object to any foreclosure proceeding or action brought by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent or any Controlling Secured Party or any other exercise by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent or any Controlling Secured Party of any rights and remedies relating to the Common Collateral, or to cause the Collateral Agent to do so. The foregoing shall not be construed to limit the rights and priorities of any Term Secured Party, any Collateral Agent or any Authorized Representative, in each case with respect to any Collateral not constituting Common Collateral.

(b) Each of the Term Secured Parties and each of the Collateral Agents agrees that it will not (and hereby waives any right to) contest or support any other Person in contesting, in any proceeding (including any Insolvency or Liquidation Proceeding), the perfection, priority, validity or enforceability of a Lien held by or on behalf of any of the Term Secured Parties in all or any part of the Collateral, or the provisions of this Agreement; provided that nothing in this Agreement shall be construed to prevent or impair (i) the rights of any of the Collateral Agents or any Authorized Representative to enforce this Agreement or (ii) the rights of any Term Secured Party from contesting or supporting any other Person in contesting the enforceability of any Lien purporting to secure Term Obligations constituting unmatured interest pursuant to Section 502(b)(2) of the Bankruptcy Code.

 

13


Section 2.03 . No Interference; Payment Over.

(a) Each Term Secured Party agrees that (i) it will not take or cause to be taken any action the purpose or intent of which is, or could be, to interfere, hinder or delay, in any manner, whether by judicial proceedings or otherwise, any sale, transfer or other disposition of the Common Collateral by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, (ii) except as provided in Section 2.02, it shall have no right to (A) direct the Authorized Term Collateral Agent or any other Term Secured Party to exercise any right, remedy or power with respect to any Common Collateral (including pursuant to any intercreditor agreement) or (B) consent to the exercise by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent or any other Term Secured Party of any right, remedy or power with respect to any Common Collateral, (iii) it will not institute any suit or assert in any suit, bankruptcy, insolvency or other proceeding any claim against the Authorized Term Collateral Agent or any other Term Secured Party seeking damages from or other relief by way of specific performance, instructions or otherwise with respect to any Common Collateral, and none of the Collateral Agents, any Authorized Term Collateral Agent or any other Term Secured Party shall be liable for any action taken or omitted to be taken by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent or other Term Secured Party with respect to any Common Collateral in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement, (iv) it will not seek, and hereby waives any right, to have any Common Collateral or any part thereof marshaled upon any foreclosure or other disposition of such Collateral and (v) it will not attempt, directly or indirectly, whether by judicial proceedings or otherwise, to challenge the enforceability of any provision of this Agreement; provided that nothing in this Agreement shall be construed to prevent or impair the rights of any of the Collateral Agents or any other Term Secured Party to enforce this Agreement.

(b) Each Term Secured Party hereby agrees that if it shall obtain possession of any Common Collateral or shall realize any proceeds or payment in respect of any such Common Collateral, pursuant to any Term Security Document or by the exercise of any rights available to it under applicable law or in any Insolvency or Liquidation Proceeding or through any other exercise of remedies (including pursuant to any intercreditor agreement), at any time prior to the Discharge of each Series of Term Obligations, then it shall hold such Common Collateral, proceeds or payment in trust for the other Term Secured Parties and promptly transfer such Common Collateral, proceeds or payment, as the case may be, to the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, to be distributed by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent in accordance with the provisions of Section 2.01(a) hereof.

(c) In furtherance of the foregoing, no Grantor shall, nor shall any Grantor permit any Subsidiary to, grant or permit or suffer to exist any Lien on any asset or property to secure any Series of Term Obligations unless it has

 

14


granted a Lien on such asset or property to secure each other Series of Term Obligations, except, (i) in the case of the Notes Obligations and with respect to the Existing Real Property Collateral only, as and for the 45-day period following the Issue Date and (ii) in the case of any Additional Term Obligations only, to the extent permitted by the terms of the Additional Term Agreement under which such Additional Term Obligations were issued.

Section 2.04 . Automatic Release of Liens; Amendments to Term Security Documents.

(a) If at any time any Common Collateral is transferred to a third party or otherwise disposed of, in each case in connection with any enforcement by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement and the applicable Term Security Documents, then (whether or not any Insolvency or Liquidation Proceeding is pending at the time) the Liens on such Common Collateral securing the Term Obligations will automatically be released and discharged; provided that any proceeds of any Common Collateral realized from such transfer or disposition shall be applied pursuant to Section 2.01 hereof.

(b) If, in connection with any sale, lease, exchange, transfer or other disposition of any Common Collateral permitted under the terms of the Secured Credit Documents (whether or not an Event of Default thereunder, and as defined therein, has occurred and is continuing), the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, for itself or on behalf of any of the Term Secured Parties, releases any of its Liens on any part of the Common Collateral, then the Liens, if any, of each Non-Controlling Authorized Representative on such Common Collateral (but not the proceeds thereof, which shall be subject to the priorities set forth in this Agreement) shall be automatically, unconditionally and simultaneously released and each Non-Controlling Authorized Representative promptly shall execute and deliver to the Authorized Term Collateral Agent or such Grantor such termination statements, releases and other documents as the Authorized Term Collateral Agent or such Grantor may reasonably request to effectively confirm such release.

(c) Each Term Secured Party agrees that any Collateral Agent may enter into any amendment (and, upon request by such Collateral Agent, each Authorized Representative shall sign a consent to such amendment) to any Term Security Document (including, without limitation, to release Liens securing any Series of Term Obligations) so long as such amendment, subject to clause (e) below, is permitted by the terms of each then extant Secured Credit Document. Additionally, each Term Secured Party agrees that any Collateral Agent may enter into any amendment (and, upon request by such Collateral Agent, each Authorized Representative shall sign a consent to such amendment) to any Term Security Document solely as such Term Security Document relates to a particular

 

15


Series of Term Obligations (including, without limitation, to release Liens securing such Series of Term Obligations) so long as (x) such amendment is in accordance with the Secured Credit Document pursuant to which such Series of Term Obligations was incurred and (y) such amendment does not adversely affect the Term Secured Parties of any other Series.

(d) Each Authorized Representative agrees to execute and deliver (at the sole cost and expense of the Grantors) all such authorizations and other instruments as shall reasonably be requested by the applicable Collateral Agent to evidence and confirm any release of Common Collateral or amendment to any Term Security Document provided for in this Section.

(e) In determining whether an amendment to any Term Security Document is permitted by this Section 2.04, a Collateral Agent may conclusively rely on a certificate of an officer of the ABL Borrower stating that such amendment is permitted by Section 2.04(c).

Section 2.05 . Certain Agreements with Respect to Bankruptcy or Insolvency Proceedings.

(a) This Agreement shall continue in full force and effect notwithstanding the commencement of any proceeding under the Bankruptcy Code or any other Federal, state or foreign bankruptcy, insolvency, receivership or similar law by or against the Parent or any of its Subsidiaries.

(b) If any Grantor shall become subject to a case (a “ Bankruptcy Case ”) under the Bankruptcy Code and shall, as debtor(s)-in-possession, move for approval of financing (“ DIP Financing ”) to be provided by one or more lenders (the “ DIP Lenders ”) under Section 364 of the Bankruptcy Code or the use of cash collateral under Section 363 of the Bankruptcy Code, each Term Secured Party (other than any Controlling Secured Party or the Authorized Term Collateral Agent) agrees that it will raise no objection to any such financing or to the Liens on the Common Collateral securing the same (“ DIP Financing Liens ”) or to any use of cash collateral that constitutes Common Collateral, unless any Controlling Secured Party, or the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, shall then oppose or object to such DIP Financing or such DIP Financing Liens or use of cash collateral (and (i) to the extent that such DIP Financing Liens are senior to the Liens on any such Common Collateral for the benefit of the Controlling Secured Parties, each Non-Controlling Secured Party will subordinate its Liens with respect to such Common Collateral on the same terms as the Liens of the Controlling Secured Parties (other than any Liens of any Term Secured Parties constituting DIP Financing Liens) are subordinated thereto, and (ii) to the extent that such DIP Financing Liens rank pari passu with the Liens on any such Common Collateral granted to secure the Term Obligations of the Controlling

 

16


Secured Parties, each Non-Controlling Secured Party will confirm the priorities with respect to such Common Collateral as set forth herein), in each case so long as (A) the Term Secured Parties of each Series retain the benefit of their Liens on all such Common Collateral pledged to the DIP Lenders, including proceeds thereof arising after the commencement of such proceeding, with the same priority vis-à-vis all the other Term Secured Parties (other than any Liens of the Term Secured Parties constituting DIP Financing Liens) as existed prior to the commencement of the Bankruptcy Case, (B) the Term Secured Parties of each Series are granted Liens on any additional collateral pledged to any Term Secured Party as adequate protection or otherwise in connection with such DIP Financing or use of cash collateral, with the same priority vis-à-vis the Term Secured Parties as set forth in this Agreement, (C) if any amount of such DIP Financing or cash collateral is applied to repay any of the Term Obligations, such amount is applied pursuant to Section 2.01(a) of this Agreement, and (D) if any Term Secured Party is granted adequate protection, including in the form of periodic payments, in connection with such DIP Financing or use of cash collateral, the proceeds of such adequate protection are applied pursuant to Section 2.01(a) of this Agreement; provided that the Term Secured Parties of each Series shall have a right to object to the grant of a Lien to secure the DIP Financing over any Collateral subject to Liens in favor of the Term Secured Parties of such Series or its Authorized Representative that shall not constitute Common Collateral; and provided , further , that any Term Secured Party receiving adequate protection shall not object to any other Term Secured Party receiving adequate protection comparable to any adequate protection granted to such Term Secured Party in connection with a DIP Financing or use of cash collateral.

Section 2.06 . Reinstatement. In the event that any of the Term Obligations shall be paid in full and such payment or any part thereof shall subsequently, for whatever reason (including an order or judgment for disgorgement of a preference under the Bankruptcy Code, or any similar law, or the settlement of any claim in respect thereof), be required to be returned or repaid, the terms and conditions of this Article 2 shall be fully applicable thereto until all such Term Obligations shall again have been paid in full in cash.

Section 2.07 . Insurance. As between the Term Secured Parties, the Authorized Term Collateral Agent shall have the right, but no obligation, to adjust or settle any insurance policy or claim covering or constituting Common Collateral in the event of any loss thereunder and to approve any award granted in any condemnation or similar proceeding affecting the Common Collateral.

Section 2.08 . Refinancings. The Term Obligations of any Series may be Refinanced, in whole or in part, in each case, without notice to, or the consent (except to the extent a consent is otherwise required to permit the refinancing transaction under any Secured Credit Document) of any Term Secured Party of

 

17


any other Series, all without affecting the priorities provided for herein or the other provisions hereof; provided that the Authorized Representative of the holders of any such Refinancing indebtedness shall have executed a Joinder Agreement on behalf of the holders of such Refinancing indebtedness.

Section 2.09 . Possessory or Control Collateral Agent.

(a) The Authorized Term Collateral Agent agrees to hold any Common Collateral constituting Possessory Collateral or Control Collateral that is part of the Collateral in its possession or control (or in the possession or control of its agents or bailees) as gratuitous bailee or sub-agent, as applicable, for the benefit of each other Term Secured Party and any assignee solely for the purpose of perfecting the security interest granted in such Possessory Collateral or Control Collateral, if any, pursuant to the applicable Term Security Documents, in each case, subject to the terms and conditions of this Section 2.09. Each Non-Controlling Authorized Representative and each Collateral Agent that is not the Authorized Term Collateral Agent agrees to hold any Common Collateral constituting Possessory Collateral or Control Collateral, from time to time in its possession, as gratuitous bailee or sub-agent for the benefit of each other Term Secured Party and any assignee, solely for the purpose of perfecting the security interest granted in such Possessory Collateral, if any, pursuant to the applicable Term Security Documents, in each case, subject to the terms and conditions of this Section 2.09.

(b) The duties or responsibilities of the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, each Non-Controlling Authorized Representative and each Collateral Agent that is not the Authorized Term Collateral Agent under this Section 2.09 shall be limited solely to holding any Common Collateral constituting Possessory Collateral and Control Collateral as gratuitous bailee or sub-agent, as applicable, for the benefit of each other Term Secured Party for purposes of perfecting the Lien held by such Term Secured Parties therein. Nothing in the preceding sentence shall be construed to impose any duty on the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, each Non-Controlling Authorized Representative or each Collateral Agent that is not the Authorized Term Collateral Agent (or any agent or bailee acting on behalf of any of them) with respect to such Common Collateral or to provide any Term Secured Party with any rights with respect to such Common Collateral beyond those specified in this Agreement and the Term Security Documents.

(c) In furtherance of the foregoing, each Grantor hereby grants a security interest to the Authorized Term Collateral Agent in the Common Collateral constituting Possessory Collateral and Control Collateral to the extent such Authorized Term Collateral Agent possesses or controls such Common Collateral as permitted in Section 2.09(a) for the benefit of the Term Secured Parties under any Series of Term Obligations (other than the Series of Term

 

18


Obligations for which the Authorized Term Collateral Agent is the collateral agent) which have been granted a Lien on such Common Collateral possessed or controlled by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent.

(d) Upon the occurrence of any change in the identity of the Person serving as the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, the retiring Authorized Term Collateral Agent shall (i) deliver to the successor Authorized Term Collateral Agent (and each Grantor hereby directs the Authorized Term Collateral Agent to so deliver) at the Grantors’ sole cost and expense, any Possessory Collateral evidencing or constituting such Common Collateral in its possession or control together with any necessary endorsements to the extent required by the Secured Credit Documents and (ii) in the case of any Common Collateral consisting of Control Collateral as to which the Authorized Term Collateral Agent has control (whether pursuant to an account control agreement or otherwise), the Authorized Term Collateral Agent and the applicable Grantor, at the Grantors’ sole cost and expense, shall take such actions, if any, as are required to cause control over such Common Collateral to become vested in the successor Authorized Term Collateral Agent.

ARTICLE 3

A DDITIONAL T ERM O BLIGATIONS

Holdco may from time to time, subject to any limitations contained in any Secured Credit Documents in effect at such time, designate additional indebtedness and related obligations that are, or are to be, secured by Liens on any assets of the Grantors that would, if such Liens were granted, constitute Common Collateral as Additional Term Obligations, by delivering to each Collateral Agent party hereto at such time a certificate of a Financial Officer of Holdco:

(a) describing the indebtedness and other obligations being designated as Additional Term Obligations, and including a statement of the maximum aggregate outstanding principal amount of such indebtedness as of the date of such certificate;

(b) setting forth the Additional Term Agreements under which such Additional Term Obligations are, or are to be, issued or incurred, and under which the Liens securing such Additional Term Obligations are, or are to be, granted or created, and attaching copies of such Additional Term Agreements as each Grantor has executed and delivered to the Person that serves as the collateral agent, collateral trustee or a similar representative for the holders of such Additional Term Obligations (such Person being referred to as the “ Additional Term Agent ”) with respect to such Additional Term Obligations on the closing

 

19


date of such Additional Term Obligations, certified as being true and complete by a Financial Officer of Holdco;

(c) identifying the Person that serves as the Additional Term Agent;

(d) certifying that the incurrence of such Additional Term Obligations, the creation of the Liens securing such Additional Term Obligations and the designation of such Additional Term Obligations as “ Additional Term Obligations ” hereunder do not violate or result in a default under any provision of any Secured Credit Document of any Series in effect at such time; and

(e) attaching a fully completed Joinder Agreement executed and delivered by the Additional Term Agent.

Upon the delivery of such certificate and the related attachments as provided above, the obligations designated in such notice shall become Additional Term Obligations for all purposes of this Agreement.

ARTICLE 4

E XISTENCE AND A MOUNTS OF L IENS AND O BLIGATIONS

Whenever the Authorized Term Collateral Agent or any Authorized Representative shall be required, in connection with the exercise of its rights or the performance of its obligations hereunder, to determine the existence or amount of any Term Obligations of any Series, or the Common Collateral subject to any Lien securing the Term Obligations of any Series, it may request that such information be furnished to it in writing by each other Authorized Representative and shall be entitled to make such determination on the basis of the information so furnished; provided , however , that if an Authorized Representative shall fail or refuse reasonably promptly to provide the requested information, the Authorized Term Collateral Agent or Authorized Representative shall be entitled to make any such determination or not make any determination by such method as it may, in the exercise of its good faith judgment, determine, including by reliance upon (and it may conclusively rely upon) a certificate of a Financial Officer of Holdco. The Authorized Term Collateral Agent and each Authorized Representative may rely conclusively, and shall be fully protected in so relying, on any determination made by it in accordance with the provisions of the preceding sentence (or as otherwise directed by a court of competent jurisdiction) and shall have no liability to any Grantor, any Term Secured Party or any other Person as a result of such determination.

 

20


ARTICLE 5

T HE A UTHORIZED T ERM C OLLATERAL A GENT

Section 5.01 . Authority.

(a) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, nothing herein shall be construed to impose any fiduciary or other duty on the Authorized Term Collateral Agent to any Non-Controlling Secured Party or give any Non-Controlling Secured Party the right to direct the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, except that the Authorized Term Collateral Agent shall be obligated to distribute proceeds of any Common Collateral in accordance with Section 2.01 hereof.

(b) In furtherance of the foregoing, each Non-Controlling Authorized Representative acknowledges and agrees that the Authorized Term Collateral Agent shall be entitled, for the benefit of the Term Secured Parties, to sell, transfer or otherwise dispose of or deal with any Common Collateral as provided herein and in the Term Security Documents, as applicable, for which the Authorized Term Collateral Agent is the collateral agent of such Common Collateral, without regard to any rights to which the Non-Controlling Secured Parties would otherwise be entitled. Without limiting the foregoing, each Non-Controlling Secured Party agrees that the Authorized Term Collateral Agent and any other Term Secured Party shall not have any duty or obligation to marshal or realize upon any type of Common Collateral (or any other Collateral securing any of the Term Obligations), or to sell, dispose of or otherwise liquidate all or any portion of such Common Collateral (or any other Collateral securing any Term Obligations), in any manner that would maximize the return to the Non-Controlling Secured Parties, notwithstanding that the order and timing of any such realization, sale, disposition or liquidation may affect the amount of proceeds actually received by the Non-Controlling Secured Parties from such realization, sale, disposition or liquidation. In addition, whether or not it is the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, no Collateral Agent or Term Secured Party shall have any duty or obligation to marshal or realize upon any type of Collateral not constituting Common Collateral, or to sell, dispose of or otherwise liquidate all or any portion of such Collateral not constituting Common Collateral, in any manner that would maximize the return to the holders of any other Series of Term Obligations, notwithstanding that the order and timing of any such realization, sale, disposition or liquidation may affect the amount of proceeds actually received by the holders of any other Series of Term Obligations from such realization, sale, disposition or liquidation. Each of the Term Secured Parties waives any claim it may now or hereafter have against the Authorized Term Collateral Agent or any Authorized Representative or Collateral Agent with respect to any other Series of Term Obligations or any other Term Secured Party of any other Series arising out of (i) any actions which the Authorized Term

 

21


Collateral Agent or any such Authorized Representative, Collateral Agent or Term Secured Party may take or omit to take (including, actions with respect to the creation, perfection or continuation of Liens on any Collateral, actions with respect to the foreclosure upon, sale, release or depreciation of, or failure to realize upon, any of the Collateral and actions with respect to the collection of any claim for all or any part of the Term Obligations from any account debtor, guarantor or any other party) in accordance with the Term Security Documents or any other agreement related thereto or to the collection of the Term Obligations or the valuation, use, protection or release of any security for the Term Obligations, (ii) any election by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent or any holders of Term Obligations, in any proceeding instituted under the Bankruptcy Code, of the application of Section 1111(b) of the Bankruptcy Code or (iii) subject to Section 2.05, any borrowing by, or grant of a security interest or administrative expense priority under Section 364 of the Bankruptcy Code by Holdco or any of its Subsidiaries, as debtor-in-possession. Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, no Collateral Agent (including the Authorized Term Collateral Agent) shall accept any Common Collateral in full or partial satisfaction of any Term Obligations pursuant to Section 9-620 of the Uniform Commercial Code of any jurisdiction, without the consent of each of the Collateral Agents representing holders of Term Obligations for whom such Collateral constitutes Common Collateral.

Section 5.02 . Rights as a Term Secured Party. The Person serving as the Authorized Term Collateral Agent hereunder shall have the same rights and powers in its capacity as a Term Secured Party under any Series of Term Obligations that it holds as any other Term Secured Party of such Series and may exercise the same as though it were not the Authorized Term Collateral Agent and the terms “ Term Secured Party ” or “ Term Secured Parties ” or (as applicable) “ Synthetic Letter of Credit Secured Party ”, “ Synthetic Letter of Credit Secured Parties ”, “ Notes Secured Party ,” “ Notes Secured Parties ,” “ Additional Term Secured Party ” or “ Additional Term Secured Parties ” shall, unless otherwise expressly indicated or unless the context otherwise requires, include the Person serving as the Authorized Term Collateral Agent hereunder in its individual capacity. Such Person and its Affiliates may accept deposits from, lend money to, act as the financial advisor or in any other advisory capacity for and generally engage in any kind of business with Holdco or any of its Subsidiaries or Affiliates as if such Person were not the Authorized Term Collateral Agent hereunder and without any duty to account therefor to any other Term Secured Party.

Section 5.03 . Exculpatory Provisions.

(a) The Authorized Term Collateral Agent shall not have any duties or obligations except those expressly set forth herein and in the other Term Security

 

22


Documents. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, the Authorized Term Collateral Agent:

(i) shall not be subject to any fiduciary or other implied duties of any kind or nature to any Person, regardless of whether an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing and shall not be required to use its own funds in the performance of any of its obligations or duties or the exercise of any of its rights or powers;

(ii) shall not have any duty to take any discretionary action or exercise any discretionary powers, except discretionary rights and powers expressly contemplated hereby or by the other Term Security Documents; provided that the Authorized Term Collateral Agent shall not be required to take any action that, in its opinion or the opinion of its counsel, may expose the Authorized Term Collateral Agent to liability or expense or that is contrary to any Term Security Document or applicable law;

(iii) shall not, except as expressly set forth herein and in the other Term Security Documents, have any duty to disclose, and shall not be liable for the failure to disclose, any information relating to Holdco or any of its Subsidiaries that is communicated to or obtained by the Person serving as the Authorized Term Collateral Agent or any of its Affiliates in any capacity;

(iv) shall not be liable for any action taken or not taken by it (A) in the absence of its own gross negligence or willful misconduct, as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final and non-appealable decision or (B) in reliance on a certificate of a Financial Officer of Holdco certifying that such action is permitted by the terms of this Agreement. The Authorized Term Collateral Agent shall be deemed not to have knowledge of any Event of Default under any Series of Term Obligations unless and until notice describing such Event of Default is given to the Authorized Term Collateral Agent by the Authorized Representative of such Term Obligations or Holdco;

(v) shall not be responsible for or have any duty to ascertain or inquire into (A) any statement, warranty or representation made in or in connection with this Agreement or any other Term Security Document, (B) the contents of any certificate, report or other document delivered hereunder or thereunder or in connection herewith or therewith, (C) the performance or observance of any of the covenants, agreements or other terms or conditions set forth herein or therein or the occurrence of any Default, (D) the validity, enforceability, effectiveness or genuineness of this Agreement, any other Term Security Document or any other

 

23


agreement, instrument or document, or the creation, perfection, continuation or priority of any Lien purported to be created by the Term Security Documents, (E) the value or the sufficiency of any Collateral for any Series of Term Obligations, or (F) the satisfaction of any condition set forth in any Secured Credit Document, other than to confirm receipt of items expressly required to be delivered to the Authorized Term Collateral Agent;

(vi) with respect to the Term Loan Agreement, the Indenture, any Additional Term Agreement or any Term Security Document, may conclusively assume that the Grantors have complied with all of their obligations thereunder unless advised in writing by the Authorized Representative thereunder to the contrary specifically setting forth the alleged violation; and

(vii) may conclusively rely on any certificate of a Financial Officer of Holdco.

(b) Each Term Secured Party acknowledges that, in addition to acting as the initial Authorized Term Collateral Agent, Wilmington Trust FSB also serves as Trustee, Notes Collateral Agent, Registrar, Authenticating Agent and Paying Agent under the Indenture and each Term Secured Party hereby waives any right to make any objection or claim against Wilmington Trust FSB (or any successor Authorized Term Collateral Agent or any of their respective counsel) based on any alleged conflict of interest or breach of duties arising from the Authorized Term Collateral Agent also serving as the Trustee, Notes Collateral Agent, Registrar, Authenticating Agent and Paying Agent.

Section 5.04 . Reliance by Authorized Term Collateral Agent. The Authorized Term Collateral Agent shall be entitled to rely upon, and shall not incur any liability for relying upon, any notice, request, certificate, consent, statement, instrument, document or other writing (including any electronic message, Internet or intranet website posting or other distribution) believed by it to be genuine and to have been signed, sent or otherwise authenticated by the proper Person. The Authorized Term Collateral Agent also may rely upon any statement made to it orally or by telephone and believed by it to have been made by the proper Person, and shall not incur any liability for relying thereon. The Authorized Term Collateral Agent may consult with legal counsel (who may include, but shall not be limited to counsel for Holdco, counsel for the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent or counsel for the Notes Collateral Agent), independent accountants and other experts selected by it, and shall not be liable for any action taken or not taken by it in accordance with the advice of any such counsel, accountants or experts.

 

24


Section 5.05 . Delegation of Duties. The Authorized Term Collateral Agent may perform any and all of its duties and exercise its rights and powers hereunder or under any other Term Security Document by or through any one or more sub-agents appointed by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent and shall not be responsible for the negligence of such sub-agents appointed with reasonable care. The Authorized Term Collateral Agent and any such sub-agent may perform any and all of its duties and exercise its rights and powers by or through their respective Affiliates. The exculpatory provisions of this Article shall apply to any such sub-agent and to the Affiliates of the Authorized Term Collateral Agent and any such sub-agent.

Section 5.06 . Non-reliance on Authorized Term Collateral Agent and Term Secured Parties. Each Term Secured Party acknowledges that it has, independently and without reliance upon the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, any Authorized Representative, any Collateral Agent or any other Term Secured Party or any of their Affiliates and based on such documents and information as it has deemed appropriate, made its own credit analysis and decision to enter into this Agreement and the other Secured Credit Documents. Each Term Secured Party also acknowledges that it will, independently and without reliance upon the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, any Authorized Representative, any Collateral Agent or any other Term Secured Party or any of their Affiliates and based on such documents and information as it shall from time to time deem appropriate, continue to make its own decisions in taking or not taking action under or based upon this Agreement, any other Secured Credit Document or any related agreement or any document furnished hereunder or thereunder.

ARTICLE 6

M ISCELLANEOUS

Section 6.01 . Notices. All notices and other communications provided for herein shall be in writing and shall be delivered by hand or overnight courier service, mailed by certified or registered mail or sent by telecopy, as follows:

(a) if to the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent, to it at:

JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.

c/o Loan and Agency Services Group

1111 Fannin, 10 th Floor

Houston, TX 77002

Facsimile: (713) 750-2938

Attention: Alice Telles

 

25


with copies to (which shall not constitute notice):

JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.

270 Park Avenue

New York, NY 10017

Facsimile: (212) 270-5127

Attn: Richard Duker;

(b) if to the Notes Collateral Agent, to it at:

Wilmington Trust FSB, as Notes Collateral Agent

1100 North Market Street

Rodney Square North

Wilmington, Delaware 19890

Facsimile: (302) 636-4145

Attention: Michael Oller, Jr.

with copies to (which shall not constitute notice):

Pillsbury Winthrop Shaw Pittman LLP

1540 Broadway

New York, NY 10036

Facsimile: (212) 881-9368

Attn: Bart Pisella, Esq.

         Timothy P. Kober, Esq.;

(c) if to any Additional Term Agent, to it at the address set forth in the applicable Joinder Agreement.

Any party hereto may change its address or telecopy number for notices and other communications hereunder by notice to the other parties hereto. All notices and other communications given to any party hereto in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement shall be deemed to have been given on the date of receipt (if a Business Day) and on the next Business Day thereafter (in all other cases) if delivered by hand or overnight courier service or sent by telecopy or on the date five Business Days after dispatch by certified or registered mail if mailed, in each case delivered, sent or mailed (properly addressed) to such party as provided in this Section 6.01 or in accordance with the latest unrevoked direction from such party given in accordance with this Section 6.01. As agreed to in writing among the Authorized Term Collateral Agent and each Authorized Representative from time to time, notices and other communications may also be delivered by e-mail to the e-mail address of a representative of the applicable person provided from time to time by such person.

 

26


Section 6.02 . Waivers; Amendment; Joinder Agreements.

(a) No failure or delay on the part of any party hereto in exercising any right or power hereunder shall operate as a waiver thereof, nor shall any single or partial exercise of any such right or power, or any abandonment or discontinuance of steps to enforce such a right or power, preclude any other or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right or power. The rights and remedies of the parties hereto are cumulative and are not exclusive of any rights or remedies that they would otherwise have. No waiver of any provision of this Agreement or consent to any departure by any party therefrom shall in any event be effective unless the same shall be permitted by paragraph (b) of this Section, and then such waiver or consent shall be effective only in the specific instance and for the purpose for which given. No notice or demand on any party hereto in any case shall entitle such party to any other or further notice or demand in similar or other circumstances.

(b) Neither this Agreement nor any provision hereof may be terminated, waived, amended or modified (other than pursuant to a Joinder Agreement or a Grantor Joinder Agreement) except pursuant to an agreement or agreements in writing entered into by each Authorized Representative and, to the extent such waiver, amendment or other modification would affect the rights of any Grantor, Holdco; provided , that this Agreement shall terminate with respect to a Series of Term Obligations (and the Authorized Representative with respect thereto) upon satisfaction and payment in full in cash of such Term Obligations.

(c) Notwithstanding the foregoing, without the consent of any Term Secured Party, any Authorized Representative may become a party hereto by execution and delivery of a Joinder Agreement in the form of Exhibit A hereto and upon such execution and delivery, such Authorized Representative and the Additional Term Secured Parties and Additional Term Obligations of the Series for which such Authorized Representative is acting shall be subject to the terms hereof and the terms of the other Term Security Documents applicable thereto.

Section 6.03 . Parties in Interest. This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of each of the parties hereto and their respective successors and assigns, as well as the other Term Secured Parties, all of whom are intended to be bound by, and to be third party beneficiaries of, this Agreement. Parent is a party hereto and agrees to cause each of its Subsidiaries that is a Grantor to comply with the provisions of this Agreement applicable to such Subsidiary; provided that Parent shall not be deemed to be a Grantor hereunder until such time, if any, as it shall meet the definition of “Grantor” set forth in Section 1.01(c).

 

27


Section 6.04 . Survival of Agreement. All covenants, agreements, representations and warranties made by any party in this Agreement shall be considered to have been relied upon by the other parties hereto and shall survive the execution and delivery of this Agreement and the removal or resignation of a Collateral Agent.

Section 6.05 . Counterparts, Integration, Effectiveness. This Agreement may be executed in counterparts (and by different parties hereto on different counterparts), each of which shall constitute an original, but all of which when taken together shall constitute a single contract. Delivery of an executed counterpart of a signature page of this Agreement by telecopy or other electronic transmission (including PDF copies) shall be effective as delivery of a manually executed counterpart of this Agreement. This Agreement shall become effective when it shall have been executed by each party hereto.

Section 6.06 . Severability. Any provision of this Agreement held to be invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any jurisdiction shall, as to such jurisdiction, be ineffective to the extent of such invalidity, illegality or unenforceability without affecting the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions hereof; and the invalidity of a particular provision in a particular jurisdiction shall not invalidate such provision in any other jurisdiction.

Section 6.07 . Governing Law. This Agreement shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the law of the State of New York, except as otherwise required by mandatory provisions of law and except to the extent that remedies provided by the laws of any jurisdiction other than the State of New York are governed by the laws of such jurisdiction.

Section 6.08 . Jurisdiction; Consent to Service of Process.

(a) Each party hereto hereby irrevocably and unconditionally submits, for itself and its property, to the nonexclusive jurisdiction of the Supreme Court of the State of New York sitting in New York County and of the United States District Court of the Southern District of New York, and any appellate court from any thereof, in any action or proceeding arising out of or relating to this Agreement, or for recognition or enforcement of any judgment, and each party hereto hereby irrevocably and unconditionally agrees that all claims in respect of any such action or proceeding may be heard and determined in such New York State or, to the extent permitted by law, in such Federal court. Each party hereto agrees that a final judgment in any such action or proceeding shall be conclusive and may be enforced in other jurisdictions by suit on the judgment or in any other manner provided by law.

 

28


(b) Each of the parties hereto hereby irrevocably and unconditionally waives, to the fullest extent it may legally and effectively do so, any objection which it may now or hereafter have to the laying of venue of any suit, action or proceeding arising out of or relating to this Agreement in any New York State or federal court referred to in Section 6.08(a). Each party hereto hereby irrevocably waives, to the fullest extent permitted by law, the defense of an inconvenient forum to the maintenance of such action or proceeding in any such court.

(c) Each party to this Agreement irrevocably consents to service of process in the manner provided for notices in Section 6.01. Nothing in this Agreement will affect the right of any party to this Agreement to serve process in any other manner permitted by law.

Section 6.09 . Waiver of Jury Trial. EACH PARTY HERETO HEREBY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, ANY RIGHT IT MAY HAVE TO A TRIAL BY JURY IN RESPECT OF ANY LITIGATION DIRECTLY OR INDIRECTLY ARISING OUT OF, UNDER OR IN CONNECTION WITH THIS AGREEMENT. EACH PARTY HERETO (A) CERTIFIES THAT NO REPRESENTATIVE, AGENT OR ATTORNEY OF ANY OTHER PARTY HAS REPRESENTED, EXPRESSLY OR OTHERWISE, THAT SUCH OTHER PARTY WOULD NOT, IN THE EVENT OF LITIGATION, SEEK TO ENFORCE THE FOREGOING WAIVER AND (B) ACKNOWLEDGES THAT IT AND THE OTHER PARTIES HERETO HAVE BEEN INDUCED TO ENTER INTO THIS AGREEMENT BY, AMONG OTHER THINGS, THE MUTUAL WAIVERS AND CERTIFICATIONS IN THIS SECTION 6.09.

Section 6.10 . Headings. Section headings used herein are for convenience of reference only, are not part of this Agreement and shall not affect the construction of, or be taken into consideration in interpreting, this Agreement.

Section 6.11 . Conflicts. In the event of any conflict or inconsistency between the provisions of this Agreement and the provisions of any of the other Secured Credit Documents or Term Security Documents, the provisions of this Agreement shall govern and control.

Section 6.12 . Provisions Solely to Define Relative Rights. The provisions of this Agreement are and are intended solely for the purpose of defining the relative rights of the Term Secured Parties in relation to one another. None of Holdco, any Grantor or any other creditor thereof shall have any rights or obligations hereunder, except as expressly provided in this Agreement ( provided that nothing in this Agreement (other than Section 2.04, 2.05, 2.06, 2.08 or 2.09 or this Article 6) is intended to or will amend, waive or otherwise modify the provisions of the Term Loan Agreement, the Indenture or any Additional Term

 

29


Agreement), and neither Holdco nor any Grantor may rely on the terms hereof (other than Sections 2.04, 2.05, 2.08, 2.09, Article 3, Article 5 and Article 6). Nothing in this Agreement is intended to or shall impair the obligations of any Grantor, which are absolute and unconditional, to pay the Term Obligations as and when the same shall become due and payable in accordance with their terms.

Section 6.13 . Integration. This Agreement together with the other Secured Credit Documents and the Term Security Documents represents the agreement of each of the Grantors and the Term Secured Parties with respect to the subject matter hereof and there are no promises, undertakings, representations or warranties by any Grantor, the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, any Authorized Representative, any Collateral Agent or any other Term Secured Party relative to the subject matter hereof not expressly set forth or referred to herein or in the other Secured Credit Documents or the Term Security Documents.

Section 6.14 . Cooperation. In connection with the exercise by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent of any enforcement right provided to it hereunder (including, without limitation, pursuant to Section 2.02) to the extent that the terms of any Term Security Document governed by non-U.S. law require that such action be taken by the Notes Collateral Agent or the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent, the Notes Collateral Agent or the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent, as the case may be, shall take such action in accordance with the written instructions of the Authorized Term Collateral Agent.

[Remainder of this page intentionally left blank]

 

30


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Agreement to be duly executed by their respective authorized officers as of the day and year first above written.

 

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,

as Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent

By:  

/s/ Mary E. Gherty

  Name:   Mary E. Gherty
  Title:   Managing Director

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB,

as Notes Collateral Agent

By:  

/s/ Michael G. Oller, Jr.

  Name:   Michael G. Oller, Jr.
  Title:   Assistant Vice President

[Term Intercreditor Agreement]

 


GRANTORS:

 

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS I, LLC

By:  

/s/ James G. Gouin

  Name:   James G. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President & CFO

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS II(a), LLC

By:  

/s/ James G. Gouin

  Name:   James G. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President & CFO

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS II(b), LLC

By:  

/s/ James G. Gouin

  Name:   James G. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President & CFO

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC

By:  

/s/ James G. Gouin

  Name:   James G. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President & CFO

TA HOLDINGS FINANCE, INC.

By:  

/s/ James G. Gouin

  Name:   James G. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President & CFO

 


GRANTORS:

 

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS USA I, LLC

By:  

/s/ Mike Rajkovic

  Name:   Mike Rajkovic
  Title:   Vice President

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS USA II, LLC

By:  

/s/ Mike Rajkovic

  Name:   Mike Rajkovic
  Title:   Vice President

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS USA III, LLC

By:  

/s/ Mike Rajkovic

  Name:   Mike Rajkovic
  Title:   Vice President

 


EXHIBIT A

[FORM OF] JOINDER AGREEMENT NO. [    ] dated as of [            ], 20[    ] (the “ Joinder Agreement ”) to the TERM INTERCREDITOR AGREEMENT dated as of August 24, 2010 (the “ Intercreditor Agreement ”), among JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as the Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent, WILMINGTON TRUST FSB, as the Notes Collateral Agent, and each ADDITIONAL TERM AGENT from time to time party thereto.

A. Capitalized terms used herein but not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings assigned to such terms in the Intercreditor Agreement.

B. Holdco proposes to issue or incur Additional Term Obligations and the Person identified in the signature pages hereto as the “Additional Term Agent” (the “ Additional Term Agent ”) will serve as the collateral agent, collateral trustee or a similar representative for the Additional Term Secured Parties. The Additional Term Obligations are being designated as such by Holdco in accordance with Article 3 of the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

C. The Additional Term Agent wishes to become a party to the Term Intercreditor Agreement and to acquire and undertake, for itself and on behalf of the Additional Term Secured Parties, the rights and obligations of an “Additional Term Agent” thereunder. The Additional Term Agent is entering into this Joinder Agreement in accordance with the provisions of the Term Intercreditor Agreement in order to become an Additional Term Agent thereunder.

Accordingly, the Additional Term Agent and Holdco agree as follows, for the benefit of the Additional Term Agent, the ABL Borrower and each other party to the Term Intercreditor Agreement:

Section 1. Accession to the Intercreditor Agreement . The Additional Term Agent (a) hereby accedes and becomes a party to the Term Intercreditor Agreement as an Additional Term Agent for the Additional Term Secured Parties from time to time in respect of the Additional Term Obligations, (b) agrees, for itself and on behalf of the Additional Term Secured Parties from time to time in respect of the Additional Term Obligations, to all the terms and provisions of the Term Intercreditor Agreement and (c) shall have all the rights and obligations of an Additional Term Agent under the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

Section 2. Representations, Warranties and Acknowledgement of the Additional Term Agent . The Additional Term Agent represents and warrants to the Term Agents and the Term Secured Parties that (a) it has full power and authority to enter into this Joinder Agreement, in its capacity as the Additional Term Agent, (b) this Joinder Agreement has been duly authorized, executed and delivered by it and constitutes its legal, valid and binding obligation, enforceable against it in accordance with the terms of this Joinder Agreement and (c) the

 

Exhibit A-1


Additional Term Obligations documents relating to such Additional Term Obligations provide that, upon the Additional Term Agent’s entry into this Joinder Agreement, the secured parties in respect of such Additional Term Obligations will be subject to and bound by the provisions of the Term Intercreditor Agreement as Additional Term Secured Parties.

Section 3. Counterparts . This Joinder Agreement may be executed in multiple counterparts, each of which shall constitute an original, but all of which when taken together shall constitute a single contract. This Joinder Agreement shall become effective when each Collateral Agent shall have received a counterpart of this Joinder Agreement that bears the signature of the Additional Term Agent. Delivery of an executed signature page to this Joinder Agreement by facsimile or other electronic transmission (including PDF copies) shall be effective as delivery of a manually signed counterpart of this Joinder Agreement.

Section 4. Benefit of Agreement . The agreements set forth herein or undertaken pursuant hereto are for the benefit of, and may be enforced by, any party to the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

Section 5. Governing Law . THIS JOINDER AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.

Section 6. Severability . In case any one or more of the provisions contained in this Joinder Agreement should be held invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any respect, none of the parties hereto shall be required to comply with such provision for so long as such provision is held to be invalid, illegal or unenforceable, but the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions contained herein and in the Term Intercreditor Agreement shall not in any way be affected or impaired. The parties hereto shall endeavor in good-faith negotiations to replace the invalid, illegal or unenforceable provisions with valid provisions the economic effect of which comes as close as possible to that of the invalid, illegal or unenforceable provisions.

Section 7. Notices . All communications and notices hereunder shall be in writing and given as provided in Section 5.01 of the Term Intercreditor Agreement. All communications and notices hereunder to the Additional Term Agent shall be given to it at the address set forth under its signature hereto, which information supplements Section 5.01 of the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

Section 8. Holdco agrees to reimburse each Collateral Agent for its reasonable out-of-pocket expenses in connection with this Joinder Agreement, including the reasonable fees, other charges and disbursements of counsel for each Collateral Agent.

 

Exhibit A-2


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Additional Term Agent has duly executed this Joinder Agreement to the Term Intercreditor Agreement as of the day and year first above written.

 

[NAME OF ADDITIONAL TERM AGENT], as ADDITIONAL TERM AGENT for the ADDITIONAL TERM SECURED PARTIES
By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  

 

Address for notices:

 

 

 

attention of:  

 

Telecopy:  

 

 

Exhibit A-3


Acknowledged by:

 

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent

By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  
By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB, as Notes Collateral Agent

By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  

[EACH OTHER ADDITIONAL TERM AGENT], as Additional Term Agent

By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  

 

Exhibit A-4


EXHIBIT B

[FORM OF] GRANTOR JOINDER AGREEMENT NO. [    ] dated as of [            ], 20[    ] (the “ Grantor Joinder Agreement ”) to the TERM INTERCREDITOR AGREEMENT dated as of August 24, 2010 (the “ Term Intercreditor Agreement ”), among TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS I, LLC (“ Holdco ”), the other GRANTORS party thereto, JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent, WILMINGTON TRUST FSB, as Notes Collateral Agent, each ADDITIONAL TERM AGENT from time to time party thereto and [                    ], a [                    ], as an additional GRANTOR.

A. Capitalized terms used herein but not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings assigned to such terms in the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

B. [            ], a Subsidiary of Holdco (the “ Additional Grantor ”), has granted a Lien on all or a portion of its assets to secure Term Obligations and such Additional Grantor is not a party to the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

C. The Additional Grantor wishes to become a party to the Term Intercreditor Agreement and to acquire and undertake the rights and obligations of a Grantor thereunder. The Additional Grantor is entering into this Grantor Joinder Agreement in accordance with the provisions of the Term Intercreditor Agreement in order to become a Grantor thereunder.

Accordingly, the Additional Grantor agrees as follows, for the benefit of the Collateral Agents, Holdco, the ABL Borrower and each other party to the Term Intercreditor Agreement:

Section 1. Accession to the Intercreditor Agreement . In accordance with Article 3 of the Term Intercreditor Agreement, the Additional Grantor (a) hereby accedes and becomes a party to the Term Intercreditor Agreement as a Grantor with the same force and effect as if originally named therein as a Grantor, (b) agrees to all the terms and provisions of the Term Intercreditor Agreement and (c) shall have all the rights and obligations of a Grantor under the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

Section 2. Representations, Warranties and Acknowledgment of the Additional Grantor . The Additional Grantor represents and warrants to each Collateral Agent and each Term Secured Party that this Grantor Joinder Agreement has been duly authorized, executed and delivered by such Additional Grantor and constitutes the legal, valid and binding obligation, enforceable against it in accordance with its terms, subject to applicable bankruptcy,

 

Exhibit B-1


insolvency, reorganization, moratorium or other laws affecting creditors’ rights generally and subject to general principles of equity, regardless of whether considered in a proceeding in equity or at law.

Section 3. Counterparts . This Grantor Joinder Agreement may be executed in multiple counterparts, each of which shall constitute an original, but all of which when taken together shall constitute a single contract. This Grantor Joinder Agreement shall become effective when each Collateral Agent shall have received a counterpart of this Grantor Joinder Agreement that bears the signature of the Additional Grantor. Delivery of an executed signature page to this Grantor Joinder Agreement by facsimile or other electronic transmission (including PDF copies) shall be effective as delivery of a manually signed counterpart of this Grantor Joinder Agreement.

Section 4. Benefit of Agreement . The agreements set forth herein or undertaken pursuant hereto are for the benefit of, and may be enforced by, any party to the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

Section 5. Governing Law . THIS JOINDER AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.

Section 6. Severability . In case any one or more of the provisions contained in this Grantor Joinder Agreement should be held invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any respect, none of the parties hereto shall be required to comply with such provision for so long as such provision is held to be invalid, illegal or unenforceable, but the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions contained herein and in the Term Intercreditor Agreement shall not in any way be affected or impaired. The parties hereto shall endeavor in good-faith negotiations to replace the invalid, illegal or unenforceable provisions with valid provisions the economic effect of which comes as close as possible to that of the invalid, illegal or unenforceable provisions.

Section 7. Notices . All communications and notices hereunder shall be in writing and given as provided in Section 6.01 of the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

Section 8. The Additional Grantor agrees to reimburse each Collateral Agent for its reasonable out-of-pocket expenses in connection with this Grantor Joinder Agreement, including the reasonable fees, other charges and disbursements of counsel for each Collateral Agent.

 

Exhibit B-2


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Additional Grantor has duly executed this Grantor Joinder Agreement to the Term Intercreditor Agreement as of the day and year first above written.

 

[NAME OF SUBSIDIARY]
By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  

 

Exhibit B-3


Acknowledged by:

 

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Synthetic Letter of Credit Facility Agent

By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB, as Notes Collateral Agent

By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  

[EACH OTHER ADDITIONAL TERM AGENT], as Additional Term Agent

By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  

 

Exhibit B-4

Exhibit 10.11

Execution Copy

AMENDED AND RESTATED ABL SECURITY AGREEMENT

Dated as of

August 24, 2010

Among

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC,

THE GUARANTORS PARTY HERETO

and

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,

as Agent


TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

 

 

         P AGE

SECTION 1.

  Definitions    2

SECTION 2.

  Grant of Transaction Liens    11

SECTION 3.

  General Representations and Warranties    12

SECTION 4.

  Further Assurances; General Covenants    15

SECTION 5.

  Equipment    16

SECTION 6.

  Recordable Intellectual Property    16

SECTION 7.

  Investment Property    17

SECTION 8.

  Controlled Deposit Accounts    19

SECTION 9.

  Cash Collateral Accounts    20

SECTION 10.

  Operation of Collateral Accounts    21

SECTION 11.

  Transfer Of Record Ownership    22

SECTION 12.

  Right to Vote Securities    22

SECTION 13.

  Remedies upon Event of Default    23

SECTION 14.

  Application of Proceeds    24

SECTION 15.

  Fees and Expenses; Indemnification    26

SECTION 16.

  Authority to Administer Collateral    27

SECTION 17.

  Limitation on Duty in Respect of Collateral    28

SECTION 18.

  General Provisions Concerning the Agent    28

SECTION 19.

  Termination of Transaction Liens; Release of Collateral    29

SECTION 20.

  Additional Lien Grantors    30

SECTION 21.

  Notices    30

SECTION 22.

  No Implied Waivers; Remedies Not Exclusive    30

SECTION 23.

  Successors and Assigns    30

SECTION 24.

  Amendments and Waivers    31

SECTION 25.

  Choice of Law    31

SECTION 26.

  Waiver of Jury Trial    31

SECTION 27.

  Severability    31

SECTION 28.

  Credit Agreement    31

SECTION 29.

  Counterparts    31

SECTION 30.

  ABL Intercreditor Agreement    32


SCHEDULES :   

Schedule 1

   Equity Interests in Subsidiaries and Affiliates Owned by Original Lien Grantors

Schedule 2

   Other Investment Property Owned by Original Lien Grantors
EXHIBITS :   

Exhibit A

   Security Agreement Supplement

Exhibit B

   Copyright Security Agreement

Exhibit C

   Patent Security Agreement

Exhibit D

   Trademark Security Agreement

Exhibit E

   Perfection Certificate

Exhibit F

   Issuer Control Agreement

Exhibit G

   Securities Account Control Agreement

Exhibit H

   Deposit Account Control Agreement

 

ii


ABL SECURITY AGREEMENT

AMENDED AND RESTATED ABL SECURITY AGREEMENT, dated as of August 24, 2010 (this “ Agreement ”) among TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC, the GUARANTORS party hereto and JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as agent (in such capacity, the “ Agent ”).

WHEREAS, the Borrower, the Guarantors, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent, and certain financial institutions are parties to the Credit Agreement described in Section 1 hereof, pursuant to which such financial institutions agreed to make loans and extend other financial accommodations to the Borrower;

WHEREAS, the Borrower had granted liens on certain of its assets to secure (i) its obligations under the Credit Agreement, (ii) its obligations under interest rate hedging arrangements designed to mitigate the risk that interest rates payable under the Credit Agreement will fluctuate and (iii) certain other obligations;

WHEREAS, pursuant to the Credit Agreement, Holdings, Holdco and Foreign Holdco had guaranteed the foregoing obligations of the Borrower, and Holdco and Foreign Holdco had granted liens on certain of their respective assets to secure their guarantees thereof;

WHEREAS, pursuant to the Credit Agreement, the Borrower caused each of its domestic subsidiaries to guarantee the foregoing obligations of the Borrower, and the Borrower caused each of its domestic subsidiaries to secure its guarantee thereof by granting Liens on its assets to the Agent;

WHEREAS, the Lenders and the Issuing Lender are not willing to make loans or issue or participate in letters of credit under the Credit Agreement, and the counterparties to the interest rate hedging arrangements referred to above are not willing to enter into or maintain them, unless (i) the foregoing obligations of the Borrower are secured and guaranteed as described above and (ii) each guarantee thereof is secured by Liens on assets of the relevant Guarantor as provided in the Security Documents; and

WHEREAS, upon any foreclosure or other enforcement of the Security Documents, the net proceeds of the relevant Collateral are to be received by or paid over to the Agent and applied as provided herein and in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement;


NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing and other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto agree as follows:

SECTION 1 . Definitions.

(a) Terms Defined in Credit Agreement . Terms defined in the Credit Agreement and not otherwise defined in subsection (b) or (c) of this Section have, as used herein, the respective meanings provided for therein.

(b) Terms Defined in UCC . As used herein, each of the following terms has the meaning specified in the UCC:

 

Term

  

UCC

Account

   9-102

Authenticate

   9-102

Certificated Security

   8-102

Chattel Paper

   9-102

Commodity Account

   9-102

Commodity Customer

   9-102

Deposit Account

   9-102

Document

   9-102

Entitlement Holder

   8-102

Entitlement Order

   8-102

Equipment

   9-102

Financial Asset

   8-102 & 103

General Intangibles

   9-102

Instrument

   9-102

Inventory

   9-102

Investment Property

   9-102

Proceeds

   9-102

Record

   9-102

Securities Account

   8-501

Securities Intermediary

   8-102

Security

   8-102 & 103

Security Entitlement

   8-102

Supporting Obligations

   9-102

Uncertificated Security

   8-102

(c) Additional Definitions . The following additional terms, as used herein, have the following meanings:

ABL Intercreditor Agreement ” shall mean that certain Amended and Restated Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010 among JPMorgan

 

2


Chase Bank, N.A., as representative with respect to the ABL Credit Agreement, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as representative with respect to the Term Loan Agreement, Wilmington Trust FSB, as representative with respect to the Indenture, each additional representative from time to time party thereto, Tower Automotive, LLC and the Lien Grantors party thereto.

ABL Termination Date ” shall have the meaning given such term in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

Applicable Agent ” shall mean (i) for purposes of the definitions of Controlled Deposit Account and Controlled Securities Account as such definitions are used in this Agreement, (A) at all times prior to the ABL Termination Date, the Agent and (B) at all times after the ABL Termination Date, the Authorized Term Collateral Agent and (ii) for all other purposes, (A) at all times prior to the Term Obligations Termination Date, the Authorized Term Collateral Agent and (B) at all times after the Term Obligations Termination Date, the Agent.

Authorized Term Collateral Agent” shall have the meaning given such term in the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

Cash Collateral Accounts ” shall have the meaning given such term in Section 9(a).

Collateral ” shall mean all property, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, on which a Lien is granted or purports to be granted to the Agent pursuant to the Security Documents. When used with respect to a specific Lien Grantor, the term “Collateral” means all its property on which such a Lien is granted or purports to be granted.

Collateral Accounts ” shall mean the Cash Collateral Accounts, the Controlled Deposit Accounts and the Controlled Securities Accounts.

Common Collateral ” shall have the meaning given such term in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

Contingent Secured Obligation ” shall mean, at any time, any Secured Obligation (or portion thereof) that is contingent in nature at such time, including any Secured Obligation that is:

(i) an obligation to reimburse a bank for drawings not yet made under a letter of credit issued by it;

(ii) an obligation under a Hedging Agreement to make payments that cannot be quantified at such time;

 

3


(iii) any other obligation (including any guarantee) that is contingent in nature at such time; or

(iv) an obligation to provide collateral to secure any of the foregoing types of obligations.

Control ” shall have the following meanings:

(a) when used with respect to any Security or Security Entitlement, the meaning specified in UCC Section 8-106; and

(b) when used with respect to any Deposit Account, the meaning specified in UCC Section 9-104.

Controlled Deposit Account ” shall mean a Deposit Account (i) that is subject to a Deposit Account Control Agreement or (ii) as to which the Applicable Agent is the Depositary Bank’s “customer” (as defined in UCC Section 4-104).

Controlled Securities Account ” shall mean a Securities Account that (i) is maintained in the name of a Lien Grantor at an office of a Securities Intermediary located in the United States and (ii) together with all Financial Assets credited thereto and all related Security Entitlements, is subject to a Securities Account Control Agreement among such Lien Grantor, the Applicable Agent and such Securities Intermediary.

Copyright License ” shall mean any agreement now or hereafter in existence granting to any Lien Grantor, or pursuant to which any Lien Grantor grants to any other Person, any right to use, copy, reproduce, distribute, prepare derivative works, display or publish any records or other materials on which a Copyright is in existence or may come into existence, including any agreement identified in Schedule 1 to any Copyright Security Agreement.

Copyrights ” shall mean all the following: (i) all copyrights under the laws of the United States or any other country (whether or not the underlying works of authorship have been published), all registrations and recordings thereof, all copyrightable works of authorship (whether or not published), and all applications for copyrights under the laws of the United States or any other country, including registrations, recordings and applications in the United States Copyright Office or in any similar office or agency of the United States, any State thereof or any other country or any political subdivision thereof, including those described in Schedule 1 to any Copyright Security Agreement, (ii) all renewals of any of the foregoing, (iii) all claims for, and rights to sue for, past or future infringements of any of the foregoing, and (iv) all income, royalties, damages and

 

4


payments now or hereafter due or payable with respect to any of the foregoing, including damages and payments for past or future infringements thereof.

Copyright Security Agreement ” shall mean a Copyright Security Agreement, substantially in the form of Exhibit B, executed and delivered by a Lien Grantor in favor of the Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties.

Deposit Account Control Agreement ” means, with respect to any Deposit Account of any Lien Grantor, a Deposit Account Control Agreement substantially in the form of Exhibit H (or otherwise in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Applicable Agent) among such Lien Grantor, the Applicable Agent and the relevant Depositary Bank.

Credit Agreement ” shall mean the Revolving Credit and Guaranty Agreement dated as of July 31, 2007 among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, as borrower, Tower Automotive, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(a), LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(b), LLC and the other guarantors party thereto, the lenders party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent.

Depositary Bank ” shall mean a bank at which a Controlled Deposit Account is maintained.

Equity Interest ” shall mean (i) in the case of a corporation, any shares of its capital stock, (ii) in the case of a limited liability company, any membership interest therein, (iii) in the case of a partnership, any partnership interest (whether general or limited) therein, (iv) in the case of any other business entity, any participation or other interest in the equity or profits thereof, (v) any warrant, option or other right to acquire any Equity Interest described in this definition or (vi) any Security Entitlement in respect of any Equity Interest described in this definition.

Indenture ” shall mean that certain Indenture among Tower Automotive, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, TA Holdings Finance, Inc., the guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, as trustee and collateral agent, dated as of August 24, 2010.

Intellectual Property Filing ” shall mean (i) with respect to any Patent, Patent License, Trademark or Trademark License, the filing of the applicable Patent Security Agreement or Trademark Security Agreement with the United States Patent and Trademark Office, together with an appropriately completed recordation form, and (ii) with respect to any Copyright or Copyright License, the filing of the applicable Copyright Security Agreement with the United States Copyright Office, together with an appropriately completed recordation form, in

 

5


each case sufficient to record the Transaction Lien granted to the Agent in such Recordable Intellectual Property.

Intellectual Property Security Agreement ” shall mean a Copyright Security Agreement, a Patent Security Agreement or a Trademark Security Agreement.

Issuer Control Agreement ” shall mean an Issuer Control Agreement substantially in the form of Exhibit F (with any changes that the Agent shall have approved).

Lien Grantors ” shall mean the Borrower and the Guarantors (other than Holdings).

Liquidity Trigger Period shall have the meaning given such term in the ABL Credit Agreement.

LLC Interest ” shall mean a membership interest or similar interest in a limited liability company.

Non-Contingent Secured Obligation ” shall mean at any time any Secured Obligation (or portion thereof) that is not a Contingent Secured Obligation at such time.

Original Lien Grantor ” shall mean any Lien Grantor that grants a Lien on any of its assets hereunder on the Closing Date.

own ” refers to the possession of sufficient rights in property to grant a security interest therein as contemplated by UCC Section 9-203, and “ acquire ” refers to the acquisition of any such rights.

Partnership Interest ” shall mean a partnership interest, whether general or limited.

Patent License ” shall mean any agreement now or hereafter in existence granting to any Lien Grantor, or pursuant to which any Lien Grantor grants to any other Person, any right with respect to any Patent or any invention now or hereafter in existence, whether patentable or not, whether a patent or application for patent is in existence on such invention or not, and whether a patent or application for patent on such invention may come into existence or not, including any agreement identified in Schedule 1 to any Patent Security Agreement.

Patents ” shall mean (i) all letters patent and design letters patent of the United States or any other country and all applications for letters patent or design letters patent of the United States or any other country, including applications in

 

6


the United States Patent and Trademark Office or in any similar office or agency of the United States, any State thereof or any other country or any political subdivision thereof, including those described in Schedule 1 to any Patent Security Agreement, (ii) all reissues, divisions, continuations, continuations in part, revisions and extensions of any of the foregoing, (iii) all claims for, and rights to sue for, past or future infringements of any of the foregoing and (iv) all income, royalties, damages and payments now or hereafter due or payable with respect to any of the foregoing, including damages and payments for past or future infringements thereof.

Patent Security Agreement ” shall mean a Patent Security Agreement, substantially in the form of Exhibit C, executed and delivered by a Lien Grantor in favor of the Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties.

Perfection Certificate ” shall mean, with respect to any Lien Grantor, a certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit E, completed and supplemented with the schedules contemplated thereby to the satisfaction of the Agent, and signed by an officer of such Lien Grantor.

Permitted Liens ” shall mean (i) the Transaction Liens and (ii) any other Liens on the Collateral permitted to be created or assumed or to exist pursuant to Section 6.01 of the Credit Agreement.

Personal Property Collateral ” shall mean all property included in the Collateral except Real Property Collateral.

Pledged ”, when used in conjunction with any type of asset, shall mean at any time an asset of such type that is included (or that creates rights that are included) in the Collateral at such time. For example, “Pledged Equity Interest” means an Equity Interest that is included in the Collateral at such time.

Post-Petition Interest ” shall mean any interest that accrues after the commencement of any case, proceeding or other action relating to the bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization of any one or more of the Lien Grantors (or would accrue but for the operation of applicable bankruptcy or insolvency laws), whether or not such interest is allowed or allowable as a claim in any such proceeding.

Real Property Collateral ” shall mean all real property (including leasehold interests in real property) included in the Collateral.

Recordable Intellectual Property ” shall mean (i) any Patent registered with the United States Patent and Trademark Office, and any Patent License with respect to a Patent so registered, (ii) any Trademark registered with the United

 

7


States Patent and Trademark Office, and any Trademark License with respect to a Trademark so registered, (iii) any Copyright registered with the United States Copyright Office and any Copyright License with respect to a Copyright so registered, and all rights in or under any of the foregoing.

Release Conditions ” shall mean the following conditions for terminating all the Transaction Liens:

(i) all Revolving Credit Commitments under the Credit Agreement shall have expired or been terminated;

(ii) all Non-Contingent Secured Obligations (other than any Non-Contingent Secured Obligations in respect of Secured Hedging Obligations) shall have been paid in full; and

(iii) no Contingent Secured Obligations (other than any Contingent Secured Obligations (i) in respect of Secured Hedging Obligations and (ii) in respect of contingent indemnification and expense reimbursement obligations as to which no claim shall have been asserted) shall remain outstanding;

provided that the condition in clause (iii) shall not apply to outstanding Letters of Credit if the Borrower has granted to the Agent, for the benefit of the Lenders, a security interest in cash (or causes a bank acceptable to the Agent and the Issuing Lender to issue a letter of credit naming the Issuing Lender as beneficiary) in an amount not less than 105% of the LC Exposure (plus any accrued and unpaid interest thereon) as of the date of such termination, on terms and conditions and pursuant to documentation reasonably satisfactory to the Agent and the Issuing Lender.

Secured Agreement ”, when used with respect to any Secured Obligation, refers collectively to each instrument, agreement or other document that sets forth obligations of the Borrower, obligations of a guarantor and/or rights of the holder with respect to such Secured Obligation.

Secured Parties ” shall mean the holders from time to time of the Secured Obligations.

Securities Account Control Agreement ” means, with respect to a Securities Account, a Securities Account Control Agreement substantially in the form of Exhibit G (with any changes that the Applicable Agent shall have approved) among the relevant Securities Intermediary, the relevant Lien Grantor and the Applicable Agent.

 

8


Security Agreement Supplement ” shall mean a Security Agreement Supplement, substantially in the form of Exhibit A, signed and delivered to the Agent for the purpose of adding a Subsidiary as a party hereto pursuant to Section 20 and/or adding additional property to the Collateral.

Term Intercreditor Agreement ” shall mean that certain Term Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010 among JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A., as representative with respect to the Term Loan Agreement, Wilmington Trust FSB, as representative with respect to the Indenture, each additional term agent from time to time party thereto and Tower Automotive, LLC and the Lien Grantors party thereto.

Term Loan Agreement ” shall mean that certain First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007, and as heretofore amended or modified, by and among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and Tower Automotive Holdings Europe B.V., as borrowers, the other guarantors party thereto, the lenders parties thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent.

Term Obligations Termination Date ” shall have the meaning given such term in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

Trademark License ” shall mean any agreement now or hereafter in existence granting to any Lien Grantor, or pursuant to which any Lien Grantor grants to any other Person, any right to use any Trademark, including any agreement identified in Schedule 1 to any Trademark Security Agreement.

Trademarks ” shall mean: (i) all trademarks, trade names, corporate names, company names, business names, fictitious business names, trade styles, service marks, logos, brand names, trade dress, prints and labels on which any of the foregoing have appeared or appear, package and other designs, and all other source or business identifiers, and all general intangibles of like nature, and the rights in any of the foregoing which arise under applicable law, (ii) the goodwill of the business symbolized thereby or associated with each of them, (iii) all registrations and applications in connection therewith, including registrations and applications in the United States Patent and Trademark Office or in any similar office or agency of the United States, any State thereof or any other country or any political subdivision thereof, including those described in Schedule 1 to any Trademark Security Agreement, (iv) all renewals of any of the foregoing, (v) all claims for, and rights to sue for, past or future infringements of any of the foregoing and (vi) all income, royalties, damages and payments now or hereafter due or payable with respect to any of the foregoing, including damages and payments for past or future infringements thereof.

 

9


Trademark Security Agreement ” shall mean a Trademark Security Agreement, substantially in the form of Exhibit D, executed and delivered by a Lien Grantor in favor of the Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties.

Transaction Guarantee” shall mean, with respect to each Guarantor, its guarantee of the Secured Obligations under the Credit Agreement or any Joinder Agreement.

Transaction Liens ” shall mean the Liens granted by the Lien Grantors under the Security Documents.

Type ” shall have the meaning specified in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

UCC ” shall mean the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in the State of New York; provided that, if perfection or the effect of perfection or non-perfection or the priority of any Transaction Lien on any Collateral is governed by the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect in a jurisdiction other than New York, “UCC” means the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in such other jurisdiction for purposes of the provisions hereof relating to such perfection, effect of perfection or non-perfection or priority.

(d) Terms Generally. The definitions of terms herein (including those incorporated by reference to the UCC or to another document) apply equally to the singular and plural forms of the terms defined. Whenever the context may require, any pronoun includes the corresponding masculine, feminine and neuter forms. The words “ include ”, “ includes ” and “ including ” shall be deemed to be followed by the phrase “ without limitation ”. The word “ will ” shall be construed to have the same meaning and effect as the word “ shall ”. Unless the context requires otherwise, (i) any definition of or reference to any agreement, instrument or other document herein shall be construed as referring to such agreement, instrument or other document as from time to time amended, supplemented or otherwise modified (subject to any restrictions on such amendments, supplements or modifications set forth herein), (ii) any reference herein to any Person shall be construed to include such Person’s successors and assigns, (iii) the words “ herein ”, “ hereof ” and “ hereunder ”, and words of similar import, shall be construed to refer to this Agreement in its entirety and not to any particular provision hereof, (iv) all references herein to Sections, Exhibits and Schedules shall be construed to refer to Sections of, and Exhibits and Schedules to, this Agreement and (v) the word “ property ” shall be construed to refer to any and all tangible and intangible assets and properties, including cash, securities, accounts and contract rights.

 

10


SECTION 2 . Grant of Transaction Liens.

(a) The Borrower, in order to secure the Secured Obligations, and each Guarantor listed on the signature pages hereof, in order to secure its Transaction Guarantee, grants to the Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties a continuing security interest in all the following property of the Borrower or such Guarantor, as the case may be, whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising and regardless of where located:

(i) all Accounts;

(ii) all Chattel Paper;

(iii) all Deposit Accounts;

(iv) all Documents;

(v) all Equipment;

(vi) all General Intangibles (including any Equity Interests in other Persons that do not constitute Investment Property);

(vii) all Instruments;

(viii) all Inventory;

(ix) all Investment Property;

(x) all books and records (including customer lists, credit files, computer programs, printouts and other computer materials and records) of such Original Lien Grantor pertaining to any of its Collateral;

(xi) such Original Lien Grantor’s ownership interest in (1) its Collateral Accounts, (2) all Financial Assets credited to its Collateral Accounts from time to time and all Security Entitlements in respect thereof, (3) all cash held in its Collateral Accounts from time to time and (4) all other money in the possession of the Agent; and

(xii) all Proceeds of the Collateral described in the foregoing clauses (i) through (xi);

provided that the following property is excluded from the foregoing security interests: (A) motor vehicles the perfection of a security interest in which is excluded from the Uniform Commercial Code in the relevant jurisdiction, (B) voting Equity Interests in any Foreign Subsidiary, to the extent (but only to the

 

11


extent) required to prevent the Collateral from including more than 65% of all voting Equity Interests in such Foreign Subsidiary, (C) United States intent-to-use trademark applications to the extent that, and solely during the period in which, the grant of a security interest therein would impair the validity or enforceability of such intent-to-use trademark applications under applicable federal law and (D) any property to the extent that the grant of a security interest therein is prohibited by any applicable law or regulation, requires a consent not obtained of any Governmental Authority pursuant to any applicable law or regulation, or is prohibited by, or constitutes a breach or default under or results in the termination of or requires any consent not obtained under, any contract, license, agreement, instrument or other document evidencing or giving rise to such property or, in the case of any Investment Property, any applicable shareholder or similar agreement, except to the extent that such law or regulation or the term in such contract, license, agreement, instrument or other document or shareholder or similar agreement providing for such prohibition, breach, default or termination or requiring such consent is ineffective under applicable law. Each Original Lien Grantor shall use all reasonable efforts to obtain any such required consent that is reasonably obtainable.

(b) With respect to each right to payment or performance included in the Collateral from time to time, the Transaction Lien granted therein includes a continuing security interest in (i) any Supporting Obligation that supports such payment or performance and (ii) any Lien that (x) secures such right to payment or performance or (y) secures any such Supporting Obligation.

(c) The Transaction Liens are granted as security only and shall not subject the Agent or any other Secured Party to, or transfer or in any way affect or modify, any obligation or liability of any Lien Grantor with respect to any of the Collateral or any transaction in connection therewith.

SECTION 3 . General Representations and Warranties. Each Original Lien Grantor represents and warrants that:

(a) Such Lien Grantor is duly organized, validly existing and in good standing under the laws of the jurisdiction identified as its jurisdiction of organization in its Perfection Certificate.

(b) Schedule 1 lists all Equity Interests in Subsidiaries and Affiliates owned by such Lien Grantor as of the Closing Date. Such Lien Grantor holds all such Equity Interests directly ( i.e. , not through a Subsidiary, a Securities Intermediary or any other Person).

(c) Schedule 2 lists, as of the Closing Date, (i) all Securities owned by such Lien Grantor (except Securities evidencing Equity Interests in Subsidiaries

 

12


and Affiliates) and (ii) all Securities Accounts to which Financial Assets are credited in respect of which such Lien Grantor owns Security Entitlements. Such Lien Grantor owns no Commodity Account in respect of which such Lien Grantor is the Commodity Customer.

(d) All Pledged Equity Interests owned by such Lien Grantor are owned by it free and clear of any Lien other than (i) the Transaction Liens, (ii) any inchoate tax liens and (iii) other Liens permitted under Section 6.01(b) or Section 6.01(m) of the Credit Agreement. All shares of capital stock included in such Pledged Equity Interests (including shares of capital stock in respect of which such Lien Grantor owns a Security Entitlement) have been duly authorized and validly issued and are fully paid and non-assessable. None of such Pledged Equity Interests is subject to any option to purchase or similar right of any Person. Such Lien Grantor is not and will not become a party to or otherwise bound by any agreement (except the Loan Documents, the Term Loan Documents and the documents governing Indebtedness that is secured by a Lien on such Pledged Equity Interests that is permitted under Section 6.01(b) or Section 6.01(m) of the Credit Agreement) which restricts in any manner the rights of any present or future holder of any Pledged Equity Interest with respect thereto.

(e) Such Lien Grantor has good and marketable title to all its Collateral (subject to exceptions that are, in the aggregate, not material), free and clear of any Lien other than Permitted Liens.

(f) Such Lien Grantor has not performed any acts that might prevent the Agent from enforcing any of the provisions of the Security Documents or that would limit the Agent in any such enforcement. No financing statement, security agreement, mortgage or similar or equivalent document or instrument covering all or part of the Collateral owned by such Lien Grantor is on file or of record in any jurisdiction in which such filing or recording would be effective to perfect or record a Lien on such Collateral, except financing statements, mortgages or other similar or equivalent documents with respect to Permitted Liens. After the Closing Date, no Collateral owned by such Lien Grantor will be in the possession or under the Control of any other Person having a claim thereto or security interest therein, other than a Permitted Lien.

(g) The Transaction Liens on all Personal Property Collateral owned by such Lien Grantor (i) have been validly created, (ii) will attach to each item of such Collateral on the Closing Date (or, if such Lien Grantor first obtains rights thereto on a later date, on such later date) and (iii) when so attached, will secure all the Secured Obligations or such Lien Grantor’s Transaction Guarantee, as the case may be.

 

13


(h) When the relevant Mortgages have been duly executed and delivered, the Transaction Liens on all Real Property Collateral owned by such Lien Grantor as of the Closing Date will have been validly created and will secure all the Secured Obligations or such Lien Grantor’s Transaction Guarantee, as the case may be. When such Mortgages (and memoranda of lease with respect to any leasehold interests included in such Real Property Collateral) have been duly recorded, such Transaction Liens will rank prior to all other Liens (except Permitted Liens) on such Real Property Collateral.

(i) Such Lien Grantor has delivered a Perfection Certificate to the Agent. The information set forth therein is correct and complete as of the Closing Date.

(j) When UCC financing statements describing the Collateral as “all personal property” have been filed in the offices specified in such Perfection Certificate, the Transaction Liens will constitute perfected security interests in the Personal Property Collateral owned by such Lien Grantor to the extent that a security interest therein may be perfected by filing pursuant to the UCC, prior to all Liens and rights of others therein except Permitted Liens. When, in addition to the filing of such UCC financing statements, the applicable Intellectual Property Filings have been made with respect to such Lien Grantor’s Recordable Intellectual Property (including any future filings required pursuant to Sections 4(a) and 6(a)), the Transaction Liens will constitute perfected security interests in all right, title and interest of such Lien Grantor in its Recordable Intellectual Property to the extent that security interests therein may be perfected by such filings, prior to all Liens and rights of others therein except Permitted Liens. Except for (i) the filing of such UCC financing statements, (ii) such Intellectual Property Filings, (iii) the due recordation of memoranda of lease with respect to the Pledged leasehold interests and (iv) the due recordation of the Mortgages, no registration, recordation or filing with any governmental body, agency or official is required in connection with the execution or delivery of the Security Documents or is necessary for the validity or enforceability thereof or for the perfection or due recordation of the Transaction Liens or for the enforcement of the Transaction Liens.

(k) Such Lien Grantor has taken, and will continue to take, all actions necessary under the UCC to perfect (and maintain the perfection of) its interest in any Accounts or Chattel Paper purchased or otherwise acquired by it, as against its assignors and creditors of its assignors.

(l) Such Lien Grantor’s Collateral is insured as required by the Credit Agreement.

 

14


(m) All of such Lien Grantor’s Inventory has or will have been produced in compliance with the applicable requirements of the Fair Labor Standards Act, as amended.

SECTION 4. Further Assurances; General Covenants. Each Lien Grantor covenants as follows:

(a) Such Lien Grantor will, from time to time, at the Borrower’s expense, execute, deliver, file and record any statement, assignment, instrument, document, agreement or other paper and take any other action (including any Intellectual Property Filing and any filing of financing or continuation statements under the UCC) that from time to time may be reasonably necessary or desirable, or that the Agent may reasonably request, in order to:

(i) create, preserve, perfect, confirm or validate the Transaction Liens on such Lien Grantor’s Collateral;

(ii) in the case of Pledged Deposit Accounts and Pledged Investment Property, cause the Agent to have Control thereof;

(iii) enable the Agent and the other Secured Parties to obtain the full benefits of the Security Documents; or

(iv) enable the Agent to exercise and enforce any of its rights, powers and remedies with respect to any of such Lien Grantor’s Collateral.

To the extent permitted by applicable law, such Lien Grantor authorizes the Agent to execute and file such financing statements or continuation statements without such Lien Grantor’s signature appearing thereon. Such Lien Grantor constitutes the Agent its attorney-in-fact to execute and file all Intellectual Property Filings and other filings required or so requested for the foregoing purposes, all acts of such attorney being hereby ratified and confirmed; and such power, being coupled with an interest, shall be irrevocable until all the Transaction Liens granted by such Lien Grantor terminate pursuant to Section 19. The Borrower will pay the costs of, or incidental to, any Intellectual Property Filings and any recording or filing of any financing or continuation statements or other documents recorded or filed pursuant hereto.

(b) Such Lien Grantor will not (i) change its name or corporate structure, (ii) change its location (determined as provided in UCC Section 9-307) or (iii) become bound, as provided in UCC Section 9-203(d) or otherwise, by a security agreement entered into by another Person, unless it shall have given the Agent at least 30 days prior notice thereof.

 

15


(c) Except for sales of inventory in the ordinary course of business, such Lien Grantor will not sell, lease, exchange, assign or otherwise dispose of, or grant any option with respect to, any of its Collateral; provided that such Lien Grantor may do any of the foregoing unless (i) doing so would violate a covenant in the Credit Agreement or (ii) an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing and the Agent shall have notified such Lien Grantor that its right to do so is terminated, suspended or otherwise limited. Concurrently with any sale, lease or other disposition (except a sale or disposition to another Lien Grantor or a lease) permitted by the foregoing proviso , the Transaction Liens on the assets sold or disposed of (but not in any Proceeds arising from such sale or disposition) will cease immediately without any action by the Agent or any other Secured Party. The Agent will, at the Borrower’s expense, execute and deliver to the relevant Lien Grantor such documents as such Lien Grantor shall reasonably request to evidence the fact that any asset so sold or disposed of is no longer subject to a Transaction Lien.

(d) Such Lien Grantor will, promptly upon request, provide to the Agent all information and evidence concerning such Lien Grantor’s Collateral that the Agent may reasonably request from time to time to enable it to enforce the provisions of the Security Documents.

SECTION 5 . Equipment. Each Lien Grantor covenants that it will not permit any of its Pledged Equipment to become a fixture to real estate or an accession to any personal property that is not included in the Collateral.

SECTION 6 . Recordable Intellectual Property. Each Lien Grantor covenants as follows:

(a) On the Closing Date (in the case of an Original Lien Grantor) or the date on which it signs and delivers its first Security Agreement Supplement (in the case of any other Lien Grantor), such Lien Grantor will sign and deliver to the Agent Intellectual Property Security Agreements with respect to all Recordable Intellectual Property then owned by it. Within 30 days after each June 30 and December 31 thereafter, it will sign and deliver to the Agent an appropriate Intellectual Property Security Agreement covering any Recordable Intellectual Property owned by it on such June 30 or December 31 that is not covered by any previous Intellectual Property Security Agreement so signed and delivered by it. Each Lien Grantor hereby authorizes the Agent to make all Intellectual Property Filings necessary to record the Transaction Liens on its Recordable Intellectual Property.

(b) Such Lien Grantor will notify the Agent promptly if it knows that any application or registration relating to any Recordable Intellectual Property owned or licensed by it that is material to its business may become abandoned or

 

16


dedicated to the public, or of any adverse determination or development (including the institution of, or any adverse determination or development in, any proceeding in the United States Copyright Office, the United States Patent and Trademark Office or any court) regarding such Lien Grantor’s ownership of such Recordable Intellectual Property, its right to register or patent the same, or its right to keep and maintain the same. If any of such Lien Grantor’s rights to any Recordable Intellectual Property are infringed, misappropriated or diluted in any material respect by a third party, such Lien Grantor will notify the Agent within 30 days after it learns thereof and will, unless such Lien Grantor shall reasonably determine that such action would be of negligible value, economic or otherwise, promptly sue for infringement, misappropriation or dilution and to recover any and all damages for such infringement, misappropriation or dilution, and take such other actions as such Lien Grantor shall reasonably deem appropriate under the circumstances to protect such Recordable Intellectual Property.

SECTION 7 . Investment Property. Each Lien Grantor represents, warrants and covenants as follows:

(a) Certificated Securities. On the Closing Date (in the case of an Original Lien Grantor) or the date on which it signs and delivers its first Security Agreement Supplement (in the case of any other Lien Grantor), such Lien Grantor will deliver to the Applicable Agent as Collateral hereunder all certificates representing Pledged Certificated Securities then owned by such Lien Grantor. Thereafter, whenever such Lien Grantor acquires any other certificate representing a Pledged Certificated Security, such Lien Grantor will immediately deliver such certificate to the Applicable Agent as Collateral hereunder. The provisions of this subsection are subject to the limitation in Section 7(j) in the case of voting Equity Interests in a Foreign Subsidiary.

(b) Uncertificated Securities . On the Closing Date (in the case of an Original Lien Grantor) or the date on which it signs and delivers its first Security Agreement Supplement (in the case of any other Lien Grantor), such Lien Grantor will enter into (and cause the relevant issuer to enter into) an Issuer Control Agreement in respect of each Pledged Uncertificated Security then owned by such Lien Grantor and deliver such Issuer Control Agreement to the Applicable Agent (which shall enter into the same). Thereafter, whenever such Lien Grantor acquires any other Pledged Uncertificated Security, such Lien Grantor will enter into (and cause the relevant issuer to enter into) an Issuer Control Agreement in respect of such Pledged Uncertificated Security and deliver such Issuer Control Agreement to the Applicable Agent (which shall enter into the same). The provisions of this subsection are subject to the limitation in Section 7(j) in the case of voting Equity Interests in a Foreign Subsidiary.

 

17


(c) Security Entitlements . On the Closing Date (in the case of an Original Lien Grantor) or the date on which it signs and delivers its first Security Agreement Supplement (in the case of any other Lien Grantor), such Lien Grantor will, with respect to each Security Entitlement then owned by it, enter into (and cause the relevant Securities Intermediary to enter into) a Securities Account Control Agreement in respect of such Security Entitlement and the Securities Account to which the underlying Financial Asset is credited and will deliver such Securities Account Control Agreement to the Applicable Agent (which shall enter into the same). Thereafter, whenever such Lien Grantor acquires any other Security Entitlement, such Lien Grantor will, as promptly as practicable, cause the underlying Financial Asset to be credited to a Controlled Securities Account. Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this clause (c), the Lien Grantors have the right not to comply therewith with respect to Securities Accounts having an aggregate value of less than $1,000,000 in the aggregate for all Lien Grantors; provided , that if an Event of Default occurs and is continuing, the Applicable Agent may terminate the foregoing right not to comply, or reduce the amount thereof, by giving at least 10 Business Days’ notice of such termination or reduction to the relevant Lien Grantors.

(d) Perfection as to Certificated Securities. When such Lien Grantor delivers the certificate representing any Pledged Certificated Security owned by it to the Applicable Agent and complies with Section 7(h) in connection with such delivery, (i) the Transaction Lien on such Pledged Certificated Security will be perfected, subject to no prior Liens or rights of others (except Liens permitted under Section 6.01(b) or Section 6.01(m) of the Credit Agreement), (ii) the Applicable Agent will have Control of such Pledged Certificated Security and (iii) the Applicable Agent will be a protected purchaser (within the meaning of UCC Section 8-303) thereof.

(e) Perfection as to Uncertificated Securities . When such Lien Grantor, the Applicable Agent and the issuer of any Pledged Uncertificated Security owned by such Lien Grantor enter into an Issuer Control Agreement with respect thereto, (i) the Transaction Lien on such Pledged Uncertificated Security will be perfected, subject to no prior Liens or rights of others (except Liens permitted under Section 6.01(b) or Section 6.01(m) of the Credit Agreement), (ii) the Applicable Agent will have Control of such Pledged Uncertificated Security and (iii) the Applicable Agent will be a protected purchaser (within the meaning of UCC Section 8-303) thereof.

(f) Perfection as to Security Entitlements . So long as the Financial Asset underlying any Security Entitlement owned by such Lien Grantor is credited to a Controlled Securities Account, (i) the Transaction Lien on such Security Entitlement will be perfected, subject to no prior Liens or rights of others (except Liens and rights of the relevant Securities Intermediary that are Permitted

 

18


Liens and any other Liens consented to by the Applicable Agent, and Liens permitted under Section 6.01(b) or Section 6.01(m) of the Credit Agreement), (ii) the Applicable Agent will have Control of such Security Entitlement and (iii) no action based on an adverse claim to such Security Entitlement or such Financial Asset, whether framed in conversion, replevin, constructive trust, equitable lien or other theory, may be asserted against the Applicable Agent or any other Secured Party.

(g) Agreement as to Applicable Jurisdiction . In respect of all Security Entitlements owned by such Lien Grantor, and all Securities Accounts to which the related Financial Assets are credited, the Securities Intermediary’s jurisdiction (determined as provided in UCC Section 8-110(e)) will at all times be located in the United States.

(h) Delivery of Pledged Certificates . All Pledged Certificates, when delivered to the Applicable Agent, will be in suitable form for transfer by delivery, or accompanied by duly executed instruments of transfer or assignment in blank, with signatures appropriately witnessed, all in form and substance satisfactory to the Applicable Agent.

(i) Communications . Each Lien Grantor will promptly give to the Applicable Agent copies of any material notices and communications received by it with respect to (i) Pledged Securities registered in the name of such Lien Grantor or its nominee and (ii) Pledged Security Entitlements as to which such Lien Grantor is the Entitlement Holder.

(j) Foreign Subsidiaries. A Lien Grantor will not be obligated to comply with the provisions of this Section at any time with respect to any voting Equity Interest in a Foreign Subsidiary if and to the extent (but only to the extent) that such voting Equity Interest is excluded from the Transaction Liens at such time pursuant to clause (B) of the proviso at the end of Section 2(a) and/or the comparable provisions of one or more Security Agreement Supplements.

(k) Compliance with Applicable Foreign Laws. If and so long as the Collateral includes (i) any Equity Interest in, or other Investment Property issued by, a legal entity organized under the laws of a jurisdiction outside the United States or (ii) any Security Entitlement in respect of a Financial Asset issued by such a foreign legal entity, the relevant Lien Grantor will take all such action as may be required under the laws of such foreign jurisdiction to ensure that the Transaction Lien on such Collateral ranks prior to all Liens and rights of others therein.

SECTION 8 . Controlled Deposit Accounts. Each Lien Grantor represents, warrants and covenants as follows:

 

19


(a) All cash owned by such Lien Grantor will be deposited, upon or promptly after the receipt thereof, in one or more Controlled Deposit Accounts. Each Controlled Deposit Account will be operated as provided in Section 10.

(b) In respect of each Controlled Deposit Account, the Depositary Bank’s jurisdiction (determined as provided in UCC Section 9-304) will at all times be a jurisdiction in which Article 9 of the Uniform Commercial Code is in effect.

(c) So long as the Applicable Agent has Control of a Controlled Deposit Account, the Transaction Lien on such Controlled Deposit Account will be perfected, subject to no prior Liens or rights of others (except the Depositary Bank’s right to deduct its normal operating charges and any uncollected funds previously credited thereto and any other Liens consented to by the Applicable Agent, and Liens permitted under Section 6.01(b) or Section 6.01(m) of the Credit Agreement).

(d) Materiality Exception. The Lien Grantors have the right not to comply with the foregoing provisions of this Section with respect to (i) Deposit Accounts that are payroll or trust accounts and (ii) other Deposit Accounts having total collected balances that do not at any time exceed $2,000,000 in the aggregate for all Lien Grantors.

SECTION 9 . Cash Collateral Accounts. (a) The Lien Grantors will establish the following Deposit Accounts (each such Deposit Account, a “ Cash Collateral Account ”), which will be operated as provided in this Section and Section 10:

(i) the Collection Account, which shall be under the exclusive control of the Agent; and

(ii) the Letter of Credit Account, which shall be under the exclusive control of the Agent.

(b) The following amounts shall be deposited into the Cash Collateral Accounts:

(i) the Lien Grantors shall deposit to the Collection Account all amounts required pursuant to Sections 2.12(b) and 5.11(b) of the Credit Agreement;

(ii) the Lien Grantors shall deposit to the Letter of Credit Account all amounts required pursuant to Sections 2.03(k) and 2.12(a)(ii) and Article 7 of the Credit Agreement; and

 

20


(iii) the Agent shall deposit to the Collection Account each amount realized or otherwise received with respect to assets of any Lien Grantor upon any exercise of remedies pursuant to any Security Document.

(c) The Agent shall maintain such records and/or establish such sub-accounts as shall be required to enable it to identify the amounts held in each Cash Collateral Account from time to time pursuant to each clause of subsection (b) of this Section, as applicable.

(d) The Agent shall withdraw amounts from the Cash Collateral Accounts and apply them for the following purposes:

(i) any amounts deposited in the Collection Account shall be applied by the Agent on each Business Day to prepay outstanding Loans or to increase the amount of Cash Collateralization in the Letter of Credit Account in accordance with Section 2.12(c) of the Credit Agreement; and

(ii) any amounts deposited to the Letter of Credit Account shall (i) be held as collateral security for the Borrower’s reimbursement obligations in respect of any LC Exposure and withdrawn and applied against the Borrower’s reimbursement obligations in respect of any unreimbursed LC Disbursements, (ii) if an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing or if the maturity of the Loans shall have been accelerated pursuant to Article 7 of the Credit Agreement, be held as collateral security for the Secured Obligations and, in the discretion of the Agent, transferred to the Collection Account or (iii) be returned to the Borrower in accordance with the terms of the Credit Agreement.

SECTION 10 . Operation of Collateral Accounts. (a) Funds held in any Cash Collateral Account may, until withdrawn, be invested and reinvested in such Permitted Investments as the Borrower shall request from time to time; provided that if an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Agent (in the case of the Collection Account and the Letter of Credit Account) or the Applicable Agent (in the case of all other Cash Collateral Accounts) may select such Permitted Investments. Funds held in any Controlled Deposit Account or Controlled Securities Account may, until withdrawn, be invested and reinvested in such Permitted Investments as the Borrower shall request from time to time; provided that if a Liquidity Trigger Period shall be continuing, the Applicable Agent may select such Permitted Investments. Any investment income received on the Cash Collateral Accounts will be deposited into and become part of the Cash Collateral Accounts.

 

21


(b) With respect to each Controlled Deposit Account and each Controlled Securities Account (it being understood that the provisions of Section 9 shall apply to all Cash Collateral Accounts), the Applicable Agent will instruct the relevant Securities Intermediary or Depositary Bank that the relevant Lien Grantor may withdraw, or direct the disposition of, funds held therein unless and until the Applicable Agent rescinds such instruction. The Applicable Agent will not rescind such instructions unless a Liquidity Trigger Period shall be continuing.

(c) If an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Agent (with respect to the Collection Account and the Letter of Credit Account) and the Applicable Agent (with respect to any other Collateral Account) may retain or liquidate, or instruct the relevant Securities Intermediary or Depositary Bank to retain or liquidate, any or all cash or investments then held in such Collateral Account and/or withdraw any amounts held therein and apply such amounts as provided in Section 14.

SECTION 11 . Transfer Of Record Ownership. At any time when an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Applicable Agent may (and to the extent that action by it is required, the relevant Lien Grantor, if directed to do so by the Applicable Agent, will as promptly as practicable) cause each of the Pledged Securities (or any portion thereof specified in such direction) to be transferred of record into the name of the Applicable Agent or its nominee. Each Lien Grantor will take any and all actions reasonably requested by the Applicable Agent to facilitate compliance with this Section. If the provisions of this Section are implemented, Section 7(b) shall not thereafter apply to any Pledged Security that is registered in the name of the Applicable Agent or its nominee. The Applicable Agent will promptly give to the relevant Lien Grantor copies of any notices and other communications received by the Applicable Agent with respect to Pledged Securities registered in the name of the Applicable Agent or its nominee.

SECTION 12 . Right to Vote Securities. (a) Unless an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, each Lien Grantor will have the right, from time to time, to vote and to give consents, ratifications and waivers with respect to any Pledged Security owned by it and the Financial Asset underlying any Pledged Security Entitlement owned by it, and the Agent will, upon receiving a written request from such Lien Grantor, deliver to such Lien Grantor or as specified in such request such proxies, powers of attorney, consents, ratifications and waivers in respect of any such Pledged Security that is registered in the name of the Agent or its nominee or any such Pledged Security Entitlement as to which the Agent or its nominee is the Entitlement Holder, in each case as shall be specified in such request and be in form and substance satisfactory to the Agent. Unless an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Applicable Agent will have

 

22


no right to take any action which the owner of a Pledged Partnership Interest or Pledged LLC Interest is entitled to take with respect thereto, except the right to receive payments and other distributions to the extent provided herein.

(b) If an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Applicable Agent will have the right (but not the obligation), to the extent permitted by law (and, in the case of a Pledged Partnership Interest or Pledged LLC Interest, by the relevant partnership agreement, limited liability company agreement, operating agreement or other governing document), to vote, to give consents, ratifications and waivers and to take any other action with respect to the Pledged Investment Property, the other Pledged Equity Interests (if any) and the Financial Assets underlying the Pledged Security Entitlements, with the same force and effect as if the Applicable Agent were the absolute and sole owner thereof, and each Lien Grantor will take all such action as the Applicable Agent may reasonably request from time to time to give effect to such right.

SECTION 13 . Remedies upon Event of Default. (a) If an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Agent may exercise (or cause its sub-agents to exercise) any or all of the remedies available to it (or to such sub-agents) under the Security Documents.

(b) Without limiting the generality of the foregoing and subject to the terms of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, if an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Agent may exercise on behalf of the Secured Parties all the rights of a secured party under the UCC (whether or not in effect in the jurisdiction where such rights are exercised) with respect to any Personal Property Collateral and, in addition, the Agent (with respect to the Collection Account and the Letter of Credit Account) and the Applicable Agent (with respect to any other Collateral Account) may, without being required to give any notice, except as herein provided or as may be required by mandatory provisions of law, withdraw all cash held in such Collateral Account and apply such cash as provided in Section 14 and, if there shall be no such cash or if such cash shall be insufficient to pay all the Secured Obligations in full, sell, lease, license or otherwise dispose of the Collateral or any part thereof. Notice of any such sale or other disposition shall be given to the relevant Lien Grantor(s) as required by Section 16. The foregoing provisions of this subsection shall apply to Real Property Collateral only to the extent permitted by applicable law and the provisions of any applicable Mortgage or other document.

(c) Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, if an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, and subject to the terms of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement with respect to each Type of Common Collateral:

 

23


(i) the Agent may license or sublicense, whether general, special or otherwise, and whether on an exclusive or non-exclusive basis, any Pledged intellectual property (including any Pledged Recordable Intellectual Property) throughout the world for such term or terms, on such conditions and in such manner as the Agent shall in its sole discretion determine; provided that such licenses or sublicenses do not conflict with any existing license of which the Agent shall have received a copy;

(ii) the Agent may (without assuming any obligation or liability thereunder), at any time and from time to time, in its sole and reasonable discretion, enforce (and shall have the exclusive right to enforce) against any licensee or sublicensee all rights and remedies of any Lien Grantor in, to and under any of its Pledged intellectual property and take or refrain from taking any action under any thereof, and each Lien Grantor releases the Agent and each other Secured Party from liability for, and agrees to hold the Agent and each other Secured Party free and harmless from and against any claims and expenses arising out of, any lawful action so taken or omitted to be taken with respect thereto, except for claims and expenses arising from the Agent’s or such Secured Party’s gross negligence or willful misconduct; and

(iii) upon request by the Agent (which shall not be construed as implying any limitation on its rights or powers), each Lien Grantor will execute and deliver to the Agent a power of attorney, in form and substance satisfactory to the Agent, for the implementation of any sale, lease, license or other disposition of any of such Lien Grantor’s Pledged intellectual property or any action related thereto. In connection with any such disposition, but subject to any confidentiality restrictions imposed on such Lien Grantor in any license or similar agreement, such Lien Grantor will supply to the Agent its know-how and expertise relating to the relevant intellectual property or the products or services made or rendered in connection with such intellectual property, and its customer lists and other records relating to such intellectual property and to the distribution of said products or services.

SECTION 14 . Application of Proceeds. (a)  If an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Agent may apply (i) any cash held in the Collection Account and the Letter of Credit Account and (ii) subject to the terms of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, any amounts held in any other Collateral Account and the proceeds of any sale or other disposition of all or any part of the Collateral, in the following order of priorities:

 

24


first , to pay the expenses of such sale or other disposition, including reasonable compensation to agents of and counsel for the Agent, and all expenses, liabilities and advances incurred or made by the Agent in connection with the Security Documents, and any other amounts then due and payable to the Agent pursuant to Section 15 or pursuant to Section 10.05 of the Credit Agreement;

second , to pay the unpaid principal of the Obligations ratably (or provide for the payment thereof pursuant to Section 14(b)), until payment in full of the principal of all Obligations shall have been made (or so provided for);

third , to pay ratably (i) all interest (including Post-Petition Interest) on the Obligations and (ii) all Fees payable under the Credit Agreement, until payment in full of all such interest and Fees shall have been made;

fourth , to pay all other Secured Obligations ratably (or provide for the payment thereof pursuant to Section 14(b)), until payment in full of all such other Secured Obligations shall have been made (or so provided for);

fifth , to the Authorized Term Collateral Agent to be applied in accordance with Section 2.01 of the Term Intercreditor Agreement; and

finally , to pay to the relevant Lien Grantor, or as a court of competent jurisdiction may direct, any surplus then remaining from the proceeds of the Collateral owned by it;

provided that (i) Collateral owned by a Subsidiary Guarantor and any proceeds thereof shall be applied pursuant to the foregoing clauses only to the extent that the value thereof does not exceed the largest amount that would not render the Transaction Guarantee of such Subsidiary Guarantor subject to avoidance under Section 548 of the United States Bankruptcy Code or any comparable provisions of applicable law. The Agent may make such distributions hereunder in cash or in kind or, on a ratable basis, in any combination thereof.

(b) If at any time any portion of any monies collected or received by the Agent would, but for the provisions of this Section 14(b), be payable pursuant to Section 14(a) in respect of a Contingent Secured Obligation, the Agent shall not apply any monies to pay such Contingent Secured Obligation but instead shall request the holder thereof, at least 10 days before each proposed distribution hereunder, to notify the Agent as to the maximum amount of such Contingent Secured Obligation if then ascertainable ( e.g. , in the case of a letter of credit, the maximum amount available for subsequent drawings thereunder). If the holder of such Contingent Secured Obligation does not notify the Agent of the maximum

 

25


ascertainable amount thereof at least two Business Days before such distribution, such holder will not be entitled to share in such distribution. If such holder does so notify the Agent as to the maximum ascertainable amount thereof, the Agent will allocate to such holder a portion of the monies to be distributed in such distribution, calculated as if such Contingent Secured Obligation were outstanding in such maximum ascertainable amount. However, the Agent will not apply such portion of such monies to pay such Contingent Secured Obligation, but instead will hold such monies or invest such monies in Permitted Investments. All such monies and Permitted Investments and all proceeds thereof will constitute Collateral hereunder, but will be subject to distribution in accordance with this Section 14(b) rather than Section 14(a). The Agent will hold all such monies and Permitted Investments and the net proceeds thereof in trust until all or part of such Contingent Secured Obligation becomes a Non-Contingent Secured Obligation, whereupon the Agent at the request of the relevant Secured Party will apply the amount so held in trust to pay such Non-Contingent Secured Obligation; provided that, if the other Secured Obligations theretofore paid pursuant to the same clause of Section 14(a) ( i.e. , clause second or fourth ) were not paid in full, the Agent will apply the amount so held in trust to pay the same percentage of such Non-Contingent Secured Obligation as the percentage of such other Secured Obligations theretofore paid pursuant to the same clause of Section 14(a). If (i) the holder of such Contingent Secured Obligation shall advise the Agent that no portion thereof remains in the category of a Contingent Secured Obligation and (ii) the Agent still holds any amount held in trust pursuant to this Section 14(b) in respect of such Contingent Secured Obligation (after paying all amounts payable pursuant to the preceding sentence with respect to any portions thereof that became Non-Contingent Secured Obligations), such remaining amount will be applied by the Agent in the order of priorities set forth in Section 14(a).

(c) In making the payments and allocations required by this Section, the Agent may rely upon information supplied to it pursuant to Section 18(c). All distributions made by the Agent pursuant to this Section shall be final (except in the event of manifest error) and the Agent shall have no duty to inquire as to the application by any Secured Party of any amount distributed to it.

SECTION 15. Fees and Expenses; Indemnification . (a) The Borrower will forthwith upon demand pay to the Agent:

(i) the amount of any taxes that the Agent may have been required to pay by reason of the Transaction Liens or to free any Collateral from any other Lien thereon;

(ii) the amount of any and all reasonable out-of-pocket expenses, including transfer taxes and reasonable fees and expenses of counsel and other experts, that the Agent may incur in connection with (x)

 

26


the administration or enforcement of the Security Documents, including such expenses as are incurred to preserve the value of the Collateral or the validity, perfection, rank or value of any Transaction Lien, (y) the collection, sale or other disposition of any Collateral or (z) the exercise by the Agent of any of its rights or powers under the Security Documents;

(iii) the amount of any fees that the Borrower shall have agreed in writing to pay to the Agent and that shall have become due and payable in accordance with such written agreement; and

(iv) the amount required to indemnify the Agent for, or hold it harmless and defend it against, any loss, liability or expense (including the reasonable fees and expenses of its counsel and any experts or sub-agents appointed by it hereunder) incurred or suffered by the Agent in connection with the Security Documents, except to the extent that such loss, liability or expense arises from the Agent’s gross negligence or willful misconduct or a breach of any duty that the Agent has under this Agreement (after giving effect to Sections 17 and 18).

Any such amount not paid to the Agent on demand will bear interest for each day thereafter until paid at a rate per annum equal to the sum of 2% plus the rate applicable to Base Rate Loans for such day.

(b) If any transfer tax, documentary stamp tax or other tax is payable in connection with any transfer or other transaction provided for in the Security Documents, the Borrower will pay such tax and provide any required tax stamps to the Agent or as otherwise required by law.

SECTION 16 . Authority to Administer Collateral. Each Lien Grantor irrevocably appoints the Agent its true and lawful attorney, with full power of substitution, in the name of such Lien Grantor, any Secured Party or otherwise, for the sole use and benefit of the Secured Parties, but at the Borrower’s expense, to the extent permitted by law to exercise, at any time and from time to time while an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, all or any of the following powers with respect to all or any of such Lien Grantor’s Collateral:

(a) to demand, sue for, collect, receive and give acquittance for any and all monies due or to become due upon or by virtue thereof,

(b) to settle, compromise, compound, prosecute or defend any action or proceeding with respect thereto,

 

27


(c) to sell, lease, license or otherwise dispose of the same or the proceeds or avails thereof, as fully and effectually as if the Agent were the absolute owner thereof, and

(d) to extend the time of payment of any or all thereof and to make any allowance or other adjustment with reference thereto;

provided that, except in the case of Personal Property Collateral that is perishable or threatens to decline speedily in value or is of a type customarily sold on a recognized market, the Agent will give the relevant Lien Grantor at least ten days’ prior written notice of the time and place of any public sale thereof or the time after which any private sale or other intended disposition thereof will be made. Any such notice shall (i) contain the information specified in UCC Section 9-613, (ii) be Authenticated and (iii) be sent to the parties required to be notified pursuant to UCC Section 9-611(c); provided that, if the Agent fails to comply with this sentence in any respect, its liability for such failure shall be limited to the liability (if any) imposed on it as a matter of law under the UCC.

SECTION 17 . Limitation on Duty in Respect of Collateral. Beyond the exercise of reasonable care in the custody and preservation thereof, the Agent will have no duty as to any Collateral in its possession or control or in the possession or control of any sub-agent or bailee or any income therefrom or as to the preservation of rights against prior parties or any other rights pertaining thereto. The Agent will be deemed to have exercised reasonable care in the custody and preservation of the Collateral in its possession or control if such Collateral is accorded treatment substantially equal to that which it accords its own property, and will not be liable or responsible for any loss or damage to any Collateral, or for any diminution in the value thereof, by reason of any act or omission of any sub-agent or bailee selected by the Agent in good faith, except to the extent that such liability arises from the Agent’s gross negligence or willful misconduct.

SECTION 18 . General Provisions Concerning the Agent.

(a) The provisions of Article 8 of the Credit Agreement shall inure to the benefit of the Agent, and shall be binding upon all Lien Grantors and all Secured Parties, in connection with this Agreement and the other Security Documents. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, 1) the Agent shall not be subject to any fiduciary or other implied duties, regardless of whether an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, 2) the Agent shall not have any duty to take any discretionary action or exercise any discretionary powers, except discretionary rights and powers expressly contemplated by the Security Documents that the Agent is required in writing to exercise by the Required Lenders (or such other number or percentage of the Lenders as shall be necessary under the circumstances as provided in Section 10.09 of the Credit Agreement),

 

28


and 3) except as expressly set forth in the Loan Documents, the Agent shall not have any duty to disclose, and shall not be liable for any failure to disclose, any information relating to any Group Member that is communicated to or obtained by the Agent or any of its Affiliates in any capacity. The Agent shall not be responsible for the existence, genuineness or value of any Collateral or for the validity, perfection, priority or enforceability of any Transaction Lien, whether impaired by operation of law or by reason of any action or omission to act on its part under the Security Documents. The Agent shall be deemed not to have knowledge of any Event of Default unless and until written notice thereof is given to the Agent by a Lien Grantor or a Secured Party.

(b) Sub- Agents and Related Parties . The Agent may perform any of its duties and exercise any of its rights and powers through one or more sub-agents appointed by it. The Agent and any such sub-agent may perform any of its duties and exercise any of its rights and powers through its Related Parties. The exculpatory provisions of Section 17 and this Section shall apply to any such sub-agent and to the Related Parties of the Agent and any such sub-agent.

(c) Information as to Secured Obligations and Actions by Secured Parties. For all purposes of the Security Documents, including determining the amounts of the Secured Obligations and whether a Secured Obligation is a Contingent Secured Obligation or not, or whether any action has been taken under any Secured Agreement, the Agent will be entitled to rely on information from (i) its own records for information as to the Lenders, the Issuing Lender, their Secured Obligations and actions taken by them, (ii) any Secured Party for information as to its Secured Obligations and actions taken by it, to the extent that the Agent has not obtained such information from its own records, and (iii) the Borrower, to the extent that the Agent has not obtained information from the foregoing sources.

(d) Refusal to Act. The Agent may refuse to act on any notice, consent, direction or instruction from any Secured Parties or any agent, trustee or similar representative thereof that, in the Agent’s opinion, (i) is contrary to law or the provisions of any Security Document, (ii) may expose the Agent to liability (unless the Agent shall have been indemnified, to its reasonable satisfaction, for such liability by the Secured Parties that gave such notice, consent, direction or instruction) or (iii) is unduly prejudicial to Secured Parties not joining in such notice, consent, direction or instruction.

SECTION 19 . Termination of Transaction Liens; Release of Collateral. (a) The Transaction Liens granted by each Guarantor shall terminate when its Transaction Guarantee terminates in accordance with the Credit Agreement.

 

29


(b) The Transaction Liens shall terminate when all the Release Conditions are satisfied; provided , that if at any time any payment of a Secured Obligation is rescinded or must be otherwise restored or returned upon the insolvency or receivership of the Borrower or otherwise, the Transaction Liens shall be reinstated.

(c) At any time before the Transaction Liens terminate, the Agent may, at the written request of the Borrower, release any Collateral (but not all or substantially all the Collateral) with the prior written consent of the Required Lenders.

(d) Upon any termination of a Transaction Lien or release of Collateral, the Agent will, at the expense of the relevant Lien Grantor, execute and deliver to such Lien Grantor such documents as such Lien Grantor shall reasonably request to evidence the termination of such Transaction Lien or the release of such Collateral, as the case may be.

SECTION 20 . Additional Lien Grantors. Any Subsidiary may become a party hereto by signing and delivering to the Agent a Security Agreement Supplement, whereupon such Subsidiary shall become a “Lien Grantor” as defined herein.

SECTION 21 . Notices. Each notice, request or other communication given to any party hereunder shall be given or made in accordance with Section 10.01 of the Credit Agreement.

SECTION 22 . No Implied Waivers; Remedies Not Exclusive. No failure by the Agent or any Secured Party to exercise, and no delay in exercising and no course of dealing with respect to, any right or remedy under any Security Document shall operate as a waiver thereof; nor shall any single or partial exercise by the Agent or any Secured Party of any right or remedy under any Loan Document preclude any other or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right or remedy. The rights and remedies specified in the Loan Documents are cumulative and are not exclusive of any other rights or remedies provided by law.

SECTION 23 . Successors and Assigns. This Agreement is for the benefit of the Agent and the Secured Parties. If all or any part of any Secured Party’s interest in any Secured Obligation is assigned or otherwise transferred in a transaction permitted under the Credit Agreement, the transferor’s rights hereunder, to the extent applicable to the obligation so transferred, shall be automatically transferred with such obligation. This Agreement shall be binding on the Lien Grantors and their respective successors and assigns.

 

30


SECTION 24 . Amendments and Waivers. Neither this Agreement nor any provision hereof may be waived, amended, modified or terminated except pursuant to an agreement or agreements in writing entered into by the Agent, with the consent of such Lenders as are required to consent thereto under Section 10.09 of the Credit Agreement. No such waiver, amendment or modification shall (i) be binding upon any Lien Grantor, except with the written consent of the Borrower or (ii) affect the rights of a Secured Party (other than a Lender) hereunder more adversely than it affects the comparable rights of the Lenders hereunder, without the consent of such Secured Party.

SECTION 25 . Choice of Law. This Agreement shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of New York, except as otherwise required by mandatory provisions of law and except to the extent that remedies provided by the laws of any jurisdiction other than the State of New York are governed by the laws of such jurisdiction.

SECTION 26 . Waiver of Jury Trial. EACH PARTY HERETO HEREBY IRREVOCABLY WAIVES ALL RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY IN ANY ACTION, PROCEEDING OR COUNTERCLAIM ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO ANY OF THE LOAN DOCUMENTS OR THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED THEREBY. EACH PARTY HERETO (A) CERTIFIES THAT NO REPRESENTATIVE, AGENT OR ATTORNEY OF ANY OTHER PARTY HAS REPRESENTED, EXPRESSLY OR OTHERWISE, THAT SUCH OTHER PARTY WOULD NOT, IN THE EVENT OF LITIGATION, SEEK TO ENFORCE THE FOREGOING WAIVER AND (B) ACKNOWLEDGES THAT IT AND THE OTHER PARTIES HERETO HAVE BEEN INDUCED TO ENTER INTO THIS AGREEMENT BY, AMONG OTHER THINGS, THE MUTUAL WAIVERS AND CERTIFICATIONS IN THIS SECTION.

SECTION 27 . Severability. Any provision of any Security Document held to be invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any jurisdiction shall, as to such jurisdiction, be ineffective to the extent of such invalidity, illegality or unenforceability without affecting the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions thereof; and the invalidity of a particular provision in a particular jurisdiction shall not invalidate such provision in any other jurisdiction.

SECTION 28 . Credit Agreement. In the event of any conflict or inconsistency between the provisions of the Credit Agreement and this Agreement but subject to Section 30, the provisions of the Credit Agreement shall control.

SECTION 29 . Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts by the parties hereto on separate counterparts, each of which, when so executed and delivered, shall be deemed an original, but all such

 

31


counterparts shall together constitute one and the same instrument. Delivery of an executed counterpart of a signature page of this Agreement by telecopier or electronic image scan transmission (such as a “pdf” file) will be effective as delivery of a manually executed counterpart of this Agreement.

SECTION 30 . ABL Intercreditor Agreement. Reference is made to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, the lien and security interest granted to the Agent, for the benefit of the Secured Parties, pursuant to this Agreement and the exercise of any right or remedy by the Agent and the other Secured Parties hereunder are subject to the provisions of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement. In the event of any conflict or inconsistency between the provisions of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement and this Agreement, the provisions of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement shall control.

 

32


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Agreement to be duly executed by their respective authorized officers as of the day and year first above written.

 

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA,
LLC, as Borrower

By:  

  /s/ James C. Gouin

  Name:   James C. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President and CFO

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Agent

By:  

  /s/ Mary E. Gherty

  Name:   Mary E. Gherty
  Title:   Managing Director

 


Guarantors:

  TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS I, LLC

  By:  

  /s/ James C. Gouin

  Name:   James C. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President and CFO

  TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS II(a),
LLC

  By:  

  /s/ James C. Gouin

  Name:   James C. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President and CFO

  TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS II(b),
LLC

  By:  

  /s/ James C. Gouin

  Name:   James C. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President and CFO

  TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS
USA I, LLC

  By:  

  /s/ James C. Gouin

  Name:   James C. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President and CFO

  TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS
USA II, LLC

  By:  

  /s/ James C. Gouin

  Name:   James C. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President and CFO

 


TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS
USA III, LLC

By:  

  /s/ James C. Gouin

  Name:   James C. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President and CFO

TA HOLDINGS FINANCE, INC.

By:  

  /s/ James C. Gouin

  Name:   James C. Gouin
  Title:   Vice President and CFO

 


SCHEDULE 1

EQUITY INTERESTS IN SUBSIDIARIES AND AFFILIATES

OWNED BY ORIGINAL LIEN GRANTORS

(as of the Closing Date)

 

Issuer

 

Jurisdiction

of

Organization

 

Owner of

Equity Interest

 

Percentage

Owned

 

Number of

Shares or

Units

       
       
       
       
       

 

S-1-1


SCHEDULE 2

INVESTMENT PROPERTY

(other than Equity Interests in Subsidiaries and Affiliates)

OWNED BY ORIGINAL LIEN GRANTORS

(as of the Closing Date)

PART 1 — Securities

 

Issuer

 

Jurisdiction

of

Organization

 

Owner of Securities

 

Amount

Owned

 

Type of

Security

       
       
       
       
       

PART 2 — Securities Accounts

The Original Lien Grantors own Security Entitlements with respect to Financial Assets credited to the following Securities Accounts:

 

Owner

  

Securities

Intermediary

  

Account Number

     
     
     
     
     

 

S-2-1


EXHIBIT A

to Security Agreement

SECURITY AGREEMENT SUPPLEMENT

SECURITY AGREEMENT SUPPLEMENT dated as of              ,          , between [NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR] (the “ Lien Grantor ”) and JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Agent.

WHEREAS, Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the Guarantors party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Agent, are parties to an Amended and Restated ABL Security Agreement dated as of August 24, 2010 (as heretofore amended and/or supplemented, the “ Security Agreement ”) under which Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC secures certain of its obligations (the “ Secured Obligations ”) and the Guarantors party thereto secure their respective guarantees of the Secured Obligations;

WHEREAS, [name of Lien Grantor] has executed a Joinder Agreement and become a Guarantor;

WHEREAS, [name of Lien Grantor] desires to become [is] a party to the Security Agreement as a Lien Grantor thereunder; 1 and

WHEREAS, terms defined in the Security Agreement (or whose definitions are incorporated by reference in Section 1 of the Security Agreement) and not otherwise defined herein have, as used herein, the respective meanings provided for therein;

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing and other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto agree as follows:

1. Grant of Transaction Liens . (a) In order to secure [its Transaction Guarantee] 2 [the Secured Obligations] 3 , the Lien Grantor grants to the Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties a continuing security interest in all the following

 

1

If the Lien Grantor is the Borrower, delete this recital and Section 1 hereof.

2

Delete bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is the Borrower.

3

Delete bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is a Guarantor.

 

A-1


property of the Lien Grantor, whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising and regardless of where located (the “ New Collateral ”):

[describe property being added to the Collateral] 4

(b) With respect to each right to payment or performance included in the Collateral from time to time, the Transaction Lien granted therein includes a continuing security interest in (i) any Supporting Obligation that supports such payment or performance and (ii) any Lien that (x) secures such right to payment or performance or (y) secures any such Supporting Obligation.

(c) The foregoing Transaction Liens are granted as security only and shall not subject the Agent or any other Secured Party to, or transfer or in any way affect or modify, any obligation or liability of the Lien Grantor with respect to any of the New Collateral or any transaction in connection therewith.

2. Delivery of Collateral . Concurrently with delivering this Security Agreement Supplement to the Agent, the Lien Grantor is complying with the provisions of Section 7 of the Security Agreement with respect to Investment Property, in each case if and to the extent included in the New Collateral at such time.

3. Party to Security Agreement . Upon delivering this Security Agreement Supplement to the Agent, the Lien Grantor will become a party to the Security Agreement and will thereafter have all the rights and obligations of a Guarantor and a Lien Grantor thereunder and be bound by all the provisions thereof as fully as if the Lien Grantor were one of the original parties thereto. 5

4. Address of Lien Grantor . The address, facsimile number and e-mail address of the Lien Grantor are:

[address, facsimile number and e-mail address of Lien Grantor]

 

4 If the Lien Grantor is not already a party to the Security Agreement, clauses (i) through (xi) of, and the proviso to, Section 2(a) of the Security Agreement may be appropriate.
5 Delete Section 3 if the Lien Grantor is already a party to the Security Agreement.

 

A-2


5. Representations and Warranties . (a) The Lien Grantor is duly organized, validly existing and in good standing under the laws of [jurisdiction of organization].

(b) The Lien Grantor has delivered a Perfection Certificate to the Agent. The information set forth therein is correct and complete as of the date hereof.

(c) The execution and delivery of this Security Agreement Supplement by the Lien Grantor and the performance by it of its obligations under the Security Agreement as supplemented hereby are within its corporate or other powers, have been duly authorized by all necessary corporate or other action, require no action by or in respect of, or filing with, any governmental body, agency or official and do not contravene, or constitute a default under, any provision of applicable law or regulation or of its organizational documents, or of any agreement, judgment, injunction, order, decree or other instrument binding upon it or result in the creation or imposition of any Lien (except a Transaction Lien) on any of its assets.

(d) The Security Agreement as supplemented hereby constitutes a valid and binding agreement of the Lien Grantor, enforceable in accordance with its terms, except as limited by (i) applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, fraudulent conveyance or other similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally and (ii) general principles of equity.

(e) Each of the representations and warranties set forth in Sections 3 through 11 of the Security Agreement is true as applied to the Lien Grantor and the New Collateral. For purposes of the foregoing sentence, references in said Sections to a “Lien Grantor” shall be deemed to refer to the Lien Grantor, references to Schedules to the Security Agreement shall be deemed to refer to the corresponding Schedules to this Security Agreement Supplement, references to “Collateral” shall be deemed to refer to the New Collateral, and references to the “Closing Date” shall be deemed to refer to the date on which the Lien Grantor signs and delivers this Security Agreement Supplement.

6. [ Compliance with Foreign Law . The Lien Grantor represents that it has taken, and agrees that it will continue to take, all actions required under the laws (including the conflict of laws rules) of its jurisdiction of organization to

 

A-3


ensure that the Transaction Liens on the New Collateral rank prior to all Liens and rights of others therein. 6 ]

7. Governing Law . This Security Agreement Supplement shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of New York.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Security Agreement Supplement to be duly executed by their respective authorized officers as of the day and year first above written.

 

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]
By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  
JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Agent
By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  

 

6 Include Section 6 if the Lien Grantor is organized under the laws of a jurisdiction outside the United States.

 

A-4


Schedule 1

to Security Agreement

Supplement

EQUITY INTERESTS IN SUBSIDIARIES AND AFFILIATES

OWNED BY LIEN GRANTOR

 

Issuer

 

Jurisdiction

of

Organization

 

Percentage

Owned

 

Number of

Shares or Units

     
     
     
     
     

 

A-5


Schedule 2

to Security Agreement

Supplement

INVESTMENT PROPERTY

(other than Equity Interests in Subsidiaries and Affiliates)

OWNED BY LIEN GRANTOR

PART 1 — Securities

 

Issuer

 

Jurisdiction

of

Organization

 

Amount

Owned

 

Type of

Security

     
     
     
     
     

PART 2 — Securities Accounts

The Lien Grantor owns Security Entitlements with respect to Financial Assets credited to the following Securities Accounts:

 

Securities Intermediary

   Account Number
  
  
  
  
  

 

A-6


EXHIBIT B

to Security Agreement

COPYRIGHT SECURITY AGREEMENT

(Copyrights, Copyright Registrations, Copyright

Applications and Copyright Licenses)

WHEREAS, [name of Lien Grantor], a              corporation 1 (herein referred to as the “ Lien Grantor ”) owns, or in the case of licenses is a party to, the Copyright Collateral (as defined below);

WHEREAS, Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC (the “ Borrower ”), Tower Automotive, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(a), LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(b), LLC, the other guarantors and lenders party thereto, and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent, are parties to a Revolving Credit and Guaranty Agreement dated as of July 31, 2007 (as amended from time to time, the “ Credit Agreement ”); and

WHEREAS, pursuant to (i) an Amended and Restated ABL Security Agreement dated as of August 24, 2010 (as amended and/or supplemented from time to time, the “ Security Agreement ”) among the Borrower, the guarantors party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent for the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, together with its successors in such capacity, the “ Grantee ”), and (ii) certain other loan documents (including this Copyright Security Agreement), the Lien Grantor has [secured certain of its obligations (the “ Secured Obligations ”)] 2 [guaranteed certain obligations of the Borrower and secured such guarantee (the “ Lien Grantor’s Transaction Guarantee ”)] 3 by granting to the Grantee for the benefit of such Secured Parties a continuing security interest in personal property of the Lien Grantor, including all right, title and interest of the Lien Grantor in, to and under the Copyright Collateral (as defined below);

NOW, THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the Lien Grantor grants to the

 

1 Modify as needed if the Lien Grantor is not a corporation.
2 Delete these bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is a Guarantor.
3 Delete these bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is the Borrower.

 

B-1


Grantee, to secure the [Secured Obligations] [Lien Grantor’s Transaction Guarantee], a continuing security interest in all of the Lien Grantor’s right, title and interest in, to and under the following (all of the following items or types of property being herein collectively referred to as the “ Copyright Collateral ”), whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising:

(i) each Copyright (as defined in the Security Agreement) owned by the Lien Grantor, including, without limitation, each Copyright registration or application therefor referred to in Schedule 1 hereto;

(ii) each Copyright License (as defined in the Security Agreement) to which the Lien Grantor is a party, including, without limitation, each Copyright License identified in Schedule 1 hereto; and

(iii) all proceeds of, revenues from, and accounts and general intangibles arising out of, the foregoing, including, without limitation, all proceeds of and revenues from any claim by the Lien Grantor against third parties for past, present or future infringement of any Copyright (including, without limitation, any Copyright owned by the Lien Grantor and identified in Schedule 1), and all rights and benefits of the Lien Grantor under any Copyright License (including, without limitation, any Copyright License identified in Schedule 1).

The Lien Grantor irrevocably constitutes and appoints the Grantee and any officer or agent thereof, with full power of substitution, as its true and lawful attorney-in-fact with full power and authority in the name of the Lien Grantor or in the Grantee’s name, from time to time, in the Grantee’s discretion, so long as any Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, to take with respect to the Copyright Collateral any and all appropriate action which the Lien Grantor might take with respect to the Copyright Collateral and to execute any and all documents and instruments which may be necessary or desirable to carry out the terms of this Copyright Security Agreement and to accomplish the purposes hereof.

Except to the extent expressly permitted in the Security Agreement or the Credit Agreement, the Lien Grantor agrees not to sell, license, exchange, assign or otherwise transfer or dispose of, or grant any rights with respect to, or mortgage or otherwise encumber, any of the Copyright Collateral.

The foregoing security interest is granted in conjunction with the security interests granted by the Lien Grantor to the Grantee pursuant to the Security Agreement. The Lien Grantor acknowledges and affirms that the rights and remedies of the Grantee with respect to the security interest in the Copyright Collateral granted hereby are more fully set forth in the Security Agreement, the

 

B-2


terms and provisions of which are incorporated by reference herein as if fully set forth herein.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Lien Grantor has caused this Copyright Security Agreement to be duly executed by its officer thereunto duly authorized as of the      day of              ,      .

 

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]
By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  

 

Acknowledged:

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,

as Agent

By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  

 

B-3


STATE OF                         )  
    )ss.:
COUNTY OF                    )  

I,                                          , a Notary Public in and for said County, in the State aforesaid, DO HEREBY CERTIFY, that                                  ,                          of [NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR] (the “ Company ”), personally known to me to be the same person whose name is subscribed to the foregoing instrument as such                              , appeared before me this day in person and acknowledged that (s)he signed, executed and delivered the said instrument as her/his own free and voluntary act and as the free and voluntary act of said Company, for the uses and purposes therein set forth being duly authorized so to do.

GIVEN under my hand and Notarial Seal this      day of              ,      .

[Seal]

 

 

Signature of notary public
My Commission expires                     

 

B-4


Schedule 1

to Copyright

Security Agreement

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]

COPYRIGHT REGISTRATIONS

 

Registration No.

 

Registration Date

 

Title

 

Expiration

Date

     
     
     
     
     

COPYRIGHT APPLICATIONS

 

Case No.

 

Serial No.

 

Country

 

Date

 

Filing Title

       
       
       
       
       

COPYRIGHT LICENSES

 

Name of

Agreement

 

Parties

Licensor/Licensee

 

Date of

Agreement

 

Subject

Matter

     
     
     
     
     

 

B-5


EXHIBIT C

to Security Agreement

PATENT SECURITY AGREEMENT

(Patents, Patent Applications and Patent Licenses)

WHEREAS, [name of Lien Grantor], a                      corporation 1 (herein referred to as the “ Lien Grantor ”) owns, or in the case of licenses is a party to, the Patent Collateral (as defined below);

WHEREAS, Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC (the “ Borrower ”), Tower Automotive, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(a), LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(b), LLC, the other guarantors and lenders party thereto, and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent, are parties to a Revolving Credit and Guaranty Agreement dated as of July 31, 2007 (as amended from time to time, the “ Credit Agreement ”); and

WHEREAS, pursuant to (i) an Amended and Restated ABL Security Agreement dated as of August 24, 2010 (as amended and/or supplemented from time to time, the “ Security Agreement ”) among the Borrower, the guarantors party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent for the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, together with its successors in such capacity, the “ Grantee ”), and (ii) certain other loan documents (including this Copyright Security Agreement), the Lien Grantor has [secured certain of its obligations (the “ Secured Obligations ”)] 2 [guaranteed certain obligations of the Borrower and secured such guarantee (the “ Lien Grantor’s Transaction Guarantee ”)] 3 by granting to the Grantee for the benefit of such Secured Parties a continuing security interest in personal property of the Lien Grantor, including all right, title and interest of the Lien Grantor in, to and under the Patent Collateral (as defined below);

NOW, THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the Lien Grantor grants to the Grantee, to secure the [Secured Obligations] [Lien Grantor’s Transaction

 

1 Modify as needed if the Lien Grantor is not a corporation.
2 Delete these bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is a Guarantor.
3 Delete these bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is the Borrower.

 

C-1


Guarantee], a continuing security interest in all of the Lien Grantor’s right, title and interest in, to and under the following (all of the following items or types of property being herein collectively referred to as the “ Patent Collateral ”), whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising:

(i) each Patent (as defined in the Security Agreement) owned by the Lien Grantor, including, without limitation, each Patent referred to in Schedule 1 hereto;

(ii) each Patent License (as defined in the Security Agreement) to which the Lien Grantor is a party, including, without limitation, each Patent License identified in Schedule 1 hereto; and

(iii) all proceeds of and revenues from the foregoing, including, without limitation, all proceeds of and revenues from any claim by the Lien Grantor against third parties for past, present or future infringement of any Patent owned by the Lien Grantor (including, without limitation, any Patent identified in Schedule 1 hereto) and all rights and benefits of the Lien Grantor under any Patent License (including, without limitation, any Patent License identified in Schedule 1 hereto).

The Lien Grantor irrevocably constitutes and appoints the Grantee and any officer or agent thereof, with full power of substitution, as its true and lawful attorney-in-fact with full power and authority in the name of the Lien Grantor or in the Grantee’s name, from time to time, in the Grantee’s discretion, so long as any Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, to take with respect to the Patent Collateral any and all appropriate action which the Lien Grantor might take with respect to the Patent Collateral and to execute any and all documents and instruments which may be necessary or desirable to carry out the terms of this Patent Security Agreement and to accomplish the purposes hereof.

Except to the extent expressly permitted in the Security Agreement or the Credit Agreement, the Lien Grantor agrees not to sell, license, exchange, assign or otherwise transfer or dispose of, or grant any rights with respect to, or mortgage or otherwise encumber, any of the Patent Collateral.

The foregoing security interest is granted in conjunction with the security interests granted by the Lien Grantor to the Grantee pursuant to the Security Agreement. The Lien Grantor acknowledges and affirms that the rights and remedies of the Grantee with respect to the security interest in the Patent Collateral granted hereby are more fully set forth in the Security Agreement, the terms and provisions of which are incorporated by reference herein as if fully set forth herein.

 

C-2


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Lien Grantor has caused this Patent Security Agreement to be duly executed by its officer thereunto duly authorized as of the      day of              ,      .

 

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]
By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  

 

Acknowledged:

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,

as Agent

By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  

 

C-3


STATE OF                         )  
    )ss.:
COUNTY OF                    )  

I,                                          , a Notary Public in and for said County, in the State aforesaid, DO HEREBY CERTIFY, that                                  ,                          of [NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR] (the “ Company ”), personally known to me to be the same person whose name is subscribed to the foregoing instrument as such                              , appeared before me this day in person and acknowledged that (s)he signed, executed and delivered the said instrument as her/his own free and voluntary act and as the free and voluntary act of said Company, for the uses and purposes therein set forth being duly authorized so to do.

GIVEN under my hand and Notarial Seal this      day of              ,      .

[Seal]

 

 

Signature of notary public
My Commission expires                     

 

C-4


Schedule 1

to Patent

Security Agreement

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]

PATENTS AND DESIGN PATENTS

 

Patent No.

 

Issued

 

Expiration

 

Country

 

Title

       
       
       
       
       

PATENT APPLICATIONS

 

Case No.

 

Serial No.

 

Country

 

Date

 

Filing Title

       
       
       
       
       

PATENT LICENSES

 

Name of

Agreement

 

Parties

Licensor/Licensee

 

Date of

Agreement

 

Subject

Matter

     
     
     
     
     

 

C-5


EXHIBIT D

to Security Agreement

TRADEMARK SECURITY AGREEMENT

(Trademarks, Trademark Registrations, Trademark

Applications and Trademark Licenses)

WHEREAS, [name of Lien Grantor], a                      corporation 1 (herein referred to as the “ Lien Grantor ”) owns, or in the case of licenses is a party to, the Trademark Collateral (as defined below);

WHEREAS, Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC (the “ Borrower ”), Tower Automotive, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(a), LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(b), LLC, the other guarantors and lenders party thereto, and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent, are parties to a Revolving Credit and Guaranty Agreement dated as of July 31, 2007 (as amended from time to time, the “ Credit Agreement ”); and

WHEREAS, pursuant to (i) an Amended and Restated ABL Security Agreement dated as of August 24, 2010 (as amended and/or supplemented from time to time, the “ Security Agreement ”) among the Borrower, the guarantors party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent for the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, together with its successors in such capacity, the “ Grantee ”), and (ii) certain other loan documents (including this Trademark Security Agreement), the Lien Grantor has [secured certain of its obligations (the “ Secured Obligations ”)] 2 [guaranteed certain obligations of the Borrower and secured such guarantee (the “ Lien Grantor’s Transaction Guarantee ”)] 3 by granting to the Grantee for the benefit of such Secured Parties a continuing security interest in personal property of the Lien Grantor, including all right, title and interest of the Lien Grantor in, to and under the Trademark Collateral (as defined below);

NOW, THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the Lien Grantor grants to the

 

1 Modify as needed if the Lien Grantor is not a corporation.
2 Delete these bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is a Guarantor.
3 Delete these bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is the Borrower.

 

D-1


Grantee, to secure the [Secured Obligations] [Lien Grantor’s Transaction Guarantee], a continuing security interest in all of the Lien Grantor’s right, title and interest in, to and under the following (all of the following items or types of property being herein collectively referred to as the “ Trademark Collateral ”), whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising:

(i) each Trademark (as defined in the Security Agreement) owned by the Lien Grantor, including, without limitation, each Trademark registration and application referred to in Schedule 1 hereto, and all of the goodwill of the business connected with the use of, or symbolized by, each Trademark (provided that no security interest shall be granted in the United States intent-to-use trademark applications to the extent that, and solely during the period in which, the grant of a security interest therein would impair the validity or enforceability of such intent-to-use trademark applications under applicable federal law);

(ii) each Trademark License (as defined in the Security Agreement) to which the Lien Grantor is a party, including, without limitation, each Trademark License identified in Schedule 1 hereto, and all of the goodwill of the business connected with the use of, or symbolized by, each Trademark licensed pursuant thereto; and

(iii) all proceeds of and revenues from the foregoing, including, without limitation, all proceeds of and revenues from any claim by the Lien Grantor against third parties for past, present or future unfair competition with, or violation of intellectual property rights in connection with or injury to, or infringement or dilution of, any Trademark owned by the Lien Grantor (including, without limitation, any Trademark identified in Schedule 1 hereto), and all rights and benefits of the Lien Grantor under any Trademark License (including, without limitation, any Trademark License identified in Schedule 1 hereto), or for injury to the goodwill associated with any of the foregoing.

The Lien Grantor irrevocably constitutes and appoints the Grantee and any officer or agent thereof, with full power of substitution, as its true and lawful attorney-in-fact with full power and authority in the name of the Lien Grantor or in the Grantee’s name, from time to time, in the Grantee’s discretion, so long as any Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, to take with respect to the Trademark Collateral any and all appropriate action which the Lien Grantor might take with respect to the Trademark Collateral and to execute any and all documents and instruments which may be necessary or desirable to carry out the terms of this Trademark Security Agreement and to accomplish the purposes hereof.

 

D-2


Except to the extent expressly permitted in the Security Agreement or the Credit Agreement, the Lien Grantor agrees not to sell, license, exchange, assign or otherwise transfer or dispose of, or grant any rights with respect to, or mortgage or otherwise encumber, any of the Trademark Collateral.

The foregoing security interest is granted in conjunction with the security interests granted by the Lien Grantor to the Grantee pursuant to the Security Agreement. The Lien Grantor acknowledges and affirms that the rights and remedies of the Grantee with respect to the security interest in the Trademark Collateral granted hereby are more fully set forth in the Security Agreement, the terms and provisions of which are incorporated by reference herein as if fully set forth herein.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Lien Grantor has caused this Trademark Security Agreement to be duly executed by its officer thereunto duly authorized as of the      day of              ,      .

 

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]
By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  

 

Acknowledged:
JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Agent
By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  

 

D-3


STATE OF                         )
  ) ss.:
COUNTY OF                    )

I,                                          , a Notary Public in and for said County, in the State aforesaid, DO HEREBY CERTIFY, that                                  ,                          of [NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR] (the “ Company ”), personally known to me to be the same person whose name is subscribed to the foregoing instrument as such                              , appeared before me this day in person and acknowledged that (s)he signed, executed and delivered the said instrument as her/his own free and voluntary act and as the free and voluntary act of said Company, for the uses and purposes therein set forth being duly authorized so to do.

GIVEN under my hand and Notarial Seal this      day of              ,      .

[Seal]

 

 

Signature of notary public
My Commission expires                     

 

D-4


Schedule 1

to Trademark

Security Agreement

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]

U.S. TRADEMARK REGISTRATIONS

 

TRADEMARK

   REG. NO.    REG. DATE
     
     
     
     
     

U.S. TRADEMARK APPLICATIONS

 

TRADEMARK

   REG. NO.    REG. DATE
     
     
     
     
     

 

D-5


TRADEMARK LICENSES

 

Name of

Agreement

 

Parties

Licensor/Licensee

 

Date of

Agreement

 

Subject

Matter

     
     
     
     
     

 

D-6


EXHIBIT E

to Security Agreement

PERFECTION CERTIFICATE

The undersigned is a duly authorized officer of [NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR] (the “ Lien Grantor ”). With reference to the Amended and Restated ABL Security Agreement dated as of August 24, 2010 among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the other Lien Grantors party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Agent (terms defined therein being used herein as therein defined), the undersigned certifies to the Agent and each other Secured Party as follows:

A. Information Required for Filings and Searches for Prior Filings. 2

1. Jurisdiction of Organization . The Lien Grantor is a [corporation] 3 organized under the laws of                      .

2. Name . The exact [corporate] name of the Lien Grantor as it appears in its [certificate of incorporation] is as follows:

3. Prior Names; Predecessors . (a) Set forth below is each other [corporate] name that the Lien Grantor has had since its organization, together with the date of the relevant change:

(b) Except as set forth in Schedule      hereto, the Lien Grantor has not changed its corporate structure 4 in any way within the past five years.

(c) None of the Lien Grantor’s Collateral was acquired from another Person within the past five years, except

(i) property sold to the Lien Grantor by another Person in the ordinary course of such other Person’s business;

(ii) property with respect to which the Transaction Liens are to be perfected by taking possession or control thereof;

(iii) property acquired in transactions described in Schedule      hereto; and

 

E-1


(iv) other property having an aggregate fair market value not exceeding $              .

4. Organizational ID Number . Set forth below is the Organizational Identification Number, if any, issued by the jurisdiction of organization of the Lien Grantor.

5. Taxpayer ID Number . Set forth below is the Federal Taxpayer Identification Number of the Lien Grantor: [only necessary for filing in North Dakota and South Dakota.]

6. Chief Executive Office . The chief executive office of the Lien Grantor (or its place of business if there is only one) is located at the address set forth below:

 

Mailing Address

  

County

  

State

     
     
     
     
     

B. Search Reports.

Attached hereto as Schedule      is a true copy of a file search report from the central UCC filing office in each jurisdiction identified in Part A–4 above with respect to each name set forth in Part A–2 and Part A–3 above (searches in local filing offices, if any, are not required). Attached hereto as Schedule      is a true copy of each financing statement or other filing identified in such file search reports.

C. Absence of Certain Property.

The Lien Grantor does not own any assets of material value which constitute commercial tort claims, farm products, electronic chattel paper, letter-of-credit rights which are not supporting obligations or as-extracted collateral, as each of the foregoing terms is defined in the UCC.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, I have hereunto set my hand this      day of              ,      .

 

 

Name:  
Title:  

 

E-2


EXHIBIT F

to Security Agreement

ISSUER CONTROL AGREEMENT

ISSUER CONTROL AGREEMENT dated as of              ,          among                          (the “ Lien Grantor ”), JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Agent (the “ Secured Party ”), and                  (the “ Issuer ”). All references herein to the “ UCC ” refer to the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in [Issuer’s jurisdiction of incorporation].

W I T N E S S E T H :

WHEREAS, the Lien Grantor is the registered holder of [specify Pledged Uncertificated Securities issued by the Issuer] issued by the Issuer (the “ Securities ”);

WHEREAS, pursuant to (i) an Amended and Restated ABL Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ ABL Security Agreement ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, as borrower (the “ Borrower ”), the guarantors party thereto including the Lien Grantor (the “ Subsidiary Guarantors ”) and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., acting as agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ Agent ”), (ii) an Amended and Restated First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Borrower, the Subsidiary Guarantors and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., acting as agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ First Lien Term Loan Agent ” and (iii) and a Notes Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ Notes Security Agreement ” and, together with the ABL Security Agreement and the First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement, the “ Security Agreements ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc. (collectively, the “ Issuers ”), the Subsidiary Guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, acting as collateral agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ Notes Agent ”, together with the Agent and the First Lien Term Loan Agent, the “ Agents ”), the Lien Grantor has granted to the Agents, for the benefit of the Secured Parties (as defined in each of the Security Agreements), a continuing security interest (the “ Transaction Lien ”) in all right, title and interest of the Lien

 

F-1


Grantor in, to and under the Securities, whether now existing or hereafter arising; and

WHEREAS, the Agents, the Borrower and certain other parties are parties to an Amended and Restated Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010 and a Term Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, pursuant to which the Notes Agent, in its capacity as Authorized Term Collateral Agent (as defined in the Term Intercreditor Agreement) is to enter into this Agreement for the benefit of the Secured Parties (as defined in each of the Security Agreements) in order to perfect the Transaction Lien on the Securities;

NOW, THEREFORE, the parties hereto agree as follows:

Section 1. Nature of Securities. The Issuer confirms that (i) the Securities are “uncertificated securities” (as defined in Section 8-102 of the UCC) and (ii) the Lien Grantor is registered on the books of the Issuer as the registered holder of the Securities.

Section 2. Instructions. The Issuer agrees to comply with any “instruction” (as defined in Section 8-102 of the UCC) originated by the Secured Party and relating to the Securities without further consent by the Lien Grantor or any other person. The Lien Grantor consents to the foregoing agreement by the Issuer.

Section 3. Waiver of Lien; Waiver of Set-off. The Issuer waives any security interest, lien or right of set-off that it may now have or hereafter acquire in or with respect to the Securities. The Issuer’s obligations in respect of the Securities will not be subject to deduction, set-off or any other right in favor of any person other than the Secured Party.

Section 4. Choice of Law. This Agreement shall be governed by the laws of [Issuer’s jurisdiction of incorporation].

Section 5. Conflict with Other Agreements. There is no agreement (except this Agreement) between the Issuer and the Lien Grantor with respect to the Securities [except for [identify any existing other agreements] (the “ Existing Other Agreements ”)]. In the event of any conflict between this Agreement (or any portion hereof) and any other agreement [(including any Existing Other Agreement)] between the Issuer and the Lien Grantor with respect to the Securities, whether now existing or hereafter entered into, the terms of this Agreement shall prevail.

 

F-2


Section 6. Amendments. No amendment or modification of this Agreement or waiver of any right hereunder shall be binding on any party hereto unless it is in writing and is signed by all the parties hereto.

Section 7. Notice of Adverse Claims. Except for the claims and interests of the Secured Party and the Lien Grantor in the Securities, the Issuer does not know of any claim to, or interest in, the Securities. If any person asserts any lien, encumbrance or adverse claim (including any writ, garnishment, judgment, attachment, execution or similar process) against the Securities, the Issuer will promptly notify the Secured Party and the Lien Grantor thereof.

Section 8. Maintenance of Securities. In addition to, and not in lieu of, the obligation of the Issuer to honor instructions as agreed in Section 2 hereof, the Issuer agrees as follows:

(i) Lien Grantor Instructions; Notice of Exclusive Control. So long as the Issuer has not received a Notice of Exclusive Control (as defined below), the Issuer may comply with instructions of the Lien Grantor or any duly authorized agent of the Lien Grantor in respect of the Securities. After the Issuer receives a written notice from the Secured Party that it is exercising exclusive control over the Securities (a “ Notice of Exclusive Control ”), the Issuer will cease complying with instructions of the Lien Grantor or any of its agents.

(ii) Non-Cash Dividends and Distributions. The Issuer shall deliver to the Secured Party all dividends, interest and other distributions paid or made upon or with respect to the Securities.

(iii) Voting Rights. Until the Issuer receives a Notice of Exclusive Control, the Lien Grantor shall be entitled to direct the Issuer with respect to voting the Securities.

(iv) Statements and Confirmations. The Issuer will promptly send copies of all statements and other correspondence concerning the Securities simultaneously to each of the Lien Grantor and the Secured Party at their respective addresses specified in Section 11 hereof.

(v) Tax Reporting. All items of income, gain, expense and loss recognized in respect of the Securities shall be reported to the Internal Revenue Service and all state and local taxing authorities under the name and taxpayer identification number of the Lien Grantor.

Section 9. Representations, Warranties and Covenants of the Issuer. The Issuer makes the following representations, warranties and covenants:

 

F-3


(i) This Agreement is a valid and binding agreement of the Issuer enforceable in accordance with its terms.

(ii) The Issuer has not entered into, and until the termination of this Agreement will not enter into, any agreement with any other person relating to the Securities pursuant to which it has agreed, or will agree, to comply with instructions (as defined in Section 8-102 of the UCC) of such person. The Issuer has not entered into any other agreement with the Lien Grantor or the Secured Party purporting to limit or condition the obligation of the Issuer to comply with instructions as agreed in Section 2 hereof.

Section 10. Successors. This Agreement shall be binding upon, and shall inure to the benefit of, the parties hereto and their respective successors and assigns.

Section 11. Notices. Each notice, request or other communication given to any party hereunder shall be in writing (which term includes facsimile or other electronic transmission) and shall be effective (i) when delivered to such party at its address specified below, (ii) when sent to such party by facsimile or other electronic transmission, addressed to it at its facsimile number or electronic address specified below, and such party sends back an electronic confirmation of receipt or (iii) ten days after being sent to such party by certified or registered United States mail, addressed to it at its address specified below, with first class or airmail postage prepaid:

Lien Grantor:

Secured Party:

Issuer:

Any party may change its address, facsimile number and/or e-mail address for purposes of this Section by giving notice of such change to the other parties in the manner specified above.

Section 12. Termination. The rights and powers granted herein to the Secured Party (i) have been granted in order to perfect the Transaction Lien, (ii) are powers coupled with an interest and (iii) will not be affected by any bankruptcy of the Lien Grantor or any lapse of time. The obligations of the Issuer hereunder shall continue in effect until the Secured Party has notified the Issuer in writing that the Transaction Lien has been terminated pursuant to the Security Agreement.

 

F-4


Section 13. Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts, all of which shall constitute one and the same instrument, and any party hereto may execute this Agreement by signing and delivering one or more counterparts.

 

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB

as Authorized Term Collateral Agent

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
[NAME OF ISSUER]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

F-5


Exhibit A

[Letterhead of Secured Party]

[Date]

[Name and Address of Issuer]

Attention:                                                              

 

  Re: Notice of Exclusive Control

Ladies and Gentlemen:

As referenced in the Issuer Control Agreement dated as of              ,              among [name of Lien Grantor], us and you (a copy of which is attached), we notify you that we will hereafter exercise exclusive control over [specify Pledged Uncertificated Securities] registered in the name of [name of Lien Grantor] (the “ Securities ”). You are instructed not to accept any directions or instructions with respect to the Securities from any person other than the undersigned unless otherwise ordered by a court of competent jurisdiction.

You are instructed to deliver a copy of this notice by facsimile transmission to [name of Lien Grantor].

Very truly yours,

 

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB

as Authorized Term Collateral Agent

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

cc: [name of Lien Grantor]

 

F-6


EXHIBIT G

to Security Agreement

SECURITIES ACCOUNT CONTROL AGREEMENT

SECURITIES ACCOUNT CONTROL AGREEMENT dated as of              ,              among                      (the “ Lien Grantor ”), JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Agent (the “ Secured Party ”), and                      (the “ Securities Intermediary ”). All references herein to the “ UCC ” refer to the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in the State of New York. Terms defined in the UCC have the same meanings when used herein.

W I T N E S S E T H :

WHEREAS, the Lien Grantor is the entitlement holder with respect to the Account (as defined below);

WHEREAS, pursuant to (i) an Amended and Restated ABL Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ ABL Security Agreement ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, as borrower (the “ Borrower ”), the guarantors party thereto including the Lien Grantor (the “ Subsidiary Guarantors ”) and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., acting as agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ Agent ”), (ii) an Amended and Restated First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Borrower, the Subsidiary Guarantors and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., acting as agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ First Lien Term Loan Agent ” and (iii) and a Notes Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ Notes Security Agreement ” and, together with the ABL Security Agreement and the First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement, the “ Security Agreements ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc. (collectively, the “ Issuers ”), the Subsidiary Guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, acting as collateral agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ Notes Agent ”, together with the Agent and the First Lien Term Loan Agent, the “ Agents ”), the Lien Grantor has granted to the Agents, for the benefit of the Secured Parties (as defined in each of the Security Agreements), a continuing security interest (the “ Transaction Lien ”) in all right, title and interest of the Lien Grantor in, to and under the Account, all financial assets credited thereto and all

 

G-1


security entitlements in respect thereof, whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising; and

WHEREAS, the Agents, the Borrower and certain other parties are parties to an Amended and Restated Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010 and a Term Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, pursuant to which the Notes Agent, in its capacity as Authorized Term Collateral Agent (as defined in the Term Intercreditor Agreement) is to enter into this Agreement for the benefit of the Secured Parties (as defined in each of the Security Agreements) in order to perfect the Transaction Lien on the Account, all financial assets from time to time credited thereto and all security entitlements in respect thereof;

NOW, THEREFORE, the parties hereto agree as follows:

Section 1. Establishment of Account. The Securities Intermediary confirms that:

(i) the Securities Intermediary has established account number [identify account number] in the name of “[name of Lien Grantor]” (such account and any successor account, the “ Account ”),

(ii) the Account is a “securities account” as defined in Section 8-501 of the UCC,

(iii) the Securities Intermediary is acting as a “securities intermediary” (as defined in Section 8-102 of the UCC) in respect of the Account,

(iv) the Securities Intermediary shall, subject to the terms of this Agreement, treat the Lien Grantor as entitled to exercise the rights that comprise all financial assets from time to time credited to the Account,

(v) all property delivered to the Securities Intermediary by or on behalf of the Lien Grantor will be promptly credited to the Account, and

(vi) all financial assets (except cash) credited to the Account will be registered in the name of the Securities Intermediary, indorsed to the Securities Intermediary or in blank or credited to another securities account maintained in the name of the Securities Intermediary and in no case will any financial asset credited to the Account be registered in the name of the Lien Grantor, payable to the order of the Lien Grantor or specially indorsed to the Lien Grantor unless such financial asset has been further indorsed to the Securities Intermediary or in blank.

 

G-2


Section 2. “Financial Assets” Election. The parties hereto agree that each item of property (whether investment property, financial asset, security, instrument, cash or other property) credited to the Account shall be treated as a “financial asset” within the meaning of Sections 8-102(a)(9) and 8-103 of the UCC.

Section 3. Entitlement Orders. The Securities Intermediary agrees to comply with any “entitlement order” (as defined in Section 8-102 of the UCC) originated by the Secured Party and relating to the Account or any financial asset credited thereto without further consent by the Lien Grantor or any other person. The Lien Grantor consents to the foregoing agreement by the Securities Intermediary.

Section 4. Waiver of Lien; Waiver of Set-off. The Securities Intermediary waives any security interest, lien or right to make deductions or setoffs that it may now have or hereafter acquire in or with respect to the Account, any financial asset credited thereto or any security entitlement in respect thereof. Neither the financial assets credited to the Account nor the security entitlements in respect thereof will be subject to deduction, set-off, banker’s lien, or any other right in favor of any person other than the Secured Party [(except that the Securities Intermediary may set off (i) all amounts due to it in respect of its customary fees and expenses for the routine maintenance and operation of the Account and (ii) the face amount of any checks that have been credited to the Account but are subsequently returned unpaid because of uncollected or insufficient funds)].

Section 5. Choice of Law. This Agreement shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of New York]. The State of New York shall be deemed to be the Securities Intermediary’s jurisdiction for purposes of the UCC (including, without limitation, Section 8-110 thereof).

Section 6. Conflict with Other Agreements. There is no agreement (except this Agreement) between the Securities Intermediary and the Lien Grantor with respect to the Account [except for [identify any existing other agreements] (the “ Existing Other Agreements ”)]. In the event of any conflict between this Agreement (or any portion hereof) and any other agreement [(including any Existing Other Agreement)] between the Securities Intermediary and the Lien Grantor with respect to the Account, whether now existing or hereafter entered into, the terms of this Agreement shall prevail. [If any Existing Other Agreement does not specify that it is governed by the laws of [the jurisdiction specified in Section 5], such Existing Other Agreement is hereby amended to specify that it is governed by the laws of [the jurisdiction specified in Section 5].

 

G-3


Section 7. Amendments. No amendment or modification of this Agreement or waiver of any right hereunder shall be binding on any party hereto unless it is in writing and is signed by all the parties hereto.

Section 8. Notice of Adverse Claims. Except for the claims and interests of the Secured Party and the Lien Grantor, the Securities Intermediary does not know of any claim to, or interest in, the Account, any financial asset credited thereto or any security entitlement in respect thereof. If any person asserts any lien, encumbrance or adverse claim (including any writ, garnishment, judgment, attachment, execution or similar process) against the Account, any financial asset credited thereto or any security entitlement in respect thereof, the Securities Intermediary will promptly notify the Secured Party and the Lien Grantor thereof.

Section 9. Maintenance of Account. In addition to, and not in lieu of, the obligation of the Securities Intermediary to honor entitlement orders as agreed in Section 3 hereof, the Securities Intermediary agrees to maintain the Account as follows:

(i) Lien Grantor Entitlement Orders; Notice of Exclusive Control. So long as the Securities Intermediary has not received a Notice of Exclusive Control (as defined below), the Securities Intermediary may, subject to paragraph (iii) below, comply with entitlement orders of the Lien Grantor or any duly authorized agent of the Lien Grantor in respect of the Account and any or all financial assets credited thereto. After the Securities Intermediary receives a written notice from the Secured Party that is exercising exclusive control over the Account (a “ Notice of Exclusive Control ”), the Securities Intermediary will cease complying with entitlement orders of the Lien Grantor or any of its agents.

(ii) Voting Rights. Until the Securities Intermediary receives a Notice of Exclusive Control, the Lien Grantor shall be entitled to direct the Securities Intermediary with respect to the voting of any financial assets credited to the Account.

(iii) Permitted Investments. Until the Securities Intermediary receives a Notice of Exclusive Control, the Lien Grantor shall be entitled to direct the Securities Intermediary with respect to the selection of investments to be made and credited to the Account.

(iv) Statements and Confirmations. The Securities Intermediary will promptly send copies of all statements, confirmations and other correspondence concerning the Account and/or any financial assets credited thereto simultaneously to each of the Lien Grantor and the Secured Party at their respective addresses specified in Section 12 hereof.

 

G-4


(v) Tax Reporting. All items of income, gain, expense and loss recognized in the Account or in respect of any financial assets credited thereto shall be reported to the Internal Revenue Service and all state and local taxing authorities under the name and taxpayer identification number of the Lien Grantor.

Section 10. Representations, Warranties and Covenants of the Securities Intermediary. The Securities Intermediary makes the following representations, warranties and covenants:

(i) The Account has been established as set forth in Section 1 above and will be maintained in the manner set forth herein until this Agreement is terminated. The Securities Intermediary will not change the name or account number of the Account without the prior written consent of the Secured Party.

(ii) No financial asset credited to the Account is or will be registered in the name of the Lien Grantor, payable to the order of the Lien Grantor, or specially indorsed to the Lien Grantor, unless such financial asset has been further indorsed by the Lien Grantor to the Securities Intermediary or in blank.

(iii) This Agreement is a valid and binding agreement of the Securities Intermediary enforceable in accordance with its terms.

(iv) The Securities Intermediary has not entered into, and until the termination of this Agreement will not enter into, any agreement with any person (other than the Secured Party) relating to the Account and/or any financial asset credited thereto pursuant to which it has agreed, or will agree, to comply with entitlement orders of such person. The Securities Intermediary has not entered into any other agreement with the Lien Grantor or the Secured Party purporting to limit or condition the obligation of the Securities Intermediary to comply with entitlement orders as agreed in Section 3 hereof.

Section 11. Successors. This Agreement shall be binding upon, and shall inure to the benefit of, the parties hereto and their respective successors and assigns.

Section 12. Notices. Each notice, request or other communication given to any party hereunder shall be in writing (which term includes facsimile or other electronic transmission) and shall be effective (i) when delivered to such party at its address specified below, (ii) when sent to such party by facsimile or other electronic transmission, addressed to it at its facsimile number or electronic

 

G-5


address specified below, and such party sends back an electronic confirmation of receipt or (iii) ten days after being sent to such party by certified or registered United States mail, addressed to it at its address specified below, with first class or airmail postage prepaid:

Lien Grantor:

Secured Party:

Securities Intermediary:

Any party may change its address, facsimile number and/or e-mail address for purposes of this Section by giving notice of such change to the other parties in the manner specified above.

Section 13. Termination. The rights and powers granted herein to the Secured Party (i) have been granted in order to perfect the Transaction Lien, (ii) are powers coupled with an interest and (iii) will not be affected by any bankruptcy of the Lien Grantor or any lapse of time. The obligations of the Securities Intermediary hereunder shall continue in effect until the Secured Party has notified the Securities Intermediary in writing that the Transaction Lien has been terminated pursuant to the terms of the Security Agreement.

 

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]

By:

 

 

  Name:
  Title:

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB
as Authorized Term Collateral Agent

By:

 

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

G-6


[NAME OF SECURITIES INTERMEDIARY]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

G-7


Exhibit A

[Letterhead of Secured Party]

[Date]

[Name and Address of Securities Intermediary]

Attention:                                                              

 

  Re: Notice of Exclusive Control

Ladies and Gentlemen:

As referenced in the Securities Account Control Agreement dated as of              ,              among [name of Lien Grantor], us and you (a copy of which is attached), we notify you that we will hereafter exercise exclusive control over securities account number              (the “ Account ”), all financial assets from time to time credited thereto and all security entitlements in respect thereof. You are instructed not to accept any directions, instructions or entitlement orders with respect to the Account or the financial assets credited thereto from any person other than the undersigned unless otherwise ordered by a court of competent jurisdiction.

You are instructed to deliver a copy of this notice by facsimile transmission to [name of Lien Grantor].

Very truly yours,

 

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB

as Authorized Term Collateral Agent

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

cc: [name of Lien Grantor]

 

G-8


EXHIBIT H

to Security Agreement

DEPOSIT ACCOUNT CONTROL AGREEMENT

DEPOSIT ACCOUNT CONTROL AGREEMENT dated as of              ,              among                      (the “ Lien Grantor ”), JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Agent (the “ Secured Party ”), and                      (the “ Bank ”). All references herein to the “ UCC ” refer to the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in the State of New York. Terms defined in the UCC have the same meanings when used herein.

W I T N E S S E T H :

WHEREAS, the Lien Grantor is the Bank’s customer (as defined in Section 4-104(1)(e) of the UCC) with respect to the Account (as defined below);

WHEREAS, pursuant to (i) an Amended and Restated ABL Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ ABL Security Agreement ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, as borrower (the “ Borrower ”), the guarantors party thereto including the Lien Grantor (the “ Subsidiary Guarantors ”) and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., acting as agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ Agent ”), (ii) an Amended and Restated First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Borrower, the Subsidiary Guarantors and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., acting as agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ First Lien Term Loan Agent ” and (iii) and a Notes Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ Notes Security Agreement ” and, together with the ABL Security Agreement and the First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement, the “ Security Agreements ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc. (collectively, the “ Issuers ”), the Subsidiary Guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, acting as collateral agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ Notes Agent ”, together with the Agent and the First Lien Term Loan Agent, the “ Agents ”), the Lien Grantor has granted to the Agents, for the benefit of the

 

H-1


Secured Parties (as defined in each of the Security Agreements), a continuing security interest (the “ Transaction Lien ”) in all right, title and interest of the Lien Grantor in, to and under the Account; and

WHEREAS, the Agents, the Borrower and certain other parties are parties to an Amended and Restated Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010 and a Term Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, pursuant to which the Agent is to enter into this Agreement for the benefit of the Secured Parties (as defined in each of the Security Agreements) in order to perfect the Transaction Lien on the Account and any and all funds or deposits from time to time held therein or credited thereto, whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising;

NOW, THEREFORE, the parties hereto agree as follows:

Section 1. Establishment of Account. The Bank confirms that:

(i) the Bank has established account number [identify account number] in the name of “[name of Lien Grantor]” (such account and any successor account, the “ Account ”);

(ii) the Account is a “deposit account” as defined in Section 9-102(a)(29) of the UCC; and

(iii) the Bank is a “bank” (as defined in section 9-102 of the UCC) and is acting in such capacity in respect of the Account.

Section 2. Instructions. The Lien Grantor, the Secured Party and the Bank agree that the Bank will comply with (i) any instruction originated by the Secured Party directing disposition of funds in the Account and (ii) any other instruction from the Secured Party in respect of the Account, in each case without further consent by the Lien Grantor or any other person.

Section 3. Waiver of Lien; Waiver of Set-off. The Bank waives any security interest, lien or right to make deductions or setoffs that it may now have or hereafter acquire in or with respect to the Account or any or all funds or deposits from time to time held therein or credited thereto. No amounts credited to the Account will be subject to deduction, set-off, banker’s lien, or any other right in favor of any person other than the Secured Party [(except that the Bank may set off (i) all amounts due to it in respect of its customary fees and expenses for the routine maintenance and operation of the Account and (ii) the face amount of any checks that have been credited to the Account but are subsequently returned unpaid because of uncollected or insufficient funds)].

 

H-2


Section 4. Choice of Law. This Agreement shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of New York. [The State of New York] shall be deemed to be the bank’s jurisdiction (as defined in Section 9-304 of the UCC) with respect to the Account.

Section 5. Conflict with Other Agreements. There is no agreement (except this Agreement) between the Bank and the Lien Grantor with respect to the Account [except for [identify any existing other agreements] (the “ Existing Other Agreements ”)]. In the event of any conflict between this Agreement (or any portion hereof) and any other agreement [(including any Existing Other Agreement)] between the Bank and the Lien Grantor with respect to the Account or any or all funds or deposits from time to time held therein or credited thereto, whether now existing or hereafter entered into, the terms of this Agreement shall prevail. If any Existing Other Agreement does not specify that it is governed by the laws of the jurisdiction specified in Section 5, such Existing Other Agreement is hereby amended to specify that it is governed by the laws of the jurisdiction specified in Section 5.

Section 6. Amendments. No amendment or modification of this Agreement or waiver of any right hereunder shall be binding on any party hereto unless it is in writing and is signed by all the parties hereto.

Section 7. Notice of Adverse Claims. Except for the claims and interests of the Secured Party and the Lien Grantor, the Bank does not know of any claim to, or interest in, the Account or any or all funds or deposits held therein or credited thereto. If any person asserts any lien, encumbrance or adverse claim (including any writ, garnishment, judgment, attachment, execution or similar process) against the Account or any or all funds or deposits held therein or credited thereto, the Bank will promptly notify the Secured Party and the Lien Grantor thereof.

Section 8. Maintenance of Account. In addition to, and not in lieu of, the obligation of the Bank to honor instructions originated by the Secured Party as agreed in Section 3 hereof, the Bank agrees to maintain the Account as follows:

(i) Lien Grantor Entitlement Orders; Notice of Exclusive Control. So long as the Bank has not received a Notice of Exclusive Control (as defined below), the Bank may comply with instructions originated by the Lien Grantor or any duly authorized agent of the Lien Grantor in respect of the Account and any or all funds or deposits held therein or credited thereto. After the Bank receives a written notice from the Secured Party that it is exercising exclusive control over the Account (a “ Notice of Exclusive Control ”), the Bank will cease complying with instructions originated by the Lien Grantor or any of its agents.

 

H-3


(ii) Statements. The Bank will promptly send copies of all statements and other correspondence concerning the Account simultaneously to each of the Lien Grantor and the Secured Party at their respective addresses specified in Section 12 hereof.

(iii) Tax Reporting. All items of income, gain, expense and loss recognized in the Account or in respect of any funds or deposits held therein or credited thereto shall be reported to the Internal Revenue Service and all state and local taxing authorities under the name and taxpayer identification number of the Lien Grantor.

Section 9. Representations, Warranties and Covenants of the Bank. The Bank makes the following representations, warranties and covenants:

(i) The Account has been established as set forth in Section 1 above and will be maintained in the manner set forth herein until this Agreement is terminated. The Bank will not change the name or account number of the Account without the prior written consent of the Secured Party.

(ii) Neither the Account nor any funds or deposits at any time held therein or credited thereto is or will be evidenced by any instrument (as defined in Section 9-102 of the UCC) or constitutes or will constitute investment property (as defined in Section 9-102 of the UCC)

(iii) This Agreement is a valid and binding agreement of the Bank enforceable in accordance with its terms.

(iv) The Bank has not entered into, and until the termination of this Agreement will not enter into, any agreement with any person (other than the Secured Party) relating to the Account and/or any funds or deposits held therein or credited thereto pursuant to which it has agreed, or will agree, to comply with instructions of such person. The Bank has not entered into any other agreement with the Lien Grantor or the Secured Party purporting to limit or condition the obligation of the Bank to comply with instructions originated by the Secured Party as agreed in Section 3 hereof.

Section 10. Successors. This Agreement shall be binding upon, and shall inure to the benefit of, the parties hereto and their respective successors and assigns.

Section 11. Notices. Each notice, request or other communication given to any party hereunder shall be in writing (which term includes facsimile or other

 

H-4


electronic transmission) and shall be effective (i) when delivered to such party at its address specified below, (ii) when sent to such party by facsimile or other electronic transmission, addressed to it at its facsimile number or electronic address specified below, and such party sends back an electronic confirmation of receipt or (iii) ten days after being sent to such party by certified or registered United States mail, addressed to it at its address specified below, with first class or airmail postage prepaid:

Lien Grantor:

Secured Party:

Bank:

Any party may change its address, facsimile number and/or e-mail address for purposes of this Section by giving notice of such change to the other parties in the manner specified above.

Section 12. Termination. The rights and powers granted herein to the Secured Party (i) have been granted in order to perfect the Transaction Lien, (ii) are powers coupled with an interest and (iii) will not be affected by any bankruptcy of the Lien Grantor or any lapse of time. The obligations of the Bank hereunder shall continue in effect until the Secured Party has notified the Bank in writing that the Transaction Lien has been terminated pursuant to the terms of the Security Agreement.

 

H-5


[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.
as Agent

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
[NAME OF BANK]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

H-6


Exhibit A

[Letterhead of Secured Party]

[Date]

[Name and Address of Bank]

Attention:                                                              

 

  Re: Notice of Exclusive Control

Ladies and Gentlemen:

As referenced in the Deposit Account Control Agreement dated as of              ,              among [name of Lien Grantor], us and you (a copy of which is attached), we notify you that we will hereafter exercise exclusive control over deposit account number              (the “ Account ”) and all funds and deposits from time to time held therein or credited thereto. You are instructed not to accept any directions or instructions with respect to the Account or the funds or deposits held therein or credited thereto from any person other than the undersigned unless otherwise ordered by a court of competent jurisdiction.

You are instructed to deliver a copy of this notice by facsimile transmission to [name of Lien Grantor].

Very truly yours,

 

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.

as Agent

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

cc: [name of Lien Grantor]

 

H-7

Exhibit 10.12

Execution Copy

AMENDED AND RESTATED

FIRST LIEN TERM LOAN SECURITY AGREEMENT

Dated as of

August 24, 2010

Among

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC,

THE GUARANTORS PARTY HERETO

and

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,

as Agent

 


TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

 

 

     P AGE

SECTION 1 . Definitions and Other Interpretive Provisions

   2

SECTION 2 . Grant of Transaction Liens

   11

SECTION 3 . General Representations and Warranties

   13

SECTION 4. Further Assurances; General Covenants

   15

SECTION 5 . Equipment

   17

SECTION 6 . Recordable Intellectual Property

   17

SECTION 7 . Investment Property

   18

SECTION 8 . Controlled Deposit Accounts

   20

SECTION 9 . Cash Collateral Accounts

   21

SECTION 10 . Operation of Collateral Accounts

   22

SECTION 11 . Transfer of Record Ownership

   23

SECTION 12 . Right to Vote Securities

   23

SECTION 13 . Remedies upon Event of Default

   24

SECTION 14 . Application of Proceeds

   25

SECTION 15 . Fees and Expenses; Indemnification

   26

SECTION 16 . Authority to Administer Collateral

   27

SECTION 17 . Limitation on Duty in Respect of Collateral

   28

SECTION 18 . General Provisions Concerning the Agent

   28

SECTION 19 . Termination of Transaction Liens; Release of Collateral

   30

SECTION 20 . Additional Lien Grantors

   30

SECTION 21 . Notices

   30

SECTION 22 . No Implied Waivers; Remedies Not Exclusive

   30

SECTION 23 . Successors and Assigns

   31

SECTION 24 . Amendments and Waivers

   31

SECTION 25 . Choice of Law

   31

SECTION 26 . Waiver of Jury Trial

   31

SECTION 27 . Severability

   32

SECTION 28 . Loan Agreement, Security Agreement

   32

SECTION 29 . Counterparts

   32

SECTION 30 Intercreditor Agreements

   32


SCHEDULES:

Schedule 1

   Equity Interests in Subsidiaries and Affiliates Owned by Original Lien Grantors

Schedule 2

   Other Investment Property Owned by Original Lien Grantors
EXHIBITS:

Exhibit A

   Security Agreement Supplement

Exhibit B

   Copyright Security Agreement

Exhibit C

   Patent Security Agreement

Exhibit D

   Trademark Security Agreement

Exhibit E

   Perfection Certificate

Exhibit F

   Issuer Control Agreement

Exhibit G

   Securities Account Control Agreement

Exhibit H

   Deposit Account Control Agreement

 

ii


FIRST LIEN TERM LOAN SECURITY AGREEMENT

AMENDED AND RESTATED FIRST LIEN TERM LOAN SECURITY AGREEMENT, dated as of August 24, 2010 (this “ Agreement ”) among TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC, the GUARANTORS party hereto and JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as agent (in such capacity, the “ Agent ”).

WHEREAS, the US Borrower and the European Borrower, the Guarantors, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent, and certain financial institutions are parties to the Loan Agreement described in Section 1 hereof, pursuant to which such financial institutions agreed to make loans and extend other financial accommodations to the US Borrower and the European Borrower; and;

WHEREAS, the US Borrower had granted liens on certain of its assets to secure to secure its obligations under the Loan Agreement;

WHEREAS, pursuant to the Loan Agreement, Holdings, Holdco and Foreign Holdco had guaranteed the foregoing obligations of the US Borrower, and Holdco and Foreign Holdco had granted liens on certain of their assets to secure their guarantees thereof;

WHEREAS, pursuant to the Loan Agreement, the US Borrower caused each of its domestic subsidiaries to guarantee the foregoing obligations of the US Borrower, and the US Borrower caused each of its domestic subsidiaries to secure its guarantee thereof by granting Liens on its assets to the Agent;

WHEREAS, pursuant to the Loan Agreement, Holdings, Holdco, Foreign Holdco, the US Borrower and the domestic subsidiaries of the US Borrower had guaranteed the obligations of the European Borrower under the Loan Agreement, and Holdco, Foreign Holdco, the US Borrower and the domestic subsidiaries of the US Borrower had granted liens on certain of their assets to secure their guarantees thereof;

WHEREAS, the Lenders and the Issuing Lender are not willing to make loans or issue or participate in letters of credit under the Loan Agreement unless (i) the foregoing obligations of the US Borrower and European Borrower are secured and guaranteed as described above and (ii) each guarantee thereof is secured by Liens on assets of the relevant Guarantor as provided in the Security Documents; and

WHEREAS, upon any foreclosure or other enforcement of the Security Documents, the net proceeds of the relevant Collateral are to be received by or


paid over to the Agent and applied as provided herein and in the Term Intercreditor Agreement and the ABL Intercreditor Agreement;

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing and other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto agree as follows:

SECTION 1 . Definitions and Other Interpretive Provisions.

(a) Terms Defined in Loan Agreement . Terms defined in the Loan Agreement and not otherwise defined in subsection (b) or (c) of this Section have, as used herein, the respective meanings provided for therein.

(b) Terms Defined in UCC . As used herein, each of the following terms has the meaning specified in the UCC:

 

Term

  

UCC

Account

   9-102

Authenticate

   9-102

Certificated Security

   8-102

Chattel Paper

   9-102

Commodity Account

   9-102

Commodity Customer

   9-102

Deposit Account

   9-102

Document

   9-102

Entitlement Holder

   8-102

Entitlement Order

   8-102

Equipment

   9-102

Financial Asset

   8-102 & 103

General Intangibles

   9-102

Instrument

   9-102

Inventory

   9-102

Investment Property

   9-102

Proceeds

   9-102

Record

   9-102

Securities Account

   8-501

Securities Intermediary

   8-102

Security

   8-102 & 103

Security Entitlement

   8-102

Supporting Obligations

   9-102

Uncertificated Security

   8-102

(c) Additional Definitions . The following additional terms, as used herein, have the following meanings:

 

2


ABL Agent ” shall have the meaning given such term in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

ABL Credit Agreement ” shall mean that certain Revolving Credit and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007 and as heretofore amended or modified, by and among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, as borrower, the guarantors party thereto, the lenders parties thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent.

ABL Intercreditor Agreement ” shall mean that certain Amended and Restated Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010 among JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as representative with respect to the ABL Credit Agreement, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as representative with respect to the Term Loan Agreement, Wilmington Trust FSB, as representative with respect to the Indenture, each additional representative from time to time party thereto, Tower Automotive, LLC and the Lien Grantors party thereto.

ABL Termination Date ” shall have the meaning given such term in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

Applicable Agent ” shall mean (i) for purposes of the definitions of Controlled Deposit Account and Controlled Securities Account as such definitions are used in this Agreement, (A) at all times prior to the ABL Termination Date, the ABL Agent and (B) at all times after the ABL Termination Date, the Agent and (ii) for all other purposes, (A) at all times prior to the Term Obligations Termination Date, the Agent and (B) at all times after the Term Obligations Termination Date, the ABL Agent.

Authorized Term Collateral Agent ” shall have the meaning given such term in the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

Borrowers ” shall mean, collectively, the US Borrower and the European Borrower.

Cash Collateral Accounts ” shall have the meaning the meaning given such term in Section 9(a).

Collateral ” shall mean all property, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, on which a Lien is granted or purports to be granted to the Agent pursuant to the Security Documents. When used with respect to a specific Lien Grantor, the term “Collateral” means all its property on which such a Lien is granted or purports to be granted.

Collateral Accounts ” shall mean the Cash Collateral Accounts, the Controlled Deposit Accounts and the Controlled Securities Accounts.

 

3


Collection Account ” shall mean the Deposit Account established pursuant to Section 9(a)(i), into which the proceeds required to be deposit therein pursuant to Section 9(b)(i), shall be deposited.

Common Collateral ” shall have the meaning given such term in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

Contingent Secured Obligation ” shall mean, at any time, any Secured Obligation (or portion thereof) that is contingent in nature at such time, including any Secured Obligation that is:

(i) an obligation to reimburse a bank for drawings not yet made under a letter of credit issued by it;

(ii) an obligation under a Hedging Agreement to make payments that cannot be quantified at such time;

(iii) any other obligation (including any guarantee) that is contingent in nature at such time; or

(iv) an obligation to provide collateral to secure any of the foregoing types of obligations.

Control ” has the following meanings:

(a) when used with respect to any Security or Security Entitlement, the meaning specified in UCC Section 8-106; and

(b) when used with respect to any Deposit Account, the meaning specified in UCC Section 9-104.

Controlled Deposit Account ” shall mean a Deposit Account (i) that is subject to a Deposit Account Control Agreement or (ii) as to which the Applicable Agent is the Depositary Bank’s “customer” (as defined in UCC Section 4-104).

Controlled Securities Account ” shall mean a Securities Account that (i) is maintained in the name of a Lien Grantor at an office of a Securities Intermediary located in the United States and (ii) together with all Financial Assets credited thereto and all related Security Entitlements, is subject to a Securities Account Control Agreement among such Lien Grantor, the Applicable Agent and such Securities Intermediary.

Copyright License ” shall mean any agreement now or hereafter in existence granting to any Lien Grantor, or pursuant to which any Lien Grantor

 

4


grants to any other Person, any right to use, copy, reproduce, distribute, prepare derivative works, display or publish any records or other materials on which a Copyright is in existence or may come into existence, including any agreement identified in Schedule 1 to any Copyright Security Agreement.

Copyrights ” shall mean all the following: (i) all copyrights under the laws of the United States or any other country (whether or not the underlying works of authorship have been published), all registrations and recordings thereof, all copyrightable works of authorship (whether or not published), and all applications for copyrights under the laws of the United States or any other country, including registrations, recordings and applications in the United States Copyright Office or in any similar office or agency of the United States, any State thereof or any other country or any political subdivision thereof, including those described in Schedule 1 to any Copyright Security Agreement, (ii) all renewals of any of the foregoing, (iii) all claims for, and rights to sue for, past or future infringements of any of the foregoing, and (iv) all income, royalties, damages and payments now or hereafter due or payable with respect to any of the foregoing, including damages and payments for past or future infringements thereof.

Copyright Security Agreement ” shall mean a Copyright Security Agreement, substantially in the form of Exhibit B, executed and delivered by a Lien Grantor in favor of the Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties.

Deposit Account Control Agreement ” means, with respect to any Deposit Account of any Lien Grantor, a Deposit Account Control Agreement substantially in the form of Exhibit H (or otherwise in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Applicable Agent) among such Lien Grantor, the Applicable Agent and the relevant Depositary Bank.

Depositary Bank ” shall mean a bank at which a Controlled Deposit Account is maintained.

Equity Interest ” shall mean (i) in the case of a corporation, any shares of its capital stock, (ii) in the case of a limited liability company, any membership interest therein, (iii) in the case of a partnership, any partnership interest (whether general or limited) therein, (iv) in the case of any other business entity, any participation or other interest in the equity or profits thereof, (v) any warrant, option or other right to acquire any Equity Interest described in this definition or (vi) any Security Entitlement in respect of any Equity Interest described in this definition.

Foreign Intercompany Receivables Collateral ” shall mean intercompany receivables owed by a Foreign Subsidiary to a Lien Grantor that are included in the Collateral.

 

5


Indenture ” shall mean that certain Indenture among Tower Automotive, LLC, the Issuers, the guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, as trustee and collateral agent, dated as of August 24, 2010.

Intellectual Property Filing ” shall mean (i) with respect to any Patent, Patent License, Trademark or Trademark License, the filing of the applicable Patent Security Agreement or Trademark Security Agreement with the United States Patent and Trademark Office, together with an appropriately completed recordation form, and (ii) with respect to any Copyright or Copyright License, the filing of the applicable Copyright Security Agreement with the United States Copyright Office, together with an appropriately completed recordation form, in each case sufficient to record the Transaction Lien granted to the Agent in such Recordable Intellectual Property.

Intellectual Property Security Agreement ” shall mean a Copyright Security Agreement, a Patent Security Agreement or a Trademark Security Agreement.

Issuer Control Agreement ” shall mean an Issuer Control Agreement substantially in the form of Exhibit F (with any changes that the Agent shall have approved).

Lien Grantors ” shall mean the US Borrower and the Guarantors (other than Holdings).

Liquidity Trigger Period ” shall have the meaning given such term in the ABL Credit Agreement.

LLC Interest ” shall mean a membership interest or similar interest in a limited liability company.

Loan Agreement ” shall mean the First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement dated as of July 31, 2007 among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and Tower Automotive Holdings Europe B.V, as borrowers, Tower Automotive, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(a), LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(b), LLC and the other guarantors party thereto, the lenders party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent.

Non-Contingent Secured Obligation ” shall mean at any time any Secured Obligation (or portion thereof) that is not a Contingent Secured Obligation at such time.

Original Lien Grantor ” shall mean any Lien Grantor that grants a Lien on any of its assets hereunder on the Closing Date.

 

6


own ” refers to the possession of sufficient rights in property to grant a security interest therein as contemplated by UCC Section 9-203, and “ acquire ” refers to the acquisition of any such rights.

Partnership Interest ” shall mean a partnership interest, whether general or limited.

Patent License ” shall mean any agreement now or hereafter in existence granting to any Lien Grantor, or pursuant to which any Lien Grantor grants to any other Person, any right with respect to any Patent or any invention now or hereafter in existence, whether patentable or not, whether a patent or application for patent is in existence on such invention or not, and whether a patent or application for patent on such invention may come into existence or not, including any agreement identified in Schedule 1 to any Patent Security Agreement.

Patents ” shall mean (i) all letters patent and design letters patent of the United States or any other country and all applications for letters patent or design letters patent of the United States or any other country, including applications in the United States Patent and Trademark Office or in any similar office or agency of the United States, any State thereof or any other country or any political subdivision thereof, including those described in Schedule 1 to any Patent Security Agreement, (ii) all reissues, divisions, continuations, continuations in part, revisions and extensions of any of the foregoing, (iii) all claims for, and rights to sue for, past or future infringements of any of the foregoing and (iv) all income, royalties, damages and payments now or hereafter due or payable with respect to any of the foregoing, including damages and payments for past or future infringements thereof.

Patent Security Agreement ” shall mean a Patent Security Agreement, substantially in the form of Exhibit C, executed and delivered by a Lien Grantor in favor of the Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties.

Perfection Certificate ” shall mean, with respect to any Lien Grantor, a certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit E, completed and supplemented with the schedules contemplated thereby to the satisfaction of the Agent, and signed by an officer of such Lien Grantor.

Permitted Liens ” shall mean (i) the Transaction Liens and (ii) any other Liens on the Collateral permitted to be created or assumed or to exist pursuant to Section 6.01 of the Loan Agreement.

Personal Property Collateral ” shall mean all property included in the Collateral except Real Property Collateral.

 

7


Pledged ”, when used in conjunction with any type of asset, shall mean at any time an asset of such type that is included (or that creates rights that are included) in the Collateral at such time. For example, “Pledged Equity Interest” means an Equity Interest that is included in the Collateral at such time.

Post-Petition Interest ” shall mean any interest that accrues after the commencement of any case, proceeding or other action relating to the bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization of any one or more of the Lien Grantors (or would accrue but for the operation of applicable bankruptcy or insolvency laws), whether or not such interest is allowed or allowable as a claim in any such proceeding.

Real Property Collateral ” shall mean all real property (including leasehold interests in real property) included in the Collateral.

Recordable Intellectual Property ” shall mean (i) any Patent registered with the United States Patent and Trademark Office, and any Patent License with respect to a Patent so registered, (ii) any Trademark registered with the United States Patent and Trademark Office, and any Trademark License with respect to a Trademark so registered, (iii) any Copyright registered with the United States Copyright Office and any Copyright License with respect to a Copyright so registered, and all rights in or under any of the foregoing.

Release Conditions ” shall mean the following conditions for terminating all the Transaction Liens:

(i) all Commitments under the Loan Agreement shall have expired or been terminated;

(ii) all Non-Contingent Secured Obligations shall have been paid in full; and

(iii) no Contingent Secured Obligations (other than any Contingent Secured Obligations in respect of contingent indemnification and expense reimbursement obligations as to which no claim shall have been asserted) shall remain outstanding;

provided that the condition in clause (iii) shall not apply to outstanding Letters of Credit if the Borrowers have granted to the Agent, for the benefit of the Lenders, a security interest in cash (or causes a bank acceptable to the Agent and the Issuing Lender to issue a letter of credit naming the Issuing Lender as beneficiary) in an amount not less than 105% of the LC Exposure (plus any accrued and unpaid interest thereon) as of the date of such termination, on terms and

 

8


conditions and pursuant to documentation reasonably satisfactory to the Agent and the Issuing Lender.

Secured Agreement ”, when used with respect to any Secured Obligation, refers collectively to each instrument, agreement or other document that sets forth obligations of either Borrower, obligations of a guarantor and/or rights of the holder with respect to such Secured Obligation.

Secured Parties ” shall mean the holders from time to time of the Secured Obligations.

Securities Account Control Agreement ” means, with respect to a Securities Account, a Securities Account Control Agreement substantially in the form of Exhibit G (with any changes that the Applicable Agent shall have approved) among the relevant Securities Intermediary, the relevant Lien Grantor and the Applicable Agent.

Security Agreement Supplement ” shall mean a Security Agreement Supplement, substantially in the form of Exhibit A, signed and delivered to the Agent for the purpose of adding a Subsidiary as a party hereto pursuant to Section 20 and/or adding additional property to the Collateral.

Term Intercreditor Agreement ” shall mean that certain Term Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010 among JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A., as representative with respect to the Term Loan Agreement, Wilmington Trust FSB, as representative with respect to the Indenture, each additional term agent from time to time party thereto, Tower Automotive, LLC and the Lien Grantors party thereto.

Term Obligations Termination Date ” shall have the meaning given such term in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

Term Priority Collateral ” shall have the meaning given such term in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

Term Proceeds Account ” shall mean the Deposit Account established pursuant to Section 9(a)(iii), into which the proceeds required to be deposited therein pursuant to Section 9(a)(iii) shall be deposited.

Trademark License ” shall mean any agreement now or hereafter in existence granting to any Lien Grantor, or pursuant to which any Lien Grantor grants to any other Person, any right to use any Trademark, including any agreement identified in Schedule 1 to any Trademark Security Agreement.

 

9


Trademarks ” shall mean: (i) all trademarks, trade names, corporate names, company names, business names, fictitious business names, trade styles, service marks, logos, brand names, trade dress, prints and labels on which any of the foregoing have appeared or appear, package and other designs, and all other source or business identifiers, and all general intangibles of like nature, and the rights in any of the foregoing which arise under applicable law, (ii) the goodwill of the business symbolized thereby or associated with each of them, (iii) all registrations and applications in connection therewith, including registrations and applications in the United States Patent and Trademark Office or in any similar office or agency of the United States, any State thereof or any other country or any political subdivision thereof, including those described in Schedule 1 to any Trademark Security Agreement, (iv) all renewals of any of the foregoing, (v) all claims for, and rights to sue for, past or future infringements of any of the foregoing and (vi) all income, royalties, damages and payments now or hereafter due or payable with respect to any of the foregoing, including damages and payments for past or future infringements thereof.

Trademark Security Agreement ” shall mean a Trademark Security Agreement, substantially in the form of Exhibit D, executed and delivered by a Lien Grantor in favor of the Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties.

Transaction Guarantee” shall mean, with respect to each Guarantor, its guarantee of the Secured Obligations under the Loan Agreement or any Joinder Agreement.

Transaction Liens ” shall mean the Liens granted by the Lien Grantors under the Security Documents.

Type ” shall have the meaning specified in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

UCC ” shall mean the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in the State of New York; provided that, if perfection or the effect of perfection or non-perfection or the priority of any Transaction Lien on any Collateral is governed by the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect in a jurisdiction other than New York, “UCC” means the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in such other jurisdiction for purposes of the provisions hereof relating to such perfection, effect of perfection or non-perfection or priority.

(d) Terms Generally. The definitions of terms herein (including those incorporated by reference to the UCC or to another document) apply equally to the singular and plural forms of the terms defined. Whenever the context may require, any pronoun includes the corresponding masculine, feminine and neuter

 

10


forms. The words “ include ”, “ includes ” and “ including ” shall be deemed to be followed by the phrase “ without limitation ”. The word “ will ” shall be construed to have the same meaning and effect as the word “ shall ”. Unless the context requires otherwise, (i) any definition of or reference to any agreement, instrument or other document herein shall be construed as referring to such agreement, instrument or other document as from time to time amended, supplemented or otherwise modified (subject to any restrictions on such amendments, supplements or modifications set forth herein), (ii) any reference herein to any Person shall be construed to include such Person’s successors and assigns, (iii) the words “ herein ”, “ hereof ” and “ hereunder ”, and words of similar import, shall be construed to refer to this Agreement in its entirety and not to any particular provision hereof, (iv) all references herein to Sections, Exhibits and Schedules shall be construed to refer to Sections of, and Exhibits and Schedules to, this Agreement and (v) the word “ property ” shall be construed to refer to any and all tangible and intangible assets and properties, including cash, securities, accounts and contract rights.

(e) The Authorized Term Collateral Agent . Without in any way limiting or otherwise modifying the rights of the Agent hereunder, all enforcement rights and all discretionary rights to take action (or to consent to the taking of any action) vested in the Agent (including in its capacity as “Applicable Agent”) pursuant to Sections 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 and 16 of this Agreement shall also be exercisable by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, acting in accordance with the Term Intercreditor Agreement; provided , that in connection with the exercise by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent of any such right, to the extent that the terms of any Security Document governed by non-U.S. law (including, without limitation, any Security Document delivered pursuant to Section 4(f) or 4(g)) require that such action be taken by the Collateral Agent, the Collateral Agent shall take such action in accordance with the written instructions of the Authorized Term Collateral Agent.

SECTION 2 . Grant of Transaction Liens.

(a) The US Borrower, in order to secure the Secured Obligations, and each Guarantor listed on the signature pages hereof, in order to secure its Transaction Guarantee, grants to the Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties a continuing security interest in all the following property of the US Borrower or such Guarantor, as the case may be, whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising and regardless of where located:

(i) all Accounts;

(ii) all Chattel Paper;

 

11


(iii) all Deposit Accounts;

(iv) all Documents;

(v) all Equipment;

(vi) all General Intangibles (including any Equity Interests in other Persons that do not constitute Investment Property);

(vii) all Instruments;

(viii) all Inventory;

(ix) all Investment Property;

(x) all books and records (including customer lists, credit files, computer programs, printouts and other computer materials and records) of such Original Lien Grantor pertaining to any of its Collateral;

(xi) such Original Lien Grantor’s ownership interest in (1) its Collateral Accounts, (2) all Financial Assets credited to its Collateral Accounts from time to time and all Security Entitlements in respect thereof, (3) all cash held in its Collateral Accounts from time to time and (4) all other money in the possession of the Agent; and

(xii) all Proceeds of the Collateral described in the foregoing clauses (i) through (xi);

provided that the following property is excluded from the foregoing security interests: (A) motor vehicles the perfection of a security interest in which is excluded from the Uniform Commercial Code in the relevant jurisdiction, (B) voting Equity Interests in any Foreign Subsidiary, to the extent (but only to the extent) required to prevent the Collateral from including more than 65% of all voting Equity Interests in such Foreign Subsidiary, (C) United States intent-to-use trademark applications to the extent that, and solely during the period in which, the grant of a security interest therein would impair the validity or enforceability of such intent-to-use trademark applications under applicable federal law and (D) any property to the extent that the grant of a security interest therein is prohibited by any applicable law or regulation, requires a consent not obtained of any Governmental Authority pursuant to any applicable law or regulation, or is prohibited by, or constitutes a breach or default under or results in the termination of or requires any consent not obtained under, any contract, license, agreement, instrument or other document evidencing or giving rise to such property or, in the case of any Investment Property, any applicable shareholder or similar agreement, except to the extent that such law or regulation or the term in such contract,

 

12


license, agreement, instrument or other document or shareholder or similar agreement providing for such prohibition, breach, default or termination or requiring such consent is ineffective under applicable law. Each Original Lien Grantor shall use all reasonable efforts to obtain any such required consent that is reasonably obtainable.

(b) With respect to each right to payment or performance included in the Collateral from time to time, the Transaction Lien granted therein includes a continuing security interest in (i) any Supporting Obligation that supports such payment or performance and (ii) any Lien that (x) secures such right to payment or performance or (y) secures any such Supporting Obligation.

(c) The Transaction Liens are granted as security only and shall not subject the Agent or any other Secured Party to, or transfer or in any way affect or modify, any obligation or liability of any Lien Grantor with respect to any of the Collateral or any transaction in connection therewith.

SECTION 3 . General Representations and Warranties. Each Original Lien Grantor represents and warrants that:

(a) Such Lien Grantor is duly organized, validly existing and in good standing under the laws of the jurisdiction identified as its jurisdiction of organization in its Perfection Certificate.

(b) Schedule 1 lists all Equity Interests in Subsidiaries and Affiliates owned by such Lien Grantor as of the Closing Date. Such Lien Grantor holds all such Equity Interests directly ( i.e. , not through a Subsidiary, a Securities Intermediary or any other Person).

(c) Schedule 2 lists, as of the Closing Date, (i) all Securities owned by such Lien Grantor (except Securities evidencing Equity Interests in Subsidiaries and Affiliates) and (ii) all Securities Accounts to which Financial Assets are credited in respect of which such Lien Grantor owns Security Entitlements. Such Lien Grantor owns no Commodity Account in respect of which such Lien Grantor is the Commodity Customer.

(d) All Pledged Equity Interests owned by such Lien Grantor are owned by it free and clear of any Lien other than (i) the Transaction Liens and (ii) any other Permitted Liens. All shares of capital stock included in such Pledged Equity Interests (including shares of capital stock in respect of which such Lien Grantor owns a Security Entitlement) have been duly authorized and validly issued and are fully paid and non-assessable. None of such Pledged Equity Interests is subject to any option to purchase or similar right of any Person. Such Lien Grantor is not and will not become a party to or otherwise bound by any

 

13


agreement (except the Loan Documents and any agreement permitted under the Loan Documents) which restricts in any manner the rights of any present or future holder of any Pledged Equity Interest with respect thereto.

(e) Such Lien Grantor has good and marketable title to all its Collateral (subject to exceptions that are, in the aggregate, not material), free and clear of any Lien other than Permitted Liens.

(f) Such Lien Grantor has not performed any acts that might prevent the Agent from enforcing any of the provisions of the Security Documents or that would limit the Agent in any such enforcement. No financing statement, security agreement, mortgage or similar or equivalent document or instrument covering all or part of the Collateral owned by such Lien Grantor is on file or of record in any jurisdiction in which such filing or recording would be effective to perfect or record a Lien on such Collateral, except financing statements, mortgages or other similar or equivalent documents with respect to Permitted Liens. After the Closing Date, no Collateral owned by such Lien Grantor will be in the possession or under the Control of any other Person having a claim thereto or security interest therein, other than a Permitted Lien.

(g) The Transaction Liens on all Personal Property Collateral owned by such Lien Grantor (i) have been validly created, (ii) will attach to each item of such Collateral on the Closing Date (or, if such Lien Grantor first obtains rights thereto on a later date, on such later date) and (iii) when so attached, will secure all the Secured Obligations or such Lien Grantor’s Transaction Guarantee, as the case may be.

(h) When the relevant Mortgages have been duly executed and delivered, the Transaction Liens on all Real Property Collateral owned by such Lien Grantor as of the Closing Date will have been validly created and will secure all the Secured Obligations or such Lien Grantor’s Transaction Guarantee, as the case may be. When such Mortgages (and memoranda of lease with respect to any leasehold interests included in such Real Property Collateral) have been duly recorded, such Transaction Liens will rank prior to all other Liens (except Permitted Liens) on such Real Property Collateral.

(i) Such Lien Grantor has delivered a Perfection Certificate to the Agent. The information set forth therein is correct and complete as of the Closing Date.

(j) When UCC financing statements describing the Collateral as “all personal property” have been filed in the offices specified in such Perfection Certificate, the Transaction Liens will constitute perfected security interests in the Personal Property Collateral owned by such Lien Grantor to the extent that a

 

14


security interest therein may be perfected by filing pursuant to the UCC, prior to all Liens and rights of others therein except Permitted Liens. When, in addition to the filing of such UCC financing statements, the applicable Intellectual Property Filings have been made with respect to such Lien Grantor’s Recordable Intellectual Property (including any future filings required pursuant to Sections 4(a) and 6(a)), the Transaction Liens will constitute perfected security interests in all right, title and interest of such Lien Grantor in its Recordable Intellectual Property to the extent that security interests therein may be perfected by such filings, prior to all Liens and rights of others therein except Permitted Liens. Except for (i) the filing of such UCC financing statements, (ii) such Intellectual Property Filings, (iii) the due recordation of memoranda of lease with respect to the Pledged leasehold interests and (iv) the due recordation of the Mortgages, no registration, recordation or filing with any governmental body, agency or official is required in connection with the execution or delivery of the Security Documents or is necessary for the validity or enforceability thereof or for the perfection or due recordation of the Transaction Liens or for the enforcement of the Transaction Liens.

(k) Such Lien Grantor has taken, and will continue to take, all actions necessary under the UCC to perfect (and maintain the perfection of) its interest in any Accounts or Chattel Paper purchased or otherwise acquired by it, as against its assignors and creditors of its assignors.

(l) Such Lien Grantor’s Collateral is insured as required by the Loan Agreement.

(m) All of such Lien Grantor’s Inventory has or will have been produced in compliance with the applicable requirements of the Fair Labor Standards Act, as amended.

SECTION 4. Further Assurances; General Covenants. Each Lien Grantor covenants as follows:

(a) Such Lien Grantor will, from time to time, at the US Borrower’s expense, execute, deliver, file and record any statement, assignment, instrument, document, agreement or other paper and take any other action (including any Intellectual Property Filing and any filing of financing or continuation statements under the UCC) that from time to time may be reasonably necessary, or that the Agent may reasonably request, in order to:

(i) create, preserve, perfect, confirm or validate the Transaction Liens on such Lien Grantor’s Collateral;

 

15


(ii) in the case of Pledged Deposit Accounts and Pledged Investment Property, cause the Agent to have Control thereof;

(iii) enable the Agent and the other Secured Parties to obtain the full benefits of the Security Documents; or

(iv) enable the Agent to exercise and enforce any of its rights, powers and remedies with respect to any of such Lien Grantor’s Collateral.

To the extent permitted by applicable law, such Lien Grantor authorizes the Agent to execute and file such financing statements or continuation statements without such Lien Grantor’s signature appearing thereon. Such Lien Grantor constitutes the Agent its attorney-in-fact to execute and file all Intellectual Property Filings and other filings required or so requested for the foregoing purposes, all acts of such attorney being hereby ratified and confirmed; and such power, being coupled with an interest, shall be irrevocable until all the Transaction Liens granted by such Lien Grantor terminate pursuant to Section 19. The US Borrower will pay the costs of, or incidental to, any Intellectual Property Filings and any recording or filing of any financing or continuation statements or other documents recorded or filed pursuant hereto.

(b) Such Lien Grantor will not (i) change its name or corporate structure, (ii) change its location (determined as provided in UCC Section 9-307) or (iii) become bound, as provided in UCC Section 9-203(d) or otherwise, by a security agreement entered into by another Person, unless it shall have given the Agent at least 30 days prior notice thereof.

(c) Except for sales of inventory in the ordinary course of business, such Lien Grantor will not sell, lease, exchange, assign or otherwise dispose of, or grant any option with respect to, any of its Collateral; provided that such Lien Grantor may do any of the foregoing unless (i) doing so would violate a covenant in the Loan Agreement or (ii) an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing and the Agent shall have notified such Lien Grantor that its right to do so is terminated, suspended or otherwise limited. Concurrently with any sale, lease or other disposition (except a sale or disposition to another Lien Grantor or a lease) permitted by the foregoing proviso , the Transaction Liens on the assets sold or disposed of (but not in any Proceeds arising from such sale or disposition) will cease immediately without any action by the Agent or any other Secured Party. The Agent will, at the US Borrower’s expense, execute and deliver to the relevant Lien Grantor such documents as such Lien Grantor shall reasonably request to evidence the fact that any asset so sold or disposed of is no longer subject to a Transaction Lien.

 

16


(d) Such Lien Grantor will, promptly upon request, provide to the Agent all information and evidence concerning such Lien Grantor’s Collateral that the Agent may reasonably request from time to time to enable it to enforce the provisions of the Security Documents.

SECTION 5 . Equipment. Each Lien Grantor covenants that it will not permit any of its Pledged Equipment to become a fixture to real estate or an accession to any personal property that is not included in the Collateral.

SECTION 6 . Recordable Intellectual Property. Each Lien Grantor covenants as follows:

(a) On the Closing Date (in the case of an Original Lien Grantor) or the date on which it signs and delivers its first Security Agreement Supplement (in the case of any other Lien Grantor), such Lien Grantor will sign and deliver to the Agent Intellectual Property Security Agreements with respect to all Recordable Intellectual Property then owned by it. Within 30 days after each June 30 and December 31 thereafter, it will sign and deliver to the Agent an appropriate Intellectual Property Security Agreement covering any Recordable Intellectual Property owned by it on such June 30 or December 31 that is not covered by any previous Intellectual Property Security Agreement so signed and delivered by it. Each Lien Grantor hereby authorizes the Agent to make all Intellectual Property Filings necessary to record the Transaction Liens on its Recordable Intellectual Property.

(b) Such Lien Grantor will notify the Agent promptly if it knows that any application or registration relating to any Recordable Intellectual Property owned or licensed by it that is material to its business may become abandoned or dedicated to the public, or of any adverse determination or development (including the institution of, or any adverse determination or development in, any proceeding in the United States Copyright Office, the United States Patent and Trademark Office or any court) regarding such Lien Grantor’s ownership of such Recordable Intellectual Property, its right to register or patent the same, or its right to keep and maintain the same. If any of such Lien Grantor’s rights to any Recordable Intellectual Property are infringed, misappropriated or diluted in any material respect by a third party, such Lien Grantor will notify the Agent within 30 days after it learns thereof and will, unless such Lien Grantor shall reasonably determine that such action would be of negligible value, economic or otherwise, promptly sue for infringement, misappropriation or dilution and to recover any and all damages for such infringement, misappropriation or dilution, and take such other actions as such Lien Grantor shall reasonably deem appropriate under the circumstances to protect such Recordable Intellectual Property.

 

17


SECTION 7 . Investment Property. Each Lien Grantor represents, warrants and covenants as follows:

(a) Certificated Securities. On the Closing Date (in the case of an Original Lien Grantor) or the date on which it signs and delivers its first Security Agreement Supplement (in the case of any other Lien Grantor), such Lien Grantor will deliver to the Applicable Agent as Collateral hereunder all certificates representing Pledged Certificated Securities then owned by such Lien Grantor. Thereafter, whenever such Lien Grantor acquires any other certificate representing a Pledged Certificated Security, such Lien Grantor will immediately deliver such certificate to the Applicable Agent as Collateral hereunder. The provisions of this subsection are subject to the limitation in Section 7(j) in the case of voting Equity Interests in a Foreign Subsidiary.

(b) Uncertificated Securities . On the Closing Date (in the case of an Original Lien Grantor) or the date on which it signs and delivers its first Security Agreement Supplement (in the case of any other Lien Grantor), such Lien Grantor will enter into (and cause the relevant issuer to enter into) an Issuer Control Agreement in respect of each Pledged Uncertificated Security then owned by such Lien Grantor and deliver such Issuer Control Agreement to the Applicable Agent (which shall enter into the same). Thereafter, whenever such Lien Grantor acquires any other Pledged Uncertificated Security, such Lien Grantor will enter into (and cause the relevant issuer to enter into) an Issuer Control Agreement in respect of such Pledged Uncertificated Security and deliver such Issuer Control Agreement to the Applicable Agent (which shall enter into the same). The provisions of this subsection are subject to the limitation in Section 7(j) in the case of voting Equity Interests in a Foreign Subsidiary.

(c) Security Entitlements . On the Closing Date (in the case of an Original Lien Grantor) or the date on which it signs and delivers its first Security Agreement Supplement (in the case of any other Lien Grantor), such Lien Grantor will, with respect to each Security Entitlement then owned by it, enter into (and cause the relevant Securities Intermediary to enter into) a Securities Account Control Agreement in respect of such Security Entitlement and the Securities Account to which the underlying Financial Asset is credited and will deliver such Securities Account Control Agreement to the Applicable Agent (which shall enter into the same). Thereafter, whenever such Lien Grantor acquires any other Security Entitlement, such Lien Grantor will, as promptly as practicable, cause the underlying Financial Asset to be credited to a Controlled Securities Account. Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this clause (c), the Lien Grantors have the right not to comply therewith with respect to Securities Accounts having an aggregate value of less than $1,000,000 in the aggregate for all Lien Grantors; provided , that if an Event of Default occurs and is continuing, the Applicable Agent may terminate the foregoing right not to comply, or reduce the amount

 

18


thereof, by giving at least 10 Business Days’ notice of such termination or reduction to the relevant Lien Grantors.

(d) Perfection as to Certificated Securities. When such Lien Grantor delivers the certificate representing any Pledged Certificated Security owned by it to the Applicable Agent and complies with Section 7(h) in connection with such delivery, (i) the Transaction Lien on such Pledged Certificated Security will be perfected, subject to no prior Liens or rights of others (except Liens permitted under Section 6.01(b) of the Loan Agreement), (ii) the Applicable Agent will have Control of such Pledged Certificated Security and (iii) the Applicable Agent will be a protected purchaser (within the meaning of UCC Section 8-303) thereof.

(e) Perfection as to Uncertificated Securities . When such Lien Grantor, the Applicable Agent and the issuer of any Pledged Uncertificated Security owned by such Lien Grantor enter into an Issuer Control Agreement with respect thereto, (i) the Transaction Lien on such Pledged Uncertificated Security will be perfected, subject to no prior Liens or rights of others (except Liens permitted under Section 6.01(b) of the Loan Agreement), (ii) the Applicable Agent will have Control of such Pledged Uncertificated Security and (iii) the Applicable Agent will be a protected purchaser (within the meaning of UCC Section 8-303) thereof.

(f) Perfection as to Security Entitlements . So long as the Financial Asset underlying any Security Entitlement owned by such Lien Grantor is credited to a Controlled Securities Account, (i) the Transaction Lien on such Security Entitlement will be perfected, subject to no prior Liens or rights of others (except Liens and rights of the relevant Securities Intermediary that are Permitted Liens and any other Liens consented to by the Agent, and Liens permitted under Section 6.01(b) of the Loan Agreement), (ii) the Applicable Agent will have Control of such Security Entitlement and (iii) no action based on an adverse claim to such Security Entitlement or such Financial Asset, whether framed in conversion, replevin, constructive trust, equitable lien or other theory, may be asserted against the Applicable Agent or any other Secured Party.

(g) Agreement as to Applicable Jurisdiction . In respect of all Security Entitlements owned by such Lien Grantor, and all Securities Accounts to which the related Financial Assets are credited, the Securities Intermediary’s jurisdiction (determined as provided in UCC Section 8-110(e)) will at all times be located in the United States.

(h) Delivery of Pledged Certificates . All Pledged Certificates, when delivered to the Applicable Agent, will be in suitable form for transfer by delivery, or accompanied by duly executed instruments of transfer or assignment

 

19


in blank, with signatures appropriately witnessed, all in form and substance satisfactory to the Applicable Agent.

(i) Communications . Each Lien Grantor will promptly give to the Agent copies of any material notices and communications received by it with respect to (i) Pledged Securities registered in the name of such Lien Grantor or its nominee and (ii) Pledged Security Entitlements as to which such Lien Grantor is the Entitlement Holder.

(j) Foreign Subsidiaries. A Lien Grantor will not be obligated to comply with the provisions of this Section at any time with respect to any voting Equity Interest in a Foreign Subsidiary if and to the extent (but only to the extent) that such voting Equity Interest is excluded from the Transaction Liens at such time pursuant to clause (B) of the proviso at the end of Section 2(a) and/or the comparable provisions of one or more Security Agreement Supplements.

(k) Compliance with Applicable Foreign Laws. If and so long as the Collateral includes (i) any Equity Interest in, or other Investment Property issued by, a legal entity organized under the laws of a jurisdiction outside the United States or (ii) any Security Entitlement in respect of a Financial Asset issued by such a foreign legal entity, the relevant Lien Grantor will take all such action as may be required under the laws of such foreign jurisdiction to ensure that the Transaction Lien on such Collateral ranks prior to all Liens and rights of others therein.

SECTION 8 . Controlled Deposit Accounts. Each Lien Grantor represents, warrants and covenants as follows:

(a) All cash owned by such Lien Grantor will be deposited, upon or promptly after the receipt thereof, in one or more Controlled Deposit Accounts. Each Controlled Deposit Account will be operated as provided in Section 10.

(b) In respect of each Controlled Deposit Account, the Depositary Bank’s jurisdiction (determined as provided in UCC Section 9-304) will at all times be a jurisdiction in which Article 9 of the Uniform Commercial Code is in effect.

(c) So long as the Applicable Agent has Control of a Controlled Deposit Account, the Transaction Lien on such Controlled Deposit Account will be perfected, subject to no prior Liens or rights of others (except the Depositary Bank’s right to deduct its normal operating charges and any uncollected funds previously credited thereto and any other Liens consented to by the Agent, and Permitted Liens).

 

20


(d) Materiality Exception. The Lien Grantors have the right not to comply with the foregoing provisions of this Section with respect to (i) Deposit Accounts that are payroll or trust accounts and (ii) other Deposit Accounts having total collected balances that do not at any time exceed $2,000,000 in the aggregate for all Lien Grantors.

SECTION 9 . Cash Collateral Accounts. (a) The Lien Grantors will establish the following Deposit Accounts (each such Deposit Account, a “ Cash Collateral Account ”), which will be operated as provided in this Section and Section 10:

(i) at or prior to the time such account shall be required in accordance with Section 9(b)(i), the Collection Account which shall be under the exclusive control of the Agent (or, if so instructed by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, the Authorized Term Collateral Agent);

(ii) when and as required by the provisions of the Loan Agreement, the Letter of Credit Account which shall be under the exclusive control of the Agent; and

(iii) at or prior to the time such account shall be required in accordance with Section 9(b)(iii), the Term Proceeds Account, which shall be under the control of the Agent (or the ABL Agent (for the benefit of the Agent in accordance with the ABL Intercreditor Agreement)).

(b) The following amounts shall be deposited into the Cash Collateral Accounts:

(i) the Agent shall deposit to the Collection Account each amount realized or otherwise received with respect to assets of any Lien Grantor upon any exercise of remedies pursuant to any Security Document;

(ii) the Lien Grantors shall deposit to the Letter of Credit Account all amounts required pursuant to Section 2.02(k) and Article 7 of the Loan Agreement; and

(iii) the Lien Grantors shall cause all principal payments made to them on the Foreign Intercompany Receivables Collateral to be deposited to the Term Proceeds Account.

(c) The Agent shall maintain such records and/or establish such sub-accounts as shall be required to enable it to identify the amounts held in each

 

21


Cash Collateral Account from time to time pursuant each clause of subsection (b) of this Section, as applicable.

(d) The Lien Grantors shall not permit to be deposited to the Term Proceeds Account any amounts that do not constitute Term Priority Collateral.

(e) Unless an Event of Default shall be continuing, the Lien Grantors shall have the right to withdraw funds held in the Term Proceeds Account for their general corporate (or limited liability company) purposes.

(f) Subject to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, if an Event of Default shall be continuing, amounts held in the Collateral Account shall be applied by the Agent in accordance with the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

SECTION 10 . Operation of Collateral Accounts. (a) Funds held in any Cash Collateral Account may, until withdrawn, be invested and reinvested in such Permitted Investments as the US Borrower shall request from time to time; provided that if an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Agent (in the case of the Collection Account and the Letter of Credit Account) or the Applicable Agent (in the case of all other Cash Collateral Accounts) may select such Permitted Investments. Funds held in any Controlled Deposit Account or Controlled Securities Account may, until withdrawn, be invested and reinvested in such Permitted Investments as the US Borrower shall request from time to time; provided that (i) prior to the ABL Termination Date, if a Liquidity Trigger Period shall be continuing or (ii) at all other times, if an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Applicable Agent may select such Permitted Investments. Any investment income received on the Cash Collateral Accounts will be deposited into and become part of the Cash Collateral Accounts.

(b) With respect to each Controlled Deposit Account and each Controlled Securities Account (it being understood that the provisions of Section 9 shall apply to all Cash Collateral Accounts), the Applicable Agent will instruct the relevant Securities Intermediary or Depositary Bank that the relevant Lien Grantor may withdraw, or direct the disposition of, funds held therein unless and until the Applicable Agent rescinds such instruction. The Applicable Agent will not rescind such instructions unless (i) prior to the ABL Termination Date, a Liquidity Trigger Period shall be continuing or (ii) at all other times, an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing.

(c) If an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Agent (with respect to the Collection Account and the Letter of Credit Account) and the Applicable Agent (with respect to any other Collateral Account) may retain or liquidate, or instruct the relevant Securities Intermediary or Depositary Bank to retain or liquidate, any or all cash or investments then held in such

 

22


Collateral Account and/or withdraw any amounts held therein and apply such amounts as provided in Section 14.

SECTION 11 . Transfer of Record Ownership. At any time when an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Applicable Agent may (and to the extent that action by it is required, the relevant Lien Grantor, if directed to do so by the Applicable Agent, will as promptly as practicable) cause each of the Pledged Securities (or any portion thereof specified in such direction) to be transferred of record into the name of the Applicable Agent or its nominee. Each Lien Grantor will take any and all actions reasonably requested by the Applicable Agent to facilitate compliance with this Section. If the provisions of this Section are implemented, Section 7(b) shall not thereafter apply to any Pledged Security that is registered in the name of the Applicable Agent or its nominee. The Applicable Agent will promptly give to the relevant Lien Grantor copies of any notices and other communications received by the Applicable Agent with respect to Pledged Securities registered in the name of the Applicable Agent or its nominee.

SECTION 12 . Right to Vote Securities. (a) Unless an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, each Lien Grantor will have the right, from time to time, to vote and to give consents, ratifications and waivers with respect to any Pledged Security owned by it and the Financial Asset underlying any Pledged Security Entitlement owned by it, and the Agent will, upon receiving a written request from such Lien Grantor, deliver to such Lien Grantor or as specified in such request such proxies, powers of attorney, consents, ratifications and waivers in respect of any such Pledged Security that is registered in the name of the Agent or its nominee or any such Pledged Security Entitlement as to which the Agent or its nominee is the Entitlement Holder, in each case as shall be specified in such request and be in form and substance satisfactory to the Agent. Unless an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Applicable Agent will have no right to take any action which the owner of a Pledged Partnership Interest or Pledged LLC Interest is entitled to take with respect thereto, except the right to receive payments and other distributions to the extent provided herein.

(b) If an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Applicable Agent will have the right (but not the obligation), to the extent permitted by law (and, in the case of a Pledged Partnership Interest or Pledged LLC Interest, by the relevant partnership agreement, limited liability company agreement, operating agreement or other governing document), to vote, to give consents, ratifications and waivers and to take any other action with respect to the Pledged Investment Property, the other Pledged Equity Interests (if any) and the Financial Assets underlying the Pledged Security Entitlements, with the same force and effect as if the Applicable Agent were the absolute and sole owner

 

23


thereof, and each Lien Grantor will take all such action as the Applicable Agent may reasonably request from time to time to give effect to such right.

SECTION 13 . Remedies upon Event of Default. (a) If an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, subject to the Term Intercreditor Agreement, the Agent may exercise (or cause its sub-agents to exercise) any or all of the remedies available to it (or to such sub-agents) under the Security Documents.

(b) Without limiting the generality of the foregoing and subject to the terms of (i) the Term Intercreditor Agreement and (ii) with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, if an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Agent may exercise on behalf of the Secured Parties all the rights of a secured party under the UCC (whether or not in effect in the jurisdiction where such rights are exercised) with respect to any Personal Property Collateral and, in addition, the Agent (with respect to the Collection Account and the Letter of Credit Account) and the Applicable Agent (with respect to any other Collateral Account) may, without being required to give any notice, except as herein provided or as may be required by mandatory provisions of law, withdraw all cash held in such Collateral Account and apply such cash as provided in Section 14 and, if there shall be no such cash or if such cash shall be insufficient to pay all the Secured Obligations in full, sell, lease, license or otherwise dispose of the Collateral or any part thereof. Notice of any such sale or other disposition shall be given to the relevant Lien Grantor(s) as required by Section 16. The foregoing provisions of this subsection shall apply to Real Property Collateral only to the extent permitted by applicable law and the provisions of any applicable Mortgage or other document.

(c) Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, if an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, and subject to the terms of (i) the Term Intercreditor Agreement and (ii) with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the ABL Intercreditor Agreement:

(i) the Agent may license or sublicense, whether general, special or otherwise, and whether on an exclusive or non-exclusive basis, any Pledged intellectual property (including any Pledged Recordable Intellectual Property) throughout the world for such term or terms, on such conditions and in such manner as the Agent shall in its sole discretion determine; provided that such licenses or sublicenses do not conflict with any existing license of which the Agent shall have received a copy;

(ii) the Agent may (without assuming any obligation or liability thereunder), at any time and from time to time, in its sole and reasonable discretion, enforce (and shall have the exclusive right to enforce) against

 

24


any licensee or sublicensee all rights and remedies of any Lien Grantor in, to and under any of its Pledged intellectual property and take or refrain from taking any action under any thereof, and each Lien Grantor releases the Agent and each other Secured Party from liability for, and agrees to hold the Agent and each other Secured Party free and harmless from and against any claims and expenses arising out of, any lawful action so taken or omitted to be taken with respect thereto, except for claims and expenses arising from the Agent’s or such Secured Party’s gross negligence or willful misconduct, as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final and non-appealable decision; and

(iii) upon request by the Agent (which shall not be construed as implying any limitation on its rights or powers), each Lien Grantor will execute and deliver to the Agent a power of attorney, in form and substance satisfactory to the Agent, for the implementation of any sale, lease, license or other disposition of any of such Lien Grantor’s Pledged intellectual property or any action related thereto. In connection with any such disposition, but subject to any confidentiality restrictions imposed on such Lien Grantor in any license or similar agreement, such Lien Grantor will supply to the Agent its know-how and expertise relating to the relevant intellectual property or the products or services made or rendered in connection with such intellectual property, and its customer lists and other records relating to such intellectual property and to the distribution of said products or services.

SECTION 14. Application of Proceeds . (a) If an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, (i) any cash held in the Collection Account and the Letter of Credit Account and (ii) subject to the terms of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, any amounts held in any other Collateral Account and the proceeds of any sale or other disposition of all or any part of the Collateral, shall be applied by the Collateral Agent in accordance with Section 2.01 of the Term Intercreditor Agreement, provided that (i) Collateral owned by a Subsidiary Guarantor and any proceeds thereof shall be applied pursuant to the foregoing clauses only to the extent that the value thereof does not exceed the largest amount that would not render the Transaction Guarantee of such Subsidiary Guarantor subject to avoidance under Section 548 of the United States Bankruptcy Code or any comparable provisions of applicable law. The Agent may make such distributions hereunder in cash or in kind or, on a ratable basis, in any combination thereof.

(b) If at any time any portion of any monies collected or received by the Agent would, but for the provisions of this Section 14(b), be payable pursuant to Section 14(a) in respect of a Contingent Secured Obligation, the Agent shall not apply any monies to pay such Contingent Secured Obligation but instead shall

 

25


request the holder thereof, at least 10 days before each proposed distribution hereunder, to notify the Agent as to the maximum amount of such Contingent Secured Obligation if then ascertainable ( e.g. , in the case of a letter of credit, the maximum amount available for subsequent drawings thereunder). If the holder of such Contingent Secured Obligation does not notify the Agent of the maximum ascertainable amount thereof at least two Business Days before such distribution, such holder will not be entitled to share in such distribution. If such holder does so notify the Agent as to the maximum ascertainable amount thereof, the Agent will allocate to such holder a portion of the monies to be distributed in such distribution, calculated as if such Contingent Secured Obligation were outstanding in such maximum ascertainable amount. However, the Agent will not apply such portion of such monies to pay such Contingent Secured Obligation, but instead will hold such monies or invest such monies in Permitted Investments. All such monies and Permitted Investments and all proceeds thereof will constitute Collateral hereunder, but will be subject to distribution in accordance with this Section 14(b) rather than Section 14(a). The Agent will hold all such monies and Permitted Investments and the net proceeds thereof in trust until all or part of such Contingent Secured Obligation becomes a Non-Contingent Secured Obligation, whereupon the Agent at the request of the relevant Secured Party will apply the amount so held in trust to pay such Non-Contingent Secured Obligation. If (i) the holder of such Contingent Secured Obligation shall advise the Agent that no portion thereof remains in the category of a Contingent Secured Obligation and (ii) the Agent still holds any amount held in trust pursuant to this Section 14(b) in respect of such Contingent Secured Obligation (after paying all amounts payable pursuant to the preceding sentence with respect to any portions thereof that became Non-Contingent Secured Obligations), such remaining amount will be applied by the Agent in the order of priorities set forth in Section 14(a).

(c) In making the payments and allocations required by this Section, the Agent may rely upon information supplied to it pursuant to Section 18(c). All distributions made by the Agent pursuant to this Section shall be final (except in the event of manifest error) and the Agent shall have no duty to inquire as to the application by any Secured Party of any amount distributed to it.

SECTION 15. Fees and Expenses; Indemnification . (a) The US Borrower and the Guarantors, jointly and severally, will forthwith upon demand pay to the Agent and the Authorized Term Collateral Agent:

(i) the amount of any taxes that the Agent and the Authorized Term Collateral Agent may have been required to pay by reason of the Transaction Liens or to free any Collateral from any other Lien thereon;

(ii) the amount of any and all reasonable out-of-pocket expenses, including transfer taxes and reasonable fees and expenses of

 

26


counsel, professional advisors and other experts, that the Agent and the Authorized Term Collateral Agent may incur in connection with (x) the administration or enforcement of the Security Documents, including such expenses as are incurred to preserve the value of the Collateral or the validity, perfection, rank or value of any Transaction Lien, (y) the collection, sale or other disposition of any Collateral or (z) the exercise by the Agent and the Authorized Term Collateral Agent of any of its rights or powers under the Security Documents;

(iii) the amount of any fees that the Borrowers shall have agreed in writing to pay to the Agent and the Authorized Term Collateral Agent and that shall have become due and payable in accordance with such written agreement; and

(iv) the amount required to indemnify the Agent and the Authorized Term Collateral Agent and their directors, officers, agents, counsel and employees (collectively, the “ Indemnitees ”) for, or hold them harmless and defend them against, any loss, liability or expense (including the reasonable fees and expenses of their counsel, professional advisors and any experts or sub-agents appointed by them hereunder) incurred or suffered by the Indemnitees or any of them in connection with the Security Documents, except to the extent that such loss, liability or expense arises from the Agent’s or the Authorized Term Collateral Agent’s (as the case may be) gross negligence or willful misconduct or a breach of any duty that the Agent or the Authorized Term Collateral Agent (as the case may be) has under this Agreement (after giving effect to Sections 17 and 18), as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final and non-appealable decision.

Any such amount not paid to the Agent or the Authorized Term Collateral Agent on demand will bear interest for each day thereafter until paid at a rate per annum equal to the sum of 2% plus the rate applicable to Base Rate Loans for such day.

(b) If any transfer tax, documentary stamp tax or other tax is payable in connection with any transfer or other transaction provided for in the Security Documents, the US Borrower will pay such tax and provide any required tax stamps to the Agent and the Authorized Term Collateral Agent or as otherwise required by law.

SECTION 16 . Authority to Administer Collateral. Each Lien Grantor irrevocably appoints the Agent its true and lawful attorney, with full power of substitution, in the name of such Lien Grantor, any Secured Party or otherwise, for the sole use and benefit of the Secured Parties, but at the US Borrower’s expense, to the extent permitted by law to exercise, at any time and from time to

 

27


time while an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, all or any of the following powers with respect to all or any of such Lien Grantor’s Collateral:

(a) to demand, sue for, collect, receive and give acquittance for any and all monies due or to become due upon or by virtue thereof,

(b) to settle, compromise, compound, prosecute or defend any action or proceeding with respect thereto,

(c) to sell, lease, license or otherwise dispose of the same or the proceeds or avails thereof, as fully and effectually as if the Agent were the absolute owner thereof, and

(d) to extend the time of payment of any or all thereof and to make any allowance or other adjustment with reference thereto;

provided that, except in the case of Personal Property Collateral that is perishable or threatens to decline speedily in value or is of a type customarily sold on a recognized market, the Agent will give the relevant Lien Grantor at least ten days’ prior written notice of the time and place of any public sale thereof or the time after which any private sale or other intended disposition thereof will be made. Any such notice shall (i) contain the information specified in UCC Section 9-613, (ii) be Authenticated and (iii) be sent to the parties required to be notified pursuant to UCC Section 9-611(c); provided that, if the Agent fails to comply with this sentence in any respect, its liability for such failure shall be limited to the liability (if any) imposed on it as a matter of law under the UCC.

SECTION 17 . Limitation on Duty in Respect of Collateral. Beyond the exercise of reasonable care in the custody and preservation thereof, the Agent will have no duty as to any Collateral in its possession or control or in the possession or control of any sub-agent or bailee or any income therefrom or as to the preservation of rights against prior parties or any other rights pertaining thereto. The Agent will be deemed to have exercised reasonable care in the custody and preservation of the Collateral in its possession or control if such Collateral is accorded treatment substantially equal to that which it accords its own property, and will not be liable or responsible for any loss or damage to any Collateral, or for any diminution in the value thereof, by reason of any act or omission of any sub-agent or bailee selected by the Agent in good faith, except to the extent that such liability arises from the Agent’s gross negligence or willful misconduct, as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final and non-appealable decision.

SECTION 18 . General Provisions Concerning the Agent.

 

28


(a) The provisions of Article 8 of the Loan Agreement shall inure to the benefit of the Agent, and shall be binding upon all Lien Grantors and all Secured Parties, in connection with this Agreement and the other Security Documents. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, (i) the Agent shall not be subject to any fiduciary or other implied duties, regardless of whether an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, (ii) the Agent shall not have any duty to take any discretionary action or exercise any discretionary powers, except discretionary rights and powers expressly contemplated by the Security Documents that the Agent is required in writing to exercise by the Required Lenders (or such other number or percentage of the Lenders as shall be necessary under the circumstances as provided in Section 10.09 of the Loan Agreement), and (iii) except as expressly set forth in the Loan Documents, the Agent shall not have any duty to disclose, and shall not be liable for any failure to disclose, any information relating to any Group Member that is communicated to or obtained by the Agent or any of its Affiliates in any capacity. The Agent shall not be responsible for the existence, genuineness or value of any Collateral or for the validity, perfection, continuation, priority or enforceability of any Transaction Lien, including without limitation the filing, form, content or renewal of UCC financing statements, Mortgages or similar documents or instruments, whether impaired by operation of law or by reason of any action or omission to act on its part under the Security Documents. The Agent shall be deemed not to have knowledge of any Event of Default unless and until written notice thereof is given to the Agent by a Lien Grantor or a Secured Party.

(b) Sub-Agents and Related Parties . The Agent may perform any of its duties and exercise any of its rights and powers through one or more sub-agents appointed by it and shall not be responsible for the negligence of such sub-agents appointed with reasonable care. The Agent and any such sub-agent may perform any of its duties and exercise any of its rights and powers through its Related Parties. The exculpatory provisions of Section 17 and this Section shall apply to any such sub-agent and to the Related Parties of the Agent and any such sub-agent.

(c) Information as to Secured Obligations and Actions by Secured Parties. For all purposes of the Security Documents, including determining the amounts of the Secured Obligations and whether a Secured Obligation is a Contingent Secured Obligation or not, or whether any action has been taken under any Secured Agreement, the Agent will be entitled to rely on information from (i) its own records for information as to the Lenders, the Issuing Lender, their Secured Obligations and actions taken by them, (ii) any Secured Party for information as to its Secured Obligations and actions taken by it, to the extent that the Agent has not obtained such information from its own records, and (iii) the Borrowers, to the extent that the Agent has not obtained information from the foregoing sources.

 

29


(d) Refusal to Act. The Agent may refuse to act on any notice, consent, direction or instruction from any Secured Parties or any agent, trustee or similar representative thereof that, in the Agent’s opinion, (i) is contrary to law or the provisions of any Security Document, (ii) may expose the Agent to liability (unless the Agent shall have been indemnified, to its reasonable satisfaction, for such liability by the Secured Parties that gave such notice, consent, direction or instruction) or (iii) is unduly prejudicial to Secured Parties not joining in such notice, consent, direction or instruction.

SECTION 19 . Termination of Transaction Liens; Release of Collateral. (a) The Transaction Liens granted by each Guarantor shall terminate when its Transaction Guarantee terminates in accordance with the Loan Agreement.

(b) The Transaction Liens shall terminate when all the Release Conditions are satisfied; provided , that if at any time any payment of a Secured Obligation is rescinded or must be otherwise restored or returned upon the insolvency or receivership of either Borrower or otherwise, the Transaction Liens shall be reinstated.

(c) At any time before the Transaction Liens terminate, the Agent may, at the written request of either of the Borrowers, release any Collateral (but not all or substantially all the Collateral) with the prior written consent of the Required Lenders.

(d) Upon any termination of a Transaction Lien or release of Collateral, the Agent will, at the expense of the relevant Lien Grantor, execute and deliver to such Lien Grantor such documents as such Lien Grantor shall reasonably request to evidence the termination of such Transaction Lien or the release of such Collateral, as the case may be.

SECTION 20 . Additional Lien Grantors. Any Subsidiary may become a party hereto by signing and delivering to the Agent a Security Agreement Supplement, whereupon such Subsidiary shall become a “Lien Grantor” as defined herein.

SECTION 21 . Notices. Each notice, request or other communication given to any party hereunder shall be given or made in accordance with Section 10.01 of the Loan Agreement.

SECTION 22 . No Implied Waivers; Remedies Not Exclusive. No failure by the Agent or any Secured Party to exercise, and no delay in exercising and no course of dealing with respect to, any right or remedy under any Security Document shall operate as a waiver thereof; nor shall any single or partial exercise by the Agent or any Secured Party of any right or remedy under any

 

30


Loan Document preclude any other or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right or remedy. The rights and remedies specified in the Loan Documents are cumulative and are not exclusive of any other rights or remedies provided by law.

SECTION 23 . Successors and Assigns. This Agreement is for the benefit of the Agent and the Secured Parties. If all or any part of any Secured Party’s interest in any Secured Obligation is assigned or otherwise transferred in a transaction permitted under the Loan Agreement, the transferor’s rights hereunder, to the extent applicable to the obligation so transferred, shall be automatically transferred with such obligation. This Agreement shall be binding on the Lien Grantors and their respective successors and assigns.

SECTION 24 . Amendments and Waivers. Neither this Agreement nor any provision hereof may be waived, amended, modified or terminated except pursuant to an agreement or agreements in writing entered into by the Agent, with the consent of such Lenders as are required to consent thereto under Section 10.09 of the Loan Agreement. No such waiver, amendment or modification shall (i) be binding upon any Lien Grantor, except with the written consent of the Borrowers, or (ii) affect the rights of a Secured Party (other than a Lender) hereunder more adversely than it affects the comparable rights of the Lenders hereunder, without the consent of such Secured Party.

SECTION 25 . Choice of Law. This Agreement shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of New York, except as otherwise required by mandatory provisions of law and except to the extent that remedies provided by the laws of any jurisdiction other than the State of New York are governed by the laws of such jurisdiction.

SECTION 26 . Waiver of Jury Trial. EACH PARTY HERETO HEREBY IRREVOCABLY WAIVES ALL RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY IN ANY ACTION, PROCEEDING OR COUNTERCLAIM ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO ANY OF THE LOAN DOCUMENTS OR THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED THEREBY. EACH PARTY HERETO (A) CERTIFIES THAT NO REPRESENTATIVE, AGENT OR ATTORNEY OF ANY OTHER PARTY HAS REPRESENTED, EXPRESSLY OR OTHERWISE, THAT SUCH OTHER PARTY WOULD NOT, IN THE EVENT OF LITIGATION, SEEK TO ENFORCE THE FOREGOING WAIVER AND (B) ACKNOWLEDGES THAT IT AND THE OTHER PARTIES HERETO HAVE BEEN INDUCED TO ENTER INTO THIS AGREEMENT BY, AMONG OTHER THINGS, THE MUTUAL WAIVERS AND CERTIFICATIONS IN THIS SECTION.

 

31


SECTION 27 . Severability. Any provision of any Security Document held to be invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any jurisdiction shall, as to such jurisdiction, be ineffective to the extent of such invalidity, illegality or unenforceability without affecting the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions thereof; and the invalidity of a particular provision in a particular jurisdiction shall not invalidate such provision in any other jurisdiction.

SECTION 28 . Loan Agreement, Security Agreement. In the event of any conflict or inconsistency between the provisions of the Loan Agreement and this Agreement but subject to Section 30, the provisions of the Loan Agreement shall control. In the event of any conflict or inconsistency between the provisions of the other Security Documents and this Agreement but subject to Section 30, the provisions of this Agreement shall govern and control.

SECTION 29 . Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts by the parties hereto on separate counterparts, each of which, when so executed and delivered, shall be deemed an original, but all such counterparts shall together constitute one and the same instrument. Delivery of an executed counterpart of a signature page of this Agreement by telecopier or electronic image scan transmission (such as a “pdf” file) will be effective as delivery of a manually executed counterpart of this Agreement.

SECTION 30 Intercreditor Agreements. Reference is made to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement and the Term Intercreditor Agreement. Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, the lien and security interest granted to the Agent, for the benefit of the Secured Parties, pursuant to this Agreement and the exercise of any right or remedy by the Agent and the other Secured Parties hereunder are subject to the provisions of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement and the Term Intercreditor Agreement. In the event of any conflict or inconsistency between the provisions of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement or the Term Intercreditor Agreement, on the one hand, and this Agreement, on the other hand, the provisions of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement or the Term Intercreditor Agreement, as applicable, shall control.

 

32


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Agreement to be duly executed by their respective authorized officers as of the day and year first above written.

 

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC,
as US Borrower and Guarantor with respect to the Secured Obligations of the European Loan Parties

By:  

/s/ Mark Malcolm

  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President and CEO
JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Agent
By:  

/s/ Mary E. Gherty

  Name:   Mary E. Gherty
  Title:   Managing Director

 


Guarantors:
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS I, LLC
By:  

/s/ Mark Malcolm

  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President and CEO

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS II(a), LLC

By:  

/s/ Mark Malcolm

  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President and CEO

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS II(b), LLC

By:  

/s/ Mark Malcolm

  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President and CEO

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS USA I, LLC

By:  

/s/ Mark Malcolm

  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President and CEO

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS USA II, LLC

By:  

/s/ Mark Malcolm

  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President and CEO

 


TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS USA III, LLC

By:  

/s/ Mark Malcolm

  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President and CEO

TA HOLDINGS FINANCE, INC.

By:  

/s/ Mark Malcolm

  Name:   Mark Malcolm
  Title:   President and CEO

 


SCHEDULE 1

EQUITY INTERESTS IN SUBSIDIARIES AND AFFILIATES

OWNED BY ORIGINAL LIEN GRANTORS

(as of the Closing Date)

 

Issuer

  

Jurisdiction

of

Organization

  

Owner of

Equity Interest

  

Percentage

Owned

  

Number of

Shares or

Units

           
           
           
           
           

 

S-1-1


SCHEDULE 2

INVESTMENT PROPERTY

(other than Equity Interests in Subsidiaries and Affiliates)

OWNED BY ORIGINAL LIEN GRANTORS

(as of the Closing Date)

PART 1 — Securities

 

Issuer

  

Jurisdiction

of

Organization

  

Owner of Securities

  

Amount

Owned

  

Type of

Security

           
           
           
           
           

PART 2 — Securities Accounts

The Original Lien Grantors own Security Entitlements with respect to Financial Assets credited to the following Securities Accounts:

 

Owner

  

Securities

Intermediary

  

Account Number

     
     
     
     
     

 

S-2-1


EXHIBIT A

to Security Agreement

SECURITY AGREEMENT SUPPLEMENT

SECURITY AGREEMENT SUPPLEMENT dated as of              ,              , between [NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR] (the “ Lien Grantor ”) and JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Agent.

WHEREAS, Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the Guarantors party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Agent, are parties to an Amended and Restated First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement dated as of August 24, 2010 (as heretofore amended and/or supplemented, the “ Security Agreement ”) under which Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC secures certain of its obligations (the “ Secured Obligations ”) and the Guarantors party thereto secure their respective guarantees of the Secured Obligations;

WHEREAS, [name of Lien Grantor] has executed a Joinder Agreement and become a Guarantor;

WHEREAS, [name of Lien Grantor] desires to become [is] a party to the Security Agreement as a Lien Grantor thereunder; 1 and

WHEREAS, terms defined in the Security Agreement (or whose definitions are incorporated by reference in Section 1 of the Security Agreement) and not otherwise defined herein have, as used herein, the respective meanings provided for therein;

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing and other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto agree as follows:

1. Grant of Transaction Liens . (a) In order to secure [its Transaction Guarantee] 2 [the Secured Obligations] 3 , the Lien Grantor grants to the Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties a continuing security interest in all the following

 

1 If the Lien Grantor is the Borrower, delete this recital and Section 1 hereof.
2 Delete bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is the Borrower.
3 Delete bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is a Guarantor.

 

A-1


property of the Lien Grantor, whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising and regardless of where located (the “ New Collateral ”):

[describe property being added to the Collateral] 4

(b) With respect to each right to payment or performance included in the Collateral from time to time, the Transaction Lien granted therein includes a continuing security interest in (i) any Supporting Obligation that supports such payment or performance and (ii) any Lien that (x) secures such right to payment or performance or (y) secures any such Supporting Obligation.

(c) The foregoing Transaction Liens are granted as security only and shall not subject the Agent or any other Secured Party to, or transfer or in any way affect or modify, any obligation or liability of the Lien Grantor with respect to any of the New Collateral or any transaction in connection therewith.

2. Delivery of Collateral . Concurrently with delivering this Security Agreement Supplement to the Agent, the Lien Grantor is complying with the provisions of Section 7 of the Security Agreement with respect to Investment Property, in each case if and to the extent included in the New Collateral at such time.

3. Party to Security Agreement . Upon delivering this Security Agreement Supplement to the Agent, the Lien Grantor will become a party to the Security Agreement and will thereafter have all the rights and obligations of a Guarantor and a Lien Grantor thereunder and be bound by all the provisions thereof as fully as if the Lien Grantor were one of the original parties thereto. 5

4. Address of Lien Grantor . The address, facsimile number and e-mail address of the Lien Grantor are:

[address, facsimile number and e-mail address of Lien Grantor]

 

4

If the Lien Grantor is not already a party to the Security Agreement, clauses (i) through (xi) of, and the proviso to, Section 2(a) of the Security Agreement may be appropriate.

5

Delete Section 3 if the Lien Grantor is already a party to the Security Agreement.

 

A-2


5. Representations and Warranties . (a) The Lien Grantor is duly organized, validly existing and in good standing under the laws of [jurisdiction of organization].

(b) The Lien Grantor has delivered a Perfection Certificate to the Agent. The information set forth therein is correct and complete as of the date hereof.

(c) The execution and delivery of this Security Agreement Supplement by the Lien Grantor and the performance by it of its obligations under the Security Agreement as supplemented hereby are within its corporate or other powers, have been duly authorized by all necessary corporate or other action, require no action by or in respect of, or filing with, any governmental body, agency or official and do not contravene, or constitute a default under, any provision of applicable law or regulation or of its organizational documents, or of any agreement, judgment, injunction, order, decree or other instrument binding upon it or result in the creation or imposition of any Lien (except a Transaction Lien) on any of its assets.

(d) The Security Agreement as supplemented hereby constitutes a valid and binding agreement of the Lien Grantor, enforceable in accordance with its terms, except as limited by (i) applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, fraudulent conveyance or other similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally and (ii) general principles of equity.

(e) Each of the representations and warranties set forth in Sections 3 through 11 of the Security Agreement is true as applied to the Lien Grantor and the New Collateral. For purposes of the foregoing sentence, references in said Sections to a “Lien Grantor” shall be deemed to refer to the Lien Grantor, references to Schedules to the Security Agreement shall be deemed to refer to the corresponding Schedules to this Security Agreement Supplement, references to “Collateral” shall be deemed to refer to the New Collateral, and references to the “Closing Date” shall be deemed to refer to the date on which the Lien Grantor signs and delivers this Security Agreement Supplement.

6. [ Compliance with Foreign Law . The Lien Grantor represents that it has taken, and agrees that it will continue to take, all actions required under the laws (including the conflict of laws rules) of its jurisdiction of organization to

 

A-3


ensure that the Transaction Liens on the New Collateral rank prior to all Liens and rights of others therein. 6 ]

7. Governing Law . This Security Agreement Supplement shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of New York.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Security Agreement Supplement to be duly executed by their respective authorized officers as of the day and year first above written.

 

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Agent

By:

 

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

6

Include Section 6 if the Lien Grantor is organized under the laws of a jurisdiction outside the United States.

 

A-4


Schedule 1

to Security Agreement

Supplement

EQUITY INTERESTS IN SUBSIDIARIES AND AFFILIATES

OWNED BY LIEN GRANTOR

 

Issuer

  

Jurisdiction of

Organization

  

Percentage

Owned

  

Number of

Shares or Units

        
        
        
        
        

 

A-5


Schedule 2

to Security Agreement

Supplement

INVESTMENT PROPERTY

(other than Equity Interests in Subsidiaries and Affiliates)

OWNED BY LIEN GRANTOR

PART 1 — Securities

 

Issuer

  

Jurisdiction

of

Organization

  

Amount

Owned

  

Type of

Security

        
        
        
        
        

PART 2 — Securities Accounts

The Lien Grantor owns Security Entitlements with respect to Financial Assets credited to the following Securities Accounts:

 

Securities Intermediary

   Account Number
  
  
  
  
  

 

A-6


EXHIBIT B

to Security Agreement

COPYRIGHT SECURITY AGREEMENT

(Copyrights, Copyright Registrations, Copyright

Applications and Copyright Licenses)

WHEREAS, [name of Lien Grantor], a                      corporation 1 (herein referred to as the “ Lien Grantor ”) owns, or in the case of licenses is a party to, the Copyright Collateral (as defined below);

WHEREAS, Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC (the “ Borrower ”), Tower Automotive Holdings Europe B.V., Tower Automotive, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(a), LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(b), LLC, the other guarantors and lenders party thereto, and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent, are parties to a First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement dated as of July 31, 2007 (as amended, the “ Loan Agreement ”); and

WHEREAS, pursuant to (i) a First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement dated as of July 31, 2007 (as amended and/or supplemented from time to time, the “ Security Agreement ”) among the Borrower, the guarantors party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent for the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, together with its successors in such capacity, the “ Grantee ”), and (ii) certain other loan documents (including this Copyright Security Agreement), the Lien Grantor has [secured certain of its obligations (the “ Secured Obligations ”)] 2 [guaranteed certain obligations of the Borrower and secured such guarantee (the “ Lien Grantor’s Transaction Guarantee ”)] 3 by granting to the Grantee for the benefit of such Secured Parties a continuing security interest in personal property of the Lien Grantor, including all right, title and interest of the Lien Grantor in, to and under the Copyright Collateral (as defined below);

 

1

Modify as needed if the Lien Grantor is not a corporation.

2

Delete these bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is a Guarantor.

3

Delete these bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is the Borrower.

 

B-1


NOW, THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the Lien Grantor grants to the Grantee, to secure the [Secured Obligations] [Lien Grantor’s Transaction Guarantee], a continuing security interest in all of the Lien Grantor’s right, title and interest in, to and under the following (all of the following items or types of property being herein collectively referred to as the “ Copyright Collateral ”), whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising:

(i) each Copyright (as defined in the Security Agreement) owned by the Lien Grantor, including, without limitation, each Copyright registration or application therefor referred to in Schedule 1 hereto;

(ii) each Copyright License (as defined in the Security Agreement) to which the Lien Grantor is a party, including, without limitation, each Copyright License identified in Schedule 1 hereto; and

(iii) all proceeds of, revenues from, and accounts and general intangibles arising out of, the foregoing, including, without limitation, all proceeds of and revenues from any claim by the Lien Grantor against third parties for past, present or future infringement of any Copyright (including, without limitation, any Copyright owned by the Lien Grantor and identified in Schedule 1), and all rights and benefits of the Lien Grantor under any Copyright License (including, without limitation, any Copyright License identified in Schedule 1).

The Lien Grantor irrevocably constitutes and appoints the Grantee and any officer or agent thereof, with full power of substitution, as its true and lawful attorney-in-fact with full power and authority in the name of the Lien Grantor or in the Grantee’s name, from time to time, in the Grantee’s discretion, so long as any Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, to take with respect to the Copyright Collateral any and all appropriate action which the Lien Grantor might take with respect to the Copyright Collateral and to execute any and all documents and instruments which may be necessary or desirable to carry out the terms of this Copyright Security Agreement and to accomplish the purposes hereof.

Except to the extent expressly permitted in the Security Agreement or the Loan Agreement, the Lien Grantor agrees not to sell, license, exchange, assign or otherwise transfer or dispose of, or grant any rights with respect to, or mortgage or otherwise encumber, any of the Copyright Collateral.

The foregoing security interest is granted in conjunction with the security interests granted by the Lien Grantor to the Grantee pursuant to the Security Agreement. The Lien Grantor acknowledges and affirms that the rights and

 

B-2


remedies of the Grantee with respect to the security interest in the Copyright Collateral granted hereby are more fully set forth in the Security Agreement, the terms and provisions of which are incorporated by reference herein as if fully set forth herein.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Lien Grantor has caused this Copyright Security Agreement to be duly executed by its officer thereunto duly authorized as of the      day of              ,      .

 

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

Acknowledged:

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,

as Agent

By:

 

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

B-3


STATE OF                         )  
    )ss.:
COUNTY OF                    )  

I,                                          , a Notary Public in and for said County, in the State aforesaid, DO HEREBY CERTIFY, that                                  ,                          of [NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR] (the “ Company ”), personally known to me to be the same person whose name is subscribed to the foregoing instrument as such                              , appeared before me this day in person and acknowledged that (s)he signed, executed and delivered the said instrument as her/his own free and voluntary act and as the free and voluntary act of said Company, for the uses and purposes therein set forth being duly authorized so to do.

GIVEN under my hand and Notarial Seal this      day of              ,      .

[Seal]

 

 

Signature of notary public
My Commission expires                     

 

B-4


Schedule 1

to Copyright

Security Agreement

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]

COPYRIGHT REGISTRATIONS

 

Registration No.

  

Registration Date

  

Title

  

Expiration

Date

        
        
        
        
        

COPYRIGHT APPLICATIONS

 

Case No.

  

Serial No.

  

Country

  

Date

  

Filing Title

           
           
           
           
           

COPYRIGHT LICENSES

 

Name of

Agreement

  

Parties

Licensor/Licensee

  

Date of

Agreement

  

Subject

Matter

        
        
        
        
        

 

B-5


EXHIBIT C

to Security Agreement

PATENT SECURITY AGREEMENT

(Patents, Patent Applications and Patent Licenses)

WHEREAS, [name of Lien Grantor], a                      corporation 1 (herein referred to as the “ Lien Grantor ”) owns, or in the case of licenses is a party to, the Patent Collateral (as defined below);

WHEREAS, Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC (the “ Borrower ”), Tower Automotive Holdings Europe B.V., Tower Automotive, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(a), LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(b), LLC, the other guarantors and lenders party thereto, and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent, are parties to a First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement dated as of July 31, 2007 (as amended, the “ Loan Agreement ”); and

WHEREAS, pursuant to (i) a First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement dated as of July 31, 2007 (as amended and/or supplemented from time to time, the “ Security Agreement ”) among the Borrower, the guarantors party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent for the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, together with its successors in such capacity, the “ Grantee ”), and (ii) certain other loan documents (including this Patent Security Agreement), the Lien Grantor has [secured certain of its obligations (the “ Secured Obligations ”)] 2 [guaranteed certain obligations of the Borrower and secured such guarantee (the “ Lien Grantor’s Transaction Guarantee ”)] 3 by granting to the Grantee for the benefit of such Secured Parties a continuing security interest in personal property of the Lien Grantor, including all right, title and interest of the Lien Grantor in, to and under the Patent Collateral (as defined below);

NOW, THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the Lien Grantor grants to the Grantee, to secure the [Secured Obligations] [Lien Grantor’s Transaction

 

1 Modify as needed if the Lien Grantor is not a corporation.
2 Delete these bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is a Guarantor.
3 Delete these bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is the Borrower.

 

C-1


Guarantee], a continuing security interest in all of the Lien Grantor’s right, title and interest in, to and under the following (all of the following items or types of property being herein collectively referred to as the “ Patent Collateral ”), whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising:

(i) each Patent (as defined in the Security Agreement) owned by the Lien Grantor, including, without limitation, each Patent referred to in Schedule 1 hereto;

(ii) each Patent License (as defined in the Security Agreement) to which the Lien Grantor is a party, including, without limitation, each Patent License identified in Schedule 1 hereto; and

(iii) all proceeds of and revenues from the foregoing, including, without limitation, all proceeds of and revenues from any claim by the Lien Grantor against third parties for past, present or future infringement of any Patent owned by the Lien Grantor (including, without limitation, any Patent identified in Schedule 1 hereto) and all rights and benefits of the Lien Grantor under any Patent License (including, without limitation, any Patent License identified in Schedule 1 hereto).

The Lien Grantor irrevocably constitutes and appoints the Grantee and any officer or agent thereof, with full power of substitution, as its true and lawful attorney-in-fact with full power and authority in the name of the Lien Grantor or in the Grantee’s name, from time to time, in the Grantee’s discretion, so long as any Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, to take with respect to the Patent Collateral any and all appropriate action which the Lien Grantor might take with respect to the Patent Collateral and to execute any and all documents and instruments which may be necessary or desirable to carry out the terms of this Patent Security Agreement and to accomplish the purposes hereof.

Except to the extent expressly permitted in the Security Agreement or the Loan Agreement, the Lien Grantor agrees not to sell, license, exchange, assign or otherwise transfer or dispose of, or grant any rights with respect to, or mortgage or otherwise encumber, any of the Patent Collateral.

The foregoing security interest is granted in conjunction with the security interests granted by the Lien Grantor to the Grantee pursuant to the Security Agreement. The Lien Grantor acknowledges and affirms that the rights and remedies of the Grantee with respect to the security interest in the Patent Collateral granted hereby are more fully set forth in the Security Agreement, the terms and provisions of which are incorporated by reference herein as if fully set forth herein.

 

C-2


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Lien Grantor has caused this Patent Security Agreement to be duly executed by its officer thereunto duly authorized as of the      day of              ,      .

 

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

Acknowledged:
JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Agent

By:

 

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

C-3


STATE OF                         )  
    )ss.:
COUNTY OF                    )  

I,                                          , a Notary Public in and for said County, in the State aforesaid, DO HEREBY CERTIFY, that                                  ,                          of [NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR] (the “ Company ”), personally known to me to be the same person whose name is subscribed to the foregoing instrument as such                              , appeared before me this day in person and acknowledged that (s)he signed, executed and delivered the said instrument as her/his own free and voluntary act and as the free and voluntary act of said Company, for the uses and purposes therein set forth being duly authorized so to do.

GIVEN under my hand and Notarial Seal this      day of              ,      .

[Seal]

 

 

Signature of notary public
My Commission expires                     

 

C-4


Schedule 1

to Patent

Security Agreement

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]

PATENTS AND DESIGN PATENTS

 

Patent No.

  

Issued

  

Expiration

  

Country

  

Title

           
           
           
           
           

PATENT APPLICATIONS

 

Case No.

  

Serial No.

  

Country

  

Date

  

Filing Title

           
           
           
           
           

PATENT LICENSES

 

Name of

Agreement

  

Parties

Licensor/Licensee

  

Date of

Agreement

  

Subject

Matter

        
        
        
        
        

 

C-5


EXHIBIT D

to Security Agreement

TRADEMARK SECURITY AGREEMENT

(Trademarks, Trademark Registrations, Trademark

Applications and Trademark Licenses)

WHEREAS, [name of Lien Grantor], a                      corporation 1 (herein referred to as the “ Lien Grantor ”) owns, or in the case of licenses is a party to, the Trademark Collateral (as defined below);

WHEREAS, Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC (the “ Borrower ”), Tower Automotive Holdings Europe B.V., Tower Automotive, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(a), LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(b), LLC, the other guarantors and lenders party thereto, and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent, are parties to a First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement dated as of July 31, 2007 (as amended from time to time, the “ Loan Agreement ”); and

WHEREAS, pursuant to (i) a First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement dated as of July 31, 2007 (as amended and/or supplemented from time to time, the “ Security Agreement ”) among the Borrower, the guarantors party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as agent for the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, together with its successors in such capacity, the “ Grantee ”), and (ii) certain other loan documents (including this Trademark Security Agreement), the Lien Grantor has [secured certain of its obligations (the “ Secured Obligations ”)] 2 [guaranteed certain obligations of the Borrower and secured such guarantee (the “ Lien Grantor’s Transaction Guarantee ”)] 3 by granting to the Grantee for the benefit of such Secured Parties a continuing security interest in personal property of the Lien Grantor, including all right, title and interest of the Lien Grantor in, to and under the Trademark Collateral (as defined below);

 

1

Modify as needed if the Lien Grantor is not a corporation.

2

Delete these bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is a Guarantor.

3

Delete these bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is the Borrower.

 

D-1


NOW, THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the Lien Grantor grants to the Grantee, to secure the [Secured Obligations] [Lien Grantor’s Transaction Guarantee], a continuing security interest in all of the Lien Grantor’s right, title and interest in, to and under the following (all of the following items or types of property being herein collectively referred to as the “ Trademark Collateral ”), whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising:

(i) each Trademark (as defined in the Security Agreement) owned by the Lien Grantor, including, without limitation, each Trademark registration and application referred to in Schedule 1 hereto, and all of the goodwill of the business connected with the use of, or symbolized by, each Trademark (provided that no security interest shall be granted in the United States intent-to-use trademark applications to the extent that, and solely during the period in which, the grant of a security interest therein would impair the validity or enforceability of such intent-to-use trademark applications under applicable federal law);

(ii) each Trademark License (as defined in the Security Agreement) to which the Lien Grantor is a party, including, without limitation, each Trademark License identified in Schedule 1 hereto, and all of the goodwill of the business connected with the use of, or symbolized by, each Trademark licensed pursuant thereto; and

(iii) all proceeds of and revenues from the foregoing, including, without limitation, all proceeds of and revenues from any claim by the Lien Grantor against third parties for past, present or future unfair competition with, or violation of intellectual property rights in connection with or injury to, or infringement or dilution of, any Trademark owned by the Lien Grantor (including, without limitation, any Trademark identified in Schedule 1 hereto), and all rights and benefits of the Lien Grantor under any Trademark License (including, without limitation, any Trademark License identified in Schedule 1 hereto), or for injury to the goodwill associated with any of the foregoing.

The Lien Grantor irrevocably constitutes and appoints the Grantee and any officer or agent thereof, with full power of substitution, as its true and lawful attorney-in-fact with full power and authority in the name of the Lien Grantor or in the Grantee’s name, from time to time, in the Grantee’s discretion, so long as any Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, to take with respect to the Trademark Collateral any and all appropriate action which the Lien Grantor might take with respect to the Trademark Collateral and to execute any and all documents and instruments which may be necessary or desirable to carry out the

 

D-2


terms of this Trademark Security Agreement and to accomplish the purposes hereof.

Except to the extent expressly permitted in the Security Agreement or the Loan Agreement, the Lien Grantor agrees not to sell, license, exchange, assign or otherwise transfer or dispose of, or grant any rights with respect to, or mortgage or otherwise encumber, any of the Trademark Collateral.

The foregoing security interest is granted in conjunction with the security interests granted by the Lien Grantor to the Grantee pursuant to the Security Agreement. The Lien Grantor acknowledges and affirms that the rights and remedies of the Grantee with respect to the security interest in the Trademark Collateral granted hereby are more fully set forth in the Security Agreement, the terms and provisions of which are incorporated by reference herein as if fully set forth herein.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Lien Grantor has caused this Trademark Security Agreement to be duly executed by its officer thereunto duly authorized as of the      day of              ,      .

 

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

Acknowledged:

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,

as Agent

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

D-3


STATE OF                         )  
    )ss.:
COUNTY OF                    )  

I,                                          , a Notary Public in and for said County, in the State aforesaid, DO HEREBY CERTIFY, that                                  ,                          of [NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR] (the “ Company ”), personally known to me to be the same person whose name is subscribed to the foregoing instrument as such                              , appeared before me this day in person and acknowledged that (s)he signed, executed and delivered the said instrument as her/his own free and voluntary act and as the free and voluntary act of said Company, for the uses and purposes therein set forth being duly authorized so to do.

GIVEN under my hand and Notarial Seal this      day of              ,      .

[Seal]

 

 

Signature of notary public
My Commission expires                     

 

D-4


Schedule 1

to Trademark

Security Agreement

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]

U.S. TRADEMARK REGISTRATIONS

 

TRADEMARK

   REG. NO.    REG. DATE
     
     
     
     
     

U.S. TRADEMARK APPLICATIONS

 

TRADEMARK

   REG. NO.    REG. DATE
     
     
     
     
     

 

D-5


TRADEMARK LICENSES

 

Name of

Agreement

  

Parties

Licensor/Licensee

  

Date of

Agreement

  

Subject

Matter

        
        
        
        
        

 

D-6


EXHIBIT E

to Security Agreement

PERFECTION CERTIFICATE

The undersigned is a duly authorized officer of [NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR] (the “ Lien Grantor ”). With reference to the Amended and Restated First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement dated as of August 24, 2010 among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, the other Lien Grantors party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Agent (terms defined therein being used herein as therein defined), the undersigned certifies to the Agent and each other Secured Party as follows:

A. Information Required for Filings and Searches for Prior Filings. 2

1. Jurisdiction of Organization . The Lien Grantor is a [corporation] 3 organized under the laws of                      .

2. Name . The exact [corporate] name of the Lien Grantor as it appears in its [certificate of incorporation] is as follows:

3. Prior Names; Predecessors . (a) Set forth below is each other [corporate] name that the Lien Grantor has had since its organization, together with the date of the relevant change:

(b) Except as set forth in Schedule      hereto, the Lien Grantor has not changed its corporate structure 4 in any way within the past five years.

(c) None of the Lien Grantor’s Collateral was acquired from another Person within the past five years, except

(i) property sold to the Lien Grantor by another Person in the ordinary course of such other Person’s business;

(ii) property with respect to which the Transaction Liens are to be perfected by taking possession or control thereof;

(iii) property acquired in transactions described in Schedule      hereto; and

 

E-1


(iv) other property having an aggregate fair market value not exceeding $              .

4. Organizational ID Number . Set forth below is the Organizational Identification Number, if any, issued by the jurisdiction of organization of the Lien Grantor.

5. Taxpayer ID Number . Set forth below is the Federal Taxpayer Identification Number of the Lien Grantor: [only necessary for filing in North Dakota and South Dakota.]

6. Chief Executive Office . The chief executive office of the Lien Grantor (or its place of business if there is only one) is located at the address set forth below:

 

Mailing Address

   County    State
     
     
     
     
     

B. Search Reports.

Attached hereto as Schedule      is a true copy of a file search report from the central UCC filing office in each jurisdiction identified in Part A–4 above with respect to each name set forth in Part A–2 and Part A–3 above (searches in local filing offices, if any, are not required). Attached hereto as Schedule      is a true copy of each financing statement or other filing identified in such file search reports.

C. Absence of Certain Property.

The Lien Grantor does not own any assets of material value which constitute commercial tort claims, farm products, electronic chattel paper, letter-of-credit rights which are not supporting obligations or as-extracted collateral, as each of the foregoing terms is defined in the UCC.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, I have hereunto set my hand this      day of              ,      .

 

 

Name:

Title:

 

E-2


EXHIBIT F

to Security Agreement

ISSUER CONTROL AGREEMENT

ISSUER CONTROL AGREEMENT dated as of              ,              among                          (the “ Lien Grantor ”), WILMINGTON TRUST FSB, as Collateral Agent (the “ Secured Party ”), and                      (the “ Issuer ”). All references herein to the “ UCC ” refer to the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in [Issuer’s jurisdiction of incorporation].

W I T N E S S E T H :

WHEREAS, the Lien Grantor is the registered holder of [specify Pledged Uncertificated Securities issued by the Issuer] issued by the Issuer (the “ Securities ”);

WHEREAS, pursuant to (i) an Amended and Restated ABL Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ ABL Security Agreement ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, as borrower (the “ Borrower ”), the guarantors party thereto including the Lien Grantor (the “ Guarantors ”) and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., acting as agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ Agent ”), (ii) an Amended and Restated First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Borrower, the Guarantors and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., acting as agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ First Lien Term Loan Agent ” and (iii) a Notes Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ Notes Security Agreement ” and, together with the ABL Security Agreement and the First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement, the “ Security Agreements ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc. (collectively, the “ Issuers ”), the Subsidiary Guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, acting as collateral agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ Collateral Agent ”, together with the Agent and the First Lien Term Loan Agent, the “ Agents ”), the Lien Grantor has granted to the Agents, for the benefit of the Secured Parties (as defined in each of the Security Agreements), a continuing security interest (the “ Transaction Lien ”) in all right, title and interest of the Lien Grantor in, to and under the Securities, whether now existing or hereafter arising; and

 

F-1


WHEREAS, the Agents, the Borrower, the Issuers and certain other parties are parties to an Amended and Restated Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, pursuant to which the Collateral Agent is to enter into this Agreement for the benefit of the Secured Parties (as defined in each of the Security Agreements) in order to perfect the Transaction Lien on the Securities;

NOW, THEREFORE, the parties hereto agree as follows:

Section 1. Nature of Securities. The Issuer confirms that (i) the Securities are “uncertificated securities” (as defined in Section 8-102 of the UCC) and (ii) the Lien Grantor is registered on the books of the Issuer as the registered holder of the Securities.

Section 2. Instructions. The Issuer agrees to comply with any “instruction” (as defined in Section 8-102 of the UCC) originated by the Secured Party and relating to the Securities without further consent by the Lien Grantor or any other person. The Lien Grantor consents to the foregoing agreement by the Issuer.

Section 3. Waiver of Lien; Waiver of Set-off. The Issuer waives any security interest, lien or right of set-off that it may now have or hereafter acquire in or with respect to the Securities. The Issuer’s obligations in respect of the Securities will not be subject to deduction, set-off or any other right in favor of any person other than the Secured Party.

Section 4. Choice of Law. This Agreement shall be governed by the laws of [Issuer’s jurisdiction of incorporation].

Section 5. Conflict with Other Agreements. There is no agreement (except this Agreement) between the Issuer and the Lien Grantor with respect to the Securities [except for [identify any existing other agreements] (the “ Existing Other Agreements ”)]. In the event of any conflict between this Agreement (or any portion hereof) and any other agreement [(including any Existing Other Agreement)] between the Issuer and the Lien Grantor with respect to the Securities, whether now existing or hereafter entered into, the terms of this Agreement shall prevail.

Section 6. Amendments. No amendment or modification of this Agreement or waiver of any right hereunder shall be binding on any party hereto unless it is in writing and is signed by all the parties hereto.

Section 7. Notice of Adverse Claims. Except for the claims and interests of the Secured Party and the Lien Grantor in the Securities, the Issuer does not know of any claim to, or interest in, the Securities. If any person asserts any lien,

 

F-2


encumbrance or adverse claim (including any writ, garnishment, judgment, attachment, execution or similar process) against the Securities, the Issuer will promptly notify the Secured Party and the Lien Grantor thereof.

Section 8. Maintenance of Securities. In addition to, and not in lieu of, the obligation of the Issuer to honor instructions as agreed in Section 2 hereof, the Issuer agrees as follows:

(i) Lien Grantor Instructions; Notice of Exclusive Control. So long as the Issuer has not received a Notice of Exclusive Control (as defined below), the Issuer may comply with instructions of the Lien Grantor or any duly authorized agent of the Lien Grantor in respect of the Securities. After the Issuer receives a written notice from the Secured Party that it is exercising exclusive control over the Securities (a “ Notice of Exclusive Control ”), the Issuer will cease complying with instructions of the Lien Grantor or any of its agents.

(ii) Non-Cash Dividends and Distributions. After the receipt of a Notice of Exclusive Control, the Issuer shall deliver to the Secured Party all dividends, interest and other distributions paid or made upon or with respect to the Securities.

(iii) Voting Rights. Until the Issuer receives a Notice of Exclusive Control, the Lien Grantor shall be entitled to direct the Issuer with respect to voting the Securities.

(iv) Statements and Confirmations. The Issuer will promptly send copies of all statements and other correspondence concerning the Securities simultaneously to each of the Lien Grantor and the Secured Party at their respective addresses specified in Section 11 hereof.

(v) Tax Reporting. All items of income, gain, expense and loss recognized in respect of the Securities shall be reported to the Internal Revenue Service and all state and local taxing authorities under the name and taxpayer identification number of the Lien Grantor.

Section 9. Representations, Warranties and Covenants of the Issuer. The Issuer makes the following representations, warranties and covenants:

(i) This Agreement is a valid and binding agreement of the Issuer enforceable in accordance with its terms.

(ii) The Issuer has not entered into, and until the termination of this Agreement will not enter into, any agreement with any other person relating to the Securities pursuant to which it has agreed, or will agree, to

 

F-3


comply with instructions (as defined in Section 8-102 of the UCC) of such person. The Issuer has not entered into any other agreement with the Lien Grantor or the Secured Party purporting to limit or condition the obligation of the Issuer to comply with instructions as agreed in Section 2 hereof.

Section 10. Successors. This Agreement shall be binding upon, and shall inure to the benefit of, the parties hereto and their respective successors and assigns.

Section 11. Notices. Each notice, request or other communication given to any party hereunder shall be in writing (which term includes facsimile or other electronic transmission) and shall be effective (i) when delivered to such party at its address specified below, (ii) when sent to such party by facsimile or other electronic transmission, addressed to it at its facsimile number or electronic address specified below, and such party sends back an electronic confirmation of receipt or (iii) ten days after being sent to such party by certified or registered United States mail, addressed to it at its address specified below, with first class or airmail postage prepaid:

Lien Grantor:

Secured Party:

Issuer:

Any party may change its address, facsimile number and/or e-mail address for purposes of this Section by giving notice of such change to the other parties in the manner specified above.

Section 12. Termination. The rights and powers granted herein to the Secured Party (i) have been granted in order to perfect the Transaction Lien, (ii) are powers coupled with an interest and (iii) will not be affected by any bankruptcy of the Lien Grantor or any lapse of time. The obligations of the Issuer hereunder shall continue in effect until the Secured Party has notified the Issuer in writing that the Transaction Lien has been terminated pursuant to the Security Agreement.

Section 13. Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts, all of which shall constitute one and the same instrument, and any party hereto may execute this Agreement by signing and delivering one or more counterparts.

 

F-4


[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB,

as Collateral Agent

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
[NAME OF ISSUER]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

F-5


Exhibit A

[Letterhead of Secured Party]

[Date]

[Name and Address of Issuer]

Attention:                                                              

 

  Re: Notice of Exclusive Control

Ladies and Gentlemen:

As referenced in the Issuer Control Agreement dated as of              ,              among [name of Lien Grantor], us and you (a copy of which is attached), we notify you that we will hereafter exercise exclusive control over [specify Pledged Uncertificated Securities] registered in the name of [name of Lien Grantor] (the “ Securities ”). You are instructed not to accept any directions or instructions with respect to the Securities from any person other than the undersigned unless otherwise ordered by a court of competent jurisdiction.

You are instructed to deliver a copy of this notice by facsimile transmission to [name of Lien Grantor].

Very truly yours,

 

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB,

as Collateral Agent

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

cc: [name of Lien Grantor]

 

F-6


EXHIBIT G

to Security Agreement

SECURITIES ACCOUNT CONTROL AGREEMENT

SECURITIES ACCOUNT CONTROL AGREEMENT dated as of              ,              among                          (the “ Lien Grantor ”), JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Agent (the “ Secured Party ”), and                          (the “ Securities Intermediary ”). All references herein to the “ UCC ” refer to the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in the State of New York. Terms defined in the UCC have the same meanings when used herein.

W I T N E S S E T H :

WHEREAS, the Lien Grantor is the entitlement holder with respect to the Account (as defined below);

WHEREAS, pursuant to (i) an Amended and Restated ABL Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ ABL Security Agreement ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, as borrower (the “ Borrower ”), the guarantors party thereto including the Lien Grantor (the “ Guarantors ”) and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., acting as agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ Agent ”), (ii) an Amended and Restated First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Borrower, the Guarantors and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., acting as agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ First Lien Term Loan Agent ” and (iii) a Notes Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ Notes Security Agreement ” and, together with the ABL Security Agreement and the First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement, the “ Security Agreements ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc. (collectively, the “ Issuers ”), the Subsidiary Guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, acting as collateral agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ Collateral Agent ”, together with the Agent and the First Lien Term Loan Agent, the “ Agents ”), the Lien Grantor has granted to the Agents, for the benefit of the Secured Parties (as defined in each of the Security Agreements), a continuing security interest (the “ Transaction Lien ”) in all right, title and interest of the Lien Grantor in, to and under the Account, all

 

G-1


financial assets credited thereto and all security entitlements in respect thereof, whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising; and

WHEREAS, the Agents, the Borrower, the Issuers and certain other parties are parties to an Amended and Restated Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, pursuant to which the Agent is to enter into this Agreement for the benefit of the Secured Parties (as defined in each of the Security Agreements) in order to perfect the Transaction Lien on the Account, all financial assets from time to time credited thereto and all security entitlements in respect thereof;

NOW, THEREFORE, the parties hereto agree as follows:

Section 1. Establishment of Account. The Securities Intermediary confirms that:

(i) the Securities Intermediary has established account number [identify account number] in the name of “[name of Lien Grantor]” (such account and any successor account, the “ Account ”),

(ii) the Account is a “securities account” as defined in Section 8-501 of the UCC,

(iii) the Securities Intermediary is acting as a “securities intermediary” (as defined in Section 8-102 of the UCC) in respect of the Account,

(iv) the Securities Intermediary shall, subject to the terms of this Agreement, treat the Lien Grantor as entitled to exercise the rights that comprise all financial assets from time to time credited to the Account,

(v) all property delivered to the Securities Intermediary by or on behalf of the Lien Grantor will be promptly credited to the Account, and

(vi) all financial assets (except cash) credited to the Account will be registered in the name of the Securities Intermediary, indorsed to the Securities Intermediary or in blank or credited to another securities account maintained in the name of the Securities Intermediary and in no case will any financial asset credited to the Account be registered in the name of the Lien Grantor, payable to the order of the Lien Grantor or specially indorsed to the Lien Grantor unless such financial asset has been further indorsed to the Securities Intermediary or in blank.

 

G-2


Section 2. “Financial Assets” Election. The parties hereto agree that each item of property (whether investment property, financial asset, security, instrument, cash or other property) credited to the Account shall be treated as a “financial asset” within the meaning of Sections 8-102(a)(9) and 8-103 of the UCC.

Section 3. Entitlement Orders. The Securities Intermediary agrees to comply with any “entitlement order” (as defined in Section 8-102 of the UCC) originated by the Secured Party and relating to the Account or any financial asset credited thereto without further consent by the Lien Grantor or any other person. The Lien Grantor consents to the foregoing agreement by the Securities Intermediary.

Section 4. Waiver of Lien; Waiver of Set-off. The Securities Intermediary waives any security interest, lien or right to make deductions or setoffs that it may now have or hereafter acquire in or with respect to the Account, any financial asset credited thereto or any security entitlement in respect thereof. Neither the financial assets credited to the Account nor the security entitlements in respect thereof will be subject to deduction, set-off, banker’s lien, or any other right in favor of any person other than the Secured Party [(except that the Securities Intermediary may set off (i) all amounts due to it in respect of its customary fees and expenses for the routine maintenance and operation of the Account and (ii) the face amount of any checks that have been credited to the Account but are subsequently returned unpaid because of uncollected or insufficient funds)].

Section 5. Choice of Law. This Agreement shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of New York]. The State of New York shall be deemed to be the Securities Intermediary’s jurisdiction for purposes of the UCC (including, without limitation, Section 8-110 thereof).

Section 6. Conflict with Other Agreements. There is no agreement (except this Agreement) between the Securities Intermediary and the Lien Grantor with respect to the Account [except for [identify any existing other agreements] (the “ Existing Other Agreements ”)]. In the event of any conflict between this Agreement (or any portion hereof) and any other agreement [(including any Existing Other Agreement)] between the Securities Intermediary and the Lien Grantor with respect to the Account, whether now existing or hereafter entered into, the terms of this Agreement shall prevail. [If any Existing Other Agreement does not specify that it is governed by the laws of [the jurisdiction specified in Section 5], such Existing Other Agreement is hereby amended to specify that it is governed by the laws of [the jurisdiction specified in Section 5].

 

G-3


Section 7. Amendments. No amendment or modification of this Agreement or waiver of any right hereunder shall be binding on any party hereto unless it is in writing and is signed by all the parties hereto.

Section 8. Notice of Adverse Claims. Except for the claims and interests of the Secured Party and the Lien Grantor, the Securities Intermediary does not know of any claim to, or interest in, the Account, any financial asset credited thereto or any security entitlement in respect thereof. If any person asserts any lien, encumbrance or adverse claim (including any writ, garnishment, judgment, attachment, execution or similar process) against the Account, any financial asset credited thereto or any security entitlement in respect thereof, the Securities Intermediary will promptly notify the Secured Party and the Lien Grantor thereof.

Section 9. Maintenance of Account. In addition to, and not in lieu of, the obligation of the Securities Intermediary to honor entitlement orders as agreed in Section 3 hereof, the Securities Intermediary agrees to maintain the Account as follows:

(i) Lien Grantor Entitlement Orders; Notice of Exclusive Control. So long as the Securities Intermediary has not received a Notice of Exclusive Control (as defined below), the Securities Intermediary may, subject to paragraph (iii) below, comply with entitlement orders of the Lien Grantor or any duly authorized agent of the Lien Grantor in respect of the Account and any or all financial assets credited thereto. After the Securities Intermediary receives a written notice from the Secured Party that is exercising exclusive control over the Account (a “ Notice of Exclusive Control ”), the Securities Intermediary will cease complying with entitlement orders of the Lien Grantor or any of its agents.

(ii) Voting Rights. Until the Securities Intermediary receives a Notice of Exclusive Control, the Lien Grantor shall be entitled to direct the Securities Intermediary with respect to the voting of any financial assets credited to the Account.

(iii) Permitted Investments. Until the Securities Intermediary receives a Notice of Exclusive Control, the Lien Grantor shall be entitled to direct the Securities Intermediary with respect to the selection of investments to be made and credited to the Account.

(iv) Statements and Confirmations. The Securities Intermediary will promptly send copies of all statements, confirmations and other correspondence concerning the Account and/or any financial assets credited thereto simultaneously to each of the Lien Grantor and the Secured Party at their respective addresses specified in Section 12 hereof.

 

G-4


(v) Tax Reporting. All items of income, gain, expense and loss recognized in the Account or in respect of any financial assets credited thereto shall be reported to the Internal Revenue Service and all state and local taxing authorities under the name and taxpayer identification number of the Lien Grantor.

Section 10. Representations, Warranties and Covenants of the Securities Intermediary. The Securities Intermediary makes the following representations, warranties and covenants:

(i) The Account has been established as set forth in Section 1 above and will be maintained in the manner set forth herein until this Agreement is terminated. The Securities Intermediary will not change the name or account number of the Account without the prior written consent of the Secured Party.

(ii) No financial asset credited to the Account is or will be registered in the name of the Lien Grantor, payable to the order of the Lien Grantor, or specially indorsed to the Lien Grantor, unless such financial asset has been further indorsed by the Lien Grantor to the Securities Intermediary or in blank.

(iii) This Agreement is a valid and binding agreement of the Securities Intermediary enforceable in accordance with its terms.

(iv) The Securities Intermediary has not entered into, and until the termination of this Agreement will not enter into, any agreement with any person (other than the Secured Party) relating to the Account and/or any financial asset credited thereto pursuant to which it has agreed, or will agree, to comply with entitlement orders of such person. The Securities Intermediary has not entered into any other agreement with the Lien Grantor or the Secured Party purporting to limit or condition the obligation of the Securities Intermediary to comply with entitlement orders as agreed in Section 3 hereof.

Section 11. Successors. This Agreement shall be binding upon, and shall inure to the benefit of, the parties hereto and their respective successors and assigns.

Section 12. Notices. Each notice, request or other communication given to any party hereunder shall be in writing (which term includes facsimile or other electronic transmission) and shall be effective (i) when delivered to such party at its address specified below, (ii) when sent to such party by facsimile or other electronic transmission, addressed to it at its facsimile number or electronic

 

G-5


address specified below, and such party sends back an electronic confirmation of receipt or (iii) ten days after being sent to such party by certified or registered United States mail, addressed to it at its address specified below, with first class or airmail postage prepaid:

Lien Grantor:

Secured Party:

Securities Intermediary:

Any party may change its address, facsimile number and/or e-mail address for purposes of this Section by giving notice of such change to the other parties in the manner specified above.

Section 13. Termination. The rights and powers granted herein to the Secured Party (i) have been granted in order to perfect the Transaction Lien, (ii) are powers coupled with an interest and (iii) will not be affected by any bankruptcy of the Lien Grantor or any lapse of time. The obligations of the Securities Intermediary hereunder shall continue in effect until the Secured Party has notified the Securities Intermediary in writing that the Transaction Lien has been terminated pursuant to the terms of the Security Agreement.

 

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,
as Agent

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

G-6


[NAME OF SECURITIES INTERMEDIARY]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

G-7


Exhibit A

[Letterhead of Secured Party]

[Date]

[Name and Address of Securities Intermediary]

Attention:                                                              

 

  Re: Notice of Exclusive Control

Ladies and Gentlemen:

As referenced in the Securities Account Control Agreement dated as of              ,              among [name of Lien Grantor], us and you (a copy of which is attached), we notify you that we will hereafter exercise exclusive control over securities account number                      (the “ Account ”), all financial assets from time to time credited thereto and all security entitlements in respect thereof. You are instructed not to accept any directions, instructions or entitlement orders with respect to the Account or the financial assets credited thereto from any person other than the undersigned unless otherwise ordered by a court of competent jurisdiction.

You are instructed to deliver a copy of this notice by facsimile transmission to [name of Lien Grantor].

Very truly yours,

 

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,

as Agent

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

cc: [name of Lien Grantor]

 

G-8


EXHIBIT H

to Security Agreement

DEPOSIT ACCOUNT CONTROL AGREEMENT

DEPOSIT ACCOUNT CONTROL AGREEMENT dated as of              ,              among                      (the “ Lien Grantor ”), JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Agent (the “ Secured Party ”), and                  (the “ Bank ”). All references herein to the “ UCC ” refer to the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in the State of New York. Terms defined in the UCC have the same meanings when used herein.

W I T N E S S E T H :

WHEREAS, the Lien Grantor is the Bank’s customer (as defined in Section 4-104(1)(e) of the UCC) with respect to the Account (as defined below);

WHEREAS, pursuant to (i) an Amended and Restated ABL Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ ABL Security Agreement ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, as borrower (the “ Borrower ”), the guarantors party thereto including the Lien Grantor (the “ Guarantors ”) and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., acting as agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ Agent ”), (ii) an Amended and Restated First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Borrower, the Guarantors and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., acting as agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ First Lien Term Loan Agent ” and (iii) a Notes Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ Notes Security Agreement ” and, together with the ABL Security Agreement and the First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement, the “ Security Agreements ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc. (collectively, the “ Issuers ”), the Subsidiary Guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, acting as collateral agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ Collateral Agent ”, together with the Agent and the First Lien Term Loan Agent, the “ Agents ”), the Lien Grantor has granted to the Agents, for the benefit of the Secured Parties (as defined in each of

 

H-1


the Security Agreements), a continuing security interest (the “ Transaction Lien ”) in all right, title and interest of the Lien Grantor in, to and under the Account; and

WHEREAS, the Agents, the Borrower and certain other parties are parties to an Amended and Restated Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, pursuant to which the Agent is to enter into this Agreement for the benefit of the Secured Parties (as defined in each of the Security Agreements) in order to perfect the Transaction Lien on the Account and any and all funds or deposits from time to time held therein or credited thereto, whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising;

NOW, THEREFORE, the parties hereto agree as follows:

Section 1. Establishment of Account. The Bank confirms that:

(i) the Bank has established account number [identify account number] in the name of “[name of Lien Grantor]” (such account and any successor account, the “ Account ”);

(ii) the Account is a “deposit account” as defined in Section 9-102(a)(29) of the UCC; and

(iii) the Bank is a “bank” (as defined in section 9-102 of the UCC) and is acting in such capacity in respect of the Account.

Section 2. Instructions. The Lien Grantor, the Secured Party and the Bank agree that the Bank will comply with (i) any instruction originated by the Secured Party directing disposition of funds in the Account and (ii) any other instruction from the Secured Party in respect of the Account, in each case without further consent by the Lien Grantor or any other person.

Section 3. Waiver of Lien; Waiver of Set-off. The Bank waives any security interest, lien or right to make deductions or setoffs that it may now have or hereafter acquire in or with respect to the Account or any or all funds or deposits from time to time held therein or credited thereto. No amounts credited to the Account will be subject to deduction, set-off, banker’s lien, or any other right in favor of any person other than the Secured Party [(except that the Bank may set off (i) all amounts due to it in respect of its customary fees and expenses for the routine maintenance and operation of the Account and (ii) the face amount of any checks that have been credited to the Account but are subsequently returned unpaid because of uncollected or insufficient funds)].

Section 4. Choice of Law. This Agreement shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of New York. [The State

 

H-2


of New York] shall be deemed to be the bank’s jurisdiction (as defined in Section 9-304 of the UCC) with respect to the Account.

Section 5. Conflict with Other Agreements. There is no agreement (except this Agreement) between the Bank and the Lien Grantor with respect to the Account [except for [identify any existing other agreements] (the “ Existing Other Agreements ”)]. In the event of any conflict between this Agreement (or any portion hereof) and any other agreement [(including any Existing Other Agreement)] between the Bank and the Lien Grantor with respect to the Account or any or all funds or deposits from time to time held therein or credited thereto, whether now existing or hereafter entered into, the terms of this Agreement shall prevail. If any Existing Other Agreement does not specify that it is governed by the laws of the jurisdiction specified in Section 5, such Existing Other Agreement is hereby amended to specify that it is governed by the laws of the jurisdiction specified in Section 5.

Section 6. Amendments. No amendment or modification of this Agreement or waiver of any right hereunder shall be binding on any party hereto unless it is in writing and is signed by all the parties hereto.

Section 7. Notice of Adverse Claims. Except for the claims and interests of the Secured Party and the Lien Grantor, the Bank does not know of any claim to, or interest in, the Account or any or all funds or deposits held therein or credited thereto. If any person asserts any lien, encumbrance or adverse claim (including any writ, garnishment, judgment, attachment, execution or similar process) against the Account or any or all funds or deposits held therein or credited thereto, the Bank will promptly notify the Secured Party and the Lien Grantor thereof.

Section 8. Maintenance of Account. In addition to, and not in lieu of, the obligation of the Bank to honor instructions originated by the Secured Party as agreed in Section 3 hereof, the Bank agrees to maintain the Account as follows:

(i) Lien Grantor Entitlement Orders; Notice of Exclusive Control. So long as the Bank has not received a Notice of Exclusive Control (as defined below), the Bank may comply with instructions originated by the Lien Grantor or any duly authorized agent of the Lien Grantor in respect of the Account and any or all funds or deposits held therein or credited thereto. After the Bank receives a written notice from the Secured Party that it is exercising exclusive control over the Account (a “ Notice of Exclusive Control ”), the Bank will cease complying with instructions originated by the Lien Grantor or any of its agents.

 

H-3


(ii) Statements. The Bank will promptly send copies of all statements and other correspondence concerning the Account simultaneously to each of the Lien Grantor and the Secured Party at their respective addresses specified in Section 12 hereof.

(iii) Tax Reporting. All items of income, gain, expense and loss recognized in the Account or in respect of any funds or deposits held therein or credited thereto shall be reported to the Internal Revenue Service and all state and local taxing authorities under the name and taxpayer identification number of the Lien Grantor.

Section 9. Representations, Warranties and Covenants of the Bank. The Bank makes the following representations, warranties and covenants:

(i) The Account has been established as set forth in Section 1 above and will be maintained in the manner set forth herein until this Agreement is terminated. The Bank will not change the name or account number of the Account without the prior written consent of the Secured Party.

(ii) Neither the Account nor any funds or deposits at any time held therein or credited thereto is or will be evidenced by any instrument (as defined in Section 9-102 of the UCC) or constitutes or will constitute investment property (as defined in Section 9-102 of the UCC)

(iii) This Agreement is a valid and binding agreement of the Bank enforceable in accordance with its terms.

(iv) The Bank has not entered into, and until the termination of this Agreement will not enter into, any agreement with any person (other than the Secured Party) relating to the Account and/or any funds or deposits held therein or credited thereto pursuant to which it has agreed, or will agree, to comply with instructions of such person. The Bank has not entered into any other agreement with the Lien Grantor or the Secured Party purporting to limit or condition the obligation of the Bank to comply with instructions originated by the Secured Party as agreed in Section 3 hereof.

Section 10. Successors. This Agreement shall be binding upon, and shall inure to the benefit of, the parties hereto and their respective successors and assigns.

Section 11. Notices. Each notice, request or other communication given to any party hereunder shall be in writing (which term includes facsimile or other

 

H-4


electronic transmission) and shall be effective (i) when delivered to such party at its address specified below, (ii) when sent to such party by facsimile or other electronic transmission, addressed to it at its facsimile number or electronic address specified below, and such party sends back an electronic confirmation of receipt or (iii) ten days after being sent to such party by certified or registered United States mail, addressed to it at its address specified below, with first class or airmail postage prepaid:

Lien Grantor:

Secured Party:

Bank:

Any party may change its address, facsimile number and/or e-mail address for purposes of this Section by giving notice of such change to the other parties in the manner specified above.

Section 12. Termination. The rights and powers granted herein to the Secured Party (i) have been granted in order to perfect the Transaction Lien, (ii) are powers coupled with an interest and (iii) will not be affected by any bankruptcy of the Lien Grantor or any lapse of time. The obligations of the Bank hereunder shall continue in effect until the Secured Party has notified the Bank in writing that the Transaction Lien has been terminated pursuant to the terms of the Security Agreement.

 

H-5


[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]

By:

 

 

 

Name:

 

Title:

 

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A., as Agent

By:

 

 

 

Name:

 

Title:

 

[NAME OF BANK]

By:

 

 

 

Name:

 

Title:

 

H-6


Exhibit A

[Letterhead of Secured Party]

[Date]

[Name and Address of Bank]

Attention:                                 

 

  Re: Notice of Exclusive Control

Ladies and Gentlemen:

As referenced in the Deposit Account Control Agreement dated as of              ,              among [name of Lien Grantor], us and you (a copy of which is attached), we notify you that we will hereafter exercise exclusive control over deposit account number                  (the “ Account ”) and all funds and deposits from time to time held therein or credited thereto. You are instructed not to accept any directions or instructions with respect to the Account or the funds or deposits held therein or credited thereto from any person other than the undersigned unless otherwise ordered by a court of competent jurisdiction.

You are instructed to deliver a copy of this notice by facsimile transmission to [name of Lien Grantor].

Very truly yours,

 

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,

as Agent

By:

 

 

 

Name:

 

Title:

cc: [name of Lien Grantor]

 

H-7

Exhibit 10.13

Execution Copy

NOTES SECURITY AGREEMENT

Dated as of

August 24, 2010

Among

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC,

TA HOLDINGS FINANCE, INC.,

THE SUBSIDIARY GUARANTORS PARTY HERETO

and

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB,

as Collateral Agent


TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

 

 

     P AGE

SECTION 1. Definitions and other Interpretive Provisions

   1

SECTION 2. Grant of Transaction Liens

   12

SECTION 3. General Representations and Warranties

   14

SECTION 4. Further Assurances; General Covenants

   16

SECTION 5. Equipment

   18

SECTION 6. Recordable Intellectual Property

   18

SECTION 7. Investment Property

   19

SECTION 8. Controlled Deposit Accounts

   22

SECTION 9. Cash Collateral Accounts

   22

SECTION 10. Operation of Collateral Accounts

   23

SECTION 11. Transfer Of Record Ownership

   24

SECTION 12. Right to Vote Securities

   24

SECTION 13. Remedies upon Event of Default

   25

SECTION 14. Application of Proceeds

   27

SECTION 15. Fees and Expenses; Indemnification

   28

SECTION 16. Authority to Administer Collateral

   29

SECTION 17. Limitation on Duty in Respect of Collateral

   30

SECTION 18. General Provisions Concerning the Collateral Agent

   30

SECTION 19. Termination of Transaction Liens; Release of Collateral

   32

SECTION 20. Additional Lien Grantors

   33

SECTION 21. Notices

   33

SECTION 22. No Implied Waivers; Remedies Not Exclusive

   33

SECTION 23. Successors and Assigns

   34

SECTION 24. Amendments and Waivers

   34

SECTION 25. Choice of Law

   34

SECTION 26. Waiver of Jury Trial

   34

SECTION 27. Severability

   34

SECTION 28. Indenture, Security Agreements

   34

SECTION 29. Counterparts

   35

SECTION 30. Intercreditor Agreements

   35


SCHEDULES :  

Schedule 1

  Equity Interests in Subsidiaries and Affiliates Owned by Original Lien Grantors

Schedule 2

  Other Investment Property Owned by Original Lien Grantors

Schedule 3

  Real Properties to be Mortgaged
EXHIBITS :  

Exhibit A

  Security Agreement Supplement

Exhibit B

  Copyright Security Agreement

Exhibit C

  Patent Security Agreement

Exhibit D

  Trademark Security Agreement

Exhibit E

  Perfection Certificate

Exhibit F

  Issuer Control Agreement

Exhibit G

  Securities Account Control Agreement

Exhibit H

  Deposit Account Control Agreement

 

ii


NOTES SECURITY AGREEMENT

NOTES SECURITY AGREEMENT, dated as of August 24, 2010 (this “ Agreement ”) among TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC and TA HOLDINGS FINANCE, INC. (collectively, the “ Issuers ” and each an “ Issuer ”), the SUBSIDIARY GUARANTORS party hereto and WILMINGTON TRUST FSB, as collateral agent for the Secured Parties (together with its successors and assigns, in such capacity, the “ Collateral Agent ”).

WHEREAS, Tower Automotive, LLC, the Issuers, the Subsidiary Guarantors and Wilmington Trust FSB, as trustee and collateral agent, are parties to that certain Indenture dated as of August 24, 2010 (as amended, restated, supplemented (including pursuant to any supplemental indenture) or otherwise modified from time to time, the “ Indenture ”), providing for the issuance of the Secured Notes;

WHEREAS, the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors are willing to secure their obligations under the Indenture and the Secured Notes (including, in the case of the Subsidiary Guarantors, pursuant to their guarantee of the obligations of the Issuers under the Secured Notes) by granting Liens on their assets to the Collateral Agent as provided in the Security Documents;

WHEREAS, it is a condition precedent to the issuance of the Secured Notes that the Issuers, the Subsidiary Guarantors and the Collateral Agent enter into this Agreement and that the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors grant the security interests in their assets as provided hereunder; and

WHEREAS, upon any foreclosure or other enforcement of the Security Documents, the net proceeds of the relevant Collateral are to be received by or paid over to the Collateral Agent and applied as provided herein and in the Term Intercreditor Agreement and the ABL Intercreditor Agreement;

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing and other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto agree as follows:

SECTION 1 . Definitions and other Interpretive Provisions.

(a) Terms Defined in the Indenture . Terms defined in the Indenture and not otherwise defined in subsection (b) or (c) of this Section have, as used herein, the respective meanings provided for therein.

(b) Terms Defined in UCC . As used herein, each of the following terms has the meaning specified in the UCC:


Term

  

UCC

Account    9-102
Authenticate    9-102
Certificated Security    8-102
Chattel Paper    9-102
Commodity Account    9-102
Commodity Customer    9-102
Deposit Account    9-102
Document    9-102
Entitlement Holder    8-102
Entitlement Order    8-102
Equipment    9-102
Financial Asset    8-102 & 103
General Intangibles    9-102
Instrument    9-102
Inventory    9-102
Investment Property    9-102
Proceeds    9-102
Record    9-102
Securities Account    8-501
Securities Intermediary    8-102
Security    8-102 & 103
Security Entitlement    8-102
Supporting Obligations    9-102
Uncertificated Security    8-102

(c) Additional Definitions . The following additional terms, as used herein, have the following meanings:

ABL Agent ” shall have the meaning given such term in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

ABL Credit Agreement ” shall mean that certain Revolving Credit and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of July 31, 2007 and as heretofore amended or modified, by and among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, as borrower, the guarantors party thereto, the lenders parties thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent.

ABL Intercreditor Agreement ” shall mean that certain Amended and Restated Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010 among JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as representative with respect to the ABL Credit Agreement, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as representative with respect to the Term Loan

 

2


Agreement, the Collateral Agent, as representative with respect to the Indenture, Tower Automotive, LLC and the Lien Grantors party thereto.

ABL Priority Collateral ” shall have the meaning given such term in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

ABL Termination Date ” shall have the meaning given such term in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

Applicable Agent ” shall mean (i) for purposes of the definitions of Controlled Deposit Account and Controlled Securities Account as such definitions are used in this Agreement, (A) at all times prior to the ABL Termination Date, the ABL Agent and (B) at all times after the ABL Termination Date, the Collateral Agent and (ii) for all other purposes, (A) at all times prior to the Term Obligations Termination Date, the Collateral Agent and (B) at all times after the Term Obligations Termination Date, the ABL Agent.

Authorized Term Collateral Agent” shall have the meaning given such term in the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

Cash Collateral Accounts ” shall have the meaning the meaning given such term in Section 9(a).

Collateral ” shall mean all property, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, on which a Lien is granted or purports to be granted to the Collateral Agent pursuant to the Security Documents. When used with respect to a specific Lien Grantor, the term “Collateral” means all its property on which such a Lien is granted or purports to be granted.

Collateral Accounts ” shall mean the Cash Collateral Accounts, the Controlled Deposit Accounts and the Controlled Securities Accounts.

Collection Account ” shall mean the Deposit Account established pursuant to Section 9(a)(i), into which the proceeds required to be deposit therein pursuant to Section 9(b)(i) shall be deposited.

Common Collateral ” shall have the meaning given such term in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

Contingent Secured Obligation ” shall mean, at any time, any Secured Obligation (or portion thereof) that is contingent in nature at such time, including any Secured Obligation that is:

(i) an obligation to reimburse a bank for drawings not yet made under a letter of credit issued by it;

 

3


(ii) an obligation under a Hedging Agreement to make payments that cannot be quantified at such time;

(iii) any other obligation (including any guarantee) that is contingent in nature at such time; or

(iv) an obligation to provide collateral to secure any of the foregoing types of obligations.

Control ” has the following meanings:

(a) when used with respect to any Security or Security Entitlement, the meaning specified in UCC Section 8-106; and

(b) when used with respect to any Deposit Account, the meaning specified in UCC Section 9-104.

Controlled Deposit Account ” shall mean a Deposit Account (i) that is subject to a Deposit Account Control Agreement or (ii) as to which the Applicable Agent is the Depositary Bank’s “customer” (as defined in UCC Section 4-104).

Controlled Securities Account ” shall mean a Securities Account that (i) is maintained in the name of a Lien Grantor at an office of a Securities Intermediary located in the United States and (ii) together with all Financial Assets credited thereto and all related Security Entitlements, is subject to a Securities Account Control Agreement among such Lien Grantor, the Applicable Agent and such Securities Intermediary.

Copyright License ” shall mean any agreement now or hereafter in existence granting to any Lien Grantor, or pursuant to which any Lien Grantor grants to any other Person, any right to use, copy, reproduce, distribute, prepare derivative works, display or publish any records or other materials on which a Copyright is in existence or may come into existence, including any agreement identified in Schedule 1 to any Copyright Security Agreement.

Copyrights ” shall mean all the following: (i) all copyrights under the laws of the United States or any other country (whether or not the underlying works of authorship have been published), all registrations and recordings thereof, all copyrightable works of authorship (whether or not published), and all applications for copyrights under the laws of the United States or any other country, including registrations, recordings and applications in the United States Copyright Office or in any similar office or agency of the United States, any State thereof or any other country or any political subdivision thereof, including those described in Schedule 1 to any Copyright Security Agreement, (ii) all renewals of

 

4


any of the foregoing, (iii) all claims for, and rights to sue for, past or future infringements of any of the foregoing, and (iv) all income, royalties, damages and payments now or hereafter due or payable with respect to any of the foregoing, including damages and payments for past or future infringements thereof.

Copyright Security Agreement ” shall mean a Copyright Security Agreement, substantially in the form of Exhibit B, executed and delivered by a Lien Grantor in favor of the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties.

Deposit Account Control Agreement ” means, with respect to any Deposit Account of any Lien Grantor, a Deposit Account Control Agreement substantially in the form of Exhibit H (or otherwise in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Applicable Agent) among such Lien Grantor, the Applicable Agent and the relevant Depositary Bank.

Depositary Bank ” shall mean a bank at which a Controlled Deposit Account is maintained.

Equity Interest ” shall mean (i) in the case of a corporation, any shares of its capital stock, (ii) in the case of a limited liability company, any membership interest therein, (iii) in the case of a partnership, any partnership interest (whether general or limited) therein, (iv) in the case of any other business entity, any participation or other interest in the equity or profits thereof, (v) any warrant, option or other right to acquire any Equity Interest described in this definition or (vi) any Security Entitlement in respect of any Equity Interest described in this definition.

Financial Officer ” means, with respect to any Person, the chief financial officer, controller or treasurer of such Person.

Foreign Intercompany Receivables Collateral ” shall mean intercompany receivables owed by a Foreign Subsidiary to a Lien Grantor that are included in the Collateral.

Foreign Subsidiary ” shall mean any Subsidiary that is not organized under the laws of the United Sates of America or any State thereof or the District of Columbia.

Group Member ” shall mean Holdco or any Subsidiary of Holdco.

Governmental Authority ” shall mean the government of the United States of America, any other nation or any political subdivision thereof, whether state or local, and any agency, authority, instrumentality, regulatory body, court,

 

5


central bank or other entity exercising executive, legislative, judicial, taxing, regulatory or administrative powers or functions of or pertaining to government.

Holdco ” shall mean Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC.

Indenture ” has the meaning provided to such term in the recitals hereto.

Intellectual Property Filing ” shall mean (i) with respect to any Patent, Patent License, Trademark or Trademark License, the filing of the applicable Patent Security Agreement or Trademark Security Agreement with the United States Patent and Trademark Office, together with an appropriately completed recordation form, and (ii) with respect to any Copyright or Copyright License, the filing of the applicable Copyright Security Agreement with the United States Copyright Office, together with an appropriately completed recordation form, in each case sufficient to record the Transaction Lien granted to the Collateral Agent in such Recordable Intellectual Property.

Intellectual Property Security Agreement ” shall mean a Copyright Security Agreement, a Patent Security Agreement or a Trademark Security Agreement.

Issuer Control Agreement ” shall mean an Issuer Control Agreement substantially in the form of Exhibit F (with any changes that the Applicable Agent shall have approved).

Issuers ” shall mean, collectively, Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc.

Lien Grantors ” shall mean the Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors.

Liquidity Trigger Period ” shall have the meaning given such term in the ABL Credit Agreement.

LLC Interest ” shall mean a membership interest or similar interest in a limited liability company.

Mortgages ” shall mean each of the mortgages and deeds of trust made by any Loan Party in favor of, or for the benefit of, the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties, in form and substance necessary to perfect the security interest granted to the Collateral Agent, as the same may be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.

Non-Contingent Secured Obligation ” shall mean at any time any Secured Obligation (or portion thereof) that is not a Contingent Secured Obligation at such time.

 

6


Note Guarantee” shall mean, with respect to each Subsidiary Guarantor, its guarantee of the Secured Obligations made under Article 11 of the Indenture.

Original Lien Grantor ” shall mean any Lien Grantor that grants a Lien on any of its assets pursuant to this Agreement on the Issue Date.

own ” refers to the possession of sufficient rights in property to grant a security interest therein as contemplated by UCC Section 9-203, and “ acquire ” refers to the acquisition of any such rights.

Partnership Interest ” shall mean a partnership interest, whether general or limited.

Patent License ” shall mean any agreement now or hereafter in existence granting to any Lien Grantor, or pursuant to which any Lien Grantor grants to any other Person, any right with respect to any Patent or any invention now or hereafter in existence, whether patentable or not, whether a patent or application for patent is in existence on such invention or not, and whether a patent or application for patent on such invention may come into existence or not, including any agreement identified in Schedule 1 to any Patent Security Agreement.

Patents ” shall mean (i) all letters patent and design letters patent of the United States or any other country and all applications for letters patent or design letters patent of the United States or any other country, including applications in the United States Patent and Trademark Office or in any similar office or agency of the United States, any State thereof or any other country or any political subdivision thereof, including those described in Schedule 1 to any Patent Security Agreement, (ii) all reissues, divisions, continuations, continuations in part, revisions and extensions of any of the foregoing, (iii) all claims for, and rights to sue for, past or future infringements of any of the foregoing and (iv) all income, royalties, damages and payments now or hereafter due or payable with respect to any of the foregoing, including damages and payments for past or future infringements thereof.

Patent Security Agreement ” shall mean a Patent Security Agreement, substantially in the form of Exhibit C, executed and delivered by a Lien Grantor in favor of the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties.

Perfection Certificate ” shall mean, with respect to any Lien Grantor, a certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit E, completed and supplemented with the schedules contemplated thereby, and signed by an officer of such Lien Grantor.

 

7


Permitted Liens ” shall mean (i) the Transaction Liens and (ii) any other Liens on the Collateral permitted to be created or assumed or to exist pursuant to the Indenture.

Person ” shall mean any natural person, corporation, division of a corporation, partnership, limited liability company, trust, joint venture, association, company, estate, unincorporated organization or Governmental Authority or any agency or political subdivision thereof.

Personal Property Collateral ” shall mean all property included in the Collateral except Real Property Collateral.

Pledged ”, when used in conjunction with any type of asset, shall mean at any time an asset of such type that is included (or that creates rights that are included) in the Collateral at such time. For example, “Pledged Equity Interest” means an Equity Interest that is included in the Collateral at such time.

Post-Petition Interest ” shall mean any interest that accrues after the commencement of any case, proceeding or other action relating to the bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization of any one or more of the Lien Grantors (or would accrue but for the operation of applicable bankruptcy or insolvency laws), whether or not such interest is allowed or allowable as a claim in any such proceeding.

Real Property Collateral ” shall mean all real property (including leasehold interests in real property) included in the Collateral.

Recordable Intellectual Property ” shall mean (i) any Patent registered with the United States Patent and Trademark Office, and any Patent License with respect to a Patent so registered, (ii) any Trademark registered with the United States Patent and Trademark Office, and any Trademark License with respect to a Trademark so registered, (iii) any Copyright registered with the United States Copyright Office and any Copyright License with respect to a Copyright so registered, and all rights in or under any of the foregoing.

Related Parties ” shall mean, with respect to any specified Person, such Person’s Affiliates and the respective directors, officers, employees, agents and advisors of such Person and such Person’s Affiliates.

Secured Agreement ”, when used with respect to any Secured Obligation, refers collectively to each instrument, agreement or other document that sets forth obligations of either Issuer, obligations of a guarantor and/or rights of the holder with respect to such Secured Obligation.

 

8


Secured Notes ” shall mean the 10.625% senior secured notes of the Issuers due September 1, 2017 issued pursuant to the Indenture.

Secured Notes Documents ” shall mean the Indenture, the Secured Notes and the Security Documents.

Secured Obligations ” shall mean, as to the Issuers, all obligations (whether in existence on the Issue Date or arising afterwards, absolute or contingent, direct or indirect) for or in respect of principal (when due, upon acceleration, upon redemption, upon mandatory repayment or repurchase pursuant to a mandatory offer to purchase, or otherwise), premium, interest, penalties, fees, expenses, indemnification, reimbursement and other amounts payable and liabilities with respect to or arising under the Secured Notes, the Indenture, this Agreement, or any of the other Security Documents to which the Issuers or either of them is a party, including without limitation (x) all interest accrued or accruing after the commencement of any bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization or similar case or proceeding at the contract rate (including, without limitation, any contract rate applicable upon default) specified in the relevant documentation, whether or not the claim for such interest is allowed as a claim in such case or proceeding and (y) the fees and expenses of the Trustee, the Collateral Agent and any of their counsel, agents and professional advisors.

Secured Parties ” shall mean the holders from time to time of the Secured Obligations.

Securities Account Control Agreement ” means, with respect to a Securities Account, a Securities Account Control Agreement substantially in the form of Exhibit G (with any changes that the Applicable Agent shall have approved) among the relevant Securities Intermediary, the relevant Lien Grantor and the Applicable Agent.

Security Documents ” shall mean, collectively, the Notes Security Agreement, the Mortgages, the Deposit Account Control Agreements, the Securities Account Control Agreements, the Intellectual Property Security Agreements, the Intellectual Property Filings, UCC financing statements, the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, the Term Intercreditor Agreement and any other documents granting a Lien upon the Collateral as security for payment of the Secured Obligations.

Security Agreement Supplement ” shall mean a Security Agreement Supplement, substantially in the form of Exhibit A, signed and delivered to the Collateral Agent for the purpose of adding a Subsidiary as a party hereto pursuant to Section 20 and/or adding additional property to the Collateral.

 

9


subsidiary ” shall mean, with respect to any Person (in this definition referred to as the “parent”), any corporation, association or other business entity (whether now existing or hereafter organized) of which at least a majority of the securities or other ownership or membership interests having ordinary voting power for the election of directors is, at the time as of which any determination is being made, owned or controlled by the parent or one or more subsidiaries of the parent or by the parent and one or more subsidiaries of the parent.

Subsidiary ” means any subsidiary of Holdco.

Subsidiary Guarantors ” shall mean (i) Holdco and each direct or indirect Domestic Subsidiary of Holdco in existence on the Issue Date (other than the Issuers) and (ii) each Person that becomes a Subsidiary Guarantor after the Issue Date pursuant to Section 4.14 of the Indenture.

Term Intercreditor Agreement ” shall mean that certain Term Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010 among JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A., as representative with respect to the Term Loan Agreement, the Collateral Agent, as representative with respect to the Indenture, Tower Automotive, LLC and the Lien Grantors party thereto.

Term Loan Agreement ” shall mean the First Lien Term Loan and Guaranty Agreement dated as of July 31, 2007, and as heretofore amended or modified, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and Tower Automotive Holdings Europe B.V, as Borrowers, Tower Automotive, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(a), LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(b), LLC and the other guarantors party thereto, the lenders party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent.

Term Obligations Termination Date ” shall have the meaning given such term in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

Term Priority Collateral ” shall have the meaning given such term in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

Term Proceeds Account ” shall mean the Deposit Account established pursuant to Section 9(a)(ii), into which the proceeds required to be deposited therein pursuant to Section 9(b)(ii) shall be deposited.

Trademark License ” shall mean any agreement now or hereafter in existence granting to any Lien Grantor, or pursuant to which any Lien Grantor grants to any other Person, any right to use any Trademark, including any agreement identified in Schedule 1 to any Trademark Security Agreement.

 

10


Trademarks ” shall mean: (i) all trademarks, trade names, corporate names, company names, business names, fictitious business names, trade styles, service marks, logos, brand names, trade dress, prints and labels on which any of the foregoing have appeared or appear, package and other designs, and all other source or business identifiers, and all general intangibles of like nature, and the rights in any of the foregoing which arise under applicable law, (ii) the goodwill of the business symbolized thereby or associated with each of them, (iii) all registrations and applications in connection therewith, including registrations and applications in the United States Patent and Trademark Office or in any similar office or agency of the United States, any State thereof or any other country or any political subdivision thereof, including those described in Schedule 1 to any Trademark Security Agreement, (iv) all renewals of any of the foregoing, (v) all claims for, and rights to sue for, past or future infringements of any of the foregoing and (vi) all income, royalties, damages and payments now or hereafter due or payable with respect to any of the foregoing, including damages and payments for past or future infringements thereof.

Trademark Security Agreement ” shall mean a Trademark Security Agreement, substantially in the form of Exhibit D, executed and delivered by a Lien Grantor in favor of the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties.

Transaction Liens ” shall mean the Liens granted by the Lien Grantors under the Security Documents.

Type ” shall have the meaning specified in the ABL Intercreditor Agreement.

UCC ” shall mean the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in the State of New York; provided that, if perfection or the effect of perfection or non-perfection or the priority of any Transaction Lien on any Collateral is governed by the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect in a jurisdiction other than New York, “UCC” means the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in such other jurisdiction for purposes of the provisions hereof relating to such perfection, effect of perfection or non-perfection or priority.

(d) Terms Generally. The definitions of terms herein (including those incorporated by reference to the UCC or to another document) apply equally to the singular and plural forms of the terms defined. Whenever the context may require, any pronoun includes the corresponding masculine, feminine and neuter forms. The words “ include ”, “ includes ” and “ including ” shall be deemed to be followed by the phrase “ without limitation ”. The word “ will ” shall be construed to have the same meaning and effect as the word “ shall ”. Unless the context

 

11


requires otherwise, (i) any definition of or reference to any agreement, instrument or other document herein shall be construed as referring to such agreement, instrument or other document as from time to time amended, supplemented or otherwise modified (subject to any restrictions on such amendments, supplements or modifications set forth herein), (ii) any reference herein to any Person shall be construed to include such Person’s successors and assigns, (iii) the words “ herein ”, “ hereof ” and “ hereunder ”, and words of similar import, shall be construed to refer to this Agreement in its entirety and not to any particular provision hereof, (iv) all references herein to Sections, Exhibits and Schedules shall be construed to refer to Sections of, and Exhibits and Schedules to, this Agreement and (v) the word “ property ” shall be construed to refer to any and all tangible and intangible assets and properties, including cash, securities, accounts and contract rights.

(e) The Authorized Term Collateral Agent. Without in any way limiting or otherwise modifying the rights of the Collateral Agent hereunder, all enforcement rights and all discretionary rights to take action (or to consent to the taking of any action) vested in the Collateral Agent (including in its capacity as “Applicable Agent”) pursuant to Sections 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 and 16 of this Agreement shall also be exercisable by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, acting in accordance with the Term Intercreditor Agreement; provided, that in connection with the exercise by the Authorized Term Collateral Agent of any such right, to the extent that the terms of any Security Document governed by non-U.S. law (including, without limitation, any Security Document delivered pursuant to Section 4(f) or 4(g)) require that such action be taken by the Collateral Agent, the Collateral Agent shall take such action in accordance with the written instructions of the Authorized Term Collateral Agent.

SECTION 2 . Grant of Transaction Liens.

(a) Each Issuer, in order to secure the Secured Obligations, and each Subsidiary Guarantor listed on the signature pages hereof, in order to secure its Note Guarantee, grants to the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties a continuing security interest in all the following property of such Issuer or such Subsidiary Guarantor, as the case may be, whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising and regardless of where located:

(i) all Accounts;

(ii) all Chattel Paper;

(iii) all Deposit Accounts;

(iv) all Documents;

 

12


(v) all Equipment;

(vi) all General Intangibles (including any Equity Interests in other Persons that do not constitute Investment Property);

(vii) all Instruments;

(viii) all Inventory;

(ix) all Investment Property;

(x) all books and records (including customer lists, credit files, computer programs, printouts and other computer materials and records) of such Original Lien Grantor pertaining to any of its Collateral;

(xi) such Original Lien Grantor’s ownership interest in (1) its Collateral Accounts, (2) all Financial Assets credited to its Collateral Accounts from time to time and all Security Entitlements in respect thereof, (3) all cash held in its Collateral Accounts from time to time and (4) all other money in the possession of the Collateral Agent; and

(xii) all Proceeds of the Collateral described in the foregoing clauses (i) through (xi);

provided that the following property is excluded from the foregoing security interests: (A) motor vehicles the perfection of a security interest in which is excluded from the Uniform Commercial Code in the relevant jurisdiction, (B) voting Equity Interests in any Foreign Subsidiary, to the extent (but only to the extent) required to prevent the Collateral from including more than 65% of all voting Equity Interests in such Foreign Subsidiary, (C) United States intent-to-use trademark applications to the extent that, and solely during the period in which, the grant of a security interest therein would impair the validity or enforceability of such intent-to-use trademark applications under applicable federal law and (D) any property to the extent that the grant of a security interest therein is prohibited by any applicable law or regulation, requires a consent not obtained of any Governmental Authority pursuant to any applicable law or regulation, or is prohibited by, or constitutes a breach or default under or results in the termination of or requires any consent not obtained under, any contract, license, agreement, instrument or other document evidencing or giving rise to such property or, in the case of any Investment Property, any applicable shareholder or similar agreement, except to the extent that such law or regulation or the term in such contract, license, agreement, instrument or other document or shareholder or similar agreement providing for such prohibition, breach, default or termination or requiring such consent is ineffective under applicable law. Each Original Lien

 

13


Grantor shall use all reasonable efforts to obtain any such required consent that is reasonably obtainable.

(b) With respect to each right to payment or performance included in the Collateral from time to time, the Transaction Lien granted therein includes a continuing security interest in (i) any Supporting Obligation that supports such payment or performance and (ii) any Lien that (x) secures such right to payment or performance or (y) secures any such Supporting Obligation.

(c) The Transaction Liens are granted as security only and shall not subject the Collateral Agent or any other Secured Party to, or transfer or in any way affect or modify, any obligation or liability of any Lien Grantor with respect to any of the Collateral or any transaction in connection therewith.

SECTION 3 . General Representations and Warranties. Each Original Lien Grantor represents and warrants that:

(a) Such Lien Grantor is duly organized, validly existing and in good standing under the laws of the jurisdiction identified as its jurisdiction of organization in its Perfection Certificate.

(b) Schedule 1 lists all Equity Interests in Subsidiaries and Affiliates owned by such Lien Grantor as of the Issue Date. Such Lien Grantor holds all such Equity Interests directly ( i.e. , not through a Subsidiary, a Securities Intermediary or any other Person).

(c) Schedule 2 lists, as of the Issue Date, (i) all Securities owned by such Lien Grantor (except Securities evidencing Equity Interests in Subsidiaries and Affiliates) and (ii) all Securities Accounts to which Financial Assets are credited in respect of which such Lien Grantor owns Security Entitlements. Such Lien Grantor owns no Commodity Account in respect of which such Lien Grantor is the Commodity Customer.

(d) All Pledged Equity Interests owned by such Lien Grantor are owned by it free and clear of any Lien other than (i) the Transaction Liens and (ii) any other Permitted Liens. All shares of capital stock included in such Pledged Equity Interests (including shares of capital stock in respect of which such Lien Grantor owns a Security Entitlement) have been duly authorized and validly issued and are fully paid and non-assessable. None of such Pledged Equity Interests is subject to any option to purchase or similar right of any Person. Such Lien Grantor is not and will not become a party to or otherwise bound by any agreement (except the Secured Notes Documents and any agreement permitted under the Secured Notes Documents) which restricts in any manner the rights of any present or future holder of any Pledged Equity Interest with respect thereto.

 

14


(e) Such Lien Grantor has good and marketable title to all its Collateral (subject to exceptions that are, in the aggregate, not material), free and clear of any Lien other than Permitted Liens.

(f) Such Lien Grantor has not performed any acts that might prevent the Collateral Agent from enforcing any of the provisions of the Security Documents or that would limit the Collateral Agent in any such enforcement. No financing statement, security agreement, mortgage or similar or equivalent document or instrument covering all or part of the Collateral owned by such Lien Grantor is on file or of record in any jurisdiction in which such filing or recording would be effective to perfect or record a Lien on such Collateral, except financing statements, mortgages or other similar or equivalent documents with respect to Permitted Liens. After the Issue Date, no Collateral owned by such Lien Grantor will be in the possession or under the Control of any other Person having a claim thereto or security interest therein, other than a Permitted Lien.

(g) The Transaction Liens on all Personal Property Collateral owned by such Lien Grantor (i) have been validly created, (ii) will attach to each item of such Collateral on the Issue Date (or, if such Lien Grantor first obtains rights thereto on a later date, on such later date) and (iii) when so attached, will secure all the Secured Obligations or such Lien Grantor’s Note Guarantee, as the case may be.

(h) When the relevant Mortgages have been duly executed and delivered, the Transaction Liens on all Real Property Collateral owned by such Lien Grantor as of the Issue Date will have been validly created and will secure all the Secured Obligations or such Lien Grantor’s Note Guarantee, as the case may be. When such Mortgages (and memoranda of lease with respect to any leasehold interests included in such Real Property Collateral) have been duly recorded, such Transaction Liens will rank prior to all other Liens (except Permitted Liens) on such Real Property Collateral.

(i) Such Lien Grantor has delivered a Perfection Certificate to the Collateral Agent. The information set forth therein is correct and complete as of the Issue Date.

(j) When UCC financing statements describing the Collateral as “all personal property” have been filed in the offices specified in such Perfection Certificate, the Transaction Liens will constitute perfected security interests in the Personal Property Collateral owned by such Lien Grantor to the extent that a security interest therein may be perfected by filing pursuant to the UCC, prior to all Liens and rights of others therein except Permitted Liens. When, in addition to the filing of such UCC financing statements, the applicable Intellectual Property Filings have been made with respect to such Lien Grantor’s Recordable

 

15


Intellectual Property (including any future filings required pursuant to Sections 4(a) and 6(a)), the Transaction Liens will constitute perfected security interests in all right, title and interest of such Lien Grantor in its Recordable Intellectual Property to the extent that security interests therein may be perfected by such filings, prior to all Liens and rights of others therein except Permitted Liens. Except for (i) the filing of such UCC financing statements, (ii) such Intellectual Property Filings, (iii) the due recordation of memoranda of lease with respect to the Pledged leasehold interests and (iv) the due recordation of the Mortgages, no registration, recordation or filing with any governmental body, agency or official is required in connection with the execution or delivery of the Security Documents or is necessary for the validity or enforceability thereof or for the perfection or due recordation of the Transaction Liens or for the enforcement of the Transaction Liens.

(k) Such Lien Grantor has taken, and will continue to take, all actions necessary under the UCC to perfect (and maintain the perfection of) its interest in any Accounts or Chattel Paper purchased or otherwise acquired by it, as against its assignors and creditors of its assignors.

(l) Such Lien Grantor’s Collateral is insured as required by the Indenture.

(m) All of such Lien Grantor’s Inventory has or will have been produced in compliance with the applicable requirements of the Fair Labor Standards Act, as amended.

SECTION 4. Further Assurances; General Covenants. Each Lien Grantor covenants as follows:

(a) Such Lien Grantor will, from time to time, at the Issuers’ expense, execute, deliver, file and record any statement, assignment, instrument, document, agreement or other paper and take any other action (including any Intellectual Property Filing and any filing of financing or continuation statements under the UCC) that from time to time may be reasonably necessary, or that the Collateral Agent may reasonably request, in order to:

(i) create, preserve, perfect, confirm or validate the Transaction Liens on such Lien Grantor’s Collateral;

(ii) in the case of Pledged Deposit Accounts and Pledged Investment Property, cause the Collateral Agent to have Control thereof (beginning, in the case of Deposit Accounts and Securities Accounts, on the date that is 60 days after the Issue Date);

 

16


(iii) enable the Collateral Agent and the other Secured Parties to obtain the full benefits of the Security Documents; or

(iv) enable the Collateral Agent to exercise and enforce any of its rights, powers and remedies with respect to any of such Lien Grantor’s Collateral.

To the extent permitted by applicable law, such Lien Grantor authorizes (but does not obligate) the Collateral Agent to execute and file such financing statements or continuation statements without such Lien Grantor’s signature appearing thereon. Such Lien Grantor appoints the Collateral Agent as its attorney-in-fact to execute and file all Intellectual Property Filings and other filings required or so requested for the foregoing purposes, all acts of such attorney being hereby ratified and confirmed; and such power, being coupled with an interest, shall be irrevocable until all the Transaction Liens granted by such Lien Grantor terminate pursuant to Section 19. The Issuers will pay the costs of, or incidental to, any Intellectual Property Filings and any recording or filing of any financing or continuation statements or other documents recorded or filed pursuant hereto.

(b) Such Lien Grantor will not (i) change its name or corporate structure, (ii) change its location (determined as provided in UCC Section 9-307) or (iii) become bound, as provided in UCC Section 9-203(d) or otherwise, by a security agreement entered into by another Person, unless it shall have given the Collateral Agent at least 30 days prior written notice thereof.

(c) Except for sales of inventory in the ordinary course of business, such Lien Grantor will not sell, lease, exchange, assign or otherwise dispose of, or grant any option with respect to, any of its Collateral; provided that such Lien Grantor may do any of the foregoing unless (i) doing so would violate a covenant in the Indenture or (ii) an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing and the Collateral Agent shall have notified such Lien Grantor that its right to do so is terminated, suspended or otherwise limited. Concurrently with any sale, lease or other disposition (except a sale or disposition to another Lien Grantor or a lease) permitted by the foregoing proviso , the Transaction Liens on the assets sold or disposed of (but not in any Proceeds arising from such sale or disposition) will cease immediately without any action by the Collateral Agent or any other Secured Party. The Collateral Agent will, at the Issuers’ expense and upon receipt of a certificate of a Financial Officer of Holdco certifying that such Transaction Lien may be released, execute and deliver to the relevant Lien Grantor such documents as such Lien Grantor shall reasonably request to evidence the fact that any asset so sold or disposed of is no longer subject to a Transaction Lien.

 

17


(d) Such Lien Grantor will, promptly upon request, provide to the Collateral Agent all information and evidence concerning such Lien Grantor’s Collateral that the Collateral Agent may reasonably request from time to time to enable it to enforce the provisions of the Security Documents.

(e) With respect to its ownership interest (whether fee or leasehold) in each real property set forth on Schedule 3, the applicable Lien Grantor shall, not later than the date that is 45 days following the Issue Date, execute and deliver to the Collateral Agent (i) a Mortgage in suitable form for recordation in the applicable state or county office sufficient to perfect the security interest in favor of the Collateral Agent and (ii) if reasonably requested by the Collateral Agent, fixture filings suitable for filing in the applicable state or county office sufficient to perfect the security interest in favor of the Collateral Agent and (iii) a customary opinion of local counsel to such Lien Grantor with respect to the validity and perfection of such security interests under Dutch law.

(f) Not later than the date that is 90 days after the Issue Date, Holdco shall cause 65% of the membership interests of Tower Automotive Holdings III Cooperatie U.A. to be pledged to the Collateral Agent to secure the Secured Obligations pursuant to one or more Dutch law governed share pledges or other collateral documents in form and substance necessary to create and perfect the security interest in such membership interests granted in favor of the Collateral Agent under Dutch law.

(g) Not later than the date that is 90 days after the Issue Date, Holdco shall cause all intercompany receivables owed by any Foreign Subsidiary to any Lien Grantor (as of the date the applicable collateral document is delivered) to be pledged to the Collateral Agent to secure the Secured Obligations pursuant to one or more Dutch law governed receivables pledges or other collateral documents in form and substance necessary to create and perfect the security interest in such intercompany receivables granted in favor of the Collateral Agent under Dutch law.

(h) At the time of delivery of each Security Document required by Section 4(f) or 4(g), Holdco shall cause to be delivered to the Collateral Agent a customary opinion of Dutch counsel with respect to the validity and perfection of the applicable security interest under Dutch law.

SECTION 5 . Equipment. Each Lien Grantor covenants that it will not permit any of its Pledged Equipment to become a fixture to real estate or an accession to any personal property that is not included in the Collateral.

SECTION 6 . Recordable Intellectual Property. Each Lien Grantor covenants as follows:

 

18


(a) On the Issue Date (in the case of an Original Lien Grantor) or the date on which it signs and delivers its first Security Agreement Supplement (in the case of any other Lien Grantor), such Lien Grantor will sign and deliver to the Collateral Agent Intellectual Property Security Agreements with respect to all Recordable Intellectual Property then owned by it. Within 30 days after each June 30 and December 31 thereafter, it will sign and deliver to the Collateral Agent an appropriate Intellectual Property Security Agreement covering any Recordable Intellectual Property owned by it on such June 30 or December 31 that is not covered by any previous Intellectual Property Security Agreement so signed and delivered by it. Each Lien Grantor hereby authorizes the Collateral Agent to make all Intellectual Property Filings necessary to record the Transaction Liens on its Recordable Intellectual Property.

(b) Such Lien Grantor will notify the Collateral Agent in writing promptly if it knows that any application or registration relating to any Recordable Intellectual Property owned or licensed by it that is material to its business may become abandoned or dedicated to the public, or of any adverse determination or development (including the institution of, or any adverse determination or development in, any proceeding in the United States Copyright Office, the United States Patent and Trademark Office or any court) regarding such Lien Grantor’s ownership of such Recordable Intellectual Property, its right to register or patent the same, or its right to keep and maintain the same. If any of such Lien Grantor’s rights to any Recordable Intellectual Property are infringed, misappropriated or diluted in any material respect by a third party, such Lien Grantor will notify the Collateral Agent in writing within 30 days after it learns thereof and will, unless such Lien Grantor shall reasonably determine that such action would be of negligible value, economic or otherwise, promptly sue for infringement, misappropriation or dilution and to recover any and all damages for such infringement, misappropriation or dilution, and take such other actions as such Lien Grantor shall reasonably deem appropriate under the circumstances to protect such Recordable Intellectual Property.

SECTION 7 . Investment Property. Each Lien Grantor represents, warrants and covenants as follows:

(a) Certificated Securities. On the Issue Date (in the case of an Original Lien Grantor) or the date on which it signs and delivers its first Security Agreement Supplement (in the case of any other Lien Grantor), such Lien Grantor will deliver to the Applicable Agent as Collateral hereunder all certificates representing Pledged Certificated Securities then owned by such Lien Grantor. Thereafter, whenever such Lien Grantor acquires any other certificate representing a Pledged Certificated Security, such Lien Grantor will immediately deliver such certificate to the Applicable Agent as Collateral hereunder. The

 

19


provisions of this subsection are subject to the limitation in Section 7(j) in the case of voting Equity Interests in a Foreign Subsidiary.

(b) Uncertificated Securities . On the Issue Date (in the case of an Original Lien Grantor) or the date on which it signs and delivers its first Security Agreement Supplement (in the case of any other Lien Grantor), such Lien Grantor will enter into (and cause the relevant issuer to enter into) an Issuer Control Agreement in respect of each Pledged Uncertificated Security then owned by such Lien Grantor and deliver such Issuer Control Agreement to the Applicable Agent (which shall enter into the same). Thereafter, whenever such Lien Grantor acquires any other Pledged Uncertificated Security, such Lien Grantor will enter into (and cause the relevant issuer to enter into) an Issuer Control Agreement in respect of such Pledged Uncertificated Security and deliver such Issuer Control Agreement to the Applicable Agent (which shall enter into the same). The provisions of this subsection are subject to the limitation in Section 7(j) in the case of voting Equity Interests in a Foreign Subsidiary.

(c) Security Entitlements . (i) Within 60 days after the Issue Date (in the case of an Original Lien Grantor) or (ii) on the date on which it signs and delivers its first Security Agreement Supplement (in the case of any other Lien Grantor), such Lien Grantor will, with respect to each Security Entitlement then owned by it, enter into (and cause the relevant Securities Intermediary to enter into) a Securities Account Control Agreement in respect of such Security Entitlement and the Securities Account to which the underlying Financial Asset is credited and will deliver such Securities Account Control Agreement to the Applicable Agent (which shall enter into the same). Thereafter, whenever such Lien Grantor acquires any other Security Entitlement, such Lien Grantor will, as promptly as practicable, cause the underlying Financial Asset to be credited to a Controlled Securities Account. Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this clause (c), unless an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, the Lien Grantors have the right not to comply therewith with respect to Securities Accounts having an aggregate value of less than $1,000,000 in the aggregate for all Lien Grantors.

(d) Perfection as to Certificated Securities. When such Lien Grantor delivers the certificate representing any Pledged Certificated Security owned by it to the Applicable Agent and complies with Section 7(h) in connection with such delivery, (i) the Transaction Lien on such Pledged Certificated Security will be perfected, subject to no prior Liens or rights of others (except Permitted Liens), (ii) the Applicable Agent will have Control of such Pledged Certificated Security and (iii) the Applicable Agent will be a protected purchaser (within the meaning of UCC Section 8-303) thereof.

(e) Perfection as to Uncertificated Securities . When such Lien Grantor, the Applicable Agent and the issuer of any Pledged Uncertificated Security

 

20


owned by such Lien Grantor enter into an Issuer Control Agreement with respect thereto, (i) the Transaction Lien on such Pledged Uncertificated Security will be perfected, subject to no prior Liens or rights of others (except Permitted Liens), (ii) the Applicable Agent will have Control of such Pledged Uncertificated Security and (iii) the Applicable Agent will be a protected purchaser (within the meaning of UCC Section 8-303) thereof.

(f) Perfection as to Security Entitlements . So long as the Financial Asset underlying any Security Entitlement owned by such Lien Grantor is credited to a Controlled Securities Account, (i) the Transaction Lien on such Security Entitlement will be perfected, subject to no prior Liens or rights of others (except Liens and rights of the relevant Securities Intermediary that are Permitted Liens and any other Liens consented to by the Collateral Agent, and other Permitted Liens), (ii) the Applicable Agent will have Control of such Security Entitlement and (iii) no action based on an adverse claim to such Security Entitlement or such Financial Asset, whether framed in conversion, replevin, constructive trust, equitable lien or other theory, may be asserted against the Applicable Agent or any other Secured Party.

(g) Agreement as to Applicable Jurisdiction . In respect of all Security Entitlements owned by such Lien Grantor, and all Securities Accounts to which the related Financial Assets are credited, the Securities Intermediary’s jurisdiction (determined as provided in UCC Section 8-110(e)) will at all times be located in the United States.

(h) Delivery of Pledged Certificates . All Pledged Certificates, when delivered to the Applicable Agent, will be in suitable form for transfer by delivery, or accompanied by duly executed instruments of transfer or assignment in blank, with signatures appropriately witnessed, all in form and substance satisfactory to the Applicable Agent.

(i) Communications . Each Lien Grantor will promptly give to the Collateral Agent copies of any material notices and communications received by it with respect to (i) Pledged Securities registered in the name of such Lien Grantor or its nominee and (ii) Pledged Security Entitlements as to which such Lien Grantor is the Entitlement Holder.

(j) Foreign Subsidiaries. A Lien Grantor will not be obligated to comply with the provisions of this Section at any time with respect to any voting Equity Interest in a Foreign Subsidiary if and to the extent (but only to the extent) that such voting Equity Interest is excluded from the Transaction Liens at such time pursuant to clause (B) of the proviso at the end of Section 2(a) and/or the comparable provisions of one or more Security Agreement Supplements.

 

21


(k) Compliance with Applicable Foreign Laws. If and so long as the Collateral includes (i) any Equity Interest in, or other Investment Property issued by, a legal entity organized under the laws of a jurisdiction outside the United States or (ii) any Security Entitlement in respect of a Financial Asset issued by such a foreign legal entity, the relevant Lien Grantor will take all such action as may be required under the laws of such foreign jurisdiction to ensure that the Transaction Lien on such Collateral ranks prior to all Liens and rights of others therein.

SECTION 8 . Controlled Deposit Accounts. Each Lien Grantor represents, warrants and covenants as follows:

(a) Beginning on or prior to the date that is 60 days after the Issue Date, all cash owned by such Lien Grantor will be deposited, upon or promptly after the receipt thereof, in one or more Controlled Deposit Accounts. Each Controlled Deposit Account will be operated as provided in Section 10.

(b) In respect of each Controlled Deposit Account, the Depositary Bank’s jurisdiction (determined as provided in UCC Section 9-304) will at all times be a jurisdiction in which Article 9 of the Uniform Commercial Code is in effect.

(c) So long as the Applicable Agent has Control of a Controlled Deposit Account, the Transaction Lien on such Controlled Deposit Account will be perfected, subject to no prior Liens or rights of others (except the Depositary Bank’s right to deduct its normal operating charges and any uncollected funds previously credited thereto and any other Liens consented to by the Collateral Agent, and Permitted Liens).

(d) Materiality Exception. The Lien Grantors have the right not to comply with the foregoing provisions of this Section with respect to (i) Deposit Accounts that are payroll or trust accounts and (ii) other Deposit Accounts having total collected balances that do not at any time exceed $2,000,000 in the aggregate for all Lien Grantors.

SECTION 9 . Cash Collateral Accounts. (a) The Lien Grantors will establish the following Deposit Accounts (each such Deposit Account, a “ Cash Collateral Account ”), which will be operated as provided in this Section and Section 10:

(i) at or prior to the time such account shall be required in accordance with Section 9(b)(i), the Collection Account, which shall be under the exclusive control of the Collateral Agent (or, if so instructed by

 

22


the Authorized Term Collateral Agent, the Authorized Term Collateral Agent); and

(ii) at or prior to the time such account shall be required in accordance with Section 9(b)(ii), the Term Proceeds Account, which shall be under the control of the Collateral Agent (or the ABL Agent (for the benefit of the Collateral Agent in accordance with the ABL Intercreditor Agreement));

(b) The following amounts shall be deposited into the Cash Collateral Accounts:

(i) the Collateral Agent shall deposit to the Collection Account each amount realized or otherwise received with respect to assets of any Lien Grantor upon any exercise of remedies pursuant to any Security Document; and

(ii) the Lien Grantors shall cause all principal payments made to them on the Foreign Intercompany Receivables Collateral to be deposited to the Term Proceeds Account.

(c) The applicable Lien Grantor shall maintain such records, which it shall provide to the Collateral Agent, and/or establish such sub-accounts as shall be required to enable it to identify the amounts held in the Collection Account from time to time pursuant to subsection (i) of this Section.

(d) The Lien Grantors shall not permit to be deposited to the Term Proceeds Account any amounts that do not constitute Term Priority Collateral.

(e) Unless an Event of Default shall be continuing, the Lien Grantors shall have the right to withdraw funds held in the Term Proceeds Account for their general corporate (or limited liability company) purposes.

(f) Subject to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, if an Event of Default shall be continuing, amounts held in the Collateral Account shall be applied by the Collateral Agent in accordance with the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

SECTION 10 . Operation of Collateral Accounts. (a) Funds held in any Cash Collateral Account may, until withdrawn, be invested and reinvested in such investments as the Issuers shall request from time to time in writing; provided that if an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Collateral Agent (in the case of the Collection Account) or the Applicable Agent (in the case of all other Cash Collateral Accounts) may (but shall not be obligated to) select such investments (it being understood that, notwithstanding the foregoing, funds held in the Cash Collateral Account shall be invested in Temporary Cash Investments

 

23


(as defined in the Indenture)). Funds held in any other Controlled Deposit Account or Controlled Securities Account may, until withdrawn, be invested and reinvested in such investments as the Issuers shall request from time to time; provided that (i) prior to the ABL Termination Date, if a Liquidity Trigger Period shall be continuing or (ii) at all other times, if an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Applicable Agent may (but shall not be obligated to) select such investments. Any investment income received on the Cash Collateral Accounts will be deposited into and become part of the Cash Collateral Accounts.

(b) With respect to each Controlled Deposit Account and each Controlled Securities Account (it being understood that the provisions of Section 9 shall apply to all Cash Collateral Accounts), the relevant Lien Grantor may withdraw, or direct the disposition of, funds held therein unless an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing and the Applicable Agent shall have delivered a notice of exclusive control in accordance with the applicable account control agreement.

(c) If an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Collateral Agent (with respect to the Collection Account) and the Applicable Agent (with respect to any other Collateral Account) may retain or liquidate, or instruct the relevant Securities Intermediary or Depositary Bank to retain or liquidate, any or all cash or investments then held in such Collateral Account and/or withdraw any amounts held therein and apply such amounts as provided in Section 14.

SECTION 11 . Transfer Of Record Ownership. At any time when an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Applicable Agent may (and to the extent that action by it is required, the relevant Lien Grantor, if directed to do so by the Applicable Agent, will as promptly as practicable) cause each of the Pledged Securities (or any portion thereof specified in such direction) to be transferred of record into the name of the Applicable Agent or its nominee. Each Lien Grantor will take any and all actions reasonably requested by the Applicable Agent to facilitate compliance with this Section. If the provisions of this Section are implemented, Section 7(b) shall not thereafter apply to any Pledged Security that is registered in the name of the Applicable Agent or its nominee. The Applicable Agent will promptly give to the relevant Lien Grantor copies of any notices and other communications received by the Applicable Agent with respect to Pledged Securities registered in the name of the Applicable Agent or its nominee.

SECTION 12 . Right to Vote Securities. (a) Unless an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, each Lien Grantor will have the right, from time to time, to vote and to give consents, ratifications and waivers with respect to

 

24


any Pledged Security owned by it and the Financial Asset underlying any Pledged Security Entitlement owned by it, and the Collateral Agent will, upon receiving a written request from such Lien Grantor, deliver to such Lien Grantor or as specified in such request such proxies, powers of attorney, consents, ratifications and waivers in respect of any such Pledged Security that is registered in the name of the Collateral Agent or its nominee or any such Pledged Security Entitlement as to which the Collateral Agent or its nominee is the Entitlement Holder, in each case as shall be specified in such request. Unless an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Applicable Agent will have no right to take any action which the owner of a Pledged Partnership Interest or Pledged LLC Interest is entitled to take with respect thereto, except the right to receive payments and other distributions to the extent provided herein.

(b) If an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Applicable Agent will have the right (but not the obligation), to the extent permitted by law (and, in the case of a Pledged Partnership Interest or Pledged LLC Interest, by the relevant partnership agreement, limited liability company agreement, operating agreement or other governing document), to vote, to give consents, ratifications and waivers and to take any other action with respect to the Pledged Investment Property, the other Pledged Equity Interests (if any) and the Financial Assets underlying the Pledged Security Entitlements, with the same force and effect as if the Applicable Agent were the absolute and sole owner thereof, and each Lien Grantor will take all such action as the Applicable Agent may reasonably request from time to time to give effect to such right.

SECTION 13 . Remedies upon Event of Default. (a) If an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, subject to the Term Intercreditor Agreement, the Collateral Agent may exercise (or cause its sub-agents to exercise) any or all of the remedies available to it (or to such sub-agents) under the Security Documents.

(b) Without limiting the generality of the foregoing and subject to the terms of (i) the Term Intercreditor Agreement and (ii) with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the ABL Intercreditor Agreement, if an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Collateral Agent may exercise on behalf of the Secured Parties all the rights of a secured party under the UCC (whether or not in effect in the jurisdiction where such rights are exercised) with respect to any Personal Property Collateral and, in addition, the Collateral Agent (with respect to the Collection Account) and the Applicable Agent (with respect to any other Collateral Account) may, without being required to give any notice, except as herein provided or as may be required by mandatory provisions of law, withdraw all cash held in such Collateral Account and apply such cash as provided in Section 14 and, if there shall be no such cash or if such cash shall be insufficient to pay all the Secured Obligations in full, sell, lease, license or

 

25


otherwise dispose of the Collateral or any part thereof. Notice of any such sale or other disposition shall be given to the relevant Lien Grantor(s) as required by Section 16. The foregoing provisions of this subsection shall apply to Real Property Collateral only to the extent permitted by applicable law and the provisions of any applicable Mortgage or other document.

(c) Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, if an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, and subject to the terms of (i) the Term Intercreditor Agreement and (ii) with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, the ABL Intercreditor Agreement:

(i) the Collateral Agent may license or sublicense, whether general, special or otherwise, and whether on an exclusive or non-exclusive basis, any Pledged intellectual property (including any Pledged Recordable Intellectual Property) throughout the world for such term or terms, on such conditions and in such manner as the Holders shall in their sole discretion determine and direct the Collateral Agent; provided that such licenses or sublicenses do not conflict with any existing license of which the Collateral Agent shall have received a copy;

(ii) the Collateral Agent may (without assuming any obligation or liability thereunder), at any time and from time to time, as directed by the Holders, enforce (and shall have the exclusive right to enforce) against any licensee or sublicensee all rights and remedies of any Lien Grantor in, to and under any of its Pledged intellectual property and take or refrain from taking any action under any thereof, and each Lien Grantor releases the Collateral Agent and each other Secured Party from liability for, and agrees to hold the Collateral Agent and each other Secured Party free and harmless from and against any claims and expenses arising out of, any lawful action so taken or omitted to be taken with respect thereto, except for claims and expenses arising from the Collateral Agent’s or such Secured Party’s gross negligence or willful misconduct, as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final and non-appealable decision; and

(iii) upon request by the Collateral Agent (which shall not be construed as implying any limitation on its rights or powers), each Lien Grantor will execute and deliver to the Collateral Agent a power of attorney, in form and substance satisfactory to appoint the Collateral Agent as attorney-in-fact, for the implementation of any sale, lease, license or other disposition of any of such Lien Grantor’s Pledged intellectual property or any action related thereto. In connection with any such disposition, but subject to any confidentiality restrictions imposed on such Lien Grantor in any license or similar agreement, such Lien Grantor

 

26


will supply to the Collateral Agent its know-how and expertise relating to the relevant intellectual property or the products or services made or rendered in connection with such intellectual property, and its customer lists and other records relating to such intellectual property and to the distribution of said products or services.

SECTION 14 . Application of Proceeds. (a)   If an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, (i) any cash held in the Collection Account and (ii) subject to the terms of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement with respect to each Type of Common Collateral, any amounts held in any other Collateral Account and the proceeds of any sale or other disposition of all or any part of the Collateral, shall be applied by the Collateral Agent in accordance with Section 2.01 of the Term Intercreditor Agreement, provided that (i) Collateral owned by a Subsidiary Guarantor and any proceeds thereof shall be applied pursuant to the foregoing clauses only to the extent that the value thereof does not exceed the largest amount that would not render the Note Guarantee of such Subsidiary Guarantor subject to avoidance under Section 548 of the United States Bankruptcy Code or any comparable provisions of applicable law. The Collateral Agent may make such distributions hereunder in cash or in kind or, on a ratable basis, in any combination thereof.

(b) If at any time any portion of any monies collected or received by the Collateral Agent would, but for the provisions of this Section 14(b), be payable pursuant to Section 14(a) in respect of a Contingent Secured Obligation, the Collateral Agent shall not apply any monies to pay such Contingent Secured Obligation but instead shall request the holder thereof, at least 10 days before each proposed distribution hereunder, to notify the Collateral Agent in writing as to the maximum amount of such Contingent Secured Obligation if then ascertainable. If the holder of such Contingent Secured Obligation does not notify the Collateral Agent in writing of the maximum ascertainable amount thereof at least two Business Days before such distribution, such holder will not be entitled to share in such distribution. If such holder does so notify the Collateral Agent in writing as to the maximum ascertainable amount thereof, the Collateral Agent will allocate to such holder a portion of the monies to be distributed in such distribution, calculated as if such Contingent Secured Obligation were outstanding in such maximum ascertainable amount. However, the Collateral Agent will not apply such portion of such monies to pay such Contingent Secured Obligation, but instead will hold such monies. All such monies and all proceeds thereof will constitute Collateral hereunder, but will be subject to distribution in accordance with this Section 14(b) rather than Section 14(a). The Collateral Agent will hold all such monies and the net proceeds thereof in trust until all or part of such Contingent Secured Obligation becomes a Non-Contingent Secured Obligation, whereupon the Collateral Agent at the request of the relevant Secured Party will apply the amount so held in trust to pay such Non-Contingent Secured Obligation.

 

27


If (i) the holder of such Contingent Secured Obligation shall advise the Collateral Agent that no portion thereof remains in the category of a Contingent Secured Obligation and (ii) the Collateral Agent still holds any amount held in trust pursuant to this Section 14(b) in respect of such Contingent Secured Obligation (after paying all amounts payable pursuant to the preceding sentence with respect to any portions thereof that became Non-Contingent Secured Obligations), such remaining amount will be applied by the Collateral Agent in the order of priorities set forth in Section 14(a).

(c) In making the payments and allocations required by this Section, the Collateral Agent may rely upon information supplied to it pursuant to Section 18(c). All distributions made by the Collateral Agent pursuant to this Section shall be final (except in the event of manifest error) and the Collateral Agent shall have no duty to inquire as to the application by any Secured Party of any amount distributed to it.

SECTION 15 . Fees and Expenses; Indemnification. (a)   The Issuers and the Subsidiary Guarantors, jointly and severally, will forthwith upon demand pay to the Collateral Agent and the Authorized Term Collateral Agent:

(i) the amount of any taxes that the Collateral Agent and the Authorized Term Collateral Agent may have been required to pay by reason of the Transaction Liens or to free any Collateral from any other Lien thereon;

(ii) the amount of any and all reasonable out-of-pocket expenses, including transfer taxes and reasonable fees and expenses of counsel, professional advisors and other experts, that the Collateral Agent and the Authorized Term Collateral Agent may incur in connection with (x) the administration or enforcement of the Security Documents, including such expenses as are incurred to preserve the value of the Collateral or the validity, perfection, rank or value of any Transaction Lien, (y) the collection, sale or other disposition of any Collateral or (z) the exercise by the Collateral Agent and the Authorized Term Collateral Agent of any of its rights or powers under the Security Documents;

(iii) the amount of any fees that the Issuers shall have agreed in writing to pay to the Collateral Agent and the Authorized Term Collateral Agent and that shall have become due and payable in accordance with such written agreement; and

(iv) the amount required to indemnify the Collateral Agent and the Authorized Term Collateral Agent and their directors, officers, agents, counsel and employees (collectively, the “ Indemnitees ”) for, or hold them

 

28


harmless and defend them against, any loss, liability or expense (including the reasonable fees and expenses of their counsel, professional advisors and any experts or sub-agents appointed by them hereunder) incurred or suffered by the Indemnitees or any of them in connection with the Security Documents, except to the extent that such loss, liability or expense arises from the Collateral Agent’s or the Authorized Term Collateral Agent’s (as the case may be) gross negligence or willful misconduct or a breach of any duty that the Collateral Agent or the Authorized Term Collateral Agent (as the case may be) has under this Agreement (after giving effect to Sections 17 and 18), as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final and non-appealable decision.

Any such amount not paid to the Collateral Agent or the Authorized Term Collateral Agent on demand will bear interest for each day thereafter until paid at a rate per annum equal to the sum of 2% plus the rate applicable to the Secured Notes for such day.

(b) If any transfer tax, documentary stamp tax or other tax is payable in connection with any transfer or other transaction provided for in the Security Documents, the Issuers will pay such tax and provide any required tax stamps to the Collateral Agent and the Authorized Term Collateral Agent or as otherwise required by law.

SECTION 16 . Authority to Administer Collateral. Each Lien Grantor irrevocably appoints the Collateral Agent its true and lawful attorney, with full power of substitution, in the name of such Lien Grantor, any Secured Party or otherwise, for the sole use and benefit of the Secured Parties, but at the Issuers’ expense, to the extent permitted by law to exercise, at any time and from time to time while an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, all or any of the following powers with respect to all or any of such Lien Grantor’s Collateral:

(a) to demand, sue for, collect, receive and give acquittance for any and all monies due or to become due upon or by virtue thereof,

(b) to settle, compromise, compound, prosecute or defend any action or proceeding with respect thereto,

(c) to sell, lease, license or otherwise dispose of the same or the proceeds or avails thereof, as fully and effectually as if the Collateral Agent were the absolute owner thereof, and

(d) to extend the time of payment of any or all thereof and to make any allowance or other adjustment with reference thereto;

 

29


provided that, except in the case of Personal Property Collateral that is perishable or threatens to decline speedily in value or is of a type customarily sold on a recognized market, the Collateral Agent will give the relevant Lien Grantor at least ten days’ prior written notice of the time and place of any public sale thereof or the time after which any private sale or other intended disposition thereof will be made. Any such notice shall (i) contain the information specified in UCC Section 9-613, (ii) be Authenticated and (iii) be sent to the parties required to be notified pursuant to UCC Section 9-611(c); provided that, if the Collateral Agent fails to comply with this sentence in any respect, its liability for such failure shall be limited to the liability (if any) imposed on it as a matter of law under the UCC.

SECTION 17 . Limitation on Duty in Respect of Collateral. Beyond the exercise of reasonable care in the custody and preservation thereof, the Collateral Agent will have no duty as to any Collateral in its possession or control or in the possession or control of any sub-agent or bailee or any income therefrom or as to the preservation of rights against prior parties or any other rights pertaining thereto. The Collateral Agent will be deemed to have exercised reasonable care in the custody and preservation of the Collateral in its possession or control if such Collateral is accorded treatment substantially equal to that which it accords its own property, and will not be liable or responsible for any loss or damage to any Collateral, or for any diminution in the value thereof, by reason of any act or omission of any sub-agent or bailee selected by the Collateral Agent in good faith, except to the extent that such liability arises from the Collateral Agent’s gross negligence or willful misconduct, as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final and non-appealable decision.

SECTION 18 . General Provisions Concerning the Collateral Agent.

(a) The provisions of Section 10.04 of the Indenture shall inure to the benefit of the Collateral Agent, and shall be binding upon all Lien Grantors and all Secured Parties, in connection with this Agreement and the other Security Documents. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, (i) the Collateral Agent shall not be subject to any fiduciary or other implied duties, regardless of whether an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, (ii) the Collateral Agent shall not have any duty to take any discretionary action or exercise any discretionary powers, except discretionary rights and powers expressly contemplated by the Security Documents that the Collateral Agent is required in writing to exercise by the required percentage of Holders of the Secured Notes as provided for in the Indenture and (iii) except as expressly set forth in the Indenture, the Collateral Agent shall not have any duty to disclose, and shall not be liable for any failure to disclose, any information relating to any Group Member that is communicated to or obtained by the Collateral Agent or any of its Affiliates in any capacity. The Collateral Agent shall not be responsible for the existence, genuineness or value of any Collateral or for the validity, perfection,

 

30


continuation, priority or enforceability of any Transaction Lien, including without limitation the filing, form, content or renewal of UCC financing statements, Mortgages or similar documents or instruments, whether impaired by operation of law or by reason of any action or omission to act on its part under the Security Documents. The Collateral Agent shall be deemed not to have knowledge of any Event of Default unless and until written notice thereof is given to the Collateral Agent by a Lien Grantor or a Secured Party.

(b) Sub- Agents and Related Parties . The Collateral Agent may perform any of its duties and exercise any of its rights and powers through one or more sub-agents appointed by it and shall not be responsible for the negligence of such sub-agents appointed with reasonable care. The Collateral Agent and any such sub-agent may perform any of its duties and exercise any of its rights and powers through its Related Parties. The exculpatory provisions of Section 17 and this Section shall apply to any such sub-agent and to the Related Parties of the Collateral Agent and any such sub-agent.

(c) Information as to Secured Obligations and Actions by Secured Parties. For all purposes of the Security Documents, including determining the amounts of the Secured Obligations and whether a Secured Obligation is a Contingent Secured Obligation or not, or whether any action has been taken under any Secured Agreement, the Collateral Agent will be entitled to rely on information from (i) its own records for information as to the Holders of the Secured Notes, their Secured Obligations and actions taken by them, (ii) any Secured Party for information as to its Secured Obligations and actions taken by it, to the extent that the Collateral Agent has not obtained such information from its own records, and (iii) the Issuers, to the extent that the Collateral Agent has not obtained information from the foregoing sources.

(d) Refusal to Act. The Collateral Agent may refuse to act on any notice, consent, direction or instruction from any Secured Parties or any agent, trustee or similar representative thereof that, in the Collateral Agent’s opinion, (i) is contrary to law or the provisions of any Security Document, (ii) may expose the Collateral Agent to liability (unless the Collateral Agent shall have been indemnified, to its satisfaction, for such liability by the Secured Parties (other than the Collateral Agent or Trustee) that gave such notice, consent, direction or instruction) or (iii) is unduly prejudicial to Secured Parties not joining in such notice, consent, direction or instruction.

(e) Insurance Proceeds . Subject to the terms of the Term Intercreditor Agreement and unless an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Collateral Agent will turn over to the relevant Lien Grantor any proceeds of any casualty or liability insurance maintained by the Lien Grantors and as to which the Collateral Agent has been named as an additional insured or loss payee,

 

31


such funds to be used by the Lien Grantors in accordance with the terms of the Indenture.

SECTION 19 . Termination of Transaction Liens; Release of Collateral. (a) Subject to the Term Intercreditor Agreement, the Transaction Liens on the Collateral of a Lien Grantor shall terminate and shall be released:

(i) to the extent such Collateral is taken by eminent domain, condemnation or other similar circumstances;

(ii) with respect to all or any portion of the Collateral of any Lien Grantor, upon the election of the Issuers following the Suspension Date;

(iii) with respect to all of the Collateral of each Lien Grantor, upon (a) satisfaction and discharge of the Indenture (as described therein) or (b) a legal defeasance or covenant defeasance of the Indenture (as described therein);

(iv) to the extent such Collateral (a) is sold, transferred or otherwise disposed of by the Issuers or any Subsidiary Guarantor (other than to Holdco, the Issuers or a Restricted Subsidiary) in a transaction not prohibited by the Indenture at the time of such sale, transfer or disposition or (b) is owned by a Subsidiary Guarantor that has been released from its Subsidiary Guarantee in accordance with the Indenture, concurrently with the release of such Subsidiary Guarantee;

(v) with respect to all or any portion of the Collateral of any Lien Grantor, with the consent of the Holders of the requisite percentage of Secured Notes in accordance with the provisions of the Indenture;

(vi) with respect to all or any portion of the Collateral of any Lien Grantor that is Common Collateral and constitutes ABL Priority Collateral, in the circumstances set forth in Section 4.2(a) of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement;

(vii) with respect to all or any portion of the Collateral of any Lien Grantor, in the circumstances set forth in the Term Intercreditor Agreement;

(viii) with respect to all of the Collateral of any Subsidiary Guarantor, upon the release of the Subsidiary Guarantee of such Subsidiary Guarantor in accordance with the Indenture; and

 

32


(ix) with respect to all or any portion of the Collateral of any Lien Grantor, in the circumstances set forth in Section 2.04(a) or 2.04(b) of the Term Intercreditor Agreement.

(b) The Transaction Liens shall terminate in accordance with clause (iii) of Section 19(a); provided , that if at any time any payment of a Secured Obligation is rescinded or must be otherwise restored or returned upon the insolvency or receivership of either Issuers or otherwise, the Transaction Liens shall be reinstated automatically and without any further action on the part of any Person (and the Lien Grantors shall take all action reasonably requested by the Collateral Agent to evidence such reinstatement).

(c) If after the release of any Collateral in accordance with clause (ii) of Section 19(a) the Reversion Date shall occur, the Transaction Liens on such Collateral shall be reinstated automatically and without any further action on the part of any Person (and the applicable Lien Grantors shall take all action reasonably requested by the Collateral Agent to evidence such reinstatement).

(d) Upon any termination of a Transaction Lien or release of Collateral, the Collateral Agent will, at the expense of the relevant Lien Grantor and upon receipt of a certificate of a Financial Officer of Holdco certifying that such Transaction Lien may be terminated or such Collateral may be released in accordance herewith, execute and deliver to such Lien Grantor such documents as such Lien Grantor shall reasonably request to evidence the termination of such Transaction Lien or the release of such Collateral, as the case may be.

SECTION 20 . Additional Lien Grantors. Any Subsidiary may become a party hereto by signing and delivering to the Collateral Agent a Security Agreement Supplement, whereupon such Subsidiary shall become a “Lien Grantor” as defined herein.

SECTION 21 . Notices. Each notice, request or other communication given to any party hereunder shall be given or made in accordance with Section 12.03 of the Indenture.

SECTION 22 . No Implied Waivers; Remedies Not Exclusive. No failure by the Collateral Agent or any Secured Party to exercise, and no delay in exercising and no course of dealing with respect to, any right or remedy under any Security Document shall operate as a waiver thereof; nor shall any single or partial exercise by the Collateral Agent or any Secured Party of any right or remedy under any Secured Notes Document preclude any other or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right or remedy. The rights and remedies specified in the Secured Notes Documents are cumulative and are not exclusive of any other rights or remedies provided by law.

 

33


SECTION 23 . Successors and Assigns. This Agreement is for the benefit of the Collateral Agent and the Secured Parties. If all or any part of any Secured Party’s interest in any Secured Obligation is assigned or otherwise transferred in a transaction permitted under the Indenture, the transferor’s rights hereunder, to the extent applicable to the obligation so transferred, shall be automatically transferred with such obligation. This Agreement shall be binding on the Lien Grantors and their respective successors and assigns.

SECTION 24 . Amendments and Waivers. Neither this Agreement nor any provision hereof may be waived, amended, modified or terminated except pursuant to an agreement or agreements in writing entered into by the Collateral Agent, with the consent of such Holders as are required to consent thereto under Article 9 of the Indenture. No such waiver, amendment or modification shall be binding upon any Lien Grantor, except with the written consent of the Issuers.

SECTION 25 . Choice of Law. This Agreement shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of New York, except as otherwise required by mandatory provisions of law and except to the extent that remedies provided by the laws of any jurisdiction other than the State of New York are governed by the laws of such jurisdiction.

SECTION 26 . Waiver of Jury Trial. EACH PARTY HERETO HEREBY IRREVOCABLY WAIVES ALL RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY IN ANY ACTION, PROCEEDING OR COUNTERCLAIM ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO ANY OF THE SECURED NOTES DOCUMENTS OR THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED THEREBY. EACH PARTY HERETO (A) CERTIFIES THAT NO REPRESENTATIVE, AGENT OR ATTORNEY OF ANY OTHER PARTY HAS REPRESENTED, EXPRESSLY OR OTHERWISE, THAT SUCH OTHER PARTY WOULD NOT, IN THE EVENT OF LITIGATION, SEEK TO ENFORCE THE FOREGOING WAIVER AND (B) ACKNOWLEDGES THAT IT AND THE OTHER PARTIES HERETO HAVE BEEN INDUCED TO ENTER INTO THIS AGREEMENT BY, AMONG OTHER THINGS, THE MUTUAL WAIVERS AND CERTIFICATIONS IN THIS SECTION.

SECTION 27 . Severability. Any provision of any Security Document held to be invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any jurisdiction shall, as to such jurisdiction, be ineffective to the extent of such invalidity, illegality or unenforceability without affecting the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions thereof; and the invalidity of a particular provision in a particular jurisdiction shall not invalidate such provision in any other jurisdiction.

SECTION 28 . Indenture, Security Agreements. In the event of any conflict or inconsistency between the provisions of the Indenture and this Agreement but

 

34


subject to Section 30, the provisions of the Indenture shall govern and control. In the event of any conflict or inconsistency between the provisions of the other Security Documents and this Agreement but subject to Section 30, the provisions of this Agreement shall govern and control.

SECTION 29 . Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts by the parties hereto on separate counterparts, each of which, when so executed and delivered, shall be deemed an original, but all such counterparts shall together constitute one and the same instrument. Delivery of an executed counterpart of a signature page of this Agreement by telecopier or electronic image scan transmission (such as a “pdf” file) will be effective as delivery of a manually executed counterpart of this Agreement.

SECTION 30 . Intercreditor Agreements. Reference is made to the ABL Intercreditor Agreement and the Term Intercreditor Agreement. Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, the lien and security interest granted to the Collateral Agent, for the benefit of the Secured Parties, pursuant to this Agreement and the exercise of any right or remedy by the Collateral Agent and the other Secured Parties hereunder are subject to the provisions of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement and the Term Intercreditor Agreement. In the event of any conflict or inconsistency between the provisions of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement or the Term Intercreditor Agreement, on the one hand, and this Agreement, on the other hand, the provisions of the ABL Intercreditor Agreement or the Term Intercreditor Agreement, as applicable, shall control.

 

35


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Agreement to be duly executed by their respective authorized officers as of the day and year first above written.

 

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS USA, LLC, as an Issuer

By:  

/s/ Mike Rajkovic

  Name:   Mike Rajkovic
  Title:   Vice President
TA HOLDINGS FINANCE, INC., as an Issuer
By:  

/s/ Mike Rajkovic

  Name:   Mike Rajkovic
  Title:   Vice President

 


Subsidiary Guarantors:
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS I, LLC
By:  

/s/ Mike Rajkovic

  Name:   Mike Rajkovic
  Title:   Vice President
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS II(a), LLC
By:  

/s/ Mike Rajkovic

  Name:   Mike Rajkovic
  Title:   Vice President
TOWER AUTOMOTIVE HOLDINGS II(b), LLC
By:  

/s/ Mike Rajkovic

  Name:   Mike Rajkovic
  Title:   Vice President

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS USA I, LLC

By:  

/s/ Mike Rajkovic

  Name:   Mike Rajkovic
  Title:   Vice President

TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS USA II, LLC

By:  

/s/ Mike Rajkovic

  Name:   Mike Rajkovic
  Title:   Vice President

 


TOWER AUTOMOTIVE OPERATIONS USA III, LLC

By:  

/s/ Mike Rajkovic

  Name:   Mike Rajkovic
  Title:   Vice President


WILMINGTON TRUST FSB, as Collateral Agent and in its capacity as Authorized Term Collateral Agent as of the date hereof

By:  

/s/ Michael G. Oller, Jr.

  Name:   Michael G. Oller, Jr.
  Title:   Assistant Vice President


SCHEDULE 1

EQUITY INTERESTS IN SUBSIDIARIES AND AFFILIATES

OWNED BY ORIGINAL LIEN GRANTORS

(as of the Issue Date)

 

Issuer

  

Jurisdiction

of

Organization

  

Owner of

Equity Interest

  

Percentage

Owned

  

Number of

Shares or Units

Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC    Delaware    Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC    100%    All the membership interests
Tower Automotive Holdings II(a), LLC    Delaware    Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC    100%    All the membership interests
Tower Automotive Holdings II(b), LLC    Delaware    Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC    100%    All the membership interests
Tower Automotive Operations USA I, LLC    Delaware    Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC    100%    All the membership interests
Tower Automotive Operations USA II, LLC    Delaware    Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC    100%    All the membership interests
Tower Automotive Operations USA III, LLC    Delaware    Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC    100%    All the membership interests
TA Holdings Finance, Inc.    Delaware    Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC    100%    All the capital stock
Tower Automotive Holdings III CoOperatie U.A.    The Netherlands    Tower Automotive Holdings II(a), LLC    99%    Member account contribution
      Tower Automotive Holdings II(b), LLC    1%    Member account contribution

 

S-1-1


SCHEDULE 2

INVESTMENT PROPERTY

(other than Equity Interests in Subsidiaries and Affiliates)

OWNED BY ORIGINAL LIEN GRANTORS

(as of the Issue Date)

PART 1 — Securities

 

Issuer

  

Jurisdiction

of

Organization

  

Owner of Securities

  

Amount

Owned

  

Type of

Security

None.

           

PART 2 — Securities Accounts

The Original Lien Grantors own Security Entitlements with respect to Financial Assets credited to the following Securities Accounts:

 

Owner

  

Securities

Intermediary

  

Account Number

None.

     

 

S-2-1


SCHEDULE 3

REAL PROPERTIES TO BE MORTGAGED

1. 850 Withrow Court, Bardstown, KY (Nelson County)

2. 81 Drettman Dr., Elkton, MI (Huron County)

3. 630/640 Southwest St, Bellevue, OH (Sandusky County)

4. 6305 St. Louis St., Meridian, MS (Lauderdale County)

 

S-3-1


EXHIBIT A

to Security Agreement

SECURITY AGREEMENT SUPPLEMENT

SECURITY AGREEMENT SUPPLEMENT dated as of              ,          , between [NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR] (the “ Lien Grantor ”) and WILMINGTON TRUST FSB, as Collateral Agent.

WHEREAS, Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, TA Holdings Finance, Inc., the Subsidiary Guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, as Collateral Agent, are parties to a Notes Security Agreement dated as of August 24, 2010 (as heretofore amended and/or supplemented, the “ Security Agreement ”) under which Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc. secure certain of their obligations (the “ Secured Obligations ”) and the Subsidiary Guarantors party thereto secure their respective guarantees of the Secured Obligations;

WHEREAS, [name of Lien Grantor] has executed a Joinder Agreement and become a Subsidiary Guarantor;

WHEREAS, [name of Lien Grantor] desires to become [is] a party to the Security Agreement as a Lien Grantor thereunder; 1 and

WHEREAS, terms defined in the Security Agreement (or whose definitions are incorporated by reference in Section 1 of the Security Agreement) and not otherwise defined herein have, as used herein, the respective meanings provided for therein;

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing and other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto agree as follows:

1. Grant of Transaction Liens . (a) In order to secure [its Note Guarantee] 2 [the Secured Obligations] 3 , the Lien Grantor grants to the Collateral

 

1 If the Lien Grantor is an Issuer, delete this recital and Section 1 hereof.
2 Delete bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is an Issuer.
3 Delete bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is a Subsidiary Guarantor.

 

A-1


Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties a continuing security interest in all the following property of the Lien Grantor, whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising and regardless of where located (the “ New Collateral ”):

[describe property being added to the Collateral] 4

(b) With respect to each right to payment or performance included in the Collateral from time to time, the Transaction Lien granted therein includes a continuing security interest in (i) any Supporting Obligation that supports such payment or performance and (ii) any Lien that (x) secures such right to payment or performance or (y) secures any such Supporting Obligation.

(c) The foregoing Transaction Liens are granted as security only and shall not subject the Collateral Agent or any other Secured Party to, or transfer or in any way affect or modify, any obligation or liability of the Lien Grantor with respect to any of the New Collateral or any transaction in connection therewith.

2. Delivery of Collateral . Concurrently with delivering this Security Agreement Supplement to the Collateral Agent, the Lien Grantor is complying with the provisions of Section 7 of the Security Agreement with respect to Investment Property, in each case if and to the extent included in the New Collateral at such time.

3. Party to Security Agreement . Upon delivering this Security Agreement Supplement to the Collateral Agent, the Lien Grantor will become a party to the Security Agreement and will thereafter have all the rights and obligations of a Subsidiary Guarantor and a Lien Grantor thereunder and be bound by all the provisions thereof as fully as if the Lien Grantor were one of the original parties thereto. 5

4. Address of Lien Grantor . The address, facsimile number and e-mail address of the Lien Grantor are:

[address, facsimile number and e-mail address of Lien Grantor]

 

4 If the Lien Grantor is not already a party to the Security Agreement, clauses (i) through (xi) of, and the proviso to, Section 2(a) of the Security Agreement may be appropriate.
5 Delete Section 3 if the Lien Grantor is already a party to the Security Agreement.

 

A-2


5. Representations and Warranties . (a) The Lien Grantor is duly organized, validly existing and in good standing under the laws of [jurisdiction of organization].

(b) The Lien Grantor has delivered a Perfection Certificate to the Collateral Agent. The information set forth therein is correct and complete as of the date hereof.

(c) The execution and delivery of this Security Agreement Supplement by the Lien Grantor and the performance by it of its obligations under the Security Agreement as supplemented hereby are within its corporate or other powers, have been duly authorized by all necessary corporate or other action, require no action by or in respect of, or filing with, any governmental body, agency or official and do not contravene, or constitute a default under, any provision of applicable law or regulation or of its organizational documents, or of any agreement, judgment, injunction, order, decree or other instrument binding upon it or result in the creation or imposition of any Lien (except a Transaction Lien) on any of its assets.

(d) The Security Agreement as supplemented hereby constitutes a valid and binding agreement of the Lien Grantor, enforceable in accordance with its terms, except as limited by (i) applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, fraudulent conveyance or other similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally and (ii) general principles of equity.

(e) Each of the representations and warranties set forth in Sections 3 through 11 of the Security Agreement is true as applied to the Lien Grantor and the New Collateral. For purposes of the foregoing sentence, references in said Sections to a “Lien Grantor” shall be deemed to refer to the Lien Grantor, references to Schedules to the Security Agreement shall be deemed to refer to the corresponding Schedules to this Security Agreement Supplement, references to “Collateral” shall be deemed to refer to the New Collateral, and references to the “Issue Date” shall be deemed to refer to the date on which the Lien Grantor signs and delivers this Security Agreement Supplement.

6. [ Compliance with Foreign Law . The Lien Grantor represents that it has taken, and agrees that it will continue to take, all actions required under the laws (including the conflict of laws rules) of its jurisdiction of organization to

 

A-3


ensure that the Transaction Liens on the New Collateral rank prior to all Liens and rights of others therein. 6 ]

7. Governing Law . This Security Agreement Supplement shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of New York.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Security Agreement Supplement to be duly executed by their respective authorized officers as of the day and year first above written.

 

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
WILMINGTON TRUST FSB, as Collateral Agent
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

6 Include Section 6 if the Lien Grantor is organized under the laws of a jurisdiction outside the United States.

 

A-4


Schedule 1

to Security Agreement

Supplement

EQUITY INTERESTS IN SUBSIDIARIES AND AFFILIATES

OWNED BY LIEN GRANTOR

 

Issuer

  

Jurisdiction

of

Organization

  

Percentage

Owned

  

Number of

Shares or Units

        
        
        
        
        

 

A-5


Schedule 2

to Security Agreement

Supplement

INVESTMENT PROPERTY

(other than Equity Interests in Subsidiaries and Affiliates)

OWNED BY LIEN GRANTOR

PART 1 — Securities

 

Issuer

  

Jurisdiction

of

Organization

  

Amount

Owned

  

Type of

Security

        
        
        
        
        

PART 2 — Securities Accounts

The Lien Grantor owns Security Entitlements with respect to Financial Assets credited to the following Securities Accounts:

 

Securities Intermediary

  

Account Number

  
  
  
  
  

 

A-6


EXHIBIT B

to Security Agreement

COPYRIGHT SECURITY AGREEMENT

(Copyrights, Copyright Registrations, Copyright

Applications and Copyright Licenses)

WHEREAS, [name of Lien Grantor], a                      corporation 1 (herein referred to as the “ Lien Grantor ”) owns, or in the case of licenses is a party to, the Copyright Collateral (as defined below);

WHEREAS, Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc. (collectively, the “Issuers”), Tower Automotive, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(a), LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(b), LLC, the other guarantors and lenders party thereto, and Wilmington Trust FSB, as trustee and collateral agent, are parties to that certain Senior Debt Securities Indenture dated as of August 24, 2010 (as amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time, the “ Indenture ”); and

WHEREAS, pursuant to (i) a Notes Security Agreement dated as of August 24, 2010 (as amended and/or supplemented from time to time, the “ Security Agreement ”) among the Issuers, the guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, as collateral agent for the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, together with its successors in such capacity, the “ Grantee ”), and (ii) certain other secured notes documents (including this Copyright Security Agreement), the Lien Grantor has [secured certain of its obligations (the “ Secured Obligations ”)] 2 [guaranteed certain obligations of the Issuers and secured such guarantee (the “ Lien Grantor’s Note Guarantee ”)] 3 by granting to the Grantee for the benefit of such Secured Parties a continuing security interest in personal property of the Lien Grantor, including all right, title and interest of the Lien Grantor in, to and under the Copyright Collateral (as defined below);

 

1

Modify as needed if the Lien Grantor is not a corporation.

2

Delete these bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is a Subsidiary Guarantor.

3

Delete these bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is an Issuer.

 

B-1


NOW, THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the Lien Grantor grants to the Grantee, to secure the [Secured Obligations] [Lien Grantor’s Note Guarantee], a continuing security interest in all of the Lien Grantor’s right, title and interest in, to and under the following (all of the following items or types of property being herein collectively referred to as the “ Copyright Collateral ”), whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising:

(i) each Copyright (as defined in the Security Agreement) owned by the Lien Grantor, including, without limitation, each Copyright registration or application therefor referred to in Schedule 1 hereto;

(ii) each Copyright License (as defined in the Security Agreement) to which the Lien Grantor is a party, including, without limitation, each Copyright License identified in Schedule 1 hereto; and

(iii) all proceeds of, revenues from, and accounts and general intangibles arising out of, the foregoing, including, without limitation, all proceeds of and revenues from any claim by the Lien Grantor against third parties for past, present or future infringement of any Copyright (including, without limitation, any Copyright owned by the Lien Grantor and identified in Schedule 1), and all rights and benefits of the Lien Grantor under any Copyright License (including, without limitation, any Copyright License identified in Schedule 1).

The Lien Grantor irrevocably constitutes and appoints the Grantee and any officer or agent thereof, with full power of substitution, as its true and lawful attorney-in-fact with full power and authority in the name of the Lien Grantor or in the Grantee’s name, from time to time, in the Grantee’s discretion, so long as any Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, to take with respect to the Copyright Collateral any and all appropriate action which the Lien Grantor might take with respect to the Copyright Collateral and to execute any and all documents and instruments which may be necessary or desirable to carry out the terms of this Copyright Security Agreement and to accomplish the purposes hereof.

Except to the extent expressly permitted in the Security Agreement or the Indenture, the Lien Grantor agrees not to sell, license, exchange, assign or otherwise transfer or dispose of, or grant any rights with respect to, or mortgage or otherwise encumber, any of the Copyright Collateral.

The foregoing security interest is granted in conjunction with the security interests granted by the Lien Grantor to the Grantee pursuant to the Security Agreement. The Lien Grantor acknowledges and affirms that the rights and

 

B-2


remedies of the Grantee with respect to the security interest in the Copyright Collateral granted hereby are more fully set forth in the Security Agreement, the terms and provisions of which are incorporated by reference herein as if fully set forth herein.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Lien Grantor has caused this Copyright Security Agreement to be duly executed by its officer thereunto duly authorized as of the      day of              ,          .

 

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

Acknowledged:

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB,

as Collateral Agent

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

B-3


STATE OF                         )
      ) ss.:
COUNTY OF                         )

I,                      , a Notary Public in and for said County, in the State aforesaid, DO HEREBY CERTIFY, that                      ,                      of [NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR] (the “ Company ”), personally known to me to be the same person whose name is subscribed to the foregoing instrument as such                      , appeared before me this day in person and acknowledged that (s)he signed, executed and delivered the said instrument as her/his own free and voluntary act and as the free and voluntary act of said Company, for the uses and purposes therein set forth being duly authorized so to do.

GIVEN under my hand and Notarial Seal this      day of              ,          .

 

[Seal]    

 

Signature of notary public    
My Commission expires  

 

 

 

B-4


Schedule 1

to Copyright

Security Agreement

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]

COPYRIGHT REGISTRATIONS

 

Registration No.

  

Registration Date

  

Title

  

Expiration

Date

        
        
        
        
        

COPYRIGHT APPLICATIONS

 

Case No.

  

Serial No.

  

Country

  

Date

  

Filing Title

           
           
           
           
           

COPYRIGHT LICENSES

 

Name of

Agreement

  

Parties

Licensor/Licensee

  

Date of

Agreement

  

Subject

Matter

        
        
        
        
        

 

B-5


EXHIBIT C

to Security Agreement

PATENT SECURITY AGREEMENT

(Patents, Patent Applications and Patent Licenses)

WHEREAS, [name of Lien Grantor], a                      corporation 1 (herein referred to as the “ Lien Grantor ”) owns, or in the case of licenses is a party to, the Patent Collateral (as defined below);

WHEREAS, Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc. (collectively, the “Issuers”), Tower Automotive, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(a), LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(b), LLC, the other guarantors and lenders party thereto, and Wilmington Trust FSB, as trustee and collateral agent, are parties to that certain Senior Debt Securities Indenture dated as of August 24, 2010 (as amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time, the “ Indenture ”); and

WHEREAS, pursuant to (i) a Notes Security Agreement dated as of August 24, 2010 (as amended and/or supplemented from time to time, the “ Security Agreement ”) among the Issuers, the guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, as collateral agent for the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, together with its successors in such capacity, the “ Grantee ”), and (ii) certain other secured notes documents (including this Patent Security Agreement), the Lien Grantor has [secured certain of its obligations (the “ Secured Obligations ”)] 2 [guaranteed certain obligations of the Issuers and secured such guarantee (the “ Lien Grantor’s Note Guarantee ”)] 3 by granting to the Grantee for the benefit of such Secured Parties a continuing security interest in personal property of the Lien Grantor, including all right, title and interest of the Lien Grantor in, to and under the Patent Collateral (as defined below);

NOW, THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the Lien Grantor grants to the

 

1

Modify as needed if the Lien Grantor is not a corporation.

2

Delete these bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is a Subsidiary Guarantor.

3

Delete these bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is an Issuer.

 

C-1


Grantee, to secure the [Secured Obligations] [Lien Grantor’s Note Guarantee], a continuing security interest in all of the Lien Grantor’s right, title and interest in, to and under the following (all of the following items or types of property being herein collectively referred to as the “ Patent Collateral ”), whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising:

(i) each Patent (as defined in the Security Agreement) owned by the Lien Grantor, including, without limitation, each Patent referred to in Schedule 1 hereto;

(ii) each Patent License (as defined in the Security Agreement) to which the Lien Grantor is a party, including, without limitation, each Patent License identified in Schedule 1 hereto; and

(iii) all proceeds of and revenues from the foregoing, including, without limitation, all proceeds of and revenues from any claim by the Lien Grantor against third parties for past, present or future infringement of any Patent owned by the Lien Grantor (including, without limitation, any Patent identified in Schedule 1 hereto) and all rights and benefits of the Lien Grantor under any Patent License (including, without limitation, any Patent License identified in Schedule 1 hereto).

The Lien Grantor irrevocably constitutes and appoints the Grantee and any officer or agent thereof, with full power of substitution, as its true and lawful attorney-in-fact with full power and authority in the name of the Lien Grantor or in the Grantee’s name, from time to time, in the Grantee’s discretion, so long as any Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, to take with respect to the Patent Collateral any and all appropriate action which the Lien Grantor might take with respect to the Patent Collateral and to execute any and all documents and instruments which may be necessary or desirable to carry out the terms of this Patent Security Agreement and to accomplish the purposes hereof.

Except to the extent expressly permitted in the Security Agreement or the Indenture, the Lien Grantor agrees not to sell, license, exchange, assign or otherwise transfer or dispose of, or grant any rights with respect to, or mortgage or otherwise encumber, any of the Patent Collateral.

The foregoing security interest is granted in conjunction with the security interests granted by the Lien Grantor to the Grantee pursuant to the Security Agreement. The Lien Grantor acknowledges and affirms that the rights and remedies of the Grantee with respect to the security interest in the Patent Collateral granted hereby are more fully set forth in the Security Agreement, the terms and provisions of which are incorporated by reference herein as if fully set forth herein.

 

C-2


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Lien Grantor has caused this Patent Security Agreement to be duly executed by its officer thereunto duly authorized as of the      day of              ,          .

 

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

Acknowledged:

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB,

as Collateral Agent

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

C-3


STATE OF                         )
      ) ss.:
COUNTY OF                         )

I,                      , a Notary Public in and for said County, in the State aforesaid, DO HEREBY CERTIFY, that                      ,                      of [NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR] (the “ Company ”), personally known to me to be the same person whose name is subscribed to the foregoing instrument as such                      , appeared before me this day in person and acknowledged that (s)he signed, executed and delivered the said instrument as her/his own free and voluntary act and as the free and voluntary act of said Company, for the uses and purposes therein set forth being duly authorized so to do.

GIVEN under my hand and Notarial Seal this      day of              ,          .

 

[Seal]    

 

Signature of notary public    
My Commission expires  

 

 

 

C-4


Schedule 1

to Patent Security

Agreement

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]

PATENTS AND DESIGN PATENTS

 

Patent No.

  

Issued

  

Expiration

  

Country

  

Title

           
           
           
           
           

PATENT APPLICATIONS

 

Case No.

  

Serial No.

  

Country

  

Date

  

Filing Title

           
           
           
           
           

PATENT LICENSES

 

Name of

Agreement

  

Parties

Licensor/Licensee

  

Date of

Agreement

  

Subject

Matter

        
        
        
        
        

 

C-5


EXHIBIT D

to Security Agreement

TRADEMARK SECURITY AGREEMENT

(Trademarks, Trademark Registrations, Trademark

Applications and Trademark Licenses)

WHEREAS, [name of Lien Grantor], a                      corporation 1 (herein referred to as the “ Lien Grantor ”) owns, or in the case of licenses is a party to, the Trademark Collateral (as defined below);

WHEREAS, Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc. (collectively, the “Issuers”), Tower Automotive, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings I, LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(a), LLC, Tower Automotive Holdings II(b), LLC, the other guarantors and lenders party thereto, and Wilmington Trust FSB, as trustee and collateral agent, are parties to that certain Senior Debt Securities Indenture dated as of August 24, 2010 (as amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time, the “ Indenture ”); and

WHEREAS, pursuant to (i) a Notes Security Agreement dated as of August 24, 2010 (as amended and/or supplemented from time to time, the “ Security Agreement ”) among the Issuers, the guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, as collateral agent for the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, together with its successors in such capacity, the “ Grantee ”), and (ii) certain other secured notes documents (including this Trademark Security Agreement), the Lien Grantor has [secured certain of its obligations (the “ Secured Obligations ”)] 2 [guaranteed certain obligations of the Issuers and secured such guarantee (the “ Lien Grantor’s Note Guarantee ”)] 3 by granting to the Grantee for the benefit of such Secured Parties a continuing security interest in personal property of the Lien Grantor, including all right, title and interest of the Lien Grantor in, to and under the Trademark Collateral (as defined below);

 

1

Modify as needed if the Lien Grantor is not a corporation.

2

Delete these bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is a Subsidiary Guarantor.

3

Delete these bracketed words if the Lien Grantor is an Issuer.

 

D-1


NOW, THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the Lien Grantor grants to the Grantee, to secure the [Secured Obligations] [Lien Grantor’s Note Guarantee], a continuing security interest in all of the Lien Grantor’s right, title and interest in, to and under the following (all of the following items or types of property being herein collectively referred to as the “ Trademark Collateral ”), whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising:

(i) each Trademark (as defined in the Security Agreement) owned by the Lien Grantor, including, without limitation, each Trademark registration and application referred to in Schedule 1 hereto, and all of the goodwill of the business connected with the use of, or symbolized by, each Trademark (provided that no security interest shall be granted in the United States intent-to-use trademark applications to the extent that, and solely during the period in which, the grant of a security interest therein would impair the validity or enforceability of such intent-to-use trademark applications under applicable federal law);

(ii) each Trademark License (as defined in the Security Agreement) to which the Lien Grantor is a party, including, without limitation, each Trademark License identified in Schedule 1 hereto, and all of the goodwill of the business connected with the use of, or symbolized by, each Trademark licensed pursuant thereto; and

(iii) all proceeds of and revenues from the foregoing, including, without limitation, all proceeds of and revenues from any claim by the Lien Grantor against third parties for past, present or future unfair competition with, or violation of intellectual property rights in connection with or injury to, or infringement or dilution of, any Trademark owned by the Lien Grantor (including, without limitation, any Trademark identified in Schedule 1 hereto), and all rights and benefits of the Lien Grantor under any Trademark License (including, without limitation, any Trademark License identified in Schedule 1 hereto), or for injury to the goodwill associated with any of the foregoing.

The Lien Grantor irrevocably constitutes and appoints the Grantee and any officer or agent thereof, with full power of substitution, as its true and lawful attorney-in-fact with full power and authority in the name of the Lien Grantor or in the Grantee’s name, from time to time, in the Grantee’s discretion, so long as any Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, to take with respect to the Trademark Collateral any and all appropriate action which the Lien Grantor might take with respect to the Trademark Collateral and to execute any and all documents and instruments which may be necessary or desirable to carry out the

 

D-2


terms of this Trademark Security Agreement and to accomplish the purposes hereof.

Except to the extent expressly permitted in the Security Agreement or the Indenture, the Lien Grantor agrees not to sell, license, exchange, assign or otherwise transfer or dispose of, or grant any rights with respect to, or mortgage or otherwise encumber, any of the Trademark Collateral.

The foregoing security interest is granted in conjunction with the security interests granted by the Lien Grantor to the Grantee pursuant to the Security Agreement. The Lien Grantor acknowledges and affirms that the rights and remedies of the Grantee with respect to the security interest in the Trademark Collateral granted hereby are more fully set forth in the Security Agreement, the terms and provisions of which are incorporated by reference herein as if fully set forth herein.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Lien Grantor has caused this Trademark Security Agreement to be duly executed by its officer thereunto duly authorized as of the      day of              ,          .

 

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

Acknowledged:

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB,

as Collateral Agent

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

D-3


STATE OF                         )
      ) ss.:
COUNTY OF                         )

I,                      , a Notary Public in and for said County, in the State aforesaid, DO HEREBY CERTIFY, that                      ,                      of [NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR] (the “ Company ”), personally known to me to be the same person whose name is subscribed to the foregoing instrument as such                      , appeared before me this day in person and acknowledged that (s)he signed, executed and delivered the said instrument as her/his own free and voluntary act and as the free and voluntary act of said Company, for the uses and purposes therein set forth being duly authorized so to do.

GIVEN under my hand and Notarial Seal this      day of              ,          .

 

[Seal]    

 

Signature of notary public    
My Commission expires  

 

 

 

D-4


Schedule 1

to Trademark

Security Agreement

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]

U.S. TRADEMARK REGISTRATIONS

 

TRADEMARK

  

REG. NO.

  

REG. DATE

     
     
     
     
     

U.S. TRADEMARK APPLICATIONS

 

TRADEMARK

  

REG. NO.

  

REG. DATE

     
     
     
     
     

 

D-5


TRADEMARK LICENSES

 

Name of

Agreement

  

Parties

Licensor/Licensee

  

Date of

Agreement

  

Subject

Matter

        
        
        
        
        

 

D-6


EXHIBIT E

to Security Agreement

PERFECTION CERTIFICATE

The undersigned is a duly authorized officer of [NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR] (the “ Lien Grantor ”). With reference to the Notes Security Agreement dated as of August 24, 2010 among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, TA Holdings Finance, Inc., the other Lien Grantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, as Collateral Agent (terms defined therein being used herein as therein defined), the undersigned certifies to the Collateral Agent and each other Secured Party as follows:

A. Information Required for Filings and Searches for Prior Filings.

1. Jurisdiction of Organization . The Lien Grantor is a [corporation] 3 organized under the laws of                      .

2. Name . The exact [corporate] name of the Lien Grantor as it appears in its [certificate of incorporation] is as follows:

3. Prior Names; Predecessors . (a) Set forth below is each other [corporate] name that the Lien Grantor has had since its organization, together with the date of the relevant change:

(b) Except as set forth in Schedule      hereto, the Lien Grantor has not changed its corporate structure in any way within the past five years.

(c) None of the Lien Grantor’s Collateral was acquired from another Person within the past five years, except

(i) property sold to the Lien Grantor by another Person in the ordinary course of such other Person’s business;

(ii) property with respect to which the Transaction Liens are to be perfected by taking possession or control thereof;

(iii) property acquired in transactions described in Schedule      hereto; and

 

E-1


(iv) other property having an aggregate fair market value not exceeding $              .

4. Organizational ID Number . Set forth below is the Organizational Identification Number, if any, issued by the jurisdiction of organization of the Lien Grantor.

5. Taxpayer ID Number . Set forth below is the Federal Taxpayer Identification Number of the Lien Grantor: [only necessary for filing in North Dakota and South Dakota.]

6. Chief Executive Office . The chief executive office of the Lien Grantor (or its place of business if there is only one) is located at the address set forth below:

 

Mailing Address

  

County

  

State

     
     
     
     
     

B. Search Reports.

Attached hereto as Schedule      is a true copy of a file search report from the central UCC filing office in each jurisdiction identified in Part A–4 above with respect to each name set forth in Part A–2 and Part A–3 above (searches in local filing offices, if any, are not required). Attached hereto as Schedule      is a true copy of each financing statement or other filing identified in such file search reports.

C. Absence of Certain Property.

The Lien Grantor does not own any assets of material value which constitute commercial tort claims, farm products, electronic chattel paper, letter-of-credit rights which are not supporting obligations or as-extracted collateral, as each of the foregoing terms is defined in the UCC.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, I have hereunto set my hand this      day of              ,          .

 

 

Name:
Title:

 

E-2


EXHIBIT F

to Security Agreement

ISSUER CONTROL AGREEMENT

ISSUER CONTROL AGREEMENT dated as of                      ,              among              (the “ Lien Grantor ”), WILMINGTON TRUST FSB, as Collateral Agent (the “ Secured Party ”), and              (the “ Issuer ”). All references herein to the “ UCC ” refer to the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in [Issuer’s jurisdiction of incorporation].

W I T N E S S E T H :

WHEREAS, the Lien Grantor is the registered holder of [specify Pledged Uncertificated Securities issued by the Issuer] issued by the Issuer (the “ Securities ”);

WHEREAS, pursuant to (i) an Amended and Restated ABL Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ ABL Security Agreement ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, as borrower (the “ Borrower ”), the guarantors party thereto including the Lien Grantor (the “ Subsidiary Guarantors ”) and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., acting as agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ ABL Agent ”), (ii) an Amended and Restated First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Borrower, the Subsidiary Guarantors and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., acting as agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ First Lien Term Loan Agent ” and (iii) and a Notes Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ Notes Security Agreement ” and, together with the ABL Security Agreement and the First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement, the “ Security Agreements ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc. (collectively, the “ Issuers ”), the Subsidiary Guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, acting as collateral agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ Collateral Agent ”, together with the ABL Agent and the First Lien Term Loan Agent, the “ Agents ”), the Lien Grantor has granted to the Agents, for the benefit of the Secured Parties (as defined in each of the Security Agreements), a continuing security interest (the “ Transaction Lien ”) in all right, title and interest of the Lien

 

F-1


Grantor in, to and under the Securities, whether now existing or hereafter arising; and

WHEREAS, the Agents, the Borrower, the Issuers and certain other parties are parties to an Amended and Restated Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, pursuant to which the Collateral Agent is to enter into this Agreement for the benefit of the Secured Parties (as defined in each of the Security Agreements) in order to perfect the Transaction Lien on the Securities;

NOW, THEREFORE, the parties hereto agree as follows:

Section 1. Nature of Securities. The Issuer confirms that (i) the Securities are “uncertificated securities” (as defined in Section 8-102 of the UCC) and (ii) the Lien Grantor is registered on the books of the Issuer as the registered holder of the Securities.

Section 2. Instructions. The Issuer agrees to comply with any “instruction” (as defined in Section 8-102 of the UCC) originated by the Secured Party and relating to the Securities without further consent by the Lien Grantor or any other person. The Lien Grantor consents to the foregoing agreement by the Issuer.

Section 3. Waiver of Lien; Waiver of Set-off. The Issuer waives any security interest, lien or right of set-off that it may now have or hereafter acquire in or with respect to the Securities. The Issuer’s obligations in respect of the Securities will not be subject to deduction, set-off or any other right in favor of any person other than the Secured Party.

Section 4. Choice of Law. This Agreement shall be governed by the laws of [Issuer’s jurisdiction of incorporation].

Section 5. Conflict with Other Agreements. There is no agreement (except this Agreement) between the Issuer and the Lien Grantor with respect to the Securities [except for [identify any existing other agreements] (the “ Existing Other Agreements ”)]. In the event of any conflict between this Agreement (or any portion hereof) and any other agreement [(including any Existing Other Agreement)] between the Issuer and the Lien Grantor with respect to the Securities, whether now existing or hereafter entered into, the terms of this Agreement shall prevail.

Section 6. Amendments. No amendment or modification of this Agreement or waiver of any right hereunder shall be binding on any party hereto unless it is in writing and is signed by all the parties hereto.

 

F-2


Section 7. Notice of Adverse Claims. Except for the claims and interests of the Secured Party and the Lien Grantor in the Securities, the Issuer does not know of any claim to, or interest in, the Securities. If any person asserts any lien, encumbrance or adverse claim (including any writ, garnishment, judgment, attachment, execution or similar process) against the Securities, the Issuer will promptly notify the Secured Party and the Lien Grantor thereof.

Section 8. Maintenance of Securities. In addition to, and not in lieu of, the obligation of the Issuer to honor instructions as agreed in Section 2 hereof, the Issuer agrees as follows:

(i) Lien Grantor Instructions; Notice of Exclusive Control. So long as the Issuer has not received a Notice of Exclusive Control (as defined below), the Issuer may comply with instructions of the Lien Grantor or any duly authorized agent of the Lien Grantor in respect of the Securities. After the Issuer receives a written notice from the Secured Party that it is exercising exclusive control over the Securities (a “ Notice of Exclusive Control ”), the Issuer will cease complying with instructions of the Lien Grantor or any of its agents.

(ii) Non-Cash Dividends and Distributions. After the receipt of a Notice of Exclusive Control, the Issuer shall deliver to the Secured Party all dividends, interest and other distributions paid or made upon or with respect to the Securities.

(iii) Voting Rights. Until the Issuer receives a Notice of Exclusive Control, the Lien Grantor shall be entitled to direct the Issuer with respect to voting the Securities.

(iv) Statements and Confirmations. The Issuer will promptly send copies of all statements and other correspondence concerning the Securities simultaneously to each of the Lien Grantor and the Secured Party at their respective addresses specified in Section 11 hereof.

(v) Tax Reporting. All items of income, gain, expense and loss recognized in respect of the Securities shall be reported to the Internal Revenue Service and all state and local taxing authorities under the name and taxpayer identification number of the Lien Grantor.

Section 9. Representations, Warranties and Covenants of the Issuer. The Issuer makes the following representations, warranties and covenants:

(i) This Agreement is a valid and binding agreement of the Issuer enforceable in accordance with its terms.

 

F-3


(ii) The Issuer has not entered into, and until the termination of this Agreement will not enter into, any agreement with any other person relating to the Securities pursuant to which it has agreed, or will agree, to comply with instructions (as defined in Section 8-102 of the UCC) of such person. The Issuer has not entered into any other agreement with the Lien Grantor or the Secured Party purporting to limit or condition the obligation of the Issuer to comply with instructions as agreed in Section 2 hereof.

Section 10. Successors. This Agreement shall be binding upon, and shall inure to the benefit of, the parties hereto and their respective successors and assigns.

Section 11. Notices. Each notice, request or other communication given to any party hereunder shall be in writing (which term includes facsimile or other electronic transmission) and shall be effective (i) when delivered to such party at its address specified below, (ii) when sent to such party by facsimile or other electronic transmission, addressed to it at its facsimile number or electronic address specified below, and such party sends back an electronic confirmation of receipt or (iii) ten days after being sent to such party by certified or registered United States mail, addressed to it at its address specified below, with first class or airmail postage prepaid:

Lien Grantor:

Secured Party:

Issuer:

Any party may change its address, facsimile number and/or e-mail address for purposes of this Section by giving notice of such change to the other parties in the manner specified above.

Section 12. Termination. The rights and powers granted herein to the Secured Party (i) have been granted in order to perfect the Transaction Lien, (ii) are powers coupled with an interest and (iii) will not be affected by any bankruptcy of the Lien Grantor or any lapse of time. The obligations of the Issuer hereunder shall continue in effect until the Secured Party has notified the Issuer in writing that the Transaction Lien has been terminated pursuant to the Security Agreement.

Section 13. Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts, all of which shall constitute one and the same instrument,

 

F-4


and any party hereto may execute this Agreement by signing and delivering one or more counterparts.

 

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB,

as Collateral Agent

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
[NAME OF ISSUER]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

F-5


Exhibit A

[Letterhead of Secured Party]

[Date]

[Name and Address of Issuer]

Attention:                     

 

  Re: Notice of Exclusive Control

Ladies and Gentlemen:

As referenced in the Issuer Control Agreement dated as of                      ,              among [name of Lien Grantor], us and you (a copy of which is attached), we notify you that we will hereafter exercise exclusive control over [specify Pledged Uncertificated Securities] registered in the name of [name of Lien Grantor] (the “ Securities ”). You are instructed not to accept any directions or instructions with respect to the Securities from any person other than the undersigned unless otherwise ordered by a court of competent jurisdiction.

You are instructed to deliver a copy of this notice by facsimile transmission to [name of Lien Grantor].

 

Very truly yours,
 

WILMINGTON TRUST FSB,

as Collateral Agent

  By:  

 

    Name:
    Title:

cc: [name of Lien Grantor]

 

F-6


EXHIBIT G

to Security Agreement

SECURITIES ACCOUNT CONTROL AGREEMENT

SECURITIES ACCOUNT CONTROL AGREEMENT dated as of                      ,              among              (the “ Lien Grantor ”), JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A, as Agent (the “ Secured Party ”), and              (the “ Securities Intermediary ”). All references herein to the “ UCC ” refer to the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in the State of New York. Terms defined in the UCC have the same meanings when used herein.

W I T N E S S E T H :

WHEREAS, the Lien Grantor is the entitlement holder with respect to the Account (as defined below);

WHEREAS, pursuant to (i) an Amended and Restated ABL Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ ABL Security Agreement ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, as borrower (the “ Borrower ”), the guarantors party thereto including the Lien Grantor (the “ Subsidiary Guarantors ”) and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., acting as agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ Agent ”), (ii) an Amended and Restated First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Borrower, the Subsidiary Guarantors and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., acting as agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ First Lien Term Loan Agent ” and (iii) and a Notes Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ Notes Security Agreement ” and, together with the ABL Security Agreement and the First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement, the “ Security Agreements ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc. (collectively, the “ Issuers ”), the Subsidiary Guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, acting as collateral agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ Collateral Agent ”, together with the Agent and the First Lien Term Loan Agent, the “ Agents ”), the Lien Grantor has granted to the Agents, for the benefit of the Secured Parties (as defined in each of the Security Agreements), a continuing security interest (the “ Transaction Lien ”) in all right, title and interest of the Lien Grantor in, to and under the Account, all financial assets credited thereto and all

 

G-1


security entitlements in respect thereof, whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising; and

WHEREAS, the Agents, the Borrower, the Issuers and certain other parties are parties to an Amended and Restated Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, pursuant to which the Agent is to enter into this Agreement for the benefit of the Secured Parties (as defined in each of the Security Agreements) in order to perfect the Transaction Lien on the Account, all financial assets from time to time credited thereto and all security entitlements in respect thereof;

NOW, THEREFORE, the parties hereto agree as follows:

Section 1. Establishment of Account. The Securities Intermediary confirms that:

(i) the Securities Intermediary has established account number [identify account number] in the name of “[name of Lien Grantor]” (such account and any successor account, the “ Account ”),

(ii) the Account is a “securities account” as defined in Section 8-501 of the UCC,

(iii) the Securities Intermediary is acting as a “securities intermediary” (as defined in Section 8-102 of the UCC) in respect of the Account,

(iv) the Securities Intermediary shall, subject to the terms of this Agreement, treat the Lien Grantor as entitled to exercise the rights that comprise all financial assets from time to time credited to the Account,

(v) all property delivered to the Securities Intermediary by or on behalf of the Lien Grantor will be promptly credited to the Account, and

(vi) all financial assets (except cash) credited to the Account will be registered in the name of the Securities Intermediary, indorsed to the Securities Intermediary or in blank or credited to another securities account maintained in the name of the Securities Intermediary and in no case will any financial asset credited to the Account be registered in the name of the Lien Grantor, payable to the order of the Lien Grantor or specially indorsed to the Lien Grantor unless such financial asset has been further indorsed to the Securities Intermediary or in blank.

 

G-2


Section 2. “Financial Assets” Election. The parties hereto agree that each item of property (whether investment property, financial asset, security, instrument, cash or other property) credited to the Account shall be treated as a “financial asset” within the meaning of Sections 8-102(a)(9) and 8-103 of the UCC.

Section 3. Entitlement Orders. The Securities Intermediary agrees to comply with any “entitlement order” (as defined in Section 8-102 of the UCC) originated by the Secured Party and relating to the Account or any financial asset credited thereto without further consent by the Lien Grantor or any other person. The Lien Grantor consents to the foregoing agreement by the Securities Intermediary.

Section 4. Waiver of Lien; Waiver of Set-off. The Securities Intermediary waives any security interest, lien or right to make deductions or setoffs that it may now have or hereafter acquire in or with respect to the Account, any financial asset credited thereto or any security entitlement in respect thereof. Neither the financial assets credited to the Account nor the security entitlements in respect thereof will be subject to deduction, set-off, banker’s lien, or any other right in favor of any person other than the Secured Party [(except that the Securities Intermediary may set off (i) all amounts due to it in respect of its customary fees and expenses for the routine maintenance and operation of the Account and (ii) the face amount of any checks that have been credited to the Account but are subsequently returned unpaid because of uncollected or insufficient funds)].

Section 5. Choice of Law. This Agreement shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of New York]. The State of New York shall be deemed to be the Securities Intermediary’s jurisdiction for purposes of the UCC (including, without limitation, Section 8-110 thereof).

Section 6. Conflict with Other Agreements. There is no agreement (except this Agreement) between the Securities Intermediary and the Lien Grantor with respect to the Account [except for [identify any existing other agreements] (the “ Existing Other Agreements ”)]. In the event of any conflict between this Agreement (or any portion hereof) and any other agreement [(including any Existing Other Agreement)] between the Securities Intermediary and the Lien Grantor with respect to the Account, whether now existing or hereafter entered into, the terms of this Agreement shall prevail. [If any Existing Other Agreement does not specify that it is governed by the laws of [the jurisdiction specified in Section 5], such Existing Other Agreement is hereby amended to specify that it is governed by the laws of [the jurisdiction specified in Section 5].

 

G-3


Section 7. Amendments. No amendment or modification of this Agreement or waiver of any right hereunder shall be binding on any party hereto unless it is in writing and is signed by all the parties hereto.

Section 8. Notice of Adverse Claims. Except for the claims and interests of the Secured Party and the Lien Grantor, the Securities Intermediary does not know of any claim to, or interest in, the Account, any financial asset credited thereto or any security entitlement in respect thereof. If any person asserts any lien, encumbrance or adverse claim (including any writ, garnishment, judgment, attachment, execution or similar process) against the Account, any financial asset credited thereto or any security entitlement in respect thereof, the Securities Intermediary will promptly notify the Secured Party and the Lien Grantor thereof.

Section 9. Maintenance of Account. In addition to, and not in lieu of, the obligation of the Securities Intermediary to honor entitlement orders as agreed in Section 3 hereof, the Securities Intermediary agrees to maintain the Account as follows:

(i) Lien Grantor Entitlement Orders; Notice of Exclusive Control. So long as the Securities Intermediary has not received a Notice of Exclusive Control (as defined below), the Securities Intermediary may, subject to paragraph (iii) below, comply with entitlement orders of the Lien Grantor or any duly authorized agent of the Lien Grantor in respect of the Account and any or all financial assets credited thereto. After the Securities Intermediary receives a written notice from the Secured Party that is exercising exclusive control over the Account (a “ Notice of Exclusive Control ”), the Securities Intermediary will cease complying with entitlement orders of the Lien Grantor or any of its agents.

(ii) Voting Rights. Until the Securities Intermediary receives a Notice of Exclusive Control, the Lien Grantor shall be entitled to direct the Securities Intermediary with respect to the voting of any financial assets credited to the Account.

(iii) Permitted Investments. Until the Securities Intermediary receives a Notice of Exclusive Control, the Lien Grantor shall be entitled to direct the Securities Intermediary with respect to the selection of investments to be made and credited to the Account.

(iv) Statements and Confirmations. The Securities Intermediary will promptly send copies of all statements, confirmations and other correspondence concerning the Account and/or any financial assets credited thereto simultaneously to each of the Lien Grantor and the Secured Party at their respective addresses specified in Section 12 hereof.

 

G-4


(v) Tax Reporting. All items of income, gain, expense and loss recognized in the Account or in respect of any financial assets credited thereto shall be reported to the Internal Revenue Service and all state and local taxing authorities under the name and taxpayer identification number of the Lien Grantor.

Section 10. Representations, Warranties and Covenants of the Securities Intermediary. The Securities Intermediary makes the following representations, warranties and covenants:

(i) The Account has been established as set forth in Section 1 above and will be maintained in the manner set forth herein until this Agreement is terminated. The Securities Intermediary will not change the name or account number of the Account without the prior written consent of the Secured Party.

(ii) No financial asset credited to the Account is or will be registered in the name of the Lien Grantor, payable to the order of the Lien Grantor, or specially indorsed to the Lien Grantor, unless such financial asset has been further indorsed by the Lien Grantor to the Securities Intermediary or in blank.

(iii) This Agreement is a valid and binding agreement of the Securities Intermediary enforceable in accordance with its terms.

(iv) The Securities Intermediary has not entered into, and until the termination of this Agreement will not enter into, any agreement with any person (other than the Secured Party) relating to the Account and/or any financial asset credited thereto pursuant to which it has agreed, or will agree, to comply with entitlement orders of such person. The Securities Intermediary has not entered into any other agreement with the Lien Grantor or the Secured Party purporting to limit or condition the obligation of the Securities Intermediary to comply with entitlement orders as agreed in Section 3 hereof.

Section 11. Successors. This Agreement shall be binding upon, and shall inure to the benefit of, the parties hereto and their respective successors and assigns.

Section 12. Notices. Each notice, request or other communication given to any party hereunder shall be in writing (which term includes facsimile or other electronic transmission) and shall be effective (i) when delivered to such party at its address specified below, (ii) when sent to such party by facsimile or other electronic transmission, addressed to it at its facsimile number or electronic

 

G-5


address specified below, and such party sends back an electronic confirmation of receipt or (iii) ten days after being sent to such party by certified or registered United States mail, addressed to it at its address specified below, with first class or airmail postage prepaid:

Lien Grantor:

Secured Party:

Securities Intermediary:

Any party may change its address, facsimile number and/or e-mail address for purposes of this Section by giving notice of such change to the other parties in the manner specified above.

Section 13. Termination. The rights and powers granted herein to the Secured Party (i) have been granted in order to perfect the Transaction Lien, (ii) are powers coupled with an interest and (iii) will not be affected by any bankruptcy of the Lien Grantor or any lapse of time. The obligations of the Securities Intermediary hereunder shall continue in effect until the Secured Party has notified the Securities Intermediary in writing that the Transaction Lien has been terminated pursuant to the terms of the Security Agreement.

 

[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,
as Agent

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

G-6


[NAME OF SECURITIES INTERMEDIARY]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

G-7


Exhibit A

[Letterhead of Secured Party]

[Date]

[Name and Address of Securities Intermediary]

Attention:                     

 

  Re: Notice of Exclusive Control

Ladies and Gentlemen:

As referenced in the Securities Account Control Agreement dated as of                      ,              among [name of Lien Grantor], us and you (a copy of which is attached), we notify you that we will hereafter exercise exclusive control over securities account number              (the “ Account ”), all financial assets from time to time credited thereto and all security entitlements in respect thereof. You are instructed not to accept any directions, instructions or entitlement orders with respect to the Account or the financial assets credited thereto from any person other than the undersigned unless otherwise ordered by a court of competent jurisdiction.

You are instructed to deliver a copy of this notice by facsimile transmission to [name of Lien Grantor].

 

 

Very truly yours,
 

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,

as Agent

  By:  

 

    Name:
    Title:

cc: [name of Lien Grantor]

 

G-8


EXHIBIT H

to Security Agreement

DEPOSIT ACCOUNT CONTROL AGREEMENT

DEPOSIT ACCOUNT CONTROL AGREEMENT dated as of                      ,              among              (the “ Lien Grantor ”), JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A, as Agent (the “ Secured Party ”), and              (the “ Bank ”). All references herein to the “ UCC ” refer to the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in the State of New York. Terms defined in the UCC have the same meanings when used herein.

W I T N E S S E T H :

WHEREAS, the Lien Grantor is the Bank’s customer (as defined in Section 4-104(1)(e) of the UCC) with respect to the Account (as defined below);

WHEREAS, pursuant to (i) an Amended and Restated ABL Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ ABL Security Agreement ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC, as borrower (the “ Borrower ”), the guarantors party thereto including the Lien Grantor (the “ Subsidiary Guarantors ”) and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., acting as agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ Agent ”), (ii) an Amended and Restated First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Borrower, the Subsidiary Guarantors and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., acting as agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ First Lien Term Loan Agent ” and (iii) and a Notes Security Agreement (as from time to time amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “ Notes Security Agreement ” and, together with the ABL Security Agreement and the First Lien Term Loan Security Agreement, the “ Security Agreements ”), dated as of August 24, 2010, among the Tower Automotive Holdings USA, LLC and TA Holdings Finance, Inc. (collectively, the “ Issuers ”), the Subsidiary Guarantors party thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB, acting as collateral agent on behalf of the Secured Parties referred to therein (in such capacity, the “ Collateral Agent ”, together with the Agent and the First Lien Term Loan Agent, the “ Agents ”), the Lien Grantor has granted to the Agents, for the benefit of the

 

H- 1


Secured Parties (as defined in each of the Security Agreements), a continuing security interest (the “ Transaction Lien ”) in all right, title and interest of the Lien Grantor in, to and under the Account; and

WHEREAS, the Agents, the Borrower, the Issuers and certain other parties are parties to an Amended and Restated Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of August 24, 2010, pursuant to which the Agent is to enter into this Agreement for the benefit of the Secured Parties (as defined in each of the Security Agreements) in order to perfect the Transaction Lien on the Account and any and all funds or deposits from time to time held therein or credited thereto, whether now owned or existing or hereafter acquired or arising;

NOW, THEREFORE, the parties hereto agree as follows:

Section 1. Establishment of Account. The Bank confirms that:

(i) the Bank has established account number [identify account number] in the name of “[name of Lien Grantor]” (such account and any successor account, the “ Account ”);

(ii) the Account is a “deposit account” as defined in Section 9-102(a)(29) of the UCC; and

(iii) the Bank is a “bank” (as defined in section 9-102 of the UCC) and is acting in such capacity in respect of the Account.

Section 2. Instructions. The Lien Grantor, the Secured Party and the Bank agree that the Bank will comply with (i) any instruction originated by the Secured Party directing disposition of funds in the Account and (ii) any other instruction from the Secured Party in respect of the Account, in each case without further consent by the Lien Grantor or any other person.

Section 3. Waiver of Lien; Waiver of Set-off. The Bank waives any security interest, lien or right to make deductions or setoffs that it may now have or hereafter acquire in or with respect to the Account or any or all funds or deposits from time to time held therein or credited thereto. No amounts credited to the Account will be subject to deduction, set-off, banker’s lien, or any other right in favor of any person other than the Secured Party [(except that the Bank may set off (i) all amounts due to it in respect of its customary fees and expenses for the routine maintenance and operation of the Account and (ii) the face amount of any checks that have been credited to the Account but are subsequently returned unpaid because of uncollected or insufficient funds)].

 

H- 2


Section 4. Choice of Law. This Agreement shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of New York. [The State of New York] shall be deemed to be the bank’s jurisdiction (as defined in Section 9-304 of the UCC) with respect to the Account.

Section 5. Conflict with Other Agreements. There is no agreement (except this Agreement) between the Bank and the Lien Grantor with respect to the Account [except for [identify any existing other agreements] (the “ Existing Other Agreements ”)]. In the event of any conflict between this Agreement (or any portion hereof) and any other agreement [(including any Existing Other Agreement)] between the Bank and the Lien Grantor with respect to the Account or any or all funds or deposits from time to time held therein or credited thereto, whether now existing or hereafter entered into, the terms of this Agreement shall prevail. If any Existing Other Agreement does not specify that it is governed by the laws of the jurisdiction specified in Section 5, such Existing Other Agreement is hereby amended to specify that it is governed by the laws of the jurisdiction specified in Section 5.

Section 6. Amendments. No amendment or modification of this Agreement or waiver of any right hereunder shall be binding on any party hereto unless it is in writing and is signed by all the parties hereto.

Section 7. Notice of Adverse Claims. Except for the claims and interests of the Secured Party and the Lien Grantor, the Bank does not know of any claim to, or interest in, the Account or any or all funds or deposits held therein or credited thereto. If any person asserts any lien, encumbrance or adverse claim (including any writ, garnishment, judgment, attachment, execution or similar process) against the Account or any or all funds or deposits held therein or credited thereto, the Bank will promptly notify the Secured Party and the Lien Grantor thereof.

Section 8. Maintenance of Account. In addition to, and not in lieu of, the obligation of the Bank to honor instructions originated by the Secured Party as agreed in Section 3 hereof, the Bank agrees to maintain the Account as follows:

(i) Lien Grantor Entitlement Orders; Notice of Exclusive Control. So long as the Bank has not received a Notice of Exclusive Control (as defined below), the Bank may comply with instructions originated by the Lien Grantor or any duly authorized agent of the Lien Grantor in respect of the Account and any or all funds or deposits held therein or credited thereto. After the Bank receives a written notice from the Secured Party that it is exercising exclusive control over the Account (a “ Notice of Exclusive Control ”), the Bank will cease complying with instructions originated by the Lien Grantor or any of its agents.

 

H- 3


(ii) Statements. The Bank will promptly send copies of all statements and other correspondence concerning the Account simultaneously to each of the Lien Grantor and the Secured Party at their respective addresses specified in Section 12 hereof.

(iii) Tax Reporting. All items of income, gain, expense and loss recognized in the Account or in respect of any funds or deposits held therein or credited thereto shall be reported to the Internal Revenue Service and all state and local taxing authorities under the name and taxpayer identification number of the Lien Grantor.

Section 9. Representations, Warranties and Covenants of the Bank. The Bank makes the following representations, warranties and covenants:

(i) The Account has been established as set forth in Section 1 above and will be maintained in the manner set forth herein until this Agreement is terminated. The Bank will not change the name or account number of the Account without the prior written consent of the Secured Party.

(ii) Neither the Account nor any funds or deposits at any time held therein or credited thereto is or will be evidenced by any instrument (as defined in Section 9-102 of the UCC) or constitutes or will constitute investment property (as defined in Section 9-102 of the UCC)

(iii) This Agreement is a valid and binding agreement of the Bank enforceable in accordance with its terms.

(iv) The Bank has not entered into, and until the termination of this Agreement will not enter into, any agreement with any person (other than the Secured Party) relating to the Account and/or any funds or deposits held therein or credited thereto pursuant to which it has agreed, or will agree, to comply with instructions of such person. The Bank has not entered into any other agreement with the Lien Grantor or the Secured Party purporting to limit or condition the obligation of the Bank to comply with instructions originated by the Secured Party as agreed in Section 3 hereof.

Section 10. Successors. This Agreement shall be binding upon, and shall inure to the benefit of, the parties hereto and their respective successors and assigns.

Section 11. Notices. Each notice, request or other communication given to any party hereunder shall be in writing (which term includes facsimile or other

 

H- 4


electronic transmission) and shall be effective (i) when delivered to such party at its address specified below, (ii) when sent to such party by facsimile or other electronic transmission, addressed to it at its facsimile number or electronic address specified below, and such party sends back an electronic confirmation of receipt or (iii) ten days after being sent to such party by certified or registered United States mail, addressed to it at its address specified below, with first class or airmail postage prepaid:

Lien Grantor:

Secured Party:

Bank:

Any party may change its address, facsimile number and/or e-mail address for purposes of this Section by giving notice of such change to the other parties in the manner specified above.

Section 12. Termination. The rights and powers granted herein to the Secured Party (i) have been granted in order to perfect the Transaction Lien, (ii) are powers coupled with an interest and (iii) will not be affected by any bankruptcy of the Lien Grantor or any lapse of time. The obligations of the Bank hereunder shall continue in effect until the Secured Party has notified the Bank in writing that the Transaction Lien has been terminated pursuant to the terms of the Security Agreement.

 

H- 5


[NAME OF LIEN GRANTOR]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,
as Agent

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
[NAME OF BANK]
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

H- 6


Exhibit A

[Letterhead of Secured Party]

[Date]

[Name and Address of Bank]

Attention:                     

 

  Re: Notice of Exclusive Control

Ladies and Gentlemen:

As referenced in the Deposit Account Control Agreement dated as of                      ,              among [name of Lien Grantor], us and you (a copy of which is attached), we notify you that we will hereafter exercise exclusive control over deposit account number              (the “ Account ”) and all funds and deposits from time to time held therein or credited thereto. You are instructed not to accept any directions or instructions with respect to the Account or the funds or deposits held therein or credited thereto from any person other than the undersigned unless otherwise ordered by a court of competent jurisdiction.

You are instructed to deliver a copy of this notice by facsimile transmission to [name of Lien Grantor].

 

Very truly yours,
 

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.,

as Agent

  By:  

 

    Name:
    Title:

cc: [name of Lien Grantor]

 

H- 7

Exhibit 23.1

CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

We consent to the use in this Amendment No. 6 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 of our report dated March 3, 2010 relating to the consolidated financial statements of Tower Automotive, LLC. and subsidiaries (the “Company”), as of and for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008 and for the five-month period ended December 31, 2007 (which report expresses an unqualified opinion and includes an explanatory paragraph relating to the application of the purchase accounting method to account for the acquisition of Tower Automotive, Inc. and the change in the measurement date of the defined benefit plan assets and liabilities to coincide with the Company’s year end), and of Tower Automotive Inc., d/b/a TA Delaware for the seven-month period ended July 31, 2007, appearing in this Registration Statement, and to the reference to us under the heading “Experts” in such Registration Statement.

Our audits of the consolidated financial statements referred to in our aforementioned report also included the financial statement schedule of the Company, listed in Item 16. This financial statement schedule is the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion based on our audits. In our opinion, such financial statement schedule, when considered in relation to the basic financial statements taken as a whole, present fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein.

/s/ Deloitte & Touche LLP

Detroit, Michigan

September 7, 2010

Exhibit 23.2

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

We consent to the use of our report dated April 5, 2008, with respect to the consolidated balance sheet of Metalsa, S. de R.L. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2007, and the related consolidated statements of income, partners’ capital and comprehensive income, and cash flows for the year then ended, included herein and to the reference to our firm under the heading “Experts” in this Amendment No. 6 to Registration Statement on Form S-1 of Tower Automotive LLC to be converted as described therein to a corporation named Tower International, Inc.

Our audit report refers to the adoption of provisions of FASB Interpretation No. 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes an Interpretation of FASB Statement No. 109 , as of January 1, 2007, and to the adoption of the recognition and disclosure provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standard No. 158, Employers’ Accounting for Defined Benefit Pension and Other Postretirement Plans , as of December 31, 2007.

 

KPMG Cárdenas Dosal, S.C
/s/ Jaime García Garcíatorres
Jaime García Garcíatorres
Monterrey, N.L., Mexico
September 3, 2010

Exhibit 24.2

POWER OF ATTORNEY

KNOW ALL PERSONS BY THESE PRESENTS, that the undersigned constitutes and appoints Mark Malcolm, James Gouin and Jeffrey L. Kersten, and each of them, his attorneys-in-fact, with full power of substitution for him in any and all capacities, to sign any and all pre-effective and post-effective amendments to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-165200) of Tower Automotive, LLC (to be converted to a corporation named Tower International, Inc.), and to file such amendments thereto, with exhibits thereto and other documents in connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact, or their substitute or substitutes, may do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.

 

Signature

 

Title

  

Date

/s/ Nicholas Chabraja

    

8/27/10

Nicholas Chabraja

 

Director

  

Exhibit 24.3

POWER OF ATTORNEY

KNOW ALL PERSONS BY THESE PRESENTS, that the undersigned constitutes and appoint Mark Malcolm, James Gouin and Jeffrey L. Kersten, and each of them, his attorneys-in-fact, with full power of substitution for him in any and all capacities, to sign any and all pre-effective and post-effective amendments to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-165200) of Tower Automotive, LLC (to be converted to a corporation named Tower International, Inc.), and to file such amendments thereto, with exhibits thereto and other documents in connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact, or their substitute or substitutes, may do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.

 

Signature

  

Title

  

Date

/s/ Dennis Donovan

     

5-25-2010

Dennis Donovan

  

Director

  

Exhibit 24.4

POWER OF ATTORNEY

KNOW ALL PERSONS BY THESE PRESENTS, that the undersigned constitutes and appoint Mark Malcolm, James Gouin and Jeffrey L. Kersten, and each of them, his attorneys-in-fact, with full power of substitution for him in any and all capacities, to sign any and all pre-effective and post-effective amendments to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-165200) of Tower Automotive, LLC (to be converted to a corporation named Tower International, Inc.), and to file such amendments thereto, with exhibits thereto and other documents in connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact, or their substitute or substitutes, may do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.

 

Signature

  

Title

  

Date

/s/ Frank English

     

May 17, 2010

Frank English

  

Director

  

Exhibit 24.5

POWER OF ATTORNEY

KNOW ALL PERSONS BY THESE PRESENTS, that the undersigned constitutes and appoint Mark Malcolm, James Gouin and Jeffrey L. Kersten, and each of them, his attorneys-in-fact, with full power of substitution for him in any and all capacities, to sign any and all pre-effective and post-effective amendments to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-165200) of Tower Automotive, LLC (to be converted to a corporation named Tower International, Inc.), and to file such amendments thereto, with exhibits thereto and other documents in connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact, or their substitute or substitutes, may do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.

 

Signature

  

Title

  

Date

/s/ Allan Gilmour

      5/26/10

Allan Gilmour

   Director   

Exhibit 24.6

POWER OF ATTORNEY

KNOW ALL PERSONS BY THESE PRESENTS, that the undersigned constitutes and appoint Mark Malcolm, James Gouin and Jeffrey L. Kersten, and each of them, his attorneys-in-fact, with full power of substitution for him in any and all capacities, to sign any and all pre-effective and post-effective amendments to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-165200) of Tower Automotive, LLC (to be converted to a corporation named Tower International, Inc.), and to file such amendments thereto, with exhibits thereto and other documents in connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact, or their substitute or substitutes, may do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.

 

Signature

  

Title

  

Date

/s/ Chan W. Galbato

      5/17/10

Chan W. Galbato

   Director